oer pares ae ererteriiabetrsar ied ; cpbear se $h Tae anc my oe : aye : wales ag ; : ; “ie ; oye + » ‘ : 4 - ae ee eee, be 7 . pibis ht " fei chet Crore ee eret rs i i pecitee ee | | | a | separa ieatiye Netcasts peececetettrai spacers renee eee aioe yeee ev iasae? heh che te by cares 13 baneree seit ore aye, ‘ ht tr atk ere, tbe. ae. > ace eas rhe + ot) ‘ : Jer st yt eo ¥,*'* Sbrorbiey ts > > , yecinh {o Meres Oks , nick etre, ; i Pl ? ‘> oy siei Pent ee : nos meth o ¥ * Si : , ie Zheng cia 3 . : 2 aes a id a ¢ rh ; zeit pete : | 2 0ee ; : whi biterh *, : ate re raveth , wee eth} vas oe iar ek * i) 7 Aha: 1S est a tl ; Hiya her late! : 4¢ asin Adel 2a del pees ‘be hs Sh 3 rt io py gaat a os ite te sir q WN qt 992eR9T00 TOEO O IOHM/1ElN ANATOMY OF THE CAT BY JACOB REIGHARD Professor of Zoology in the University of Michigan AND H. S. JENNINGS Instructor in Zoology in the University of Michigan WITH ONE HUNDRED AND SEVENTY-THREE ORIGINAL FIGURES DRAWN BY LOUISE BURRIDGE JENNINGS NEW YORK HENRY HOLT AND COMPANY 1901 ae ir ae ya! a PREFACE. ALTHOUGH the cat has long been in common use for the practical study of mammalian anatomy, a clear, correct, not too voluminous account of its structure, such as should be in the hands of students in the laboratory, has remained a -desideratum. A number of works have been published on the cat, some of them of much value, yet there is none which fulfils exactly the conditions mentioned. The books which have appeared on this subject are the following: 1. Strauss-Durckheim, H. Anatomie descriptive et com- parative du Chat. 2 vols. Paris, 1845. 2. Mivart, St. George. The Cat: an Introduction to the Study of Back-boned Animals, especially Mammals. New York, 1881. 3. Wilder, Burt G., and Gage, Simon H. Anatomical Technology as applied to the Domestic Cat. New York, 1882. 4. Gorham, F. P., and Tower, R. W. A _ Laboratory Guide for the Dissection of the Cat. New York, 1895. 5. Jayne, H. Mammalian Anatomy. Vol. I. Phila- delphia, 1898. The first of these works treats only of the muscles and bones, and is not available for American students. Its excel- lent plates (or Williams’s outline reproductions of the same) should be in every laboratory. The second book named is written in such general terms that its descriptions are not readily applicable to the actual structures found in the dissection of the cat, and experience has shown that it is not fitted for a laboratory handbook. It contains, in addition to a general account of the anatomy of the cat, also a discussion of its embryology, psychology, paleontology, and classification. ili iv PREFACE. . The book by Wilder and Gage professedly uses the cat as. a means of illustrating technical methods and a special system of nomenclature. While of much value in many ways, it does not undertake to give a complete account of the anatomy of the animal. The fourth work is a brief laboratory guide. The elaborate treatise by Jayne, now in course of publica- tion, is a monumental work, which will be invaluable for refer- -ence, but is too voluminous to place in the hands of students. At present only the volume on the bones has been published. As appears from the above brief characterization, none of these books gives a complete description of the anatomy of the cat in moderate volume and without extraneous matter. This is what the present work aims to do. In the year 1891-92, Professor Reighard prepared a partial account of the anatomy of the cat, which has since been in use, in typewritten form, in University of Michigan classes. It has. been used also at the Universities of Illinois, Nebraska, and West Virginia, and in Dartmouth College, and has proven so useful for college work in Mammalian Anatomy that it was decided to complete it and prepare it for publication. This has been done by Dr. Jennings. . The figures, which are throughout original, are direct re- productions of ink drawings, made under the direction of Dr. Jennings by Mrs. Jennings. The book is limited to a description of the normal anatomy of the cat. The direct linear action of each muscle taken alone has been given in the description of muscles; other matters belonging to the realm of physiology, as well as all histological matter, have been excluded. It was felt that the monumental work of Jayne on the anatomy of the cat, now in course of publication, forms the best repository for a description of varia- tions and abnormalities, so that these have been mentioned in the present volume only when they are so frequent as to be of much practical importance. Except where the contrary is stated, the descriptions are based throughout on our own dissections and observations and are in no sense a compilation. For this reason we have not PREFACE. v thought it necessary to collect the scattered references to the anatomy of the cat that may occur in the literature. A collection of such references may be found in Wilder and Gage’s Anatomical Technology. In addition to the works already referred to, we have of course made use of the standard works on human and veterinary anatomy. Among these should be mentioned as especially useful the Axatomie des Hundes by Ellenberger and Baum. Other publications which have been of service in the preparation of the work are Windle and Parson’s paper Ox the Myology of the Terrestrial Carniv- ora, in the Proceedings of the Zoological Society of London for 1897 and 1898, T. B. Stowell’s papers on the nervous system of the cat in the Proceedings of the American Philo- sophical Society (1881, 1886, 1888) and in the Journal of Comparative Neurology (vol. I.), and F. Clasen’s Die Muskeln und Nerven des proximalen Abschnitts der vorderen Extremt- tat der Katze, in Nova Acta der Ksl. Leop-Carol. Deutschen Akademie der Naturforscher, Bd. 64. ' Nomenclature.—The question of nomenclature has been one of difficulty. What is desired is a wnzform set of anatomical names,—a system that shall be generally used by - anatomists. At present the greatest diversity prevails as to the names to be applied to the different structures of the body. The only set of terms which at the present time seems to have any chance of general acceptance is that proposed by the German Anatomical Society at their meeting in Basel in 1895, and generally designated by the abbreviation BNA. This system has therefore been adopted, in its main features, for use in the present work. It.seems impossible at the present time, however, to impose any one set of terms absolutely upon anatomists of all nations, and we have felt it necessary to use for certain familiar structures, in place of the BNA terms, names that have come to have a fixed place in English anatomy, and may almost be considered component parts of the English language. The German anatomists have expressly recognized the fact that this would be to a greater or less degree necessary among anatomists of different nations, and have characterized their list as for the present tentative, and vi PREFACE. capable of farther development. The only purpose of a name is that it shall furnish a key to a common understanding; where the BNA name does not furnish such a key to English readers, and where there is a term in established English usage that does serve this purpose and seems unlikely to be sup- planted, we have used the latter. But we have endeavored to make the number of these exceptions as small as possible, and in such cases we have usually cited at the same time the term proposed by the German society, followed by the abbreviation BNA. When, on the other hand, we have adopted a BNA term for which there is also a commonly used English equiva- lent, the latter has likewise usually been cited in parenthesis. In deciding whether or not to use in a given case the BNA term many difficult cases arose. Will the common English name zznominate bone (os innominatum) be replaced by the, BNA term os cox@ or coxal bone? We have held this to be highly improbable, and have therefore used the term zznomz- nate bone, merely citing os core (BNA) as a synonym. In the same way we have used centrum as a designation of a part of a. vertebra, in place of corpus (BNA); premaxillary bone or pre- maxilla in place of os tncistvum (BNA); malar bone in place of os zygomaticum (BNA); trapezoid as a name of one of the bones of the carpus, in place of os multangulum minus (BNA), etc. In other cases where it has seemed probable that the BNA term would come into common use, though now un- familiar, this and the more common English expression are both used or used alternatively; such has been the case, for example, with the Gasserian ganglion or semilunar ganglion (BNA). In naming the cerebral sulci and gyri the system in use for man is not well fitted for bringing out the plan of those in the brain of the cat, so that it was necessary to reject the BNA names for these structures. As to the use of the Latin terms and their equivalents in English form, we have made a practice of employing in the text sometimes one, sometimes the other; this has the advan- tage of giving variety, and of impressing the interchangeability of the Latin and English forms on the mind of the student. Where a given structure is called by two equally well-known PREFACE. vii names, we have used both, holding that the student should become familiar with each and recognize their identity of meaning. In general we have maintained the principle that the primary purpose of such a work as the present is not to illus- trate or defend any particular system of nomenclature, but to aid in obtaining a knowledge of the structures themselves. With this end in view, we have used such terms as would in our judgment best subserve this purpose, making the BNA system, as the one most likely to prevail, our basis. In apply- ing the system we have had to keep in mind a number of sometimes conflicting principles. In some cases the judgment of other anatomists will doubtless differ from our own; but this we feel to be inevitable. The matter of an absolutely uniform nomenclature is not ripe for settlement at the present time. Some further explanation is needed in regard to the topo- graphical terms, or terms of direction, used in the present work. We have adopted the BNA terms in this matter also. The terms superior, inferior, anterior, and posterior have been avoided, as these terms do not convey the same meaning in the case of the cat as they do in man, owing to the difference ‘in the posture of the body. In place of these terms are used dorsal and ventral, cranial and caudal. As terms of direction these, of course, must have an absolutely fixed meaning, sig- nifying always the same direction without necessary reference to any given structure. For example, cranial means not merely toward the cranzum, but refers to the dzrection which is indicated by movement along a line from the middle of the body, toward the cranium; after the head or cranium is reached, the term still continues in force for structures even beyond the cranium. Thus the tip of the nose is considered to be craniad of the cranium itself. Lateral signifies away from the middle plane; medial toward it. Jnner and outer or internal and external are used only with reference to the struc- ture of separate organs, not with reference to the median plane of the body. In describing the limbs the convexity of the joint (the elbow or knee) is considered as dorsal, the concavity being therefore Viii PREFACE. ventral. Medial refers to that side of the limb which in the normal position is toward the middle of the body; /ateral to the outer side. Terms of direction which are derived only from the structure of the limb itself are in some cases more conven- ient than the usual ones. In the fore limbs the terms radza/ (referring to the side on which the radius lies) and w/zar (referring to the side on which the ulna lies) are used; in the hind limbs the terms 7zdza/ and fibular are used in a similar manner. Jzsta/ means toward the free end of a limb or other projecting structure; proxzmal, toward the attached end. For all these terms an adverbial form ending in -ad has been employed. Experience has shown this to be very useful in practice, and while not expressly recommended by the BNA, it is not condemned. Terms ending in -a/ are therefore adjectives; those ending in -ad are adverbs. In compounding these terms of direction, the hyphen has been omitted in accordance with the usage recommended by the Standard Dictionary. Thus dorsoventral is written in place of dorso-ventral, etc.. The student will perhaps’ be assisted in understanding these compounds if he notes that the first component always ends in -o, so that the letter o prac- tically serves the purpose of a hyphen in determining how the word is to be divided. In one particular the BNA nomenclature is not entirely consistent. While recommending or at least permitting the use of the general terms dorsal and ventral in place of the human fosterior and anterior, and cranial and caudal in place of superior and inferior, it retains the words anterior, posterior, supertor, and inferior as parts of the names of definite organs. For example, we have the muscle serratus anterior in place of serratus ventralis; serratus posterior inferior in place of serratus dorsalis caudalis. ‘This is very unfortunate, from a comparative standpoint, but we have felt it necessary to retain the BNA terms in order that the structures of the cat may receive the same names as the corresponding structures of man. In the matter of orthography we have endeavored to follow the best English anatomical usage, as exemplified in Gray’s PREFACE. ix Human Anatomy,—therefore writing peroneus in place of peroneus, pyriformis in place of piriformis, etc. The book is designed for use in the laboratory, to accom- pany the dissection and study of the structures themselves. Anatomy cannot be learned from a book alone, and no one should attempt to use the present work without at the same time carefully dissecting the cat. On the other hand, anatomy can scarcely be learned without descriptions and figures of the structures laid bare in dissection, so that this or some similar work should be in the hands of any one attempting to gain a knowledge of anatomy through the dissection of the cat. The figures have all been drawn from actual dissections, and have been carefully: selected with a view to furnishing the most direct assistance to the dissector. It is hoped that no figures are lacking that are required for giving the students the necessary points of departure for an intelligent dissection of any part of the body. The fore limb is illustrated somewhat more fully than the hind limb, because it was thought that the fore limb would usually be dissected first; the hind limb will be easily dissected, with the aid of the figures given, after the experience gained in dissecting the fore limb. As the book is designed to accompany the dissection of the specimen in the laboratory, it was deemed best to give succinct specific directions for the dissection of the different systems of organs, together with suggestions as to methods of preserving and handling the material. These are included in an appen- dix. CONTENTS. PAGE SEAR SRELECTON OF: THE OAT oe corel Suk 6 vos to sice we Roh ei ale eeees I PoE ne WV CriCUPALACOMUDT . o5)2 oS) ae e) oie cau geo 4 FA owe eras ok Orne eee I RHE AGIO CV OLN at a uw clal isis ipa doe oa wie Be ola ECR URIS OR eee I Stet OPUS oie cali act sie sae ws. oka ele We aiE ee agG wi Bs Pees OAT Al V CLEC DEG SACP o'giu' ao x: ooo cla séiv cele wise've dite wewwieeencae 8 ATA MEMO oa os Sine Ok anew no Base RU Rey Wee ee waco II Cervical Verte prs ..'5 ainocs a<-60 6 Soe eset his sa nwa cence weae a abe s II Ligaments of the Vertebral Colum, . 6.25 cs ccusbisacewscchiccsdcs 16 RR aie PRBS Se grote a alae sgh aly din! eS alld ee lol6'e: area ein aigta seu ann Stella aie alee 18 PE VE BG POT MU aes See 5 acs o 05 Be ke eb k oeinw dre Eee ea wale waren ekewee 20 RD ee iy oa ee tas Weak phe tiy/S ialeic'g os ul abe EER RR OME noe eS 21 Occipital Done, ¢ 5 o5- + <'a'5-\-'» ela lein stare! waa, e\s welt aS eras ererein ee Sea's 22 PEREEDATICIAL vise’ s'w wiialg cscs bic.t «\nis-gcn\o bin Ob oeie wale aud mee Mes.6 S50 6 25 SOU CU Davaduwns ts chen s sac eckecsond viswedes wees ‘dase seme t 25 EPCS ON CINGMEG erate aia t eit ig 400d tose be cele bs args SP ne An aoa e ema eemestes 29 IRIE MOA Sis a taa le le Aha: ein winioia miss Pala preted Ie slog Minw Aid sl oie\e sieele een eee 30 PRVICRANG oats Sinha ions sniee os Winn Seale Raneisity sie eR ea Maen cou eras 36 VOQUAE op ainda selene © a bb se cin dole wie tale bac cae oe neo eisaln wes hnis 37 PRR ERD SS Cae pining a4 d'5 Sos a base aboisla sek ee gMies Sasa e eee Se eRe 39 PORN ALY ool ca)sip) hoa 050 doe 6. Owe cic aig A Gre ow Ee aa om pnaiee Set 41 ASAIN eree la NS ra teteie cca waa y) oh ard w/b lated ale Sol Rake PN Sb 6 Mek Slee A aie Sree 42 PLTMMNG ee ai spin ons cw ose xox ceaes Saoaeeet oe e arp nor wi meee 42 ASM Moats lal ag eons! ccd, Vin ales cig hin ce sarnialtia eae ey Se Sea eee teaeD 44 WPA AtRIAG Soe alte eae sie bs jelww in eek a aha Wa ewes pp alswisy: siviets Solace ele wd 45 CORY AN a oof i5 clccean pa eis Sais sb bide Main dia Wbigtl nn dw era oud ons @matn iS 46 NRA erg ct nial alas pio wc Oi0r © ion ve SLT TY oles & obser ak eu tee ataes hue ai a 47 INEADOI NS ere ek, Seth asic 8a: Ga eo! cuales wor abide pags Lente ieee aon alecore 47 ERGO vicis Sena oe ok Bie ee EROS Calis cae PRET GON seas alaleeereien’ 49 SPS aia Bar MVONE Eick usa corsa era's < welw Nib Diet Reale Sb o Mioievieoes 49 MEAUIENSS CPE HUE oc igo aie le, gageate sie 6 uie Sis ep ala Kb ee was Come 57 Jomts anc Ligaments of the Skull...) 2.5. «ovis vices Bete ewig hols clea « 61 ine P Ne MOLACIC MERISCMIICS "ou s-sian's she's pd «0d Seam a aeald weenie «eis @ 62 MATERA Garon era ue hts acwini pie’ d'eys eid als wath vine i coup RB ofhinca wiale's SOS G8 ss 62 MRIS ae ch aig te ta ctan So: > atalino ola e's eid ae ho we wale Fale abe eaa Ne eat 64 RB WASSUAISS Go oie: ccc aie soos) sigre Rialbis a) Op ore ale MIRE RISS DLS ew Sivoo ois Gaels 64 TREES ec atases Seo al Cigek oh calles ern We Sook ake loka ol’o. 4a Obi ein W/E eg aig es mia gat ms abe 67 RINT peige Ce Nene Soni ci b¥ ids nd bie We ME DL ea pe ewe ara es 68 ee ER Se OR erie en ea of Sea ae erat ANE orc AC yy ri AEP 69 xil CONTENTS. PAGE Bones-ob the Hands corse es ae test agi ae ee cial aa hcareiaue asker 71 Joints and Ligaments of the Thoracic Limbs..................02.- 73 Wi: The Pelvic Pxtremitiesscc So ven waco oie ceo tin wits Meo ses choaic bk elecbe 7 dsinominate: “Bones. iss) so sid aa sneer head rele we oe se wlelnwawe oe os 76 POINT aes. iso tok sale ices ane eA Ee ee ence Ree Teves csiwiel we oleiack 79 Patella: ci:s pie slcls'ecaip ab vie: werd a aeiaiar aise tan ois a Spaces cha tole niece! saile 80 Be 2s CUA le er a eer N rer ieamase 1rd rear Seslisy -7 my ae ey ne ae 80 Pills oc saa a Gvsipeeidc utescecons BS naheaatrun sta’ eis oieicis e's wis. 16 82 WATSUS < chess eas ow es seem eteee cian oe aise Meisels ine lowe eels wile «lk si scs ose 82 Bones-af the Fook ssi ss ss Ghee ke ce CANES OUP aha aee ssl bs a wes 85 Joints and Ligaments of the Pelvic Limbs ................2.0.---- 86 Tie WCE i 5a cas Sos cae We Onde a RSM eee bs Geskde cies 93 A Musclessor Hie: Sian oy Se ieco aia ws vistainralaa dintes eisleian ee bere 4/5 Sigil elins 93 Pe Muscles of the Head syg.cs ce i soils oe Sk os ROReacs Siva Sidtenc soles arhess 96 As “SUDETHICIAL DEUSELES Tso 45 ots woth aes ars oa hie pee eases wip ear) vinis 96 Wh, TIGER MUSCLES ae Sees eel ce iailete mint oe ss store sean sis boiwa em 6 a0 26 107 a. Masclés:of Mastication’. 22% <..'5\ssivwe a) tints Sere oes - Dieeeicts 107 é; “Muscles’of PHyoid Bone. os tocaes toe telons «0s eee tas ass eas 112 III. Muscles of the Body.... © see. ee sees ceeeee Bee Sables signers & 9-5 115 ¥. Muscles Of the Backer aw ess cals assis gallate cs Riis Rag eg ae 115 4. Misacles of the DROUGET os os dishes sak oc sowie sinee's uss 115 ‘B. Muscles of the Vertebral Columnyies0 0. Jvicccese secs cs c's « 123 a. Muscles of the Lumbar and Thoracic Region......... 126 6. Dorsal Muscles of the Cervical Region.............. 131 C Muscles of Cie Tate ra ned bounce owen ies sh sons. 136 2. Muscles on the Ventral Side of the Vertebral Column........... 138 A. Lumbar and. Fhoracic Regions jis.s i. cseisetics vied vce ees 138 B. Muscles on the Ventral Side of the Neck................. 139 3; Daneiies OF Che TROTAK oc fone see Vy sis Ue pi ee awk ed vied ews 144 A. Breast Muscles (Connecting the Arm and Thorax) ........ 144 B. Muscles of the’ Wall of the: Thorax: oo .0e.6s Secs ccacccss 148 An) ADAM TAL NTUSHIOS: fac «Wisse wiaterts pane ayes ik Seay SmN TW ue aee has 153 2V; Meakcles-of the Thrtatic Ee so coca c vate Med Sieh wine eielee leew ce yale 156 T, SWuSCIES OF Che OMIIER c5(Ss.cis o.cibcsia ls biseb A dlse’s we’ sia's ies s'c'e's 156 A. Lateral Surface... ....06.scesccccccccscecceccssccceens 156 Pie BECCARY FSEABE 05.5.3 5 Fd cnslemindwiniog diese asi Manta o's uo es'sy 161 2. Muscles of the Brachium or Upper Arm .............0..006... 164 3. Muscles of the Antibrachium or Forearm.........-..0eeee+0005 172 Fastin of the Forearin, osc cis n ss cules eee mies kin asle ecient ss 172 A. Muscles on the Ulnar and Dorsal Side of the Forearm ..... 173 B. Muscles on the Radial and Ventral Side of the Forearm.... 179 a Whisclesot the Hand so... 8. Vis viv er ccc a ete w ele niga deve Gis Kevse'a 184 A. Between: the) LEndonss; sos oe Wisond ee eee disthe's Glee one's 184 B. Muscles of the Thumb,......... Ween Artes. Co See Rees ara 184 Cy, between the Metacarpals ats at cen ka ese cite arsine ee en Sie s 185 D, Special Muscles of the Second Digit. ir ocean. 8S 185 £.: Special Muscles of ‘the: Fifth-Digit. 2). isc voce eee 185 Ve Muscles of the:-Pelvic Tsimbs:23 ssoic nese Se wey bw cohen Sos be ees oss 186 CONTENTS. xiii PAGE A. On the Lateral Surface of the Hip........ a Ged silos! s ac 4s 186 PASCIA‘ OL EDO AMIR GS vas < ca p's oa see dae yeahh sos cae 186 iB; (On the Medial Surface of the Hip.) 356. vse secre cceses =< 192 Oe MBBC Nes GE FOO UID OG ici, as cow ars sare sun eae Selec he din a orcs 194 Fo ERIE OL TOS LOWED LER 6 cess camiks ens isa sda ok e's'ao 6 203 ey A Ue NA SE, oo va 0-99 As SE MES Kak Che Se chinese 203 B..QOn the Dorsal and Lateral Surfaces... 50.55. csc cece ccess 209 As Muscles! Of 106 PO0ts 5 oss. cc wcete hase wine ois stole w Se ekewoses 212 AY Muscles on the Dorsum of the POOb< oy. oe's sed ce se eceae 212 Ay muscles on the Sole Of the Hoot as vices cceedivcis secs oc 212 Cu Wiscles GF She T dTsUS 602 Bo oe cine ds tin be wd eelsce somes 215 EA BOURNE ere y Peis soe seth bia SOs nie Wee neal ek vo 6 Ce oma Werke ee ats 217 POTS BOOV 5 ASIY au cs Uso ba Cava hoes wa Sole upitie An Gal BPG Ss eka bows 217 WE AlNeOte COMAs es can a asia seins bee Shem sea Eh TAs Slots Hare eielae pats 221 Bo MOU oes races lg sss asin an Moines senate ties Sone tees 221 Prlande OF SRC Outta 6 sais 9 tise hae oe Siva sis eae okie ee oon e eet = 223 ROG ee Cui i ohs Kalco ae ee kaa 0k MAES ba eas oe Does 224 ROUSE gc pis ks ost 5 Sa ene os os se ee ea ier res. os 2.6 MGSCICS OP Ihe FONDUE. 0c iis s.c can cuca dniees ei acnee asia. te 22 ie OMIA pha a oki ona Cb pk opie OS ea oN ma Eels o Bas Cas 229 Muscles:o§ the Sott Palate; i956 see wite ses stews sce. 230 Bk MALIN > op aries ais WN SK ola sie al Kine Sd eee Ie Mm ER RAS cela oars 231 Muscles of the Play nx 607-5 Sc. sie etee Pcie Ov ae arlene 232 gh 8 Oa 1 Re net a aetran are cen pO har ea ee are hee pg eau try ae 234 Be Re i kat fl oy assis. ie de OA Ok SOE Re ie eae alae Bea 234 SC IDAIS AULCRIIDG ¢ a 5rs-u/s's'n's) 0 win sera al Wan REOPEN es Ware oT ere ga ete 236 GO. barge Intestitie. 60)5.5 eed hccee cane Le SE a ese ek Hae Vince 237 2 UL iver Pancreas, And OpICON «acs casa seh ete o 5k oe dea erates 239 Pal. Respivataey OUoans es o's 6a sy5'¢ sco oe 9-9 # aelean hale cela wine vines See 243 Be NASR CRMIE es op hes asso nie So ne see Ma pale Wee a wine Ey were ela'e Hime 243 Bec AATVOSs os avo ves: Br PRAT Pak eer aro See aes Ne or ace 240 Cartilages of the Larynx. cei oc. inane ecelciesn's voc vee seis €'s 247 Mascies et the Lary i505 s-cce gras cic ook OA Wek Aa Wale aun eee es 249 By MCACNOR i acim wisi tiginia gic tivilaLe Gunibia Week Rete so eek Winleae Sa ae oe 251 Bee EAS so scs s Ga ae ae Se eae dd nele seis oe vives aNUs esse saa’ 252 PENG: GANG 25: cc cc delaseule ec) cau sroscsteery ss 6 ae eae hb aan s ese 254 PRN VSMS Cal Cain gk a arcana baatetetaieioigiacnhig aiaie'S pie maul and ore 254 TY, Alpogenital Sy stent: 2% So ciiiciin ccaaeinacs lab wos vere cine ee) 649 wi enenes a 255 ie Rexetory, Organs: iss cep ct ca vein ss diesem bad Comber wees cena es 255 TSAAMOVS rs fos k 55d bie ds oR Wale eels soles See RRO Ahi @ Sean ws 255 MRS ter ip Ws oe claics b Kesh Sekine a eee tee EN eah se habeas 256 BAGO iat reek i ivlole Peele tiaie ie aise ts bea eaR eas siel vies’ nae als 256 (Suprarenal Bodies).........2cc-ccesececeseecccscescceseces 257 Be i ASONAT A OILERS oc fa: oiaians: ackinele.c.ecaihinis (taadis P 8a ae GU oF cabs ce wet 257 Pee TAGS Song So oan sl om sm eed dss Gs eo RS UN eo 0 0S eA 257 Pe MOINS Rais el celle CRRA Cos PAT ERM EE eee nine ors fies 263 Muscles of the Urogenital Organs, Rectum, and Anus,.......... 268 a. Muscles Common to the Male and Female................ 268 4: Muscles: Peculiar to the Male. ...:c be et ees caeetiw set ss 271 XIV CONTENTS. PAGE ¢:: Muscles Peeuhar.to the Pemale 7055 2024000 oo ee ee oes 272 TEE: CIRCULATORY: SYSTEM J scans aisiac wis BREE VE ee ROE oe ss Saree Seas 274 A Phe Heart: 05 vasa coos coe me nee ae Cimon s SOS ora ORR Se eae ant se 274 FE TG Arteries aise ius sa aan aternta ina bean larele meen stank ard ae eel Raia ec awe. 280 1.) Pulmonary: ATELY. . ees sss ele sc ealee Eoa wees abe cele stee sx 280 Be ATTA ee vn icis och Nite ties US ROME M Ph ee awhlbn abs cd 'p ass sede ss 281 a4. Vhoracic ‘Aortyand ats 2Branches ewoec icc oe oie es os 281 Comomon-Caratid Artery oo siiccge tetas neneetsdcces 283 Stibela vist Avery swig ais westerns ote oe ie eieiciic'y ate 290 B. Abdominal Aorta and its Branches.............e0eeeeees 301 External Iliac Artery and its Branches ................ 309 EIS, The Veta sce. ois iba eee eek AGE oda Weed ce Ve pn nd woke S05 315 ¥E, oMEINSIGE ENS ELCAPE Lule sige ears Wee Gl aalsion ea eleig ss ele vil vob ae aioe toe 315 2. Vena Cava Superior and its Branches,........sscecesesccsecee ‘316 Veins of the Brain and Spinal Cord .......... WeSC ved daa 324 3... Vena Cava: inferior and te Branenes i415). ck we cass c ene es okie 325 OPEL MCLE a iiss core sejute vata als teats po tei tip sieatew biota Da olga ese sities 326 EV... CoV PALE OHSECI vic ars ft ss tiv aia ei oe atte ed otals slots hcis Gh eWebus een cae 330 E. Scymiphaties Of the Plea oon cu oo wi pls siet k Diiecs ches se bg o o's. 331 2. Lymphatics of the Neck ............200. UKE LO NEEV Gute co cas 332 3. Lymphatics of the Thoracic Limbs............... cccceeccsees 332 4. Lymphatics of the Thorax and Abdomen.................e000 333 »: Laymphatics of the; Pelwicslambs once cso baie rls ticic ope e.cescs ss 334 THE “NERVOUS OYSTEM) 5 coenidcrwiss velae cuss ones SERS} ee ee es eet sincos 335 1; 2 The: Central Nervous System, = coi. scp hss ois lolepiate > aie cies oe Se gered 336 Ke CSpinial MOOK, core wie tints e eteGapntye tale weiela Wie Sons we ale 'c'oy Sits > (o's 330 2, The Brains 6.35354 sche net gine Wit ote wistieta bo leceungeie: Maren ses ss 339 (5) DEVCCRCO DAI ois evade cc bams epdts $a8s oo essen ese 344 (5) Paotenceph an soos cco keer whee b S bnc cewnes cee yes ss 347 (5) -taesencephalon cs 5.655555 Ve aes costes bee ecse es oe Spe! (4) Diencephalon: 2. 5. 60. ce eeeceesees edema w sislgtn cia hin is vies 352 (5) Pelencephaton.ci.:. inca sense uke ste oa ness epee bsp nesses 357 il, ‘The Perspneral Nervous Syetenh 2c ss sanneh eves chose ene scaeesss cs 369 ¥. | CrandalsNerves: 25 sais sche ecaictap ec nus b's sistas t SE ES a apa 369 1. Olfactory Nerve is U55 oasis w cote diesen sa Aarelieisie mis e's ccplt'e e's 369 TI-Optic: Nerve. <2): sic ce Pele aie pia wis sales wip ceis sieie ours.d wile sw cis 369 HIT: Oculomoton: Nerve oye sont cue ce aes ede Slats owe 5 e's abseibisis o's 369 BV. DrochlearwINGrveys cess. os pagans ale starotaia Sine Suslers «1s-oiclors.e 3% 370 Wis EIGEMINAL INCLVCss ccise oe ekeig a deck ont Oisiale hae «Si e's oes 370 Vi Abdacens oes c so/nrseise aicery an eaIS RS Obie ke aue cio Kezas Sins 375 VIL: Facial: Nerveoin. si. .4\54% 540s ease wha Sie Mais a ietedis sceiSa re esa 375 VII. Auditory-Netye:< fo 7.c.s6e se ree bare a saias eis 's8's 377 TX. Glossophary neeal Nerve aus voice evnesielee ce mets es sie) «'s 378 hs VAGUS INGEVG™: 24h ib ee nGietip hae RG Risley slbisiecemisitiy eis 858% 6 6 378 XI. Accessory Nerve.........see00- EG eee n aes ated» 382 XIE. Hypoglossal Nerve.....:00scivwccccicsedosesecsocsccecees 383 2; SpinalSNerves si): cuistsa wale fae w vanes ee Poe DEN ie tang ele eer s 383 Ah. COPVICALINGEV ES ei, o sioiw inte sah ees shale Ree BD Sie She's aes 383 The Brachial: Plexas, ooo osc e's en os see Sawa ie ase sins 5 386 CONTENTS. XV PAGE Pye BMRA CL PNET MOBS ce al ca'ars ale Civ d'alp siwala\es a's etelslee Sines eek es 393 Go SAMA UAU INCL VES: o\5 o',055 xb pd oro ineiesiey WaWerceae Keeeis 394 PAID E, PICRUS oa cen bis 3 do o.gelests ace. pib'sle pala sec waters 395 D. Sacral Nerves and Sacral Plexus............e06. aaa cities 399 iB Nerves Of the Tails 6.505 «ss eck s Va fatale Sioa dine aise wate (ues AOE: Aa IE VOT so os alvin a's igs 6 5.0,0al'a ns oe'wncneeeb ne cows: 404 SENSE ORGANS AND INTEGUMENT..........-ececcecceesees Bese Sepa 409 Mee Re Rae ase cere pin ai aeaca aegig cas a PNG is 4.0 Sia wpatalie | s Distareie Ay ooestin’ «076 ei dewiata oe 409 SR MAL CRMAR Fra hao ciate C's) c aie soe ees Ais chee WW, wise aS aes Sle Gere eles Ge Sle Asie 415 EE ONAN VON OAM os cig bk g'acsie oc 'a'k.s.gia> als Wibegie as tanret bis aca e a Ste ointe eid 426 MR EAE AN Ma hic ai lalg: sin iets Sw Sia cv cie tala Slnia g a eiivels «inn bierk a siciea sie 426 Pera PERSO NSNIMCRNE 9 op SU Sais ola 2's 0516.0) 055 oa ao bi care Mw Ww eld is "ee Soi ais ve vee leads 427 APPENDIX: PRACTICAL DIRECTIONS.........6. SRE Ee OL SI PE pes ge 429 LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS. FIG. PAGE MEPOMGICCON ar toe ee Sue Lek oN sins woe CR OU ERE Hse eed ceecwepes se Sotcres: 2 Bi Pomrth “Thoracic Vertetea.. 6.050) 6 vic. os's sicicsnescstccceuases egeepeea xd Hee x6 Erp ata: aso. oleis\d,6isieie giaisjeie's see's & a ¥:b\s h.eceiee'e sania Oe 3 MeL A MORRCIC VOTER eins vs vine ositc seep eavess caver tetindboecabedieneies 5 RAR TOMMEIOUEY ciscind sind e's $a'ss KUinbc eels phae bebe weleg arse velamen'n 7 a ORIN sso 8 eile cra Cowlety ine) ® wm sidinlai cae sieisinie e's e/d'e's)s\e abe' aie dais Desiemiveciceas 9 7 SE are wikia et acd cceicisae es meee Welk sels Horne a ee wip even me ae 9 Se RAMCAL VOMLODYA patie cwiael e's baiein wo sare o aiéw vl walocg'dic ahscelatat gis stolbses Are p ele Il 9- £s Sry cach v\ na were eee) s:6 le si0',e) Sie 0 a 6.018 wisp ala 9's ein b¥lale bie pibia eo It ge UA ere PP ee ek ey ee tay tr type pee aie 12 PE, antes CORCREE WERRCOTR GS aos ws ns 'b sous esau cies regenedos sss oe Siinlia'y'« 13 Bab ter CN AR rg at areca lao oee! eal sin lO rs' 4,6 sing sns ie oe RP aie- 4 Get Di ela a ge eoreie pods sighs Siw weeks MR RAG aerate atte Je et alath at pis shel Sieth Soi vw Siete nS ioscin e wlaiais ta ela ees: E sie d8 4 leaee's 15 Se Ldgaments of the Odontid Process. oi o0% vo icp bbs ising dienes oe siainiece 18 BM TTD 5a cps wing tin nig lad O00. 0 visierdivie py clbieia a(kl'¥ Owe)be a's Ws cic d's bAeee 9 a8 ele 19 Maer OTANI atest Srna oi otala-ang mu bi Bie ware ate Bare e niki Ru ENA Se asaya) SAW in/ pon ee Om 20 Ue GCIDLEAL EIOBO i's: 2. $4) cna: a(t siaralal a ohana taig miwraceralaiaie (eo armlalstie"h pve! eleia bl ieroiti 22 18. ae Be th OC ahoca nats dint nip twine Sines ecatee OES SOT aoy we baltwo) 4 gn biae cit ste Ns 22 Riga MELOV DAE eta Later ale arstacw fin 8 cs ores ol Varwern b's are Viptaig's sida h eslaisle)s mp a/sieralele ee 25 ea Ren SSENCA NCE st cegeca te baie GicSet ar chao) oje/aia'd Win Dig ieca ia w are pial cies breie te sin is 6/6 S omcaceiee 25 ch EOSPNONOIGE VEMAL DUNACE: pels cy sain ieikd ele See rey Ee ihietanig emerald « ees bic tek kt 55 BE ACAVATICS OE ORM se dines o's Ging salen iain Weare eee aie ao caty aloo sete spies fas 57 Boo Sills Median Section. | oie ic se ire aioe a eater any eB leis oes seclbvee be oe Wis ce 60 AA OCA PUB 6 shies ea ate cee Seinen Spehind Nate eaie gee eee Nees Wah ale elas ec 62 A Sire ANNs 555 gate la a\wra lp a'e: lutein oleae Sra are retusa Ter his tele o5 Bins 0m Riis ais ae 40. Clavicle. .. oc. ccc scveg en eene sees we eee ser as EOS a IO Me 64 Age SELUIMENUS /oi'5 6k sins bo SNe Vem ok verkie HES ele Wainb ui ge WOlstaig Sa llale eiktals dis 65 48. {ai ae enh n highs «ab die a? ve weet eC eMe Oe ab bees keds ie psp ¢ 65 AOe Radius and Ung ie. s.s se digisk see toc mine ees chs cmele nels 68 50. 455 URES eT BEE SIs Se ne mle ster oh Whe hie me DRE pie RT Mintate SCRE N A so 68 51. Bones of the Hand......... Cee ccrneeugeessnestasesevecesereseresss 70 52. Ligaments of the Elbow........ ech ne Rasa neg rae bbls he eb as Me erKe Seb 74 53- as BA OSE TS EG eet Ke ad SAR SEE LoTR Ree U EGS o.5 Rein wicKscieis 74 RAL ATMO aLe PONE OL WAST cies sys wise aereieawiaee Solas ite hele ciaieles oreo so eis 76 Ger ANROMIMAte CONES ys u's'g oe acto bia Re once eas wR ee wip Slaven Wie Sees iy aun ot 77 RRp ra! CWE ges ciara sales olay wlan es wip eels Sartre Sian y were Rierue Sie Welt g Misohe sols 79 SF CAA MUG PUNTA, Sins codes eu ss ke Se we Rhein ee eS so hype chs sai ee a¥6 81 6S. Bones Of the Foot... os. 6 sess es socssdeseccetenese Pagers vesseveseecs 83 Oy SAACAOUS W5 aio kalau sane Nine ne 8 45:0 SRV a us citiaie pialein’siale ce Mig wine 6 aie ep 83 OG. HARE OIN SF ins tp econ pee ue ae eee eR EN CSS CAEN KD Cae eee Knee 89 61. 6B HAE Sid Shy lata a ag le ag ecb ali an gs phe 5 atl Panes Ona Ue ep ee ciate ere the Ace kira 89 O27) Muscles OF: Ne ORINGs sew actette scae ha petals ele ois Wea e Egin suis ee aie cine > 94 03: Mascies’on Dorsal Side of Meads so sis. xa ees cs 5.55 seca swovs done a0 97 GANGSTER Ot TAREE L's. siete acy e ave ibd Oe rgieis Beale Bini oad nik is aya eieteiaee aie, 102 65. Ventral Muscles of Thorax, Neck, and Head...................00000. 109 66, Pleryooid and Palatal: Mascles2. 6 scc acai eeica wena sisi eeleacia ess sees 112 67. ‘Muscles of “Tongue,-H yoid, and: Pharynxs ss. ci65:04-co0 3 ss ce sie sie cob os 114 Go. dfirst Layer or Body Muscles:.. 50. ss isaikavsases epee rscgipenersiare’sce cities pre/eteiate 117 66, Deep Muscles: Of the Vertebroe ana wRADg i ers css Cece Sap cee ss 8 a's 125 70. Dorsal Muscles of Lumbar and Caudal Regions...... Sain a aie aieae esa 127 PEN ASCP: MUBEIES GL ANCCK 2 craic coc Rea eo ean eee RTS S AGisag oe wn ere 135 72. Muscles on the Ventral Surface of the Cervical Vertebre.............. 143 we “Seco Layer OF body Muscless fol Cia sce wesvaawawraesasacn teas 149 (ESE reel hgt 1:3 (eye Rme Gsepe Paee anni en aratite ie g tenn Sires ah Ace acy Gras ait firye Sear iat 152 RL Atel As MUIRCIES CC AT ELG 21s) ssn iasippa'y olate ea 4 eintnce UaMioles Pere OPeiws <5 01) «\ aon 158 76, Origin: of Lateral Muscles On Scapola. 27.6 vsiessinpis sani cee ee waeeee wee 160 Won MECIALIMUSCIER OF ATI «24 'ce nse Ware ecco oisln tae 2G Renee eats pi atk yee 162 78. Origin of Medial Muscles on Scapula..........02...ceeeeeeeeeeeeees 163 Wow Deep Medial Muscles of ATM. a'o cine caus pias evlws.e slaiei nie hk trsleiyelee © o:0 bie 167 BU. veep Lateral Muscles Of Arms. i.s/p caw wie ck bis ean euate ais p ciecess iateie'e a's 169 81. Areas of Origin of Muscles on Ventral Surface of Humerus............ 171 ee evs CES ERS “ ‘¢ Medial Side of Humerus,.............. 171 83. “© “ « « 4 & Dorsal Surface of Left Humerus........ 171 4.’ FOnGOnS On: DAC OF Hand. ctds ig a's 3s aleve seine seleye en Pelsipbem aces 00's ep! 175 Be. Deep Muscles of Foreayin. os.) is.'s icpan cae vaveeesbrcbpake ne'sss'cks 177 86. Insertions of Muscles on Radius and Ulna.......0. 0.02.2... cee eee eee 178 87. is a Rot awas REC) SSE TAS Dy clegtgna aes slalshe Si RLWIN LOLA INES 61 e's 6 182 LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS. x1X FIG. PAGE eee ree Ere Pen ESTE ETO A LOS (OU cae ae aes sino ele ere coal sald ere cee alee o weltiw ah veeets 183 ey eens MeacIes GL Pal OL FIAT 62 secs Se cw tin ee caccebseces 184 go. Lateral Muscles of the Leg....... Pee ae PES PURE Oia dar 9 Pace te ie Certs 192 gt. Medial RON ale reek RN NS Seyret tae al aia Sr si Cand e' Sia ki aioiaieieid'g S Gi-aiee ache Welaar ne 197 g2. Deep Medial Muscles of Thigh ........--.205-ssecccccseeseveesees: 200 93. Teeth of the Upper Jaw..........-...--.- cesses Pata suauiatancaeat ata 225 Re EO WOE AW alee ccs scene ey ie bean dawe ceca dn ev gndvasionss 226 Os. Tongue, Epiglottis, Cte rss. cide ceed eee ceeteacecveceseaceues 227 96. Muscles of Tongue, Hyoid, and Pharynx....... ts Sed se MOR WARE SSS Ee Sool 229 MN Scions «baie oo ehh Com ecus Sak 238 O09; Theocolic Valve's . oo ss ee ese see e ec ctene tes euverseeesevencnecs 238 MPRA PU CT Sit iin pov dig a aiedkaes Sis te Wei oie ¥.0\ 6 Rae «0 sieiele’s wle'a t.da/pia odie winiactls 240 NER Ss fo tea alg wale Sia ein nie /eca na wiping a kw eivieie Wea NTs staple oleate ae eines 240 BOs, UE ANCEEAS ANG: MPICON is sis Sse d's c siesce cree eseke ees ciao emioieleleae ate cto 242 toss Cartilages Of Noses coo ccec cscisctenssncsectnciseseaveetansessewewsd 244 Re RO PURIAOUH OR LAE VIE vin 0 cin sn 0.0, sso wiaicie nines nee ables w¥s bs Ves teieicaees 247 105. Muscles of Larynx..... * Ses SEAS Sea aaa 2 gPO SAE | Ween eer GO Minas SEIT g= RN 250 MO SLONCDT 6 iaic nei:d'o'd sialeie lginie'se eles coc eecccies elev eet ace sles ccceseseaiuis 253 107. Thymus Gland........ Spiele Metele are aide ain: Ueisi) ele pecn enema ommend Sow nis ate 254 Me PIONCY cc kns = Seca n wd OO Ge onesie cess ssn ees odes ew bene agcedsedess 255 RU SRECHUON OE NGMOE C5 yaa swic a Nb ale Caio 0c 60's Wa oe bay Sanu 0 Ugh ownage nis 255 PMR EGER 5 Cepia ph atn acuiglolsiy aig sitio alata ecu gla Gb. ciarsluis'e tietsln'g aaieloive-wia ania) 260 MEI CreM GAL OF SANS G50 pioia! ciaiese'e #5 o'pibie « 4 cin ole e(slGib bio a ¥lo\gsipieig Suh sjoe 262 Bee rEMiale UTOCENITAl OTC ANS sas, oii’ec rae S ee ae ae ee NS THE SKULL. 39 which is for articulation with the cribriform plate of the ethmoid. Craniad of this the surface is marked by ridges and looks into the nasal cavity. The cranial margin is produced dorsally in the form of a blunt triangular spine. Mediad of this spine the bone articu- lates with the lachrymal bone. The ventral border articulates by its cranial one-third with the orbital plate of the palatine, and by its caudal two-thirds with the body and wing of the presphenoid. _ Maxillary Bone. Maxilla (Figs. 27 and 28).—The maxillary bone forms the cranial and lateral portions of the roof of the mouth. The bones of opposite sides meet craniad, but diverge caudad to enclose the palatal plates of the palatine bones. Each consists of a thick prismatic ventral portion or Fic. 27,MAXILLARY BONE, Fic. 28.— MAXILLARY BONE, LATERAL SURFACE. MEDIAL SURFACE. a, body; 6, frontal process; c, infraorbital foramen; d, elevation for root of canine tooth; ¢, canine tooth; /, first premolar; g, second premolar; %, third pre- molar; 7, molar tooth; 7, zygomatic process; 4, beginning of lachrymal canal; 4, ridge to which the ventral nasal concha is attached; m, nasal crest of palatine process. body (a) and a thin flat plate, the frontal process (4), extending dorsad from the cranial part of the bone. The body (a) has the form of a triangular prism whose broader dorsal face looks into the nasal cavity and orbit, while the ventral face looks into the mouth, and the lateral face toward the cheek. From the junction of the dorsal and lateral surfaces at the cranial end the large flat curved frontal process (6) passes dorsad, while the teeth are implanted along the border, alveolar border or process, formed by the junction of the ventral and lateral surfaces. 4° THE SKELETON OF THE CAT. The lateral surface is continuous with the lateral surface of the frontal process and shows at the base of the frontal process on its caudal border the large infraorbital foramen (Fig. 27, c), for the vessels and nerves of the same name. Near the medial end of the surface is a cylindrical elevation (@) for the root of the canine tooth (¢). The ventral surface is smooth and looks into the roof of the mouth. On the dorsal surface caudal and cranial halves may be dis- tinguished. The caudal one-half enters into the floor of the orbit. The lateral edge of this portion is divided into two laminz, between which is received the end of the malar bone. Caudad this edge is prolonged into the short dorsally directed zygomatic process (7). The cranial half of the dorsal surface looks into the nasal cavity and is separated from the caudal half by a sharp vertical lamina of bone which runs caudo- mediad from the base of the nasal process. To the dorsal edge of this lamina are articulated the lachrymal bone and a part of the palatine. At the point where the lamina joins the base of the nasal process a foramen is seen leading into a canal, the nasolachrymal canal (#). Craniad of the lamina the surface is concave. Where it becomes continuous with the inner edge of the frontal process there is attached to it a thin bone, the ventral nasal concha (or maxilloturbinal), which is rolled into an irregular spiral. The nasolachrymal canal opens ventrad of its cranial end. The cranial third of this part of the bone projects further mediad than does the rest of the medial border, forming thus ‘the broad palatine process. This is rough on its medial edge for articulation with the premaxillary and the palatine process of the opposite bone. This medial edge rises also dorsally into a low ridge, the nasal crest (vz), which is roughened for artic- ulation with the vomer. The caudal two-thirds of the medial edge articulates with the palatine bone. The cranial end of the bone articulates with the premaxilla. The caudal end is smooth. The frontal process (4) presents on its inner surface, which looks into the nasal cavity, certain transverse ridges which are a ee ee ee a ee Ne eee ee ee THE SKULL. 4L in relation with the ethmoid bone. Its outer surface is smooth. By its cranial border it articulates with the nasal bone dorsally and with the premaxillary bone ventrally. Its dorsal end articulates medially with the nasal spine of the frontal bone, and caudally with the orbital plate of the same bone. Premaxillary Bone. (Os incisivum BNA.) Premaxilla (Fig. 29).—The premaxillary bones bear the incisor teeth and form the cranial portion of the roof of the mouth. Each consists of an irregular, horizontal palatal portion (4) and of a perpendicular nasal process (c) which forms part of the lateral boundary of the nares and enters into the formation of the lateral wall of the nasal cavity. The palatal portion has in its caudal border a deep notch for the foramen incisivum or anterior palatine canal, which lies between it and the Fye, 29. — Pre. maxillary and transmits blood-vessels and nerves. agape - pds It articulates with the maxillary bone by this tiovery Cra- border. NIOLATERAL ASPECT. The medial border is raised into a thin crest — g, the three in. of bone which, besides forming the medial wall of ‘ior teeth; 4, Acie a : p palatal portion of the foramen incisivum or anterior palatine canal, the bone; ¢, nasal articulates by its medial border with the bone of P™°°**: the opposite side, forming a sort of median trough (sulcus pala- tinus) which projects dorsad into the nasal cavity and receives the ventral border of the nasal septum. The caudal end of this border articulates laterad with the maxilla, dorsad with the vomer. Its craniolateral border bears the incisor teeth (a). The nasal process (c) presents three surfaces, all elongated and triangular; one, the medial surface, is smooth and concave and looks into the nasal cavity. Its dorsal border is rough for articulation with the nasal bone dorsad, and smooth ventrad where it aids in forming the nares. The lateral surface is smooth. The caudal surface is rough for articulation with the maxil- lary bone. 42 THE SKELETON OF THE CAT. Nasal Bone. Os nasale (Fig. 30).—The nasal bones fill the space between the nasal process of the premaxillary, the frontal process of the maxillary, and the nasal spine of the frontal bone (Fig. 39, 7). They thus form part of the dorsal wall of the nasal cavity near the middle line. Each may be described as consisting of two elongated triangular lamellz, one vertical, the other horizontal. The vertical lamella is curved slightly ore et ventrad and has its apex directed craniad. It is DorsavL applied by its medial surface against the vertical ee lamella of the opposite bone, the two thus forming a median vertical partition, the nasal crest (Fig. 43, 12), which extends ventrad into the nasal cavity and, by joining the dorsal edge of the lamina perpendicularis, helps to form the internasa] septum. The horizontal lamella is attached to the dorsal margin of the vertical lamella in such a way that its apex lies opposite the base of the vertical lamella. It helps to roof in the nasal cavity, and by its base forms a part of the dorsal boundary of the narial opening. By its lateral margin it articulates with the nasal spine of the frontal at its caudal end, with the frontal process of the maxillary at its middle, and with the nasal process of the premaxilla at its cranial end. The lateral angle of its base projects in a curved line which forms the dorsal part of the lateral boundary of the narial opening. From the lateral border of the horizontal lamella a bony plate curves ventrad and mediad, enclosing a narrow fossa which receives a part of the ethmoid. This is the concha nasalis superior (nasoturbinal bone). Ethmoid Bone. -Os ethmoidale (Figs. 31 and 32).—The ethmoid bone closes in the cranial cavity at its cranial end and extends forward into the nasal cavity, which it largely fills. It consists of a median vertical portion, the lamina perpen- dicularis (Fig. 43, z; Fig. 42, ~), forming a part of the nasal septum, of two lateral portions made of thin sheets of bone variously folded and united—the labyrinths (or ethmotur- binals), which fill the greater part of the nasal cavity; and of THE SKULL. 43 a transverse perforated plate, the cribriform plate (lamina cribrosa), attached to the caudal end of the lamina perpendicu- laris and the labyrinths. The lamina perpendicularis (Fig. 43, 2; Fig. 42, p) is a flat four-sided bone. By its caudal margin it is continuous with the cribriform plate; by its ventral margin it is enclosed by the halves of the vomer; by its dorsal margin it unites with the crest formed by the vertical portion of the nasal bone craniad and with the vertical lamina of the medial margin of the frontal caudad, while its cranial margin is continued into the septal cartilage of the nose. Its lateral faces are smooth and free. The lamina cribrosa or eribriform plate (Fig. 42, 0) is elongated heart-shaped, with the apex of the heart ventrad. Its caudal face is concave and looks into the cranial cavity. It presents three irregular longitudinal rows of holes, one median and two lateral, for the passage of the olfactory fibres from the cranial cavity into the nasal cavity. Its cranial face is continuous along the medial line with the lamina perpendic- ularis, and at the sides with the labyrinths. The notch in the heart is directed dorsad and receives the vertical lamina of the medial border of the frontal bone. The Fic. 31 —ETHMOID AND VOMER, Fic. 32.—ETHMOID AND VOMER, SiDE VIEW. VENTRAL VIEW. a, vomer; 4, vertical cells of the labyrinth of the ethmoid; c, horizontal cell of the same; d, part of the ethmoid that forms the lamina papyracea; ¢, edge of cribri- form plate. apex of the heart articulates with the cranial end of the dorsal surface of the presphenoid. Its lateral margins are articulated with the ethmoidal ridges on the medial surface of the frontal bone. The labyrinths (Figs. 31 and 32) are attached to the cranial face of the lamina cribrosa, one on each side of the lamina perpendicularis. Each is made of thin bony plates irregularly 44 THE: SKELETON OF THE CAT. folded so as to enclose spaces, the ethmoid cells. In each may be distinguished a cranial portion (4), in which the cells are nearly vertical, and a caudal portion (c), in which the cells are nearly horizontal. The medial surfaces are separated by a space from the lamina perpendicularis. This space is broadest along the junction of the horizontal and vertical portions of the labyrinth. There are thus formed two passageways which correspond to the superior meati of human anatomy. The lateral surfaces come into contact with the frontal process of the maxillary and the orbital plate of the frontal bone. On the lateral surface of each labyrinth there is a thin irregular lamina of bone lying in a dorsoventral longitudinal plane and closing in some of the ethmoid cells laterally (¢). A small part of this lamina, situated near the caudoventral angle of the bone, appears in the orbital fossa on the external surface of the skull between the presphenoid, palatine, and frontal bones or between the lachrymal, palatine, and frontal bones. Sometimes in the entire skull two such pieces may be seen, one in each of these positions. This corresponds to the lamina papyracea of human anatomy. The dorsocaudal angle of each bone is received into the space between the orbital plate of the frontal and the vertical lamina of the medial border of the frontal. Its ventrocaudal angle is received between the cranial extensions of the lateral walls of the presphenoid, while its ventral surface is overlaid caudally by the expanded portion of the vomer, to which it is attached at its caudolateral angles. — Vomer (Figs. 31 and 32, a).—The vomer. consists of two thin laminz of bone which ensheath the ventral margin of the lamina perpendicularis (or the cartilaginous plate which con- tinues ventrad from this margin). and unite ventrad of it; the two thus form a trough open dorsad. Each becomes horizontal near its caudal end and at the same time expands. The expanded portion lies ventrad of the labyrinth of the ethmoid, closing in some of its cells: its lateral angles are united with the labyrinths. At its caudal end the bone articulates with the body of the ‘produced caudad into a long process which is THE SKULL. 45 presphenoid, and each half of it is produced caudad near the middle line into a triangular spine which lies ventrad of the body of the presphenoid. The horizontal portion of the bone helps to separate the olfactory and respiratory passages of the nasal chamber, while its vertical portion contributes to the formation of the nasal septum. The ventral margin formed by the junction of the two halves of the bone is smooth and free caudad, but at its cranial end is broad and rough for articulation with the palatal processes of the maxilla. Palatine Bone. Os palatinum (Fig. 33).—The palate bone or palatine bone consists .of two portions, a horizontal or palatal portion (a) and a perpendicular or nasal portion (4), uniting at an angle of about forty-five degrees. The horizontal portions (a) of the two bones are received between the maxillary bones and form the caudal and medial part of the roof of the mouth. Each is irregularly quadrilateral in form, with the caudolateral angle continuous with the perpendicular portion of the bone. The lateral margin of the horizontal por- tion articulates over its cranial half with the maxillary bone. At about its middle a short thick maxillary spine (c) projects caudolaterad. The Fic. 33.—Pata- ; CE ie: TINE BONE, remainder of the lateral margin is directly con- Honea veaw. tinuous with the perpendicular plate of the bone. a, horizontal The medial margin is rough for articulation with Portion; 4 per- ee oe Z pendicular __ por- the corresponding margin of the opposite pala- tion; 6s, SRE gine. : : : spine; d, posterior tine; the caudal angle of this margin projects 7 sae A caudad as the short posterior nasal spine (7). sphenopalatine Th a9 anette f d iat foramen; /, cau. e caudal margin forms a free edge which ga) opening | of bounds the choanz; it passes laterally into the pe palatine canal. perpendicular portion. The ventral surface (Fig. 41, 8) looks into the mouth. Near the middle of its craniolateral margin are two or more small foramina (Fig. 41, g) which form the cranial temination of the posterior palatine canal. The dorsal surface is smooth and looks into the nasal cavity. 46 THE SKELETON OF THE CAT. The perpendicular or nasal portion (Fig. 33, 4) of the palatine is thin and irregularly quadrilateral in form. It is attached by its cranial two-thirds to the dorsal surface of the horizontal portion. The outer surface is concave and looks into the orbital fossa. The inner surface is convex and looks into the nasal cavity. The perpendicular portion is marked by two formaina just craniad of the middle. The larger dorsal oval foramen is the sphenopalatine foramen (¢). The smaller ventral foramen is the caudal opening of the posterior palatine canal (/). From this opening the canal passes craniomediad, lying in the sub- stance of the palatine bone; it opens on the ventral surface of the horizontal portion at the small openings previously described (Fig. 41, ¢). By its cranial margin it articulates with the lachrymal bone. By its dorsal margin it articulates craniad with the orbital plate of the frontal: with the lamina papyracea at its middle, and with the body of the presphenoid caudad. The caudal half of the dorsal margin is partially divided into two lamelle with a rough surface between them: this rough surface lies against the ventral surface of the presphenoid. The caudal margin articulates with the pterygoid portion of the sphenoid. Lachrymal Bone. Os lachrymale (Fig. 34; Fig. 39, 10). —The lachrymal bone is a thin pentagonal scale of bone filling Fic. 34.—LACHRYMAL BONE OF Fic. 35.—MALAR BONE oF RIGHT SIDE, LEFT SIDE, EXTERNAL SURFACE. LATERAL SURFACE, Fig. 34.—a, notch forming the beginning of the lachrymal canal. Fig. 35.—@, ridge for origin of the masseter muscle; 4, frontal process; c, zygo- matic process. the interval between the horizontal plate of the palatine, the maxillary, and the orbital plate of the frontal. Its outer surface looks into the orbit, its inner surface into the nasal cavity. a ee, eT ee Te THE SKULL. 47 Near the middle of its cranial border it is notched obliquely by a foramen (a), the beginning of the nasolachrymal canal. Malar Bone. Jugal Bone. Os zygomaticum (Fig. 35). —The malar or zygomatic bone is a flat curved plate of bone which forms the lateral wall of the orbit and together with the zygomatic process of the temporal forms the zygomatic arch. Its outer surface is smooth and marked by a longitudinal ridge (a) for attachment of the masseter muscle. At its caudal end the bone is continued into two processes: one, the frontal process or orbital process (4), is a triangular spine of bone directed caudomediad; when the bones are articulated it lies opposite the zygomatic process of the frontal to which it is joined by a ligament (orbital ligament). ‘lhe other, zygomatic process (c) of the malar bone, extends ven- trocaudad and articulates with a similar process from'the tem- poral to form the zygomatic arch above mentioned. Its inner surface is smooth and looks into the orbit, except that of the zygomatic process, which looks into the temporal fossa. Its cranial border is roughened at the expense of both sur- faces and articulates with the maxillary bone. Its other borders are smooth except the dorsal border of the zygomatic process, which is roughened for attachment to the zygomatic process of the temporal. The Mandible. Mandibula (Figs. 36 and 37).—The mandible (or inferior maxillary bone) is composed of two halves which come together at the cranial end and form the lower jaw. At its caudal end each half articulates with the temporal bone at the mandibular fossa, and at its cranial end it joins the opposite bone, the suture being known as the sym- physis of the jaw (symphysis menti) (Fig. 37, a). Each half consists of a horizontal portion, the body (4), bearing teeth on one of its borders (the alveolar border), and of a vertical portion, the ramus (c). The body (4) has the form of a flattened cylinder and has two surfaces and two borders. The lateral surface (Fig. 36) is smooth and presents near its cranial end a foramen (or sometimes two), the mental foramen (d), forming the cranial 48 THE SKELETON OF THE CAT. termination of the mandibular canal. At its caudal end is a deep fossa continuing on to the ramus, the coronoid fossa, or masseteric fossa (¢). The medial surface (Fig. 37) is smooth and has near its caudal end a foramen, the mandibular foramen (/), which Fic. 37.—MANDIBLE, MEDIAL SURFACE. a, symphysis; 4, body; ¢, ramus; ¢@, mental foramina; ¢, coronoid fossa; 7, man- dibular foramen; g, angular process; 2, coronoid process; 7, condyloid process; I, 2, 3, the three incisor teeth; 4, the canine tooth; 5, 6, the premolars; 7, the molar tooth. communicates with the mandibular canal leading lengthwise through the bone to the mental foramen. The cranial end is roughened for attachment to the bone of the opposite side. The ventral border is smooth and rounded; it ends caudally in a blunt point, the angular process (g). The dorsal (alveolar) border is slightly curved and bears the sockets (alveoli) for the teeth. It is continuous with the cranial margin of the coronoid process. The ramus is divided into two portions, the coronoid process (2) and the condyloid process (¢). The coronoid process (/) extends dorsocaudad as a thin plate of bone with smooth sur- faces and borders. Its outer surface is partly occupied by the coronoid fossa (¢). The condyloid process (2) has the form of THE SKULL. 49 a semicylindrical transverse piece of bone attached to the caudal margin of the coronoid process. It articulates with the mandibular fossa of the temporal bone. Hyoid Bone. Os hyoideum (Fig. 38 and Fig. 104).— The hyoid bene forms the support for the tongue and gives origin to muscles passing to the rt tongue and larynx. It also supports the thyroid cartilage (Fig. 104, 1). It consists of a transverse \\ bony bar, the body (Fig. 38, a) WA and of two cornua or horns yy¢. 38, Hyorp Bong, Dorsat View. attached to each end of the 4, body; 4, ¢, d, ¢, cranial cornu; /, hod caudal cornu; b, ceratohyal; cy epihyal: y: d, stylohyal; ¢, ‘tympanohyal; f, thyro- The cranial cornu (lesser hyal. cornu of human anatomy) is the longer (Fig. 38, d-e). Each arises from the cranial face of the body at its lateral end, curves laterad, and then caudodorsad. It consists of four bony pieces movably united by cartilage. The terminal piece is the tympanohyal (e); it is imbedded in the tympanic bulla just ventrad of the stylomastoid foramen. It is not therefore seen attached to the cornu after the latter has been separated from the skull. The other pieces become successively shorter toward the body, and are called stylohyal (@), epihyal (c), and ceratohyal (4). The caudal cornua (/) (greater cornua of human anatomy) arise from the ends of the body. Each consists of.a single piece of bone, the thyrohyal (/), which passes caudolaterad ; its free end is united to a process of the thyroid cartilage (Fig. 104, 1). The Skull as a Whole.—In the following description of the skull as a whole the mandible, hyoid, and ear-bones are not included. The skull forms a bony box which contains the brain and is produced craniad into the facial portion which encloses the nasal cavity and forms the framework of the face. In dorsal view (Fig. 39) the skull presents a smooth con- vex surface, broadest caudad, with the two zygomatic arches 5° THE SKELETON OF THE CAT. (g) curving out some distance laterally. The following bones are visible in dorsal view: the occipital (1), interparietal (2), parietals (3), temporals (4), frontals (5), malar or zygomatic Fic. 39.—SKULL, DORSAL SURFACE, I, occipital bone; 2, interparietal bone; 3, parietal bones; 4, temporal; 5, frontal; 6, malar; 7, nasal; 8, maxillary; 9, premaxillary; 10, lachrymal. a@, lambdoidal ridge; 4, external occipital tubercle; ¢, sagittal crest; d, parietal eminence; ¢, line which forms the dorsal boundary of the temporal fossa; /, zygomatic process of the frontal; g; zygomatic arch; %, frontal process of the malar; z, supraorbital arch; 7, nares; #, foramen incisivum or anterior palatine foramen; /, sphenopalatine foramen; m, zygomatic process of the temporal; #, infraorbital foramen; 0, opening ef lach- rymal duct. bones (6), nasals (7), maxillaries (8), premaxillaries (9), and lachrymals (10). The caudal boundary of the dorsal surface is marked by the prominent lambdoidal ridge (2) which passes from the middle cranioventrad along each side to the root of the zygomatic arch: it is borne by the occipital and temporal bones. From the middle of the lambdoidal ridge a second ridge, the sagittal THE SKULL. 51 crest (c), passes craniad in the middle line across the inter- parietal bone: it varies greatly in extent, reaching ina very old and muscular cat to the cranial border of the parietals, while in kittens it does not exist. The most prominent portions of the skull in this region, just craniad of the middle of the parie- tal bones, are known as the parietal tubercles or eminences (@). A faint curved line (e) runs from the cranial end of the sagittal crest craniolaterad to the base of the zygomatic process of the frontal: it marks the dorsal boundary of the origin of the tem- poral muscle, and may therefore be considered the dorsal boundary of the temporal fossa. This fossa extends from its dorsal boundary as far laterad and caudad as the lambdoidal ridge (a), and as far craniad as a line connecting the tip of the zygomatic process of the frontal (/) with the frontal process of the malar (Z). The temporal muscle takes origin from its surface. The middle portion of the dorsal surface-is formed by the frontals (5). Each frontal presents laterally a prominent zygomatic process (/), extending ventrolaterad toward a cor- responding (frontal) process (#) of the malar bone. These two processes mark the boundary between the orbital fossa (craniad) and the temporal fossa (caudad). Craniad of the zygomatic process of the frontal a sharp margin separates the dorsal sur- face of the skull from the wall of the orbital fossa: this is the supraorbital arch or margin (7). The cranial portion of the dorsal surface is formed by the maxillary (8), nasal (7), and premaxillary bones (9). Just craniad of the nasals, bounded ventrad and craniad by the premaxillaries, appears the large opening of tae nares (¥), leading into the nasal cavity. The zygomatic arch (¢) is formed by the zygomatic process of the temporal (7) and the malar or zygomatic bone (6). Each presents near its middle a prominent dorsocaudally directed process, the frontal process (#) of the malar bone. The zygomatic arch forms the lateral boundary of the temporal and orbital fosse, which are separated by a line connecting the frontal process of the malar (Z) and the zygomatic process of the frontal (/). 52 THE SKELETON OF THE CAT. A portion of the floor of the orbit and the opening of the lachrymal canal (0) may also be seen in dorsal view; they are described in connection with the lateral surface. The caudal surface of the skull is formed largely by the occipital bone (Fig. 17), surrounding the foramen magnum (Fig. 17, @). At the sides of the foramen magnum are the two prominent curved occipital condyles (e) for articulation with the atlas. Craniolaterad of the condyles, separated from them by a deep notch, are the jugular processes (/) of the occipital, closely applied to the caudal ends of the tympanic bulle. Dorsad of the foramen magnum are faint indications of a median ridge running dorsad, the external occipital crest (Fig. 17,2); this rises at its junction with the lambdoidal ridge to form the prominent external occipital tubercle (Fig. 39, 2). The dorsal and dorsolateral boundaries of the posterior surface are formed by the lambdoidal ridge (Fig. 17, 4; Fig. 39, a). The lateral surface of the skull (Fig. 40) is much more complicated than the dorsal and posterior surfaces. Caudally _ the occipital condyles (a) and external occipital crest (4) are visible; dorsocaudad the sagittal crest (c). Extending from the caudal end of the sagittal crest the lambdoidal ridge (@) is seen passing ventrocraniad to the tym- panic bulla, thence craniad to the root of the zygomatic arch. In the ventral part of the caudal region the tympanic bulla (¢) is visible with the jugular process (/) of the occipital pressed close against its caudal end. Just craniad of the jugular process the mastoid process (g) of the temporal rests against the side of the bulla. Beneath the cranial edge of this process is the opening of the stylomastoid foramen (4) for the seventh nerve, while just ventrad of the foramen is the small pit (z) in the tympanic bulla for the reception of the tympanohyal bone. Craniad of the stylomastoid foramen is the large opening of the external auditory meatus (7), leading into the middle ear. Immediately dorsocraniad of the external auditory meatus the zygomatic arch begins as the zygomatic process (£) of the temporal bone. On the cranial surface of the base of this process is the deep mandibular fossa (/) for the condyle of the THE SKULL. 53 mandible. This fossa is bounded caudally by the prominent postmandibular process (77). All that portion of the lateral surface of the skull which lies craniodorsad of the lambdoidal ridge may be divided (exclud- ing the zygomatic arch) into three main parts, the temporal fossa, the orbital fossa, and the face. The boundaries of the temporal fossa have been given. The orbital fossa is bounded Fic. 40,—-SKULL, SIDE VIEW. I, occipital bone; 2, interparietal; 3, parietal; 4, temporal; 5, 5’, frontal; 6, malar; 7, sphenoid; 8, palatine; 9, presphenoid; 10, maxillary; II, nasal; 12, pre- maxillary; 13, incisor teeth; 14, canine; 15, 16, 17, premolars; 18, molar. a, oc- cipital condyle; 4, external occipital crest; ¢, sagittal crest; ¢, lambdoidal ridge; e, tympanic bulla; /, jugular process; g, mastoid process; /, stylo-mastoid foramen; 2, pit for tympanohyal bone; 7, external auditory meatus; 4, zygomatic process of tem- poral bone; 7, mandibular fossa; #, postmandibular process; #, zygomatic process of the frontal; 9, supraorbital margin; , external pterygoid fossa; 7, sphenopalatine foramen; 7, orbital fissure; s, internal pterygoid fossa; ¢, hamulus; w, foramen ovale; v, foramen rotundum; w, optic foramen; x, opening of lachrymal canal; y, infraorbital foramen. externally by a prominent semicircular ridge formed chiefly by the zygomatic arch, the zygomatic process of the frontal (7), and the supraorbital arch (0) of the frontal, which may be traced to the cranial root of the zygomatic arch. The orbital fossa may be considered to end caudally and ventrally at the level of the optic foramen (zw); ventrad of it are certain smaller | fosse. Immediately ventrad is the long external pterygoid fossa (/), from which arises part of the external pterygoid muscle. This fossa begins at the sphenopalatine foramen (¢) and extends caudad to the orbital fissure (7); it is separated by a ridge from the orbital fossa. Caudoventrad of the external 54 THE SKELETON OF THE CAT. pterygoid fossa and separated from it by a sharp ridge is the small narrow internal pterygoid fossa (s), which extends ven- trad without interruption on to the surface of the hamulus (¢) and caudad to within two or three millimeters of the tympanic bulla. From it the internal pterygoid muscle takes origin. The hamulus (¢) projects caudoventrad in this region, forming a prominent feature in a lateral view. Four foramina leading into the cranial cavity are visible in a lateral view of the skull, craniad of the tympanic bulla. The one nearest the bulla is the foramen ovale (w) for the third division of the fifth nerve; next craniad of this is the foramen rotundum (v) for the second division of the fifth nerve. These two foramina pierce the alisphenoid: just craniad, of them, between the alisphenoid and the orbitosphenoid, is the large orbital fissure (7) (foramen lacerum anterius), which transmits the third, fourth, and sixth cranial nerves and the first division of the fifth. Dorsocraniad of the orbital fissure is the optic foramen (w), for the optic nerve. Ventrad of the cranial portion of the orbit is the large sphenopalatine foramen (7), for the nerves and arteries of the same name. Just craniad of this is the small caudal opening of the posterior palatine canal, which passes through the sub- stance of the palatine bone and opens on its ventral surface near its cranial margin. Just dorsad of the cranial root of the zygomatic arch is the opening of the lachrymal canal (7), while the root of the arch is pierced by the large infraorbital foramen (7), which transmits the infraorbital nerves and artery from the orbit. The teeth.(13-18), implanted along the alveolar border of the maxillary and premaxillary, form a prominent feature in a lateral view: they are described in the account of the alimen- tary canal. The ventral surface of the skull (Fig. 41) is very complex. It is separated by the orbits into a caudal and a cranial portion, united by a narrow median trough-like part. Laterad of this trough-like part are visible parts of the orbit and the zygomatic arches, which do not properly belong to the ventral surface and have already been described. THE SKULL. 55 Caudally there appear in the ventral view the foramen magnum (a), occipital condyles (4), and jugular processes (c). In front of the jugular processes the two tympanic bulle (d) form prominent features, with the mastoid process (e), the stylomastoid foramen (/), and the external auditory meatus Fic. 41.—SKULL, VENTRAL VIEw. I, occipital bone; 2, temporal; 3, sphenoid; 4, presphenoid; 5, frontal; 6, malar; 7, vomer; 8, palatine; 9, maxillary; 10, premaxillary. @, foramen magnum; 4, occipital condyles; ¢, jugular process; @, tympanic bulla; ¢, mastoid process; /, stylo- mastoid foramen; g, external auditory meatus; 4, jugular foramen; 2, styliform proc- ess; 7, groove for Eustachian tube; 4, foramen ovale; 7, foramen rotundum; m, pterygoid process of sphenoid; 7, perpendicular plate of palatine; 0, choanz or pos- terior nares; , zygomatic arch; g. cranial end of posterior palatine canal; 7, pala- tine grooves; s, foramina incisiva or anterior palatine foramina; ¢, opening of ptery- goid canal. (g) on their lateral surfaces. All these structures have been described. The tympanic bullz (@) are placed with long axes directed craniomediad, so that they converge toward their cranial ends. At the caudomedial angle of each bulla is the 56 THE SKELETON OF THE CAT. large jugular foramen (/), for the ninth, tenth, and eleventh nerves. Opening into the mediocaudal margin of the jugular foramen is the smaller hypoglossal foramen, for the twelfth nerve. The craniomedial end of the tympanic bulla projects craniad as the styliform process (2). Just laterad of this process is the opening (7) into the tympanic bulla by which the tuba auditiva or Eustachian tube passes into the middle ear. A faint groove for the tube passes craniomediad from this opening, on the sur- face of the sphenoid. Craniolaterad of the opening for the tuba auditiva is the foramen ovale (£); craniad of this the foramen rotundum (/) is faintly indicated. On the surface of the sphenoid just craniad of the styliform process of the bulla tym- pani is the minute opening of the pterygoid canal (Z).’ The orbital fissure and optic foramen are not seen in the ventral view. The middle region of the ventral surface is narrow: it is formed by a trough-like fossa which is bounded laterally by the pterygoid processes (7) of the sphenoid and the perpendicular plates of the palatines (7). Ventrad of this lies, in the natural condition, the soft palate, converting the fossa into the nasal portion of the pharynx or nasopharynx. Craniad this fossa is bounded by the free caudal edges of the palatines; beneath which the fossa communicates with the nasal cavity by the two choane (0). Laterad of this median fossa are visible in the ventral view parts of the temporal and orbital fossz, bounded laterally by the zygomatic arches (). The cranial part of the ventral surface is a somewhat tri- angular plane area formed by the palatal portions of the pala- tines (8), maxillari2s(9), and premaxillaries (10), which together constitute the hard palate (palatum durum). Laterad and craniad this area is bounded by the alveolar borders of the maxillaries and premaxillaries bearing the teeth. The hard palate is marked near the cranial border of the palatine bones with two or more foramina which form the cranial termination of the posterior palatine canal (g). Two faint grooves pass from these foramina a short distance craniad, gradually con- verging: these are known as the palatine grooves (7) (sulci THE SKULL. 57 palatini). Near the cranial end of the hard palate are two large openings close together near the middle line: these are the foramina incisiva (or anterior palatine foramina) (s). Cavities of the Skull (Figs. 42 and 43).—The bones of the cranial portion of the skull enclose the cranial cavity for Fic. 42.—SKULL, WITH DorRSAL SURFACE REMOVED, SHOWING THE CRANIAL AND NASAL CAVITIES, a, foramen magnum; 4, caudal end of hypoglossal canal; ¢, jugular foramen; d, internal auditory meatus; e, tentorium, forming the cranial boundary of the cerebellar fossa; 7, dorsum sell; g, sella turcica; 2, anterior clinoid processes; z, foramen ovale; 7, foramen rotundum; 4, orbital fissure; 7, optic foramen; , chiasmatic groove; , presphenoid bone; 9, cribriform plate; ~, lamina perpendicularis of eth- moid; g, labyrinths of ethmoid; 7”, nares; s, foramina incisiva or anterior palatine foramina; ¢, infraorbital foramen; #, opening of the lachrymal canal; v, caudal opening of posterior palatine canal; w, sphenopalatine foramen; x, frontal process of the malar; y, zygomatic process of the temporal; z, appendicular fossa, in the pe- trous bone. the brain; the facial bones enclose the nasal cavity, for the olfactory organ. The cranial cavity is divisible into three principal fossz: the cerebellar fossa (Fig. 43, /) caudad, for the cerebellum; 58 THE SKELETON OF THE CAT. the cerebral fossa (//) in the middle, for the cerebrum; the small olfactory fossa (///) at the cranial end for the olfactory bulb of the brain. The cerebellar fossa (/) is bounded caudally by the occipital bone enclosing the foramen magnum (Fig. 42, a). Its ventral surface is formed by the basilar portion of the occipital and the petrous portions of the temporals; its lateral surface by the mastoid portions of the temporals and parts of the parietals and occipital. Its roof is formed by the parietals and interparietal. Craniad the cerebellar fossa is partly separated from the cere- bral fossa by the tentorium (Fig. 42, ¢; Fig. 43, /) formed by the two parietals: this encloses a quadrangular opening by which the two fosse2 communicate. The caudal, dorsal, and lateral walls of the cerebellar fossa are deeply marked by fosse for the lobes of the cerebellum; the small appendicular fossa (Fig. 43, ¢), forming a deep indentation in the petrous bone near its dorsocaudal end, is particularly noticeable. The following openings are found in the walls of the cere- bellar fossa. Caudad is the large foramen magnum (Fig. 42, @) by which the brain-cavity communicates with the vertebral canal. Near the caudal margin of the foramen magnum, on its lateral side, just mediad of the dorsal end of the occipital condyle, is the caudal opening of the condyloid canal (Fig. 43, a) which passes craniad through the substance of the occipital bone to open just caudad of the petrous: it transmits a vein. The condyloid canal varies greatly in size in different speci- mens. A few millimeters craniad of the edge of the foramen magnum on the floor of the fossa is the small opening of the hypoglossal canal (Figs. 42 and 43, 6), for the twelfth nerve. Just craniad of this, at the caudomedial border of the petrous, is the large jugular foramen (c). On the petrous itself, near the middle, is the internal auditory meatus (d) divided into the dorsal facial canal for the seventh nerve, and a ventral passage for the eighth nerve. At the cranial end of the cerebellar fossa is the large opening bounded by the free edges of the tentorium. The cerebral fossa forms much the largest part of the cranial cavity. It is bounded by the parietals (Fig. 43, 3’), THE SKULL, 59 squamous portions of the temporals (4), frontals (8), the sphenoid (5), and presphenoid (6). A slight rounded ridge on its lateral wall at about the position of the suture between the frontals and parietals separates a smaller cranial portion sometimes called the anterior fossa, from a larger caudal por- tion sometimes known as the middle fossa of the cranial cavity. The walls of the cerebral cavity are marked with numerous ridges and shallow furrows for the cerebral convolutions. The floor of the cerebral cavity is bounded caudad by the prominent dorsum sella (Fig. 42, f; Fig. 43, g), just craniad of which is the rounded depression known as the sella turcica (Fig. 42, g; Fig. 43, %), for lodgment of the hypophysis. A number of foramina pierce the floor of the cavity in this region. Just ventrad of the cranial tip of the petrous portion of the temporal is the small foramen lacerum (medius). Craniad and laterad of this is a row of four foramina: the caudal one is the foramen ovale (Fig. 42, 2); then come in order the foramen rotundum (7), the orbital fissure (4), and the optic foramen (Fig. 42, /; Fig. 43, 2). The two optic foramina are connected by the shallow transverse chiasmatic groove (Fig. 42, ), for the optic chiasma. Another small foramen continues caudad from a groove on the floor of the orbital fissure; this opens on the ventral surface of the sphenoid, between the wing and the body of the bone. The groove and foramen constitute the pterygoid canal, which transmits a nerve,—the nerve of the pterygoid canal, or Vidian nerve. The cranial cavity narrows at its cranial end to form the small olfactory fossa (Fig. 43, //7) which lodges the olfactory bulbs. This is bounded by the frontals and the lamina cribrosa (Fig. 42, 0) of the ethmoid; caudad it opens directly into the cerebral fossa. Numerous openings through the lamina cribrosa for the olfactory fibres connect the olfactory fossa with the nasal cavity. The roof of the fossa is marked by a promi- nent median crest from the united edges of the frontals. The nasal cavity is almcest completely filled by the ethmoid and vomer and the conche nasales. Its roof is formed by the nasal bones and portions of the frontals; its sides by the frontals, lachrymals, maxillaries, premaxillaries, and palatine 60 THE SKELETON OF THE CAT. bones; its floor by the horizontal plates of the palatines, maxillaries, and premaxillaries. The nasal cavity opens craniad by the large nares (Fig. 39, 7; Fig. 42, ~), which are bounded by the premaxillary and Fic. 43.—SKULL, MEpIAN LONGITUDINAL SECTION, SHOWING THE CAVITIES. Z, cerebellar fossa; 7/, cerebral fossa; ///, olfactory fossa. 1, occipital bone; 2, interparietal; 3, 3’, parietal; 4, temporal (4, squamous portion; 4’, petrous portion; 4’, tympanic portion); 5, sphenoid; 6, presphenoid; 7. palatine; 8, frontal; 9, max- illary; 10, premaxillary; 11, ethmoid; 12, nasal; 13, incisor teeth; 14, canine; 15, 16, 17, premolars; 18, molar. a@, condyloid canal; 4, hypoglossal canal; ¢, jugular foramen; d, internal auditory meatus; ¢, appendicular fossa; /, tentorium; g, dorsum sellz; #, sella turcica; z, hamular process; 7, pterygoid process of sphenoid; k, optic foramen; 7, presphenoid sinus; #, m’, frontal sinus; 7, lamina perpendicu- laris of the ethmoid (broken at cranial edge). nasal bones. In the natural condition this opening is divided by a median cartilage which is continuous with the lamina per- pendicularis (Fig. 43, ) of the ethmoid, thus forming a parti- tion which divides the nasal cavity into two separate halves. From the floor of the cranial part of the cavity rises a ridge formed of the nasal crests of the maxillaries and premaxillaries, and the cranial portion of the vomer. Farther caudad the vomer spreads out in a horizontal plane and separates from the floor of the cavity, so that the nasal cavity is thereby divided by a horizontal partition into dorsal and ventral portions. The ventral portion is small, forming the inferior meatus of the nose; it ends caudally at the choane (posterior nares, Fig. 41, 0) which lead into the nasopharynx. That portion of the nasal cavity lying dorsad of the vomer is almost com- THE SKULL. 61 pletely filled by the ethmoid and the conchz nasales, superior and inferior. It is bounded caudally by the lamina cribrosa of the ethmoid (Fig. 42, 0). The nasal cavity communicates with the cranial cavity by the foramina for the olfactory fibres in the lamina cribrosa; with the nasopharynx by the choanz; with the exterior of the body by the nares; with the mouth-cavity by the foramina incisiva or anterior palatine foramina (Fig. 42, s); with the orbit by the sphenopalatine foramen and the naso- lachrymal canal. It communicates directly also with the frontal sinuses (Fig. 43, 1, m’), the sphenoidal sinuses (Fig. 43, 7), and with the cells of the labyrinths of the ethmoid. JOINTS AND LIGAMENTS OF THE SKULL. Sutures of the Skull.—The bones of the skull join each . other by means of immovable articulations known as sutures. These sutures are designated by combining the names of the bones between which they are situated: as, sphenofrontal suture (sutura sphenofrontalis), between the sphenoid and frontal; nasomaxillary suture (sutura nasomaxillaris), between the nasal and maxillary bones. When a suture joins the two corresponding bones of opposite sides the prefix inter is used, as the intermaxillary suture (sutura intermaxillaris) between the maxillaries. The sutures bounding the parietals have, however, received special names not derived in this manner. The suture caudad of the parietals, separating them from the occipital and interparietal, is known as the lambdoidal suture; that between the two parietals is the sagittal suture; that separating the parietals and squamous portions of the temporals is the squamous suture; that between the parietals and frontals is the coronal suture. The suture separating the two frontals also is known as the frontal suture, in place of interfrontal. Articulations of the Mandible.—In man the two halves of the mandible are united craniad, so as to form a single bone. In the cat the two halves are separate, but articulate closely at the symphysis menti by a thin interarticular cartilage. The articulation of the mandible at the mandibular fossa of the temporal is covered with a close articular capsule. The 62 THE SKELETON OF THE CAT. mandibular fossa is lined with cartilage. A slender ligament passes from the angular process of the mandible caudad to the external auditory meatus, being attached to the latter about 8 millimeters from its medial end. This is the stylomandib- ular ligament. V. BONES OF THE THORACIC EXTREMITIES, Scapula (Figs. 44 and 45).—The scapula may be described as a flat triangular bone with one angle rounded. It lies Fic. 44.—SCAPULA, LATERAL SURFACE. Fic. 45.—ScAPuLA, MEDIAL SURFACE, J, fossa supraspinata; 7/, fossa infraspinata; ///, fossa subscapularis; /V, fossa for teres major. a, vertebral border; 4, coracoid border; ¢, glenoid border; d@, glen- oid angle and fossa; ¢, coracovertebral angle; /, glenovertebral angle; g, spine; 2, tuberosity of the spine; 2, metacromion; 7, acromion; 4%, supraglenoidal tubercle; 2, incisura scapulz; #2, coracoid process; #, groove indicating portion of spine; a, o’, ridges for attachment of muscle-fibres. beneath the muscles on the lateral face of the thorax near its cranial end. From its lateral surface there projects a flat ridge (Fig. 44, g), the spine of the scapula. The ventral end of the ridge is free as a curved process, the acromion process (Fig. 44, /)- The ventral angle of the scapula (7), the glenoid angle THORACIC LIMBS. 63 (lateral angle of human anatomy), is much heavier than the others and bears a concave, pear-shaped articular facet, the glenoid fossa, for articulation with the humerus. The border with which this angle is more nearly continuous may be called the glenoid border (c) (axillary border of human anatomy). Near the narrower cranial end of the glenoid fossa is a small curved projection of the bone, the coracoid process (Fig. 45, m). The border upon which it lies is the coracoid border (6) (superior border of human anatomy). The third border is turned toward the vertebral column and is the vertebral border (a). The angle between the glenoid and vertebral borders is the glenovertebral angle (/) (inferior angle of human anatomy), and that between the coracoid and vertebral borders the coracovertebral angle (¢) (medial angle of human anatomy). The medial or costal surface (Fig. 45) is smooth and nearly flat. A shallow furrow (z) marks the position of the spine of the scapula. Between the furrow and the coracoid border are two oblique parallel ridges (0 and o’) for the insertion of muscle- fibres. Near the glenoid border is a well-marked ridge sepa- rating the subscapular fossa (///), comprising the greater.-part of the medial surface of the scapula, from the fossa in which the teres major muscle has origin (JV). The surface presents several nutrient foramina usually directed toward the glenoid angle. The lateral surface (dorsal surface of human anatomy) (Fig. 44) is divided by the spine (g) into two portions. The portion of the scapula craniad of the spine and the cranial surface of the spine bound the supraspinous fossa (fossa supra- spinata) (/), while the surface caudad of the spine and the caudal portion of the spine bound the infraspinous fossa (fossa infraspinata) (//). The spine (g) begins as a triangular elevated area in the middle of the vertebral margin and runs toward the glenoid angle. It rises gradually for about two-fifths of its length and then the margin becomes broader and the spine remains of the same height to its glenoid end. There is a rough thickening, the tuberosity (7) of the spine, situated on its free border about 64 THE SKELETON OF THE CAT. midway between the tip of the acromion and the vertebral end of the spine. The spine is inclined toward the glenoid margin so.as to form an angle of about 60 degrees with the caudal half of the lateral surface. At the base of the acromion process (7) the margin of the spine presents a flat triangular projection, the metacromion (2), directed toward the glenoid border. The acromion (7) continues in the direction of the spine. It is thicker than the spine, smooth and rounded on both its surfaces and both its borders, and its apex is connected by fibrous tissue to the clavicle. The coracoid border (4) presents a slight rounded notch, the incisura scapule or suprascapular notch (/), just dorsad of the glenoid angle, and at its ventral end bears the coracoid process (7) which is directed ventromediad. The glenoid angle (d) is the only one requiring special mention. Between the root of the coracoid process and the glenoid cavity it presents a tubercle, the supraglenoidal or bicipital tubercle (2), for the tendon of origin of the biceps muscle. The glenoid angle is separated by a contracted neck from the rest of the bone. Between this angle and the inner margin of the acromion there is left a deep notch, the great scapular notch. Clavicle. Clavicula (Fig. 46).—The clavicle in the cat is greatly reduced. It is a slender curved rod —— @ of bone imbedded in the muscles of the Fic. 46.—Cravicte, Shoulder and connected by fibrous tissue to a, medial end; 4, lat- the apex of the acromion process. The om lateral end (0) is slightly enlarged. Humerus (Figs. 47 and 48).—The humerus forms the sup- port of the upper arm and articulates by its proximal end with the scapula at the glenoid cavity, and by its distal end with the radius and ulna, the bones of the lower arm. It is a nearly cylindrical bone with enlarged ends, and is so curved that its dorsal and ventral borders are hooked at the opposite ends so that it has the form of an Italic / The proximal end of the bone bears on its dorsomedial portion a thickening, the head of the humerus (@), which bears ee eee ee =" ). beer” Po THORACIC LIMBS. 65 a smooth ovoid articular facet by which the bone articulates with the glenoid cavity of the scapula. The head is not separated from the body by a distinct anatomical neck as in the human humerus. Along the lateral border of the proximal end of the shaft is a high rough ridge semicircular in side view, the great tuberosity (4). It gives attachment to muscles and is marked Fic. 47.—HUMERUS, VENTRAL SIDE. Fic. 48.—HuMERus, MEDIAL SIDE. a, head; 4, greater tuberosity; c, lesser tuberosity; ¢, bicipital groove; e, pectoral ridge; f, deltoid ridge; g, rough area for insertion of latissimus dorsi and teres major; A, nutrient foramen; 2, capitulum; 7, trochlea; 7, coronoid fossa; m, radial fossa; 7, medial epicondyle; 9, lateral epicondyle; g, supracondyloid foramen. on its dorsal border by a deep depression for the tendon of the infraspinatus muscle. On the medial margin of the proximal end closely associated with the head is a smaller elevation, the lesser tuberosity (¢), also for muscular attachment. Between the greater and lesser tuberosities on the ventral 2 THE SKELETON OF THE CAT. surface is seen a broad groove, the sulcus intertubercularis or bicipital groove (¢), which passes distad onto the surface of the shaft. In the natural state it is converted into a canal by overlying tendons and lodges the tendon of the biceps muscle. The shaft is nearly cylindrical at its middle, but its dorso- ventral diameter is slightly greater than its mediolateral diameter. Its proximal end is flattened mediolaterad, while its distal end is flattened dorsoventrad. From the ventral margin of the greater tuberosity a ridge, the pectoral ridge (c), is continued onto the surface of the shaft, and from the dorsal margin another ridge, the deltoid ridge (/), passes distad and ventrad so as to meet the pectoral ridge near the middle of the ventral surface of the bone. On the medial: margin of the bone near the junction of the first and second fourths is a roughened area (g) for the attachment of the ten- dons of the latissimus dorsi and teres major muscles, and on the same surface near the junction of the second and last thirds is a nutrient foramen (/). The distal end of the bone presents a smooth saddle-shaped articular surface, which, in well-marked bones, is divided, when seen from the ventral surface, by a slight nearly median ridge into two unequal portions, lateral and medial (¢ and 7). The lateral half is rounded and is called the capitulum (7). It is broader ventrad than dorsad, and is not continued onto the dorsal surface of the bone. It is for articulation with the proximal end of the radius. The medial half of the surface, the trochlea (7), is concave and passes directly into the capitular surface laterad, but is limited mediad by a sharp ridge. It is continued onto the dorsal surface of the bone, where it is limited also laterad by a ridge. It articulates with the semilunar notch of the ulna. Proximad of the trochlea the dorsal surface presents a deep fossa, the olecranon fossa, which receives the olecranon of the ulna when the arm is straightened. On the ventral surface (Fig. 47) are two shallower fossa: separated by a longitudinal ridge. The one over the trochlea receives the coronoid process of the ulna when the arm is bent, and is called thence the coronoid fossa (/). The one over the capitulum, the radial eee: ey ee eee THORACIC LIMBS. 67 fossa (7), receives a triangular facet on the proximal end of the radius at the same time. Between the radial and coronoid fosse on one side and the olecranon fossa on the other is only a thin plate of bone. On the medial surface of the distal end is a considerable roughened elevation, the medial epicondyle (z) (epitrochlea). It gives origin to flexor muscles and to the ulnar collateral ligaments of the elbow-joint. Opposite the _ medial epicondyle over the capitulum is the lateral epicondyle (0) for the origin of extensor muscles of the forearm and of the radial collateral ligaments of the elbow-joint. From the lateral epicondyle a ridge, the lateral supracondyloid ridge (f), con- tinues proximad, curving onto the dorsal surface of the bone and ending about opposite the junction of the deltoid and pectoral ridges. Proximad of the medial epicondyle the bone is pierced near its medial margin by an oblique oval foramen, the supracondy- loid foramen (¢). Radius (/, Figs. 49 and 50).—In the usual position the radius lies with its proximal end on the lateral side of the arm, articulating with the capitulum of the humerus. The proximal end is thus laterad of the proximal end of the ulna. Its distal end, however, lies on the medial side of the distal end of the ulna, so that the radius in the natural position crosses ventrad of the ulna. The radius is a curved bone slightly flattened dorsoven- trally, with enlarged ends. It may be described as consisting of a shaft and of a proximal and a distal end. Its proximal end presents on the ventral surface a tuberosity, the bicipital tuberosity (c), for the insertion of the tendon of the biceps muscle. Proximad of this the bone is contracted to form a neck (4) which is surmounted by a head (a). The head has on its proximal surface a depressed oval facet by which it articulates with the capitulum, and on its ulnar border a long narrow facet, the articular circumference (7), for articulation with the radial notch of the ulna; also a triangular facet (e), which fits into the radial fossa of the humerus. The shaft is convex dorsad and concave ventrad. The distal end-is somewhat pyramidal. From its medial or radial 68 THE SKELETON OF THE CAT. side a wedge-shaped process, the styloid process (/), extends distad. The distal surface of the end together with the lateral surface of the styloid process form a concave articular cavity (g) which fits against the scapholunar bone. Fic. 49.—Rapius AND ULNA, Dorso- Fic. 50.—RADIUS AND ULNA, VENTRO- LATERAL VIEW. MEDIAL VIEW. Z, radius; 77, ulna. a@, head of radius; 6, neck; ¢, bicipital tuberosity; ¢, articular circumference; ¢, facet for radial fossa of humerus; /, styloid process of radius; g, facet for articulation of scapholunar bone; /, semilunar (or great sigmoid) notch of ulna; 7, coronoid process; 7, olecranon; 4, area for insertion of brachialis and clavobrachial muscles; 7, rough area for attachment of interosseous membrane; m, styloid process of ulna. The dorsal surface of the distal end is marked by longi- tudinal grooves for tendons, and its lateral or ulnar surface bears a concave facet for articulation with the ulna. Ulna (//, Figs. 49 and 50).—The ulna is a long slender Te eT eae ee Re ee ee ee eT THORACIC LIMBS. 69 bone, flattened mediolaterad. It is enlarged at its proximal end and becomes gradually smaller toward the distal end. The proximal end is marked ventrally by a deep excava- tion, the semilunar notch, or great sigmoid cavity (Z). By the saddle-shaped articular surface of the semilunar notch it articulates with the trochlea. This articular surface is divided into two parts by a transverse non-articular area. The distal boundary of the semilunar notch is a blunt process, the coro- noid process (2), which bears on its lateral surface a concave facet, the radial notch, for the head of the radius. The portion of the bone proximad of the semilunar notch is called the olecranon (7). It fits into the olecranon fossa of the humerus when the arm is straightened, and is rough at its end for the insertion of tendons. The body of the ulna becomes triangular distad. The distal end is slightly larger than the shaft just proximad of it, and bears on its radioventral side a hemispherical head for articulation with the radius. Distad of the head the bone con- tinues as the flattened styloid process (sz), which projects distad from its dorsolateral side and is smooth on the medial side of its apex, for articulation with the cuneiform bone of the wrist. Carpus (Fig. 51).—The carpus (wrist) consists of seven bones arranged in two rows, three in the proximal row and four in the distal row. Beginning on the medial side of the hand (thumb or radial side), the first bone in the proximal row is the scapholunar (a) (equal to the scaphoid or navicular and lunar of the human hand). It articulates with the radius. The next is the cuneiform (4), articulating with the styloid process of the ulna, and the next, which is attached to the cuneiform and projects freely ventrad, is the pisiform (c). In the distal row the bone on the radial side is the trapezium (d@); the next is the trapezoid (¢), the next the os magnum (/), and the last the unciform (g). The distal row articulates with the metacarpals or bones of the palm of the hand (1-5). In the kitten the scapholunar is represented by three bones, the scaphoid or navicular, on the radial side, the lunare, be- tween the scaphoid and the cuneiform, and a centrale, which lies distad of the other two. 7° THE SKELETON OF THE CAT. Scapholunar Bone. Os scapholunaris (Fig. 51, a).—The scapholunar is a quadrangular bone with the ventroradial angle produced into a blunt process. Its proximal surface is smooth and articulates with the distal end of the radius. The distal end is marked by oblique ridges and articulates with the unci- form, os magnum, trapezoid, and trapezium. The ulnar surface articulates with the cuneiform, and the dorsal surface of the ventroradial process with the radial sesamoid. Cuneiform Bone. Fic. 51.— Carpus, META- CARPUS, AND PHALANGES, DoRSAL SURFACE. a, scapholunar cuneiform; ¢, pisiform; d@, trape- zium; @, trapezoid; 7, os mag- num; g, unciform; 4, radial sesamoid; 2, proximal phalanges; Jj, second phalanges; 4, distal phalanges; I, 2, 3, 4, 5, meta- carpals in order from the radial side. bone ; 8," (Os triquetrum BNA) (Fig. 51, 6).— The cuneiform bone has the form of a flattened pyramid. Its base articulates with the unciform, its” proximoulnar surface with the pisiform except at its dorsal margin, where it articulates with the styloid process of the ulna. On its -proximoradial sur- face is a smooth facet for articulation with the scapholunar. Pisiform Bone. Os pistforme (Fig. 51, c).—The pisiform bone is about twice as long as broad, with enlarged ends. Its dorsal end articu- lates with the cuneiform, and on its proximal surface, separated from the above by a smooth ridge, is a smooth facet for articulation with the styloid process of the ulna. Unciform Bone. (Os hamatum BNA) (Fig. 51, g).—The unciform is a wedge-shaped bone with the apex of the wedge directed proximad, and smooth for articulation with the scapholunar. By a part of its ulnar surface it articulates with the cunei- form, and by its radial surface with the osmagnum. Its distal end articulates with the fourth and fifth metacarpals. Os magnum. (Os capitatum BNA) (Fig. 51, f).—The os magnum may be described as an THORACIC LIMBS. : 71 oblong plate bearing on its proximal surface a semicircular ridge which crosses it diagonally. The proximal end of the bone articulates with the scapholunar. Its distal end articulates with the third metacarpal except near its ventroulnar angle, where it articulates with the fourth metacarpal. Its ulnar sur- face articulates with the unciform. Its radial border articulates with the trapezoid, the third metacarpal, and, by two facets, with the second metacarpal. Trapezoid. (Os multangulum minus BNA) (Fig. 51, e).— The trapezoid is somewhat wedge-shaped, with the apex of the wedge pointing ventrad. Its proximal side articulates with the scapholunar, its distal side with the second metacarpal, its ulnar ‘side with the os magnum, and its radial side with the trapezium. Trapestum. (Os multangulum majus BNA.) (Fig. 51, @). —The trapezium has the form of a triangular prism curved into a semicircle. The convex face looks proximad and articulates by its ventral half with the scapholunar. The ulnar surface articulates with the second metacarpal dorsally, and ventrally with the trapezoid. Its radial surface articulates with the first metacarpal. Bones of the Hand or Manus (Fig. 51, 1-5).—The Meta- carpals. Metacarpus.—The metacarpals are the five bones of the palm of the hand; they are numbered from one to five, beginning with the thumb. They are cylindical elongated bones with enlarged ends. The distal end is called the head, and the proximal end the base. Each head bears a hemispherical articular facet which is marked over its ventral half by a prominent smooth ridge. The surface dorsad of the ridge articulates with the proximal head of a phalanx. The ridge and the surface at its sides are for a pair of sesamoid bones. The first metacarpal (1) is the shortest. Its head is oblique, and it articulates by the ulnar half of its proximal surface with the trapezium (@); by the radial half with the radial sesa- moid (A). The second metacarpal (2) is marked on the proximal part of its dorsal surface by an oblique groove passing from the radial side distad to the ulnar side. The base articulates with the trapezoid (¢). The ulnar surface of the proximal end 72 THE SKELETON OF THE CAT. articulates with the os magnum (/) and third metacarpal, while the radial surface articulates with the trapezium (d@). The third metacarpal (3) is the longest, and its base is rhomboidal with a projecting dorsoradial angle separated by a groove from the rhomboid surface. The proximal end articu- ‘lates with the os magnum (/) and second metacarpal; the radial surface of the proximal end with the second, and the ulnar surface with the fourth, metacarpal. The fourth metacarpal (4) has a base similar in form to that of the third, and when placed in position with the fifth the two form a hemispherical facet which articulates with the unciform (g) and os magnum (/). The fourth metacarpal articulates by its radial side with the third, and by its ulnar side with the fifth. The fifth metacarpal (5) articulates by its proximal end with the unciform (g), and by the radial side of its proximal end with the fourth metacarpal. Digits (Fig. 51).—The first digit of the hand is called the pollex (thumb), the second the index, the third the medius, the fourth the annularis, the fifth the minimus. The first digit has two phalanges, each of the others three ‘phalanges. Phalanges (Fig. 51, 2, 7, &).—The phalanges of the proxi- mal row (2) are elongated, flattened dorsoventrally and curved so as to be longitudinally convex dorsad. All have thickened ends. The proximal end is notched, and its proximal surface looks dorsad and is concave for the head of the metacarpal. The distal end is pulley-shaped, and the pulley surface extends farther on to the ventral than on to the dorsal surface, and serves for articulation with the middle phalanx. The phalanges of the middle row (7) are like those of the proximal row, but shorter. The proximal surface is triangular and marked by a median facetted ridge. The whole surface is smooth and adapted to the distal end of the phalanx of the first row. The distal end is transversely elongated, so as to be cylindrical, and projects more toward the ulnar than toward the radial side. The distal phalanx (4) articulates with this cylinder so that when it is fully extended it lies on the ulnar side of the middle phalanx. ge ee eee eT ye —= ve THORACIC LIMBS. 73 The distal phalanx (#) has the form of a quadrangular prism. It is excavated on its proximal surface for articulation with the middle phalanx. Its distal surface presents dorsad a deep excavation from the bottom of which arises a compressed plate of bone having the form of a bird’s beak. The depression receives the base of a claw, and the beak-like projection sup- ports the claw. Sesamotd Bones of the Hand. Ossa sesamotdea.—The hand contains, in addition to those already described, eleven small bones that are developed in tendons. One of these, the radial sesamoid (Fig. 51, %), is closely applied to the radial end of the scapholunar bone. It is developed in the tendon of the extensor brevis pollicis muscle. The other ten occur in pairs as small flattened curved bones on the ventral side of the joint between each metacarpal and the phalanx with which it articulates. JOINTS AND LIGAMENTS OF THE- THORACIC LIMBS. The shoulder-joint is an arthrodial or ball-and-socket joint. The bones entering into its formation are the scapula and the humerus. The capsular ligament or articular capsule is very ample and allows for extended movement of the humerus. It is attached to the edge of the glenoid fossa of the scapula and passing distad covers the head of the humerus and is inserted at the line of junction of the shaft and the epiphysis which forms the head of the bone. On the lateral side of the ventral sur- face of the humerus the attachment continues distad about two centimeters along the lateral edge of the bicipital groove. On the medial side the insertion passes over the proximal end of the lesser tuberosity. A strong transverse band passes from the greater tuberosity to the lesser tuberosity and bridges the bicipital groove, converting it into a canal. The lateral and medial parts of the capsule are strengthened by thicker bands of fibres, the more prominent medial one of which passes from the coracoid process of the scapula to the lesser tuberosity. To the capsule are closely united parts of the supraspinatus, 74 THE SKELETON OF THE CAT. ‘ infraspinatus, coracobrachialis, and subscapularis muscles. A synovial membrane lines the capsule within and forms a sheath around the biceps tendon, so that the latter does not actually enter the synovial capsule. The elbow-joint (Figs. 52 and 53) is a ginglymus or hinge-joint. The bones which enter into it are the humerus, radius, and ulna. The capsule of the joint forms a sac, with the following attachments to the bones: (1) To the humerus it is attached at the proximal edge of the coronoid and radial fossz; to the sides of the capitulum and trochlea distad of the two epicon- dyles, and to the distal edge of the olecranon fossa. (2) To the ulna it is attached at the edges of the radial and semilunar Fic. 52.--LIGAMENTS OF ELBOW- Fic. §3.—ELBOW-JOINT, LATERAL JOINT, MEDIAL SIDE. VIEW. Fig. 52.—1, humerus; 2, ulna; 3, radius. a@ and 4, the two medial collateral ligaments. Fig. 53.—1, humerus; 2, radius; 3, ulna. @, dorsal collateral ligament; 4, ven- tral collateral ligament; ¢, annular ligament. notches; (3) to the radius around the articular facet, two or three centimeters distad of the border. Many of the muscles of this region are closely attached to the capsule. Closely connected with the capsule of the joint are the collateral ligaments. The two medial collateral ligaments (Fig. 52) arise from the medial epicondyle. One (é) passes distad and laterad to the interval between the radius and ulna; here it divides, one branch going to the head of the radius, while the other is attached to the lateral surface of the ulna at the edge of the semilunar notch. The second medial ligament (a) lies dorsad of the first; it passes to the medial surface of the ulna, at the distal edge of the semilunar notch. THORACIC LIMBS. 75 The two collateral ligaments on the lateral side (Fig. 53) arise from the lateral epicondyle. The ventral one (4) passes almost directly distad and is inserted into the lateral surface of the proximal end of the radius about one centimeter from the articular surface; its inner surface is partly united to the annu- lar ligament (c) of the radius. The dorsal one (a) is attached to the lateral border of the semilunar notch of the ulna. Articulations of Radius and Ulna.—The proximal radio- ulnar articulation (Fig. 53) is by a pivot-joint or trochoid. The two bones are held in place by the annular ligament (Fig. 53, ¢). This is attached on the lateral side to the dorsal border of the radial notch of the ulna, passes around the head of the radius, receiving some ligamentous fibres which come from the lateral epicondyle, and is attached to the coronoid process of the ulna. The annular ligament is closely united with the capsule of the joint. The radius and ulna are united for about their middle third by the thin interosseous membrane, which fills the interosseous space between their adjacent edges. The Wrist.—At the wrist or carpus there are in reality three joints, the first between the radius and ulna proximad and the first row of carpals distad, the second between the two rows of carpal bones, the third between the distal row of carpals and the metacarpals. The first two are movable joints; the third is not. Each of these three joints has a capsule, and the bones entering into the joints are interconnected by numer- ous ligaments. These ligaments are named by combining the names of the two bones which they interconnect. Ligaments which interconnect bones of the same row in the carpus are sometimes distinguished as interosseous ligaments, as con- trasted with intercarpal ligaments, which connect together bones of different rows. According to their position the liga- ments may also be distinguished as dorsal, ventral, and lateral. Detailed descriptions and figures of all these ligaments are given by Strauss-Durckheim. Metacarpals.—The joint between the carpals and meta- carpals has been described. At the distal end of the meta- carpals the articulations with the phalanges have each a 76 THE SKELETON OF THE CAT capsule. The joint is further strengthened by a double lateral ligament on each side. The two sesamoid bones at each joint are interconnected by a strong transverse ligament, and each is connected with the head of the metacarpal and the base of the first phalanx by a lateral ligament.- Phalanges.—Between the phalanges the joints possess cap- sules, and each has a radial and an ulnar lateral ligament. VI. BONES OF THE PELVIC EXTREMITIES, Innominate Bones. Ossa innominata. (Os coxe BNA) (Figs. 54 and 55).—The two innominate bones articulate with the sacrum and extend thence caudoventrad and finally turn-mediad and unite in the middle line, forming the symphy- sis pubis. They thus form an arch, the pelvic arch, pelvic girdle or pelvis, which is closed dorsad by the sacrum. In the middle of the lateral surface of each bone is a hemispherical depression, the acetabulum (Fig. 55, @), which receives the head of the femur. In the kitten each innominate bone is composed of three principal parts united by sutures (Fig. 54). From the sacrum to the acetabulum is a single bar, the ilium (/). Fic. 54. — INNoMI- Caudad of the acetabulum are two bars. NATE Bone or Krr- The dorsal one of these is the ischium (//), TEN, VENTROLAT- 4 . eet Wear and the ventral one is the pubis (///). The /, ilium; Z/, ischium; ischium enters into the formation of the tthe pens: - — acetabulum (a), but the pubis does not. ulum; 4, obturator fora- The two bones, however, are in contact at sath the ventral edge of the acetabulum. From this point they diverge, but unite with one another again near the middle line and thus -enclose an oval foramen, the obtura- tor foramen (4). Wedged between the ilium, ischium, and pubis at their point of junction and helping to form the ace- tabulum is a small irregular bone, the acetabular bone (//’). In the adult cat these four parts are united into a single bone which is nevertheless usually described, ignoring the acetabular PELVIC LIMBS. 77 piece, as made up of ilium (Fig. 55, 7), ischium (//), and pubis (///). The ilium (/) is somewhat contracted at the middle and broader at its ends. One end enters into the acetabulum (Fig. 55, @) and forms about one-fifth the articular surface. This end is also the thickest part of the bone. The lateral surface of the ilium is concave for the attachment of muscles. The me- dial surface is smooth over its acetabular half and rough over its sacral half. The rough portion is marked at its junction with the smooth portion by the ear-shaped auricular impression by which the bone articulates directly with the sacrum. The caudal half of that part of the medial surface craniad of the auricular impression gives attachment to the ilio-sacral ligaments which bind the ilium to | the sacrum. The dorsal border is straight at its cranial end and Fy¢g, 55.—InNominaTE BONE OF concave and rounded at its caudal bs CaT, VENTROLATERAL end. Between the two portions 7 jjium; 77, ischium; Z//, pubis. and at the dorsal edge of the @, crest of the ilium; 4, posterior in- : : ferior spine; ¢, great sciatic notch; d, auricular surface is a protuberance acetabulum: @’, incisura acetabuli: ¢, corresponding to the posterior stns of the shium: J ese iat inferior spine (Fig. 55, 4) of the 4, ramus of the ischium; i, ramus of human ilium. The concavity of ne J, obturator: foramen; pubic tubercle; 72. iliopectineal line; the dorsal border (c) corresponds /’, ilio-pectineal eminence; m, anterior to the great sciatic notch of the ““P&TOr Process human ilium. At its caudal end is the short spine of the ischium (¢), which is nota part ofthe ilium. The ventral border of the ilium is broad caudad, becoming narrower craniad. The lateral margin of the ventral border is continued to a tuberosity at the edge of the acetabulum; its medial margin is called the \B Ne Se Qs; 78 THE SKELETON OF THE CAT. iliopectineal line (/) and extends on the pubis to the symphysis. An eminence, the iliopectineal eminence (/’), on the iliopec- tineal line, lies opposite to the acetabulum at about the junction of the ilium and pubis. The cranial end of the bone is thick- ened, forming the crest (a) of the ilium. At the junction of the crest with the ventral border is a projection, the anterior superior process (7) of human anatomy. The pubis (///) (including the acetabular bone) enters into the formation of the acetabulum (d@) constituting about one- sixth the circumference, but less than one-sixth its area. It may be described as a flat, curved bone, contracted at the middle and expanded at the ends. The dorsal end enters into the acetabulum; the ventral end unites with the opposite bone at the symphysis pubis and sends caudad a projection, the ramus (2) of the pubis, which unites with the ramus of the opposite bone to form about two-thirds of the entire symphysis. At the sides of the symphysis a slightly marked angle projects craniad from each of the pubic bones; these two together con- stitute the pubic tubercle (£), for the origin of the rectus abdominis muscle. The surfaces of the ramus are smooth. One of its borders is concave ‘and enters into the formation of the obturator foramen (7). Another of its borders is the ilio- pectineal line (7). Its third border is rough for the symphysis. The ischium (//) has the form of a triangular prism con- tracted at the middle. Its cranial end forms nearly two-thirds of the acetabulum. Its caudal end bears dorsad a rough thickening, the tuberosity of the ischium (g). From the caudal half of the ventral border of the bone a sickle-shaped process, the ramus (%) of the ischium, curves medioventrad and then craniad and joins the ramus of the pubis. Its medial border is rough and enters into the symphysis, forming the caudal one-third. The lateral angle of the bone is rounded. Its dorsal angle is marked near the cranial end by the spine (ce) of the ischium. The concavity between this spine and the tuberosity corresponds to the lesser sciatic notch (/) of human anatomy. The acetabulum (d@) is cup-shaped. The ventral one-sixth of its border is deficient and a broad groove extends from the PELVIC LIMBS. 79 deficiency to the bottom of the cup. The deficiency, incisura acetabuli, or acetabular notch (@’), is closed naturally by a ligament, and the groove gives origin to the ligament (liga- mentum teres) which attaches the head of the femur. Femur (Fig. 56).—The femur is the proximal bone of the posterior extremity. It consists of enlarged proximal and distal ends connected by a nearly cylin- drical shaft. The proximal end presents on its medial side a hemispherical head (a) which fits into the acetabulum. It is supported by a neck (4) which is con- tracted near the head and expanded dorso- ventrally where it joins the remainder of the bone. The medial surface of the head presents near its ventral border a depres- ~ sion (c) for the insertion of the round liga- ment of the femur. Ventrad the articular surface of the head extends as an acute projection onto the shaft, so that the whole articular surface appears somewhat pear- shaped. On the lateral side of the proxi- mal end opposite the head is a projecting mass, the great trochanter (d), forming the end of the shaft. On the medial side of the great trochanter at its junction with the neck is a deep fossa, the trochanteric fossa or digital fossa (e) for the insertion ‘of muscles. From the ventral surface of *™® Mt arash es the great trochanter a ridge, the inter- a, head; 4, neck; ¢, de- trochanteric line (/), is continued distad, ery ee ee ending in a pyramidal projection, the ¢, trochanteric fossa; /, lesser trochanter (g), which serves for jcrrochanteric line; lesser trochanter; h, linea the insertion of muscles. A second ridge aspera; 7, medial condyle; ‘ : J, lateral condyle; 4, inter- is continued to the lesser trochanter from condyloid fossa; '/, lateral the neck. A_ slight but well-marked ¢picondyle. ridge, the spiral ridge or line, runs round two sides of the neck parallel to the second ridge. 80 THE SKELETON OF THE CAT. The shaft is nearly straight and cylindrical. A rough line is continued along its ventral surface from the lesser trochanter, and a similar line along its lateral surface from the greater trochanter; these unite ventrad to form the linea aspera (/). On its ventral surface is a nutrient foramen, directed proximad. The shaft gradually widens distad and ends in two condyles (¢ and 7) which are continuous dorsad but separated ventrad by a deep notch, the intercondyloid fossa (4). The distal surface of the shaft and condyles is articular. This articular surface is larger on the lateral condyle (7). The part of the articular surface on the end of the shaft (patellar surface) is for the patella; that part of it on the condyles and separated by the notch is for the tibia. On the lateral surface of the lateral condyle is a slight prominence, the lateral epicondyle (/), and on the medial sur- face of the medial condyle is another prominence, the medial epicondyle; both are for the attachment of ligaments. Patella (Fig. 1, ~).—The patella is a small flat bone with a pear-shaped outline, having its apex distad. It lies against -the articular surface at the lower end of the shaft of the femur. It thus covers the knee-joint. The inner surface is smooth and convex from side to side, but concave in a proximodistal line. It fits against the lower end of the femur. Its outer surface is rough and concave. It is a sesamoid bone inserted in the tendon of the quadriceps femoris muscle. Three other sesamoid bones are found in the region of the knee (see Fig. 61, p. 89). Two are in the tendons of the gastrocnemius muscle, proximad of the two condyles of the femur. The third is in the tendon of the popliteus muscle, just laterad of the lateral condyle of the femur. Tibia (/, Fig. 57).—The tibia is the longer of the two bones of the leg between the knee and the ankle, and is the longest bone of the body. It has a triangular shaft and enlarged proximal and distal ends. The proximal end is curved ventrad and projects into two prominences, the tuberosities, on either side. Each tuberosity bears on its proximal end an articular facet for the condyles of the femur; these are known respectively as the lateral and PELVIC LIMBS. medial condyles (a and 4) of the tibia. The condyles are oval, convex dorsoventrad, and concave from side to side. The two con- dyles are separated at the middle of their contiguous margins by a bicuspid projection, the spine of the tibia (c). They are con- tinuous dorsad, but separated ventrad by a deep notch between the tuberosities, the popliteal notch. On the distal side of the lateral condyle is an elongated tacet for the proximal end of the fibula. The shaft is triangular, smallest at about its middle and enlarged at both ends. It presents dorsal, medial, and lateral borders, and medial, lateral, and ventral surfaces. The lateral surface is concave proximad. The medial surface is convex. The two are continuous at the distal end. At their proximal ends the border separating them is raised into a prominent ridge, the crest (@) of the tibia, the proximal end of which contributes to increase the proximal sur- face of the bone, and presents an oblong tubercle (e) for the insertion of the liga- mentum patella (ligament of the quadri- ceps femoris muscle). The ventral surface is concave proximad where it abuts upon the tuberosities. Its proximal half is crossed by two rough parallel lines, the distal one of which crosses in a spiral course from the lateral to the medial border; near its begin- ning is a nutrient foramen. The distal end extends farther distad on its medial side. The extension is the medial malleolus (7). The malleolus presents two grooves on its medial surface for the tendons of muscles. On the lateral side of the distal 81 Fic. 57.—TIBIA AND FIBULA’ OF LEFT Lec, Dorsal VIEW. Z, tibia; 77, fibula. a, medial condyle of the tibia; 4, lateral con- dyle; c, spine of the tibia; @, crest of the tibia; e, tubercle for at- tachment of the patellar ligament; /, medial malleolus; g, projection of dorsal surface of the tibia; 4, head of fibula; z, lateral malleolus. end is an oblique triangular facet for the distal end of the 82 THE SKELETON OF THE CAT. fibula. The ventral surface of the distal end presents an ob- lique border which passes from the apex of the malleolus proximolaterad. The dorsal-surface extends into a V-shaped projection (g) between the malleolus and the fibular facet. The distal end presents an oblique ridge running from the apex of the V-shaped extension of the dorsal surface to near the base of the medial malleolus. The ridge and the con- cavities on either side of it, the medial one of which is deeper, fit against the proximal trochlear surface of the astragalus. Fibula (//, Fig. 57).—The fibula lies at the lateral side of the tibia in the shank. -It is a slender triangular bone with enlarged proximal and distal ends. The proximal end or head (#) is flattened. It bears a facet on its proximomedial surface for articulation with the tibia, and is longitudinally grooved on the outer surface. The shaft has a very sharp medial border. This border is turned toward the tibia and gives attachment to the interosseous membrane, which runs between the tibia and fibula. The distal end is expanded to form the lateral malleolus (z). This bears a facet on the proximal portion of its medial surface near its dorsal margin, for the tibia, and distad of this is a second facet for the astragalus. The ventral and lateral sur- faces are grooved: for tendons. Tarsus (Fig. 58).—The tarsus consists of seven bones. The longest of these, lying on the lateral side of the foot and forming the support of the heel, is the calcaneus or os calcis (a). It articulates distad with a bone, the cuboid (c), which bears the fourth and fifth metatarsals. Lying between the calcaneus and the tibia is the astragalus or talus (4), the distal end of which articulates with the boat-shaped navicular or scaphoid (2). The scaphoid bears on its distal surface the three cunei- form bones, lateral (¢), medial (g), and intermediate, bearing the rudiment of the first metatarsal and the second and third metatarsals. Astragalus. (Talus BNA) (Fig. 58, 6).—The astragalus may be divided into body, neck, and head. The body is marked on its proximal surface by a deep pulley-like groove for the articulation with the distal end of the tibia, and on its a \ ( Fic. 58.—Tarsus, META- TARSUS, AND PHALANGES oF LerT Foot, VENTRAL VIEW. a, calcaneus; 4, astragalus; ¢, cuboid; d@, scaphoid; ¢, lat- eral cuneiform; g, medial cuneiform; 4, peroneal groove, for the tendon of the peroneus longus muscle; 7, proximal phalanges; 7, second row of phalanges; 4, distal phalanges; 7, sesamoid bones, 1, rudi- mentary first (medial) meta- tarsal; 2, 3, 4, 5, the other metatarsals. PELVIC LIMBS. 83 lateral and medial surfaces by curved facets for articulation with the malleoli of the tibia and fibula. This entire surface for articulation with the bones of the leg is known as the trochlea. The lower surface is marked by two facets separated by a groove; these are for articulation with corresponding facets on the calcaneus. Distally the bone contracts to form the neck and enlarges at the end, forming the head, which is smooth on its distal surface for articulation with the navicular or sca- phoid. Calcaneus (Fig. 58, a, and Fig. 59). —The calcaneus (os calcis) is the largest bone of the foot and forms the heel. It is two or three times as long as broad and has six surfaces: dorsal, ventral, medial, lateral, proximal, and distal. The proximal one-half of the dorsal surface (Fig. 59) is smooth, while the distal half is broadened and bears two facets which are separated by a groove. These articulate with the corresponding facets on the astragalus. The medial Fic. 59.—CALCANEUS OF RIGHT Foot, Dorsal VIEW. a, distal facet for cuboid; 4, proximal end with groove for tendon of Achilles; ¢, sustentacu- lum tali; ¢, peroneal tubercle. 84 THE SKELETON OF THE CAT. facet is borne on a projection of the bone, the sustentaculum tali (c). Distad of the facets the surface is rough. The ventral surface is smooth.. The proximal end (4) is grooved for the tendon of Achilles. The lateral surface is smooth and marked by a grooved tubercle, the peroneal tubercle (@), near the distal end. The medial surface is marked by part of the articular facet for the astragalus, and also by the grooved sustentaculum tali. The distal end (a) articulates with the cuboid. Cubotd. Os cubotdeum (Fig. 58, c).—The cuboid has somewhat the form of a cube and articulates by its proximal end with the calcaneus (a), and by its distal end with the fourth and fifth metatarsals. Its medial surface articulates with the scaphoid (@) and lateral cuneiform (¢). The ventral surface is marked near its distal end by an oblique ridge, distad of which is a deep groove, the peroneal groove (%), for the tendon of the peroneus longus muscle. Scaphoid. (Os naviculare pedis BNA) (Fig. 58, @).— The scaphoid is a boat-shaped bone. Its proximal surface is marked by a concave facet for the head of the astragalus (0), and its distal surface has three facets for the lateral (¢), inter- mediate and medial (g) cuneiform bones. At the junction of the ventral with the medial surface is a prominent tubercle. The lateral surface bears two linear facets for articulation with the calcaneus (a) and cuboid (c). Lateral Cuneiform. Lctocunetform. Os cunetforme ter- tum BNA (Fig. 58, e).—The lateral cuneiform is a wedge- shaped bone with a hooked process extending from the ventral sharp angle of the bone. It articulates by its proximal end with the scaphoid (@), and by its distal end with the third metatarsal. The medial surface bears near its distal end two facets for the second metatarsal, and on its proximal end a facet for the intermediate cuneiform. The caudal surface has a facet on its proximal end for the cuboid (c). Intermediate Cunetform. Mesocunetform. Os cunetforme secundum BNA.—The intermediate cuneiform is small and wedge-shaped, with the base of the wedge dorsad. It lies between the lateral cuneiform and the medial cuneiform, articu- lates by its proximal end with the middle facet of the scaphoid, PELVIC LIMBS. 85 and bears on its distal end the second metatarsal. It is not visible in ventral view. Medial Cunetform. Entocunetform. Os cunetforme primum BNA (Fig. 58, g).—The medial cuneiform lies on the medial side of the foot. It is a flat triangular bone about twice as long as broad, and broader at its proximal end than at the distal end. It bears on its distal end the rudimentary first meta- tarsal. The proximal end is oblique and bears a concave facet for the lateral distal facet of the scaphoid (d). The lateral surface has a concave facet at its proximal end for the inter- mediate cuneiform, while the distal portion is applied against the medial surface of the second metatarsal. Bones of the Foot or Pes (Fig. 58).—JMJetatarsals. Meta- tarsus (Fig. 58, 1-5).—The metatarsals are five in number. They bear a close resemblance to the metacarpals, but they may be distinguished by their bases. The first metacarpal (1) is rudimentary and conical. Its base has a facet for the distal end of the medial cuneiform (), while the outer surface fits into a depression on the inner sur- face of the base of the second metatarsal. The second (2). The proximal surface of the base is tri- angular, corresponding to’ the distal end of the intermediate cuneiform. The medial surface is marked by two concavities, one along the proximal border for the distal end of the medial cuneiform, and one distad of this for the first metatarsal. The lateral surface bears on the proximal margin an oblique tri- angular facet dorsad and a similar facet ventrad, both for the lateral cuneiform (¢). Distad of these facets is a rough ridge. The ¢hird (3). The proximal end of its base is a triangular facet with the apex directed ventrad and the sides excavated. It is for the distal end of the lateral cuneiform (e). Its medial surface presents a depression which receives the ridge of the second metatarsal. On the lateral surface a short distance distad of the proximal border is a triangular concave facet, and near the proximal border ventrad a second concave facet. Both are for the fourth metatarsal. The fourth (4). The proximal end is convex, notched medially and facetted for the cuboid (c). Its medial surface 86 THE SKELETON OF THE CAT. bears dorsad, a short distance from its proximal end, a smooth tubercle, and ventrad a small convex facet. Both articulate with facets on the lateral surface of the third metatarsal. The lateral surface has a sinuous facet along its dorsal border, and ventrad of this a depression. There is a second facet along the ventral border. Both facets are for the fifth metatarsal, and the depression is for ligaments. The fifth (5) has its base flattened and expanded so as to be wedge-shaped, with the apex of the wedge directed proxi- mad. Its dorsal end extends into atubercle. It thus presents only lateral and medial surfaces. The medial surface shows two tubercles, one distad of the other. The distal tubercle and the distal half of the proximal tubercle are facetted and fit into the sinuous facet on the fourth metatarsal. A narrow facet on the ventral border of the surface articulates with the facet on the ventral border of the lateral surface of the fourth metatarsal. The proximal half of the distal tubercle is facetted for the cuboid (c). The lateral surface is smooth, non-articular, and obliquely grooved. Phalanges (Fig. 58, 2, 7, &).—There are three phalanges in each of the four digits, and these are almost identical with those described for the manus. Sesamoid Bones. Ossa sesamoidea (Fig. 58, /).—The sesamoid bones are found at the joints between the metatarsals and phalanges, and are in all respects like those of the manus. JOINTS AND LIGAMENTS OF THE PELVIC LIMBS. Ligaments of the Pelvis.—The ilium and sacrum are articu- lated at the auricular facet of the ilium and the corresponding rough surface ofthe sacrum. The joint is an amphiarthrosis, per- mitting very little movement. A capsular ligament surrounds the articular surface, being attached to the bones about its circum- ference; itis shortand strong. Craniad of the capsule is a thick very short ligament, composed of very strong transverse fibres passing from the rough surface of the sacrum to the correspond- ing rough surface ofthe ilium. This forms the lateral iliosacral ligament, which is united at its caudal border to the capsule. A strong, wide ligamentous band passes from the dorsal PELVIC LIMBS. 87 border of the ilium to the sides of the sacrum. This is indis- tinctly subdivided into several bands, which together represent the long and short posterior iliosacral ligaments of man. Symphysis pelvis.—The medial borders of the pubis and ilium meet in the middle line ventrad of the pelvis and are here united by cartilage. The joint is strengthened by numerous small bands which pass across the line of junction from one side to the other; these occur on both surfaces. The Hip-joint.—The hip-joint is an enarthrosis, or ball- and-socket joint in which more than half the spherical head of the femur is received into the acetabulum. The depth of the acetabulum is increased by a rim of fibrocartilage about its margin, forming the labrum glenoidale. This passes across the acetabular notch, forming the transverse ligament of the acetabulum; beneath it blood-vessels and nerves pass into the acetabular cavity. The capsule of the joint is large and loose. It is attached about the margin of the acetabulum, and passes over the head of the femur, to be attached to the bone several millimeters distad of the head. It thus encloses both the head and the neck of the femur. The ligamentum teres, or round ligament, is a very strong, short ligament which passes from the depression in the head of the femur to the bottom of the acetabulum. The Knee-joint (Figs. 60 and 61).—The joint between the femur and the tibia is very complex. The surfaces of the con- dyles of the femur do not correspond to those of the condyles of the tibia. Between the ends of the two bones are placed two disks of. cartilage, the menisci, or semilunar cartilages _ (Fig. 60, ¢ and d; Fig. 61, a and 4), of such a form that the congruity of articular surfaces is restored. Each meniscus has a proximal surface corresponding to the form of one of the condyles of the femur, and a distal surface corresponding to a condyle of the tibia. The menisci are held in position by liga- ments. The knee-joint permits not only backward and forward movement, but also a small amount of rotary motion, The joint has two capsules, one on the dorsal (convex) side, the other on the ventral side. The two communicate 88 THE SKELETON OF THE CAT. only by a small passageway lying within the joint between the ends of the bones. The dorsal one is attached to the femur several millimeters proximad of the patellar surface and some distance on each side of the latter. The patella is imbedded in its outer wall, and it is attached to the tibia on the edges of the articular surface of the latter, from the crest to the tuber- osities. The capsule is also attached laterally and medially to the sides of the menisci, and is closely united to the patellar ligaments. Its cavity contains a mass of yellow fat. The ventral capsule is attached to the borders of the articu- lar surfaces of the femur and tibia on their ventral sides, to the menisci, and to the epicondyles of the femur and the tuberosi- ties of the tibia. Its walls are stronger and its cavity smaller than those of the dorsal capsule. The ligaments of the knee-joint (Figs. 60 and 61), aside from the capsules, may be classified into: (1) those which are connected with the patella; (2) collateral ligaments (Fig. 60, z and 7), which pass from the epicondyles directly distad along the sides of the joint to the tibia or fibula; (3) crucial ligaments (Fig. 60, gand%; Fig. 61, cand @), which cross within the joint from one side of the femur to the opposite side of the tibia; (4) ligaments which hold the menisci in place (Fig. 60, e and /; Fig. 61, e and /). (1) LIGAMENTS OF THE PATELLA.—The patella is im- bedded in the dorsal wall of the dorsal capsule of the joint. From its distal end a strong tendon or ligament passes distad to the crest of the tibia. This is known as the ligamentum patellz: it may be considered a part of the tendon of M. quad- riceps femoris. On the lateral side the capsule of the joint is strengthened by the transverse fibres of the tendon of M. plan- taris, which aid in holding the patella in place. (2) COLLATERAL LIGAMENTS.—Of these there are two. The ligamentum collaterale fibulare (Fig. 60, 7) is attached to the lateral epicondyle of the femur and passes distad across the tendon of the plantaris muscle to the head of the’ fibula. Dorsad of the fibular ligament and parallel with it passes the tendon of origin of the extensor longus digitorum. The liga- mentum collaterale tibiale (Fig. 60, z; Fig. 61, g) begins on > "A aD Tes ae Nil Reo ees Se a a a ys PELVIC LIMBS. 89 the medial epicondyle of the femur and passes distad to the lateral tuberosity of the tibia; part of it passes one to one and a half centimeters distad of the tuberosity to be attached to a rough ridge on the side of the tibia. (3) CRUCIAL LIGAMENTS.—There are two of these also. The ligamentum cruciatum anterius, or anterior crucial liga- ment (Fig. 60, ¢; Fig. 61, c), is a thick, strong ligament which begins on the dorsal part of the proximal end of the tibia nearer the medial side (Fig. 60, g), and passes ventrad and _ proxi- / Fic. 60.—KNEE-JOINT, FROM THE Fic. 61. — KNEE-JOINT, FROM THE DoRSAL OR PATELLAR SIDE, VENTRAL OR FLEXOR SIDE. Fig. 60.--The patella has been removed. 1, femur; 2, tibia; 3, fibula. a, patellar surface of femur; 4, tubercle for attachment of ligamentum patelle; c, medial meniscus; @, lateral meniscus; e, /, ligaments of the menisci; g, ligamentum crucia- tum anterius; 4, ligamentum cruciatum posterius; 7, ligamentum collaterale tibiale; J, ligamentum collaterale fibulare. Fig. 61.—The capsule of the joint has been opened. 1, femur; 2, tibia (fibula not shown); 3, sesamoid bone in lateral head of M. gastrocnemius; 4, sesamoid in medial head of M, gastrocnemius; 5, tendon of M. popliteus, with sesamoid bone; 6, 7, lateral and medial condyles of the femur, with the intercondyloid notch between them; 8, 9, lateral and medial condyles of the tibia, with the popliteal notch between them; a, 6, medial and lateral menisci; ¢, ligamentum cruciatum anterius; d, liga- mentum cruciatum posterius; ¢, /, ligaments of the lateral meniscus; g, ligamentum collaterale tibiale. mad, between the ends of the two bones forming the joint, into the intercondyloid fossa of the femur, and becomes attached to the medial surface of the lateral condyle of the femur (Fig. 61, c). It is composed of two partially separated bands, form- ing a slight angle with one another. It is crossed near its dorsal and ventral ends by two of the ligaments of the menisci. The ligamentum cruciatum posterius, or posterior crucial liga- go THE SKELETON OF THE CAT. ment (Fig. 60, 4; Fig. 61, @), begins on the tibia at the edge of the popliteal notch (Fig. 61, d), nearer the medial side, and passes dorsad and proximad to be attached to the ventral edge of the patellar surface of the femur, in the intercondyloid fossa (Fig. 60, %). (4) LIGAMENTS OF THE MENISCI.—There are five of these, connecting the menisci with the femur or tibia. One (Fig. 60, ¢) passes from the dorsal edge of the medial menis- cus (c) transversely across the anterior crucial ligament (g) to the proximal end of the tibia nearer the lateral side. A second (Fig. 60, f) passes from the dorsal margin of the lateral meniscus (@) transversely beneath the anterior crucial ligament (g) to the proximal end of the tibia nearer the ventral side and medial border. A third (Fig. 61, /) passes from the ventral margin of the lateral meniscus obliquely across the anterior crucial ligament (c) to the lateral side of the medial condyle of the femur. The fourth (Fig. 61, ¢) is small, passing from the medial angle of the ventral border of the lateral meniscus distad to the popliteal notch. The fifth passes from the ventral border of the medial meniscus laterad beneath the posterior crucial ligament to the proximal end of the tibia, nearer the ventral and lateral sides. Articulations between the Tibia and Fibula.—At the proximal end the fibula is as it were suspended from the distal side of the overhanging lateral tuberosity of the tibia by strong ligamentous tissue. The capsule of the joint is formed by an extension of the capsule of the knee-joint which passes between the tibia and fibula on the ventral side. Forming the dorso- lateral wall of this extension is a strong, thick ligament which passes directly from the head of the fibula to the lateral surface of the lateral tuberosity of the tibia. A second more delicate ligament passes from the head of the fibula dorsoproximad to the tubercle laterad of the crest of the tibia, bridging a groove through which passes the tendon of M. extensor longus digi- torum. The tibia and fibula are connected throughout their length by an interosseus membrane. This is broad and very thin in its proximal part, narrower and thicker distad. PELVIC LIMBS. gt Distad the two malleoli forming the ends of the fibula and tibia are closely and immovably united. The capsule of the joint is here an extension proximad of the capsule of the articu- lation with the astragalus. On the dorsal side a short broad band of strong fibres passes from the surface of the tibia obliquely laterodistad to the border of the fibula; this forms the anterior ligament of the lateral malleolus. On the ventral side a very much weaker set of fibres forms the ventral wall of the articular capsule; it is called the posterior ligament of the lateral malleolus. Tibia and fibula are also connected on the dorsal side by the ligamentum transversum cruris, or trans- verse ligament of the lower leg (Fig. 91, 5), which spans the tendons of Mm. extensor longus digitorum and tibialis anterior. From the middle of the distal margin of this a slender sup- porting ligament passes distad and is inserted on the dorsal surface of the tarsus. The grooves in the two malleoli for the passage of the tendons are spanned by ligamentous fibres (retinacula) for holding the tendons in place. Articulation between the Leg and the Foot.—At the distal end there is formed between the two malleoli a deep irregular fossa, into which is received the trochlea of the astragalus. The joint is covered by a large articular capsule, which passes also, as above noted, between the tibia and fibula. In addition to the capsule the following ligaments may be dis- tinguished: (a) On the lateral side, (1) a short ligament from the fibula to the astragalus, directed toward the proximal end of the foot; (2) a ligament from the fibula to the calcaneus, attached to the latter proximad of the peroneal tubercle; (3) a stronger ligament from the fibula to the calcaneus, lying beneath the last-mentioned and directed toward the proximal end of the bone. (4) On the medial side may be distinguished (1) a strong ligament from the tibia (medial malleolus) to the sustentaculum tali, and passing thence onto the scaphoid; (2) a short ligament from the medial malleolus to the astragalus. The Tarsus.—The articulations between the separate bones of the tarsus and between the tarsus and metatarsus have a considerable number of variously communicating articular cap- sules. The separate bones are connected by many ligaments. g2 THE SKELETON OF THE CAT. The ligaments of the ventral surface (ligamenta plantaria) are especially well developed. Here may be noticed particularly a very large calcaneocuboid ligament, and a large calcaneocunei- form ligament which passes from the sustentaculum tali to the medial cuneiform. Those on the dorsal surface (ligamenta dorsalia) are less strong and numerous. Many ligaments, longitudinal, transverse, and oblique, pass also between the separate bones (ligamenta interossea). Ligamenta lateralia, on the lateral and medial borders of the foot, are also distin- guishable. Strauss-Durckheim enumerates ninety-four liga- ments of the tarsus; an account of each of these does not form part of the plan of the present work. , The ligaments of the metatarsus and phalanges are of the same general character as in the forelimb. Of these Strauss- Durckheim enumerates thirty-six; they will not be described here. THE MUSCLES. I. THE MUSCLES OF THE SKIN. (Fig. 62.) M. cutaneus maximus (Fig. 62, 4).—This isa very large, thin muscle which covers almost the whole side of the body. It arises from the outer surface of the latissimus dorsi (Fig. 68, m) near its ventral end and from the bicipital arch (Fig. 65, 7’) in the axilla; from the linea alba for a considerable distance (two or three inches) caudad of the base of the xiphoid process, and from the thorax over a line joining the axilla and the base of the xiphoid. Sometimes a few fibres take origin from the fascia which covers the pectoantibrachialis on the ventral side of the arm. From their origin the fibres diverge. The cranial ones curve about the base of the forelimb and are inserted into the skin at or near the middle line caudad of the first thoracic vertebra. The most cranial fibres of all are inserted about one to one and a half centimeters from the middorsal line; thence the line of insertion approaches the middorsal line to reach it at about the eighth or ninth thoracic vertebra. The middle fibres run parallel to the middorsal line in the lumbar and sacral regions as far as the root of the tail, a small bundle. passing onto the dorsal side of the tail, another onto the ventral side. The fibres of the caudal portion pass onto the thigh, the ventral ones running in the fold of skin which stretches from thigh to abdomen, and are finally lost in the fascia along a line connecting the knee and the root of the tail. A strong fascia connects the adjacent borders of the cutaneus and platysma and lies over the scapular region. 93 ‘uIdA AvnSonf [eusd}x9 ‘I ‘sour sipeiojoad "yy ‘stperouny-rydix "yr 4y ‘tyoviq sdaowy “yy jo wnsuoy yndeo ‘f tryovaq sdaouy ‘W JO eviayey yndeo ‘2 tsteryoesq “OARS "WW ‘y ‘snapioyep-ormosoe “y 4F :snaplojjap-ourds +p ‘f ‘styeaquaa eetndeos 10wwag] “WW ‘7 ‘snizadesj-o1moioe “py ‘py ‘saposnut zsdaap Surmoy “[OF OY} Woes o1v SNUIXBUE snouZINd ay) pu vUIshye{d oY} UseMjog “SHO sluvpnsiquo "|W ‘9 {snuIxem snoueno "W ‘9 :vusdqerd "yw 62 Sy ‘p ‘NING AHL JO saTosaWw—'zg ‘oly ry THE MUSCLES. 94 THE MUSCLES OF THE SKIN. 95 This muscle lies immediately beneath the integument. It covers the first layer of body muscles. ° Astion.—Moves the skin. M. platysma (Figs. 62 and 64, a, a’, a’’).—This muscle forms a thin layer of fibres covering the sides of the neck and face, in close relation with the integument. Several more or less distinct portions may be distinguished. (1) Most of the fibres (@) arise from the middorsal line, from the occiput to the first thoracic vertebra, in a narrow fascia common to the muscles of the two sides. The most cranial fibres of this region arise as a small bundle from the external occipital crest, beneath the levator auris longus (Fig. 63, &) &): : From this origin in the middle line the fibres pass cranio- laterad. The most cranial fibres curve about the ventral side of the ear and pass toward the caudal angle of the eye, where they unite with fibres of the zygomaticus (Fig. 64, d@) or corru- gator supercilii lateralis (Fig. 64, #), or pass to the lower eyelid. Caudad of these the fibres cover the side of the face and become lost among the facial muscles, some passing to the lower eyelid, some to the fibrous pad which supports the vibrisse, some to the angle of the mouth, some to the lower — lip. The most ventral fibres meet the fibres of the opposite muscle just ventrad of the symphysis of the mandible. The ventral free border of the platysma is separated on the ventral side of the neck from the border of the opposite muscle by a wedge-shaped area having its point at the symphysis menti. The fibres of this portion of the muscle are interrupted by an attachment to the skin, along a line passing from the base of the ear to about the middle of the coracoid border of the scapula, The dorsal (2) and ventral (a’) portions of the muscle, separated by this line of attachment, are sometimes described as separate muscles (the supercervicocutaneus and cervicofacial, respectively, of Strauss-Durckheim). (2) A band of fibres one or two centimeters across (a’’) arises in the fascia of the side of the neck just craniad of the middle of the coracoid border of the scapula, and passes caudo- 96 THE MUSCLES. ventrad toward the manubrium, its fibres crossing the fibres of the first part of the platysma at right angles. These fibres become lost in the fascia ventrad of the manubrium, or pass across the middle line to intermingle with the corresponding fibres of the opposite side. This portion of the platysma is sometimes absent. The platysma is everywhere subcutaneous, except at its dorsocranial angle, where a small bundle of fibres is covered by the levator longus auris. It covers the deeper muscles of the neck and head. Closely attached to its inner surface-are the submentalis and depressor conchz, whose fibres bridge over the ventral interval between the borders of the platysmas of opposite sides. Action.— Moves the skin of the face and neck. II. THE MUSCLES OF THE HEAD. A. SUPERFICIAL MuscLes.—The most superficial layer of muscles on the face and head is formed by differentiation of the fibres of the platysma. The muscles thus formed are not clearly distinct from each other; in this region sets of fibres differing in direction and in origin or insertion receive separate names even though the different sets of fibres are closely inter- woven. In the quadrangle on the dorsal surface of the head enclosed between the two eyes and the two ears, a thin superficial sheet of fibres is found, in which a number of different sets may be distinguished (Fig. 63). These have received the following names. M. intermedius scutulorum (Fig. 63, «2).—This consists of a broad thin sheet of transverse fibres between the two external ears. The fibres are attached at either end to the scutiform cartilage (1) of the two ears, and pass without inter- ruption across the middle line. At its cranial edge this muscle is continuous with the corrugator supercilii.medialis (6); at its lateral edge with the frontoscutularis; at its caudal edge with the levator auris longus (g). Relations.—Outer surface with.the integument. Inner sur- ries Ss ea THE MUSCLES OF THE HEAD, 97 face with the galea aponeurotica (to which the muscle is closely united), the epicranius muscle (/) and the temporal muscle (7). Action.—Draws the two ears dorsad, toward the middle line. Fic. 63.—MUSCLES ON THE DorsAL SURFACE OF THE HEAD. On the right side are shown the superficial muscles; on the left side the super- ficial muscles have mostly been removed, exposing the deeper muscles and the bone. a, M. intermedius scutulorum; 4, M. corrugator supercilii medialis; c, M. orbicularis oculi; d, M. corrugator supercilii lateralis; ¢, cranial end fibres of M. platysma; /, M. adductor auris superior; g, g’, M. levator auris longus (g. cranial portion; g’, caudal portion); 4, 2’, M. epicranius (2, M. occipitalis; 2’ M. frontalis); 7, M. trans- versus auricule; %, M. auricularis superior (cut on the left side); 2, M. abductor auris. brevis; #, M. abductor auris longus; 7, M. temporalis; 0, cut origin of M. frontoscutularis; 4, 4’, M. levator labii superioris aleeque nasi (/’, the origin from the maxillary bone); g, angular head of M. quadratus labii superioris. 1, scutiform cartilage; 2, external ear; 3, bones of the skull. M. corrugator supercilii medialis (4).—This consists of a thin sheet of scattered fibres lying craniad of the last and intermingling with it. The fibres take origin near the middle line, pass laterad, then cufve craniad, converging, to be 98 THE MUSCLES. inserted into the whole extent of the upper eyelid, especially near the caudal angle. Here the fibres unite with those of the orbicularis oculi (c). This muscle is continuous caudad with the intermedius scutulorum (@), craniad with the orbicularis oculi (c); laterad with the corrugator supercilii lateralis (7). Toward the medial side the fibres lose themselves in a tendinous sheet that joins the galea aponeurotica. Relations. —Outer surface with the integument. Inner sur- face with the frontoscutularis and the skull. Action.—Raises the upper eyelid. M. orbicularis oculi (Fig. 63, c; Fig. 64, s).—This con- sists of two thin bands of muscle-fibres which lie one in either eyelid parallel to its border and unite at the angle of the eye. Origin by short tendon-fibres from a tubercle on the surface of the frontal process of the maxillary bone just dorsad of the orbital end of the lachrymal canal and between the two parts of the quadratus labii superioris (Fig. 63, f and q). The muscle splits into two parts which pass into the two eyelids. At the outer angle of the eye the two bands unite by the intervention of tendon-fibres between the muscle-fibre bundles of the two. Relations.—Outer surface with the integument. Inner sur- face with the inner membrane of the eyelid. Action.—Closes the eye. M. corrugator supercilii lateralis (Fig. 63, d; Fig. 64, £). —This consists of a number of scattered fibres which arise from among the fibres of the frontoscutularis, and from the tendon lying just craniad of the external opening of the ear, to which are united also parts of the zygomaticus (Fig. 64, @) and sub- mentalis (Fig. 64, c). The fibres pass craniad, converging so as to form a narrow band which is inserted at the caudolateral angle of the eye, where it unites with the orbicularis oculi (Fig. 64, s). This muscle is continuous on the medial side with the corrugator supercilii medialis (Fig. 64, 7) and the frontoauricularis, on the lateral side with the platysma. Relations.—-Outer surface with the integument. Inner sur- face with the frontal bone and the frontoscutularis. THE MUSCLES OF THE HEAD. 99 Action.—Pulls the angle of the eye caudad; at the same time pulls the external ear craniad. M. frontoauricularis.—A few of the fibres which are attached along the upper eyelid sometimes pass dorsocaudad, mingled with fibres of the corrugatores supercilii medialis and lateralis and the frontoscutularis, to the craniomedial angle of the auricular cartilage, where they unite with the fibres of the adductor auris superior. These fibres are sometimes distin- guished as the frontoauricularis muscle. M. levator auris longus (Fig. 63, g and g’). (Part of the auricularis posterior of man.)—This lies on the caudal half of the dorsal surface of the head, forming a laterocaudal continua- tion of the intermedius scutulorum (a). Origin from the middle line of the neck dorsad of the atlas, and from the sagittal crest for about one centimeter craniad of the external occipital tubercle. The fibres form a broad thin sheet which passes craniolaterad as far as the caudal end of the scutiform cartilage (1). Here the muscle divides; the major portion is attached to the scutiform cartilage (1), its fibres intermingling with those of the intermedius scutulorum (a). The caudal portion of the muscle (g’) passes onto the surface of the auricle, extending one or two centimeters distad; here it is inserted on an oblique line which lies directly craniad of the insertion of the transversus auricule (2). The caudal portion of this muscle (g’) having origin above the atlas and insertion on the auricle, is sometimes considered a separate muscle, the supercervicoauricular or cervicoauric- ular. The cranial portion (g) with origin on the sagittal crest and insertion on the scutiform cartilage might be distinguished as the occipitoscutularis. The levator auris longus is continuous at its cranial end medially with M. epicranius (/); laterally with M. intermedius scutulorum (a). Relations. —Outer surface with the integument. Inner surface with the temporal muscle (7), the auricularis superior (2), the abductor longus auris (#7), a narrow strand of the platysma, and the clavotrapezius. Action.—Pulls the external ear dorsocaudad. EOD THE MUSCLES. The four following muscles lie partly or entirely beneath those already described; they are doubtless formed as differen- tiations of the inner layers of the platysma. M. auricularis superior (or attollens auris) (Fig. 63, £).— This muscle forms a band about one centimeter broad lying just beneath the levator longus (¢). Origin on the sagittal crest for about one centimeter craniad of the interparietal bone. The muscle passes laterad onto the surface of the auricle and is inserted into the auricular cartilage a little caudad of the middle of its convex surface. At its lateral end the cranial margin is closely united to the under surface of the levator auris longus (g). Relations.—Outer surface at the medial end with the epi- cranius (/), the abductor auris longus (wz), and levator auris longus (g); at the lateral end with the skin. Inner surface with the temporal muscle (z) and the auricular cartilage. Action.—Pulls the external ear dorsad. M. abductor auris longus (Fig. 63, #; Fig. 64, g). (Part of the auricularis posterior of man.) Origin on the sagittal crest dorsad of the interparietal bone, caudad of that of the auricularis superior (4), which it partly covers. The muscle passes laterad as a flat band 8 to 10 millimeters wide over the caudal surface of the concha of the ear, and is inserted (Fig. 64, g) on the lateral surface of the eminentia conche, caudad of the antitragus. Relations. —Outer surface with the levator auris longus (¢) and the integument. Inner surface with the auricularis superior (2), the abductor auris brevis (/), and the concha. Action.—Pulls the external ear caudad. M. abductor auris brevis (Fig. 63, /). Origin by a tendon from the lambdoidal crest for one or two centimeters laterad of the middle. The muscle passes lateroventrad lying beneath the abductor longus (#) as a flat band 6 to 8 millimeters wide which is inserted into the medial surface of the most proximal portion of the concha, just distad of-its junction with the cartilaginous auditory meatus. THE MUSCLES OF THE HEAD. Iol Relations.—Outer surface with the abductor longus (7), a small strand of the platysma and the concha. Inner surface with the temporal muscle (7). Action.—Pulls the concha caudad. M. epicranius (or occipitofrontalis) (Fig. 63, % and %’). Origin on the sagittal crest or suture, just craniad of the origin of the levator longus auris, to the inner surface of which this muscle is closely united. From the origin the fibres pass craniad forming a band (/) about 8 or 10 millimeters in width, the two muscles lying close to one another and partly united in the middle line. About two centimeters craniad of their origin the fibres ot both muscles end in a tendinous sheet, the galea aponeurotica, which covers the surface of the skull in the region between the ears and eyes, and is formed by the inner surface of the intermedius scutulorum (a) and other muscles of this region. The galea aponeurotica passes craniad onto the surface of the nose, where it gives origin again to a thin sheet of muscle-fibres (Z’) which are inserted into the integument near the cranial ends of the nasal bones. M. epicranius is thus formed of two muscular portions (4 and #’), connected by a long tendinous sheet. The caudal portion is frequently distinguished as the occipital muscle. (M. occipitalis, %), the cranial portion, on the nose, as the frontal muscle (M. frontalis, 7’). | Relations. —Outer surface of the occipitalis (Z) with the intermedius scutulorum (a), the levator auris longus (g), and the integument; inner surface with the auricularis superior (/), the abductor auris longus, and the bone. Outer surface of the frontalis (Z’) with the integument; inner surface with the bones of the skull. Action.—Moves the integument of the dorsal surface of the head and of the nose. Ventrad of the external ear the following three differen- tiated portions of the platysma may be distinguished. M. zygomaticus (major) (Fig. 64, @).—A slender band connecting the angle of the mouth with the scutiform cartilage of the ear. At the angle of the mouth the fibres arise from among those 102 THE MUSCLES. of the orbicularis oris (¢), from both the upper and the lower lip. They pass thence dorsocaudad across the zygomatic arch as a band 8 or 10 millimeters wide which is attached to a Fic. 64.—SUPERFICIAL MUSCLES ON THE LATERAL SURFACE OF THE HEAD AND NECK, a, a’, a’, M. platysma; 4, M. depressor conch; c, M. submentalis; ¢, M. zygo- maticus (4, c, and @ lie beneath the platysma and are seen through it); e, M. zygo- maticus minor; /’, M. caninus; /, g, parts of M. quadratus labii superioris (/, angular head; g, M. levator labii superioris alzeque nasi); 4, M. myrtiformis; 7, M. orbicularis oris; 7, M. corrugator supercilii medialis; %, M. corrugator supercilii lateralis; 7, M. adductor auris superior; 7, M. helicis; 7, M. antitragicus; 0, M. adductor auris inferior; #. M. conchzeus externus; g, M. abductor auris longus; 7, parts of M. auricularis externus; s, M. orbicularis oculi. tendinous aponeurosis lying just craniad of the external opening of the ear. To this aponeurosis are attached also, wholly or partly, the corrugator supercilii lateralis (4) and the submenta- THE MUSCLES OF THE HEAD. 103 lis (c). The aponeurosis is united with the caudoventral angle of the scutiform cartilage and with the ventral edge of the cranial margin of the auricular cartilage. This muscle is united at its cranial end with the orbicularis oris (¢); throughout its length more or less with the platysma (a, a’); at its caudodorsal end with the corrugator supercilii lateralis (£) on its medial side, and with the submentalis (c) on its lateral side. Relations. —Outer surface with the integument and the platysma (a@’). Inner surface with the masseter, temporal, frontoscutularis, and adductor auris inferior (0). Action.—Draws the angle of the mouth dorsocaudad; the external ear ventrocraniad. M. submentalis (Fig. 64, c).—A flat band, similar to the last, and closely connected for some distance to its caudal border. It arises as scattered fibres near the ventral middle line at about the level of the larynx, the fibres of the opposite muscles crossing the middle line and intermingling. The fibres pass dorsad, converging so as to form a narrower band, which unites dorsad with the zygomaticus (d), to be inserted with it into the tendinous aponeurosis above described. Relations.—Outer surface with the integument and pla- tysma (a’). Inner surface with the muscles of the hyoid, the digastricus, the parotid gland, the masseter, the zygomatic arch and the temporal muscle. Action.—Draws the external ear ventrad. M. depressor conche (Fig. 64, 4).—A thin band of fibres, caudad of the last and parallel with it. The muscle arises as scattered fibres on the ventral surface of the neck, one or two centimeters craniad of the manubrium, the fibres of the muscles of opposite sides crossing the middle line and inter- digitating. They pass dorsad, gathering together to form a narrow band which is inserted into the summit of the antitragus. Relations.—Outer surface with the skin at the ventral end, and with the platysma (a’) further dorsad. Inner surface with the deep muscles of the neck and with the parotid gland. Action.—Draws the external ear ventrad. 104 THE MUSCLES. Lying deeper than the muscles thus far described, but closely connected with a number of them, are the following: M. frontoscutularis. Origin (Fig. 63, 0) on the frontal bone, along the supra- orbital margin, from the craniomedial angle of the eye caudad to the zygomatic process of the frontal. The fibres form a large muscle which passes dorsocaudad ‘to the scutiform cartilage and is mostly attached along its ventrolateral border. Some of the outer fibres, however, pass distad of the scutiform cartilage toward the cartilage of the ear, thus joining the adductor auris superior (/). The outer surface of this muscle is closely connected with fibres of the intermedius scutulorum (a), the corrugatores supercilii medialis (6) and lateralis (@), and the frontoauricu- laris, when this exists. The outer surface is covered near the origin by the orbicularis oculi (c), farther dorsad by the muscles just mentioned and the integument. The inner surface is in relation with thes frontal bone and the adductor auris inferior (Fig. 64, 0). Action.—Pulls the ear craniad. M. adductor auris inferior. (Fig. 64, 0.) (Part of the auricularis anterior of man.)—A small muscle lying beneath the frontoscutularis. Origin on the ligament which connects the zygomatic process of the frontal with the frontal process of the malar. The fibres form a thin band about 7 millimeters wide which passes craniad, closely united to the inner surface of the fronto- scutularis. At the caudal edge of the zygomaticus (d) the muscle is interrupted by a short tendinous interval; the fibres then continue to their insertion on the tip of the antitragus. Relations.—Outer surface with the frontoscutularis, the zygomaticus (@), and the integument. Inner surface with the temporal muscle and M. antitragicus (7). Action.—Pulls the ear craniodorsad. The remainder of the muscles of the ear, which, with the exception of the tragicus lateralis, merely interconnect the cartilages of the external ear or parts of these cartilages, are Pe THE MUSCLES OF THE HEAD. 105 described in connection with the account of the Auditory Organ. Owing to the presence of the fibrous pad to which the whiskers are attached, the facial muscles between the eye and the mouth differ in the cat in some respects from those of related animals. This fibrous pad interrupts the muscles, fre- quently breaking muscles which are elsewhere single into two. M. zygomaticus minor, or malaris (Fig. 64, ¢).—This muscle is not always present; when it exists it forms a very thin flat band of fibres passing from the ventral side of the eye toward the angle of the mouth. Origin among the fibres of the orbicularis oculi (s) in the lower eyelid. The fibres pass ventrad; the insertion varies. In some specimens the insertion is among the fibres of the orbicularis oris (2), at the angle of the mouth, beneath the zygomaticus (@). In other cases this muscle is said to be inserted into the pad on which the whiskers rest. Relations.—Outer surface with the integument and near its insertion with the zygomaticus major (@7). Inner surface with the malar bone and the masseter muscle. Action.—Pulls the angle of the mouth (or the whiskers) dorsad. M. orbicularis oris (Fig. 64, 7).—This forms a very thin layer of subcutaneous concentric fibres which surround the mouth, that of the upper lip being thicker than that of the lower lip. The part of the muscle. in the lower lip has its fibres intermingled with those of the platysma (a’). In the median line the fibres of the upper lip are interrupted by a raphe, and caudad of this are intermingled with those of the caninus. M. quadratus labii superioris (Fig. 63, p and g; Fig. 64, fand g).—This is a complex of muscle-fibres attached chiefly to the fibrous pad on which the whiskers rest. In it two parts can be distinguished more or less completely. (1) M. levator labii superioris aleque nasi (Fig. 63, p; Fig. 64, g) on the sides of the nose. This arises (a) as a con- tinuation of the frontal portion of the epicranius, and (4) in a 106 THE MUSCLES. small bundle (Fig. 63, f)) from near the dorsal end of the frontal process of the maxillary bone, in common with the next. The two slips thus formed unite craniad and are inserted partly into the integument on the outer side of the wing of the nose, partly into the skin of the upper lip, lateroventrad of the nose, and partly into the pad on which the whiskers are located, in connection with the next. (2) The angular head (caput angulare), or levator labii Superioris proprius (Fig. 63, g; Fig. 64, /) is much larger than the last. It takes origin from a small tubercle at the cranial border of the orbit, close to the origin of the orbicularis oculi. The fibres diverge from their origin to their insertion among the whiskers and in the fibrous pad on which the whiskers rest. Action.—Erects the whiskers and raises the upper lip. M. caninus or levator anguli oris (Fig. 64, /’). Origin in a depression on the lateral surface of the maxil- lary bone, just craniad of the last premolar tooth. The fibres pass craniad, diverging, toward the whiskers, and have their insertion into the pad of tissue on which the whiskers rest. Action.—Retracts the whiskers and raises the upper lip. M. buccinator.—A thin muscle against the mucous mem- brane of the upper lip, partly united with the orbicularis oris and lying beneath M. caninus. Origin on the outer surface of the superior maxillary bone in the depression between the infraorbital foramen and the first premolar tooth. The fibres pass ventrad, diverging, and mingle with those of the deep part of the orbicularis oris. Relations.—Outer surface with the caninus and with the orbicularis oris. Inner surface with the mucous membrane of the upper lip. ; Action.—Raises the upper lip. M. myrtiformis (probably corresponds to a part of the human M. nasalis) (Fig. 64, £).—A thin sheet of muscle-fibres lying craniad of the levator labii superioris aleque nasi and passing from the whiskers to the nose and upper lip. It is dis- tinguishable from the alzque nasi by the direction of the fibres. THE MUSCLES OF THE HEAD. 107 Origin from the pad upon which the whiskers rest. The fibres diverge and have their Insertion upon the wing of the nose and into the skin of the upper lip near the median line. Action. —Dilator of the nares and elevator of the upper lip. M. ‘‘moustachier’’ (Str.-D.) (probably corresponds to one of the Mm. incisivi).—It lies on the upper lip near the median line. Origin from the outer surface of the premaxilla near the suture along the ventral border of the narial opening. The fibres diverge and pass caudad into the upper lip within the superficial fibres of the orbicularis oris. Insertion.—The skin of the upper lip just craniad of the whiskers. Some of the fibres pass into the pad on which the whiskers rest. Action.—It carries the lip craniad. M. quadratus labii inferioris.—A thin flat band extending almost the length of the lower lip. Origin from the alveolar border of the mandible, between the molar tooth and the canine. The fibres pass dorsad into the lower lip, where they intermingle with those of the orbi- cularis oris.. The muscle is perhaps not constant. Action.—Depressor of the lower lip. Sometimes a few fibres arising from the cranial portion of the alveolar border of the mandibula pass mediad, seeming to join corresponding fibres from the opposite side. Such fibres would constitute a M. transversus menti. B. DEEP MUSCLES OF THE HEAD, (a) Muscles of Mastication. M. digastricus (Fig. 65, 6).—The digastric is a thick pris- matic muscle lying mediad of the angle of the lower jaw, con- necting it with the base of the skull. Origin by fleshy fibres from the outer surface of the jugular process of the occipital bone, and by a thin tendon from the tip of the mastoid process and from the ridge between the mastoid and the jugular processes. The muscle passes craniad, becoming at the same time broader and more voluminous. 108 THE MUSCLES. Insertion.—The ventral border of the mandible craniad of the caudal border of the molar tooth. The insertion area extends slightly onto both surfaces of the bone and is triangular, with its apex craniad. Relations.—Outer (ventral) surface with the following, beginning at the caudal end: the rectus capitis lateralis, the cleidomastoid (/), the submaxillary gland (2), the stylohyoid (7), a large lymph-gland (3), and the integument. Inner (dorsal) surface with the jugulohyoid, the tympanic bulla, the masseter (a), the hyoglossus, and the mylohyoid (c). Action.—Depressor of the lower jaw. M. masseter (Figs. 65 and 66, a).—The masseter forms the projecting mass so prominent in the cat behind and below the eye. Its outer surface is covered by a strong aponeurosis. The muscle is divided into three layers which are distinct .as to origin, insertion, and direction of fibres, but which are otherwise not distinct. The superficial layer takes Origin by the superficial aponeurosis from the Hae which runs lengthwise of the outer surface of the malar bone, and by fleshy fibres from the surface of the malar bone ventrad of this ridge. The fibres pass obliquely caudad to their insertion. Insertion.—The caudal half of the lateral margin of the ventral border of the mandible, by a sheet of fascia which lies on the inner surface of the muscle. The superficial fibres curve ventrad of the mandible and are inserted into a tendinous inter- section between this muscle and the internal pterygoid (Fig. 66, c). The middle layer takes Origin from the ventral border of the malar bone, from opposite the molar tooth to within three millimeters of the mandibular fossa. The fibres pass ventrad and have their Insertion into the mandible at the ventral border of the external coronoid fossa by means of the aponeurosis which covers the inner surface of the muscle. The deep layer takes Origin by a strong tendon from the ventral border of the zygoma just craniad of the mandibular fossa. The fibres pass cranioventrad, diverge and have their tl THE MUSCLES OF THE HEAD. 109 Fic. 65.—MUSCLES ON THE VENTRAL SURFACE OF THE THORAX, NECK AND | HEAD. The left side shows the first layer of muscles beneath the skin and skin-muscles; the right side shows the second layer, except in the head region. a, M, masseter; 4, M. digastricus; c, M. mylohyoideus; @, M. stylohyoideus; e, M. sternohyoideus; J, M. thyreohyoideus; g, M. sternomastoideus; g’, M. sternothyreoideus; 4, M. cleidomastoideus; 7, M. levator scapulze ventralis; 7, M. clavotrapezius; 4, M. clavo- brachialis; 7, M. pectoralis major; m, M. pectoantibrachialis; , part of M, scalenus; o,°M_ pectoralis minor; 4, M, xiphihumeralis; g, M. iatissimus dorsi; 7, M. epi- trochlearis; s, caput longum of M. triceps brachii; ¢, M. biceps brachii; ¢’, bicipital arch; #, M. acromiodeltoideus; v, M. brachialis. 1, parotid gland; 2, submaxillary gland; 3, lymphatic glands; 4, external ear; 5, external jugular vein; 6, manubrium; 7, first rib; 8, common carotid artery; 9, molar gland. ™ T10 THE MUSCLES. /nsertion into the external coronoid fossa. Relations.—Outer surface with the following, beginning at the caudal border: the external ear, the parotid gland (Fig. 65, 1), the platysma, the submentalis, the zygomaticus (major), the zygomaticus minor. Ventral border with a lymph gland caudad of the angle of the mouth (Fig. 65, 3), and the digastric muscle (4). Inner surface with the bones. Action.—A very powerful elevator of the lower jaw. M. temporalis (Fig. 63, ~).—The temporal muscle is the great mass taking origin from the temporal fossa and having its insertion on both surfaces and both borders of the coronoid process of the mandible. It may be divided into two layers, deep and superficial. The superficial layer. The temporal fascia stretches over the temporal fossa, being attached to its borders; that is, to the sagittal and lambdoidal crests, to the curved ridge which con- nects the sagittal crest with the zygomatic process of the frontal bone, to the caudal border of this process, to the caudal border of the malar bone, to the caudal border of the ligament con- necting the malar bone and the zygomatic process of the frontal, and to the dorsal border of the zygomatic process of the temporal bone and its dorsal root. The craniolateral part of this fascia is much stronger than the remainder. The muscle-fibres take origin from the strong craniolateral part of the inner surface of the temporal fascia, from the groove on the temporal bone dorsad of the dorsal root of its zygomatic process, from the whole inner surface of this process and of the zygomatic process of the malar bone, and sometimes also from that part of the frontal bone which lies within the temporal fossa. Insertion.—The outer surface of the coronoid process of the mandible dorsad of the coronoid fossa, and both borders of the coronoid process. The cranial fibres may be inserted craniad of the coronoid process onto the aponeurosis covering the deep portion of the muscle. The caudal part of this portion is more or less distinct and is sometimes described as a separate head. The deep portion. Origin by fleshy fibres from the whole surface of the tem- THE MUSCLES OF THE HEAD. IIL poral fossa, except in cases where the cranial part of the fossa is occupied by the superficial portion. The fibres converge toward the coronoid process, and the ventral third of the outer surface is covered by strong fascia. Insertion.—The whole inner surface of the coronoid process of the mandible. Relations.—Outer surface with the external ear, the ear- muscles (Fig. 63), the epicranius (Fig. 63, Z), the corrugatores supercilii lateralis (7) and medialis (4). Inner surface with the skull, the pterygoideus externus (Fig. 66, 4), and the struc- tures within the orbit. : Action.—Elevator of the lower jaw. M. pterygoideus externus (Fig. 66, 4).—This lies on the medial side of the mandible, ventrad of the ventral portion of the temporal. Origin.—The external pterygoid fossa (Fig. 40, 2), which lies on the lateral surface of the perpendicular plate of the pala- tine bone, and on the surface of the pterygoid process of the sphenoid bone dorsad of the internal pterygoid fossa. The fossa extends from the foramen rotundum to the sphenopala- tine foramen. The muscle passes with parallel fibres laterad, ventrad, and caudad and has its Insertion by a strong flat tendon into the medial surface of the mandible near its ventral border between the opening of the mandibular canal and the base of the angular process. Relations. —Ventral surface with the masseter (a), the digastric, and the soft palate with its muscles. Dorsal surface with the temporal, and near its origin with the muscles of the eye, and other structures in the orbit. Action.—Elevator of the lower jaw. M. pterygoideus internus (Fig. 66, c).—This lies caudad of the pterygoideus externus, nearly parallel to it, and is con- nected with it at its lateral end. _ Origin from the whole surface of the internal pterygoid fossa (Fig. 40, 5). Insertion by fleshy fibres into the ventral surface of the external pterygoid and its tendon, into the medial surface of the angular process of the mandible and caudad of the angular 112 THE MUSCLES. process for about one centimeter into a fascia common to it and the masseter muscle, and into the stylomandibular ligament. Relations. —Ventral surface with the styloglossus and the Fic. 66.—OBLIQUELY VENTRAL VIEW OF THE DEEP MUSCLES OF THE LOWER JAW AND PALATE. The tongue and other structures forming the floor of the mouth have been re- moved, showing the roof of the mouth. On the right side the masseter and ptery- goideus internus have been removed. a, a’, M. masseter; 4, M, pterygoideus ex- ternus; c, M. pterygoideus internus; ¢@, @’, M. tensor veli palatini; ¢, e’, M. levator veli palatini; 7, M. constrictor pharyngis superior. 1, aponeurosis of the velum palatinum; 2, ridges formed by the palatines and pterygoid portions of the sphenoid; 2 hamular processes; 4, free caudal border of the velum palatinum; 5, bulla tym- pani. soft palate. Dorsal surface with the bulla tympani (5) and base of the skull. Cranial surface with the pterygoideus externus (0), with which it is partly united. Action.—Assists the pterygoideus externus. (6) Muscles of the Hyoid Bone. M. stylohyoideus (Fig. 65, @).—The’ stylohyoid is a ribbon-like muscle about three millimeters wide. It lies on Se eee ee THE MUSCLES OF THE HEAD. 113 the superficial surface of the digastric, caudad and ventrad of the angle of the jaw. Origin by fleshy fibres from the outer surface of the stylohyal bone near its middle. The muscle curves over the outer sur- face of the digastric (4), and ends about one centimeter from the middle line in a slender flat tendon. Insertion into the middle of the ventral surface of the body of the hyoid bone. Some of the fibres of the mylohyoid (c) are inserted into its tendon. Relations. —Outer surface with the submaxillary gland (2) and the submentalis muscle. Inner surface with the digastric (4), the hyoglossus (Fig. 67, %), and the geniohyoid (Fig. 67, g). Action.—Raises the hyoid. M. geniohyoideus (Fig. 67, ¢).—The geniohyoid is a long slender muscle which lies next to the median line between the symphysis menti and the hyoid bone, closely applied to its fellow of the opposite side and within (dorsad of ) the mylohyoid (Fig. 65, ¢). Origin from the ventral half of the inner surface of the mandibula for about one millimeter from the symphysis. Insertion by muscle-fibres into the lateral half of the ventral surface of the body of the hyoid bone. Relations.—Outer (ventral) surface with the stylohyoid (Fig. 65, @) and the mylohyoid (Fig. 65, c); medial border with the muscle of the opposite side. Lateral border with the hyoglossus (Fig. 67, #) and genioglossus (Fig. 67, f). Inner (dorsal) surface with the genioglossus. Action.—Draws the hyoid forward. M. jugulohyoideus (Fig. 67, 4).—The jugulohyoid is a small flat quadrangular muscle covering the outer part of the ventral surface of the tympanic bulla. Origin from the ventral border of the jugular process. Insertion into the caudal side of the cartilaginous part of the stylohyoid opposite the origin of the styloglossus. Relations.—Ventral surface with the digastric. Dorsal sur- face with the tympanic bulla (3). Action.—Draws the hyoid backward and thus gives a firmer surface of origin for the styloglossus. II4 THE MUSCLES. M. mylohyoideus (Fig. 65, c).—The mylohyoid is a large thin muscle seen after the reflection of the digastric, filling with its fellow of the opposite side the whole angle between the rami of the lower jaw. _ Its fibres are transverse. Origin from the middle of the medial surface of the body ] Rez STA Fic. 67.—MuscLes or Toncur, Hyorp BoNE, AND PHARYNX. a, M. tragicus lateralis;.4, M. jugulohyoideus; c, M. pterygoideus externus; d, partially cut surface of M. pterygoideus internus; e, M. styloglossus; 7, M. genio- glossus; g, M. geniohyoideus; 4, M. hyoglossus; 7, M. glossopharyngeus; 7, M. constrictor pharyngis medius; 4, M. constrictor pharyngis inferior; 4 M. stylo- pharyngeus; , M. sternohyoideus (cut); 2, M. cricothyreoideus; 0, M. sterno- thyreoideus (cut); 4, M. thyreohyoideus. 1, mandible; 1’, angular process of mandible; 2, stylomandibular ligament; 3, bulla tympani; 4, trachea; 5, cesophagus; 6, thyroid gland; 7, isthmus of the thyroid gland. of the mandible between the caudal opening of the mandibular canal and the symphysis of the jaw. Insertion with the opposite muscle into a median raphe which extends from the symphysis of the jaw to the hyoid bone and is closely united to the external surface of the geniohyoid. | Some of the fibres gain insertion into the body of the hyoid et MUSCLES OF THE BODY. 115 bone through their insertion into the tendon of the stylo- hyoid (@). Relations.—Outer surface with the submentalis (Fig. 64, c) and the digastric (Fig. 65, 6). Lateral edge with the masseter (a), the digastric (4), and the mandibula. - Caudal border with the stylohyoid (2). Inner (dorsal) surface with the geniohyoid (Fig. 67, g), the hyoglossus (Fig. 67, 2), and the genioglossus (Fig. 67, /). Action.—Raises the floor of the mouth and thus brings the hyoid forward. M. ceratohyoideus. Origin, the two proximal pieces of the cranial horn of the hyoid. The fibres pass caudad parallel to one another and within the middle constrictor of the pharynx. Insertion into the whole length of the caudal cornu of the hyoid bone. Relations.—Outer surface with the middle constrictor of the pharynx. Inner surface with the pharynx. Action.—Draws craniad the body of the hyoid by bringing its cornua together and bending the joint between the two pieces of the cranial cornua. The muscles connecting the hyoid and the tongue are described in connection with the description of the tongue. III. MUSCLES OF THE BODY. . 1. Muscles of the Back. A. MUSCLES OF THE SHOULDER (connecting the forelimb with the back) (Fig. 68). M. trapezius.—The trapezius muscle is divided in the cat into three portions, the spinotrapezius, the acromiotrapezius, and the clavotrapezius. M. spinotrapezius, or trapezius inferior (Fig. 68, 7).—The spinotrapezius (caudal part of the human trapezius) is a flat triangular muscle. Origin from the tips of the spinous processes of all or nearly all the thoracic vertebre and from the intervening supraspinous ligament. The origin may extend from a point anywhere between the first and fourth spines to any point between the eleventh and thirteenth. 116 THE MUSCLES. Insertion along an S-shaped line (Fig. 76, &-/) which crosses the tuberosity of the scapular spine and forms an angle with the spine of about forty-five degrees. The line extends on one side onto the fascia covering the supraspinatus muscle, and on the other side onto the fascia covering the infraspinatus, but does not reach the borders of the scapula. The cranial two-thirds of the insertion is by a flat tendon which is broader craniad. Relations. —Outer surface with the: cutaneus maximus, and craniad with the acromiotrapezius (Z). Inner surface with the latissimus dorsi (#) caudad and with the rhomboideus, supra- spinatus, and infraspinatus craniad. Caudal border free; cranial border in contact with the acromiotrapezius (/). Action.—Draws the scapula dorsocaudad. M. acromiotrapezius, or trapezius superior (Fig. 68, %).— The acromiotrapezius (middle part of the human trapezius) is a flat four-sided muscle just craniad of the spinotrapezius, from the median dorsal line to the scapular spine. Origin along the median dorsal line from the spinous process of the axis to a point anywhere between the spinous processes of the first and fourth thoracic vertebre. Its caudal two-thirds is from a flat tendon which is directly continuous with the muscle of the opposite side and thus bridges the depression between the vertebral borders of the scapule. This tendon narrows craniad, and its cranial fourth is attached by a fascia to the spinous processes of the cervical vertebree. At the cranial border of the muscle the fibres sometimes reach the middle line. The fibres of the muscle run nearly transversely. Insertion (Fig. 76, #).—Into the outer surface of the meta- cromion, the glenoid border of the scapular spine from the metacromion to the tuberosity, and along a line continued for about one centimeter from the tuberosity onto the surface of the spinotrapezius (7) at the junction of its muscular and tendi- nous portions. ie Relations.—Outer surface with the cutaneus maximus, the integument and platysma. Inner surface with a mass of fat partially covering the rhomboideus; with the occipitoscapularis, spinotrapezius, supraspinatus, levator scapula, and _ splenius. *purs Areypixeurqns ‘z {puvs pyored ‘1 eye] viosvy fz ‘rakvy peroysodns ‘erosvy [esropoqumy ‘f ‘snSuoy wpnvo soxsy “J ‘xv ‘snusa}xo. apne sojoNpqe "py ‘a2 {stpera}e] apneo 10sua}xa ‘W ‘2 ‘snsourpuaymes “ ‘z ‘stiowey sdaoiq *w ‘7 ‘sterouayopnes “py ‘s fayeT aetosey 10sud} ‘W ‘4 ‘sniioyies "yy ‘4 !snuiaj}xo sturumopqe snnbyqo "jw ‘7 ‘tour siperoyoad “yy fo ‘stperaummyrydix “py ‘vz ‘tisiop snumssyey “py ‘ww ‘iyousq sdaowy ‘WW JO opesoye, yndvo 7 ‘nyowiq - sdooiy “J Jo wnsuocy yndvo ty ‘snizodenourds ‘pw ‘/ ‘snoproyapourds “yw ‘e¢ ‘snizadeyommoir “yw ‘y ‘snaplojyfaporumoise “py iF ‘sipesyuoa xyndvos s0jvaa] We ‘f ‘sterpovaqoayyo ‘py ‘a ‘snizodenoavjo ‘jw Y ‘snoployseuousays “yy “7 ‘S1ajassem “py ‘g ‘suernynosoyuoys “yy ‘v7 ‘SHTIOSAW-NIMS GNV NIMS AHL HLVANAd ‘saTOSAW-AGOg ao MAAVT LSUY—'S9 “Oly 117 MUSCLES OF THE BODY. 118 THE MUSCLES. Near its origin its caudal border touches the outer surface of the spinotrapezius (7). Its cranial border is overlaid near its insertion by the levator scapulz ventralis (/) and is closely related to the caudal border of the clavotrapezius (@) near its origin. Action.—The two muscles hold the scapulz together. M. clavotrapezius (Fig. 68, d).—The clavotrapezius (cranial part of the human trapezius) is a flat muscle passing from the lambdoidal crest and middorsal line to the clavicle and covering the side of the neck. Origin.—The medial half of the lambdoidal crest and the middorsal line between the crest and the caudal end of the spine of the axis. The fibres are parallel and pass caudoven- trad so that the muscle covers the ventral surface of the neck caudally and fills the concavity at the front of the shoulder. Insertion into the clavicle and into a raphe between the clavotrapezius and the clavobrachial (¢) muscles. This raphe extends along the clavicle and for some distance laterad of it. The muscle is partly continuous with the clavobrachial (e). Relations.—Outer surface with the platysma, and at its craniomedial angle with the levator auris longus. Inner sur- face with the rhomboideus, splenius, occipitoscapularis, levator scapulz, cleidomastoid, and supraspinatus. The cranial edge touches the sternomastoid. The caudal border touches the acromiotrapezius near the origin. Action.—Draws the scapula craniodorsad. _ This muscle and the clavobrachial (e¢) are sometimes con- sidered as forming a single muscle, the cephalohumeral, or cephalobrachial. M. occipitoscapularis (or levator scapule dorsalis or rhomboideus capitis) (Fig. 73, @).—The occipitoscapularis (equivalent to a part of the human rhomboideus) is a slender flat muscle from the lambdoidal ridge to the coracovertebral angle of the scapula. Origin, the medial half of the lambdoidal ridge beneath the clavotrapezius (Fig. 68, d). The origin does not extend quite to the middle line. The muscle passes almost directly caudad. Its caudal end is thicker and narrower than the cranial end and MUSCLES OF THE BODY. 119 is wedged between the rhomboideus dorsally and the levator scapule ventrally. Insertion either into the inner surface of the levator scapulz near its dorsocranial border at its insertion or into the scapula near the coracovertebral angle (Fig. 78, /) or into both. Its fibres are very closely related to those of the rhomboideus. Relations. —By its outer surface with the clavotrapezius (Fig. 68, @) and acromiotrapezius (/). At its insertion it is often overlaid by either the rhomboideus or the levator scapule or both. By its inner surface with the splenius (Fig. 73, b). Its caudal third is wedged between the rhomboideus and the levator scapule. Action.— Draws forward and rotates the scapula. M. rhomboideus (probably equivalent to the human rhom- boideus major and rhomboideus minor).—A rather thick trape- zoid muscle connecting the vertebral border of the scapula with the spinous processes of the adjacent vertebre. Origin from the caudal two or three fifths of the cervical supraspinous ligament and from the sides and tips of the first four -thoracic vertebral spines and the interspinous ligaments caudad of these four spines. It passes lateroventrad, and the fibres converge somewhat so that the line of insertion is shorter than the line of origin. Insertion by a short tendon (1 millimeter long) into the vertebral border of the scapula, the line of insertion passing gradually from the inner (Fig. 78, ¢) to the outer (Fig. 76, z) surface; and by fleshy fibres into the outer surface of the gleno- vertebral angle of the scapula (Fig. 76, z) in close connection with the origin of the teres major (7). A bundle of fibres at the cranial border may be inserted into the cranial border of the levator scapulze at its insertion. Relations.—By its outer surface with the spinotrapezius (Fig. 68, 7), acromiotrapezius (/), latissimus dorsi (#), and clavotrapezius (d@); it is usually partially separated from these muscles by a mass of fat. By its inner surface near its insertion with the serratus anterior (Fig. 73, 2) and levator scapule (Fig. 73, 4), and craniad with the splenius (Fig. 73, 4), and the tendon of the serratus posterior superior (Fig. 73, 7). At 120 THE MUSCLES. its lateral end it touches the occipitoscapularis (Fig. 73, a), serratus anterior (2), levator scapule (/), supraspinatus (Fig. 75, a), and infraspinatus (Fig. 75, c), and the teres major (Fig. 75, @). Action.—Draws the scapula toward the vertebral column. M. cleidomastoideus (clavicular portion of the human sterno- cleidomastoid) (Fig. 65, %).—A narrow flat muscle between the mastoid process and the clavicle. Origin from the apex and caudal margin of the mastoid process of the temporal bone, by tendon and muscle-fibres. The muscle passes caudad, becoming broader and thinner. Insertion into the lateral four-fifths of the clavicle within the insertion of the clavotrapezius, and into the raphe which continues laterad of the clavicle. Relations.—Outer or lateral surface at the caudal end with: the clavotrapezius (Fig. 65, 7); further craniad with the depressor conche (Fig. 64, 4), the platysma, and the sterno- mastoid (Fig. 65, ¢). Inner or medial surface with the supra- spinatus (Fig. 75, @) caudad, with the mass of fat in the axilla at its middle, with the levator clavicule ventralis (Fig. 65, 7} and obliquus capitis superior (Fig. 71, ¢) craniad. Action.—Pulls the clavicle craniad when the head is fixed. Turns the head and depresses the snout when the clavicle is fixed. M. levator scapule ventralis, or levator clavicule (Fig. 68, 7; Fig. 65, 2; Fig. 72, ¢, c’, c’’) (not usually found in man). Origin (Fig. 72, c’, c’’) in two parts. (1) By fleshy fibres from the ventral surface of the atlantal transversé process near its caudal border (c’). (2) By a small tendon from the ventral surface of the basioccipital opposite the middle of the length of the bulla tympani (c’’) in common with the longus capitis (a). The two heads unite to form a flat band which passes caudo- ventrad and is inserted (Fig. 76, /) by a flat short tendon, about eight millimeters broad, into the outer surface of the metacromion along its ventral border, and into the infraspinatus fossa for one or two millimeters distad of that border. Relations.—Near the insertion the dorsal border overlaps the border of the acromiotrapezius (Fig. 68, 2), and the ventral MUSCLES OF THE BODY. 121 border is attached by strong fascia to the border of the clavo- trapezius (Fig. 68, 2). The outer surface is in relation with the longissimus capitis (Fig. 73, g), Clavotrapezius (Fig. 68, @), cleidomastoid (Fig. 73, @), platysma, and the skin. The inner surface is in relation caudad with the supraspinatus and with a mass of fat and a lymphatic gland which occupy the hollow of the shoulder. Craniad it is in relation with the cleidomastoid (Fig. 73, @), the scalenus (Fig. 73, /), the - longus capitis (Fig. 73, ¢), and the obliquus superior (Fig. Ti, ©). Action. —Pulls the scapula craniad. M. latissimus dorsi (Fig. 68, m; Fig. 65, g; Fig. 77, e). —A large triangular sheet covering rather more than the dorso- cranial half of the abdomen and thorax. It arises from the middorsal line, from the pelvis to the fifth thoracic spine, and is inserted into the humerus. Origin from the tips of the neural spines of the vertebrae from the fourth or fifth thoracic to about the sixth lumbar. As far as the tenth or eleventh thoracic vertebra the origin is directly by muscle-fibres. Caudad of this is a broad triangular tendon which may be so closely united to the tendons of the underlying muscles that it cannot be separated. The muscle passes cranioventrad, the fibres converging to the axilla. In ‘the axilla a part of the cutaneus maximus and the epitrochle- aris (Fig. 65, 7) take origin from the outer surface. Insertion.—The muscle then ends in a flat tendon, to the cranial surface of which the fibres of the teres major (Fig. 77, c) are attached. Five to ten millimeters from the humerus the muscle-fibres of the teres give place to the tendon-fibres, and the conjoined tendon of the teres and latissimus which is thus formed (Fig. 79, d’) is inserted into a rough elongated area (Fig. 82, f) which lies parallel with the pectoral ridge on the medial surface of the shaft of the humerus (Fig. 48, g). The teres tendon forms the proximal part of the conjoined tendon. A part of the tendon of the latissimus may join the pectoralis minor at its distal or caudal border (Fig. 65), and thus it may contribute to the formation of both pillars of the bicipital arch (Fig. 65, 2’). 122 THE MUSCLES. Relations.—Its outer surface is covered caudad by the cutaneus maximus, and craniad by the spinotrapezius (Fig. 68, 7) and the long head of the triceps (Fig. 68, #). The cranial border comes into relation with the spinotrapezius (7) and teres major (Fig. 77, ¢c). The caudal border is in contact at the ventral end with the xiphihumeralis (Fig. 65, #) and pectoralis minor (Fig. 65, 0). The inner surface of the latissi- mus covers near its cranioventral end parts of the xiphihumer- alis (Fig. 68, ), pectoralis minor (Fig. 68, 0), teres major (Fig. 77, c), and serratus anterior (Fig. 73, 2). The caudal border covers a portion of the obliquus externus abdominis (Fig. 68, #); the dorsal and middle portions cover parts of the longissimus dorsi (Fig. 69, 7”), the spinalis dorsi (Fig. 69, g), the serratus posterior superior (Fig. 73, /), and serratus pos- terior inferior (Fig. 73, 7). Action.——Pulls the arm caudodorsad. M. serratus anterior and levator scapule (Fig. 73, 7and /) in the cat are continuous at both origin and insertion, and it is barely possible to separate their contiguous borders without cutting the fibres. The muscle extends from the transverse processes of the last five cervical vertebree and from the first nine or ten ribs to the medial surface of the scapula near its vertebral margin (Fig. 78, c and @). M. serratus anterior (or serratus magnus) (Fig. 7a, #): Origin.—From the first nine or ten ribs in as many sub- divisions. The first subdivision arises from the whole or nearly the whole of the caudal border of the first rib. The next four or five arise either from the ribs or from the costal cartilages near or at their junction with the ribs. The last four subdivi- sions arise from the ribs at increasing distances from the carti- lages. The fibres converge and the subdivisions join one another. Insertion (Fig. 78, c) into a narrow area on the medial sur- face of the scapula near the vertebral border. The glenoid half of the insertion is by a short tendon, the remainder by muscle-fibres. Relations.—Outer (lateral) surface with the latissimus dorsi (Fig. 68, m), teres major (Fig. 77, ¢). subscapularis (Fig. MUSCLES OF THE BODY. 123 77, a), and near the origin with the rectus abdominis (Fig. 73, &), the scalenus (Fig. 73, f/’’’), and the obliquus externus (Fig. 68, #). Inner (medial) surface with the serratus posterior superior (Fig. 73,°/) and its tendon, and with the intercostales externi (Fig. 73, m). Atits insertion the muscle touches the rhomboideus. The cranial edge is united to the caudal edge © of the levator scapule (Fig. 73, 7). Action.—Depressor of the scapula. M. levator scapule (Fig. 73, 2). Origin.—From the dorsal tubercles of the transverse pro- cesses of the last five cervical vertebree and from the ligaments between the tubercles. A slip sometimes arises from the atlas. Lnsertion (Fig. 78, @) into a triangular area on the medial surface of the scapula near its vertebral border. It is continu- ous with the insertion of the serratus anterior. Relations.—Outer (lateral) surface with a mass of fat sep- arating it from the clavotrapezius (Fig. 68, @) and cleidomas- toid (Fig. 65, 2), and with the subscapularis (Fig. 77, a). Inner (medial) surface with the splenius (Fig. 73, 4), the tendon of the serratus posterior superior (Fig. 73, 7), and the cervical portion of the longissimus dorsi (Fig. 69, /’’). Near the inser- tion the muscle touches the occipitoscapularis (Fig. 73, a) and rhomboideus. Caudal border united with the serratus anterior (Fig: 73, 2). Action. —Draws the scapula cranioventrad. B. MUSCLES OF THE BACK (interconnecting parts of the vertebral column) (Fig. 69).—The muscles connected with the vertebral column form a mass which is less markedly differen- tiated into distinct muscles than is the case in the limbs. A great longitudinal mass of fibres begins in the sacral region and extends along the vertebral column to the head. This mass contains fibres running in various directions and attached at one or both ends to the sacrum, the innominate bones, the spinous, transverse, and articular processes, and to the arches, of the ver- tebra ; to the ribs and to the head, and having in general the function of moving the vertebra in various ways, or of moving parts connected with the vertebrae. In some regions, especially the cervical, it is possible to distinguish clearly distinct muscles 124 THE MUSCLES. which have been differentiated from this mass. In the greater part of its extent, however, it is possible to distinguish only more or less closely interconnected bundles,—the more clearly marked of which have received special names. The great dorsal mass running along each side of the ‘vertebral column, occupying the space between the spinous processes and the transverse processes, receives the general name of M, extensor dorsi communis; the separate muscles are to be considered as parts or differentiations of this. The largest part of the mass is in the lumbar region (first portion of the longissimus dorsi, Fig. 69, 7). At the caudal end of the thorax a lateral mass, parts of which become connected with the ribs, is separated off from the main part of the muscle; this extends craniad into the cervical region as M. iliocostalis (Z). The main portion of the longissimus dorsi (7/’) continues craniad on the medial side of the iliocostal into the neck region. At about the level of the eighth or ninth thoracic vertebra a strip begins to become separated off on the medial side of the longissimus; further forward it becomes clearly distinct, forming the spinalis dorsi (g). The separate muscles connecting the cervical vertebrze with each other and with the head are differentiations of the extensor dorsi com- munis. A still deeper set of fibres, interconnecting the vertebre, forms the multifidus spine and a number of other small muscles. A description of the different bundles of fibres, under the names usually given, follows. Certain general principles are observed in some of the names used. Muscles which intercon- nect the spinous processes of the vertebre receive the name spinalis. Those interconnecting contiguous spinous processes are called interspinalis. Muscles attached at one end to transverse processes, at the other to the spinous processes, receive the name transversospinalis. Semispinalis has the same signification as transversospinalis, but is a name usually applied to subdivisions of the transversospinalis group. The intertransversarii are muscles interconnecting the transverse processes. Ww N tal ‘stUTWOpe snsssasuBA) "| ‘7 STUIO]UL SaTeIsOoIAVUT “Wy “Y {qura}xo SoTBIsOoTayUL “WAY ‘2 ‘SITeISOOOTL “J “Y + !S4OP ‘ ‘ . $ . ‘ LS ¥ ssuideo snuussiduoy ‘py Jo pua yno ‘2 ssHurpe snSuo] ‘JW ‘p ‘touedns sides sunbijqo yw ‘2 ‘snxapduioo "J ‘9 +SPOTAteo JayUAIq “WY? ‘€L ‘o1g NI NMOHS SHIOSAW FHL dO TVAOWAY AALAV AasodxXy ‘xdog ao saTosaW daaq—"69 “old MUSCLES OF THE BODY. 126 THE MUSCLES. (a) Muscles of the Lumbar and Thoracic Regions.—The muscles of the lumbar and thoracic regions are mostly covered by a strong fascia, known as the lumbodorsal fascia (Fig. 68, v). This consists of two sheets, the superficial sheet being applied directly to the outer surface of the inner sheet, or sepa- rated from it by a mass of fat. The superficial sheet (Fig. 68, y) overlies the lumbar region and the caudal half of the thoracic region. On the medial side it is attached to the spinous processes of the vertebrz and is united closely to the deeper layer. Laterally this fascia is continuous with the latissimus dorsi (#) and obliquus abdominis externus (f). Caudad it is attached to the spine of the ilium and becomes continuous with the fascia covering the gluteus muscles. The deeper sheet (Fig. 70, c) is of a tendinous character, forming the external tendinous layer of the longissimus dorsi, many of whose fibres take origin from its under surface. It is described more fully in the account of this muscle. M. longissimus dorsi (Fig. 69, 7, /’, 7”; Fig. 70, a and 4).—A very large muscle, filling most of the region between the spinous processes and transverse processes of the lumbar and thoracic vertebree, and extending into the cervical region. The muscle is largest in the lumbar region (Fig. 69, /; Fig. 70), where it is divided into a narrow medial (Fig. 70, a) and a thick lateral portion (Fig. 70, 0), the latter being again partially subdivided by the fascia. The two parts unite farther craniad. The medial division (Fig. 70, a) consists of muscular bundles connecting the spinous processes of the vertebrz with the accessory and mammillary processes of other vertebrz; it is continuous caudad with the extensor caude lateralis (Fig. 70, f). The muscle-fibres take origin in the sacral region by small round tendons from the spinous processes of the last two sacral and the caudal vertebrae. They curve cranioventrad, forming a large belly, and are inserted into the accessory and mammillary processes of the lumbar vertebrze. In the thoracic region this division unites with that portion of the lateral divi- MUSCLES OF sion in which the fibres coming from the fascia of origin are in- serted into the laminz and trans- verse processes of the thoracic vertebre. The lateral division (Fig. 70, 6) is much larger than the medial one, forming in the lumbar region a nearly cylin- drical mass. Origin from the crest of the ilium (Fig. 70, 1) and the medial surface of the ilium as far caudad as the auricular impression ; also from the deep layer of the lum- bodorsal fascia (c). © This fascia is connected with the crest of the ilium and with the tips of the spinous processes of the vertebre in the lumbar and thoracic regions, and from it a _ large proportion of the fibres of the longissimus take origin. In the lumbar region it dips into the muscle as an intermediate longitudinal sheet (c), partially dividing it lengthwise into. two parts. Fibres taking origin from the lateral surface of this inter- mediate sheet curve cranioven- trad, and are inserted on the transverse processes of the lum- bar vertebre. Fibres taking origin from the medial surface of the sheet pass mediocraniad and are inserted into the acces- sory processes and the surfaces of the vertebral arches. THE BODY. 127 ZZ } i z Ze aa LA ss Fic. 70.—MUSCLES ON THE DORSAL SIDE OF THE VERTEBRAL COLUMN IN THE LUMBAR, SACRAL, AND CAU- DAL REGIONS. Both sheets of the lumbodorsal fascia have been removed, the deep layer (c) being cut where it passes into the longis- simus dorsi. 1, crest of ilium; 4—7, tips of spinous processes of the fourth to seventh lumbar vertebre. J, //, tips of spinous processes of first two sacral ver- tebree. a, 6, M. longissimi dorsi (a, medial portion; 4, lateral portion; 0’, portion taking origin from the lumbo- dorsal fascia); c, cut edge of deep layer of lumbodorsal fascia; d@, M. multifidus spine; ¢, M. extensor caudz medialis; , M. extensor caudze lateralis, g, M. abductor caudze externus. In the thoracic region (Fig. 69, /’) 128 THE MUSCLES most of the fibres are inserted in separate bundles by small tendons on the transverse processes of the vertebra, while some of the medial fibres unite with tendinous strands which become attached to the laminz and articular processes of the vertebra. At the region of the eighth or ninth thoracic verte- bra the spinalis dorsi (Fig. 69, ¢) begins to be separated _ off on the medial side, the separation becoming complete only some distance farther craniad; the longissimus dorsi then con- tinues into the cervical region (/”). Bundles of fibres become attached in the manner above described to transverse processes of all the thoracic vertebree. In the cervical region (/’’) the muscle spreads out and becomes thinner, and bundles of fibres become attached to the transverse processes of the cervical vertebre as far forward as the second. In the more cranial portion of its extent the muscle receives fibres having origin on the articular processes and lamine of the cervical and a few of the more cranial thoracic vertebre. The portion of the muscle which is inserted on the cervical transverse processes (/’’) is sometimes distinguished as the longissimus cervicis; it is not well separated from the rest of the muscle in the cat. The longissimus capitis (Fig. 69, ¢; Fig. 73, g) is to be considered a differentiated cranial portion of this muscle. Relations.—Outer surface with the following, beginning with the caudal end: the sartorius (Fig. 68, g), the latissimus dorsi (Fig. 68, #), the lumbodorsal fascia (Fig. 68, y), the serratus posterior inferior (Fig. 3, 2) and superior (Fig. 73, 7), and the levator scapule (Fig. 73, %). Lateral margin ' with the abdominal muscles, the iliocostal (Fig. 69, %), and the levator scapule (Fig. 73, 2). Medial side with the multi- fidus spine (Fig. 70, @), the spinous processes of the thoracic vertebre, the spinalis dorsi (Fig. 69, g), the complexus (Fig. 69, 4), the biventer cervicis (Fig. 69, a), and the longissimus capitis (Fig. 69, ¢). Action.—Extends the vertebral column. M. iliocostalis (Fig. 69, %).—This is a muscle about 14 to 2 centimeters wide, lying on the dorsal portion of the ribs, laterad of the longissimus dorsi (/’). It is composed of many MUSCLES OF THE BODY. 129 partly separated bundles, each with an oblique tendon. The muscle begins at the last or next to the last rib, where it is connected with the longissimus by a rather small bundle of fibres. The rest of the muscle-fibres take origin in bundles from the lateral surface of the ribs, at about the angles, or from thin tendons connecting the angles, of the ribs; they pass obliquely craniad and are inserted, usually by tendons, on the lateral surface of the third or fourth rib craniad of the one on which the given bundle has origin. The insertions on any given rib lie ventrad of the origins on the same rib. In the cat this muscle is confined to the thoracic region. Relations. —Outer surface with the serratus posterior inferior (Fig. 73, 2) and superior (Fig. 73, 7), and the levator scapulz (Fig. 73, #). Inner surface with the dorsal surface of the ribs, the external intercostals (Fig. 69, 7), and craniad with the levatores costarum. Medial edge in contact with the longissi- mus dorsi (Fig. 69, 7’). Action. —Draws the ribs together. M. spinalis dorsi (Fig. 69, g).—A muscle interconnecting the spinous processes of vertebrae some distance apart, in the thoracic and cervical regions. It lies on the medial side of the longissimus dorsi (/’). Origin by strong tendons from the tips of the spinous pro- cesses of the tenth to the thirteenth thoracic vertebra. These tendons represent the cranial portion of the deep layer of the lumbodorsal fascia, and give origin also to many fibres of the longissimus dorsi, so that the two muscles are completely united at the origin of the spinalis. They become separated at about the level of the sixth thoracic vertebra, the spinalis form- ing a strong separate bundle passing into the neck region close against the sides of the spinous processes. The insertion is by fleshy bundles into the sides of the spinous processes of the first nine or ten thoracic vertebre and of the cervical vertebre as far forward as the second. Some of the fibres of this muscle pass craniad into the biventer cervicis (Fig. 69, a). Relations.—Outer surface with the tendons of the serratus posterior inferior (Fig. 73, 7) and serratus posterior superior (Fig. 73, 7), and with the splenius (Fig. 73, 4), biventer 130 THE MUSCLES. cervicis (Fig. 69, a), and complexus (Fig. 69, 6). Lateral and ventral surface with the longissimus dorsi (/’); medial surface with the spinous processes and the multifidus spine. Action.—Extensor of the vertebral column. M. multifidus spine.—This consists of bundles of fibres which have origin on the transverse processes or neighboring parts, pass craniodorsad across one or more vertebrz, and are inserted into the spinous processes of vertebre lying some dis- tance craniad of the origin. They lie deeper than the muscles previously described. The muscle is most strongly developed in the lumbar region (Fig. 70, @), where it forms a thick inter- woven mass in which it is difficult to distinguish separate bundles. The fibres in this region have origin on the accessory or mammillary processes and usually pass over more than one vertebra between origin and insertion; their insertions reach the dorsal ends of the spinous processes, so that part of the muscle lies immediately beneath the lumbar fascia. In other regions the multifidus is covered by other muscles. In the thoracic region the separate bands are more distinct, and usually pass in their course over but one intervening vertebra. In the cervical region the bands are interconnected, forming a fairly distinct single muscle, which is described separately below as the semispinalis cervicis (Fig. 71, c). The portion of this muscle attached to the head (semispinalis capitis) forms the biventer cervicis (Fig. 69, a) and complexus (4). Caudad this muscle passes onto the tail as the extensor caude medialis (Fig. 70, ¢). Relations. —Outer and lateral surface in the lumbar region with the longissimus dorsi (Fig. 69, f) and the lumbodorsal fascia (Fig. 68, y); in the thoracic region with the longissimus dorsi (Fig. 69, 7’) and spinalis dorsi (g). Inner surface with the arches, articular processes, and spinous processes of the vertebre. Action.—Extends the back when the muscles of both sides work together. Turns the vertebral column obliquely side- ways when one set acts alone. The deepest layer of the multifidus forms what is sometimes MUSCLES OF THE BODY. 131 distinguished as the Mm. rotatores; no separate layer of this sort is to be made out in the cat. Mm. interspinales.—Muscle-bundles passing from the spinous process of one vertebra to that of the vertebra imme- diately craniad or caudad of it. They are best developed in the lumbar region. Mm. intertransversarii.— Muscle-fibres interconnecting the transverse processes. In the lumbar region the inter- transversarii mediales connect the accessory and mammillary processes; the intertransversarii laterales lying between the transverse processes. In other regions only one set of the intertransversarii is to be distinguished. (6) Dorsal Muscles of the Cervical Regton.—The clavotra- pezius (Fig. 68, @) and occipitoscapularis (Fig. 73, a) have been described in connection with the muscles of the shoulder. The remaining muscles of this region may be considered as differentiations of the general vertebral musculature (M. ex- tensor dorsi communis). M. splenius (Fig. 73, 4.)—A large sheet of muscle cover- ing the dorsal part of the side of the neck, beneath the trapezii. Origin from the whole cervical ligament and from the fascia covering the deeper muscles along a line which extends from the first thoracic spinous process caudolaterad for about two centimeters. Insertion by a thin tendon into the whole lambdoidal ridge. Laterad the tendon may be fused with that of the longissimus capitis (Fig. 73, 2). Relations.—Outer surface with the sternomastoid (Fig. 68, ¢), occipitoscapularis (Fig. 73, @), clavotrapezius (Fig. 68, @), rhomboideus, tendon of the serratus posterior superior (Fig. 73, 7), and the levator scapule (Fig. 73, %). Lateral edge closely united with the longissimus capitis (Fig. 73, g). Inner surface with the longissimus capitis, complexus (Fig. 69, 4), and biventer cervicis (Fig. 69, a). ; Action.—Lateral flexor of the head. The two together elevate the head. M. longissimus capitis (trachelomastoideus) (Fig. 73, ¢; Fig. 69, ¢).—This is a slender muscle lying close against the 132 THE MUSCLES. lateral border of the splenius (Fig. 73, 4), and sometimes fused with the splenius at its craniad end. It is a cranial continua- tion of the longissimus dorsi (Fig. 69, /’’). Origin by five slips which are attached by strong tendons to the anterior articular processes of the last four cervical vertebre. The tendons are common to this muscle and the complexus. The five slips unite to form a flat belly which has its Insertion by a strong rounded tendon into the mastoid process of the temporal bone. The tendon may be closely united to that of the splenius. . Relations.—-Lateral surface with the sternomastoid (Fig. 68, c), the levator scapule (Fig. 73, Z), and longissimus dorsi (Fig. 69, 7’). Medial surface with the splenius (Fig. 73, 4) (to which it is partly united), the complexus (Fig. 69, 4), and the longus atlantis (Fig. 69, @). Action.—Lateral flexor of the head. M. biventer cervicis (Fig. 69, a) (medial portion of M. semispinalis cervicis et capitis).—The biventer cervicis is a flat muscle which lies beneath the splenius (Fig. 73, 4), next the median line of the neck, with its fibres longitudinal. Origin in three or four slips from the surface of the three or four aponeurotic arches which take origin from the tips of the spinous processes of the last cervical and the first three thoracic vertebrz and pass laterad and caudad to the anterior processes of the second, third, fourth, and fifth thoracic verte- bre. These arches are deviated from their straight course by four aponeurotic bands which pass from them obliquely caudad and dorsad to the sides of the spinous processes of the vertebra into which the arches are inserted. The arches form the beginning of the sheet of fascia which passes outside of the longitudinal supraspinous muscles, and the anchoring bands form the beginning of a similar sheet which passes within the longitudinal supraspinous muscles. An additional slip may take origin from the cervical ligament between the last cervical and the first thoracic vertebrze. The fibres form a flat band divided by two or three oblique tendinous intersections. It adheres closely to the cervical supraspinous ligament. MUSCLES OF THE BODY. 133 Insertion by a strong tendon into the medial part of the lambdoidal crest. Relations.—Outer surface with the splenius (Fig. 73, 6) and at the caudal end with the longissimus dorsi (Fig. 69, /”). Inner surface with the spinalis dorsi (Fig. 69, g), the semi- spinalis cervicis (Fig. 71, c), and the rectus capitis posterior major (Fig. 71, a). Medial edge with the muscle of the oppo- site side; lateral edge with the complexus (Fig. 69, 0). Action.—Raises the snout. M. complexus (Fig. 69, 4) (lateral portion of M. semi- spinalis cervicis et capitis).—The complexus is closely asso- ciated with the biventer cervicis (a) and lies on its lateral side ~ beneath the splenius (Fig. 73, 0). Origin by tendinous bands from the anterior articular processes of the last five or six cervical and the first one, two, or three thoracic vertebre. The same bands give origin externally to the fibres of the longissimus capitis (Fig. 69, ¢), and internally to those of deeper muscles of the neck. The six or more muscular slips continued from these tendons unite to form a flat band, the Insertion of which is by a flat tendon into the medial third of the lambdoidal crest some distance ventrad of the free edge of the crest. Near the insertion the lateral border of the muscle is connected by an aponeurotic band to the lateral border of the transverse process of the atlas. Relations.—Outer surface at the dorsal border with the biventer cervicis (Fig. 69, a); at the middle with the splenius (Fig. 73, 6); at the ventral border with the longissimus capitis (Fig. 69, ¢) and the longissimus dorsi (Fig. 69, f’’). Inner surface with the cervical portion of the spinalis dorsi, with the semispinalis cervicis (Fig. 71, c), the obliquus capitis inferior (Fig. 71, 6), the rectus capitis posterior major (Fig. 71, a), and the obliquus superior (Fig. 71, @). Action.—Raises the head. M. spinalis dorsi extends into the cervical region; it has been described. M. semispinalis cervicis (Fig. 71, c).—This represents that portion of the multifidus spinz which extends into the 134 THE MUSCLES. cervical region. It is not composed of distinct bundles, like the multifidus of the thoracic region, but all the fibres are united into a fairly well-defined muscle. Origin from the articular processes of the last five cervical vertebrez. /nsertion into the spinous processes of the cervical vertebrz up to the second, the largest part of the muscle being inserted into the caudal end of the spine of the atlas. Relations.—Outer surface with the spinalis dorsi (Fig. 69, g) and the complexus (Fig. 69, 6). Inner surface with the vertebre. Action.—Extends the neck. M. longissimus dorsi extends into the cervical region, where it is often distinguished as the longissimus cervicis (Fig. 69, 7’). It has been described. M. longus atlantis (Fig. 71, 7; Fig. 69, d@).—This repre- sents a differentiated portion of the longissimus dorsi. Origin from the transverse process and the side of the vertebral arch of the third cervical vertebra. Insertion into the caudolateral angle of the wing of the atlas. Relations. —Dorsal surface with the complexus (Fig. 69, 4), the longissimus capitis (Fig. 69, ¢), and the obliquus inferior (Fig. 71, 6). Ventral surface with the scalenus (Fig. 71, g), longissimus dorsi (Fig. 69, 7”), and levator scapule (Fig. 71, h). Action.—Extends the neck and turns the head sideways. M. rectus capitis posterior major (Fig. 71, a). Origin.—The whole length of the spinous process (or crest) of the axis, or its caudal part only. It is united by a raphe to the opposite muscle. The muscle passes craniad and laterad to its ; Insertion into an area ventrad of the medial part of the lambdoidal crest beneath the insertion of the complexus (Fig. 69, 6) and the biventer cervicis (Fig. 69, a). - Relations. —Dorsal surface with the biventer cervicis (Fig. 69, a). Ventral surface with the rectus capitis posterior medius (Fig. 71, @) and the obliquus capitis inferior. a MUSCLES OF THE BODY. 135 Action.—Raises the snout. M. rectus capitis posterior medius (Fig. 71, 7). (This is in man a part of the rectus capitis posterior major. )—lIt lies beneath the rectus capitis posterior major (Fig. 71, a). Fic. 71.—DEEP MUSCLES OF THE NECK, AFTER THE REMOVAL OF MM. BIVENTER CERVICIS AND COMPLEXUS. a, M. rectus capitis posterior major; 4, M. obliquus capitis inferior; ¢, M. semi- spinalis cervicis; ¢, M. rectus capitis posterior medius;e, M. obliquus capitis superior; J; M. longus atlantis; g, M. scalenus (part of cervical portion); 4, cut end of M. levator scapulz. Origin from the cranial end of the axial spine. It forms a triangular prismatic mass which passes craniad and has its Insertion into an elongated area on the occipital bone, ventrad of the median half of the lambdoidal crest. Relations.—Dorsal surface with the rectus capitis posterior major (Fig. 71, a). Ventral surface with the atlas and the rectus capitis posterior minor. Action.—Assists the rectus capitis posterior major. M. rectus capitis posterior minor.—A small triangular muscle beneath the rectus capitis posterior medius (Fig. 71, Z). Origin by the apex of the triangle from the cranial border of the dorsal arch ot the atlas for about two millimeters laterad of. the median line. The muscle passes over the ligament which connects the atlas to the occiput and adheres to it. Insertion into an elongated area on the occipital bone, 136 THE MUSCLES. ventrad of the insertion of the rectus capitis posterior medius for about five millimeters next to the median line. Relations.—Dorsal surface with the rectus capitis posterior medius. Ventral surface with the posterior atlanto-occipital membrane. Action.—Assists the rectus capitis posterior major. M. obliquus inferior (Fig. 71, 0). Origin from the whole lateral surface of the spine of the axis. The parallel fibres form a thick mass which passes laterad and craniad. Insertion into the dorsal surface of the transverse process of the atlas along a narrow area near its lateral margin. Relations.—Outer surface with the rectus capitis posterior major (Fig. 71, @), the complexus (Fig. 69, 6), and the obliquus superior (Fig. 71, ¢). Inner surface with the axis. Action.—Rotates the head. M. obliquus capitis superior (Fig. 71, ¢; Fig. 72, ¢).— This is a triangular muscle passing from the outer border of the atlas laterad of the recti capitis posteriores to the occiput. Origin from the lateral border of the transverse process of the atlas on its ventral margin. The fibres pass craniad and diverge. Insertion into the caudal side of the mastoid process of the temporal bone and into a line parallel with the lambdoidal ridge and ventrad of it, from the mastoid process to within one centimeter of the median line. Relations.—Outer surface with. the splenius (Fig. 73, 4), complexus (Fig. 69, 4), and longissimus capitis (Fig. 73, g). Inner surface with the obliquus inferior (Fig. 71, 4), the wing of the atlas, and the rectus lateralis (Fig. 72, d). Ventral border with the cleidomastoid (Fig. 73, @) and one head of the levator scapule ventralis (Fig. 72, c’). Action.—F lexes the head laterally. Mm. interspinales and intertransversarii are found in the neck region also; they are described with the muscles of the back. C. MUSCLES OF THE TAIL.—M. extensor caude medialis (Fig. 70, e).—This is a continuation caudad of the multifidus MUSCLES OF THE BODY. 137 spine (Fig. 70, d@); it lies next to the dorsal median line, the muscles of right and left side touching one another in the middle line. Origin by numerous fleshy bundles from the spinous processes of the sacral and first caudal vertebree. The fibres pass caudad and are inserted by tendons into the articular processes and the dorsal surface of the caudal vertebre. Action.—Extends (raises) the tail. M. extensor caud@ lateralis (Fig. 70, f).—This is a con- tinuation caudad of the medial portion of the longissimus dorsi (Fig. 70, a); it lies just laterad of the extensor caude medialis (Fig. 70, @). Origin in many fleshy bundles from the articular processes of the sacral vertebra, and the transverse processes of the caudal vertebre. The fibres curve dorsocaudad and are inserted by many long slender tendons on the dorsal surfaces of the caudal vertebree. The muscle grows continually smaller as it passes caudad. Action.— Raises the tail. M. abductor caude (coccygis) externus (Fig. 68, w; Fig. 70, g).—A rounded muscle on the lateral surface of the cranial part of the tail. Origin from the medial side of the dorsal border of the ilium, and from the dorsal surface of the sacrum. The muscle passes caudad, lying just ventrad of the extensor lateralis, and is zxserted into the transverse processes and lateral surfaces of the caudal vertebrz, as far back as the eighth or ninth. Action.—Bends the tail sideways. M. abductor caude internus (or M. coccygeus).—A large flat muscle, having origin on the spine of the ischium. The muscle passes dorsomediad, spreading out, and is inserted into the transverse processes of the second to the fourth caudal vertebre. Relations.—Lateral surface with the caudofemoralis (Fig. 68, s), gluteus maximus, and pyriformis. Medial surface with the iliocaudalis and the flexor caudz longus (Fig. 68, +). M. iliocaudalis (Str.-D.) (Fig. 162, 11’, page 398).—This represents a portion of the levator ani of man, and in some 138 THE MUSCLES. specimens is united with that muscle (Fig. 162, 11) in the cat. Origin along the ventral half of the medial surface of the ilium, caudad of the sacrum. The fibres pass caudad and are inserted by a flat tendon into the ventral surface of the caudal vertebrz, from the second or third to about the seventh. Relations.—Lateral surface with the gluteus maximus and abductor caude internus (Fig. 68, w). Medial surface with the levator ani (Fig. 162, 11), with which this muscle may be partly united. Action.—The two muscles together flex the tail. M. flexor caude longus (Fig. 162, 12; Fig. 113, c, page 270). Origin on the ventral surface of the last lumbar vertebra, of the sacrum, and of the transverse processes of the caudal vertebree. Caudad the muscle forms long, strong tendons which are zzserted on the ventral surface of the tail. Relations.—Lateral surface with the ilium, the gluteus maximus, the abductor caudz internus, the iliocaudalis, and the skin of the tail. Dorsally it touches in the caudal region the abductor caudz externus (Fig. 68, w), medially the flexor caudz brevis (Fig. 162, 18). Action.—F lexes the tail. M. flexor caude brevis (Fig. 162, 13). Origin on the ventral surface of the caudal vertebrz, from the first to the seventh or eighth. The principal head comes from the first vertebra. The bundles thus formed pass caudad and are inserted each into the ventral surface of a vertebra some distance caudad of the origin. The muscle extends to about the tenth caudal vertebra, and its most caudal parts are closely interconnected with the flexor caudz longus. Relations—Lateral edge with the flexor caude longus. Medial edge in the sacral region with the levator ani (Fig. 162, 11) and the iliocaudalis (Fig. 162, 11’); in the caudal region with the muscle of the opposite side. Action.—F lexes the tail. 2. Muscles on the Ventral Side of the Vertebral Column. A. LUMBAR AND THORACIC REGIONS.—The iliopsoas (Fig. MUSCLES OF THE BODY. 139 162, 8) belongs in this group, but since it moves the leg it is described with the muscles of the pelvic limbs. M. psoas minor (Fig. 162, 9, page 398).— This muscle lies along the ventral surface of the vertebral column, next to the peritoneum, and extends from the thoracic vertebrae to the ilium. Origin usually by five heads, from the caudal border of the centra of the last two (or one) thoracic and first three (or four) lumbar vertebree. These heads also serve as origin for a part of the iliopsoas, and are closely united at their origin with the quadratus lumborum. They unite to form an, at first, rather large flat, muscle, which rapidly becomes smaller caudad, finally forming a slender tendon which is zzserted on the ilio- pectineal line, just craniad of the acetabulum. Relations.—Dorsolateral surface with the quadratus lum- borum and iliopsoas (Fig. 162, 8). Ventral surface with the pleura and diaphragm near the origin; with the peritoneum caudad. Action.—Flexes the back in the lumbar region. M. quadratus lumborum.—A flat muscle lying on the ventral surface of the transverse processes of the lumbar verte- bre. Craniad it has origin on the ventral surface of the last two thoracic vertebra, and by a few fibres from the last rib. The muscle passes caudad, lying on the lateral side of the psoas minor (Fig. 162, 9), and becomes attached to each of the transverse processes of the lumbar vertebre. Caudad the muscle passes into a strong flat tendon which is inserted into the anterior inferior spine of the ilium. Relations.—Dorsal surface with the transverse processes and the intertransverse muscles. Ventral and medial surfaces with the psoas minor (Fig. 162, 9) and iliopsoas (Fig. 162, 8). Action.—Bends the vertebral column sideways. B. MUSCLES ON THE VENTRAL SIDE OF THE NECK (Fig. © 65, page 109).—M. sternomastoideus (Fig. 65, g; Fig. 68, c).—The sternomastoid (sternal portion of the human sternocleidomastoid) is a flat band one to three centimeters wide extending from the cranial end of the manubrium and the midventral line craniad of it to the lambdoidal ridge. 140 THE MUSCLES. The origin extends from the cranial end of the manubrium along the midventral line as far as the caudal border of the cricoid cartilage, and is in two parts. The caudal portion arises from the lateral surface of the manubrium along the dorsal half of its cranial end, and from the median raphe for about one centimeter craniad of the manubrium. Its fibres are parallel and tend to diverge into two layers. The cranial portion arises by means of fibres which cover the median line and. interdigitate with the fibres of the opposite muscle between the cricoid cartilage and a point a few millimeters craniad of the manubrium. Its caudal border is thus overlaid by the caudal portion. Its fibres converge and join those of the caudal portion. The muscle passes dorsocraniad and is Inserted by means of a flat tendon into the lateral half of the lambdoidal ridge and into a continuation of the ridge onto the mastoid portion of the temporal bone as far as the mastoid process. The thickest part of the tendon is inserted into the mastoid process. Relations.—Outer surface at the caudal end with the pec- toralis major (Fig. 65, /); in the middle part with the platysma, the depressor conche (Fig. 64, 6), and with the external jugu- lar vein (Fig. 65, 5), which crosses it obliquely; at the cranial end with the submaxillary (Fig. 65, 2) and parotid (1) glands. Inner surface with the sternohyoid (Fig. 65, ¢), sternothyroid (g'), internal jugular vein, longus capitis muscle, the cleido- mastoid (#), levator scapule ventralis (z), a large lymphatic. gland ventrad of the ear, and the splenius (Fig. 73, 4). Action.—One muscle turns the head and depresses the snout. Both together depress the snout. M. sternohyoideus (Fig. 65, ¢).—A slender muscle on the midventral line of the neck close to the opposite muscle. Origin from the cranial border of the first costal cartilage. The muscle passes craniad closely united near its caudal end to the sternothyroid (g’). Insertion (Fig. 67, m) into the outer half of the ventral sur- face of the body of the hyoid bone caudad of the origin of the geniohyoid (Fig. 67, g). Relations.—Outer surface with the sternomastoid (Fig. MUSCLES OF THE BODY. — 141 65, g). Inner surface with the thyrohyoid (Fig. 65, /; Fig. 67, p), the trachea (Fig. 67, 4), and the larynx. Action.—Draws the hyoid caudad. Raises the ribs and sternum when the hyoid is fixed. M. sternothyreoideus (Fig. 65, ¢’).—The sternothyroid lies beneath the sternohyoid and is connected with it at its caudal end. Origin from the first costal cartilage beneath the sterno- hyoid. Insertion (Fig. 67, 0) into the lateral part of the caudal border of the thyroid cartilage of the larynx. Relations.—Outer surface with the sternohyoid (Fig. 65, ¢) and laterally with the sternomastoid (Fig. 65, ¢). Inner sur- face with the trachea (Fig. 67, 4), and at the lateral edge with the thyroid gland (Fig. 67, 6). Action.—Pulls the larynx caudad. M. scalenus (Fig. 73, //’’’).—This is a large and com- plex muscle lying on the ventral side of the neck and the lateral surface of the thorax. It might equally well be classified with the muscles of the thorax. It is divisible into a consider- able number of interconnected bundles which are sometimes described as separate muscles. The largest, middle portion (scalenus medius) (/’) takes origin by thin tendons from the sixth, seventh, eighth, and ninth ribs, just dorsad of their junction with the cartilages; these tendons unite near their origins to form a flat band which becomes fleshy at about the fifth rib, passes craniad, and unites just craniad of the first rib with the other parts of the muscle. The dorsal portion (scalenus posterior) (/”) has origin by a very slender tendon from about the middle of the outer surface of the third or fourth rib; it extends craniad as a narrow band which passes laterad between the heads of the serratus anterior (¢) that are attached to the second and third (or third and fourth) ribs, and unites with the other heads. The ventral head (part of scalenus anterior) (/’’) arises by one or two minute tendons from the cartilages of the second and third ribs; they are partly united with the transversus costarum (7). This ventral head passes craniad and unites with the other heads. 142 : THE MUSCLES. These three divisions unite just craniad of the first rib with each other and with the cervical portion of the muscle (/) (part of scalenus anterior). This consists of a number of small bundles of fibres which arise from the first rib and the transverse processes of the first thoracic and the last six cervical vertebre. The zzsertion is onto the transverse processes of all the cervi- cal vertebrz, including the axis andatlas. According to Strauss- Durckheim the fibres from any given transverse process are insert- ed into the transverse processes of all the vertebr craniad of it. The muscle is partly continuous craniad with the longus capitis (¢).. The cervical nerves pass out between the bundles of the cervical portion. Relations.—Outer (lateral) surface in the thoracic region with the external oblique (Fig. 68, ), the pectoralis minor (Fig. 65, 0), and in part with the serratus anterior (Fig. 73, 2); in the cervical region with the sternomastoid (Fig. 65, g). Inner (medial) surface with the serratus anterior (Fig. 73, 2), the levator scapule (Fig. 73, Z), the longus atlantis, the trans- verse processes of the cervical vertebrz, and the longus capitis (Fig. 73, ¢). Action.—Flexes the neck and draws the ribs craniad. M. longus capitis (or rectus capitis anterior major) (Fig. 72, a; Fig. 73, e).—This is a long muscle lying on the ventral aspect of the cervical vertebre. With the muscle of the opposite side and the underlying longus colli (Fig. 72, g’) it forms a trough in which lie the cesophagus, pharynx, and trachea. Origin by five (or six) heads from the ventral margins of - the transverse processes of the cervical vertebre from the second to the sixth inclusive. The heads unite into a common belly, the lateral border of which is united with the levator scapule ventralis (Fig. 72, c’) near its insertion. Insertion into the body of the sphenoid bone between the bulla and the middle line. The insertion extends craniad. onto the basisphenoid. ; Relations.—Ventral surface with the sternomastoid (Fig. 65, g) and the large lymphatic gland ventrad of the external ! MUSCLES OF ear. with the levator scapule ven- tralis (Fig. 72, c-c’”’). Medial surface with the carotid artery, the trachea, cesophagus, and pharynx. Dorsal edge with the vertebre, the longus colli (Fig..72, g’), and the rectus ca- pitis anterior minor (Fig. 72,0). Action.—Lowers the snout. M. rectus capitis anterior minor (Fig. 72, 6).—This is a flat band beneath (dorsad of) the longus capitis (qa). Origin from the ventral sur- face of the inferior arch (body) of the atlas (3) for about five millimeters laterad of the mid- dle line. Insertion into a deep depres- sion on the basioccipital caudad of the insertion of the longus capitis (a2) and between the caudal end of the bulla (1) and the median line. Relations.—Véntral surface with the longus capitis (a). Dorsal surface with the anterior (ventral) atlanto-occipital mem- brane (2). Action. — Depresses snout. M. rectus capitis lateralis (Fig. 72, d@).—This lies ventrad -of the obliquus superior (¢) on the ventral face of the transverse process of the atlas and at first the THE BODY. 143 Lateral surface with the scalenus (Fig.72, 2) and craniad Fic. 72..-MUSCLES ON THE VENTRAL SURFACE OF THE CERVICAL VER- TEBRA. On the left side the longus capitis and one head of the levator scapulz ventralis have been cut, in order to show the rec- tus capitis anterior minor. ‘ a, M. longus capitis; 4, M. rectus capitis anterior ~ minor; ¢, M. levator scapulz ventralis (c’, its atlantal head; ¢’’, its occipital head); d, M. rectus capitis lateralis; e, M. obliquus capitis superior; 7, M. longis- simus capitis; g, M. longus colli (g’, its cervical portion; g”, its thoracic por- tion); 2, part of M. scalenus. 1, bulla tympani; 2, ventral atlanto-occipital membrane; 3, ventral arch of atlas; 4, first rib. appears to be a part of the obliquus superior. 144 THE MUSCLES. Origin from the median half of the ventral surface of the — transverse process of the atlas. The fibres form a cylindrical mass which passes craniad and slightly laterad. /nsertton into the fossa laterad of the condyle of the occipi- tal bone. Relations.—Ventral surface with the digastric (Fig. 65, 0) and the lymphatic gland ventrad of the ear. Dorsal surface with the wing of the atlas. Action.—Flexes the head laterally. M. longus colli (Fig. 65, ¢’, g’”).—A long, rather slender muscle lying on the ventral surface of the cervical and first six thoracic vertebre. It consists of many separate bundles, and is divisible into a thoracic and a cervical portion. The thoracic portion (g¢’’) has origin by six heads from the ventral surface of the first six thoracic vertebre. The separate heads join to form a band which passes craniad and is inserted for the most part into the processus costarius of the sixth cervical vertebra; a portion of it joins the cervical division of the muscle. p The cervical portion (¢’) is a continuation craniad of the thoracic portion. It arises in small bundles from the transverse processes and sides of the ventral surfaces of the centra of the cervical vertebree. These bundles pass craniomediad, so that those from the muscles of opposite sides meet and are inserted on the centra of the vertebrez in the middle line, each pair of bundles forming a V opening caudad. The most cranial insertion is into the tubercle on the middle of the ventral sur- face of the ventral arch of the atlas (3). Relations.—Dorsal surface with the centra of the vertebre. Ventral surface in the thorax with the trachea; in the neck with the cesophagus. Medial edge with the muscle of the opposite side. Lateral margin in the cervical region with the longus capitis (a). Action.—Bends the neck. 3. Muscles of the Thorax.—A. BREAST-MUSCLES (con- necting the arm and thorax) (Fig. 65, page 109). The muscles connecting the arm with the sternum, corre- sponding to the pectoralis muscles of man, fall into a consider- MUSCLES OF THE BODY. 145 able number of not always clearly separated bundles in the cat. We shall distinguish by name four such bundles; these might be, and frequently are, further subdivided. M. pectoantibrachialis (Fig. 65, #).—This is a small flat bundle about one or two centimeters wide, forming the most superficial portion of the pectoralis group. Origin on the lateral surface of the manubrium. The muscle passes laterad onto the arm and is zuzserted by a flat tendon into the superficial fascia of the dorsal border of the forearm, near the eblow-joint. The tendon is continuous craniad with the border of the clavobrachial (£), so that a bundle of fibres may pass from this muscle to be inserted with the clavobrachial, or a bundle from the clavobrachial to be inserted with this. The tendon is continuous caudad with that of the epitrochlearis (7). The fascia of insertion may be traced to an attachment into the dorsal border of the ulna. This muscle usually receives near its insertion a slip, sometimes called its caudal division, from the deep layer of the pectoralis major. Relations.—Outer surface with the integument. Inner sur- face with both divisions of the pectoralis major (/) on its medial two-thirds, and with the biceps (¢) and bicipital arch (¢’) in its lateral one-third. The cranial border is closely applied to that of the clavobrachial (£), except at the two ends. Action.—Draws the arm mediad. M. pectoralis major, or ectopectoralis (Fig. 65, /, 7').— In this it is usually possible to distinguish a superficial and a deep layer. The superficial (/’) layer is a flat band of fibres one or two centimeters wide. Origin from a raphe in the midventral line, along the cranial half of the manubrium and for five to ten millimeters craniad of it. Insertion (Fig. 81, f).—The pectoral ridge of the middle third of the shaft of the humerus, slightly dorsad of the line of insertion of the deep portion. Relations. — Outer surface with the clavobrachial (Fig. 65, #) and integument, the medial end caudally with the pectoantibrachialis (7), and the distal end with the brachialis 146 THE MUSCLES. (v). Inner surface with the deep portion (/), the fibres of which it crosses obliquely. The deep portion (/) is a flat band of parallel fibres about three times as broad as the superficial portion. Origin.—The ventral surface of the manubrium and of the first three divisions of the sternum, and the median raphe for about one centimeter craniad of the manubrium. It passes directly laterad. Insertion (Fig. 81, ¢) along a line which begins at the infraspinatus fossa of the great tuberosity, and runs parallel to the deltoid ridge until it reaches the pectoral ridge at the junc- tion of the second and third fourths of the humerus and then continues in the direction of the pectoral ridge as far as the junction of the third and fourth fourths of the humerus. Some of its fibres may pass caudad of the biceps and be inserted with the epitrochlearis. Into the part of the line which is parallel to the deltoid ridge the muscle is inserted by a flat tendon; into the remainder of the line it is usually inserted directly by muscle-fibres, though at its caudal end its insertion may again be tendinous. Relations.—Outer surface with the cutaneus maximus, the outer layer of the pectoralis major (Fig. 65, 7’), the pectoanti- brachialis (72), and the clavobrachial (£). Inner surface with the pectoralis minor (0), the proximal end of the humerus, the coracobrachialis (Fig. 77, /), and the supraspinatus (Fig. 77, d@) at the insertion of the latter. At the cranial part of its origin it touches the sternomastoid (Fig. 65, ¢) and sternohyoid (Fig. 65, ¢). : Action.—Draws the arm mediad and turns the foot forward. M. pectoralis minor, or entopectoralis (Fig. 65, 0).—This is a fan-shaped mass of fibres, flat but thicker than the pec- toralis major. Origin from the lateral half of the first six divisions of the body of the sternum and sometimes from the xiphoid process. The fibres are divisible into several bundles which vary in extent and distinctness and are sometimes described as separate muscles. They pass craniolaterad and converge so that the line of insertion is about one-half as long as that of the origin. ence sian Peer Te SO MUSCLES OF THE BODY. 147 Insertion (Fig. 81, @) into the humerus along a line which forms the ventral border of the bicipital groove at the proximal end of the bone, passes thence onto the pectoral ridge and continues in the direction of the pectoral ridge nearly as far as the middle of the length of the humerus. The cranial and caudal fibres are inserted by means of a thin tendon; the middle fibres directly. The cranial border of the tendon of insertion is continued as a thin tendon to the coracoid process; it is closely united with the insertion of the supraspinatus. Relations.—By its outer surface with the pectoralis major (Fig. 65, 2) over its cranial half; with the cutaneus maximus, latissimus dorsi (Fig. 65, g), and integument over its caudal half. By its inner surface with the xiphihumeralis (Fig. 65, J), rectus abdominis (Fig. 73, £), and a mass of fat in the axilla. The tendon of the xiphihumeralis is also connected with its inner surface near its insertion. Its cranial border is free. Its caudal border is in relation at its medial end with the xiphi- humeralis, at its lateral end with the tendon of the latissimus dorsi (Fig. 65, @). Action.—Draws the arm toward the middle line. M. xiphihumeralis (Fig. 65, g).—A long, thin, narrow muscle which may be considered as part of the pectoralis minor. Origin a median raphe along the xiphoid process or at an angle to the median line on the rectus abdominis muscle. It passes craniad, becoming gradually smaller, and about two centimeters from its insertion ends in a thin tendon. Insertion.—lt ends in a flat tendon which in passing is con- nected by a strong fascia with the tendon of the latissimus (Fig. 65, 7). It passes along the inner surface of the pectoralis minor (0) to be inserted with its cranial fibres near the ventral border of the bicipital groove. Relations.—Outer surface with the cutaneus maximus at its medial end, with the pectoralis minor (0) at its distal end. Inner surface with the external oblique (Fig. 68, #), the rectus abdominis (Fig. 73, &), and a mass of fat in the axilla. Borders free. Some of the fibres of the cutaneus maximus are attached to its outer surface. 148° THE MUSCLES. Action.—Assists the pectoralis minor. B. MUSCLES OF THE WALL OF THE THORAX.—M. ser- ratus posterior superior (Fig. 73, /).—A thin sheet of muscle and tendon beneath the serratus anterior (7) on the dorsal part of the thorax and neck. Origin by fleshy slips from the outer surfaces of the first nine ribs just ventrad of their angles. The origin may extend as far as the tenth or eleventh ribs. The first slip is usually delicate. The fibres are directed dorsad and craniad-and unite to form a continuous sheet. This ends along a longitudinal line opposite the vertebral transverse processes in the aponeuro- sis which covers the longissimus dorsi and other muscles in this region. Its insertion is into the median dorsal raphe between the axial spinous process and the tenth thoracic spinous process. Relations.—Outer surface with the serratus anterior (2), the latissimus dorsi (Fig. 68, m), and the rhomboideus. Inner surface with the external intercostals (Fig. 73, mz), the iliocos- tal (Fig. 69, 2), the longissimus dorsi (Fig. 69, /), the spinalis dorsi (Fig. 69, g), and the splenius (Fig. 73, 6). Action.—Draws the ribs craniad. M. serratus posterior inferior (Fig. 73, ”).—The serratus posterior inferior is a thin muscle lying caudad of the serratus posterior superior (/) and sometimes overlying the caudal] end of the latter. Origin by four or five heads from the last four or five ribs. In some specimens only three heads may be present. The separate bundles pass dorsocaudad and unite to form a contin- uous sheet which ends in a continuation of the aponeurosis of the serratus posterior superior (/). Insertion into the lumbar spinous processes and the inter- vening interspinous ligaments. Relations. —Outer surface with the latissimus dorsi (Fig. 68, £), and at the origins with the intercostales externi (Fig. 73, m). Inner surface with the intercostales interni (Fig. 69, &)- at the origin and with the intercostales externi (Fig. 69, 7), _ iliocostal (Fig. 69, %), longissimus dorsi (Fig. 69, /), and the caudal end of the spinalis dorsi (Fig. 69, g). 149 MUSCLES OF THE.- BODY. “elosey [esiopoquiny ‘¢ !snusajzur sturmopqe snnbyqo “jw ‘0 {4oLayut so11aysod snqewies “TW Sg $1UIIXd SITBISOA9UT “JL ‘eu ‘zouadns touiajsod snyeiios "We ‘7 ‘(uopus} Ss}! ‘y) sturmopqe snot “j ‘¥ ‘uuniejsoo snsxaasuvs) “ff +(ynd) oLajyUB SsNywILS “J * $(qno) aendeos royeaay “JW ‘y ‘saideo snurssisuol “py 4 {(uonsod peotasso ‘f SuOIsIAIp [e.jQUdA ‘,f saoistarp yessop {,,/ SUOIstAIp e[pprat ‘f) snuayeos “WW ‘f tsnideo snSuoj ‘py ‘2 ‘(jno) snaploysewmopre[ “WW ‘P $(qnd) stpeajuaa andes 1oyeasy] “WW “ ‘sntuatds “yy fg *(jn9) suvpndessoydios0 “yl “P °89 ‘OI NI NMOHS SaTosay AHL GNV AWITIYOY AHL AO TVAOWAY UALAV AasodXa SATOSAYW Aaog—EL “OIA sSott 150 THE MUSCLES. Action.—Assists the serratus posterior superior. M. transversus costarum, or sternocostalis externus (Fig. 73, 7). This is a thin muscle applied to the cranial part of the side of the thorax, covering the cranial end of the rectus abdominis (A). Origin by tendon from the side of the sternum between the attachments of the third and sixth ribs. The muscle passes dorsocraniad to its Insertion on the first rib and the lateral portion of its costal cartilage. : Relations. —Outer surface with the pectoralis minor (Fig. 65, 0). Inner surface with the scalenus (Fig. 73, /’”’), the rectus abdominis (Fig. 73, %), and the intercostales externi (Fig. 73, m). Atits insertion it is united with a portion of the scalenus (Fig. 73, /’”). : Action. —Draws the sternum forward. Mm. levatores costarum.— Small muscles having origin on the transverse processes of the thoracic vertebrz, passing caudoventrad, and becoming zzserted on the angle of the rib lying immediately caudad of the origin. They are continuous with the external intercostals. Relations. —Outer surface with the longissimus dorsi (Fig. 69, 7), and craniad with the iliocostal (Fig. 69, %). Inner surface with the internal intercostals (Fig. 69, £). Action.—Pull the ribs dorsocraniad. Mm. intercostales externi (Fig. 73, m; Fig. 69, 7).—The external intercostals are placed in the outer portion of the intercostal spaces. They are composed of bundles of fibres attached by their ends to the adjacent borders of the ribs and having in general the direction of the external oblique muscle, e., they pass from their cranial ends caudoventrad. They occupy the intercostal spaces between the true ribs and extend even caudad into the spaces between the false ribs. They are ‘lacking between the ventral ends of the costal cartilages. of the first six to eight ribs, so that the internal intercostals (Fig. 69, #) are here exposed. The more caudal external intercos- tals are more nearly craniocaudal in direction. Relations.— Outer surface with obliquus abdominis externus MUSCLES OF THE BODY. 151 (Fig. 68, P), latissimus dorsi (Fig. 68, #), serratus posterior inferior (Fig. 73, 2) and superior (Fig. 73, 2), serratus anterior (Fig. 73, 2), scalenus (Fig. 73, 7), and iliocostal (Fig. 69, /). Inner surface with the internal intercostals (Fig. 69, £). Action. —Protractors of the ribs. Mm. intercostales interni (Fig. 69, #).—The internal intercostals are similar to the external intercostals, beneath which they lie. Their fibres pass between the ribs at nearly right angles to those of the external intercostals and have nearly the direction of the fibres of the internal oblique. They occupy all the intercostal spaces from the first to the thirteenth ribs. Relations. —Outer surface with the external intercostals (Fig. 69, 2), and ventrad with the scalenus (Fig. 73, /), trans- versus costarum (Fig. 73, 7), and rectus abdominis (Fig. 73, &). Inner surface with the pleura and the transversus thoracis. Action.—Retractors of the ribs. M. transversus thoracis (triangularis sterni; sternocostalis internus).—This represents a thoracic portion of the transversus abdominis. It consists of five or six flat muscular bands lying on the inner surface of the thoracic wall. Origin on the lateral borders of the dorsal face of the sternum, opposite the attachments of the cartilages of the third to the eighth ribs. The six bands thus formed, each about one centimeter wide, pass laterad and are zzser¢ed into the cartilages of the ribs near their junction with the ribs, and into the fascia which covers the inner surface of the internal intercostals in this region. Relations. —Outer surface with the internal intercostals and the cartilages of the ribs. Inner surface with the pleura. Diaphragma (Fig. 74).—The diaphragm consists of a cen- tral so-called semilunar tendon (e) and of muscular fibres which pass radially from the body wall to the tendon. It forms a complete oblique partition between the abdominal and thoracic cavities. The dorsal end is farther caudad than the ventral. The central tendon (e) is thin and irregularly crescent- shaped, with the convexity ventrad and the horns of the cres- cent prolonged as two tendinous bands (e’) which end in two 152 THE MUSCLES, triangular membranous portions (d) of the diaphragm, one on each side of the spinal column. It is pierced by an opening for the vena cava (/). Fic. 74.—DIAPHRAGM, CAUDAL SURFACE SEEN OBLIQUELY: FROM THE RIGHT. a, right crus; 4, left crus; ¢, ¢, sternocostal part of diaphragm; d, d’, membra- nous portions of the diaphragm; ¢, central tendon; e’, prolongations of central ten- don; /, opening for posterior vena cava; g, cesophagus; 4, aorta; z, M. transversus abdominis. The muscular portion is in two parts: (a) The vertebral portion (a, 6) arises by a single tendon from the ventral surface of the second, third, and fourth lumbar centra. The tendon diverges into two, the right one (a) of which is much stronger, and from each of the two arise muscle-fibres. Each mass of fibres is one of the two crura (sing. crus) ofthe diaphragm. The aorta (#) enters the abdomen between the crura dorsally. The fibres of each crus diverge to be inserted into the central tendon and the dorsal continuation of its horn. The two sets of fibres unite ventrad of the opening of the aorta. Between this open- ing and the central tendon is another opening for the cesopha- Pes < ‘ ee ee Sg ae ET Py ee ee MUSCLES OF THE BODY. 153 gus (g); this lies entirely in that part of the diaphragm which arises from the right crus (a). The fibres are again united ventrad of the cesophageal opening. (6) The sternocostal part (¢, ¢’) takes origin from the xiphoid process and the last five ribs, by fleshy bundles which interdigitate with those of the transversus abdominis (2). The fibres converge to the central tendon (e). Between the crus of each side and the most dorsal of the costal fibres is the membranous interval (2) mentioned above. 4. Abdominal Muscles. M. obliquus abdominis externus (Fig. 68, £).—A large, thin sheet of muscle covering the whole - abdomen and part of the thorax ventrally. Origin.—(a) From the last nine or ten ribs by means of as many tendons, which are interconnected to form arches that span the slips of the serratus anterior. The muscle-fibres arise from these tendons and from their intervening arches. (6) From the lumbodorsal aponeurosis common to it and the internal oblique. The cranial fibres pass nearly ventrad, the caudal fibres caudad, and the intervening fibres take an inter- mediate course. The fibres end in a thin aponeurosis of inser- tion along a curved line which passes at first caudad and then laterodorsad. The aponeurosis fibres continue in the direction _ of the muscle-fibres to the © Insertion into the median raphe ventrad of the sternum from the insertion of the seventh costal cartilage to the xiphoid process, into the linea alba from the sternum to the pubic tubercle, and into the turbercle and the cranial border of the pubis. Caudad of the xiphoid process the aponeurosis is closely -united to the superficial layer of the internal oblique, where it forms the outer layer of the sheath of the rectus abdominis. Laterad of the pubic tubercle the tendon is perforated by the inguinal canal. In the cat neither the caudal part of the muscle nor its tendon is attached to the ilium, as it is in man and the dog, so that no Poupart’s ligament, or inguinal ligament, is formed. Relations.—Outer surface with the cutaneus maximus, the integument, and near the origin with the latissimus dorsi (Fig. 68, #). Inner surface with the obliquus internus (Fig. 154 THE MUSCLES. 73, 0), the rectus abdominis (Fig. 73, %), the intercostales ex- terni (Fig. 73, m), a small part of the serratus posterior inferior (Fig. 73, 2), and by its dorsal tendon with the longissimus dorsi (Fig. 69, /). Action.—Constrictor of the abdomen. M. obliquus abdominis internus (Fig. 73, 0).—A thin sheet similar to the preceding but of less extent. Its fibres cross those of the external oblique nearly at right angles and lie beneath them. Origin.—(1) Between the fourth and seventh lumbar verte- bre from the lumbar aponeurosis which is common to it and the external oblique. The lumbar aponeurosis takes origin from the lumbar spinous processes and the interspinous ligaments, and is continuous craniad with the aponeurosis of the serratus posterior inferior. Laterad it splits into three sheets, two for the above-named muscles and a third which passes to the vertebral transverse processes and forms the fascia covering the supraspinous muscles of the lumbar region. (2) By a similar aponeurosis from the ventral half of the iliac crest. (3) By fleshy fibres from the three crural arches. These are three delicate ligamentous arches which stretch from the crest of the ilium.to the pubic spine. The dorsal one gives exit to the iliopsoas muscle, the middle to the femoral vessels, and the ventral to the spermatic cord. In the female the middle and ventral arches may fuse. The pillar between the dorsal and middle arches is attached to the iliopectineal eminence. Insertion.—The fibres pass cranioventrad and end along a longitudinal line in a thin aponeurosis of insertion, which is united in the linea alba to those of the external oblique and transversus. At the caudal end of the aponeurosis all its fibres pass outside of the rectus abdominis (Fig. 73, %). At its cranial end the fibres divide into two sheets or laminz, one of which passes outside of the rectus and the other inside. The outer lamina unites with the aponeurosis of the external oblique, while the inner lamina unites with that of the trans- versus. There is thus formed a sheath for the cranial part of the rectus muscle. Relations.—Outer surface with the obliquus externus (Fig. MUSCLES OF THE BODY. 155 68, #). Inner surface with the transversus abdominis (Fig. 69, 7), and by its ventral tendon with the rectus. Action.—Compressor of the abdomen. M. transversus abdominis (Fig. 69, /).—A thin sheet covering the whole surface of the abdomen and lying beneath the internal oblique. Its fibres are nearly transverse. Origin.—(1) By fleshy fibres or by a thin aponeurosis foun the cartilages of all the false and floating ribs, by interdigitation with the fibres of the diaphragm. (2) From the tips of all the lumbar transverse processes. (3) From the ventral border of the ilium. (4) From the dorsal and middle of the three crural arches, where it may blend partly with the internal oblique. The muscle is continuous craniad with the transversus thoracis muscle. Near the lateral border of the rectus abdominis the ‘muscle ends in a thin aponeurosis of insertion which is con- tinued (its fibres having the direction of the muscle-fibres) to the Insertion in the linea alba. Relations. —Outer surface with the internal oblique (Fig. 73, 0) and the rectus abdominis (Fig. 73, &), dorsad also with the longissimis dorsi (Fig. 69, f). Inner surface with a thin fascia covering the peritoneum and ventrocaudad with the rectus (Fig. 73, &). The dorsal edge of the muscle touches the iliopsoas and longissimus dorsi; the ventral edge touches the muscle of the opposite side. Action.—Constrictor of the abdomen. M. rectus abdominis (Fig. 73, #).—A rather thick, flat muscle which lies near the median ventral line separated by the linea alba from its fellow of the opposite side and stretching from the pubis to the first costal cartilage. Opposite the first lumbar vertebra it is approximately four centimeters wide. It narrows at both ends. Origin by a strong tendon from the tubercle of the pubis. The muscle passes craniad at first between the peritoneal fascia -and the transversus aponeurosis, then in the sheath formed by the internal and external oblique and the transversus aponeuro- sis. It emerges from the sheath opposite the xiphoid process and passes ventrad of the costal cartilages. Between the third 156 THE MUSCLES. and fourth costal cartilages it ends in a thin tendon which passes beneath the transversus costarum and is Inserted into the first costal cartilage near its middle, into the second costal cartilage near its sternal end, and into the sternum between the first and fourth cartilages. Relations.—Outer surface of the cranial part of the muscle and its tendon with the pectoralis minor (Fig. 68, 0) and the transversus costarum (Fig. 73, 7); caudad the muscle is covered by the outer layer of the rectus sheath. Lateral edge with the obliquus externus (Fig. 68, #), obliquus internus (Fig. 73, 0), and transversus abdominis (Fig. 69, 7). Medial edge with the muscle of the opposite side. Inner surface with the internal intercostals (Fig. 69, #) and the rib cartilages; the inner layer of the rectus sheath and the peritoneum. Action.—Retracts the ribs and sternum and compresses the abdomen. IV. MUSCLES OF THE THORACIC LIMBS, The muscles connecting the thoracic limbs with the rest of the body have been described. 1. Muscles of the Shoulder. A. MUSCLES ON THE LATERAL SURFACE OF THE _ SHOULDER. M. deltoideus.—The deltoid muscle of the cat is divided into two (or three) portions which are together equivalent to the human deltoid. These are the spinodeltoid, the acro- miodeltoid, and possibly the clavobrachial, which is frequently called clavodeltoid. M. spinodeltoideus (Fig. 75, ¢; Fig. 68, z).—A rather thick, flat muscle between the scapular spine and the deltoid ridge of the humerus. It forms a chord of the angle between the glenoid border of the scapula and the humerus. Origin by short tendon-fibres from the glenoid border of somewhat more than the middle third of the spine of the. scapula (Fig. 76, g), and from a tendinous raphe between the spinotrapezius (Fig. 68, 7), acromiotrapezius (Fig. 68, 4), and MUSCLES OF THE THORACIC LIMBS. 157 infraspinatus (Fig. 75, ¢). The origin may pass toward the vertebral border of the scapula onto the infraspinatus muscle (Fig. 75, ¢). Insertion (Fig. 81, 4%) by a flat tendon upon the deltoid ridge of the humerus, nearly parallel to that of the pectoralis major. Relations.—Outer surface with the integument and at the insertion with the acromiodeltoideus (Fig. 75, 7). Inner sur- face with the infraspinatus (c), teres-minor (Fig. 80, c), caput laterale (Fig. 75, 4), and caput longum (Fig. 75, g) of the triceps muscle. Action.—Flexes the humerus and rotates it outward. M. acromiodeltoideus (Fig. 75, /; Fig. 68, ¢).—A flat muscle which overlies the distal end of the spinodeltoideus (Fig. 75, ¢). It connects the acromion with the humerus. Origin (Fig. 76, d@).—From the glenoid border of the acromion, and sometimes the adjacent metacromion as far as the tip. Jnsertion.—Mostly upon the outer surface of the spinodel- toideus (Fig. 75, ¢). The outer fibres are continued to the bone, especially at the lateral border of the muscle, and are inserted along a line ventrad of the line of insertion of the spinodeltoideus, and extending farther distally (Fig. 81, ¢). Some of the outer fibres pass into the brachialis (Fig. 80, 4%). Relations.—Outer surface with the integument and the clavobrachial (Fig. 68, ¢). Inner surface with the infraspinatus (Fig. 75, c), teres minor (Fig. 80, c), spinodeltoid (Fig. 75, ¢), and caput laterale of the triceps (Fig. 75, /). Action.—Like that of the spinodeltoid. M. clavobrachialis (Fig. 65, 4; Fig. 68, ¢).—A flat, tri- angular muscle on the cranial surface of the shoulder, forming a direct continuation of the clavotrapezius (Fig. 68, d). These two are frequently described as constituting a single muscle, the cephalohumeral or cephalobrachial. (The clavobrachial is frequently given the name clavodeltoid; as its homology with the human clavodeltoid appears doubtful, it seems well to use the name clavobrachial, as proposed by Clasen.) Origin. —Its superficial fibres are continuations of the 158 THE MUSCLES. Fic. 75.—MUSCLES ON THE LATERAL SURFACE OF THE ARM. a, M. supraspinatus; 4, | part of insertion of M. rhom- boideus; ¢, M. infraspinatus; d, M. teres major; e, M. spi- nodeltoideus; 7, M. acromio- deltoideus; g, caput longum of M. triceps brachii; 2, caput laterale of M. triceps brachii; z,M. brachialis; 7, M. biceps; k, M. brachioradialis; 7, M. extensor carpi radialis lon- gus; m, M. extensor com- munis digitorum (72’, tendon of same); 7, M. extensor la- teralis digitorum; (7z’ tendon of same); o, M. extensor carpi ulnaris (0', tendon of same); ~, M. extensor indicis proprius; g, fifth head of M, flexor profundus digitorum; rv, m. flexorcarpi ulnaris. 1, vertebral border of the scap- ula; 2, spine of the scapula; 3, greater tuberosity of the humerus; 4, olecranon; 5, transverse ligament of the wrist. MUSCLES OF THE THORACIC LIMBS. 159 clavotrapezius (Fig. 68, @); other fibres have origin from the clavicle and from a raphe laterad of the clavicle which is com- mon to this muscle and the clavotrapezius. It passes distad along the cranial surface of the arm, growing narrower as it appreaches the convexity of the elbow. Insertion.—Eight to ten millimeters from the ulna it joins the brachialis muscle Oe: 79, 2) to be inserted with it by a flat tendon (Fig. 79, 2; Fig. 87, c) upon a rough area on the medial surface of the ies just distad of the semilunar notch, and about midway between the dorsal and ventral borders. Relations. — Outer surface with the integument. Inner surface with the pectoralis major (Fig. 65, /), biceps (Fig. 77, £), lateral head of the triceps (Fig. 75, %), acromiodeltoid (Fig. 75, 7), and brachialis (Fig. 80, %). Medial border with the pectoantibrachialis (Fig. 65, mm). Lateral border free except near the insertion, where it is in relation with the brachialis. Action.—Flexor of the antibrachium. M. supraspinatus (Fig. 75, a) occupies the whole of the supraspinatus fossa of the scapula. It is covered by strong fascia which stretches from the free edge of the spine to the coracoid border of the scapula and to the coracoid half of its vertebral border. Origin (Fig. 76, 6) by fleshy fibres from the whole surface of the supraspinatus fossa, from the above-mentioned fascia, and from the subscapularis (Fig. 77, @) craniad of the coracoid border of the scapula. Insertion (Fig. 83, a@).—It passes over the capsule of the shoulder-joint, to which it is closely attached, and is inserted into the free border of the great tuberosity ventrad (or proxi- mad) of the fossa for the infraspinatus (Fig. 83, c). Relations.—Outer surface with the spinotrapezius (Fig. 68, 7), acromiotrapezius (Fig. 68, 2), levator scapule ventralis (Fig. 68, /), clavotrapezius (Fig. 68, @),.and cleidomastoid (Fig. 65, %). Inner surface with the scapula. The distal end of the coracoid border is closely related to the pectoralis minor (Fig. 79, f). The glenoid border is related to the origin of the deltoidei. 160 THE MUSCLES. Action.—Extends the humerus after it has been flexed on the scapula. M. infraspinatus (Fig. 75, c).—This fills the infraspinatus fossa, its fibres converging to the insertion on the great tuber- osity of the humerus. Origin (Fig. 76, @).—By fleshy fibres from the whole infra- spinatus fossa, and by a raphe between it and the teres major Fic, 76.—LATERAL SURFACE OF THE SCAPULA, WITH THE AREAS OF ATTACH- MENT OF MUSCLES. | a, M. infraspinatus; 4, M. supraspinatus; c, origin of M. biceps; ¢, M. acromio- deltoideus; ¢, M. teres minor: _/, M. levator scapulz ventralis; g, M. spinodeltoideus; A, M. acromiotrapezius; z, M. rhomboideus; 7, M. teres major; 4-/, line of insertion of M. spinotrapezius. (Fig. 75, @), and sometimes by fibres from the teres minor (Fig. 80, c), triceps, spinodeltoideus (Fig. 75, ¢), spinotrapezius (Fig. 68, 7), and subscapularis (Fig. 77, a). Insertion (Fig. 83, ¢).—By a flat tendon which passes over the capsule of the joint, into the ventral half of the infraspinatus fossa on the great tuberosity of the humerus. (The dorsal half of the fossa is covered by a synovial bursa.) ; Relations.—Outer* surface with the spinotrapezius (Fig. 68, 7), spinodeltoid (Fig. 68, 2), acromiodeltoid (Fig. 68, g), teres major (Fig. 75, @), and levator scapule ventralis (Fig. —_ MUSCLES OF THE THORACIC LIMBS. 161 68, 7). Inner surface with the scapula. Glenoid border with the teres minor (Fig. 80, c), the teres major (Fig. 75, @), and the long head of the triceps (Fig. 75, ¢). Action.—Rotates the humerus outward. M. teres minor (Fig. 80, c).—A small muscle from the glenoid border of the scapula to the proximal end of the humerus. Origin (Fig. 76, e) by a sheet of tendinous fibres from the glenoid border of the scapula beginning about one-fifth the length of the border from the glenoid fossa and extending to its middle. It is often attached to the infraspinatus (Fig. 80, 4) and the caput longum of the triceps (Fig. 75, 2). Insertion (Fig. 83, @) by a short tendon into the tubercle just distad of the infraspinatus fossa on the great tuberosity of the humerus. Relations. —Outer surface with the spinodeltoideus (Fig. 75, €), acromiodeltoideus (Fig. 75, /), and the infraspinatus (Fig. 80, 6). Inner surface with the lateral (Fig. 75, Z) and long (Fig. 75, g) heads of the triceps and the capsule of the joint. Action.—Assists the infraspinatus to rotate the humerus outward. B. MUSCLES ON THE MEDIAL SURFACE OF THE SHOULDER. | (Fig. 77.) M. subscapularis (Fig. 77, @a).—A triangular mass from the subscapular fossa to the lesser tuberosity of the humerus. Origin (Fig. 78, a).—From the whole subscapular fossa except along the fusiform area for the attachment of the levator scapule and the serratus anterior near the vertebral border, and except over a quadrangular area about one centimeter long near the glenoid angle. The origin is by fleshy fibres directly — from the periosteum except along two or three lines marked by oblique ridges. To these lines are attached tendinous fibres. At the glenoid border the area of origin sometimes occupies part or the whole of the surface of the fossa for the origin of the teres major, so that the teres arises from the fascia on the sur- face of the subscapularis. At the coracoid border some of the fibres may take origin from the adjacent fascia of the supra- spinatus (Fig. 77, @). 162 THE MUSCLES. Insertion (Fig. 82, 6).—-The fibres converge. to the glenoid border, and the insertion is by a strong, flat tendon into the dorsal border of the lesser tuberosity of the humerus. . Relations. — Lateral surface with the scapula and the capsule of the shoulder-joint. Medial surface with the levator scapule (Fig. 73, 2), ser- ratus anterior (Fig. 73, 2), part of the scalenus (Fig. 73, f), the transversus cos- tarum (Fig. 73, 7), and the coracobrachialis (Fig. 77, /). Cranial border with the supraspina- tus (Fig. 77, d@)._ Caudal border Fic. 77.—MuscLEs ON THE MEDIAL SIDE OF THE ARM. M. epitrochlearis, M. clavobrachialis, and the breast-muscles have been removed. a, M. subscapularis; 4, insertion of M. levator scapulze and of M. serratus anterior; c, M. teres major; d, M. supraspinatus; e, M. latissimus dorsi (e’, cut edge of that part which becomes united with the bicipital arch); 7, M. coracobrachialis; g, M. biceps brachii (the capsule of the joint has been laid open to show its tendon); 4, cut insertions of pectoralis muscles; z, caput longum of M. tri- ceps brachii; 7, long portion of caput mediale of M. triceps brachii; %, intermediate portion of caput mediale of M. triceps brachii; 7, short por- tion of caput mediale of M. triceps brachii; 7, cut end of M. clavobrachialis; 7, M. brachiora- dialis; 0, M. extensor carpi radialis longus: J, M. extensor carpi radialis brevis; g, M. pro- nator teres; 7, M. flexor carpi radialis; s, M. palmaris longus (s’, its tendons); ¢, M. flexor carpi ulnaris (¢, ulnar head; ¢’, humeral head); z, third head of M. flexor profundus digitorum; 2’, fifth head of M. flexor profundus digitorum; z’’, one of the tendons of M. flexor profundus digitorum; v, M, pronator quadratus; w, M. abductor brevis pollicis; «, ulnar part of M. flexor sublimis digi- torum. I, transverse ligament of the wrist. ee Se See en el ee , od sai ae. - the serratus anterior (Fig. 73, 2), MUSCLES OF THE THORACIC LIMBS, 163 with the teres major (Fig. 77, ¢) and infraspinatus (Fig. 75, ¢). Action.—Pulls the humerus inward (mediad). M. teres major (Fig. 75, d; Fig. 77, c).—A thick muscle, triangular in cross-section, lying parallel with the glenoid border of the scapula. Origin (Fig. 76,7; Fig. 78, 0) from the vertebral one-third of the glenoid border of the scapula, and from fascia covering the subscapularis (Fig. 77, a) and the infraspinatus (Fig. 75, ¢) over a small area near the gleno- vertebral angle of the scapula. It may touch the insertion of the rhomboideus. Insertion (Fig. 82, f) by a tendon common to it and the latissimus dorsi (Fig. 79, @’), as already described. Relations. — Outer surface with the caput longum (Fig. 75, g) and the long portion (Fig. 80, f) of the caput mediale of the triceps, the latissimus dorsi (Fig. 77, ¢), and the cutaneus maximus. Inner surface with . Fic. 78.—MEDIAL SURFACE OF THE seeeomenus. (Fig. 73, 7), the “cusecra “with. THE AREAS OF transversus costarum (Fig. 73,7), © ATTACHMENT oF MuscLeEs. and the biceps (Fig 27, £) a, M. subscapularis; 4, M. teres major; F : > ; c, M serratus anterior; d, M. levator Dorsal border with the subscapu- scapule; ¢, M. rhomboideus; 4, M. oc- : : . : cipitoscapularis; g, M. biceps; 4, M. laris (Fig. 77> a) and infraspina- coracobrachialis; 7, caput longum of M. tus (Fig. 75, c). triceps. Action.—Rotates the humerus inward and flexes it in oppo- sition to the infraspinatus, teres minor, and the deltoidei. 164 THE MUSCLES 2. Muscles of the Brachium or Upper Arm. M. clavobrachialis and the pectoralis group (Fig. 65, page 10g) lie partly in this region; they have been described. M. coracobrachialis (Fig. 77, /; Fig. 79, c).—A very short muscle covering the inner (medial) surface of the capsule of the shoulder-joint. It extends from the coracoid process _to the proximal end of the humerts. Origin (Fig. 78, 4).—By a round tendon from the tip of the coracoid process. Insertion (Fig. 82, ¢) usually by fleshy fibres on an area five to eight millimeters long and about half as wide, which lies on the medial side of the humerus parallel with the ridge which runs from the dorsal end of the lesser tuberosity to the shaft and close to it. The proximal end of the area is about one centimeter from the proximal end of the head of the humerus. Relations.—Medial surface with the biceps (Fig. 77, g), pectoralis minor (Fig. 65, 0), and teres major (Fig. 77, ¢). Lateral surface with the capsule of the shoulder-joint. Dorsal border with the subscapularis (Fig. 77, a) and the long portion. of the caput mediale of the triceps (Fig. 77, 7). Action.—Adducts the humerus. The part of the coracobrachialis just described is known as the short head. A Jong head is sometimes found. It is a conical bundle of fibres of varying size, which arises from the tendon of origin of the short head. It passes distad into a long and extremely slender tendon, the insertion of which varies greatly in different individuals. It is commonly on the humerus in the region of the supracondyloid foramen. M. epitrochlearis or extensor antibrachii longus (Fig. 65, v).—A thin, flat muscle on the inner or medial side of the brachium, from the lateral surface of the latissimus dorsi (Fig. 65, 7) to the olecranon process of the ulna. Origin from the lateral or outer surface of the ventral border of the latissimus dorsi (Fig. 65, g) near the insertion of the cutaneus maximus.* Fibres are often attached to the teres major and the pectoralis minor. 7 Insertion by a flat tendon which is closely connected with MUSCLES OF THE THORACIC LIMBS. 165 that of the pectoantibrachialis (Fig. 65, 7) and is continuous with the general antibrachial fascia, into the caudal border of the cutaneous (dorsal) surface of the olecranon process of the ulna. Relations.—Outer (medial) surface with the integument, the latissimus dorsi (Fig. 65, g), and the cutaneus maximus. Inner (lateral) surface with the biceps (Fig. 65, 7), caput longum (Fig. 65, s), and caput mediale (Fig. 77, 7, £) of the triceps. Action.—Extends the antibrachium and tends to supinate the hand by rotating the ulna. M. biceps brachii (Fig. 77, ¢; Fig. 65, 2).—A thick, fusi- form muscle lying on the front (ventral) surface of the humerus. Origin (Fig. 76, c) by a strong, round tendon from the bicipital tubercle of the glenoid angle of the scapula, at its coracoid margin. (In man there is a second head—coracoid head—from the coracoid process.) The tendon passes through the capsule of the joint and then along the bicipital groove, which is converted into a canal by a strong ligament. Insertion by a rounded tendon (Fig. 87, 4) on the bicipital tuberosity of the radius (Fig. 86, £). Relations.—The tendon of origin passes through the capsule of the joint, which is covered by a part of the pectoralis minor. The muscle is then spanned for the middle part of its course by the bicipital arch (Fig. 65, ¢’), a description of which is given below. Farther distad it is covered by the clavobrachial (Fig. 65, #) and epitrochlearis (Fig. 65, 7). At its distal end (Fig. 79, 7’) the muscle passes between the pronator teres on the radial side and the conjoined tendon of the brachialis and clavobrachial (Fig. 79, z’) on the other. The biceps lies throughout most of its length on the ventral surface of the humerus, and touches along the medial border of its inner sur- face the coracobrachialis (Fig. 77, f), the teres major, (Fig. 77, c), the intermediate portion of the caput mediale of the triceps (Fig. 77, &), and the short portion (Fig. 77, /) of the same. Its lateral border touches the pectoralis minor (Fig. 65, 0) and the brachialis (Fig. 79, z). Action.—Flexes the forearm, and tends to supinate the hand. 166 THE MUSCLES. The bicipital arch (Fig. 65, #’) is a tendinous arch formed over the biceps muscle. Its outer or lateral pillar is formed by the tendon of the pectoralis minor (0), to which may be added part of the latissimus (g) tendon. Its inner or medial pillar is formed by the conjoined tendon of the teres major and latissimus dorsi (Fig. 79, d@’), while the xiphihumeralis (Fig. 65, £), cutaneus maximus (Fig. 62, 6), and epitrochlearis (Fig. 65, 7) are connected with one or the other pillar or with the muscles composing them. The caudal portion of the deep layer of the pectoralis major (Fig. 65, 7) may be connected with the inner pillar. M. brachialis (Fig. 79, 2; Fig. 75, 7).—From the lateral surface of the humerus to the ulna. Origin (Fig. 83, g, g’) from a long V-shaped line two to four millimeters wide on the lateral surface of the humerus. The apex of the V is just distad of the teres minor tubercle (@). Its dorsal limb (g’) extends along the lateral supracondyloid ridge to a point opposite the proximal margin of the supra- condyloid foramen; its ventral limb (g) extends in the direc- tion of the deltoid ridge to the middle of the bone. No muscle-fibres take origin between the two limbs. The fibres converge and end ina flat tendon which joins the tendon of the clavobrachial (Fig. 79, 2). Insertion (Fig. 87, c).—The dorsal portion of the depressed rough area on the lateral surface of the ulna just distad of the semilunar notch. Relations.—Outer surface with the acromiodeltoid (Fig. 75, /), the caput laterale of the triceps (Fig. 75, %), the brachioradialis (Fig. 75, #), and the proximal end of the ex- tensor carpi radialis longus (Fig. 75, 7). Inner surface with the humerus. Medial edge with the pectoralis major (Fig. 65, 2) and the biceps (Fig. 77, ¢). Action.—Flexor of the antibrachium. M. triceps brachii.—The triceps muscle of the cat, like that of man, is divisible (as its name indicates) into three main portions. These are a lateral portion (caput laterale), an intermediate or long portion (caput longum), and a medial por- . tion (caput mediale). The first two correspond to the simi- eee MUSCLES OF THE THORACIC LIMBS. 167 larly named heads in man; the medial portion falls into a number of subdivisions whose homologues are uncertain. Fic. 79.—DEEP MUSCLES ON THE MEDIAL SIDE OF THE HUMERUS. a, M. supraspinatus; 4, M. subscapularis; c, M. coracobrachialis; @, M. teres major (@’, its tendon); ¢, part of M. latissimus dorsi joining the teres major; /, cut end of M. pectoralis minor; g, long part of caput mediale of M. triceps brachii; /, in- termediate part of caput mediale of M. triceps; z, M. brachialis (2’, its tendon); 7, short part of caput mediale of M. triceps; 2, cut end of M. clavobrachialis; /, 7’, cut ends . of M. biceps; 7, M. brachioradialis; 7, M. extensor carpi radialis longus; 0, M. ex- tensor carpi radialis brevis; /, fifth head of M. flexor profundus digitorum; g, first head of M. flexor profundus digitorum. 1, humerus; 2, olecranon; 3, medial epi- condyle of humerus. Caput laterale (anconeus lateralis) (Fig. 75, 4; Fig. 68, 7). —The lateral portion is a flat muscle (most of it subcutaneous) on the lateral side of the brachium, connecting the proximal end of the humerus with the olecranon process of the ulna. 168 THE MUSCLES. Origin (Fig. 81, /’).—By a flat tendon trom the proximal portion of the deltoid ridge and the distal border of the teres minor tubercle. Insertion (Fig. 86, c) by a thin, flat tendon into the lateral border of the dorsal surface of the ulna between a point oppo- site the distal margin of the semilunar notch and the proximal end of the olecranon. Relations.—Lateral surface with the integument, and at the ' proximal end with the spinodeltoid and acromiodeltoid (Fig. 75,eand f). Medial surface with the brachialis (Fig. 75, 2), the caput longum (g), the caput mediale, the brachioradialis (2), the anconeus (Fig. 80, 7), and the origins of the extensor carpi radialis longus (Fig. 75, /), the extensor communis digitorum (m), and the extensor digitorum lateralis (7). Caput longum (anconeus longus) (Fig. 75, g; Fig. 68, 2; Fig. 77, z).—A prismatic, fusiform mass connecting the scapula with the olecranon. Origin (Fig. 78, 2) by a thick, flat tendon from a triangular area one or two centimeters long at the glenoid end of the scapula on the glenoid border. The base of the area is about one millimeter from the margin of the glenoid fossa. Insertion (Fig. 86, 6).—The muscle ends in a thick tendon which passes over the bifurcated ventral end of the olecranon and is inserted upon the rounded tuberosity which forms the dorsal angle of the olecranon. Relations.—Lateral surface with the caput laterale (Fig. 75, #), a portion of the caput mediale (Fig. 77, 7 and &), the spinodeltoid (Fig. 75, ¢), the infraspinatus (Fig. 75, c), and the integument. Medial surface with the epitrochlearis (Fig. 65, ~) and the conjoined portions of the latissimus dorsi and teres major (Fig. 79, d’). Ventral border with the caput mediale (Fig. 77, 7 and &). : Caput mediale.—The medial head consists of three portions (Fig. 79, g, 2, 7)- (1) The long portion (anconeus posterior) (Fig. 77, 7; Fig. 79, &; Fig. 80, /). Origin (Fig. 83, ¢) from a triangular area on the dorsal sur- face of the humeral shaft. The base of the area is against the MUSCLES OF THE THORACIC LIMBS. 169 articular head, and its apex about one-sixth the length of the humerus from the head. It is between the coracobrachialis and the lateral head of the triceps. Fic. 80.—DEEP MUSCLES ON THE LATERAL SURFACE OF THE HUMERUS. a, part of M. supraspinatus; 4, part of M. infraspinatus; c, M. teres minor; d@, M. teres major; ¢, part of M. latissimus dorsi joining M. teres major; /, long part of caput mediale of M. triceps brachii; g, cut insertion of M. acromiodeltoideus; 4, M. brachi- alis; 7, M. brachioradialis; 7, intermediate part of caput mediale of M. triceps brachii; k, M. extensor carpi radialis longus; 7, M. anconeus; m, M. extensor communis digi- torum. I, great tuberosity of humerus; 2, 3, superficial radial and dorsal interos- seous branches, respectively, of the radial nerve. Insertion (Fig. 86, a).—The muscle ends in a long, slen- der tendon which passes through the furrow on the ventral 170 THE MUSCLES. angle of the olecranon and is inserted into an oblique ridge which forms the dorsal limit of the furrow. The tendon is separated from the floor of the furrow by a synovial bursa. (2) The intermediate portion (anconeus internus) (Fig. 77, .k; Fig..-79, #3: Fig. 80,:7). Origin (Fig. 82, g) by fleshy fibres from a triangular area proximad of the middle of the dorsomedial surface of the humerus. The length of the area equals about one-fourth the length of the bone. Its apex points proximad and is almost continuous with the apex of the area of origin of the long por- tion. Insertion (Fig. 87, 2) by short tendon-fibres into the medial border of the ventral and proximal surfaces of the olecranon. It is connected with the tendon of the long portion. (3) Short portion (Fig. 79, 7; Fig. 77, 7). Origin (Fig. 82, 2) from the outer surface of the bony bar which encloses the supracondyloid foramen of the humerus, as far as the medial epicondyle. Insertion (Fig. 87, e) by fleshy fibres into the medial border of the olecranon distad of the ey for the insertion of the caput longum. Relations of the caput mediale.—Lateral surface with the _ caput laterale (Fig. 75, %), the humerus, and the anconeus (Fig. 80, 7). Dorsal surface with the caput longum (Fig. 77, 2), the epitrochlearis (Fig. 65, 7), and the teres major (Fig. 79, @). Ventral surface with the biceps (Fig. 77, ¢). Action of the Triceps.—The entire triceps group forms a powerful extensor of the forearm. The short portion of the medial head tends also to rotate the arm outward, so as to supinate the hand. M. anconeus (Fig. 80, /).—A triangular muscle on the outside of the elbow-joint from the humerus to the ulna. Origin (Fig. 83, 2).—An irregularly triangular area at the distal end of the dorsal surface of the humerus. ‘The area of origin is limited laterally by the sharp lateral supracondyloid ridge. It sometimes extends onto the lateral epicondyle. Lnsertion (Fig. 86, d).—The lateral surface of the ulna from the distal margin of the semilunar notch to the proximal end “MUSCLES OF THE THORACIC LIMBS. 171 Fic. 81.—VENTRAL Sur- Fic. 82.—MEDIAL SIDE FIG, 83.—DORSAL SURFACE FACE OF HUMERUS, OF HUMERUS, WITH OF THE LEFT HUMERUS, WITH THE AREAS OF THE AREAS OF AT- WITH THE AREAS OF ATTACHMENT OF Mus- TACHMENT OF Muvws- ATTACHMENT OF Muws- CLES. CLES. CLES. Fig. 81.—a, M. subscapularis; 4, M. supraspinatus; c, Mm. teres major and latis- simus dorsi; ¢, M. pectoralis minor; ¢, deep layer of M. pectoralis major; /, super- ficial layer of M. pectoralis major; g, M. acromiodeltoideus; 4, M. spinodeltoideus; fh’, caput laterale of M. triceps; 7, M. brachialis; 7, second portion of M. brachialis; k, M. extensor carpi radialis longus; /, M. extensor carpi radialis brevis; #, M. ex- tensor communis digitorum; 7, M. extensor lateralis digitorum; 0, M. extensor carpi ulnaris; #, short portion of caput mediale of M. triceps; 7, M. pronator teres; 7, M. palmaris longus; s. third and fourth parts of M. flexor profundus digitorum; 7, M. flexor carpi radialis; «, second head of M. flexor profundus digitorum. Fig. 82.—a, M. supraspinatus; 4, M. subscapularis; ¢, M. pectoralis minor; d, long portion of caput mediale of M. triceps; ¢, M. coracobrachialis; 7, Mm. teres major and latissimus dorsi; g, intermediate portion of caput mediale of M. triceps; 4, deep layer of M. pectoralis major; 7, superficial layer of M. pectoralis major; 7, M. anconeus; , short portion of caput mediale of M. triceps; 4 M. pronator teres; m, M, flexor carpi radialis; 2, second head of M. flexor profundus digitorum; 9, third and fourth heads of M. flexor profundus digitorum; 7, M. palmaris longus; g, M. flexor carpi ulnaris. Fig. 83.—a, M. supraspinatus; 4, M. subscapularis; c, M. infraspinatus; d, M. teres minor; ¢, long portion of caput mediale of M triceps; 7, M. coracobrachialis; & &, M. brachialis; Z, intermediate portion of caput mediale of M. triceps; z, M. anconeus; 7, short portion of medial head of M. triceps; 2, M. pronator teres; 4 second and third heads of M. flexor profundus digitorum; #, M. palmaris longus; n, M. extensor carpi ulnaris. 172 THE MUSCLES. of the olecranon. The muscle covers the capsule of the joint and is closely adherent to it. Relations. —Outer (dorsal) surface with the caput laterale (Fig. 75, 2) and the intermediate portion (Fig. 80, 7) of the caput mediale. Inner surface with the bones and the capsule of the joint. Action.—Keeps the capsule tense and probably rotates the ulna slightly so as to pronate the hand. 3. Muscles of the Antibrachium or Forearm. Fascia of the Forearm.—The muscles of the forearm are not in contact with the skin, but are covered by the strong antibrachial fascia. This consists of two layers. The super- ficial one is a continuation of the general subcutaneous fascia of the arm; it covers the forearm as a continuous sheet which becomes thinner distad, and is finally lost near the wrist. The deep layer forms a dense, tendinous sheet which is closely applied to the muscles. It begins partly as a continuation of the general fascia of the arm, partly from the tendons of the triceps and epitrochlearis muscles. The sheet is attached to the dorsal surface of the ulna, between the extensor carpi ulnaris‘and the first head of the flexor profundus digitorum. It surrounds the forearm as a continuous sheath. On the lateral surface it dips between the extensor muscles, becoming closely attached to them and forming a partial sheath for each; it is attached with special firmness to their tendons. On the medial side of the arm the fascia passes smoothly over the flexors without dipping between them; it is continuous, however, with the border of the pronator teres, and distad of this muscle it is firmly attached to the radius. at At the wrist the fascia becomes attached to the longitudinal ridges on the dorsal surface of the head of the radius, bridging thus the intervening grooves and holding the tendons in place between the ridges. The fascia then continues to form the dorsal fascia of the hand. On the ventral side of the wrist the fascia becomes thickened to form a strong transverse ligament (Fig. 77, 1), which is attached at its radial and ulnar ends to the carpus, and which holds in place the tendons of the MUSCLES OF THE THORACIC LIMBS. 173 flexor muscles. Distad of the transverse ligament the fascia spreads out in the palm of the hand, and becomes united with the fibrous pad which is situated here. On the fingers the fascia becomes attached to the phalanges, forming tendinous sheaths, the so-called vaginal ligaments, for- the flexor muscles. Near the base and the head of the first phalanx strong, narrow, ring-like bands, the annular ligaments (Fig. 88, 2), are formed in these sheaths; these surround and bind down the tendons of the flexor muscles. A. MUSCLES ON THE ULNAR AND DORSAL SIDE OF THE FOREARM (extensors and supinators) (Fig. 75, p. 158). _M. brachioradialis or supinator longus (Fig. 75, 2; Fig. 77, n).—This is a ribbon-like muscle lying on the lateral side of the brachium and the ventrolateral border of the antibra- chium just beneath the superficial fascia. It connects the humerus and the radius. Origin.—By a thin tendon from about the middle fifth of the dorsal border of the humerus, or sometimes proximad of the middle. The muscle curves over the outer surface of the brachialis (Fig. 75, 2), to which it is closely applied, and runs along the lateral border of the antibrachium to its insertion. Insertion by a short tendon into the ridge which forms the ventral limit of the groove on the outer surface of the styloid process of the radius and upon the adjacent ligaments. Relations.—Outer surface with the integument, and at the proximal end with the caput laterale of the triceps (Fig. 75, %). Inner surface with the brachialis (2), the extensor carpi radialis longus (/) and brevis, and the extensor communis digitorum (7). Action. —Supinator of the hand. M. extensor carpi radialis longus (Fig. 75, 7; Fig. 77, o).—This lies along the radial side of the forearm, and con- nects the humerus and the second metacarpal. Origin (Fig. 81, &) from the middle portion of the lateral supracondyloid ridge between the origin of the brachialis (7) and the anconeus. About the middle of the forearm the muscle ends in a slender tendon (Fig. 84, ¢) which passes through the groove on the radial side of the dorsal surface of the distal end of the radius. 174 THE MUSCLES. Insertion (Fig. 84, ¢).—The tendon passes across the car- pus and is inserted onto the dorsal surface of the base of the second metacarpal on the radial side just distad of the groove for the radial artery. Relations.—-Outer surface at the proximal end with the caput laterale of the triceps (Fig. 75, %), farther distad with the integument and the brachioradialis (£); the distal tendon with the extensor pollicis brevis (Fig. 84, d). Radial surface with the brachialis (Fig. 75, 2) and the integument. Ulnar ~ surface with the extensor carpi radialis brevis (Fig. 77, f), and near the proximal end with the extensor communis digitorum (Fig. 75, 7). Action.—Extensor of the hand. M. extensor carpi radialis brevis (Fig. 77, ).—A slender muscle from the humerus to the third metacarpal. Origin (Fig. 81, 7) from the distal part of the lateral supra- condyloid ridge distad of the extensor longus. Near the carpus the muscle ends in a slender tendon which passes through the groove with the extensor longus tendon. The tendon then diverges from the extensor longus and has its Insertion (Fig. 84, f) into the radial side of the dorsal sur- face of the base of the third metacarpal. Relations.—Outer surface with the extensor longus (Fig. 77, 0), the integument, and distad with the extensor pollicis brevis (Fig. 84, d@). Radial surface with the extensor longus. | Ulnar surface with the extensor communis digitorum (Fig. 75, m) and the extensor brevis pollicis. Inner surface with the pronator teres (Fig. 77, 7), supinator (Fig. 85, 4), and extensor brevis pollicis (Fig. 85, a). Action.—Extensor of the hand. M. extensor digitorum communis (Fig. 75, #).—A slen- der muscle from the lateral supracondyloid ridge of the humerus to the phalanges of the second, third, fourth, and fifth digits. Origin (Fig. 81, m).—The distal surface of the lateral supracondyloid ridge dorsad of the origin of the extensor carpi radialis brevis. At the junction ofthe middle and distal thirds of the radius the muscle passes into a large, flat tendon (Fig. 75, 7’) which passes PRN On cp i i -(7) and extensor brevis. Ulnar surface MUSCLES OF THE THORACIC LIMBS. 175 through the groove on the middle of the dorsal surface of the distal end of the radius. The groove is converted into a canal by a strong transverse ligament. The tendon divides near the groove into four portions (Fig. 84, a) which diverge and pass to the four ulnar digits. Insertions. — Each division of the tendon as it passes over the dorsal sur- face of the first phalanx has its border connected by strong fascia to the dorsal surface of the phalanx. It finally passes through the groove at the distal end of the first phalanx and is inserted mostly into the base of the second phalanx; a portion continues distad to be inserted into the third phalanx. Relations. —Outer surface with the integument and at the origin with the caput laterale (Fig. 75, 2) of the triceps. Radial surface with the extensor longus with the extensor digitorum lateralis (7). Inner surface with the supinator (Fig. 85, 4) and the extensor pollicis brevis Fig. a). ( 8s 85; ) Fic. 84. ARRANGEMENT OF Action.—Extensor of the four ulnar +He Tenpons oN THE digits. BACK OF THE HAND. eal : a, M. extensor communis M. extensor digitorum lateralis digitorum: 4, M. extensor late- Fig. mz). (This corresponds i si- Talis digitorum; ¢, M. exten- ( S- 75,2). ( : be P : d 7 geie sor indicis; ¢, M. extensor tion to the extensor digiti quinti proprius brevis pollicis; ¢, M. extensor of man.) carpi radialis longus; 7, M. ioe : extensor carpi radialis brevis; Origin (Fig. 81, z) from the lateral g, M. extensor carpi ulnaris; ° : hk, tendons of the interossei. supracondyloid ridge of the humerus ,’ transverse ligament of the distad of the origin of the extensor wrist. communis. The muscle passes along the ulnar border and dorsal surface of the forearm between the extensor communis (Fig. 75, 7) and the extensor carpiulnaris(0). Near the carpusit ends ina tendon 176 THE MUSCLES. (z'), which divides immediately into three or four (Fig. 84, 6). These pass through the groove on the ulnar side of the dorsal surface of the radius and diverge to the digits lying beneath the extensor communis tendon. Insertion (Fig. 84, 6).—The three tendons on the ulnar side join the ulnar sides of the tendons of the extensor com- munis (a) at their insertions. The radial of the four tendons (not always present) joins the tendon of the extensor indicis (c) and may also give a branch to the radial side of the base of the - first phalanx of the third digit. Relations.—Outer surface with the integument. Radial border with the extensor communis digitorum (wz); ulnar border with the extensor carpi ulnaris (0). Inner surface with the supinator (Fig. 85, 4) and the extensor brevis pollicis (Fig. 85, a); distad with the extensor indicis (Fig. 85, c). Action.—Extensor of the four ulnar digits. M. extensor carpi ulnaris (Fig. 75, 0). | Origin.—(1) By a short, broad tendon from the distal por- tion of the lateral epicondyle of the humerus (Fig. 81, a) distad of the origin of the extensor lateralis, and (2) by a smaller tendon from the ulna at the dorsal tip of the semilunar notch (Fig. 86, @). The muscle passes along the ulnar side of the forear dorsad of the extensor digitorum lateralis (7). It ends near the junction of the middle and distal thirds of the forearm in a large, flat tendon (0’) which is closely adherent to the ligaments of the wrist and which passes over the distal end of the ulna to its Insertion into the tubercle on the ulnar side of the base of the fifth metacarpal (Fig. 34, g). Relations.—Outer surface with the integument. Radial (or ventral) border with the extensor digitorum lateralis (Fig. 75, 2); ulnar (or dorsal) border with the flexor profundus digi- torum (g). Inner surface with the radius, the extensor indicis Fig. 85, c), and the extensor pollicis brevis (Fig. 85, a). Action.—Indicated by its name. M. extensor indicis (proprius) (Fig. 85, c; Fig. 75, f) (in- cludes extensor pollicis longus also). eT ee ee ie ti RS SRE GR SACS Aan Ae ERE RR a abate ee clin MUSCLES OF THE THORACIC LIMBS. ie Origin (Fig. 86, 7) by short, fleshy fibres from the lateral surface of the ulna between the semilunar notch and the junc- tion of the third and fourth (distal) fourths. The muscle-fibres pass obliquely distad and toward the radial side and join the tendon (Fig. 85, c’), which runs nearly the whole length of the radial surface. Insertion (Fig. 84, c).—The tendon passes through the groove on the ulnar side of the dorsal surface of the base of the radius and divides into two. Both of these usually go to the base of the second phalanx of the second digit, but one may pass to the pollex, or there may be three divisions going to the first three digits. j Fic, 85.—DEEP MUSCLES ON THE EXTENSOR SURFACE OF THE RADIUS AND ULNA. a, M. extensor brevis pollicis (a’, its tendon); 4, M. supinator; ¢c, M. extensor in- dicis (c’, its tendon); @, tendon of M. extensor carpi radialis brevis; ¢, tendon of M. extensor carpi radialis longus. 1, humerus; 2, olecranon; 3, styloid process of ulna; 4, distal end of radius; 5, head of radius. Relations.—Outer surface with the integument, the extensor carpi ulnaris (Fig. 75, 0), and the extensor digitorum lateralis (Fig. 75, 2). Dorsal border with the flexor profundus digi- torum (Fig. 75, g). Inner surface with the extensor brevis pollicis (Fig. 85, a). Action as indicated by the name. M. supinator (Fig. 85, 4).—A flat muscle wrapped spirally about the proximal end of the radius. Origin by a short, strong tendon from the lateral side of the annular ligament of the radius and by tendinous fibres from the radial collateral ligament passing from the humerus to the radius. From the tendon of origin the fibres diverge, passing toward the radial side and distad. Insertion (Fig. 86, g).—The dorsal and part of the ventral surface of the proximal two-fifths of the radius to within 178 THE MUSCLES five millimeters of the articular face of the head. Relations.—Outer surface with the ex- tensor carpi radialis brevis, extensor com- munis digitorum (Fig. 75, #), and extensor lateralis digitorum (Fig. 75, 2). Radial | border with the pronator teres (Fig. 77, ¢). : \E wy Inner surface with the radius. Action.—Supinator of the hand. M. extensor brevis pollicis or extensor ossis metacarpi pollicis (Fig. 85, @) (includes M. abductor longus pollicis of man). Origin (Fig. 86, 2) by fleshy fibres from the ventral half of the lateral surface of the shaft of the ulna from the semilunar notch to the styloid process; from the ulnar half of 4 the dorsal surface of the radius from the i a7 bicipital: tubercle -to a short distance distad of the middle of the bone; and from the interosseous membrane between these two E J areas. The fibres converge to form a strong, | flat tendon (Fig. 84, 2) which passes obliquely over the tendons of the extensor carpi radialis longus (e) and brevis (/) to its Insertion into the radial side of the base Fic. 86. — Laterat Of the first metacarpal. The radial sesamoid OR EXTENSOR SUR- hone of the wrist is imbedded in the tendon FACE OF RADIUS AND ener: : ULNA, WITH THE at its insertion. caonar Poe is acs Relations.—Outer surface with the ex- a, long portion of tensor carpi radialis brevis, the extensor caput mediale of M. : i . . triceps; 4, caput lon- CoOmmunis digitorum (Fig. 75, m), extensor gum of M. triceps; ¢ Jateralis digitorum (Fig. 75, ), and extensor caput laterale of M. tri- . dici Fi 8 I f ‘th th ceps; d, M. anconeus; indicis (Fig. 85, c). Inner surface wi e e, M. extensor carpi radius and ulna, and distad with the tendons ulnaris; 7, M. extensor indicis; g, M. supina- of the two extensores carpi radiales (Fig. tor; #, M. extensor brevis pollicis; 7, M. 84, ¢ and /). ‘ pronator teres; 7, M. Action.—Extends and abducts the pol- flexor profundus digi- 1 torum; 4, M. biceps. ex. SO Oy ee MUSCLES OF THE THORACIC LIMBS. 179 B. MUSCLES ON THE RADIAL AND VENTRAL SIDE OF THE FOREARM (flexors and pronators). M. pronator teres (Fig. 77, ¢). . Origin (Fig. 82, 7) by a short strong tendon from the extremity of the medial epicondyle of the humerus. ' Insertion (Fig. 86, 2) by fleshy fibres and short tendinous fibres along the medial border of the radius, at its middle. The radial edge of the muscle is continuous with the strong deep layer of the antibrachial fascia. Relations.—Outer surface with the superficial fascia. Radial border with the tendon of the biceps (Fig. 79, 7’), with the extensor carpi radialis brevis (Fig. 77, #), and the supinator (Fig. 85, 4). Ulnar border with the flexor carpi radialis (Fig. 77, r) and part of the flexor profundus digitorum (Fig. 77, ~). Action.—Pronates the hand by rotating the radius. M. flexor carpi radialis (Fig. 77, ~).—A slender fusiform muscle. Origin (Fig. 82, m) from the tip of the medial epicondyle of the humerus. Insertion.—The slender tendon passes through a deep groove between the os magnum and the first metacarpal. The groove is converted into a canal by the overlying tendons and muscles. The tendon is finally inserted into the bases of the second and third metacarpals. Relations.—Outer surface with the pronator teres (Fig. 77, q), the superficial fascia, and the third head of the flexor profundus (z). Radial border with the pronator teres (¢). Ulnar border with the third and fourth heads of the flexor pro- fundus. Inner surface with the ulna proximad and the fifth head of the flexor profundus (z’) distad. Action indicated by the name. M. palmaris longus (Fig. 77, s).—A flat fusiform muscle beneath the fascia on the medial border of the forearm. Origin (Fig. 82, ~) by a short flat tendon from the distal part of the medial surface of the medial epicondyle of the humerus. About one centimeter from the wrist the muscle ends in a flat tendon which passes through the transverse ligament and divides on the hand into four or five (or sometimes only three) 180 THE MUSCLES. tendons (Fig. 77, s’) which diverge to the insertions. The ulnar portion of the flexor sublimis digitorum (Fig. 77, +) takes origin from the common tendon before its division. Insertion.—Each tendon except the first gives off a branch which spreads out in the trilobed pad in the palm. The middle two of these may be traced to the integument covering the pad. The tendon is then inserted (Fig. 88, a) near the base of the first phalanx onto the outer surface of the perforated portion of the flexor sublimis tendon (4, 6’) at its side, except that to the thumb, which divides near its distal end into two which are inserted into the sesamoid bones at the base of the first phalanx. The tendons of insertion are closely united to the fibrous pulley- ring at the base of the first phalanx, and each may send a slip to the base of the phalanx at either side of the ring. Relations. —Outer surface with the superficial fascia and one head of the flexor sublimis (Fig. 77, 7). Radial border with the flexor carpi radialis. Ulnar border with the flexor carpi ulnaris and a part of the flexor profundus digitorum. Inner surface with the flexor carpi radialis (7), the flexor carpi -ulnaris (2), the flexor profundus digitorum (z), and the radial head of the flexor sublimis digitorum. Action.—Flexor of the first phalanx of each of the digits. M. flexor carpi ulnaris (Fig. 77, ¢, 7). Origin. —There are two heads. The first or humeral head (?’) takes origin in common with the second part of the flexor profundus from the median surface of the distal end of the humerus just distad of the medial epicondyle (Fig. 82, g). The second or ulnar head (¢) takes origin by fleshy fibres from the lateral surface of the olecranon and from the dorsal border of the ulna from the olecranon to a point distad of the semilunar notch (Fig 87, /). The two heads join proximad of the middle of the forearm. The muscle passes obliquely across the ven- tral surface of the forearm to its Insertion by fleshy and tendinous fibres into the proximal surface of the pisiform bone. Relations. —Outer surface with the integument and the palmaris longus (Fig. 77, s). Inner surface and ulnar border with the flexor profundus digitorum. MUSCLES OF THE THORACIC LIMBS. 181 Action indicated by the name. M. flexor sublimis digitorum (or perforatus).—-This muscle is in two parts, which are given a common name only because of the similar structure and insertions of their tendons. The ulnar part (Fig. 77, x) is a conical muscle taking origin from the outer surface of the tendon and muscle of the palmaris longus and from the adjacent ligament. — It gives rise to two or three tendons (Fig. 88, 4) which arise from distinct slips of the muscle; these pass to the ulnar two or three digits. That passing to the fourth or fifth digit receives an accessory slip from a small mass of fibres attached to the transverse liga- ment on the radial side of the palmaris tendon. The radial part is a small flat triangular muscle which takes origin from the outer surface of the tendon formed by the junction of the tendons of the first and second parts of the flexor profundus. It divides into two slips, each giving rise to a tendon. These tendons (Fig. 88, 4’) pass to the second and third digits. That to the third digit may divide into two, one of which goes to the fourth digit. Each of the four tendons (Fig. 88, 4 and 0’) is perforated by a tendon of the flexor profundus (Fig. 88, c) as it passes through the fibrous pulley-ring at the base of the first phalanx. It then continues beneath the flexor profundus tendon through the second pulley-ring (2) and is inserted into the base of the second phalanx: Relations.—Outer surface of the ulnar part with the integu- ment; inner surface with the palmaris longus (Fig. 77, s). Outer surface of the radial part with the palmaris longus; inner surface with the flexor profundus. Action.—Flexor of the second phalanx of digits 2-5. M. flexor profundus digitorum (or perforans).—This arises by five heads, the tendons of which join one another at the wrist to make the strongest and deepest of the flexor tendons. The first or ulnar head has origin (Fig. 87, ¢) from the dor- sal half of the medial (radial) surface of the ulna from the proximal lip of the semilunar notch to within a centimeter of the styloid process. Its fibres converge to a large flat tendon which forms the lateral (ulnar) and superficial part of the common tendon. 182 Fic. 87.—Rapius AND ULNA, Medial or Flexor Side, with M. pronator quadratus and the Areas of Attachment of Other Muscles. a, M. pronator quadratus; 4, tendon of M. biceps; ¢, conjoined tendon of M. brachialis and M. clavobrachialis; @, insertion of caput longum of M. triceps; e¢, insertion of short portion of caput mediale of M. triceps; /, origin of M. flexor carpi ulnaris; g, origin of first head of M., flexor profundus digitorum; 4, origin of fifth head of M. flexor profun- dus digitorum; 2, intermediate portion of caput mediale of M. triceps. THE MUSCLES. The second head has origin (Fig. 82, 2) from the distal end of the medial epicondyle of the humerus between the flexor ulnaris and the third and fourth heads of the profun- dus. It may be very closely attached to these muscles at their origins. Its tendon joins the radial border of the tendon of the first head. From this junction the radial part of the flexor sublimis arises. | The third head (Fig. 77, u) has origin (Fig. 82, 0) by astrong tendon from the medial epicondyle of the humerus, between the palmaris (/) and flexor radialis (7). Its tendon forms the radial part of the common tendon. The fourth head has origin by a strong tendon from the medial epicon- dyle of the humerus just ventrad of the origin of the second head and the flexor ulnaris, to which many of its fibres are attached. Its tendon forms the middle and superficial part of the common tendon. The fifth or radial head (Fig. 75, q; Fig. 77, u’) has origin (Fig. 87, 2) from the middle third of the ventral surface of the shaft of the radius over an area limited by two oblique bony ridges; from the adjacent parts of the interosseous membrane; and from the ventral part of the medial surface of the shaft of the ulna between a point about two centimeters distad of the semi- lunar notch and the junction of the middle and distal thirds of the shaft. i i i a i MUSCLES OF THE THORACIC LIMBS. 183 Its very thick tendon forms the middle and deep part of the cominon tendon. The common tendon (Fig. 88, ¢’) covers the carpus and metacarpus ven-— trally. It divides into five tendons (c) which pass to the five digits and are zw- serted into the bases of the terminal phalanges. Those of the first four digits perforate the tendon of the flexor sublimis (6) at the base of the first phalanx of each digit. At the same place each. passes through a fibrous pulley-ring attached to the base of the phalanx. Each then passes through a second pulley-ring (2) near the head of the phalanx and is finally inserted into the base of the terminal phalanx. - Relations. — Outer surface with the pronator teres (Fig. 77, ¢@), flexor carpi radialis (Fig. 77, 7), palmaris longus (s), flexor carpi ulnaris (¢), integument, and extensor carpi ulnaris (Fig. 75, 0). Inner surface with the radius, ulna, interosseous membrane and pronator quadratus (Fig. 87, a). Action.—Flexor of all the digits. M. pronator quadratus (Fig. 87, a). —A thick quadrangular muscle whose fibres run obliquely between the distal ends of the ulna and radius. ‘Origin by fleshy fibres from about the distal half of the ventral (flexor) surface or border of the ulna and from the interos- seous membrane adjacent to the area. The fibres pass obliquely distad toward the radial side to their Insertion by fleshy fibres into the ven- Fic, 88.—ARRANGEMENT OF THE TENDONS of M. palmaris longus, M. flexor sublimis digito- rum, and M. flexor pro- fundus digitorum, with Mm, .lumbricales. The integument, fibrous pads, and the palmaris longus (except the ends of its tendons) have been re- moved; the flexor sublimis has been cut. a, cut ends of tendons of M. palmaris longus; 4, tendons of M. flexor sublimis digitorum, ulnar division; 4’, radial part of M. flexor sublimis digitorum; ¢, tendons of M. flexor profundus digi- torum (¢c’, the common ten- don); @, M. abductor digi- ti quinti; e, M. flexor brevis digiti quinti; 7, Mm. lum- bricales (/’, their tendons). I, transverse ligament of tral (flexor) surface of the radius distad of wrist: 2, annular ligaments. the area of origin of the fifth head of the profundus. 184 THE MUSCLES. Relations.—Outer surface with the flexor profundus. Inner surface with the radius, ulna, and interosseous membrane. Action as indicated by the name. 4. Muscles of the Hand. A. BETWEEN THE TENDONS.—Mm. lumbricales (Fig. 88, f, 7’).—Four small muscle in the palm of the hand. Origin by fleshy fibres from the outer (palmar) surface of the tendon common to the ulnar four parts of the profundus (c’). Insertion (f').—The four slips are flat at their origin. Each becomes cylindrical and curves about the base of one of the four ulnar digits and is inserted into the radial side of the base of the first phalanx close to its ventral border. Action.—Bend the digits toward the radial side. B. MUSCLES OF THE THUMB.—M. abductor brevis pollicis (Fig. 77, w) (in- cludes also the opponens pollicis of man). —A very minute, probably rudimentary muscle. a: Goi eae. Mosca Origin from the transverse ligament OF THE PALM oF THE (1) which connects the prominent fibrous, AND : . hairless projection that lies over the pisi- a, M. flexor brevis polli- i fi cis; 4, M. adductor pollicis; form bone with the radial border of the SG fae bewedigd head of the radius. The muscle passes secundi); @, M. adductor radiodistad and ends in a very slender fie Pangea IN ae tendon, the insertion of which is into the M. interosseus of fourth base of the first phalanx of the thumb. nde ieee M. flexor brevis pollicis (Fig. 89, a). fifth digit (M. flexor brevis Origin by fleshy fibres from the ad- digiti quinti); z, M. ab-. ductor digiti quinti. 1-5, Jacent borders of the os magnum and sca- the digits in order. pholunar bones and from the fascia which bridges the intervening groove for the flexor carpi radialis. Insertion by a short tendon into the base of the first phalanx of the pollex. Action. —Flexor of the thumb. ee ee ee es MUSCLES OF THE THORACIC LIMBS. 185 M. adductor pollicis (Fig. 89, 2). Origin by fleshy fibres from the ventral border of the os magnum. It curves about the base of the first metacarpal on its ulnar side to its insertion. Insertion by fleshy fibres into the base of the first phalanx of the pollex on its ulnar side. C. MuscLes LYING BETWEEN THE METACARPALS.— Mm. interossei (Fig. 89).—Small stout muscles lying on the palmar surfaces of the metacarpals of the second, third, fourth, and fifth digits. Origin by fleshy fibres from the ventral or lateral surfaces of the bases of the metacarpals. Near the distal end of the metacarpal each divides into two masses which pass onto the lateral surfaces of the metacarpal, so as to leave the ventral surface of the distal end exposed. Insertion partly onto the lateral surfaces of the base of the first phalanx and its sesamoids, and partly by a slender tendon (Fig. 84, h) which is continued dorsad to join the extensor tendon of the digit. D. SPECIAL MUSCLES OF THE SEGOND DIGIT (THE INDEX).—M. flexor brevis digiti secundi (or indicis).—This name may be applied to M. interosseus of the second digit (Fig. 89, ¢). M. abductor digiti secundi.—This name might be applied to a portion of the interosseus of the second digit which is sometimes differentiated from the remainder. Origin from the radial and ventral surfaces of the base of the second metacarpal, and from the ventral surface of the trapezium. Insertion into the radial side of the base of the first phalanx of the second digit and into its sesamoid. M. adductor digiti secundi (Fig. 89, 2). Origin from the ventral surface of the os magnum. Insertion into the ulnar side of the base of the first phalanx of the second digit. E. SPECIAL MUSCLES OF THE FIFTH DiGIT.—M. ab- ductor digiti quinti (Fig. 89, 7).—A thick, small, conical bundle. 186 THE MUSCLES. Origin from the distal surface of the pisiform bone and from the transverse ligament on the ulnar side of the pisiform. It ends in a slender tendon which runs along the ulnar side of the fifth metacarpal to its Jnsertion into the ulnar side of the base of the first phalanx of the fifth digit. | M. flexor brevis digiti quinti (Fig. 89, 2; Fig. 88, ¢).— This covers ‘the ventral surface of the fifth metacarpal, and is really the interosseus of this digit. Origin. by fleshy fibres from the ventral surface of the base of the fifth metacarpal; from the ventral process of the unci- form bone, and from the transverse ligament proximad of the fifth metacarpal. Insertion by fleshy fibres into the ventral border of the proximal end of the first phalanx of the fifth digit. M. opponens (adductor) digiti quinti (Fig. 89, 2). Origin by a flat tendon from the ventral surface of the os magnum on the ulnar side of the adductor pollicis (4). It passes toward the ulnar side and distad, the fibres diverging to their Insertion (1) into nearly the whole of the radial surface of’ the fifth metacarpal, (2) into the base of its first phalanx. V. MUSCLES OF THE PELVIC LIMBS. 1. Muscles of the Hip. A. ON THE LATERAL SURFACE OF THE Hip. Fascia of the Thigh.—After the removal of the superficial fascia with its fat and blood-vessels, there is seen a strong glistening fascia, the fascia lata (Fig. 68, z, page 117), cover- ing the vastus lateralis muscle over the dorsal half of the thigh. Ventrally it dips between the vastus lateralis and the biceps femoris and, becoming gradually thinner, is lost on the surface of the former muscle. Passing over the dorsal border of the thigh, it extends beneath the sartorius and is attached to the dorsal border of the vastus medialis. Toward its distal end the fascia is continuous with the tendon of the biceps femoris and dorsad with the border of the sartorius muscle, while ee ee a - } . MUSCLES OF THE PELVIC LIMBS. 187 between these points it is united with the tendon of the vastus lateralis ; it thus gains insertion into the patella. At its proxi- mal end the fascia receives the insertion of the tensor fasciz late (Fig. 68, 7). M. tensor fascie late (Fig. 68, 7, page 117; Fig. 92, a). —The tensor fascie late is a thick triangular muscle which may be recognized by its insertion into the proximal end of the fascia lata (Fig. 68, z; Fig. 92, a’). Origin by fleshy fibres as a thick triangular prism from the outer margin of the ventral border of the ilium craniad of the auricular impression and from the fascia covering the ventral border of the gluteus medius (Fig. 90, 4) over its cranial half. The caudal border of the muscle may be continuous with the cranial border of the gluteus maximus. The muscle spreads out in a fan-like manner, covering the proximal third of the dorsal surface of the thigh. The cranial fibres pass farther distad than the others. Znsertion into the fascia lata (Fig. 68, z) along an irregular line which begins caudad at the base of the great trochanter and ends on the cranial side of the thigh at the junction of the © first and second thirds. Relations. —Outer surface with the cutaneus maximus (Fig. 62, 6, page 94) and craniad with the sartorius (Fig. 68, g). Cranial border with the sartorius (¢g); caudodorsal border with the gluteus medius (Fig. go, 4). Inner surface with the gluteus medius, the rectus femoris (Fig. 92, 4), and the vastus lateralis (Fig. 90, @). Action indicated by the name. It also assists the quad- riceps femoris in extending the leg. M. gluteus maximus.—The gluteus maximus is a rather small quadrangular muscle in the angle between the gluteus medius (Fig. 90, 4) and the caudal vertebre. Origin (Fig. 163, 3, page 401) by fleshy fibres from the tips of the transverse processes of the last sacral and the first caudal vertebrz, from the fascia covering the spinous muscles dorsad of the transverse processes of these vertebrae, and from the fascia covering the gluteus medius. The muscle passes laterad and slightly caudad to its 188 THE MUSCLES. /nsertion by tendon and muscle-fibres into a tubercle on the caudal side of the great trochanter at the middle of its distal end, and for a few millimeters into the ridge which continues distad from this tubercle. Relations.—Outer surface with the caudofemoralis (Fig. 68, s, page 117), the superficial fascia, and a few fibres of the cutaneus maximus. Inner surface with the abductor caudze internus, the tenuissimus (Fig. 90, g), the great sciatic nerve (Fig. 163, a), the obturator internus (Fig. 90, ¢), the gluteus medius (Fig. 90, 4), the gemellus superior, and the pyriformis (Fig. 163, 7). Cranial border with the gluteus medius and the tensor fasciz late. Caudal border with the caudofemoralis (Fig. 68, s). Action. —Abducts the thigh. M. gluteus medius (Fig. 90, 4).—The gluteus medius is a very large triangular muscle which connects the ilium and the sacrum with the great trochanter (1). Origin by fleshy fibres (1) from the superficial sacral fascia; (2) from the lateral surface of the fascia which covers the sur- face of the supraspinous extensor muscles of the tail; (3) from the fascia intervening between it and the tensor fascia late; (4) by tendon fibres from the dorsal half of the crest of the ilium and its dorsal border, and the dorsal half of the lateral surface craniad of the auricular impression; and (5) from the tips of the transverse processes of the last sacral and the first caudal vertebre. The fibres converge to a strong internal tendon. Insertion into the proximal end of the great trochanter. Relations.—Outer surface with the gluteus maximus and tensor fascia late, and between these with the strong fascia lying beneath the cutaneus maximus muscle. Inner surface with the gluteus minimus, the pyriformis, and the gemellus superior. Cranial border with the tensor fasciz late. Caudal border with the gluteus maximus. Action.—Abducts the thigh. M. pyriformis (Fig. 163, 7).—The pyriformis is a triangu- lar muscle covered by the gluteus maximus and the gluteus medius (Fig. 90, 4) and overlying the gemellus superior (Fig. 163, 6). MUSCLES OF THE PELVIC LIMBS 189 Origin by fleshy fibres from the tips of the transverse processes of the last two sacral and the first caudal vertebre. The muscle passes laterad through the great sciatic notch to its Insertion by a flat tendon into an elongated area on the proximal border of the great trochanter just outside (caudad) of the insertion of the gemellus superior. Relations.—Outer surface with the gluteus medius (Fig. g0. 4) and the gluteus maximus. Inner surface with the ~ gemellus superior (Fig. 163, 6), the great sciatic nerve (Fig. 163, a), and the flexor caude longus (Fig. 68, +). Action.—Abductor of the thigh. M. gemellus superior (Fig. 163, 6).—The gemellus superior is a triangular muscle lying beneath the pyriformis (Fig. 163, 7). It is broader than the pyriformis, so that it projects beyond its borders both caudad and craniad. It is closely united craniad with the gluteus minimus, so that the limits of the two are definable only with difficulty. Its caudal border is closely united to the gemellus inferior. Origin by fleshy fibres from an elongated area on the dorsal border of the ilium and ischium. The area is narrowed craniad. It does not quite reach the posterior inferior iliac spine in the one direction nor the spine of the ischium in the other direction. The fibres converge to a strong tendon the Insertion of which is into a triangular area dorsad of the tip of the great trochanter. Relations. —Outer surface with the gluteus medius (Fig. 90, 0), the pyriformis (Fig. 163, 7), the great sciatic nerve (Fig. 163, a), and the gluteus maximus. Inner surface with the ilium, ischium, the capsularis, the caudal edge of the gluteus minimus (Fig. 163, 5), and the cranial edge of the obturator internus (Fig. 90, @). Action.—Rotates the femur and abducts it so as to carry the foot outward. M. gluteus minimus (Fig. 163, 5).—The gluteus minimus is a long triangular muscle beneath the middle of the gluteus medius (Fig. 90, 4) and with its caudal border against or covering the cranial border of the gemellus superior (Fig. 163, 6), to which it is frequently closely united. 190 THE MUSCLES. Origin from the ventral half of the ilium, from near its cranial end to a point midway between the posterior iliac spine and the spine of the ischium. The muscle ends in a strong flat tendon. Insertion into an oval facet at the base of the dorsal surface of the great trochanter on its lateral side. Relations.—Outer surface with the gluteus medius (Fig. 90, 4) and at the caudal border with the gemellus superior (Fig. 163, 6). Inner surface with the capsularis and rectus femoris (Fig. 92, 6). Action.—Rotates the femur so as to carry the foot out. M. capsularis (gluteus quartus, or epimeralis).—The cap- sularis is a small flat bundle of muscle-fibres which lies obliquely beneath the gluteus minimus (Fig. 163, 5) and gemellus superior (6) on the lateral or outer surface of the ilium. Origin by fleshy fibres from the surface of the ilium over a triangular area between the origin of the rectus femoris (Fig. 92, 0) ventrad, the gemellus superior (Fig. 163, 6) dorsad, and of the gluteus minimus (Fig. 163, 5) craniad and the aceta- bulum caudad. The muscle passes over the smooth surface of the ilium and the pubis ventrad of the acetabulum and then over the capsule of the joint. Insertion by fleshy fibres for about one centimeter in the middle. line on the dorsal surface of the femur distad of the great trochanter. Relations.—Outer surface with the gluteus minimus (Fig. 163, 5), the gemellus superior (6), and the vastus lateralis (Fig. 90, @). Inner surface with the ilium, the rectus femoris (Fig. 92, 8), the capsule of the joint, and the vastus medialis (Fig. 92, ¢). Action.—Rotates the thigh so as to carry the foot inward, hence antagonizes the iliopsoas. M. gemellus inferior.—The gemellus inferior is a flat tri- angular muscle situated just caudad of the gemellus superior and beneath the obturator internus (Fig. 90, ¢), so that it is seen on reflecting the latter Origin from the dorsal one-half of the whole lateral surface of the ischium between the ischial spine and the ischial tuber- a, a eo ee MUSCLES OF THE PELVIC LIMBS. I9gI osity. The fibres converge toward its insertion. The inner surface of the muscle is covered by a strong tendon. Insertion into the inner surface of the tendon of the obturator internus (Fig. 90, ¢) by tendon- and muscle-fibres. Some of the muscle-fibres are inserted into the capsule of the joint. Relations.—Outer surface with the obturator internus (Fig. 90, ¢). Medial surface with the ischium. Caudal border with the quadratus femoris (Fig. 90, f). Cranial border with the gemellus superior. Action.—Abductor of the thigh. The muscle may be con- sidered as a separate head of the obturator internus (Fig. gO, @). M. quadratus femoris (Fig. 90, 7).—The quadratus femoris is a short thick muscle connecting the ischial tuberosity (2) and the proximal end of the femur. It lies just caudad of the obturator internus (¢) beneath the proximal end of the biceps femoris (Fig. 68, 7). . The origin is by fleshy fibres from a considerable triangular area on the lateral surface of the ischium near the tuberosity. The area lies between the origin areas of the gemellus inferior, biceps, semimembranosus, and the obturator externus. Insertion into the distal two-thirds of the ventral border of the great trochanter and about half the adjacent surface of the lesser trochanter. Relations. —Outer surface with the tenuissimus (Fig. 90, ¢), the biceps (Fig. 68, 7), the semitendinosus (Fig. 90, 7), and the great sciatic nerve (Fig. 163, a). Caudal border with the semimembranosus (Fig. 90, z). Ventral. border with the adductor femoris (Fig. 90, %); dorsal border with the obturator internus (Fig. 90, ¢) and gemellus inferior. Action.—Extensor of the thigh and rotator of the femur so as to carry the foot inward. M. obturator externus.—The obturator externus is a flat triangular muscle beneath the adductor femoris (Fig. 92, ¢). Origin by fleshy fibres from the median lip of the obturator foramen and from both dorsal and ventral surfaces of the rami of the pubis and ischium adjacent to the lip. Also from the 192 THE MUSCLES. outer surface of the ramus of the ischium as far as the area for the quadratus femoris (Fig. 90, /). The fibres converge to a strong flat tendon. Insertion into the proximal por- tion of the bottom of the tro- chanteric fossa. Relations.—Ventral sur- face with the adductor fem- oris (Fig. 92, g). Dorsal surface with the pubis and ischium. Caudal border with the quad- ratus femoris (Fig. 90, /). Action. — Assists the iliopsoas. B. MUSCLES ON THE MEDIAL SUR- FACE OF THE HIp.— M. obturator internus (Fig. 90, e).—The obtura- _ tor internus appears as a tri- angular muscle caudad of the ge- mellus superior. FIG. 90.—MUSCLES ON THE LATERAL SIDE OF THE LEG, AFTER REMOVAL OF THE MUSCLES SHOWN IN Fic, 68 (Biceps, TENSOR FASCL# LATA, CAuUDO- FEMORALIS, AND GLUTEUS MAXIMUS). a, M. sartorius; 4, M. gluteus medius; c, M. rectus femoris; d, M. vastus lateralis; ¢, M. obturator internus; J, M. quadratus femoris; g, M. tenuissimus; 2, M. ad- ductor femoris; z, M. semimembranosus; 7, M. semi- tendinosus; 4, M. vastus intermedius; 7, M. plantaris; m, m', m'', M. gastrocnemius, outer head (#, part from the external sesamoid bone; 7’, from the plantaris; 7”, from the superficial fascia); 7, M. tibialis anterior; o, M. soleus; #, M. extensor longus digitorum; g, M. peroneus longus; 7, M. peroneus tertius (7 its tendon); s, M. peroneus brevis; 7, tendon of Achilles; «, M. extensor brevis. digitorum. I, great trochanter of femur; 2, tuberosity of ischium, with cut origin of M. biceps femoris; 3, patella; 4, calcaneus; 5, transverse liga- ments; 6, lateral malleolus. MUSCLES OF THE PELVIC LIMBS. 193 Origin by numerous small separate heads from the dorsal surface of the ramus of the ischium along its symphysis and following its medial border from the symphysis nearly to the tuberosity. The fibres form a flat muscle which narrows and passes through the lesser sciatic notch, turns ventrad and ends in a strong flat tendon whose Insertion is into the bottom of the trochanteric fossa of the femur. The tendon is continued proximad on the inner surface of the muscle and forms a smooth firm surface by which the muscle glides over the dorsal border of the ischium. Into the inner surface of this tendon near its insertion the tendon of the gemellus inferior is inserted. . Relations.—Medial surface within the pelvis with a mass of fat separating it from the pelvic organs. Dorsal or outer sur- face with the biceps femoris, the tenuissimus, the caudofemora- lis, and the great sciatic nerve. Inner surface with the ischium and the great sciatic nerve. Caudal (or ventral) border with the quadratus femoris. Action.—Abductor of the thigh. M. iliopsoas (Fig. 162, 8; Fig. 91, c).—The iliopsoas (equivalent to the human psoas and iliacus) is a conical muscle emerging from the abdominal cavity onto the medial surface of the femur. Origin.—(a) The portion corresponding to the human psoas (Fig. 162, 8) arises by ten vertebral heads. The first five of these come from the five cranial tendons of origin of the psoas minor (Fig. 162, 9); the sixth from a tendinous expansion which passes from the tendon of the first head over the ventral longitudinal muscles to the transverse process of: the fifth lumbar vertebra. The seventh, eighth, ninth, and tenth heads arise by fleshy fibres from the ventral surfaces of the centra of the last four lumbar vertebre. (6) The portion corresponding to the human iliacus arises by fleshy fibres from the ventral border of the ilium, from opposite the auricular impression to the iliopectineal eminence. The portions of the muscle all converge to form a conical mass which ends in a strong tendon lying on its outer sur- face. 194 THE MUSCLES. Insertion by tendon and fleshy fibres into the apex of the lesser trochanter of the femur. Relations.—Dorsal surface with the quadratus lumborum (with which this muscle is partly united), the rectus femoris (Fig. 91, @), and, by the iliac head, with the gluteus minimus. . Ventral and medial surface with the psoas minor (Fig. 162, 9) and the peritoneum. Lateral edge with the transversus abdominis (Fig. 162, 4). Action.—Rotates the thigh so as to carry the foot out; also flexes the thigh. 2. Muscles of the Thigh. M. biceps femoris (Fig. 68, ¢, page 117).—A very large flat muscle covering about two-thirds of the lateral side of the thigh. Origin (Fig. 90, 2).—From the ventral surface of the tuberosity of the ischium by tendon- and muscle-fibres. The fibres diverge, and near the knee the mass has spread out, end- ing in a fascia. The dorsal border of the muscle and the common fascia are continuous dorsad with the superficial fascia of the thigh and with the tendon of the caudofemoralis (Fig. 68, s). Ventrad it is continuous with the superficial fascia of the shank. Insertion into rather more than the proximal one-third of the dorsal border of the tibia along its lateral margin and into the lateral margin of the patella. In passing over the knee- joint it is closely united to the underlying ligaments and tendons. . Relations.—Outer surface with the superficial fascia and with a few of the most caudal fibres of the cutaneus maximus (Fig. 62, 6, page 94). ~Cranial (or dorsal) edge with the caudofemoralis (Fig. 68, s) and the vastus lateralis (Fig. 90, @). Caudal border with the semitendinosus (Fig. 68, 2) and a mass of fat. Inner surface with the caudofemoralis (Fig. 68, s), the tenuissimus (Fig. 90, g), the obturator internus (Fig. 90, e), the quadratus femoris (Fig. 90, /), the semitendinosus (Fig. 68, #), the semimembranosus (Fig. 90, z), the adductor femoris (Fig. 90, %), the great sciatic nerve (Fig. 163, a), and distad a a ah li ae MUSCLES OF THE PELVIC LIMBS. 195 with the following muscles of the lower leg: the tibialis anterior (Fig. 90, 2), the extensor longus digitorum (Fig. 90, /), the peroneus longus (Fig. 90, g), and the lateral head of the gastrocnemius (Fig. 90, m). Action.—Abductor of the thigh, and flexor of the shank. M. tenuissimus or M. abductor cruris (Fig. 90, g).—A very slender muscle, only three or four millimeters wide. Origin from the tip of the transverse process of the second caudal vertebra, in common with the caudofemoralis (Fig. 68, s) or gluteus maximus. It passes obliquely beneath the biceps femoris (Fig. 68, 7) distad and ventrad, to the distal end of the ventral border of that muscle. Here it becomes con- tinuous with the ventral border of the biceps, ending in a con- tinuation of the same fascia into which the biceps is inserted. Relations.—Outer surface with the caudofemoralis (Fig. 68, s) and the biceps femoris (Fig. 68, 7); distad with the integument. Inner surface with the obturator internus (Fig. 90, ¢), quadratus femoris (/), semitendinosus (7), adductor femoris (4), semimembranosus (2), and distad with the muscles of the lower leg. M. caudofemoralis (parameralis, Strauss-Durckheim) (Fig. 68, s, page 117). Origin by a flat tendon from the transverse processes of the second and third caudal vertebre. The muscle forms a flat band which passes distad along the middle of the lateral side of the thigh over the pelvis and caudad of the great trochanter. At the middle of the thigh it ends in a very thin tendon. The tendon passes distad along the medial surface of the biceps femoris (Fig. 68, 7), pierces the fascia lata near the knee, and passes to its Insertion into the middle of the lateral border of the patella. Relations.—Outer surface with the superficial fascia and a few fibres of the cutaneus maximus; distad with the biceps femoris (Fig. 68, 7). Cranial border with the gluteus maxi- mus; caudal border with the biceps femoris. Inner surface with the tenuissimus (Fig. 90, ¢), the gluteus maximus, the abductor caudz internus, and with the obturator internus (Fig. 90, e); distad with the vastus lateralis. 196 THE MUSCLES. Action.—Abducts the thigh and helps to extend the shank. M. semitendinosus (Fig. 90, 7).—A long slender muscle on the ventral (caudal) border of the thigh, between the semi- membranosus (7) and the biceps femoris (Fig. 68, 2). Origin from the apex of the tuberosity of the ischium beneath the origin of the biceps femoris. The muscle passes to the medial side of the shank and ends in a thin but strong tendon (Fig. 92, 2’) about five millimeters broad. The tendon curves proximad and passes beneath the gracilis tendon (Fig. I, 0) to its Insertion into the crest (dorsal border) of the ue one or two centimeters from its proximal end. Relations.—Lateral surface with the biceps femoris (Fig. 68, 2), the integument, a mass of fat, and distad with the gas- trocnemius (Fig. 92, 7) and popliteus (Fig. 92, 2). Caudal surface with the integument. Medial surface with the semi- membranosus (Fig. 90, 2) and distad with the integument of the lower leg. Action.—F lexor of the shank. M. semimembranosus (Figs. 90 and 91, z; Fig. 92, 2).— A thick prismatic muscle lying along the ventral (or caudal) side of the thigh between the semitendinosus (7) and the gracilis (Fig. 91, 4). Origin by short tendon-fibres from the caudal border of the tuberosity and the ramus of the ischium. The muscle mass is divided throughout most of its length into two portions (Fig. 92, # and h’), one of which (Z’) lies laterad and caudad of the other. The two portions pass to the medial side of the knee. The caudal portion (%’) ends in a strong flat tendon five milli- meters broad, the Insertion of which is into the medial surface of the femur on the medial epicondyle, at the middle of its distal border and into the adjacent medial surface of the tibia behind the lateral ligament. ; The dorsal part has its zwsertion into the distal one and one-half to two centimeters of the ridge which is continued from the medial epicondyle of the femur onto the shaft; and nto the sesamoid bone of the medial epicondyle. —_ ae a ee eee ee eee ea en MUSCLES OF THE PELVIC LIMBS. 197 Relations.—Lateral surface with the semitendinosus (Fig. 90, 7), the biceps femoris (Fig. 68, 2), and distad with a small part of the adductor femoris (Fig. 92, g),and with the gas- trocnemius (Fig. 92, 7). Medial surface with the gracilis (Fig. gt, %) and distad with the sartorius (Fig. 91, a). Cra- nial (or dorsal) border at the origin with the quad- ratus femoris (Fig. 90, J); for the remainder of its length with the adductor femoris (Fig. go, #). Caudal bor- der with the integu- ment proximad. Action, — Extensor of the thigh. M. sartorius (Fig. 91, a; Fig. 68, 7).—A large flat muscle along the medial side of the thigh near its cranial (dorsal) border. Origin from the ventral half of the crest of the ilium and from the medial half of its ventral border craniad of the auricular impression. The caudal third of the origin is by a thin tendon, the rest by fleshy fibres. Fic. 91.—MUSCLES ON THE MEDIAL. SIDE OF THE LEG. a, M. sartorius; 4, M. gracilis; ¢, M. iliopsoas; d, M. rectus femoris; 2, M. vastus medialis; 7, M. pectineus; g, M. adductor longus; 4, M. adductor femoris; 7, M. semimembranosus; 7, M. semitendinosus; %, medial head of M. gastrocnemius; 7, M, plantaris; m, M. flexor longus hallucis (#’, its tendon); 2, M, flexor longus digitorum; (7’, its tendon); 0, M. tibialis posterior; /, M. tibialis anterior; g, M. interosseus of second digit. I, patella; 2, calcaneus; 3, medial malleolus; 4, second metatarsal; 5, transverse ligament of the lower leg. 198 THE MUSCLES. Insertion on a long S-shaped line which begins on the dorsal border of the tibial shaft about two centimeters from its proximal end, passes thence to the middle of the proximal end of the medial surface of the tibia, thence across the ligaments of the knee-joint and the medial surface of the medial epicondyle to the patella, crosses the patella obliquely to the middle of its. proximal end, and may be continued for some distance proximad along the middle line on the fascia. Relations. —Medial surface with the integument and proxi- mad with the internal oblique muscle (Fig. 68, ). Lateral (inner) surface with the tensor fascie late (Fig. 68, rv), the vastus lateralis (Fig. 90, @), the superficial fascia, the vastus medialis (Fig. 92, c), the rectus femoris (Fig. 92, 4), and the distal end of the semimembranosus (Fig. 92, %’). Action.—Adducts and rotates the femur and extends the tibia. M. gracilis (Fig. 91, 4).—The gracilis is a flat, thin, sub- cutaneous muscle occupying the ventral half of the medial sur- face of the thigh. Origin by a strong tendon from the caudal three-fourths of the symphysis of the ischium and pubis. The tendon may extend caudad of the symphysis in the middle line to the level of the tuberosity of the ischium. For about its first centimeter the tendon is common to the two muscles of opposite sides and gives origin on two sides to the fibres of the adductor femoris. The common tendon divides into two which pass laterad, each ending in a convex border from which the muscle-fibres spring. Insertion.—It ends ina thin aponeurosis, part of which is continuous with that of the sartorius. The aponeurosis is finally inserted into the medial surface of the tibia near its proximal end, while distally it is continuous with the fascia. Relations.—Outer (medial) surface with the integument. Inner (lateral) surface with the semimembranosus (Fig. 91, 7) and the adductor femoris (Fig. 91, 7). Action.—Adducts the leg and draws it caudad. M. adductor femoris (magnus et brevis) (Fig. 92, ¢; Fig. 90, #).—The adductor femoris lies between the semimembrano- Fe Eee ee a NT a eT oe eee te eee ee MUSCLES OF THE PELVIC LIMBS, 199 sus (Fig. 92, #) and the femur. Its proximal part is covered by the semimembranosus, while its distal part lies outside of it. Origin by muscle-fibres from the rami of the pubis and the ischium along the whole of the length of the symphysis; from the ramus of the ischium between the symphysis and the tuberosity, and from the tendon of origin common to the two gracilis muscles. Insertion into nearly the whole of the ventral surface of the shaft of the femur. The area begins at the base of the great trochanter opposite the proximal end and the insertion area of the gluteus maximus. It extends thence distad along the _ caudal border of the surface as an area about one millimeter wide. At the junction of the first and second thirds of the shaft the area expands and occupies the whole of the ventral surface of the bone, ending at the intercondyloid fossa. Relations. —Lateral surface with the biceps (Fig. 68, 2), the great sciatic nerve (Fig. 163, a), the tenuissimus (Fig. 90, g), and the semimembranosus (Fig. 92, £); dorsolateral border in contact with the vastus lateralis (Fig. 92, c). Dorsal surface with the quadratus femoris (Fig. 90, /) and obturator externus (Fig. 90, e). Caudal surface with the semimembranosus (Fig. 92, #). Medial surface with the gracilis (Fig. 91, 4), adductor longus (Fig. 92, f), pectineus (Fig. 92, ¢), vastus medialis (Fig. 92, c), and distad with the medial head of the gastroc- nemius (Fig. 92, 7). Action.—An extensor of the thigh. M. adductor longus (Fig. 91, ¢; Fig. 92, /).—A thin muscle which covers the dorsal half of the medial surface of the adductor femoris (Fig. 92, g). Origin by muscle-fibres from the median three-fourths of the cranial border of the pubis, the line of origin forming a medial continuation of that of the pectineus (Fig. 92, ¢). Insertion by a thin aponeurosis into the external linea aspera of the femur along the second and third fifths of the bone. Relations.—With its medial or cranial surface the adductor longus forms part of the boundary of a depression among the muscles at the proximal end of the medial side of the leg. 200 THE MUSCLES. This depression is called the iliopectineal fossa; it contains the femoral vein and artery and saphenous nerve imbedded in fat (Fig. 127). The medial edge of the adductor longus is in relation with the integument; the lateral edge with the pec- Fic. 92.—SEcoND LAYER OF MUSCLES ON THE MEDIAL SIDE OF THE THIGH. a, M. tensor fascize late; a’, fascia lata; 46, M. rectus femoris; c, M. vastus medi- alis; d¢, M. iliopsoas (cut); ¢, M. pectineus; 7, M. adductor longus; g, M. adductor femoris; 4, 4’, M. semimembranosus; 7, M. semitendinosus (2’, its tendon); 7, medial head of M. gastrocnemius; 4, M. popliteus; Z, M. flexor longus digitorum. 1, patellar ligament; 2, ligamentum collaterale tibiale. tineus (Fig. 92, ¢). Inner or caudal surface with the adductor femoris (Fig. 92, g). Action.—Adductor of the thigh. M. pectineus (Fig. 92, ¢).—A flat band of fibres closely united with the adductor longus (/), of which it appears to be a lateral continuation. | : Origin by fleshy fibres from the lateral one-fourth of the cranial border of the pubis. The muscle passes over the smooth outer surface of the pubis between its origin area and MUSCLES OF THE PELVIC LIMBS. 201 the acetabulum, crosses the iliopsoas (@) obliquely and has its Insertion by muscle-fibres into an elongated area (five milli- meters in length) on the shaft of the femur just distad of the lesser trochanter and between the insertion of the adductor femoris (2) and that of the vastus medialis (c). Relations.—The cranial edge forms part of the floor of the iliopectineal fossa. Lateral surface in relation with the iliopsoas (2) and vastus medialis (c); medial surface with the adductor longus (/) and adductor femoris (g). Action.—Adductor of the thigh. M. quadriceps femoris.—The quadriceps femoris is a very powerful extensor muscle on the front of the thigh. It consists of four muscles which unite to form the great extensor of the shank. It is inserted into the patella and through it, by the ligamentum patellz, into the tibia. It may be compared to the triceps brachii. The parts are: (1) M. rectus femoris (Fig. 92, 4; Fig. go, c). _ Origin by strong tendon from an elongated triangular area which has its base at the acetabulum and its apex about five to seven millimeters craniad of the acetabulum, along the ven- tral border of the ilium. The area is between that for the capsularis and that for the iliopsoas.. The muscle is flat near its origin, but soon becomes a triangular prismatic mass which is united to the dorsal border of the vastus lateralis (Fig. 90, @) at the junction of the middle and last thirds of the thigh. Insertion into the oblique area on the outer surface of the patella near its proximal border in connection with the vastus lateralis. Relations.—Outer or lateral surface at the origin with the gluteus minimus, the edge of the capsularis, the gluteus medius (Fig. 90, 4), and farther distad with the vastus lateralis (Fig. 90, 2). Medial surface with the tensor fascie late (Fig. 92, a), sartorius (Fig. 90, a), and vastus medialis (Fig. 92, ¢). Inner (caudal) surface with the vastus intermedius. (2) M. vastus lateralis (Fig. 90, @).—A flat triangular prismatic mass joined distally to the preceding. It covers the dorsal part of. the lateral surface of the thigh. Origin from a triangular area on the dorsal and lateral sur- 202 THE MUSCLES. faces of the shaft and the great trochanter of the femur. The base of the area is at the great trochanter, and its apex is at the junction of the second and third fifths of the shaft on the linea aspera. The linea aspera forms the ventral boundary of the triangle, while its dorsal boundary is formed by a line drawn from its apex to the dorsomedial angle of the great trochanter. The mass unites with the rectus femoris (c) by its dorsal border at the junction of the middle and distal thirds of the thigh. /nsertion into the oblique area on the outer surface of the patella near its lateral border in connection with the rectus femoris. (3) M. vastus medialis (Fig. 92, c) lies on the medial side of the thigh. Origin by fleshy fibres over a diamond-shaped area on the shaft of the femur lying between the medial branch of the linea aspera and the area for the vastus lateralis. Proximad the area is bounded by the ‘spiral line, and distad it is bounded by a line parallel to the spiral line and having its proximal end at about the junction of the first and second thirds of the bone. The muscle forms a triangular, prismatic mass. It ends ina thin aponeurosis which is continuous dorsad with the border of the rectus femoris (Fig. 92, 4), and ventrad sometimes with the tendon of the gracilis (Fig. 91, 6). Insertion into the medial border of the patella and the liga- mentum patellz. The insertion may extend onto the head of the tibia. The adjacent surfaces of the vastus lateralis and the vastus ‘medialis are connected over their distal thirds by an aponeuro- sis which passes transversely beneath the rectus femoris. The distal end of the aponeurosis is inserted into the proximal border of the patella. Its proximal end receives the insertion of some muscle-fibres which form a part of the vastus medialis as here described. This mass of fibres is described by Strauss- Durckheim as the crural muscle. Sometimes the transverse aponeurosis is continuous with only one of the two vasti and sometimes with neither, so that the insertion of the crural of Strauss-Durckheim becomes more or less independent. Relations: of the vastus medialis. Outer (medial) surface MUSCLES OF THE PELVIC LIMBS. 203 with the sartorius (Fig. 91, @) and the structures in the ilio- pectineal fossa. Cranial (or dorsal) surface with the rectus femoris (Fig. 92, 6) and vastus intermedius. Caudal (ventral) surface with the pectineus (lig. 92, ¢), adductor longus (Fig. 92, 7), adductor femoris (Fig. 92, ¢), and semimembranosus (Fig. 92, 4). (4) M. vastus intermedius.—A flat mass of muscle which lies beneath the rectus femoris. Origin from nearly the whole of the dorsal surface of the shaft of the femur between the areas for the vastus medialis and vastus lateralis. The area of origin extends distad to an oblique line the middle of which is about one and one-half centimeters from the patellar surface, the lateral border of the area being longer than the medial border. Insertion by muscle-fibres into the capsule of the joint. The central fibres are inserted about one centimeter proximad of the patella, while the lateral mass passes to the level of the proximal end. Relations.—Outer surface with’ the rectus femoris (Fig. 92, 6); borders with the vastus medialis (Fig. 92, c) and vastus lateralis (Fig. 90, @); inner surface with the femur. Action.—The quadriceps extensor is an extensor of the shank. The vastus intermedius acting separately is a tensor of the capsule of the knee-joint. 3. Muscles of the Lower Leg (Crus). A. ON THE VENTRAL SIDE. —M. gastrocnemius.—This _ is the great muscular mass of the calf. It arises by two heads, the caput laterale or lateral head (Fig. 90, m), and the caput mediale or medial head (Fig. 91, &), of the gastrocnemius. Caput laterale (Fig. 90, ™, m’, m’’).—The origin of the lateral head is in four portions: (1) From the tendon of origin of the plantaris which comes from the middle of the lateral border of the patella. The ten- don ends in a small conical mass of fibres (#’) which joins the ventral part of the common head. (2) By a slender flat tendon, distad of the first, from the 204 THE MUSCLES. superficial fascia of the shank (’’). The tendon ends in a conical mass which joins the dorsal border of the common head. (3) By a strong tendon and by muscle-fibres from the distal border of the lateral sesamoid bone (Fig. 61, 3) of the femur. These fibres (7) form the middle and outer part of the common > head. (4) By muscle-fibres from the middle of the outer surface of the aponeurosis covering the plantaris (Fig. 90, 7) along rather more than the proximal half of the tibia. The lateral head thus formed is flat and fusiform in section. Caput mediale (Fig. 91, £; Fig. 92, J): —The medial head resembles the lateral head Bocaly: Origin by a strong tendon from the medial sesamoid bone of the femur (Fig. 61, 4) and by muscle-fibres from the surface of the shaft for a short distance proximad of this. The two heads unite by their contiguous borders at the junction of the first and second thirds of the tibia. The common muscle narrows rapidly and ends in a flat tendon which joins the tendon of the soleus to form the so-called ten- don of Achilles (tendo calcaneus) (Fig. 90, 7). This has its Insertion into the proximal end of the calcaneus (Fig. gO, 4) near its ventral border. This tendon together with that of the soleus (Fig. 90, 0) and the fascia of the shank forms a tubular sheath for the tendon of the plantaris. Relations.—(1) Of the lateral head. Lateral (Gute) surface with the biceps femoris (Fig. 68, ¢) and the superficial fascia. Medial (inner) surface with the popliteus (Fig. 92, #), the plantaris (Fig. 90, 7) (to which it is closely united), the medial head of the gastrocnemius (Fig. 91, #), the soleus (Fig. go, 0), and the peroneus longus (Fig. 90, g). (2) Of the medial head. Medial (outer) surface with the superficial fascia and the tendons of the gracilis (Fig. 91, 4), semimembranosus (Fig. 92, %’), and semitendinosus (Fig. 92, 2). Lateral (inner) surface at the origin with the adductor femoris (Fig. 92, ¢), then with the plantaris (Fig. 91, 7), the popliteus (Fig. 92, £), flexor longus digitorum (Fig. 91, 2), and the lateral head of the gastroc- nemius (Fig. 90, 72). Action.—Extensor of the foot. (It is to be noted that what i Ry Oe eee mee Cy a re aes MUSCLES OF THE PELVIC LIMBS. 205 is called extension in the foot is analogous to what is called flexion in the hand, so that the extensors of the foot are most readily to be compared with the flexors of the hand.) M. plantaris (Fig. 90,°/; Fig. 91, 7).—A fusiform muscle covered distally by the gastrocnemius, but appearing between the two heads of the gastrocnemius at their proximal ends (Fig. 90, 7). Origin by a strong tendon from the middle of the lateral . border of the patella and by fleshy fibres from the ventral border of the lateral sesamoid. The patellar tendon ends in a flattened head which passes ventrad over the lateral epicondyle of the femur and then curves distad; it is closely united with the lateral head of the gastrocnemius. The muscle ends in a thick tendon which passes through a sheath formed by the tendons of the gastroc- nemius and soleus, and the fascia of the shank. The tendon passes over the grooved proximal end of the calcaneus onto its ventral surface. It is held in place against the groove by two sheets of aponeurosis, which leave the tendon on either side for a distance of more than a centimeter and are attached to the lateral surfaces of the calcaneus at its proximal end. Lateral motion is thus hindered, while longitudinal motion is permitted. Between this tendon and the tendon of Achilles is a synovial bursa which aids the gliding movement of the tendon. In the sole of the foot opposite the distal end of the calcaneus the tendon broadens and ends in the flexor brevis digitorum (pedis perforatus) muscle, which might also be considered as a second part of the plantaris. In man the plantaris is inserted into the calcaneus along with the gastrocnemius. Relations.—The muscle is covered throughout by the two heads of the gastrocnemius (Fig. 90, m; Fig. 91, #),-except at the proximal end (Fig. 90, /), where it is in contact with the integument. Inner surface in relation with the popliteus (Fig. 92, #), the soleus (Fig. 90, 0), the flexor longus digitorum (Fig. 91, 2), and flexor longus hallucis (Fig. 91, ). M. soleus (Fig. 90, 0).—A flat fusiform muscle lying beneath the plantaris. Origin by muscle-fibres from the lateral surface of the head 206 THE MUSCLES. of the fibula, and by tendon-fibres from the proximal two-fifths of its ventral border. Insertion.—The muscle ends in a slender tendon which joins the lateral border of the gastrocnemius tendon to form the tendon of Achilles (Fig. 90, ¢), which forms the sheath of the plantaris tendon. Relations.—Outer surface with the gastrocnemius (Fig. 90, m) and plantaris (Fig. 90, 7). Inner surface with the peroneus longus (Fig. 90, 7), peroneus tertius (Fig. 90, 7), and flexor hallucis (Fig. 91, 7). Action.—Assists the gastrocnemius to caleaa the foot. M. triceps sure.—The gastrocnemius and the soleus are sometimes considered as forming a single muscle, with three heads, under the name triceps sure. M. popliteus (Fig. 92, #).—A triangular muscle passing from the femur obliquely toward the medial side over the ven- tral surface of the proximal end of the tibia. Origin by a strong tendon from the popliteal groove on the surface of the lateral epicondyle of the femur. In the tendon is a sesamoid bone, the popliteal bone (Fig. 61, 5, page 89), which glides over the ventral part of the lateral articular facet - on the proximal end of the tibia. As the muscle passes over the joint it is closely attached to the joint capsule. From the popliteal bone, which with the tendon lies within the capsule of the knee-joint, the muscle-fibres diverge to their Insertion into the proximal end of the ventral surface of the tibial shaft on the medial side of the medial oblique ridge. The area of insertion extends slightly onto the medial surface of the bone. Relations. —Outer surface with the gastrocnemius (Fig. 92, 7) and plantaris (Fig. 91, 7), and with the tendon of the semitendinosus (Fig. 92, 2). Distal border with the origins’ of the soleus and flexor longus digitorum. Inner surface with the capsule of the knee-joint and the tibia. Actton.—Rotates the thigh so as to turn the toes inward. The three following deep muscles on the ventral surface of the shank are covered by a deep fascia (the deep crural fascia) a a ee a Se ae ee a aR Lae ee ae eed eee ae, ay, Sew ey MUSCLES OF THE PELVIC LIMBS. 207 which separates them from the overlying muscles. This fascia stretches from the dorsal border of the tibia about the ventral side of the shank to the medial border of the tibia. It sends a slip beneath the border of the fibula. M. flexor longus digitorum (Fig. 91, m and z).—Owing to the reduction of the first digit in the cat the tendon of the flexor longus hallucis (#) has become united to that of the flexor longus digitorum (7), so that the two might be considered separate heads of a single muscle. The head corresponding to the flexor longus hallucis (wz) is much larger than that corre- sponding to the flexor longus digitorum (z). The two heads will be described separately. (1) M. flexor longus hallucis (Fig. 91, m).—This lies against the ventral surface of the tibia and fibula beneath the popliteus (Fig. 92, &) and soleus (Fig. go, 0). Origin by fleshy fibres, (1) from the sheet of deep crural fascia which dips between it and the tibialis posterior (Fig. gI, 0) and the flexor longus digitorum (z). (2) From the ven- tral surface of the tibia distad of the lateral oblique line to within one to three centimeters of the distal end of the shaft. (3) From the medial surface of the shaft and head of the fibula and from the whole interosseous ligament. On the fibular side the origin may extend onto the tendon of the popliteus and the fascia of the peroneus longus. The fibres form a flat fusiform mass ending one centimeter from the heel in a strong flat tendon (m') which passes over the groove on the distal surface of the astragalus and over the groove on the sustentaculum tali. The two grooves are converted into a continuous canal by strong transverse ligaments, and the canal is lined by an extension of the synovial bursa of the ankle-joint. Emerging from the canal the tendon broadens and receives on its medial side the insertion of the tendon of the flexor longus digitorum (7). The tendon gives origin on its outer surface to the lumbricales and to the common plantar ligament. The tendon continues to broaden until it reaches the middle of the length of the meta- carpals; here it divides into four tendons which pass to the terminal phalanges of the digits. Insertion.—The relations of the four tendons and their 208 THE MUSCLES. insertions are identical with those of the flexor profundus digi- torum of the hand. Relations.—Outer surface with the soleus (Fig. 90, 0) and plantaris (Fig. 91, 7). Lateral border with the soleus, the peroneus tertius (Fig. 90, ~), and peroneus brevis (Fig. 90, s). Medial border with the tibialis posterior (Fig. 91, 0) and flexor longus digitorum (Fig. 91, 7). Action.—Flexor of the phalanges. (2) M. flexor longus digitorum (Fig. 91, 7). Origin by muscle- and tendon-fibres from the ventral sur- face of the tibia over its proximal half between the oblique ridges; by fleshy fibres from an aponeurosis between it and the tibialis posterior (Fig. 91, 0), and by tendon from the medial surface of the head of the fibula. At the junction of the middle and distal thirds of the bone the muscle ends in a slender ten- don which passes through the ventral groove on the medial surface of the tibia and, curving onto the sole of the foot, becomes attached to the medial border of the common tendon described under the last. Relations.—Outer surface with the medial head of the gas- trocnemius (Fig. 91, &) and with the superficial fascia. Inner surface with the tibialis posterior (Fig. 91, 0). Medial border at the proximal end with the popliteus (Fig. 92, &), lateral border with the tibialis posterior (Fig. 91, 0), and flexor longus hallucis (Fig. 91, wz). Action.—F lexor of the phalanges. M. tibialis posterior (Fig. 91, 0).—A slender flat fusiform muscle beneath the flexor longus digitorum and between it and the flexor longus hallucis. Origin by fleshy fibres from nearly the whole medial surface of the head of the fibula, from the inner surface of the apo- neurosis between it and the flexor longus digitorum (7), and by a few fleshy fibres from the ventral surface of the tibia between the oblique ridges. Some fibres may also arise from the outer surface of the aponeurosis covering the flexor longus hallucis (m). The muscle ends at about the middle of the tibia in a slender flat tendon which passes parallel to the tendon of the flexor longus digitorum (z) through the dorsal groove on the Li a oe Se BN 2 Pa Bl i a See need a MUSCLES OF THE PELVIC LIMBS. 209 medial surface of the distal end of the tibia. This groove is converted into a canal by a transverse ligament. Beyond the canal the tendon turns onto the plantar surface of the foot and passes through a groove on the ventral surface of the scaphoid bone. It then divides. Insertion into the outer tuberosity on the surface of the scaphoid, and onto the proximal end of the ventral surface of the medial cuneiform. Relations.—Outer and medial surface with the flexor longus digitorum (z). Lateral surface with the flexor longus hallucis (wz). Action. —Extensor of the foot. B. MUSCLES ON THE DORSAL AND LATERAL SURFACES OF THE LOWER LEG. —M. peroneus longus (Fig. 90, g).— A slender, fusiform muscle lying superficially on the lateral side of the leg, dorsad of the soleus. Origin by tendon-fibres from the lateral surface of the head of the fibula and from the proximal half of the lateral surface of its shaft. At the junction of the middle and distal thirds of the lower leg the muscle ends in a slender tendon which passes through the groove on the lateral surface of the lateral malleolus. This groove is converted into a canal by a transverse ligament. The tendon passes through the groove on the peroneal tubercle of the calcaneus, then turns onto the sole of the foot and passes through the peroneal groove on the cuboid bone. It then turns mediad and passes through the groove between the ventral processes of the lateral cuneiform and the metatarsal until it reaches the first metatarsal. The entire groove is converted into a canal by the overlying ligaments. Insertion into (1) the base of the fifth metatarsal, and (2) the outer side of the base of the first metatarsal, and (3) by slender branches into the bases of the other metatarsals. Relations.—Outer (lateral) surface with the superficial fascia and the tendon of the biceps femoris. Inner surface with the - peroneus tertius (7) and peroneus brevis (s), and with the extensor longus digitorum (/). At the proximal end the dorsal border touches the tibialis anterior (7). Action. —Flexor of the foot. 210 THE MUSCLES. M. peroneus tertius (Fig. 90, ~).—A slender fusiform muscle beneath the peroneus longus (¢). Origin by fleshy fibres from about the second quarter of the lateral surface of the fibula. The muscle ends in a slender tendon (r’), which passes with that of the peroneus brevis (s) through the groove on the ventral border of the lateral mal- leolus. The groove is converted into a canal by a transverse ligament. Emerging from it, the tendon turns and passes along the outer margin of the foot. In passing the sesamoid at the base of the first phalanx of the fifth digit it is united to it bya band which passes from the sesamoid to the tendon. The zzsertion is finally into the lateral border of the extensor tendon of the fifth digit as it passes from the first to the second phalanx. Relations.—Outer surface with the peroneus longus (¢), the soleus (0), and the superficial fascia. Ventral border with the ‘soleus (0) and flexor longus hallucis (Fig. 91, #). Inner sur- face with the peroneus brevis (Fig. 90, s). Action. —Extensor and abductor of the fifth digit and flexor of the foot. M. peroneus brevis (Fig. 90, s) lies beneath the other peronei. Origin by fleshy fibres from the distal half of the surface of the fibula, which it embraces. At the lateral malleolus the muscle ends in a thick tendon which passes through the canal on the ventral surface of the malleolus. In the canal it is enlarged and surrounded by a synovial bursa. It then turns onto the foot and passes over the dorsal surface of the calcaneus on its lateral side and has its Insertion into the tubercle on the lateral side of the base of the fifth metatarsal. Relations. —Outer surface with the peronei longus (g) and tertius (7). Inner surface with the bone. Action. —Extensor of the foot. M. extensor digitorum longus (Fig. 90, #).—A fusiform muscle which lies beneath the tibialis anterior (7), against the interosseous membrane, and between the tibialis anterior and the peronei. MUSCLES OF THE PELVIC LIMBS. 211 Origin by a thin flat tendon from the lateral surface of the lateral epicondyle of the femur just dorsad of the origin of the popliteus. The tendon becomes narrower and thicker and passes through the capsule of the knee-joint and over a slight groove on the tibia just dorsad of the head of the fibula. The belly of the muscle extends the entire length of the tibia, pass- ing beneath the transverse ligament (5) along with the tendon of the tibialis anterior (z). At the ankle it runs through a fibrous loop whicli is attached to the dorsal surface of the calcaneus (the annular ligament of the calcaneus); it then turns and passes onto the dorsum of the foot. The muscle ends in four slender tendons, the two middle of which begin at the transverse ligament, while the others begin at the fibrous loop. The tendons diverge to the four digits. Each tendon is con- nected with the fibrous sheath surrounding the base of the first phalanx, and each has a synovial bursa beneath it at this point. Near the distal end of the first phalanx the tendon is united on the lateral side to the conjoined tendon of the extensor brevis digitorum and an interosseus muscle, and on the medial side to the tendon of the interosseus. The lateral side of the most lateral tendon is not thus united, but is joined on the outer side by the tendon of the peroneus tertius. Insertion.—The tendon thus formed on the dorsum of each phalanx by the junction of the two or three tendons above mentioned is firmly attached to the base of the second phalanx at its proximal end in the middle of its dorsal surface. In crossing the joint between the first and second phalanges the tendon forms a fibrous pad which protects the dorsum of the joint and glides over it. _It then continues to be inserted into the base of the terminal phalanx. Relations. —Outer surface with the tibialis anterior (7) and the superficial fascia. Inner surface with a part of the tibialis anterior, with the bones, the interosseous membrane, and the peroneus brevis (s). Action.—Extensor of the phalanges. M. tibialis anterior (Fig. 90, ~).—This is the superficial muscle covering the lateral side of the tibia. Origin by fleshy fibres from the proximal one-sixth of the 212 THE MUSCLES. lateral surface of the shaft of the tibia, from the proximal third of the medial border of the shaft and head of the fibula, and from the intervening interosseous ligament. The triangular body of the muscle covers the lateral surface of the tibia and the outer surface of the extensor longus digitorum (f). Near the malleolus it ends in a strong tendon which passes beneath the transverse ligament along with the tendon of the extensor longus (f). The tendon crosses the dorsal surface of the foot obliquely toward its medial side. Insertion into the outer surface of the first metatarsal. Relations.—Outer surface with the superficial fascia and the tendon of the biceps femoris. Inner surface with the extensor longus (f), the tibia, and the interosseous membrane. Action.—F lexor of the foot. 4. Muscles of the Foot. _ A. MUSCLES ON THE DORSUM OF THE FOOT.—M. ex- tensor brevis digitorum (Fig. 90, ~).—A broad thin muscle covering the tarsus and part of the metatarsus on the lateral side of the dorsum of the foot. It may be divided into three slips. Origin from the distal border of nearly the whole calcaneal annular ligament (5), and from the proximal end of the dorsal surface of the three lateral metatarsals. At the middle of the metatarsals the muscle ends in three flat tendons which pass into the three interspaces between the four tendons of the ex- tensor longus. Each tendon is divided into two branches. Insertion.—The lateral branch of each tendon is inserted into the cartilaginous plate which lies in the metatarsophalan- ~ geal articulation of the digit on the outer side. The medial branch joins the lateral side of the extensor longus tendon on the dorsum of the first phalanx. Action.—¥Extensor of the digits. B. MUSCLES OF THE SOLE OF THE FootT.—M. Sexes brevis digitorum (pedis perforatus).—This is the direct con- tinuation of the tendon of the plantaris. It lies immediately beneath the superficial plantar fascia. The flat belly of the muscle has its medial border attached by an oblique tendinous MUSCLES OF THE PELViC LIMBS. 213 band to the medial surface of the scaphoid and the medial cuneiform. It divides into four slips which diverge to the four toes, each ending in a flat tendon. The slips decrease in size from the lateral to the medial side. The three lateral ones overlap one another proximally. Insertion.—Each tendon expands at the distal end of the metatarsal and is wrapped about the tendon of the deep flexor which perforates it. The two halves unite beneath the perforat- ing tendon and pass together with the perforating tendon through fibrous rings, the annular ligaments. One of these is attached to the sesamoids at the base of the phalanx. The other is attached to the head of the first phalanx. The tendons are finally inserted into the bases of the second phalanges. The two annular ligaments are connected by fascia so as to form a continuous canal for the tendons. This canal is lined by a synovial membrane. Covering this canal is a more super- ficial layer of fascia. Before passing into the proximal annular ligament the two middle tendons unite each with the tendon of the corresponding lumbrical muscle. Each also gives off a branch, the lateral one on its lateral side and the medial one on its medial side. These branches, like those of the two middle ones, are inserted into the common phalangeal fascia. Action.—Flexor of the second phalanges of the digits. M. quadratus plante (called also the plantar head of the flexor longus digitorum) is a thin flat muscle which takes origin from the dorsal part of the lateral surface of the cal- caneus and the cuboid. Its fibres converge to a flat tendon which passes transversely across the flexor longus digitorum and beneath the flexor brevis digitorum and calcaneometatar- sal. /nsertion.—Into the medial part of the outer surface of the tendon of the flexor longus digitorum. Action.—It holds the flexor longus tendon in place. Mm. lumbricales.—These are six. Origin.—The three larger ones have origin from the outer surface of the expanded portion of the flexor longus digitorum on its distal half. Each ends in a slender tendon. Insertions.—The tendons unite with the divisions of the 214 _ THE MUSCLES. tendon of the flexor brevis which pass to the three lateral digits, at their entrance to the first annular ligament. The one to the fifth digit is sometimes absent. The other three have origzz from the tendon of the flexor longus digitorum at the point where it divides. Each-occupies one of the three intervals between the four divisions, and its fibres originate from the proximal ends of the two tendons which bound its interval. Insertion by a very slender tendon into the medial side of the first phalanges of the third, fourth, and fifth digits near their bases. Action.—Move the third, fourth, and fifth digits toward the medial side. _ Mm. interossei.—The interosseus of the second digit forms five portions, which cover the ventral surface of the digit. Origin.—(1) By two tendons from the ventral process of the lateral cuneiform. The muscle divides into four parts, three of which pass to the medial side of the digit and act as abductors. They are called the long, short, and middle abductors (abductor longus, brevis, and intermedius digiti secundi). Insertions.—The short head into the medial sesamoid of the metatarsophalangeal joint, the middle into the medial side of the base of the first phalanx, and the long into the extensor communis tendon near the distal end of the first phalanx. The names long, short, and middle refer to the lengths of the tendons as determined by their points of insertion. The fourth portion which comes from the lateral cuneiform has its zzsertion into the lateral side of the extensor tendon near the distal end of the first phalanx. It is therefore an adductor longus digiti secundi. In some cases there is an adductor brevis from this same head. (2) The fifth part of the interosseus of the second digit has origin from the middle of the ligament covering the peroneal canal, along with the middle adductor of the fifth digit. The two muscles diverge. /usertion into the outer side of the base of the first phalanx of the second digit. It is an adductor medius digiti secundi. if i gh) MUSCLES OF THE PELVIC LIMBS. 215 The interossei of the third and fourth digits are alike. Origin from the ventral surface of the base of the metatar- sal. The muscles cover the ventral surface of the shaft. At the head each divides and passes onto the sides of the metatarsal. Insertion.—Each half of the muscle shows a tendency to divide into two parts. One of these, the more superficial and ventral, ends in a tendon which joins the extensor tendon near the distal end of the first phalanx. The other part is inserted by short tendon- and muscle-fibres into the side of the base of the first phalanx; one of the parts is therefore a middle, and the other a long, adductor or abductor, the adductores and abduc- tores digiti tertii and quarti. ‘The fifth digit has five short muscles. M. abductor medius digiti quinti. Origin from the ventral surface of the calcaneus and from the fifth metatarsal. Insertion by a slender tendon into the lateral side of the base of the first phalanx of the fifth digit. M. adductor medius digiti quinti. Origin with the adductor medius digiti secundi. Insertion on the inner side of the base of the phalanx of the fifth digit. M. opponens digiti quinti. Origin by a flat tendon from the middle of the ligament which covers the peroneal canal. It passes obliquely outward parallel to the last. /nsertion on the inner side of the shaft of the fifth metatar- sal. The two remaining muscles of the fifth digit take origin from the outer part of the ligament covering the peroneal canal. They cover the ventral surface of the shaft. Insertion.—The lateral one is inserted into the lateral sesa- moid and is therefore an abductor brevis. The medial one is inserted into the extensor tendon and is therefore an adductor longus. C. MUSCLES OF THE TARSUS.—M. calcaneometatarsalis (part of M. adductor minimi digiti ?).—A weak muscle made up 216 THE MUSCLES. largely of tendon-fibres, some of which pass directly from origin to insertion. It may be regarded as a ligament. Origin, the lateral and ventral surface of the calcaneus near the proximal end. It passes distad and slightly laterad outside of the quadratus plante. Insertion, the lateral side of the base of the fifth metatarsal, and the adjacent surfaces of the cuboid and calcaneus. Action. —Probably causes slight motion of the cuboid on the head of the calcaneus. — M. scaphocuneiformis.—A small muscle lying on the sole of the foot in the depression between the lateral cuneiform, medial cuneiform, and the lateral tubercle of the scaphoid. It is hidden by the overlying ligaments. Origin, the lateral tubercle of the scaphoid bone. It passes distad and laterad. Insertion, the lateral surface of the medial cuneiform. Action.—Rotates the medial cuneiform on the scaphoid and would thus act as an opponens of the great toe if the great toe were present. THE VISCERA. I. THE BODY CAVITY. The greater part of the viscera are situated in the body cavity or celom. This is divided by the diaphragm into two parts, the thoracic cavity and the abdominal cavity. Each is lined by a serous membrane, in which the part covering the outer wall of the cavity is distinguished as the parietal layer from the part covering the viscera, which is known as the visceral layer. The thoracic cavity is bounded by the thoracic vertebre, the ribs, the sternum, and the diaphragm. The cranial open- ing of the cavity is filled by the trachea and cesophagus as they enter from the neck region. The thoracic cavity is lined by -two thin layers of tissue, the outer one of which is the fascia endothoracica, while the inner is the pleura. The fascia endothoracica is a sheet of connective tissue which lines the entire inner surface of the thoracic cavity, descending from the dorsal median line to the heart, and passing into the fibrous layer of the pericardium. The pleura is a thin membrane covering -the fascia endothoracica and corresponding to the peritoneum of the abdominal cavity. It forms two sacs, the pleure, lining respectively the right and left halves of the thoracic cavity. Each of these two sacs is closed, the viscera being suspended within them by folds of the membrane, so that the cavity is everywhere separated from the viscera by a sheet of the pleura. That portion of the pleura which lines the thoracic wall is known as the parietal layer; it may be divided into that covering the ribs (costal pleura), and that covering the diaphragm. That portion which covers the viscera is the visceral layer, or, since it covers chiefly the lungs, it may be 217 218 THE VISCERA. distinguished as the pulmonary pleura. The medial walls of the two pleural sacs come in contact in the median plane, forming a median vertical partition passing lengthwise of the thoracic cavity. This partition is known as the mediastinal septum. The space between the two layers which make up the mediastinal septum is known as the mediastinum, or mediastinal cavity; it contains numerous organs of the thorax. Three parts are usually distinguished in this cavity: a ventral mediastinal cavity, containing chiefly blood-vessels and the thymus gland; a middle mediastinal cavity, enclosing the heart and the anterior and posterior vene cave; and a dorsal medi- astinal cavity, containing the trachea, the cesophagus, and the aorta. The abdominal cavity lies caudad of the diaphragm; in it are sometimes distinguished the abdominal cavity proper, extending as far caudad as the cranial edge of the pubis, and the pelvic cavity, lying caudad of this, in the region surrounded by the innominate bones and the sacrum. The two cavities are not distinctly marked off, so that it is convenient to con- sider the abdominal cavity as undivided. Both parts are lined by the peritoneum. The peritoneum is a thin transparent sheet of connective tissue supporting on its surface a layer of flattened epithelial cells, the peritoneal epithelium. It forms a sac which lines the entire abdominal cavity. This sac is closed in the male; in the female, however, it communicates with the exterior through the uterine (or Fallopian) tubes and uteri. All the organs of the abdominal cavity are outside the sac. In the course of their development these organs have encroached on the peritoneal sac. Each has grown against the outer wall of the sac to a greater or less extent and has forced a part of this wall ahead of it into the cavity. In some cases the encroachment has gone so far that the organ in question lies apparently within the peritoneal cavity, suspended from the wall of the sac by a fold of that wall. The wall may thus be divided into three portions. One of these, the parietal layer, lines the wall of the body cavity. The second (the mesentery in case of the alimentary canal, or a ligament in the case of another organ) ee ee ee . pid): THE BODY CAVITY. 219 suspends the organ from the body wall. Between the layers of each inesentery or ligament blood-vessels may pass to the organs. The third portion or visceral layer covers the organ in question, forming its serous covering. The reflections of the peritoneum to form the mesenteries and ligaments may be thus described: Caudally the peritoneum covers the whole surface of the bladder and is reflected from its ventral wall to the linea alba as the suspensory ligament of the bladder. Farther craniad the peritoneum suspends the rectum and colon from the mid- dorsal line, forming the mesorectum and mesocolon. The mesocolon continues craniad to the level of the caudal end of the right kidney and is broadest at its cranial end. At this end the mesocolon passes into the mesentery proper, which suspends the small intestine and is very broad and much folded. Its dorsal border is attached to the median line opposite the caudal end of the kidneys and is very short compared to its very long ventral or intestinal border. Toward the cranial end the mesentery of the jejunum passes gradually into the very much shorter duodenal mesentery. This is drawn out at the caudal end of the duodenum into a fold, the duodenorenal liga- ment which attaches the duodenum to the kidney. The mesogastrium or peritoneal fold for the stomach passes from that part of the median dorsal line lying between the kidneys and the diaphragm, to the greater curvature of the stomach. It does not pass directly to the stomach, but passes first ventrad of the small intestine as far as the pelvis. Thence it turns craniad to reach the greater curvature of the stomach. The fold thus formed is called the great omentum. It forms the dorsal and ventral walls of a sac, the omental sac, the cavity of which is called the lesser peritoneal cavity. The descending limb of the fold forms the dorsal wall of the sac, and its ascending limb forms the ventral wall. Each of these walls is double like a mesentery, so that the great omentum consists of four sheets of peritoneum. Between the two sheets forming the descending limb lies the left half of the pancreas, which passes thence to the right into the duodenal mesentery. A transverse fold passes from the descending limb of the 220 THE VISCERA. omentum along the cranial border of the pancreas to the duodenal mesentery. Farther to the right the descending limb of the omentum, which is here shorter, encloses the spleen and - holds it in position parallel to the greater curvature of the stomach and about one centimeter from it. This part of the. great omentum is sometimes called the gastrosplenic or gastrolienal omentum. The great omental sac: communicates with the peritoneal sac by an opening, the foramen epiploicum or foramen of Winslow. This opening lies caudad and dextrad of the caudate lobe of the liver. This lobe itself lies within the sac. Along the ventral border of the foramen epiploicum pass the common bile-duct from the liver and the portal vein to the liver. The size of the great omental sac is increased by the lesser omentum. This is a double sheet of peritoneum which stretches horizontally from the liver to the duodenum and the lesser curvature of the stomach. It covers ventrad the caudate lobe of the liver. Its right border is at the foramen epiploicum. The part of it which stretches to the duodenum is called the duodenohepatic ligament and contains the bile-ducts and the portal vein. The part that stretches to the stomach is called the gastrohepatic ligament. The peritoneum covers the caudal and cranial surfaces of the liver and is reflected to the adjacent parts to form the ligaments of the liver. The suspensory ligament of the liver passes from the caudal surface of the diaphragm and the median ventral line for about one or two centimeters caudad of the diaphragm, to the liver, and extends between itstwo halves. The ligamentum teres or round ligament is the thickened free caudal border of the suspensory ligament. It is the remains of the foetal umbili- cal vein. From the dorsal border of the liver the peritoneum which covers its cranial surface .turns ventrad onto the caudal surface of the diaphragm, while that which covers its caudal surface turns dorsad onto the caudal surface of the diaphragm to reach the dorsal body wall. Between these two sheets a small linear part of the surface of the liver is closely applied to the diaphragm without intervening peritoneum. The two a ES. fe Ties aa, Ve a SSSI " i eg ee Besos Sete OR hai a! bsg a ihe es WA THE ALIMENTARY CANAL. 221 sheets which bound this area constitute the coronary ligament of the liver. This ligament is broader where it passes from the left lateral lobe to the diaphragm and is called the triangular ligament. (There is perhaps a corresponding right trangular ligament, from the cranial division of the right lateral lobe.) The caudal division of the right lateral lobe is held to the kidney of that side by the hepatorenal ligament. II, THE ALIMENTARY CANAL. APPARATUS DIGESTORIUS. The alimentary canal may be divided into mouth, pharynx, cesophagus, stomach, small intestine, and large intestine. With these are associated certain accessory structures,—the salivary glands, the liver, and the pancreas. The spleen, though not belonging to the digestive system, is usually described in connection with it. The respiratory organs are almost throughout in close relation with the organs of the digestive system. 1. The Mouth. Cavum oris.—The mouth cavity extends from the lips to the pharynx. It is narrower toward the lips, broadens caudad as far back as the last teeth, then becomes narrowed to form the isthmus faucium, by which it communi- cates with the pharynx. The mouth cavity is divisible into the vestibule of the mouth (vestibulum oris), which comprises that part outside the jaws proper, bounded externally by the lips and cheeks, and the mouth cavity proper (cavum oris proprium), which lies within the teeth. That portion of the vestibule which is bounded by the cheeks is sometimes farther distinguished as the buccal cavity. The entire mouth cavity (except the teeth) is lined by the mucous membrane or mucosa. The lips (labia oris) are thick folds of skin bounding the entrance to the mouth cavity. The outer surface is covered with hair; the inner surface is covered with the mucous mem- brane. The upper lip is marked in the. median line by a deep external groove which extends upward to the septum of the nose. Along the inner surface of this groove the lip is closely united to the jaw by a thick fold, the frenulum of the upper lip. For some distance on each side of the frenulum the inner 222 THE VISCERA. surface of the lip bears numerous large papilla. The lower lip is also united to the jaw by a frenulum in the median line; it is again united to the jaw just caudad of the canine tooth, in the space between the latter and the first premolar. Caudad the two lips pass into each other (forming the commissura labiorum), and unite with the cheek. The muscles of the lips have been described (page 105). The cheeks (bucce) in the cat are comparatively thin and small, extending from the lips caudad to the ramus of the mandible. The outer surface is covered with hair; the inner surface is smooth and somewhat folded. The buccal cavity is rather small. On the inner surface of the cheek open the duct of the parotid (Steno’s duct), the ducts of the molar gland, and that of the infraorbital gland. The roof of the mouth cavity is formed by the hard and soft palates. The hard palate (palatum durum) forms the cranial part of the roof; it is supported by the palatal plates of the maxillary and palatine bones. The mucosa of the hard palate is elevated to form seven or eight curved transverse ridges, which are concave caudad. Between the ridges are rows of papilla. In front of the most cranial ridge is a papilla in the middle line, and at each side of the papilla is the open- ing of a small duct (the incisive duct or Stenson’s duct), which leads dorsad through the incisive foramen to the vomeronasal organ (or organ of Jacobson), which lies on the floor of the nasal cavity. Caudad of the hard palate the roof of the mouth is formed by the soft palate or velum palatinum, described below. The floor of the mouth cavity is formed chiefly by the tongue, which extends as far caudad as the isthmus faucium. Ventrad of the free edge of the tongue the mucosa forms a prominent median vertical fold which unites the tongue with the floor of the mouth beneath it; this fold is the frenulum - linguz. On each side of the median line at the cranial border of the floor of the mouth is a prominent papilla, at the apex of which open the ducts of the submaxillary and sublingual glands, the former on the lateral side of the apex, the latter on the medial side. THF ALIMENTARY CANAL. 223 The sides of the mouth cavity are formed by the teeth and the gums, covering the alveolar borders of the mandible, maxillaries, and premaxillaries. The mouth cavity presents further for examination the glands, the teeth, the tongue, and the soft palate. | THE GLANDS OF THE MOUTH (GLANDULA: ORIS).— There are five pairs of salivary glands which open into the mouth cavity. 1. The parotid gland (glandula parotis) (Fig. 65, 1; Fig. 131, 10) is flattened, rather finely lobulated, and lies ventrad of the external auditory meatus and beneath the dermal muscles. Its cranial border follows the caudal border of the masseter muscle and overlies it somewhat; its caudal border is about three centimeters caudad of the border of the masseter. Its borders are unevenly lobed. The parotid duct (ductus paro- _ tideus: frequently called Stenon’s or Steno’s duct) is formed by the union of several smaller ducts near the ventral end of the cranial border of the gland. It passes craniad imbedded in the fascia covering the masseter. At the cranial border of the masseter it turns inward and lies close against the mucous membrane of the mouth, so that from the inside of the mouth it appears as a white ridge on the mucosa. It opens on the inside of the cheek opposite the most prominent cusp of the last premolar tooth. Along the course of the parotid duct in some cases one or more small accessory parotid glands are found. 2. The submaxillary gland (glandula submaxillaris) (Fig. 65, 2, page 109, and Fig. 131, 11) is approximately kid- ney-shaped. Its surface is nearly smooth, the lobulations not being apparent externally. It lies ventrad of the parotid, at the caudal edge of the masseter muscle, just caudad of the angular process of the mandible. The posterior facial vein (Fig. 131, &) crosses its outer surface, and its cranioventral border is hidden by two lymphatic glands (Fig. 131, 12) lying at the sides of the anterior facial vein. The submaxillary duct (ductus submaxillaris, frequently called Wharton’s duct) leaves the inner surface of the gland and passes beneath the digastric and mylohyoid muscles and against the outer surface of the styloglossus. From the point where the styloglossus 224 THE VISCERA. passes into the tongue the duct continues craniad close against the oral mucosa and parallel to the mandibula. It is accom- panied by the duct of the sublingual, which lies at first dorsad of it and then mediad. It opens at the apex of the prominent papilla which lies at the side of the middle line at the cranial end of the floor of the mouth. 3. The sublingual gland is elongated and conical in form, with its base against the submaxillary, of which it appears to be a continuation. It stretches along the submaxillary duct for about one and one-half centimeters, lying between the masseter and digastric muscles. The sublingual duct leaves its ventral side, passes close to the submaxillary duct, at first dorsad and then mediad of it, and opens on the medial side of the apex of the same papilla with the submaxillary duct. 4. The molar gland (glandula molaris) (Fig. 65, 9) lies between the orbicularis oris and the mucosa of the lower lip. It stretches from the cranial border of the masseter to a point | between the first premolar and the canine. It is flat, broad caudad, and ends in a point craniad. It has several ducts which pass straight through the cheek and open on the mucous surface of the mouth. 5. The infraorbital (or orbital) gland lies in the lateral part of the orbit on its ventral floor. It is ovoid and about one and one-half centimeters long and one-third as thick. Its ventral end rests against the mucosa of the mouth just caudad of the molar tooth. Its duct leaves the ventral end and opens into the mouth at a point about three millimeters caudad of the molar tooth. THE TEETH. DENTES.—The adult cat has thirty teeth, fourteen in the lower jaw and sixteen in the upper jaw. There are twelve incisors, four canines, ten premolars, and four molars. The tooth formula for the cat is then iS Sate. Powsee, Rese Las z MEY 2 m8 ate, 4 Z 3—3 I—I 2—2 I—I The teeth are implanted in the alveolar borders of the premaxillaries, maxillaries, and mandible. In each tooth can be distinguished the root, imbedded in the socket of the bone, EGS Se ear ee Se THE ALIMENTARY CANAL 225 the crown, which projects above the gums, and a narrow neck connecting the two. The root is composed of one or more separate fangs; the crown bears one or more points or cusps. At the cranial end of each jaw are six incisor teeth (Figs. 93 and 94, a). These are imbedded in the alveolar borders of the premaxillaries and the man- dible. The incisor teeth are small, with a crown bearing a sharp edge which is notched so as to form three minute cusps. The root of each has a single fang. The lateral inciscrs are the largest in each jaw, and those of the upper jaw are larger Fic. 93.—Uprer Jaw, witH Roots : OF THE TEETH LAID BARE. than those of the lower. eee Rice ass , incisors; 6, canine; ¢, first pre- Caudad of the. incisors, and molar; d, second premolar; ¢, third pre- : . molar; 7, molar. in the upper jaw separated from them by a slight interval, are the canines (4), two in each jaw. These are long, strong, pointed teeth, deeply imbedded in the mandible and maxillaries, their large sockets causing a rounded . swelling on the external surface of the bones. Each has a single fang and a single cusp. When the mouth is closed the upper canines lie laterocaudad of the lower ones. Caudad of the canines there is in each jaw a considerable interval free from teeth: this is called the diastema. Caudad of the diastema are the premolar teeth, three pairs (c, d, ¢) in the upper jaw and two pairs (c, d) in the lower jaw. These teeth are compressed sideways, and those of the lower jaw fit inside of those of the upper jaw. In the upper jaw (Fig. 93) the first premolar (c) is small and usually has but a single cusp and a single fang, though occasionally there is a small supple- mentary cusp and fang. The second premolar is larger (@) ; it has a large central cusp, with a single smaller cranial cusp and two small caudal cusps, making four in all. This tooth has two fangs. The third premolar (¢) is the largest tooth in the jaws; it has three large cusps in longitudinal series and a small cusp lying on the medial side of the first one in the row. Its root has three fangs. The molar tooth (/) of the upper 226 THE VISCERA. jaw is small and lies caudomediad of the last premolar. It has two small cusps and two fangs. Fic. 94. MANDIBLE, WITH ROOTS OF THE TEETH LAID BARE. a, incisors; 4, canine; ¢, first premolar; d, second premolar; /, molar. In the lower jaw (Fig. 94) the two premolars (c and @) are similar, the caudal one being a little larger. Each has four cusps; a single large one, a small one craniad of this, and two small ones caudad of it. Each has two fangs. The single molar (/) is the largest tooth of the lower jaw; it has two large cusps and two fangs. The Deciduous Teeth.—At birth the cat has no teeth. There appears later a set of twenty-six teeth: twelve incisors, four canines, and ten molars (six in the upper jaw and four in the lower). These teeth are later replaced by the permanent ones above described. The deciduous teeth of the cat are fully described by Jayne (‘‘ Mammalian Anatomy,’’ vol. I. p. 319), where also an account is given of the order of appearance of the teeth. THE TONGUE. LINGUA (Fig. 95).—The tongue is a muscular organ covered with mucous membrane; in life it is very mobile. It is an elongated organ, flat above, broadest in the middle, and very slightly narrowed at each end. It extends from the incisor teeth to the isthmus faucium and nearly fills the mouth cavity. The caudal third of the tongue forms the floor of the mouth cavity, so that the tongue has here no ventral surface, but is directly continuous with underlying organs. It is in this region that the extrinsic muscles of the tongue (except the genioglossus) enter it. The cranial two- thirds of the tongue is partly or entirely free from the floor of the mouth, the cranial one-third being completely free and movable. In about the middle third the ventral surface of the oT ee THE ALIMENTARY CANAL. 227 tongue is held to the floor of the mouth by the fold known as the frenulum lingue. The frenulum contains parts of the two genioglossus muscles, which enter the tongue through it. The ventral surface and lateral borders of the tongue are smooth, soft, and free from papillae. The dorsal surface is raised into papilla of various kinds, and has a slight median longitudinal furrow. The caudal part of the dorsal surface is softer, redder, and marked with papille of a different kind from those of the rest of the tongue. From the caudal end a small median vertical fold, the frenulum (or plica) glossoepiglottica passes from the dorsal surface of the tongue to the cranial surface of the epiglottis. The papille of the tongue are of three kinds. 1. The very num- erous filiform papille (a) (pap- ille filiformes); many of them / are horny and tooth-like, with points turned caudad. These are most numerous at the middle of the free end of the tongue. 2. The fungiform papille (4) (papille fungiformes) are found scattered over the surface of the middle of Fic. 95. — Toncur, EPIGLOTTIS, the tongue caudad of the large “ND OPENING or Larynx. f : a, filiform papille; 4, fungiform filiform papilla. They are en- papillze; 4’, very large papillz at the larged at their free ends. There ‘ides of the tongue; ¢, circumvallate : f papille; d, tonsils; ¢, epiglottis; 7 is a prominent row of very large plica aryepiglottica; g, arytenoid car- ones (4’) opposite the circumval- ney A ise weak ona ot ne late papillz at the borders of the vocal cords. tongue. 3. The circumvallate papille (c) (papille vallate) are blunt and each is surrounded by a trench which is bounded in turn bya raised wall. They are in two rows of two or three 228 THE VISCERA. each, which converge near the base of the tongue so as to form a V with the apex directed caudad. MUSCLES OF THE TONGUE (Fig. 96).—M. genioglossus (/) passes from the symphysis of the lower jaw into the tongue and lies beneath (dorsad of) the geniohyoid (g). Origin from the medial surface of the mandible near the symphysis and dorsad of the origin of the geniohyoid. Insertion.—The fibres pass dorsad, diverging in a fan-like manner and forming a flat vertical plate closely applied to the muscle of the opposite side. This plate extends along the caudal three-fourths of the tongue, i.e. as far as it is attached. The cranial fibres arch craniad to the tip of the tongue, the caudal fibres arch caudad to the root of the tongue. Dorsad the muscle is confounded with the muscle of the opposite side. Action.—Draws the root of the tongue forward and the tip backward. M. hyoglossus (/).—From the body of the hyoid bone to the tongue. Origin.—(1) From the ventral surface of the body of the hyoid laterad of the geniohyoid ( s); and (2) by a second head from the ceratohyal. Lnsertion.—Both heads penetrate into the tongue between the styloglossus (e¢) and the genioglossus (f/f). The fibres intermingle with those of the styloglossus (¢) and thus help to form the lateral parts of the tongue. They finally end in the integument on the dorsum of the tongue at the sides. Action.— Retracts the tongue and depresses it. M. styloglossus (e).—From the stylohyal bone to the tongue. Origin from the mastoid process of the temporal bone, from the stylomandibular ligament (2) (which connects the border of the external auditory meatus with the angular process of the mandible) and from the proximal cartilaginous portion of the cranial cornu of the hyoid bone. The fibres pass mediad, diverging between those of the digastric and hyoglossus (/) into the lateral part of the tongue. Insertion.—The fibres pass toward the tip of the tongue, where the mass finally ends in a point, the superficial ones is in RN ne ee ree es, THE ALIMENTARY CANAL. 229 gaining insertion into the integument at the sides of the tongue. Relations. —Outer surface with the digastric (Fig. 65, 2) and mylohyoid (Fig. 65, c). Inner surface with the ptery- Fic. 96.—MuscLes or ToncuE, Hyomp Bonr, AND PHARYNX. a, M. tragicus lateralis; 4, M. jugulohyoideus; c, M. pterygoideus externus; d, partially cut surface of M. pterygoideus internus; e, M. styloglossus; 7, M. genio- glossus; g, M. geniohyoideus; 4, M. hyoglossus; z, M. glossopharyngeus; 7, M. con- strictor pharyngis medius; 4, M. constrictor pharyngis inferior; 7, M. stylopharyngeus; m, M. sternohyoideus (cut); 7, M. cricothyreoideus; 0, M. sternothyreoideus (cut); ’ ~, M. thyreohyoideus. 1, mandible; 1’, angular process of mandible; 2, stylo- mandibular ligament; 3, bulla tympani; 4, trachea; 5, cesophagus; 6, thyroid gland; 7, isthmus of the thyroid gland. goideus internus (Fig. 96, @), the cranial cornu of the hyoid, and the tympanic bulla. Action.—Retracts the tongue and raises it. The intrinsic muscles of the tongue (those entirely within it) are attached to its integument at both their ends. There are three sets of fibres: a longitudinal, a transverse, and a ver- tical one. These are seen most readily in cross-sections. The SOFT PALATE. VELUM PALATINUM (Fig. 66, page 230 THE VISCERA. 112).—The soft palate is the free curtain-like structure which forms the caudal part of the roof of the mouth. It is attached to the caudal border of the palatal plates and the ventral border of the perpendicular plates, of the palatine, and to the pterygoid processes and hamuli of the sphenoid, and extends some dis- tance caudad of the hamuli. It thus forms a rather long and narrow curtain separating the caudal part of the nasal cavity from the mouth. Caudad it ends in a free arched border (Fig. 66, 4) which is at about the level of the epiglottis, and may lie against the cranial or the caudal surface of the latter. The narrowed passage bounded by the margin of the velum palat- inum dorsad and the tongue ventrad is the isthmus faucium. From the sides of the velum a short distance from the caudal border a fold of mucosa passes ventrad to the side of the tongue; a short distance caudad of this a similar fold passes to the floor of the pharynx. These folds form the cranial and caudal pillars of the fauces. Between these folds is a shallow pocket, from the bottom of which there arises a prominent pro- jection or swelling which is one of the two tonsils (Fig. 95, @). Each tonsil is a reddish, lobulated gland, lymphoid in the adult, nearly a centimeter in length, and about one-third as long as broad, with its long axis craniocaudad. The velum palatinum consists of two layers of mucous membrane, oral and nasal, with intervening muscular and con- nective tissue. The muscles of the soft palate in the cat are as follows: M. tensor veli palatini (Fig. 66, d, d’, page 112). Origin from the ventral surface of the body of the sphenoid between the foramen ovale and the groove for the Eustachian tube. The muscle ends in a flat tendon which passes over the hamular process (3) of the pterygoid bone. Insertion by spreading out in the soft palate into an aponeurosis which joins the aponeurosis of the opposite muscle and lies between the mucous membrane of the mouth and that of the nose. Action.—Stretches the palate. M. levator veli palatini (Fig. 66, ¢, e’).—A flat triangular muscle which lies within the tensor. OER ema Dt Fe, Pra ee, Eke phe Fis 235 15 at a THE ALIMENTARY CANAL. 231 Origin from the surface of the body of the sphenoid mediad of the groove for the Eustachian tube, from the styliform process of the bulla tympani, and in part from the Eustachian tube. The muscle passes caudad, and its fibres then diverge into the velum palatinum. Insertion into the velum palatinum, some of the fibres meeting in the middle line. .4ction indicated by the name. A number of other muscles have been described in the soft palate of the cat; they are, however, poorly developed and not easily distinguished. For an account of these, see Stowell, Proceedings of the Am. Soc. of Microscopists, 1889. 2. The Pharynx.—At the caudal end of the mouth cavity the passage for the food and that for the air cross; at the cranial end the food-passage (mouth) is ventral, the respiratory passage (nasal cavity) dorsal. Farther caudad the food-passage ‘ (esophagus) is dorsal, while the respiratory passage (larynx and trachea) is ventral. In the region of crossing there is therefore for a certain distance a common passageway for food and air, and this is known as the pharynx. It extends from the isthmus faucium, at the free caudal margin of the soft palate, to the beginning of the cesophagus, at the dorsal or caudal margin of the opening of the larynx. The dorsal wall of the pharynx is separated from the base of the skull and the centra of the cervical vertebre only by intervening muscles (longus capitis, levator scapule ventralis, and longus colli, Fig. 72, page 143). Its lateral and ventral walls are supported by the hyoid bone and the cartilages of the larynx. Craniad the pharynx continues, usually, without break into _ the cavity lying dorsad of the soft palate. But at the time of swallowing the free edge of the soft palate is pushed dorsad against the dorsal wall of the pharynx, while the caudal part of the pharynx is drawn craniad, so as to form a cavity con- tinuous with that of the mouth. In this way the cavity above the soft palate is completely separated at the time of swallow- ing from the rest of the pharynx. This separated portion is known as the nasopharynx: it is strictly a portion of the respiratory passage, as the food does not pass into it. The 232 THE VISCERA. nasopharynx is continuous craniad by the choane with the nasal cavity; it forms a horizontal tube between and ventrad of the perpendicular plates of the palatine bones, and has the same craniocaudal extent as the soft palate. Its dorsal wall lies against the basis cranii and the longus capitis muscles; its lateral walls against the pterygoid muscles and the perpendic- ular plates of the palatine bones; its ventral wall is the soft palate. At the middle of its length, at the junction of its dorsal and lateral wall, are two longitudinal slits about three millimeters long. These are the medial openings of the Eustachian tubes, by which the nasopharynx communicates with the tympanic cavity. The pharynx proper, situated caudad of the nasopharynx, is smaller than the latter. It is bounded craniad by the epiglottis and the margin of the soft palate, and is continuous between the two, by the isthmus faucium, with the mouth cavity. Its floor is formed by the cranial end of the larynx. At its caudal end it passes dorsally into the cesophagus, while ventrally it communicates with the larynx. Its walls are muscular. MUSCLES OF THE PHARYNX (Fig. 96).—M. glossopharyn- geus (7). Origin.—Some fibres on the ventral and lateral part of the genioglossus (/) leave that muscle near its caudal end. They form a thin band of diverging fibres which pass outside of the cranial horn of the hyoid. A similar sheet of fibres leaves the midventral part of the styloglossus (¢). The two sheets unite and the united muscle crosses the hyoid, turns dorsad, and has its Insertion into the median dorsal raphe of the pharynx. Action.—Constrictor of the pharynx. M. constrictor pharyngis inferior (4).—A thin sheet of muscle covering the sides of the pharynx at its caudal end. Origin from the lateral surfaces of the thyroid and the cricoid cartilages. The fibres pass dorsad and craniad, the cranial ones covering the fibres of the middle constrictor (7). Insertion.—TYhe median longitudinal raphe on the dorsum of the pharynx. The caudal fibres are transverse and contin- THE ALIMENTARY CANAL. 233 uous with the circular fibres of the cesophagus. The cranial fibres may pass as far as the base of the sphenoid. Action. —Constrictor of the pharynx. M. constrictor pharyngis medius (7). —A thin sheet which covers the middle part of the lateral surface of the pharynx. Origin. —The ventral two pieces of the cranial horn and the whole of the caudal horn of the hyoid. The fibres diverge, passing dorsad. Insertion into the median dorsal raphe of the pharynx. The cranial fibres are inserted into the base of the sphenoid bone. The muscle covers part of the stylopharyngeus (/) and the superior constrictor (Fig. 66, f, page 112) and is partly covered by the glossopharyngeus (Fig. 96, Z). Action.—Constrictor of the pharynx. M. stylopharyngeus (/). Origin from the tip of the mastoid process of the temporal bone and from the inner surface of the cartilaginous piece between the tympanohyal and the stylohyal bones. The parallel fibres form a flat band which passes ventrocaudad over the outer surface of the constrictor superior. Insertion.—The ventral fibres pass beneath the middle con- strictor (7) at its cranial border and, continuing toward the . middle line of the pharynx, gradually lose themselves among the fibres of the superior constrictor. The dorsal fibres pass onto the outer surface of the middle constrictor and are lost among its fibres. Action.—Constrictor of the pharynx. M. constrictor pharyngis superior or pterygopharyngeus (Fig. 66, 7, page 112).—A flat, triangular sheet beneath the constrictor medius. Origin.—The tip of the hamular process of the pterygoid bone. The muscle passes caudad, the fibres diverging, and dips beneath the cranial border of the constrictor medius. Insertion into the median dorsal raphe of the pharynx. The dorsal fibres are inserted into the base of the sphenoid. The ventral fibres pass lengthwise of the pharynx, closely connected with those of the stylopharyngeus (Fig. 96, 7), and finally reach the level of the larynx. 234 THE VISCERA. Action.—Constrictor of the pharynx. 3. The @sophagus.—The cesophagus is a straight tube, dorsoventrally flat when empty, which extends from the pharynx to the stomach. It has a uniform diameter when moderately dilated of about one centimeter. It lies dorsad of the trachea and against the longus colli muscles (Fig. 72, g’) covering the centra of the cervical vertebre, until it reaches the caudal end of the thyroid giand (Fig. 96, 6); then it passes to the left and lies Jaterodorsad of the trachea until it reaches the bifurcation of the trachea. It there returns to the median line, passes gradually distad, separated from the vertebra by the aorta, and finally pierces the diaphragm about two centi- meters from the dorsal body wall, and enters the stomach. Its attachment to the diaphragm is loose enough to permit of longi- tudinal motion. In passing through the thoracic cavity it lies in the posterior mediastinum ventrad of the aorta. Its wall consists of a muscular coat, a submucosa, and a mucosa, and its inner surface presents many longitudinal folds. It has no serous covering, its side walls being merely in contact with the halves of the mediastinal septum. 4. The Stomach. Ventriculus (Fig. 97).—The stomach is the widest part of the alimentary canal. It is a pear-shaped sac, the long axis of which is curved nearly into a semicircle. The broad end of the sac lies to the left and dorsad; here the stomach communicates with the cesophagus (a). The narrowed end extends to the right and lies more ventrad than the other end; it passes here into the duodenum (g). That portion of the stomach which communicates with the cesophagus is known as the cardiac end (4); the opposite is the pyloric end. Owing to the curved form of the stomach above mentioned it is possi- ble to distinguish a concave and a convex side. The concave side is directed craniad and dextrad; it is called the lesser curvature of the stomach (c). The longer convex border is directed caudad and to the left; it is called the greater curva- ture (7). The greater curvature extends to the left, next to the cesophagus, into a prominent convexity known as the fundus (¢) of the stomach. The stomach lies at the cranial end of the abdominal + . Es THE ALIMENTARY CANAL. 235 cavity, mostly to the left of the middle line. Its cardiac end is in contact by its dorsal surface with the dorsal, nearly hori- zontal, portion of the diaphragm. On its ventral side the cardiac end does not touch the diaphragm, so that a small part of the cesophagus passes here for a short distance into the abdominal cavity, to join the stomach. The communication of cesophagus and stomach is by a simple conical increase in FIG. 97-—STOMACH, VENTRAL VIEW. a, cesophagus; 4, cardiac end of the stomach; ¢, lesser curvature; d, greater curvature; e, fundus; f, pyloric valve; g, part of duodenum. size of the former. The pyloric end of the stomach extends to the right of the middle line, becoming constantly smaller; at its junction with the duodenum there is a constriction which marks the position of the pyloric valve (/). This valve is formed by a ring-like thickening of the circular muscle-fibres of the alimentary canal, forming a sphincter muscle at the junction of the stomach and duodenum and causing a projection of the mucosa into the lumen of the canal. The ventral surface of the stomach lies against the liver except when the stomach is much distended with food, when the ventral surface comes to lie against the ventral abdominal wall. The stomach is supported by the great omentum and the gastrohepatic ligament. It is connected with the duodenum by the gastroduodenal ligament; with the spleen by ‘the gas- trolienal ligament. 236 THE VISCERA. The inner surface of the stomach presents longitudinal folds at its pyloric end and along the greater curvature as far as the fundus. The prominence of these depends on the degree of distension. Its walls are composed of an external peritoneal layer, an internal mucous layer, and an intervening muscular layer. This may be seen with the unaided eye in sections of the wall. 5. The Small Intestine. Intestinum tenue.—The small intestine lies in numerous coils which take up the greater part of the space in the abdominal cavity. It has a length about three times that of the body of the cat. It is usually considered as, divided into three parts, duodenum, jejunum, and ileum; these divisions are, however, not clearly marked off. The small intestine is suspended by the mesentery already described. The duodenum is that part of the small intestine which fol- lows the stomach. At the pylorus (Fig. 97, /) the alimentary canal makes a rather sharp turn so that the first part of the duodenum forms an angle with the pyloric portion of the stomach, and extends caudad and slightly toward the right, soon becoming directed almost entirely caudad and lying along the right side. About eight or ten centimeters caudad of the pylorus it makes a U-shaped bend, extending thus craniosinis- trad for four or five centimeters. Here it passes without definite limit into the jejunum, the duodenum being considered to end at the next turn caudad. The entire duodenum is about four- teen to sixteen centimeters in length. Between the two limbs of the U-shaped bend formed by the duodenum, the duodenal half of the pancreas is enclosed (Fig. 102, a). The walls of the duodenum are composed of the serous (peritoneal) investment, a muscular coat which is made up of an outer thin, longitudinal layer of fibres and an inner thick, | circular layer, a submucous coat, and inside this a mucous coat. The mucosa is thrown up into numerous delicate finger-like villi which give to it a velvety appearance. On the dorsal wall of the duodenum, about three centimeters distad of the pylorus, the mucosa presents a slight papilla, at the apex of © which is seen the oval opening of the ampulla of Vater. This THE ALIMENTARY CANAL. 237 is an ovoid space in the wall of the duodenum. The space is encroached upon by numerous folds of the walls. The common bile-duct and the pancreatic duct open into it, the former extending from the bottom of the ampulla nearly to its mouth, and the latter extending from the bottom about half-way to the mouth. Two centimeters caudoventrad of the opening of the ampulla of Vater is the opening of the accessory pan- creatic duct. It can usually be demonstrated only by passing a bristle into the duodenum through an opening in the duct. The jejunum is the part of the small intestine following the duodenum. It is not separated from the part of the small intestine following it by any sharp line. In man it constitutes two-fifths of the small intestine exclusive of the duodenum, and is characterized by its emptiness after death and by the absence from it of Peyer’s agminated glands (Peyer’s patches). The ileum is the portion of the small intestine between the jejunum and colon. It lies suspended by its mesentery in numerous folds in the caudal part of the abdominal cavity, separated from the ventral abdominal wall only by the great omentum. It is of nearly uniform diameter, but its caudal por- tion is. thinner-walled than its cranial portion. Its walls have a microscopic structure like that of the duodenum and jejunum. On its inner surface and on the inner surface of the jejunum are seen close-set villi, but these become rather sparser toward the caudal end of the ileum and disappear about one centimeter from the opening into the colon. Among the villi of the caudal end of the ileum are numerous rounded elongations free from villi. These are the solitary follicles or solitary glands (lymphatic) of the intestine. These glands when aggregated together form the agminated glands or patches of Peyer. The ileum passes at the caudal end into the colon, the opening being guarded by the ileocolic valve (Fig. 99). This is formed by a marked projection of the mucosa (/) and transverse muscle layer (¢) of the ileum into the colon. Its surface is free from villi. 6. The Large Intestine. Intestinum crassum. — The large intestine is divided into colon and rectum. The colon or first part of the large intestine lies against the dorsal body 238 THE VISCERA. wall and is separated from the ventral body wall by the folds of the ileum. It has a diameter about three times that of the ileum. The opening of the ileum into it is on its side between one and two centimeters from its cranial end (Fig. 98). ©The Fic. 98.—JUNCTION OF SMALL AND Fic. 99. — SECTION OF THE ILEO- LARGE INTESTINE. ; COLIC VALVE. Fig. 98.—a, ileum; 4, ascending colon; ¢, cecum; @, position of ileocolic valve. Fig. 99.—a, caecum; 4, colon; ¢, ileum; @, longitudinal muscle layer; ¢, trans- verse muscle layer; 7, mucosa; g, ileocolic valve (opened, as when material is pass- ing into the colon). blind pouch thus formed by the cranial end of the colon is the cecum (Fig. 98, c; Fig. 99, a). The cecum ends in a slight conical projection which may be considered as the rudiment of a vermiform appendix. The colon lies at first on the right side and passes at first craniad; then transversely to the left, then caudad, lying nearly in the middle line and next to the dorsal abdominal wall. The colon may thus be distinguished accord- ing to its direction into ascending, transverse, and descending colon. At its caudal end the colon passes without sharp limit into the rectum. | At the bottom of the cecum on its inner surface is seen a collection of solitary glands forming one of the agminated glands of Peyer, or Peyer’s patches. The mucous membrane is without villi. It presents a few considerable elevations, probably solitary glands. THE ALIMENTARY CANAL, 239 The rectum is the terminal portion of the large intestine lying in the median line close to the dorsal body wall, from which it is suspended by the short mesorectum. Its structure is like that of the colon. It opens externally at the anus. The entire large intestine has a length about one-half that of the animal. At each side of the anus are two large secreting sacs, the anal sacs-or glands, each about a centimeter in diameter. These open into the anus one or two millimeters from its caudal boundary. Muscles of the Rectum and Anus.—Owing to the close interrelation of the muscles of the rectum and anus with those of the urogenital organs, all these muscles will be described together at the end of the description of the urogenital system. 7. The Liver, Pancreas, and Spleen.—The Liver. Hepar. —The liver (Figs. 100 and 101) is a large red-brown organ occupying the cranial part of the abdominal cavity. It is closely applied to the caudal surface of the diaphragm and -extends thence ventrad of the stomach so as to conceal all but its pyloric end. Owing to the position of the stomach the larger mass of the liver is on the right side and it extends somewhat further caudad on this side. The liver is divided by the dorsoventral suspensory liga- ment into the right and left lobes, and each half is again divided into lobes. On the left is a small left median (0) and a larger left lateral lobe (a). The left lateral (2) extends caudad with a thin edge which covers the greater part of the ventral surface of the stomach. On the right there is a large right median (or cystic) lobe (c, c’). Its cranial surface is dome-shaped and fitted against the right two-thirds of the caudal surface of the diaphragm. Its ventral edge is thin, its dorsal edge thick, and its caudal surface marked -by a deep dorsoventral cleft in which lies the gall-bladder (Fig. 101, f). Dorsad and caudad of the cystic lobe is the right lateral lobe (d, 2’), which is deeply cleft. Its elongated caudal division (d’) extends in a point to the caudal end of the right kidney and is adapted to the medial half of its ventral surface. Its smaller and more compact cranial division (¢@) ends ventrally in a thin edge. It lies between the caudal division (@’) and the cystic lobe (c), and 240 THE VISCERA. Fic, 100.—Liver, CRANIAL SURFACE. @, left lateral lobe; 4, left median dobe; c, right median lobe; @, @’, right lateral lobe; ¢, gall-bladder; f opening of posterior vena cava, with the smaller openings of the hepatic veins. Fic. 101.—LIVER TURNED CRANIAD, SHOWING DorRSOCAUDAL SURFACE. a, left lateral lobe; 4, left median lobe; ¢, ¢’, right median (or cystic) lobe; ¢, @’, cranial and caudal divisions of the right lateral lobe; ¢, caudate lobe; /, gall-bladder; g, cystic duct; 4, hepatic ducts; 7, common bile-duct; 7, portal vein; 4, part of duodenum. WS PATE tee Se jai ci a a aa al THE ALIMENTARY CANAL. 241 its dorsal surface is adapted to the suprarenal body. The caudate or Spigelian lobe (Fig. 101, ¢) is an elongated, tri- angular, pyramidal lobe. It lies in the omental sac and partly closes the foramen epiploicum (foramen of Winslow). At its base it is connected with the caudal division of the right lateral lobe (@’). The Gall-bladder (Fig. 101, /) is pear-shaped and lies in a cleft on the caudal (or dorsal) surface of the right median lobe (c, c’) of the liver. Its larger end is directed caudad (or ventrad) and is free. By one surface it is in contact with the liver and not covered by peritoneum, while the other surface is covered by peritoneum. The peritoneum in passing from the larger free end to the liver forms one or two ligament-like folds. By its smaller end the gall-bladder is continuous with the cystic duct (¢). This duct is about three centimeters long and has a sinuous course. At itssdistal end it is joined by two (or more) hepatic ducts (2), bringing the bile from the lobes of the liver. The relation of these to the cystic duct varies. They may open into it by a common trunk or separately. Of these hepatic ducts one is made up by the junction of smaller hepatic ducts from the left half of the liver and the left half of the cystic lobe, while the other is similarly formed by smaller ducts from the right half of the cystic lobe, from both divisions of the right lateral lobe and from the caudate lobe. The duct formed by the junction of the hepatic and cystic ducts is the common bile-duct (ductus communis choledochus) (7). It passes in the free right border of the gastroduodenal omentum to the duodenum (#) and opens into it by way of the ampulla of Vater, in common with the pancreatic duct, at a point on the dorsal surface of the duodenum and about three centimeters from the pylorus. Pancreas.—The pancreas (Fig. 102, a) is a flattened, closely lobulated gland of irregular outline, about twelve centi- meters long, varying in width from’ one to two centimeters. It is bent nearly at right angles at about its middle. One of the halves (a’) into which it is divided by its bend lies in the descending limb of the great omentum, and is near the greater curvature of the stomach (@) and parallel to it. The free end ? el ra 242 THE VISCERA. of this half is in contact with the spleen (¢). The other half ' (a) lies in the duodenal omentum between the limits of the duodenal U (c) and reaches to the bottom of the U. The pancreas has two ducts. The larger pancreatic duct (é) (sometimes known as the duct of Wirsung) collects the pan- creatic fluid from both halves of the gland, the ductlets from each half uniting to make two larger ducts, which then unite near the angle of the gland to make the pancreatic duct. This is short and broad and opens into the ampulla of Vater together with the common bile-duct. The accessory pancreatic duct nN y FIG. 102.—PANCREAS AND SPLEEN. The cesophagus has been cut and the stomach turned caudad, so that the dorsal surface of the stomach and the ventral surface of the duodenum are seen. a, pan- creas (@, duodenal portion; a’, gastric portion); 4, pancreatic duct; ¢, duodenum; d, stomach; e, spleen. (duct of Santorini) opens into the duodenum about two centi- meters caudoventrad of the ampulla of Vater. It is formed by the union of branches which anastomose with those of the pancreatic duct. It is apparently sometimes lacking. Spleen. Lien.—The spleen (Fig. 102, ¢) is a deep red, flattened, elongated gland belonging to the lymphatic system. One of its ends, the left, lies against the free end of the gastric half of the pancreas and is broader than the other end. The spleen is curved and is suspended in the descending limb of the great omentum so that it follows the greater curvature of the stomach (7). ; A a a SS eee ee ee ee eae eae RESPIRATORY ORGANS. 243 Ill. RESPIRATORY ORGANS. APPARATUS RESPIRA- TORIUS. The organs of respiration consist of the nasal cavity, the nasopharynx, the pharynx (also a food-passage), the larynx (also the organ of the voice), the trachea, the bronchi, and the lungs. With them are usually described also the thyroid and thymus glands. | 1. The Nasal Cavity. Cavum nasi.—The osseous frame- work of the nasal cavity has already been described (page 59), and in connection with this description the boundaries of the cavity and its connections with other cavities have been given. It consists essentially of a large cavity bounded by the facial bones and divided by a longitudinal partition into two lateral halves. The two cavities thus formed are nearly filled by (1) the labyrinths of the ethmoid (ethmoturbinals), (2) the superior nasal conche or nasoturbinals, projecting into the dorsal part from the ventral surface of the nasal bones, and (3) the inferior nasal conche, or maxilloturbinals, prejecting into the ventral portion from the medial surfaces of the maxillaries. There remain to be considered, in addition to the bones, the cartilaginous framework of certain parts of the nose, and the mucous membrane. The lamina perpendicularis is con- tinued by cartilage, especially craniad, in such a way as to make a complete septum separating the two cavities. This septum extends from the septum of the external nose caudad to the lamina cribrosa, and from the internasal suture ventrad to the vomer and the suture of the premaxillaries. All parts of the nasal cavity are lined by mucous membrane. This is continuous at the nares with the integument, while at the choane it passes into the mucosa of the pharynx. It covers the conche nasales and the labyrinths of the ethmoid, passing into the cellules of the latter. Owing to the crowding together of the conchez nasales and the labyrinths the nose is almost completely filled, only three narrow passageways being distin- guishable. The ventral one of these, known as the ventral or inferior meatus of: the nose, lies ventrad of the inferior nasal concha, next to the nasal septum. It passes caudad beneath 244 THE VISCERA. the horizontal plate formed by the vomer and ethmoid, and opens caudad at the choane into the nasopharynx. The dorsal or superior meatus of the nose lies just ventrad of the superior nasal concha, next to the median septum; it leads to the frontal sinus, the lamina cribrosa, and the caudal parts of the ethmoid. The middle meatus of the nose has almost dis- appeared in the cat; it is simply the narrow space between the superior and inferior meati. It is practically filled by the ethmoid, into the cells of which it leads. The mucosa is con- tinued from the nasal cavity into the sinuses of the frontals and presphenoid. At the sides of the nasal septum, near the ventral edge, and about one to one and a half centimeters caudad of the nares, there is on each side a small curved cartilaginous tube, about one centimeter or less in length. This, the vomeronasal organ, or organ of Jacobson, lies against the septum, between it and the mucosa. It begins at the incisive canal or anterior palatine foramen, in the roof of the mouth, curves thence caudodorsad close against the side of the nasal septum, and ends blindly in the nasal cavity. The nares or cranial openings of the nasal cavity are sup- ported by a number of cartilages which form the framework of the snout or external nose. ‘The cartilaginous continuation of the lamina perpendicularis extends some distance craniad of the tips of the nasal and. premaxillary bones, forming the septum of the external nose (Fig. 103, a). From the dorsal edge of this projecting car- tilaginous septum, two thin cartilaginous wings _ (6) extend laterad, forming the dorsal wall of Fic. 103. — Cross- the narial opening. Each then turns ventrad SECTION OF THE i s Cartitaces or to form the lateral wall of the opening, but Sees EXTERNAL does not form the ventral floor; instead it a, cartilage of the Curves mediad and finally dorsad, thus ex- rigor Acnee HAO tending from the floor of the opening as a formed by internal prominent ridge (c) within the nares. The portion of wing. cartilaginous wing is thus rolled into a sort of spiral, ending with a free edge within the narial opening. From the ventral edge of the median cartilaginous septum there oS ee ee en | ee ee ee ee Se ee re a RESPIRATORY ORGANS. 245 are likewise lateral extensions, which form part of the ventral boundary of the nares; these do not quite reach the ventral parts of the dorsal wings, however, so that a small part of the narial opening is not bounded by cartilage. A section of the narial: cartilages is shown in Fig. 103. The wings from the dorsal edge of the septum do not extend quite to the cranial tip of the nose, so that a notch is formed on the ventrolateral side of the nares; a section in this region would therefore differ from that figured. The framework of the external nose thus formed is covered externally by thick hairless skin, containing many glands. From the ventral end of the internarial septum a groove passes ventrad, partly dividing the upper lip. The inner surfaces of the cartilages are covered by the mucosa, which forms a number of ridges. The narial opening is almost completely divided by the prominent ridge which is supported by the free edge (c) of the cartilaginous wing above described. This free edge is covered by a thick layer of mucosa, and the entire ridge so formed is continuous caudad with the inferior nasal concha. On the medial side of the partial partition formed by this ridge and near the ventral side there begins a slight distance caudad of the outer opening another ridge, supported by the ventrally incurved portion of the cartilaginous ring. This soon becomes a thick swelling; beneath it opens the lachrymal canal, and that part of the passageway that lies ventromediad of it is the beginning of the inferior meatus of the nose. About one or two centimeters caudad of the external opening a third ridge projects from the dorsolateral wall of the cavity toward the large ridge first described; dorsomediad of it is a narrow passage which is the entrance to the superior meatus of the nose. The olfactory mucosa, or that part to which the olfactory nerve is distributed, and which therefore acts as the sensory surface, is confined to the dorsocaudal parts of the nasal cavity, in the region occupied by the cells of the ethmoid. The air penetrates to this region probably only by a definite act of snuffing, the inferior meatus serving as the usual passage- way of air to the lungs. . 246 THE VISCERA. The nasopharynx and pharynx are considered under the alimentary canal (page 231). 2. The Larynx. The larynx is the enlarged upper end of the air-passage which leads from the pharynx to the lungs. It is a box com- posed of pieces of cartilage connected by ligaments and moved by muscles, and it is lined by mucous membrane. At the root of the tongue about one centimeter caudad of the body of the hyoid bone is the triangular leaf-like epiglottis (Fig. 95, e, page 227). When food is taken this closes the opening into the larynx, and the food passes over it into the cesophagus. It is so curved that its apex is directed craniad. A fold of mucous membrane, the plica glossoepiglottica or frenulum of the epiglottis, extends from the middle of its cranial surface to the root of the tongue, and on each side of this fold is a depression. From each side of the base of the epiglottis a fold, plica aryepiglottica (Fig. 95, /), extends caudad to the base of the arytenoid cartilage (g). Dorsad of this fold and separated from it by a depression is a ridge which marks the position of the caudal hyoid cornu. The plice aryepiglottice (/) and the epiglottis (¢) form the boundaries of the aditus laryngis, or opening into the larynx. The cavity of the larynx is divided into three portions. The upper one of these is the vestibule of the larynx. It is bounded caudad by two folds of mucosa (2) that stretch from the caudal surface of the epiglottis near its base to the tips of the arytenoid cartilages. These folds are the false vocal cords (2). Their vibration is said to produce purring. Caudad of the false vocal cords two -folds of the mucosa stretch from the apices of the arytenoid cartilages to the thyroid cartilages, near the base of the epiglottis. These folds are nearer the median plane than the false vocal cords. They are the true vocal cords (7). The middle portion of the laryngeal cavity is that between the true and the false vocal cords. It is produced laterally into a very small pouch or pocket on each side, the ventriculus. The narrow slit between the true vocal cords is the glottis (%). It can be narrowed eS ee eee ee en ee RESPIRATORY ORGANS. 247 and widened by the action of muscles. The vocal cords, which bound it, are set vibrating by currents of air transmitted from the lungs, and the voice-sounds are thus produced. The caudal portion (inferior portion) of the laryngeal cavity is that between the glottis and the first tracheal cartilage. It is narrowed near the glottis. CARTILAGES OF THE LARYNX (Fig. 104).—There are three unpaired cartilages, the thyroid (1), cricoid (3), and epiglottic (2), and two paired cartilages, the arytenoids (4). The thyroid cartilage (cartilago thyreoidea) (1) has nearly the form of a visor of a cap, but is relatively broader at its ends than a cap visor. It forms about two-thirds the circumference of a circle,‘and is so situated that it embraces the other carti- Fic. 104.—CARTILAGES OF LARYNX, WITH SIDE ViEW oF Hyorp Bong, 6, ceratohyal; ¢, epihyal; d, stylohyal; ¢, tympanohyal; /, thyrohyal. 1, thyroid cartilage; 2, epiglottis; 3, cricoid cartilage; 4, arytenoid cartilage;. 5, cricothyroid ligament; 6, thyrohyoid ligament; 7, trachea. lages ventrally and laterally. Its caudal and cranial borders are oblique to its caudocranial axis and are directed dorso- caudad. To the middle of the cranial border is attached the epiglottic cartilage (2), and the whole cranial margin is con- nected by membrane (6) to the body and caudal cornua (/) of the hyoid bone. The dorsal border projects craniad into a considerable cornu which is attached to the free end of the caudal hyoid cornu (f/f). The border also projects caudad into a process which articulates with a facet on the lateral surface of the cricoid cartilage (3). In the middle of the dorsal surface 248 THE VISCERA. is a longitudinal ridge for attachment of the vocal cords and origin of the thyroarytenoid muscles (Fig. 105, @), and at the caudal end of this ridge the caudal border presents a consider- able rounded notch. The cricoid cartilage (cartilago cricoidea) (3) has the form of a seal ring with its broader part dorsad. \ The broad dorsal part of the ring is partly embraced by the wings of the thyroid cartilage (1). Its caudal border is undulating and nearly at right angles to its caudocranial axis. It is connected by membrane with the first tracheal ring. The cranial border is oblique to the long axis and lies in a plane which passes from the ventral side craniodorsad. Near the median line on each side it articulates by an oblique facet with one of the two arytenoid cartilages (4). Near the midventral line the crico- thyroid ligament (5) is attached and it stretches thence to the midcaudal notch of the thyroid cartilage (1). The outer surface presents at the middle of each side a facet for articulation with the thyroid, and is marked in the median dorsal line by a ridge for the posterior cricoarytenoid muscle (Fig. 105, 0). The arytenoid cartilages (cartilago arytenoidea) (Fig. 104, 4) are triangular pyramids with base and sides nearly equilateral triangles. One side articulates with an oblique facet on the cranial border of the cricoid near the mid-dorsal line. Near the opposite apex is attached the vocal cord. At the lateral angle of the base is attached on its dorsal side the pos- terior cricoarytenoid muscle (Fig. 103, 4), and on its ventral side the thyroarytenoid (Fig. 105, @) and lateral cricoaryte- noid (Fig. 105, ¢) muscles. The movements produced by these muscles carry the arytenoid ends of the vocal cords toward or from the median plane and thus open or close the glottis. The epiglottic cartilage (Fig. 104, 2) is flexible (fibro- cartilage) and of a cordate form. It is so curved that its caudal surface is convex dorsoventrally and concave from side to side. It supports the epiglottis. Its cranial surface presents a slight median ridge for attachment of muscles. By its base it is attached to the midventral part of the cranial border of the thyroid cartilage (1). Its position varies so that it either stands — RESPIRATORY ORGANS. 249 erect with its apex directed craniad to allow the passage of air to the lungs, or, as in the act of swallowing, it is turned caudad over the aditus laryngis so as to allow food to pass over it and into the cesophagus. ‘rhe vocal cords are two fibrous elastic bands. Each is attached at one end to the apex of the arytenoid cartilage, and at the other end to the median ridge on the dorsal surface of the thyroid. Each supports a projecting fold of mucous mem- brane, the vibration of which causes the voice. MUSCLES OF THE LARYNX.—1. Muscles moving the entire larynx. A. Elevators. M. thyreohyoideus (Fig. 96, /, page 229). —A flat band on the lateral side of the larynx. Origin on the lateral part of the caudal border of the thyroid cartilage. ! Insertion on the medial two-thirds of the caudal border of the caudal cornu of the hyoid. Action.—Raises the larynx. The stylohyoid (Fig. 65, d, page 109) and the median and inferior constrictors (Fig. 96, 7 and #) of the pharynx, already described, have the same action. B. Depressors.—The sternothyroid (Fig. 65, g’), already described (p. 141). 2. Muscles which move the parts of the Lae vats one upon another. A. Muscles on the Outer Surface of the Larynx. M. cricothyreoideus (Fig. 96, ~).—A broad flat band “which with its fellow covers the ventral surface of the cricoid cartilage and the cricothyroid ligament. Origin.—The lateral half of the ventral surface of the cricoid cartilage. The muscles diverge so as to leave a part of the cricothyroid ligament between them. Insertion.—The ventral part of the caudal border of the thyroid cartilage laterad of the median ventral notch. M. cricoarytenoideus posterior (Fig. 105, 4).—The two muscles cover the dorsal surface of the larynx. Origin.—-From the dorsal part of the caudal border of the - cricoid cartilage (3) and from its median dorsal crest.. The 250 THE VISCERA. fibres pass craniolaterad, converging. The lateral fibres are nearly longitudinal in direction. Insertion.—The dorsal border of the caudal end of the arytenoid cartilage (4). Action.—Moves the arytenoid on its oblique articulation with the thyroid. The apex of the arytenoid is thus carried laterad, and the vocal cords are separated so as to widen the glottis. Fic. 105.—MuscLES OF THE LARYNX, AS EXPOSED BY REMOVAL OF MOST OF THE Lerr HALF OF THE THYROID CARTILAGE, I, epiglottis; 2. portion of the thyroid cartilage (cut); 3, cricoid cartilage; 4, arytenoid cartilage; 5, trachea. a, M. arytenoideus transversus; 4, M. cricoarytenoi- deus posterior; ¢, M. cricoarytenoideus lateralis; ¢d, M. thyreoarytenoideus. M. artyenoideus transversus (Fig. 105, @2).—A small unpaired muscle running transversely between the caudal ends of the arytenoid cartilages, just beneath the mucous membrane and parallel to the cranial border of the cricoid cartilage. M. glossoepiglotticus.—A small longitudinal muscle, lying by the side of its fellow in the frenulum of the epiglottis. Origin.—The median fibrous septum of the tongue. Insertion.—The dorsal (cranial) surface of the epiglottic cartilage in the median line near its attached border. Action.—Draws the epiglottis craniad. M. hyoepiglotticus is a small bundle of parallel fibres lying in the frenulum of the epiglottis craniad and dorsad of the body of the hyoid bone. Origin.—The lateral end of the cranial surface of the body of the hyoid. The two muscles pass craniodorsad, converging, and unite with the preceding. : Insertion with the preceding. (The lateral portion of the muscle may continue craniad to the tongue as a second part of the hyoglossus. ) Action.—Like the preceding. RESPIRATORY ORGANS. 251 B. Muscles on the Inner Surface of the Cartilages of the Larynx. M. thyreoarytenoideus (Fig. 105, d).—-The thyroarytenoid is a triangular, flat muscle of considerable size. It lies within the wing of the thyroid cartilage (2), and its fibres are nearly dorsoventral in direction. Origin.—The median longitudinal crest on the dorsal sur- face of the thyroid cartilage (2). Insertion.—The fibres converge to the insertion into the cranial lip of the laterocaudal angle of the arytenoid carti- lage (4). Action.—Turns the arytenoid on its oblique articulation so as to close the glottis. M. cricoarytenoideus lateralis (Fig. 105, c).—Triangular, a little smaller than the preceding, caudad of which it is situated, so that it also is covered by the wing of the thyroid. Origin.—The lateral part of the cranial border of the cricoid cartilage (3). The fibres converge, passing dorsad. Insertion.—The caudal lip of the laterocaudal angle of the arytenoid cartilage (4). Action.—Similar to the preceding, so that it closes the glottis. 3. The Trachea (Fig. 105, 5; Fig. 106, a).—The trachea is that part of the air-passage which extends from the larynx to the bronchi (Fig. 106). It is a straight tube composed of a lining mucosa with ciliated epithelium, and a connective-tissue covering which encloses supporting cartilages. Each tracheal cartilage is incomplete dorsally where it lies against the cesophagus, the gap between the two free ends of each ring being filled with muscular and connective tissue. As a result of this the diameter of the trachea is not fixed, but can be increased and diminished. The first ring is broader than the others. Where the cesophagus leaves the median line, the dorsal surface of the trachea lies against the longus colli mus- cles (Fig. 72, g’’). Its ventral surface is against the sterno- hyoid (Fig. 65, ¢) and sternothyroid (Fig. 65, ¢’) muscles. Its lateral surfaces are partly covered by the thyroid gland (Fig. 96, 6), and are in close relation with the carotid artery 252 THE VISCERA. (Fig. 119, a, page 284), the vagus and sympathetic nerves (Fig. 156, z), and the internal jugular vein (Fig. 119, 8). In the thoracic cavity the great vessels coming from the heart lie against the ventral surface of the trachea (Fig. 129, 2). At about the level of the sixth rib the trachea divides into the two main bronchi (Fig. 106). Each bronchus is supported by incomplete rings of cartilage like those of the trachea and has otherwise in general the structure of the trachea. In the lungs the bronchi become divided into many branches (Fig. 106), in the manner described in the account of the lungs. 4. The Lungs. Pulmones.—Immediately after division of the trachea the two bronchi enter the lungs (Fig. 106). These are two large, much-lobed organs, which fill the greater part of the thoracic cavity. The main lobes of the lungs are completely separated from each other, except in so far as they are connected by the bronchi and connective tissue; the main lobes may also be partly subdivided into secondary lobes that are not thus completely separated. The two lungs are com- pletely separated from each other, except at the radix, where they are united by the bronchi; they lie in the right and left halves of the thoracic cavity, with the mediastinal septum between them. The bronchi on entering the lungs divide in the following manner. Each divides at first into two main branches. The cranial branch on the right side is known as the eparterial bronchus (4), because it lies craniad of the pul- monary artery. All the others are hyparterial; i.e., they lie caudad of the pulmonary artery. The right cranial bronchus does not further subdivide into large bronchi, but gives off numerous small branches. The right caudal bronchus divides into three main branches. There are thus four main branches of the right bronchus. The left cranial bronchus divides into two main branches; the left caudal bronchus continues caudad as a main trunk giving off small branchlets. Of the left bronchus there are thus but three main subdivisions. The main subdivisions of the bronchi on the two sides correspond, as will be seen, with the lobulation of the-lungs. The right lung (Fig. 106, 1-4) is slightly larger than the RESPIRATORY ORGANS. 253 left (1’-3’). It divides into three smaller proximal lobes (1-3), and one large distal one (4). The most cranial one of the proximal lobes (1) is sometimes partly subdivided. The third one of the proximal lobes (3) lies mediad of the others; it is partly subdivided and one-half projects into a pocket in the Fic. 106.—RAMIFICATIONS OF THE BRONCHI, WITH OUTLINES OF THE LOBES OF THE LUNGS, VENTRAL VIEW. 1-4, lobes of the right lung; 1’-3', lobes of the left lung. a, trachea; 4, epar- terial bronchus. mediastinum, so that it comes to lie across the middle line, extending a short distance onto the left side. This lobe is frequently called the mediastinal lobe (3). The caudal lobe (4) of the right lung is large and flat, containing about half the substance of the lung. The left lung is divided into three main lobes (1-3); the two cranial ones (1’-2/) are, however, partly united at the base, so that they may be considered subdivisions of but a single lobe; thus the left lung has but two distinctly separated lobes. Each lung is attached to the aorta, vertebral column, and diaphragm by a fold of pleura, the pulmonary ligament. This 254 THE VISCERA. is broadest at the caudal lobe of each lung. Each pulmonary ligament is double, being formed of two sheets of the pleura. The Thyroid Gland. Glandula thyreoidea (Fig. 96, 6).— The thyroid gland consists of two lateral lobes (6) and a median lobe or isthmus (7). Each lateral lobe (6) is an elongated, flattened, lobulated mass with round ends. It is Fic. 107.—PosITION oF THYMUS GLAND, FROM LEFT SIDE. a, heart; 4, aorta; c, cesophagus; d@, thymus gland; ¢, lymphatic gland; /, left subclavian artery; g, internal mammary artery. /, cut ends of first rib; XZ, eleventh rib. about two centimeters long and about one-fourth as broad. It lies at the side of the trachea (4), dorsad of the lateral margin of the sternohyoid muscle. Its cranial end is at the level of the caudal border of the cricoid cartilage. The isthmus (7) is a delicate band two millimeters wide which connects the caudal ends of the two lateral lobes. It passes ventrad of the trachea and in close contact with it. The thyroid has no duct. The Thymus Gland. Glandula thymus (Fig. 107, d).— The thymus gland is best developed in young kittens; in the adult cat it has partly or almost completely degenerated. It is an elongated, flattened organ, of a pinkish-gray color, which lies in the. mediastinal cavity, between the two lungs and against the sternum. It extends caudad as far as the heart (a), over- lying the pericardium at its posterior end. At its cranial end it projects, when well developed, a short distance (about one centimeter) outside of the thoracic cavity into the neck region. The caudal end is forked, and the left lobe thus formed is usually larger than the right. The cranial end may also show indication of a division into two lobes, but this is frequently not the case. eS ee THE UROGENITAL SYSTEM. 255 IV. THE UROGENITAL SYSTEM. APPARATUS UROGENI- TALIS. 1. The Excretory Organs. KIDNEY. REN (Figs. 108 and 109). The kidneys of the cat are compact (i.e., not lobulated) and have the usual kidney or bean form. They lie in the abdomi- nal cavity, one on either side of the vertebral column, against the dorsal body wall, in the region between the third and fifth lumbar vertebree. The right kidney is one or two centimeters farther craniad than the left, and the long axes of the two con- verge craniad a little. _Each is covered by peritoneum on its’ ventral surface only (i.e., it is retroperitoneal). At the border of the kidney, where the peritoneum passes from it to the body wall, there is an accumulation of fat, which is most abundant at the cranial end of the kidney. Within the peri- toneal investment the kidney is enclosed in a special loose fibrous covering, the capsule or tunica fibrosa, which is con- tinuous with the fibrous coat of the ureter and pelvis. In the middle of the median border of each kidney is a notch, the hilus. It gives exit to the ureter (Fig. 108, c) and renal veins Fic. 108.—LrEFT KIDNEY, VENTRAL Fic. 109.— MEDIAN LONGITUDI- SURFACE. NAL SECTION OF KIDNEY. Fig. 108.—a, renal artery; 4, renal vein; ¢, ureter. Fig. 109.—a, medullary portion; 4, cortical portion; ¢, papilla; ¢@, pelvis; e, renal artery; 7, renal vein; g, ureter. (6), and entrance to the renal artery (2). On the ventral sur- face of the kidney within the capsule are seen grooves radiating from the hilus. They contain blood-vessels. If the substance of the kidney is sliced away parallel to the ventral surface for some distance (Fig. 109), there is exposed a cavity, the sinus, 256 THE VISCERA. which lies near the medial border and the opening of which is the hilus. It contains the pelvis (@) (the expanded beginning of the duct of the kidney), and also renal vessels (¢ and /) with © their branches. These structures are enclosed in fat, which fills the remainder of the sinus. Upon opening the pelvis the kidney substance is seen to project into it in the form of a cone, the papilla (c), the apex of which is directed mediad. On the © apex of the papilla are the numerous openings of the uriniferous collecting-tubes, some of them opening at the bottom of an apical depression of the papilla. In a section made parallel to the ventral surface and in the - median plane, the substance of the kidney is seen to consist of a peripheral darker and more granular cortical portion (Fig. 109, 4), and of a central, lighter, less granular medullary portion (2). Both portions are marked by lines which con- verge to the apex of the papilla (c). THE URETER (Fig. 108, c; Figs. 111 and 112, 6).—The duct of the kidney begins as the pelvis (Fig. 109, @), a coni- cal sac the base of which encloses the base of the papilla. From the apex of the papilla the urine passes into the pelvis. | The outer wall of the pelvis is continuous with the capsule of the kidney. At the hilus the pelvis narrows to form the ureter . (Fig. 109, g). The ureter passes caudad in a fold of peri- toneum which contains fat. Near its caudal end it passes dorsad of the vas deferens (Fig. 111, ¢), turns ventrocraniad, and pierces the dorsal wall of the bladder (Fig. 111, a) obliquely near the neck. On the inside of the bladder the openings of the ureters appear as pores about five millimeters apart, and each is surrounded by a white, ring-like elevation of the surface. THE BLADDER. VESICA URINARIA.—The bladder (Fig. III, a) is pear-shaped. It lies in the abdominal cavity between its ventral wall and the rectum and a short distance craniad of the pubic symphysis. Caudad it is continued into a rather long, narrow neck (/) which passes dorsad of the symphysis to the pelvic cavity. The bladder is covered by peritoneum and is held.in place by its neck and by three folds of the peritoneum. One of these THE UROGENITAL SYSTEM. 257 passes from its ventral wall to the linea alba and is the suspen- sory ligament. Two others pass one from each side of the bladder to the dorsal body wall at the sides of the rectum. They are the lateral ligaments of the bladder. They form the walls of a partly isolated peritoneal pocket into which the rectum passes; this pocket opens craniad into the peritoneal cavity. The wall of the bladder is composed of an internal epithelium, a layer of plain muscle-fibre bundles which cross one another in various directions, and the external peritoneal layer. _ SUPRARENAL BODIES. GLANDULA) SUPRARENALES.— The suprarenal bodies are two ovoid bodies about a centimeter in the longest diameter, lying craniomediad of the kidneys, but usually not touching them. In a fresh condition they are of a pinkish or yellow color. They are usually imbedded in fat and are covered by peritoneum on their ventral surface. They have no duct and are of uncertain function. 2. The Genital Organs. A. THE MALE GENITAL ORGANS. External Genital Organs.—The external genital organs are the scrotum and penis. ‘ The scrotal sac or scrotum is a pouch of integument which lies ventrad of the anus in the median line against the ischiatic symphysis. It is marked by a median groove which indicates the position of an internal septum dividing its cavity into lateral halves, within each of which is one of the testes. The penis (Fig. 111, 7; Fig. 113, 6; see also page 262) lies ventrad of the scrotal sac. It projects caudad. It is covered by the integument, which projects at its end as a free fold, the prepuce. Within the prepuce is the projecting glans penis (Fig. 113, 7). It is conical and bears on the ventral side of its free end the opening of the urethra, the common urinogenital opening. On the side on which the urethra opens the glans is connected to the prepuce by a fold of integument, the frenu- lum. The surface of the glans is covered with sharp, recurved, horny papille. 258 THE VISCERA. The Scrotum and Testes, and the Ducts of the Testes.—The scrotum contains the two testes, one in each of its compart- ments. Each testis lies in a diverticulum of the abdominal cavity, which is lined by an extension of the peritoneum. The testis has the same relation to this peritoneal diverticulum - that the intestine has to the abdominal cavity; i.e., it does not lie within the cavity of the diverticulum, but is suspended apparently within it by means of a fold of its wall which acts as a mesentery. The peritoneal diverticulum is called the tunica vaginalis propria and consists thus of a parietal layer and a visceral layer. The tunica vaginalis propria consists of a slender proximal part through which the blood-vessels pass to the testis and the vas deferens from it, and of an expanded distal part in which lies the testis. Only the distal part lies within the scrotum. The blood-vessels and vas deferens are suspended in the narrow part of the tunica vaginalis propria by means of a mesenterial fold similar to that which suspends the testis, and continuous with it. This fold and the blood-vessels and vas deferens con- tained within it form the spermatic cord (Fig. 111, @) which passes from the abdomen to the scrotal sac in the narrow part _of the tunica vaginalis propria. In the formation of the human tunica vaginalis the various layers of the body wall are carried out by it and form the tunics, or coats of the testis. The one of these coats next the tunica vaginalis propria (which is reckoned as one of the coats) is the tunica vaginalis communis (or fascia propria) and is formed by the transversalis fascia. Outside of the tunica vaginalis communis is the cremaster muscle, an incomplete layer formed from the fibres of the internal oblique muscle. Next is the cremasteric (or inter- columnar) fascia from the aponeurosis of the external oblique muscle, and outside of this is the integument forming the scrotum. In this integument there is a layer of smooth muscle which is sometimes described as the tunica dartos. In the cat the tunica dartos and the cremaster muscle are wanting. The cremaster is replaced by the elevator scroti muscle. The coats of the testis are thus five, as follows: 1. The scrotum (the integument). THE UROGENITAL SYSTEM. ' 259 2. Cremasteric fascia (subcutaneous fascia). 3. The levator scroti muscle (subcutaneous muscle-layer) (Fig. 113, 7). 4. Tunica vaginalis communis (transversalis fascia). 5. Tunica vaginalis propria (peritoneum). - The tunica vaginalis communis is inseparably united with the parietal layer of the tunica vaginalis propria. Where the spermatic cord passes from the abdominal wall to the scrotum it is covered by integument and cremasteric fascia on its ventral surface only, but is entirely surrounded by the tunica vaginalis propria and tunica vaginalis communis. The canal by which the spermatic cord passes through the body wall is known as the inguinal canal. The end by which it opens into the abdominal cavity is the internal inguinal ring, and the oppo- site end is called the external inguinal ring. The internal inguinal ring is merely the point of connec- tion between the proximal tubular portion of the tunica vaginalis propria and the abdominal cavity. It is circular, and is situated close against the lateral side of the lateral ligament of the bladder at its middle. The external inguinal ring is an oval opening in the apo- neurosis of insertion of the external oblique muscle. The apo- neurosis of this muscle ends caudally in a free border along the cranial edge of the pubis, from the ilium to the pubic tubercle. The external ring is just craniad of the end of this aponeurosis. The inguinal canal between these rings lies along the lateral border of the rectus muscle. It is one to one and a half centimeters long. Its medial wall rests on the rectus muscle; its dorsal wall on the fat contained within the lateral ligament of the bladder. The lateral and ventral walls lie on the transversus muscle proximally, on the internal oblique near the distal end. The wall itself is composed of tunica vaginalis propria and communis. As it passes within the caudal border of the internal oblique muscle it receives some aponeurotic fibres from it. A thin aponeurosis is also continued from the border of the external ring onto the tunica vaginalis propria. The testes (Fig. 110) are the organs which produce the spermatozoa. They lie one in each compartment of the scrotal © 260 THE VISCERA. sac, enveloped in the membranes or tunics described when treating of the scrotum. Each is attached to the dorsal wall of its peritoneal pouch by a mesenteric fold. The testis is sur- rounded by the visceral layer of the tunica vaginalis propria, and within this, by a dense fibrous covering, the tunica albu- ginea, which sends septa into its interior. Within the fibrous covering it is made up of numerous coils of seminiferous tubules which are readily seen by the naked eye. The epididymis (Fig. 110, c) is the beginning of the efferent duct of the testis. It appears as a flat band with a broad rounded end which lies on the medial surface of the testis at its cranial end (2). From this point it passes about the cranial end of the testis from its medial to its lateral surface, forming thus a semicircle with the convexity ventrad. Thence it passes as a narrower band (c) along the dorsal side of the testis, laterad of the sus- pending mesentery, to the caudal end of the testis (2). At the caudal end of the testis it is enlarged, passes from its lateral to its medial surface, and turns at the same time craniad to become continuous with the vas deferens (e). The enlarged cranial end is the caput epi- Fic, 110.Trsmis, didymis (4); the enlarged caudal end the cauda a, testis; 6, caput Cpididymis (d). The whole epididymis is epididymis; ¢, epi- encased in a tough fibrous covering similar to didymis; @, cauda ‘ : epididymis; e¢, vas that of the testis. The fibrous covering (albu- nanckenc ‘P*- ginea) of the testis and that of the epididymis are connected by fibrous tissue. Within the fibrous covering the head of the epididymis is made up of tubules which pass from the testis into its end: these are the vasa efferentia testis. The vasa efferentia unite within the caput into a single vessel which passes in a very tortuous course to the cauda: Its numerous windings form the cauda, from the end of which it passes craniad as the vas deferens (ec). The vas deferens (Fig. 110, ¢; Fig. 111, c) is a slender tube much convoluted at its beginning. It passes from the cauda epididymis (@) along the mesenterial fold of the testis THE UROGENITAL SYSTEM. 261 on its medial side, to the spermatic cord (Fig. 111, d). It leaves the spermatic cord at the internal inguinal ring and, curving over the ureter (Fig. 111, 6), bends craniad and approaches the vas deferens of the opposite side dorsad of the neck of the bladder (Fig. 111, f). The two vasa deferentia pass caudad together as far as the cranial border of the pubis. There they enter the prostate gland (¢), pierce the dorsal wall of the neck of the bladder, and open close together on the inner surface. The two openings are separated by a slight elevation, the veru montanum. The Urethra (Fig. 111, #).—The urethra is the common urinogenital duct which is formed by the union of the neck of the bladder (/) and the vasa deferentia (c) dorsad of the cranial border of the pubis. It extends thence to the end of the penis. It is divided into three portions. 1. The prostate portion is the commencement of the urethra; it is surrounded by the prostate gland (g). 2. The membranous portion (Z) extends from the prostate portion to a point between the crura of the penis. This por- tion is surrounded by the thick compressor urethrz muscle, so that its wall appears much thicker than it really is. _ 3. The spongy portion (pars cavernosa) extends along the ventral side of the penis to its end in the groove between the corpora cavernosa penis. At its beginning is an enlargement formed by the bulbocavernosus muscle. This is known as the bulbus urethre. The walls of the spongy portion are thick and vascular and form the corpus cavernosum urethre or corpus spongiosum. At its end the corpus cavernosum urethrz is greatly enlarged and forms the glans penis (7). Glands of the Urethra.—1. The prostate (Fig. 111, g) isa bilobed gland lying on the dorsal wall of the urethra and sur- rounding the ends of the vasa deferentia (c). It opens into the urethra at its beginning by numerous small ducts visible to the naked eye on the inner surface of the urethra. 2. The bulbourethral or Cowper’s glands (Fig. 111, 7).— There are two bulbourethral or Cowper’s glands, one on either side of the bulbus of the urethra between the ischiocavernosus and bulbocavernosus muscles. Each has a covering of muscle- 262 THE VISCERA. fibres derived from the neighboring bulbocavernosus (Fig. 113, 2). Each is said to open by a single duct into the urethra at the root of the penis. The penis (Fig. 111, 2; Fig. 113, 6) is a cylindrical organ with the apex directed backward. It is covered by integument Fic. 111.— MALE GENITAL ORGANS. a, bladder; 4, 4’, ureters; c, vasa deferentia; ¢, spermatic cord; ¢, spermatic artery and vein; 7, neck of bladder; g, prostate gland; 4, urethra; 7, bulbourethral (or Cowper’s) gland; 7, corpus cavernosum penis, cut from ischium; 4, ischiocavernosus muscle (cut); 7, penis; #, glans penis; 7, testis. which projects at its free end in the form of a fold, the prepuce (Fig. 113), which ensheaths the glans (Fig. 113, 7) of the penis. Beneath the integument is a layer of strong fibrous subcutaneous fascia continuous with that of the surrounding parts. On the dorsum of the penis a thin band of fibrous tissue, the ligamentum suspensorium penis, is continued from the i i Rs i OO ee =e eee THE UROGENITAL SYSTEM 263 middle line beneath the pelvic symphysis. This band divides distally, and its halves ensheath the glans and thus form a sup- port of the penis. The penis is formed by three bodies, the two corpora cavernosa penis and the single corpus cavernosum urethre (corpus spongiosum). The corpora cavernosa penis (Fig. 111, 7). Each is a cylindrical sheath of dense fibrous tissue within which are trabeculz separating blood-sinuses. Each corpus cavernosum is attached by the one pointed end to the caudal border of the ramus of the ischium near the symphysis. From their attach- ments the corpora cavernosa approach one another, forming the crura of the penis. They become closely united by their medial surfaces and pass thus to the free end of the penis where their somewhat pointed distal ends are imbedded in the glans (m). A groove is left between the corpora cavernosa on the dorsum of the penis, and there is a second groove on the ventral side. In the latter groove lies the urethra. The corpus cavernosum urethre is the spongy portion of the urethra which lies in the groove on the ventral surface of the penis, between the corpora cavernosa penis. It becomes greatly enlarged at the distal end of the penis, forming the glans (#}. A small bone (6s penis) is imbedded in the distal end of the penis. B. FEMALE GENITAL ORGANS (Fig. 112).—The urinal organs of the female are like those of the male. The neck (4) of the bladder is, however, much longer, extending almost to the border of the ischiatic ramus. The urethra is consequently short. The genital organs consist of the ovaries (c) (the organs which produce the eggs), the oviducts or uterine tubes (e) (Fallopian tubes), which receive the eggs from the ovaries; a bifid uterus (/ and z) in which the ova undergo their develop- ment, and a vagina (#) which leads from the uterus to its junction with the neck of the bladder. The neck of the bladder (£) unites with the vagina to form the urogenital sinus (z) which is very short, leads to the external opening, and is comparable to the male urethra. 264 THE VISCERA. Ventrad of the external orifice of the urogenital sinus is the clitoris, a rudimentary structure homologous with the penis of the male. The Ovaries (c).—The ovaries lie in the abdominal cavity in the same longitudinal line with the kidneys and a short dis- tance caudad of them. Each is an ovoid body about one centi- meter long and one-third to one-half as broad. On its surface are numerous whitish projecting vesicles, the larger of which show clear centres. They are the Graafian follicles (best seen in section), which contain the eggs. There may be present one or more elevations of the size of the largest Graafian folli- cles, but of a bright red or brown color. They are the corpora lutea (sing. corpus luteum),—Graafian follicles from which the eggs have been discharged. The ovary is held in position by the broad ligament of the uterus, a fold of the peritoneum, which passes here from the uterine tube to the adjacent body wall. The ovary lies in a sort of a pocket formed by the broad ligament. In the natural position the pocket opens ventrolaterad. The ovary is further held in position by the ligament of the ovary (ligamentum ovarii), a short thick cord which passes from the ventral face of the ovary,at its uterine end to the adjacent ventral surface of the uterus. The Uterine Tubes (e).—The uterine (or Fallopian) tubes or oviducts are the tubes which convey the ova from the ovary (c) to the uterus (/). Each begins with an expanded trumpet- shaped opening, the ostium tube abdominale (7). Its walls are thin, and the mucosa of its inner surface is thrown up into undulating, radiating ridges. The ostium (@) lies on the lateral side of the ovary (c) at its cranial end, and the trumpet partly clasps the ovary. From the ostium the tube (¢) turns craniad, then mediad, and then caudad, so as to describe a curve about the cranial end of the ovary. It then extends caudad on the mediodorsal aspect of the ovary to its junction with the uterine cornu (/). It is sinuous throughout its course, and the first two-thirds (the vestibulum) is of considerably greater diameter than the last third. Throughout the last two-thirds of its course it lies in THF UROGENITAL SYSTEM. 265 Fic, 112.—FEMALE UROGENITAL ORGANS, OBLIQUELY VENTRAL VIEW. a, kidney; 4, ureter; c, ovary; @, ostium tubee abdominale; ¢, uterine (Fallopian) tube; 7, cornua of the uterus; g, cranial edge of broad ligament; 4, round ligament of the uterus; z, body of the uterus; 7, bladder; %, neck of the bladder; 7, position of cervix uteri; mz, vagina; 2, urogenital sinus or vestibule, with M. urethralis; 2, corpus cavernosum clitoridis, with M. ischiocavernosus (cut); /, fibres of M. con- strictor vestibuli. I, aorta; 2, internal spermatic arteries; 3, uterine arteries; 4 “external iliac arteries; 5, hypogastric arteries; 6, umbilical artery; 7, inferior hemor- rhoidal artery; 8, branches of N. pudendus. 266 THE VISCERA. the free border of the broad ligament. Its mucosa is thrown into irregular folds, mostly longitudinal, and is lined by ciliated epithelium. From the foregoing description it is seen that the ova must pass through the body cavity in order to reach the ostium tube. The Uterus (f, t).—The uterus consists of a median por- tion or body (z) which is unpaired, and of two horns or cornua (7) which extend from the body to the uterine tubes. The body (z) of the uterus is a tube about four centimeters long which lies in the abdominal cavity, ventrad of the rectum and between it and the bladder. Its caudal end is at the level of the cranial border of the pubis. The cranial end of its cavity is divided by a median dorsoventral partition into lateral halves, while the cavity of its caudal portion is unpaired. The mucosa _is thrown up into large longitudinal folds. At.its caudal end the uterus projects into the vagina (#), so that when the vagina is opened the end of the uterus is seen projecting into it as a prominent papilla. The portion of the uterus thus enclosed by the vagina is the cervix uteri or neck of the uterus. Its free end is directed ventrocaudad, and a prominent ridge is continued from its caudodorsal side along the mid-dorsal wall of the vagina. The uterine cavity communicates with the vaginal cavity by a V-shaped opening, the os uteri, which looks ven- trocaudad and has its apex directed cranioventrad. Each horn (/) of the uterus passes craniolaterad in a nearly straight course from the body (z) to the uterine tube (¢). It narrows rapidly and becomes continuous with the tube. The mucosa is thrown. into longitudinal folds. Ligaments of the Uterus._-The Broad Ligament.—The uterus is held in place principally by the broad ligaments. These are two folds of the peritoneum, each cf which is attached to the whole length of one of the cornua and the adjacent part of the uterine tube and to the corresponding lateral surface of the body of the uterus. Each ligament ends craniad in a con- cave free border. Its attached border forms a curved line which begins laterad of the kidney and extends thence to the lateral ligament of the bladder. From the lateral ligament of the bladder the broad ligament extends caudad into the recto- a le oi yh ae thee eal dea THE UROGENITAL SYSTEM. 267 vesical pouch of the peritoneum, which lies between the rectum and the bladder. It holds the body of the uterus to the lateral wall of this pouch, and together with the opposite ligament and the body of the uterus forms thus a transverse partition, which divides the rectovesical pouch into dorsal and ventral portions. The round ligament (/) is a fibrous band which extends from a point of the body wall, which corresponds exactly to the internal inguinal ring of the male, to the cornu of the uterus about two centimeters from the cranial end. It is attached to the broad ligament by an intervening fold of peritoneum. The Vagina (m).-—The vagina extends from the os uteri (at 7) dorsad of the symphysis of the pelvis to a point a short distance craniad of the caudal border of the ischiatic symphysis. At this point it joins the neck of the bladder (£) to form the vestibulum or urogenital sinus (7), which is homologous with the urethra of the male. Urogenital Sinus (n).—The urogenital sinus extends from the caudal end of the vagina (7) to the external opening, which is situated ventrad of the anal opening. It is about a centimeter long and nearly as wide, and is marked off from the vagina by a circular fold of mucosa, while its inner surface presents longitudinal folds. On its ventral wall at its cranial end is the opening of the neck of the bladder, which is enclosed by a ring-like elevation of the mucosa, most prominent at the sides. The external entrance to the urogenital sinus forms the vulva. The Clitoris.—The clitoris is a minute organ homologous with the penis and lying on the ventral floor of the urogenital sinus. -Its distal end lies at the entrance of the urogenital sinus on its ventral border. In adult specimens the prepuce of the clitoris appears as a slight elevation of the integument surrounding a central vascular structure which appears red in the fresh organ. From the clitoris there are two small cor- pora cavernosa clitoridis (0) passing craniad and then diverging to be attached to the ischiatic rami. The ischiatic portion of 268 THE VISCERA. each is covered by a muscle (ischiocavernosus). The clitoris is said to contain a bone. Mammary Glands.—The mammary glands secrete the milk, and lie on the ventral surface of the body beneath the jntegument. The separate glands are closely gathered into two chief masses, one on each side- the ventral middle line. Each of these extends from about the region of the fourth rib to the caudal end of the abdomen, ending over the pubic symphysis. On each side the glands are gathered into five groups, each of which is furnished with a nipple. The nipple is a projection of the integument, having near its distal end numerous fine openings for the ducts of the glands. The first two nipples are on the thorax, the other three on the abdomen, the most caudal ones being about two or three centimeters in front of the cranial edge of the pubis. Rudimentary mammary glands and nipples are present in the male. MUSCLES OF THE UROGENITAL ORGANS, RECTUM, AND ANus (Figs. 113 and 114).—The muscles connected with the caudal openings of the alimentary canal and of the urogenital organs are closely interrelated, a single muscle sometimes acting on parts of both systems. For this reason all these muscles are described together. The region lying between the anus and thie external open- ing of the urogenital organs is known as the perineum. The perineum is formed chiefly by muscles and fascia. a. Muscles common to the Male aud Female.—M. sphincter ani externus (Fig. 113, 7; Fig. 114, a).—This muscle is con- founded with the feyatur scroti (Fig. 113, 7) or the levator vulve (Fig. 114, 4). The two take origin in common from the integument on the dorsum of the root of the tail dorsad of the fifth caudal vertebra. There the fibres from the opposite sides are intermingled. The common muscle passes ventrad about the tail as a flat band close to the integument. Dorsad of the anus the inner fibres of the muscles of the opposite sides are united. They then separate and surround the anus as a band five millimeters wide situated beneath the integument. Ven- trad of the anus the fibres are again intermingled. Some fibres aT a ee ae er NY aint, THE UROGENITAL SYSTEM. 269 on each side then continue to the scrotum as the levator scroti (Fig. 113, 7) or to the vulva as the levator vulve (Fig. 114, 4). Fibres also pass onto the anal pouch and unite with the sphinc- ter ani internus, forming the constrictors of the anal pouch (Strauss-Durckheim). M. sphincter ani internus (Fig. 113, 4; Fig. 114, c).— The sphincter ani internus is a broad and thick band of striated muscle-fibres which surrounds the rectum at the anus. Dorsad the band is about two centimeters broad, while ventrad it is less than one. In the ventral median line some of the fibres pass craniad to help in forming the bulbocavernosus muscle. The muscle surrounds the anal sac. (The muscle here described under this name is that described under the same name in the cat by Strauss-Durckheim and Mivart; it corresponds, however, to a part of the sphincter ani externus of the dog, as described by Ellenberger and Baum.) M. levator ani (or pubiocaudalis) (Fig. 162, 11).—This muscle lies in the pelvic cavity. Each muscle forms a nearly vertical sheet, and between the two are the rectum and the urethra. Origin from the symphysis of the pelvis. Insertion into the midventral line of the centra of the third, fourth, and fifth caudal vertebrz, close to the muscle of the opposite side. This muscle is frequently continuous with the iliocaudalis (Fig. 162, 11’). Action.—Bends the tail and compresses the rectum. M. ischiocavernosus (Fig. 113, #; Fig. 114, ¢).—A small, flat, spindle-shaped muscle which lies upon the crus of the penis or clitoris. Each has Origin from the caudal border of the ramus of the ischium, about one centimeter from the median line. Insertion, in the male, into the whole outer surface of the crus penis, or bulb of the.corpus cavernosum penis. In the female the muscle is smaller than in the male, and the insertion is into the ventral surface of the urogenital sinus, at the base of the clitoris. M. transversus perinei (Fig. 114, z).—A small bundle of fibres which arises from the medial surface of the ischium, just 270 THE VISCERA. dorsad of the origin of the ischiocavernosus, and passes mediad to join the sphincter ani internus (c). M. caudoanalis (S.-D.) (Fig. 113, /; Fig. 114, g).—A slender, flat bundle of fibres having origin on the middle line of the ventral surface of the second and third caudal vertebrz. It passes caudoventrad, lying between the levator ani and the Fic. 113.—-MUSCLES OF THE ANUS, UROGENITAL ORGANS, AND TAIL IN THE MALE (SLIGHTLY SCHEMATIC). One side of the pelvis has been removed. a, a’, M. extensor caudz lateralis; 4, M. abductor caudz externus; ¢, ¢’, M. flexor caudz longus; d, M. flexor caudze brevis; ¢, M. caudorectalis; 7, M. caudoanalis; g, M. caudocavernosus; 4, M. sphincter ani internus; 7, M. sphincter ani externus; 7, M. levator scroti; 4, M. recto- cavernosus; 7, M. bulbocavernosus; m, M. ischiocavernosus (cut); , M. compressor urethree membranacez. 1, tail; 2, rectum; 3, bulbourethral or Cowper’s gland; 4, prostate gland; 5, symphysis pubis; 6, penis; 7, glans penis; 8, testis; 9, spermatic cord. caudorectal (Fig. 113, ¢; Fig. 114, 7), and unites with the ventral portion of the sphincter ani internus (Fig. 113, %). Action.—Draws the anus craniodorsad. M. caudorectalis (Fig. 113, ¢; Fig. 114, 7). Origin from the ventral surface of the sixth and seventh caudal vertebre. A small, at first unpaired band two or three millimeters wide is formed, which passes cranioventrad, soon THE UROGENITAL SYSTEM. 271 dividing into two lateral halves. These spread out over the sides of the rectum, forming a broad sheet of fibres which pass into the walls of the rectum, among the transverse fibres of the latter. This muscle is covered by the caudoanalis (Fig. 113, f), caudocavernosus ( ¢) (or caudovaginalis, Fig. 114, 4), iliocaudalis, and levator ani. 6. Muscles Peculiar to the Male (Fig. 113).—M. levator scroti (7).—This is a band of fibres which passes ventrad in the median line from the sphincter ani externus (z) onto the scrotum. Here it spreads out beneath the skin, forming especially a well-marked bundle in the median furrow between the two testes. M. rectocavernosus, or retractor penis (4).—A small bundle of fibres which arises in two parts from the ventral sur- face of the sphincter ani internus (#). The two parts unite into a single bundle which passes caudad on the middle line of the ventral surface of the penis; it is inserted into the corpus caver- nosum just proximad of the glans. The muscle is covered only by integument, and overlies the ischiocavernosus (77). M. caudocavernosus (S.-D.) (g).—A slender bundle just craniad of the caudoanalis (/). Origin on the median ventral line of the first two caudal vertebre. The muscle passes caudoventrad, lying between the levator ani and the caudorectal (¢). It divides into two bands, one of which is inserted into the base of the corpus cavernosum, while the other extends farther caudad and is inserted at the distal extremity of the corpus cavernosum. Action.—Flexes the penis (bends it backward). M. bulbocavernosus (accelerator urine) (/).—The two muscles cover the ventral surface of the penis. Origin of each from a median raphe, which passes from the bulbous portion of the urethra toward the anus. The fibres pass toward the distal end of the penis and have their Insertion into the distal half of the lateral surface of the corpus Ccavernosum penis. M. compressor urethre membranacee ().—A thick layer of striated muscle-fibres which surrounds the urethra. between Cowper’s gland (3) and the prostate (4). The fibres have a 272 THE VISCERA. circular course, and the cranial ones are attached to the crura of the penis. The other fibres have no fixed attachment. c. Muscles Peculiar to the Female (Fig. 114).—M. levator vulve (Strauss-Durckheim), or constrictor cunni (4).—This is homologous with the levator scroti of the male. It consists of a band of fibres which pass ventrad from the external sphincter ani (2) and surround the vulva (3), lying immediately beneath the integument. M. constrictor vestibuli, or rectovaginalis (Strauss-Durck- heim) (@). : Fic. 114.._MUSCLES OF THE ANUS AND UROGENITAL ORGANS IN THE FEMALE, a, M. sphincter ani externus; 4, M. levator vulve; c, M. sphincter ani internus; d, M. constrictor vestibuli; ¢, M. ischiocavernosus (cut); 7, M. urethralis; g, M. caudoanalis; 2, M. caudovaginalis; 7, M. transversus perinei; 7, M. caudorectalis, I, the tail; 2, anus; 3, vulva; 4, rectum; 5, vagina; 6, neck of the bladder. Origin from the sides of the sphincter ani internus (c). The muscle forms a distinct bundle two or three millimeters wide, which passes ventrocaudad and is zzserted into the ventral sur- face of the urogenital sinus, caudad of the insertion of the ischiocavernosus (¢). M. caudovaginalis (Strauss-Durckheim) (Z).—A_ slender -and just craniad of the caudoanalis (g), and corresponding to the caudocavernosus of the male. Origin from the median line of the ventral surface of the first two caudal vertebree. The muscle passes caudoventrad, lying between the levator ani and the caudorectal (7), and is inserted into the ventral side of the urogenital sinus, at the base of the clitoris. THE UROGENITAL SYSTEM. 273 M. urethralis (/).—This consists of fibres surrounding the cranial part of the urogenital sinus and the caudal parts of the vagina and neck of the bladder. Origin partly on the caudal part of the symphysis of the ischium, partly from the ventral surface of the urogenital sinus, where the fibres are attached to the corpora cavernosa clitoridis. The fibres pass dorsad over the surface of the sinus, and over the surface of the union of the vagina and neck of the bladder, to be inserted into the sides of the vagina and the dorsal surface of the urogenital sinus. THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. I. THE HEART. COR. The heart lies in the mediastinum, enclosed in the pericar- dial sac, and projects rather more toward the left than toward the right. It is an ovoid or pear-shaped organ, with its long axis directed approximately craniocaudad. Its caudal end or apex is, however, directed slightly ventrad and to the left, while the larger cranial end or base faces slightly dorsad as well as craniad. * Laterally and dorsally the heart is largely covered by the lungs. The ventral side and a considerable portion of the lateral surface are, however, not thus covered, so that they lie against the thoracic wall. The heart extends from about the fourth or the fifth to the eighth rib, and its apex touches the diaphragm. The cavity of the heart is divided by a longitudinal dorso- ventral septum into lateral halves—a right and a left side. Each side is again divided by a transverse dorsoventral septum (auriculoventricular) into two chambers, one of which, the auricle, lies at the base; the other, the ventricle, lies at the apex of the heart. There are thus right and. left auricles and right and left ventricles. An external groove, partly filled with fat, separates the auricular portion of the heart from the ventricular part; this groove is known as the sulcus coronarius. Each auricle or ventricle has a single set of blood-vessels either leaving it or entering it. Thus the blood enters the right auricle by the inferior and superior vene cavz (Fig. 116, @ and e) (praecava and postcava). It passes thence into the right ventricle, and from the right ventricle to the lungs by 274 ; Ree ee ~ rr THE HEART. i 275 a single pulmonary artery (Fig. 115, 7). It returns to the left auricle by the numerous pulmonary veins (Fig. 116, g, h, z), and passes thence to the left ventricle. From the left ventricle it passes to the body by a single aorta (Fig. 115, g). When the heart is viewed from the ventral surface (Fig. 115), a considerable blood-vessel, the coronary artery (g¢), running from the base to a point a little to the right of the apex, indicates the position of the septum (ventricular septum), between the right (a) and left (4) ventricles. The apex thus belongs to the left ventricle. From the cranial end of the right ventricle the pulmonary artery (/) is seen passing obliquely craniad and toward the left. Beneath the pulmonary artery the aorta (g) appears rising from the middle of the base of the heart and passing directly craniad. At the base appears a part of the auricular appendage of the left auricle (d), and at the right a part of the right auricular appendage (c). The former (@) is larger and bent at right angles, 80 that its free end is directed toward the apex. In the dorsal view (Fig. 116) the position of the ventricular septum is not indicated. On the surface of the left ventricle a short distance from the ventricular septum and nearly parallel to it are seen branches of the coronary artery and the coronary vein passing toward the apex. Craniad of the left ventricle is seen the left auricle (4) with the pulmonary veins (g, 2, 2) opening into it. Craniad of the right ventricle (a) is the right auricle (c) with the vene cave (d and ¢) opening into it near the middle. Coming from beneath the auricles are seen the pulmonary artery (7) and the aorta (/). The chambers of the heart. 1. The right auricle (atrium dextrum) (Figs. 115 and 116, c). Externally the right end of the right auricle projects so as to form its auricular appendage (Fig. 115, c) which lies at the right of the base of the aorta (Fig. 115, g). The superior vena cava (Fig. 116, ¢) is seen entering near the cranial end of the auricular septum opposite the base of the aorta. The inferior vena cava (Fig. 116, @) enters the auricle near the coronary sinus and close to the auricular septum. The netted appearance which the wall, especially that of the 276 THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. appendage, presents externally is due to the muscular thicken- ings of the wall (musculi pectinati). sevtecionn | NA GGG Fic. 115.— HEART, VENTRAL VIEW. Fic. 116.—HEART, Dorsal VIEW. Fig. 115.—a, right ventricle; 4, left ventricle; ¢, right auricular appendage; d, left auricular appendage; ¢, conus arteriosus; /, pulmonary artery; g, aortic arch; A, thoracic aorta; z, vena cava superior; 7, innominate artery; 4, left subclavian artery; 7, left common carotid; #, right common carotid; 2, right subclavian; 9, azygos vein; f, the two innominate veins; g, coronary artery. Fig. 116.—a, right ventricle; 4, left auricle; c, right auricle; d, vena cava in- ferior; ¢, vena cava superior; /, aorta; g, #, 7, groups of pulmonary veins ( g, dorsal group; 4, sinistral group; 7, dextral group); 7, pulmonary artery (division into two); &, innominate artery; 2, left subclavian; m, left common carotid; ~, right common carotid; 0, right subclavian; #, azygos vein. The cavity (including that of the auricular appendage) is somewhat egg-shaped, with its long axis transverse. The THE HEART. 277 musculi pectinati, which branch and unite into a network, are most abundant on its dorsal wall at the right. The axes of the two venz cave if produced into the cavity of the auricle would meet one another at its centre and nearly at right angles. Caudad of the opening of the inferior vena cava is seen the slit-like opening of the coronary sinus, guarded craniad by the semilunar valve of the coronary sinus (or valve of Thebesius). The coronary sinus receives blood from coronary veins, which collect it from the walls of the heart. In the auricular septum ventrad of the opening of the inferior vena cava is seen a faintly marked smooth oval depres- sion, the fossa ovalis. When the auricular septum is examined by transmitted light it is seen to be thinner over the fossa ovalis. There is an opening, foramen ovale, at this point in foetal life, so that the blood of the inferior vena cava then passes directly from the right auricle to the left auricle. Cau- dad the cavity of the right auricle communicates with that of the ventricle by the large oval auriculoventricular opening, which is guarded by the tricuspid valves (Fig. 117). 2. The right ventricle (ventriculus dexter) (Figs. 115 and 116, a) does not reach quite to the apex of the heart, so that it makes up less than one-half of its ventricular portion. It makes a half-spiral turn about the left ventricle, from its lateral . side at the apex toward its ventral side at the base, where it ends in the pulmonary artery (Fig. 115, ¢). Its wall is very thin as compared with that of the left ventricle. Its cavity (Fig. 117) is nearly flat on its medial side, convex on its lateral side. It communicates with the auricle craniodorsad. Cranio- ventrad the cavity is narrower and turns around toward the ventral side of the heart and opens into the pulmonary artery. That portion of the ventricle between the auriculoventricular opening and the pulmonary artery is the conus arteriosus (Fig. 115, ¢; Fig. 117, f). Internally the wall presents many muscular trabecule (Fig. 117, a) of various sizes. These are more numerous over the ventricular wall than on the septum. They do not occur on the conus (/). Surrounding the auriculo- ventricular opening is the tricuspid valve (Fig. 117, d, d',d’’). It consists of three flaps. One of these (@’) is septal 278 THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. (i.e., it lies against the septum), while of the two others which do not lie against the septum, one is dorsal (d’’) and the other ventral. Each flap is thin, semicircular, and membranous, and is attached to the border of the auriculoventricular opening by the diameter of the semicircle. The free border of each is attached to the wall of the heart by numerous delicate ten- dinous bands, the chorde tendinee (c), some of which are attached to the lower face of each valve. The chorde tendinez . Fic. 117.—HEART, WITH RIGHT VENTRICLE LAID OPEN TO SHOW THE TRI- CUSPID VALVE. a, trabeculz; 4, columnze carneze; ¢, chordz tendinez; d@, d’, d”’, the teks flaps of the tricuspid valve; e, aorta; /, conus arteriosus, laid open; g, semilunar valves of the pulmonary artery. of the septal valve (or most of them) are attached at their opposite ends to the septum directly, while those of the dorsal and ventral flaps are attached to the ends of three or more band-like muscles, columne (or. trabecula) carnee (4), which are fixed by their opposite ends to the ventricular wall. Between the conus arteriosus (/) and the pulmonary artery are three pocket-like semilunar valves (Fig. 117, ¢), one ven- tral, one dextral, and one sinistral. Between each valve and the wall of the pulmonary artery there is an enlargement of the cavity of the artery, one of the pulmonary sinuses (or sinuses of Valsalva). Beyond the sinuses the pulmonary artery divides into right and left branches (Fig. 116, 7). ee eee ee oe THE HEART. 279 3. The left auricle (atrium sinistrum) (Fig. 115, d; Fig. 116, 6). The auricular appendage (Fig. 115, @) is bent at right angles and its apex turned caudad. The cavity is thus irregular. Muscular trabeculze occur only in the auricular appendage. When the auricular septum is examined by trans- mitted light. the position of the fossa ovalis is indicated at about the middle of the septum as seen from the left side. Ventrad of it is a fold of the septal wall. The pulmonary veins enter the dorsal wall of the auricle in three groups (Fig. 116, g, #, 2). Each group opens into a more or less pronounced sinus or extension of the auricular cavity. The sinuses may be called, on account of their posi- tion, dorsal (g), sinistral (¢), and dextral (Z). 4. The left ventricle (Fig. 115, 4) occupies rather more than the left half of the base of the heart. Its walls are two or three times as thick as those of the right ventricle. In- ternally its walls present a few muscular bands, comparable to the trabecule of the left ventricle. There are two very large columnz carnez, one dorsad and one ventrad. At the cranial end it communicates near the lateral wall with the left auricle by the auriculoventricular opening, and near the septum with the aorta. The bicuspid valve (or mitral valve), which guards the auriculoventricular opening, consists of two flaps, one septal and one lateral. Their chorde tendinez, which come from their free borders as well as from their outer surfaces, are attached to the columnz carnez, chorde passing from both valves to each columna carnea. The opening into the aorta is guarded by three aortic semilunar valves, each of which partly conceals an aortic sinus (or sinus of Valsalva). One valve is dorsal, one sinis- tral, and one dextral. In the dextral sinus is the opening of one of the coronary arteries, which carry blood to the walls of the heart. Pericardium. The pericardium is a sac enclosing the heart. It lies in the middle mediastinum, and the two halves of the mediastinal septum with their fat may be dissected away from it. Its wall is composed of two layers, an external firm fibrous layer and 280 THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. an internal layer of flattened epithelial cells similar to the peritoneal epithelium (serous layer). The fibrous layer forms a sac which repeats roughly the form of the heart. This sac is attached to the aorta at the point of origin of the subclavian artery, to the pulmonary artery at its bifurcation, and to the venz cave and pulmonary veins near their entrance into the heart. At these points it is continuous with the fibrous coats of the vessels named, and from them it is reflected over the heart, forming a complete sac enclosing it but not attached to | it anywhere. The heart lies within this sac. The serous layer lines the fibrous sac and gives to the surface of the heart and fibrous layer a smooth glistening appearance. It is reflected over the heart. The relation of the heart to it is much the same as the relation of the intestine to the peritoneal sac. The serous layer consists therefore of two portions, parietal, lining the sac, and visceral, covering the heart. The parietal and visceral portions are continuous along a line which runs approximately parallel to the auriculoventricular groove and encloses all the great blood-vessels. Within this line the heart lies against the fibrous layer of pericardium and is not covered by the serous layer. The serous layer is easily dissected free from the heart-wall, but its parietal portion is closely adherent to the fibrous layer. II. THE ARTERIES. ARTERIZ. 1. A. pulmonalis, the Pulmonary Artery (Fig. 115, /). The pulmonary artery passes craniodorsad and slightly to the left from the cranial end of the conus arteriosus. One to one and a half centimeters from the conus it divides into right and left branches (Fig. 116, 7). Just before the division the dorsal surface of the pulmonary artery is connected by the short ligamentum arteriosum, or ligamentum Botalli, with the aorta. This is the remnant of a canal which in foetal life forms a free communication between the pulmonary artery and the aorta; this canal is known as the ductus Botalli. The ligament is almost or quite obliterated in.the adult cat. The left branch of the pulmonary artery passes to the left lung, crossing ventrad of the thoracic aorta. It then divides ’ THE ARTERIES. 281 into branches which pass to the lobes of the left lung. The point of division of the left branch of the pulmonary artery lies craniad of all the lobes of the lung, so that the lobes of the left lung are said to be all hyparterial, i.e., below (or caudad of) the artery. 7 The right branch passes under (dorsocaudad of) the aortic arch, and reaches the right lung at about the junction of the cranial lobe with the remainder of the lung. The cranial lobe of the right lung is therefore said to be eparterial, since it is craniad of the pulmonary artery; the other lobes are hypar- terial. The right branch divides at its entrance to the lung and is distributed to its lobes. 2. Aorta (Fig. 115, g; Fig. 118, a). The aorta is the single great vessel which conveys blood from the left ventricle. It makes a sharp semicircular curve dorsad (Fig. 118, a’) and to the left, passes caudad at the left side of the vertebral column, and passes between the crura of the diaphragm to reach the abdominal cavity. It is divisible into thoracic aorta (Fig. 118) and abdominal aorta (Fig. 126). A. Thoracic Aorta (Fig. 118).—The first portion of the thoracic aorta, curved as above described, is the aortic arch (a’). It lies in the thoracic cavity opposite the interval between the third and fourth or fourth and fifth ribs. It is separated from the vertebral column on the right by the superior vena cava (g), and on the left by the cesophagus (4). At its beginning it lies a little to the right of the median plane; but it passes at once to the left side of the vertebral column. BRANCHES OF THE THORACIC AORTA. 1. Aa. coronaria.—The coronary arteries are two. They arise from the aortic sinuses. The left one (Fig. 118, f) leaves the aorta on the left side, passes dorsad of the pulmonary artery, and divides into two branches, one of which follows the auricu- loventricular groove (sulcus coronarius) to the dorsal side of the heart and sends branches to the adjacent heart-walls, while the , other runs onto the ventricles, following approximately the ventral border of the ventricular septum. . The right coronary artery passes in the auriculoventricular groove toward the right and dorsad, and supplies the adjacent walls of the heart. es eee ee eee ee ee ee ee ee oe es Lae ~~ .. Noe i. de 7 v = THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. 282 inate innomina . anonyma (Fig. 115, 7; Fig. 118, 4).—The artery passes craniad from the convexity of the aortic arch (a’). 2. It gives rise first to a small mediastinal artery (7) which “Qno) que yypeamy “Zr (No) qu ways 7774 *(ynd) qu ysay {7 = *yOou oy} wos sjonp oneyduid] ag) Jo guo ‘g tyonp do1ovs0y} ‘S ‘sndeydoseo ‘p ‘vuseu stpioo vuaa ‘€ ‘ules avpnsnf peusajur ‘Zz Suroa svpnsnf peuszsjxe ‘t ‘uaA peoradao0r4y} ‘2 Seepndeos esioasuvd} “y JO youvsq puoosss Surkueduiosov ulaa ‘f tsajosnut je1ojoed ay} Jo spud [esojey pue snizodeny -OAB]D O} UIDA ‘v SUIAA AlvTpIxe ‘az SUIOA [BIGO}IOA ‘2 !UTIA [VOTAINDOYSOO ‘72 | AJOVIV [BUAD}S ‘7 !SUTOA OJBUTMOUUI om} oy} ‘s ‘urea AlvuIUvUT [eUOJUT ‘4 ‘vavd vudA Joladns ‘4 !A1a}4e Arvuo109 Yet *¢ ‘satay jeaseydosa ‘a ‘Sallaylw [eysoorsyur ‘eé !AtajIw yeuNserpour ‘az ‘a[ndvos vsroasuvy) ‘y ‘y ‘sixe peorassv01dyy ‘f !Aroyre Areyyixe ‘2 ‘Aroye Areurureut peusojur ‘y ‘Arojrw peaqoyioa ‘8 ‘stxe yeorars90}s00 48 !pyjores uoulwo0s yat ‘f ‘pros 4 ‘ a @ ‘ uowluos j4yS1t ‘4 Suvravjoqns yysu ‘yp fuelavpoqns yet 4 {AsojAe ayeUTMOUUT ‘9 {(yorR oTAOe ‘y) BOR ‘Dv ‘ACIS LAAT AHL WOW GAMAIA ‘XVUOH], AHL AO STASSHTA—"SII ‘Ol ‘ passes ventrad into the mediastinum, then to the left common carotid (Fig. 115, 7), then to the right common carotid (Fig. Sometimes the carotids are given off froma common 115, 2). trunk. inate is innomina Beyond the right common carotid the continued as the right subclavian (Fig. 115, 7). THE ARTERIES. 283 3. A. subclavia sinistra (Fig. 115, £; Fig. 118, c).—The left subclavian passes craniad from the convexity of the aortic arch. It curves about the first rib (Fig. 118, /) to enter the armpit, where it becomes the axillary artery (7). 4. Aa. intercostales (z).—The intercostal arteries are given off from the dorsal side of the aorta. Each passes to an inter- costal space and divides into three branches. One of these passes ventrad along the caudal margin of the cranial one of the two ribs between which it extends. Another goes to the deep muscles of the back, and the third enters the spinal canal through the intervertebral foramen. The arteries for the first and second (and sometimes the third) intercostal space usually arise from the subclavian (costocervical axis, Fig. 118, g). 5. Aa. bronchiales.—The bronchial arteries are two, and ’ arise either from the aorta opposite the fourth intercostal space or from the fourth intercostal arteries. . They accompany the bronchi to the lungs. 6. Aa. esophagee (Fig.-118, 0).—The cesophageal arteries are small branches of varying origin passing to the cesophagus. 7. Aa. lumbales.—The lumbar arteries correspond to the intercostals, but pass off between the lumbar vertebre. The obliquity of the diaphragm throws the origin of one or two pairs of them within the thorax. A. CAROTIS COMMUNIS. THE COMMON CAROTID ARTERY. (Fig. 115, Zand m; Fig. 1109, a). The two common carotid arteries arise from the innom- inate artery in the manner already described. Each passes craniad along the side of the trachea. In the thorax (Fig. 118, f) the common carotid lies mediad of the sub- clavian artery (Fig. 118, c) and dorsad of the superior vena cava (Fig. 118, g). In the neck (Fig. 119) the artery lies, accompanied by the vagus and sympathetic nerves and the internal jugular vein (4), in the space between the longus capitis muscle (7) and the trachea (14); it is covered ventrally by the sternomastoid and sternothyroid (2) muscles, lying close to the lateral border of the latter. Near its origin the common carotid may give rise to the small inferior thyroid artery. It 284 . THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. then passes to about the level of the larynx without giving off branches; here it gives off the superior thyroid (c) on the ventral side and one or more muscular branches (e) on the dorsal side. One or two centimeters further craniad it gives oft on the dorsal side the internal carotid (¢) and the occipital artery (f/f). The main artery now takes the name external carotid (7). Branches of the common carotid: we ES Fic. 119.—COMMON CAROTID ARTERY AND INTERNAL JucuLar VEIN. a, common carotid artery; 4, internal jugular vein; c, superior thyroid artery; d, cervicalis ascendens artery; ¢, large muscular branches; /, occipital artery; g, in- ternal carotid; 4, branch to larynx; 2, lingual artery; 7, external maxillary; 2, supe- rior labial; 7, inferior labial; #z, external carotid; 7, internal maxillary; 0. posterior auricular; ~, superficial temporal. 1, M. sternohyoideus; 2, M. sternothyreoideus; 3, M. geniohyoideus; 4. M. genioglossus; 5, M. constrictor pharyngis medius; 6, M. constrictor pharyngis inferior; 7, M. longus capitis; 8, M. digastricus; 9, M. mas- seter; 10, M. scalenus; 11, M. levator scapulze (cut); 12, M. levator scapule ven- tralis (cut); 13, M. splenius; 14, trachea. 1. A. thyreoidea ima.—The inferior thyroid is a small artery which arises either from the common carotid near its origin, or from the innominate before the origin of the carotid. It passes craniad on the trachea as far as the thyroid gland, giving branches to the trachea and cesophagus. 2. A. thyreoidea superior (c).—The superior thyroid leaves the carotid opposite the thyroid cartilage and passes mediad and caudad, sending branches to the thyroid gland, and the THE ARTERIES. 285 sternothyroid (2) and sternohyoid (1) muscles. A_ small branch, the superior laryngeal, passes to the larynx, and supplies those muscles of the larynx which are not enclosed by the cartilages. 3. Rami musculares (¢).—One or two branches, usually of considerable size, leave the common carotid at about the same level as the superior thyroid and pass to the muscles on the dorsal side of the neck, the main trunk of the artery passing between the longus capitis (7) and scalenus muscles (10). , 4. A. occipitalis (/).—The occipital artery arises from the common carotid at about the same point as the internal carotid. It immediately sends a large branch dorsad, passing between M. longus capitis (7) and the vertebral column, to the deep muscles of the neck. The occipital then crosses the outer surface of the digastric muscle (8) to the back of the skull, and runs along the lambdoidal: crest just beneath the splenius muscle. It sends a number of branches to the muscles of the back of the neck; and one of its branches may unite with the vertebral artery as it lies in the groove on the atlas, or witha branch of the vertebral. 5. A. carotis interna (g).—The internal carotid artery is one of the terminal branches of the common carotid. It is very small. It is given off near or in common with the occipital artery, passes toward the cranial end of the tympanic bulla, enters the bulla with the Eustachian tube, and passes into the skull at the foramen lacerum. Its course is much convoluted before entering the foramen. Within the skull (Fig. 121, g) it joins the posterior cerebral artery (Fig. 121, /) at the side of the hypophysis. : 6. A. carotis externa (Fig. 119, m).—After giving off the internal carotid the continuation of the common carotid artery receives the name external carotid (#7). It passes craniad and laterad between the digastric (8) and styloglossus muscles, where it gives off cranioventrad the lingual artery (7) anda number of small muscular branches; also sometimes the small laryngeal artery. At the dorsolateral border of the digastric (8) it gives off the external maxillary artery (7), and about one centimeter farther craniad the posterior auricular (0). It now 286 THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. turns mediad, lying against the cartilaginous auditory meatus, on its cranial side, and gives off the superficial temporal (). The artery then continues mediad, taking the name internal maxillary (z)—so that the internal maxillary artery is to be considered the terminal branch of the external carotid. Branches of the external carotid artery (Fig. 119): a. A. lingualis (Fig. 119, 2; Fig. 120, d@).—The lingual artery leaves the external carotid near its beginning and passes craniomediad along the ventral border of the digastric muscle (Fig. 120, 9), accompanied by the hypoglossal nerve. It gives off numerous small branches to the hyoid and pharyngeal muscles, then passes dorsad of the hyoglossus muscle (Fig. 120, 6), where it gives off a branch which passes transversely across the middle line to communicate with the artery of the other side. Beneath the hyoglossus the artery turns craniad and passes into the tongue. Here it runs along the medial border of the styloglossus to the tip of the tongue, giving off numerous branches into the substance of this organ. 6. Rami musculares.— Muscular branches pass to the digastric and to the hyoid muscles. A small branch (Fig. 119, h), which may arise either from the external carotid or from the common carotid near the beginning of the external carotid, passes to the larynx and supplies the thyroarytenoid and lateral cricoarytenoid muscles of the larynx. c. A. maxillaris externa (Fig. 119, 7).—The external maxillary artery leaves the external carotid (wz) opposite the angle of the jaw and at about the dorsal border of the digastric muscle (8). It passes craniad, lying at first beneath the digastric muscle and sending a branch to the submaxillary gland. Opposite the caudal border of the mylohyoid muscle it gives off the submental artery, turns dorsad, emerges from beneath the digastric, and passes along the cranial border of the masseter onto the face. Here it divides into superior (4) and inferior (7) labial branches, which pass along the upper and lower lips, respectively, giving off numerous branches. ; The submental artery passes to the symphysis menti between the digastric and mylohyoid muscles, giving off on its course collateral branches to the muscles of this region. THE ARTERIES. eas i; d. A. auricularis posterior (Fig. 119, 0).—The posterior auricular leaves the external carotid (1) opposite the middle of the bulla tympani and beneath the submaxillary gland. It passes about the base of the ear on its caudal and dorsal sides outside of the deep muscles of the occipital region, but beneath the auricular muscles, and sends several branches to the muscles of the external ear, passing onto the caudal surface of the concha. It sends also a large branch mediad to the muscles of the occiput, especially to the temporal muscle, within which it ramifies. A large branch (anterior auricular, Fig. 131, z) passes from the caudal side of the concha craniodorsad, and appears on the cranial side of the external ear, running along the cranial margin of the auditory opening. e. A. temporalis superficialis (Fig. 119, f; Fig. 120, %). —The superficial temporal artery arises from the external carotid as the latter lies between the cartilaginous auditory meatus and the caudal border of the masseter muscle. It passes dorsad and gives off soon after its origin a muscular branch to the masseter, and an auricular branch which passes distad along the concha auris and ramifies over its cranial surface. The superficial temporal itself passes onto the surface of the temporal muscle (Fig. 120, 11), to which it gives numerous branches. It extends to the caudal angle of the eye - (Fig. 131, s), where it divides. One branch passes into the lower eyelid; the larger branch passes along the dorsal side of the eye, sending a branch into the orbit and small branches onto the dorsal surface of the nose. Jj. A. maxillaris interna (Fig. 119, 7; Fig. 120, z).—The internal maxillary artery is the continuation of the external carotid. It turns caudad at the caudal end of the mandible, then passes craniad, lying dorsad of the pterygoid muscles (Fig. 120, 10), and against the medial surface of the mandible. It gives off the inferior alveolar artery (Fig. 120, 7), then the middle meningeal (%), and then continuing mediad divides into three or four branches. The branches redivide, and the twigs form a complicated plexus, the carotid plexus (Fig. 120, 7), which surrounds the maxillary division of the fifth nerve near its exit from the foramen rotundum. One of the larger 288 THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. branches of the plexus enters the skull through the orbital fissure, lying beside the hypophysis; it divides in the manner described below. Fic, 120.—BRANCHES OF EXTERNAL CAROTID ARTERY. @, common carotid; 4, branch to larynx; ¢, internal carotid; d@, lingual; ¢, ex- ternal carotid; /, posterior auricular; g, external maxillary; 4, superficial temporal; z, internal maxillary; 7, inferior alveolar; &, middle meningeal; /, carotid plexus; , branch to temporal muscle; 7, ophthalmic; 9, infraorbital; f, lesser palatine. 1, M. constrictor pharyngis inferior; 2, M. sternothyreoideus; 3, M. sternohyoideus; 4, M. thyreohyoideus; 5, M. constrictor pharyngis medius; 6, M. hyoglossus; 7, M. genio- hyoideus; 8, M. genioglossus; 9, M. digastricus; 10, Mm. pterygoidei externus and internus (cut); 11, M. temporalis (cut). Beyond the carotid plexus a main trunk which may be con- sidered the continuation of the internal maxillary passes craniad, lying on the dorsal surface of the external pterygoid muscle; nearly opposite the molar tooth it divides into the infraorbital (Fig. 120, 0) and the sphenopalatine arteries. Branches of the internal maxillary artery and of the carotid plexus: 1. A. alveolaris inferior (Fig. 120, 7).—The inferior alveo- lar (or inferior dental) artery leaves the inferior maxillary just THE ARTERIES. 289 opposite the condyloid process of the mandible. . It enters the mandibular canal by the mandibular foramen, along with the nerve of the same name, and traverses the canal, furnishing branches to the lower teeth. It emerges at the mental foramen, and its terminal branches are distributed to the chin, but a branch is continued in the bone beyond the mental foramen and supplies the incisor and canine teeth of the lower jaw. 2. A. meningea media (Fig. 120, £).—The middle menin- geal is a large vessel which leaves the internal maxillary at about the same level as the inferior alveolar. It passes into the foramen ovale and ramifies in the dura mater. Its branches leave distinct impressions on the inner surface of the bones of the skull. 3. A large branch (Fig. 121, 2) from the plexus passes into the cranial cavity through the orbital fissure and lies within the skull at the side of the hypophysis. It gives off the following branches: a. A posterior communicating branch, very short, which extends caudad and joins the internal carotid artery (Fig. Pi ty 2 . 6. A. cerebri media (Fig. 121, 7).—The middle cerebral artery passes dorsad on the side of the cerebral hemisphere along the fissure of Sylvius and divides into numerous branches _which are distributed to the surface of the cerebrum. c. A. cerebri anterior (Fig. 121, 7) passes dorsad between the cerebral hemispheres. Just craniad of the optic chiasma the two anterior cerebral arteries are united by a small com- municating branch, thus completing the circulus arteriosus or circle of Willis (Fig. 121), surrounding the hypophysis (see page 292). 4. From the carotid plexus several branches pass, arising either separately or in common, to the masseter, temporal, and pterygoid muscles. 5. A. ophthalmica (Fig. 120, ~).—The ophthalmic artery passes from the carotid plexus to the structures in the orbit. It gives off numerous branches which supply the muscles of the eyeball, and other structures of this region. It sends an ethmoidal branch into the nasal cavity through the ethmoidal 290 THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. foramen in the orbital plate of the frontal bone, then continues distad to emerge from the orbit on the medial side of the eye; here it anastomoses with branches of the superficial temporal. 6. A. palatina minor (Fig. 120, #).—The lesser palatine artery leaves the internal maxillary distad of the carotid plexus, near the caudal border of the maxillary bone. It passes ventrocaudad into the soft palate. 7. A. sphenopalatina.—The sphenopalatine is one of the terminal branches of the internal maxillary; it passes mediad through the sphenopalatine foramen into the nasal cavity, and divides into numerous branches which supply the mucous membrane of the nose. It gives off just before it enters the sphenopalatine foramen the descending palatine (A. palatina descendens), which passes into the posterior palatine canal and emerges on the surface of the hard palate, where it ramifies. 8. A. infraorbitalis (Fig. 120, 0).—The infraorbital artery is a direct continuation craniad of the internal maxillary. It sends off numerous small branches to the teeth of the upper jaw, and a rather large branch which passes to the lower eye- lid. It then enters the infraorbital foramen, at the same time dividing usually into two or three branches; these emerge from the foramen and supply the parts of the nose and upper lip adjacent to the foramen (Fig. 131, 7). A. SUBCLAVIA. THE SUBCLAVIAN ARTERY. The left subclavian (Fig. 118, c) arises from the convexity of the aortic arch just distad of the origin of the innominate artery, and about two or three centimeters from the heart. It passes craniad and slightly to the left, and turns into the left arm just craniad of the first rib. The right subclavian (Fig. 115, ) is a direct continuation of the innominate, the artery receiving the name subclavian after the right common carotid is given off, usually at about the level of the second or third intercostal space. The subclavian has the following branches: the vertebral artery (Fig. 118, ¢’), the internal mammary (Fig. 118, 4), _ the costocervical axis (Fig. 118, g), the thyrocervical axis (Fig. 118, 7). Beyond the last-named branch it continués into the arm as the axillary artery (Fig. 118, 2; Fig. 122, £): THE ARTERIES. 29% a. A. vertebralis (Fig. 118, ¢’).—The vertebral artery arises from the dorsal surface of the subclavian opposite the first rib. It passes craniad and dorsad at the side of the thoracic portion of the longus colli muscle, and enters the foramen transversarium of the sixth cervical vertebra. It passes thence craniad through the foramina transversaria (which together form the vertebrarterial canal) and gives off at the intervertebral foramina branches to the muscles of the neck and branches which pass across the ventral surface of the spinal cord to join A. spinalis anterior. Craniad of the foramen transver- sarium of the atlas the vertebral artery turns dorsad in the groove on the lateral surface of the atlas. Here it gives off a large branch which passes laterodorsad to the muscles of the neck and may anastomose with a branch of the occipital artery. The vertebral artery then passes into the verte- bral canal through the atlantal foramen. It passes to the ventral FIG. 121,—ARTERIES OF THE VEN- : s TRAL SURFACE OF THE BRAIN, side of the spinal cord and unites a, A, vertebralis; 4, A. spinalis an- at about the level of the foramen terior; ¢, A. basilaris; ¢, A. cerebelli s inferior posterior; e, A. cerebelli an- magnum with the vertebral artery terior; f A. cerebri posterior; g, cut of the o site si is. I ends of the two internal carotid arteries; t pposite ide (Fig fe @) A, cut ends of branches from the ca- to form the basilar artery (A. rotid plexus (g and / are placed within * * . : the circulus arteriosus or circle of basilaris) (Fig. 121, ¢), which wins. ¢ A. cerebri media: 7, A. passes craniad along the ventral cerebri anterior. middle line of the brain. Just before their union the two verte- bral arteries (2) give off each a branch which passes caudo- mediad. These two branches soon unite in the middle line, forming the anterior spinal artery (A. spinalis anterior) (4), which passes caudad the entire length of the spinal cord, lying on its ventral middle line and receiving many communicating branches from the vertebral, intercostal, and lumbar arteries. 292 THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. A. basilaris (c).—This arises by the union of the two vertebral arteries in the manner just described. It passes craniad along the ventral middle line of the medulla and pons, giving numerous small branches to these structures. A large branch, A. cerebelli inferior posterior (7), passes on each side to the caudal surface of the cerebellum, on which it ramifies. ' At the cranial margin of the pons the basilar artery divides. From each division a very large branch passes on each side across the pedunculi cerebri to the cranial part of the cere- bellum; this is A. cerebelli anterior (¢). Just craniad of this, arising from nearly the same point, the smaller A. cerebri posterior (/) passes laterad to the caudal part of the cerebrum; it is joined by the internal carotid artery (g). The small continuations of the two halves of A. basilaris then pass craniad at the side of the hypophysis to join the posterior com- municating branches from the carotid plexus. As other branches of the carotid plexus unite across the middle line craniad of the optic chiasma, an arterial circle is formed on the base of the brain, surrounding the hypophysis and the optic chiasma. This is known as the circulus arteriosus, or circle of Willis (see page 289). 6. A. mammaria interna (Fig. 118, %).—The internal mam- mary artery rises from the ventral surface of the subclavian opposite the first rib, and passes in the mediastinum ventro- caudad to reach the sternum opposite the third intercostal space. It sends two or three small branches craniad to the midventral part of the thoracic wall and then extends caudad at the side of the sternum. It sends off lateral branches to the ventral thoracic wall, branches to the mediastinum and peri- cardium, a branch to the diaphragm which anastomoses with the phrenic; and finally it passes out of the thoracic cavity caudad of the last costal cartilage, extends caudad in a zigzag course at the lateral border of the rectus muscle and anasto- moses with the inferior epigastric artery. c. Truncus costocervicalis (Fig. 118, g).—The costo- cervical axis arises from the subclavian opposite the first rib, passes craniodorsad, and divides almost at once into two branches. The smaller one of these, the superior intercostal THE ARTERIES. 293 (A. intercostalis suprema), passes caudad and, dividing, sup- plies the first and second intercostal spaces, and then passes to the deep muscles of the back. The other branch divides almost immediately into two. One of these, A. transversa colli, passes laterad in front of the first rib and enters the serratus anterior muscle. In this it passes dorsad, giving off branches to this muscle and to the levator scapule, till it reaches M. rhomboideus, which it likewise supplies. . The other branch (A. cervicalis profunda), which seems to form a continuation of the main artery, passes directly dorsad and leaves the thoracic cavity between the heads of the first and second ribs. Here it passes into the deep muscles of the neck; it can be traced in the substance of the complexus muscle as far forward as the atlas. d. Truncus thyreocervicalis (Fig. 118, 7).—The thyro- cervical axis (or thyroid axis) arises from the subclavian beneath the first rib, a short distance distad of the origin of the costocervical axis. It passes laterocraniad and dorsad, lying on the mediocranial side of the brachial plexus. A short dis- tance from its origin it gives offa branch, varying much in size, the cervicalis ascendens (Fig. 119, @), which passes craniad on the ventral side of the neck, supplying the sterno- mastoid, sternohyoid, the cervical portion of the scalenus, and sometimes other muscles of the neck region. Other branches pass from the thyroid axis to the inner surface of the clavo- trapezius (Fig. 122, @) and to the ventral end of the pectoral muscles. At the level of the cranial border of the scapula the artery takes the name A. transversa scapula, or suprascapularis. This divides into three main branches. The first branch, sometimes large, sometimes small, passes to the lymphatic gland in the hollow of the shoulder, and to the adjacent muscles; it supplies the clavotrapezius, acromio- trapezius, levator scapulz ventralis, splenius, occipitoscapularis, and rhomboideus. A second branch passes between the sub- scapularis and supraspinatus muscles, dividing into various branches which supply the muscles named. The third branch pierces the supraspinatus muscle, just craniad of the acromion process, and ramifies in that muscle. 294 THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. e. A. axillaris (Fig. 122, g).—The axillary artery is the continuation of the subclavian laterad of the first rib. It lies caudad of the brachial plexus and parallel to it. It sends off the following branches:° : 1. A. thoracica anterior (Fig. 122, %).—The anterior ‘thoracic is a slender artery which leaves the ventral side of the axillary opposite the first rib and passes caudomediad, to supply the medial ends of the pectoral muscles ( g). 2. A. thoracica longa (/).—The long thoracic artery is larger than the preceding, leaves the axillary a short distance laterad of it, and passes caudad to the middle portions of the pectoral muscles (8) and continues to the inner surface of the latissimus dorsi. A short distance beyond the long thoracic the axillary divides into two. The more cranial one of these is the sub- scapular (/); the other is the brachial (¢’). 3. A. subscapularis (/).—The subscapular artery passes laterad and gives off a short distance from its origin the A. thoracicodorsalis (7) and A. circumflexa humeri posterior (see below); it may also give rise to the circumflexa anterior humeri (/’), and to the profunda brachii (w); these two branches, however, rise more frequently from the brachial artery (g’) and are described in connection with it. The sub- scapular artery then passes through the triangular interval between the scapular end of the long head of the triceps, the latissimus dorsi, and the glenoid border of the scapula. Within this interval it sends muscular branches to the long head of the triceps, the subscapularis, and the latissimus dorsi. That to the latter muscle is very large. At the border of the scapula, opposite the tuberosity of the spine, it turns craniad, passes over the Jateral surface of the infraspinatus muscle, supplying it; crosses the spine, and sends branches into the supraspinatus fossa in both directions parallel to the scapular spine. These supply the supraspinatus, acromiotrapezius, and spinotrapezius, and anastomose with the branches of the transversa scapule. As the subscapularis turns craniad onto the surface of the infra- spinatus it sends dorsad a small branch, the circumflexa scapulz, which passes in the infraspinatus fossa close to its THE ARTERIES. 295 S FIG. 122.—BLOOD-VESSELS AND THE MORE VENTRAL NERVES OF THE AXILLA, VENTRAL VIEW. The pectoral and clavobrachial muscles have been cut and laid aside, their ends being shown; only a part of the nerves are exhibited. 1, M. clavobrachialis; 2, cut end of M. pectoralis major; 3, cut end of M. pectoralis minor; 4, M. biceps; 5, M. teres major; 6, M. epitrochlearis, partly cut and turned back; 7, M. latissimus dorsi, partly cut; 8, M. pectoralis minor; 9, M. pectoralis major; 10, short portion of caput mediale of M. triceps brachii. @, branches of the thyrocervical axis to clavobrachial and clavotrapezius muscles; 4, suprascapular nerve; ¢, first subscapular nerve; d, musculocutaneous nerve; e¢, median nerve; /, V. axillaris; 7’, V. brachialis; g, A. axillaris; 2’, A. brachialis; 4, first anterior thoracic nerve, accompanied by the an- terior thoracic artery and vein; z, V. subscapularis; 7, large muscular branch (to subscapular muscle) of the subscapular vein and brachial artery; 7, A. subscapularis; *Z’, A. circumflexa humeri anterior; #, radial nerve; #, ulnar nerve; 0, medial cutaneous nerve; . A. thoracica longa; g, ”, second anterior thoracic nerve; s, V. longa thoracica; ¢, A. and V. thoracicodorsalis; #, A. profunda brachii; v, branch of brachial artery accompanying medial cutaneous nerve; w, branch of A. collateralis radialis superior; x, A. collateralis radialis superior; y, V. mediana cubiti; z, A. col- lateralis ulnaris. 296 "THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. glenoid border as far as the glenovertebral angle, supplying the infraspinatus and latissimus dorsi by iateral branches. A. thoracicodorsalis (7).—This arises from the subscapular a short distance from its origin and passes across the teres major to the latissimus dorsi (7), giving branches to both these muscles and to the epitrochlearis. A. circumflexa humeri posterior.—The posterior circum- - flex artery arises from the A. subscapularis close to the origin of the latter. It passes between the subscapularis muscle and the teres major, close to the border of the biceps, then between the lateral and long heads of the triceps. It gives off a branch to the inner surface of the spinodeltoid and acromiodeltoid, then passes distad to supply the lateral and long heads of the triceps. : 4. A. brachialis (g’).—The brachial artery is the con- tinuation of the axillary (g) into the arm beyond the origin of the subscapular (/). It passes along that side of the biceps which lies next to the humerus. It passes thus, accompanied by the brachial vein (/’) and median and ulnar nerves, through the bicipital arch and afterwards between the biceps (4) and the intermediate division of the medial head of the triceps to the supracondyloid foramen of the humerus, through which it passes with the median nerve to reach the concavity of the elbow. It gives off the following branches: a. A. circumflexa humeri anterior (/’).—The anterior cir- cumflex artery usually leaves the brachial near its origin (but may arise from the subscapular (/) or one of its branches); it passes to the biceps (4) near the origin of the latter and sends a branch proximad to the head of the humerus. 6. A. profunda brachii or superior profunda (w).—This arises from the first part of the brachial or it may come off from one of the branches of the axillary (e.g., the subscapularis). It passes along with the radial nerve onto the dorsal side of the humerus and supplies the triceps muscle. It also sends branches to the epitrochlearis (6) and latissimus dorsi (7). c. Rami musculares.—Muscular branches are given off near the supracondyloid foramen to the biceps (4), epitro- _chlearis (6), and brachialis muscles. A nutrient artery leaves THE ARTERIES. 297 the brachial proximad of the supracondyloid foramen, either separately or in common with the muscular branches, and passes into the nutrient foramen at the junction of the middle and distal thirds of the shaft of the humerus, supplying the bone. d. A. collateralis ulnaris (superior) (or A. anastomotica magna) (z).—This leaves the brachial artery just proximad of the supracondyloid foramen and passes to the convexity of the elbow, supplying the structures about the olecranon. e. A. collateralis radialis superior (Fig. 130).—This rises from the axillary artery just proximad of the supracondyloid foramen (Fig. 122, x), in company with the vena mediana cubiti (y), passes across the surface of the biceps (4), beneath the pectoantibrachialis, into the concavity of the elbow. Here it gives branches to the pectoantibrachialis, clavobrachialis, and extensor muscles of the forearm. It then passes onto the ven- troradial border of the forearm (Fig. 130) and runs along this border, in company with the vena cephalica (Fig. 130, c) and the superficial radial nerve (g), to the wrist, sending off branches to the integument. At the wrist it turns onto the dorsum of the hand, passing in a gentle curve to the ulnar side and distad, and giving off a branch for the space between each pair of metacarpal bones. These branches (Fig. 130, e) (Aa. digitales dorsales) pass distad and anastomose with branches coming from the palm. jf. A. radialis (Fig. 123).—Distad of the convexity of the elbow the brachial artery takes the name radial artery. It passes from the supracondyloid foramen on the medial side of the biceps tendon (1) and beneath the pronator teres muscle (5), giving off small branches, as far as the middle of the fore- arm, where it gives off the ulnar artery (4). It then passes from beneath the pronator teres (5) and lies on the surface of the fifth part of the flexor profundus (8 ), covered only by the fascia and integument. Near the wrist it sends off a branch (m) toward the ulnar side of the arm, which passes into the palm on the surface of the tendon of the flexor profundus, giving twigs to the digits and to the pad in the palm. A branch from this may join the ulnar, and the common trunk 298 THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. thus formed passes into the hand and gives origin to the branches described under the ulnar artery. The presence and size of this branch of the radial varies with the size of the ulnar artery, it being smaller or absent as the ulnar is larger. It is shown at m, Fig. 123. The radial artery (g) now turns gradually dorsad and passes beneath the tendon of the extensor brevis pollicis onto the dorsum of the hand. It passes over the oblique groove on the dorsal surface of the base of the second metacarpal beneath the tendon of the extensor carpi radialis longus and passes between the bases of the second and third metacarpals into the palm of the hand. Here it passes to the ulnar side and anastomoses with the ulnar artery to form the palmar arch. Branches of the Radial Artery. 1. A. radialis recurrens (z).—The radial recurrent arises in the concavity of the elbow and sends a branch proximad to the structures in the concavity; it then continues to the radial side of the forearm at the elbow, supplying adjacent parts of the brachialis (2), the extensor carpi radialis, and the extensor communis digitorum. 2. A. ulnaris recurrens (7).—The ulnar recurrent arises on the medial side of the tendon of the biceps and supplies structures in the concavity of the elbow on the ulnar side, also the pronator teres (5) and proximal ends of the flexor carpi radialis and flexor profundis digitorum. 3. Rami musculares.—Muscular branches are given off along the course of the artery, to adjacent muscles. A nutrient artery to the radius leaves the radial artery about two centi- meters distad of the supracondyloid foramen. 4.. Aainterossee (anterior (/) and posterior) are given off usually separately between the origin of the ulnar artery and the biceps tendon. Sometimes they arise as a common trunk which soon divides. The posterior interosseous artery passes distad, supplying the flexor muscles of the forearm. It also sends a branch to the pronator teres. The anterior interos- seous (/) may arise from the ulnar artery. It passes dorsad to the interosseous membrane, on which it runs distad; sends a nutrient branch to the ulna, and then passes to the wrist in the THE ARTERIES. 299° FIG. 123.—NERVES AND ARTERIES OF THE FOREARM, SEEN FROM THE FLEXOR SIDE. Mm. palmaris longus, flexor carpi radialis, flexor carpi ulnaris, and the third and fourth heads of flexor profundus digitorum have been removed; also part of M. prona- tor teres. 1, biceps; 2, conjoined tendon of brachialis and clavobrachialis; 3, short portion of caput mediale of triceps brachii; 4, intermediate portion of caput mediale of triceps brachii; 5, cut ends of pronator teres; 6, brachioradialis; 7, extensor carpi radialis longus and brevis; 8, fifth head of flexor profundus digitorum; 9, second head of flexor profundus digitorum; 10, radial part of flexor sublimis digitorum; 11, common tendon of flexor profundus digitorum; 12, first head of flexor profundus digitorum; 13, cut origin of flexor carpi ulnaris. a, ulnar nerve; 4, median nerve; ¢, dorsal cutaneous branch of the ulnar nerve; ¢, palmar branch of ulnar nerve; ¢, deep palmar branch; /, superficial palmar branch; g’, A. brachialis; g, A. radialis; A, A. collateralis ulnaris superior; 7, A. radialis recurrens; 7, A. ulnaris recurrens; sf A. ulnaris; 7, A. interossea anterior; m, large branch of A. radialis, joining A. ulnaris. " 300 THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. substance of the pronator quadratus, which it supplies. It sends a branch to the dorsal surface of the wrist; this ramifies on the carpus, forming a network of small arteries. 5. A. ulnaris (£).—The ulnar artery passes beneath the second, third, and fourth parts of the flexor profundus digitorum (but outside of the origin of the fifth part), to the inner surface of the flexor carpiulnaris. It supplies the flexor carpi ulnaris, the flexor profundus and palmaris longus, and passes on the inner surface of the flexor carpi ulnaris to the wrist. Near the wrist it sends a branch onto the side of the forearm, and another to its midventral part, and ends in a small branch to the wrist on the radial side of the pisiform bone. This branch anastomoses with the radial to form the palmar arch, described below. 6. The palmar arch (Fig. 124) is formed by the termina- tion of the radial artery (a) in the palm and its junction with the end of the ulnar (/). The radial artery reaches the palm between the bases of the second and third metacarpals and passes thence toward the ulnar side and distad, piercing the interosseus muscle of the third digit and lying on the outer surface of the interossei of the third and fourth digits beneath the adductors of the second and fifth digits. A small com- municating branch from the radial passes to it between the first and second metacarpals. Branches of the palmar arch : A. princeps pollicis et indicis (c) leaves the palmar arch near its radial end and sends a branch onto the ulnar side of the thumb and one onto the radial side of the index. The palmar interossee (@) are three in number. They leave the palmar arch (4) and pass distad and dorsad in the intervals between the four ulnar digits. The radial one passes along the ulnar side of the first digit, the ulnar one along the radial side of the fifth digit. The middle one divides and sup- plies the contiguous sides of the third and fourth digits. Each of these interosseous arteries sends off muscular branches (e) to the short muscles in the palm, and branches into the fibrous pad which occupies the palm of the hand. The palmar arch THE ARTERIES. 30r also sends branches onto the dorsum of the hand at the sides of the fourth metacarpal. Branches pass from these proximad to the wrist. B. AORTA ABDOMINALIS. THE ABDOMINAL AORTA.— The abdominal aorta emerges into the abdomen from between the crura of the diaphragm, at about the level of the second Jumbar vertebra. It passes caudad along the dorsal middle line, lying to the left of the inferior vena cava. It gives off parietal branches to the body wall, and visceral branches to the viscera, and ventrad of the first sacral vertebra it gives off two large branches on each side, the external iliac (Fig. 126, 2) and the hypogastric (Fig: 126, 7)—a very small median vessel, the sacralis media (Fig. 126, 0), continuing the course of the , aorta and passing into the tail. The aorta gives off the following branches: A. celiaca; A. mesenterica superior; Aa. adrenolumbales; Aa. re- nales; A. mesenterica inferior; Aa. ilio- Fic. 124. THE PALMAR ARCH AND ITS BRANCHES IN THE PALM OF THE HAND. The interosseous mus- cles have been removed, except those of the third and fourth digits. 1, M. abductor digiti quinti; 2, ; Mm. interossei of third lumbales; Aa. lumbales (seven pairs); Aa. iliace externe ; Aa. hypogastrice. A. A. celiaca (Fig. 125).—The ceeliac artery is a large branch which is given off from the aorta one centimeter or less caudad of the opening in the diaphragm. 3: and fourth digits; 4, M. adductor pollicis; 5,,M. flexor brevis pollicis. a, termination of radial artery; 6, palmar arch; ¢, A. prin- ceps pollicis et indicis; @, Aa. interosseze; ¢, muscu- lar branches of the same; yj, A-ulnaris; g, deep pal- It passes directly ventrad about three or mar branch of ulnar nerve. four centimeters, then divides, usually at once, into three branches. The most cranial of these is the hepatic (d), the next is the gastrica sinistra (¢), while the third and largest, seeming to form a continuation of the cceliac, is the splenic (/) (A. lienalis). The coeliac artery may give rise also, before its division, to the two phrenic arteries (which, however, usually arise from the adrenolumbales), and either before or at the point of division to one or two small Aa. ventriculi dorsales, which, however, frequently arise from the gastrica sinistra. 302 THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. Branches of the cceliac artery: 1. A. hepatica (¢@).—The hepatic artery passes cranioven- trad, pierces the descending limb of the great omentum and passes craniad to the liver, lying, together with the portal vein and common bile-duct, in the ventral boundary of the foramen Fic. 125.—THE C@LIAc ARTERY AND ITS BRANCHES. @, abdominal aorta; 4, A. cceliaca; ¢, A. mesenterica superior (cut); @, A. he- patica (cut); ¢, A. gastrica sinistra; 7, A. lienalis; g, A. gastroduodenalis (cut from A. hepatica); 2, A. pylorica; z, A. gastroepiploica dextra; 7, A. pancreaticoduode- nalis superior; 2, A. pancreaticoduodenalis inferior (cut from inferior mesenteric); 7, A. ventriculi dorsalis. 1, spleen; 2, stomach; 3, duodenum; 4, pancreas. epiploicum (foramen of Winslow) and contained, together with the last-named vessels, in a fibrous sheath called the capsule of Glisson. Just before entering the sheath it gives off the gastroduodenalis (¢). At its termination the hepatic artery divides, sending branches to the lobes of the liver and a cystic artery to the gall-bladder. a. A. gastroduodenalis (¢).—This arises from the hepatic- near the pylorus and passes caudad, dividing one or two centi- meters from its origin into three branches, A. pylorica (2), A. pancreaticoduodenalis superior (7), and A. gastroepiploica dextra (2). The pylorica (Z) (which may arise directly from the hepatic) passes fo the pylorus, thence along the lesser cur- THE ARTERIES. 393 vature of the stomach, dividing into numerous branches and anastomosing with the gastrica sinistra. The pancreaticoduo- denalis superior (7) passes to the duodenum, supplying it and the duodenal part of the pancreas and anastomosing with the pancreaticoduodenalis inferior (#). The gastroepiploica dextra (2) passes along the greater curvature of the stomach from the pyloric end and supplies the walls of the stomach, sending branches also to the ascending limb of the great omentum. These branches anastomose with the terminal branches of the splenic artery. 2. A. gastrica sinistra (¢).—This arises from the cceliac artery and passes to the lesser curvature of the stomach, extending along this to the right. It gives off many branches to the walls of the stomach, and anastomoses with A. pylorica. A. ventriculi dorsalis (/).—One or two small arteries which arise either from the gastrica sinistra or the cceliac artery, and pass toward the dorsal part of the greater curvature of the stomach near its cardiac end. 3. A. lienalis (/).—The splenic artery is the largest of the branches of the cceliac axis, of which it appears to be the direct continuation. It divides into two large branches, one to the cranial end, the other to the caudal end, of the spleen (1). From the latter a large branch passes to the pancreas and descending limb of the great omentum. B. A. mesenterica superior (Fig. 126, @).—The superior mesenteric artery is larger than the cceliac. It supplies the blood to the small intestines and caudal portion of the pancreas and to the ascending and transverse colon. It arises from the ventral side of the abdominal aorta about one centimeter caudad of the coeliac axis and passes caudoventrad, forming a curve with the convexity dextrad. It gives off the pancrea- ticoduodenalis inferior, colica media, colica dextra, ileocolica, and numerous branches to the small intestine. 1. A. pancreaticoduodenalis inferior (Fig. 125, £).—This passes to the caudal end of the pancreas and a part of the duodenum, anastomosing with the pancreaticoduodenalis superior. 2. A. colica media is a large branch to the transverse and 304 THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. descending portions of the large intestine. It divides and sends branches in both directions which anastomose with the colica dextra and with branches from the inferior mesenteric arteries. 3. A. colica dextra.—A small branch which passes to the ascending and transverse colon, anastomosing with the colica media and ileocolica. It is sometimes absent. 4. A. ileocolica.—This passes to the caecum and supplies that structure, sending branches to the ileocolic valve and the caudal end of the ileum, and anastomosing with the colica . dextra and the intestinal branches of the superior mesenteric. 5. The superior mesenteric now divides into about sixteen terminal branches which pass to the small intestine. In many cases these branches unite near the intestine, forming arches, and from these arches numerous short branches pass to the intestine. 3. A. adrenolumbalis (or lumboabdominalis) (Fig. 126, ¢). —This rises from the aorta, one on each side, about two centimeters caudad of the superior mesenteric. Each passes laterad onto the dorsal body wall, supplying the muscles of this region. A large branch passes caudad along the surface of the muscles dorsad of the kidney and anastomoses with the ilio- lumbar artery. From the adrenolumbalis rises usually: A. phrenica (/).—The phrenic artery rises either from the ceeliac (c) or the adrenolumbalis (¢) and passes to the dia- phragm, near its dorsal border. In the diaphragm it passes ventrad, lying at the medial margin of the costal portion of the diaphragm, as far as its sternal portion, where it unites with the artery of the opposite side. The two thus form an arch, from which radiating arteries pass off to supply the diaphragm. 4. A. renalis (g).—The two renal arteries arise from the sides of the aorta, usually at about the same point, so that the left passes caudolaterad and the right craniolaterad (owing to the position of the kidneys). The artery usually divides just before entering the kidney (2). It passes dorsad of the vein (4). The renal artery sometimes sends a branch to the supra- renal body (1). It also occasionally gives origin to the sper- matic artery (Z). apa 5. A. spermatica interna (/).—This rises from the aorta THE ARTERIES. 305 Fic. 126..—ABDOMINAL BLOOD-VESSELS, VENTRAL VIEW. @, vena cava inferior; 4, abdominal aorta; c, A. coeliaca (cut); d, A. mesen- terica superior (cut); e, A. adrenolumbalis; 7, A. phrenica; g, A. renalis; 4, A. sper- matica interna; 7, A. mesenterica inferior (cut); 7, A. iliolumbalis; 4, A. iliaca externa; /, A. hypogastrica; m, beginning of A. femoralis; ~, A. umbilicalis; 0, A. and V. sacralis media (0, the artery; o’, the vein); f, A. glutea superior; g, A. glutea inferior; 7, A. and V. hemorrhoidalis media; s, V. adrenolumbalis; ¢, V. renalis; 2, V. spermatica interna; v, V. iliolumbalis; w, V. iliaca communis; x, V. femoralis; y, V. and A. profunda femoris; z, V. hypogastrica. 1, suprarenal body; 2, kidney; 3, ureter; 4, outline (broken) of rectum. 306 THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. on each side at about the level of the caudal ends of the kidneys, and passes laterad (or it may arise from the renal). In male specimens the artery turns caudad, along with the correspond- ing vein (z), and passes to the inguinal canal. Thence it passes along with the vas deferens and the vein (forming all together the spermatic cord) to the testes and the other structures in the scrotum. In females (Fig. 112, 2, page 265) the artery is larger and passes more nearly directly laterad, being much convoluted. It passes to the ovary, being now called the ovarian artery. It sends branches into the ovary (c) and to the cranial end of the uterus (/); the latter anastomosing with branches of the uterine artery (3). 6. A. mesenterica inferior (Fig. 126, z).—The inferior me- senteric artery has its origin from the aorta at about the level of the last lumbar vertebra. It passes toward the large intestine, and near it divides into two branches, the colica sinistra, which passes craniad along the descending colon, anastomos- ing with the colica media, and the superior hemorrhoidal, which passes caudad along the descending colon and rectum and anastomoses with the middle hemorrhoidal (page 308). 7. A. iliolumbalis (Fig. 126, 7).—The iliolumbar arteries arise from the aorta about two centimeters caudad of the inferior mesenteric and pass laterad over the ventral surface of the psoas minor and iliopsoas muscles. Each divides into two main branches, one passing caudad and the other craniad; these supply the muscles of this region. The cranial branch anas- tomoses with branches of the adrenolumbalis (¢). The caudal branch sends an artery through the abdominal wall to appear at the cranial edge of the thigh; it passes onto the lateral sur- face of M. sartorius and extends here some distance distad. 8. A. lumbalis.—There are usually seven pairs of lumbar arteries, passing almost directly dorsad from the dorsal surface of the aorta; the first pair arising just craniad of thé diaphragm, the last at the same level as the origin of the external iliac. The two arteries of a pair usually arise from the aorta one behind the other, or they may arise by a common trunk. They correspond to the intercostal arteries. They pass THE ARTERIES. 307 between the centra of the vertebre and the muscles of the dorsal region, and send one main branch laterad, the other dorsad; both supply the dorsal muscles. From the dorsal branch small arteries pass into the vertebral canal to join the anterior spinal artery. 9. A. iliaca externa (Fig. 126, %).—The external iliac artery passes obliquely caudad from the aorta, lying ventrad of the common iliac vein and against the medial surface of the psoas minor muscle. It passes onto the ventral surface of this and the iliopsoas and at the same time reaches the tendon of the abdominal muscles; through a small opening in this tendon lying ventrocaudad of that for the iliopsoas, it leaves the abdominal cavity. On its emergence from the abdominal cavity onto the medial surface of the thigh it receives the name A. femoralis (#7). The branches of the external iliac artery are described below (page 309). 10. A. hypogastrica (or iliaca interna) (Fig. 126, 7).—The hypogastric or internal iliac arteries are given off from the aorta usually within a centimeter caudad of the external iliac. Each passes caudolaterad, lying on the medial side of the common iliac vein, and divides into branches which supply the struc- tures within the pelvis and the muscles about the pelvic wall. There is much variation in the origin and relations of the branches of this artery. The following seems to be a very common arrangement: A very short distance from the origin the umbilical artery (x) is given off. The hypogastric artery then extends two or three centimeters and gives off A. glutea superior (f), which passes at once to the pelvic wall. A little farther caudad the hypogastric divides into the middle hemorrhoidal (7), to the rectum, and the glutea in- ferior (7), which passes out of the pelvis. Branches of the hypogastric artery: a. A. umbilicalis (Fig. 126, z).—This small artery arises from the hypogastric about one centimeter from the beginning of the latter, and passes ventrad to the bladder. Here it divides into two branches—the superior vesical to the sides of the bladder; the inferior vesical to the neck of the bladder and the urethra. 308 THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. 6. A. glutea superior (Fig. 126, ~).—This passes dorso- laterad from the hypogastric and reaches the pelvic wall against the medial surface of the ilium. Here it divides into two branches. One passes between the iliopsoas muscle and the ventral border of the ilium to the medial surface of the gluteus maximus; it gives branches to the gluteus muscles, the pyri- formis, and the rectus femoris. The other branch passes dorsad of the ilium, sending a branch to the medial surface of the gluteus medius, and a small branch which joins the lateral sacral artery and enters thus the sacral canal. c. A. hemorrhoidalis media (Fig. 126, ~).—The middle hemorrhoidal passes ventrad from the hypogastric, onto the lateral surface of the rectum. It passes caudad near the ventral side of the rectum as far as the anus. A short distance from the origin it gives off a branch which passes almost directly ventrad toward the beginning of the urethra. In the male this branch is small, sending twigs to the urethra and the prostate. In the female it is much larger, forming A. uterina (Fig. 112, 3, page 265). The uterine artery turns craniad onto the uterus, which it supplies, passing to the cranial end of the uterine cornu and anastomosing with the ovarian artery. The middle hemorrhoidal gives off in the female branches to the vagina (Fig. 112, m) and neck of the bladder (2), and a large branch to the urogenital sinus (7); it then supplies the anal glands and other structures about the anus, and anas- tomoses with the terminal branches of the hemorrhoidalis superior. In the male branchlets are given to'the urethra, to the bulbourethral (or Cowper’s) gland, and to the penis. The A. dorsalis penis is a small branch which passes along the median dorsal groove of the penis to the glans. The middle hemorrhoidal then supplies the structures about the anus and anastomoses with the superior hemorrhoidal, as in the female. ad. A. glutea inferior (Fig. 126, 7).—This is the terminal portion of the hypogastric. It passes along with the great sciatic nerve to the great sciatic notch, and reaches the medial surface of M. pyriformis. It divides into branches Which sup- ply the gluteus and pyriformis muscles, while a small branch accompanies the great sciatic nerve. A small branch also THE ARTERIES. 309 passes onto the lateral surface of the tail, extending caudad along its side. 11. A. sacralis media (Fig. 126, 0).—This is the continua- tion of the aorta into the sacral and caudal regions. It extends to near the end of the tail, lying in the ventral middle line against the sacral and caudal vertebre. In the caudal region it passes through the hemal arches, covered by the chevron bones. Between the vertebrz it gives off side branches com- parable to the intercostal and lumbar arteries of the aorta. Branches of the sacralis media: a. A. sacralis lateralis.—Behind the first sacral vertebra a large branch, the lateral sacral, is given off on each side. This enters the first anterior sacral foramen, gives a branch to the structures in the sacral canal, and sends a dorsal branch out through the posterior sacral foramen to the muscles on the dorsal side of the sacrum. Similar but smaller branches are given off between the suc- ceeding vertebrz, sacral and caudal. The External Iliac and its Branches.—The origin of the external iliac (Fig. 126, #) is described above (page 307). It gives off the following branches: 1. A. profunda femoris (Fig. 126, v).—This is given off just before the external iliac leaves the abdominal cavity. It passes caudad, and about one centimeter from its origin.it gives off three branches, sometimes all separately, sometimes two-in common. One of these passes mediad in the lateral ligament of the bladder and ramifies on the lateral surface of that organ. A second passes through the abdominal wall and into the fat on the medial surface of the thigh; it sends a branch caudad toward the external genital organs, while its main trunk passes distad in the subcutaneous fat almost to the knee. From one of these two a small branchlet passes in the male to the sper- matic cord and accompanies this to the testis; it represents thus the external spermatic artery. The third branch, A. epigastrica inferior, passes directly to the ventral surface of the rectus abdominis muscle, on which it passes craniad, sending branches to the muscles of the abdominal walls. It anasto- moses with terminal branches of the internal mammary artery. 310s) THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. The profunda femoris itself passes between the iliopsoas and the pectineus muscles, then to the medial surface of the adductor femoris. It divides into branches which supply the pectineus, adductor longus, adductor femoris, caudofemoralis, quadratus femoris, semimembrano- sus, and semitendinosus. 2. A. femoralis (Fig. 127).—This is the con- tinuation of the external iliac onto the medial sur- face of the thigh. The artery lies in a triangular depression between the borders of the sartorius (1) and gracilis (9) muscles. The floor of the depression is formed. by the adductor longus (6), pec- tineus (5), vastus internus, and rectus femoris (3) muscles. This triangular depression is known as the ilio- pectineal fossa, or Scarpa’s triangle; it con- tains also the femoral vein (a) and saphenous nerve (g), which pass along with the artery. Fic. 127.—SUPERFICIAL ARTERIES, VEINS, AND NERVES ON THE MEDIAL SIDE OF THE LEG. a, A. and V. femoralis; 4, N. femoralis; c, A. profunda femoris; @, A. and V. circumflexa femoris lateralis; e, ramus muscularis; /, A. saphena and V. saphena magna; g, N. // saphenus; 4, A. and V. articularis genu suprema; ¢, N. tibi- ji ¢ alis; 7, plantar branch of A. saphena; 4, dorsal branch of A. ~ saphena. 1, M. sartorius; 2, M. tensor fascie late; 3, M. rectus femoris; 4, M. iliopsoas; 5, M. pectineus; 6, M. ad- ductor longus; 7, M. adductor femoris; 8, M. semimembra- nosus; 9, M. gracilis; 10, M. semitendinosus; 11, medial head of M. gastrocnemius; 12, M. plantaris; 13, M. flexor longus digitorum; 14, M. tibialis anterior; 15, tibia. THE ARTERIES. git The artery extends distad, and at about the middle of the length of the thigh it passes, along with the vein and nerve, into a groove between the vastus medialis and the adductor femoris. This groove is converted into a canal by the overlying aponeu- rosis; it is known as Hunter’s canal or the canalis adduc- torius. At the distal end of the adductor femoris the femoral artery ceases to be superficial and passes between the vastus medialis and the semimembranosus to the popliteal space; it now receives the name A. poplitea. Branches of the femoral artery: a. A. circumflexa femoris lateralis (Fig. 127, d@).—The lateral circumflex arises from the femoral about one centimeter from its emergence from the abdominal cavity. It passes craniad and laterad and divides into two main portions. One part passes between the rectus femoris and vastus medialis, gives branches to these muscles, and sends an ascending branch to the structures about the hip-joint, and a descend- ing branch into the vastus medialis muscle. The remainder of the lateral circumflex passes along the inner (lateral) surface of the sartorius (1) to the cranial border of the leg, giving branches to the sartorius (1) and tensor fasciz late (2). 6. A large muscular branch (¢) passes caudad (or ventrad) and distad across the distal end of the adductor femoris (7) _ and between the gracilis (9) and semimembranosus, supplying these muscles. Other small muscular branches ‘may be given off from both sides of the femoral. c. A. articularis genu suprema (Z).—The superior articu- lar artery arises from the femoral, either in common with the saphenous artery or separately, a little proximad of the point where the femoral ceases to be superficial. It passes toward the knee, between the vastus medialis and semimembranosus, and covered by the sartorius (1), and ramifies over the medial surface of the knee-joint and in the structures just proximad of the joint. d. A. saphena (/).—The saphenous artery frequently takes origin in common with the superior articular (%), but may arise separately at about the same level. It passes distad across the gracilis (9), accompanied by the saphenous nerve (g) and vein, 312 THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. sends several branches dorsad (toward the knee), and at about the middle of the lower leg it divides into two main branches, a dorsal branch (£), passing to the dorsum of the foot, and a plantar branch (7), to the sole of the foot. The dorsal branch is accompanied by the main saphenous nerve (g) and vein. It sends one or two branches to the medial side of the ankle- joint, passes then onto the dorsum of the foot, and divides into four main branches. The medial one passes along the medial side of the medial digit; the other three pass to the intervals between the digits. Each divides into two branches which supply the contiguous sides of the two digits between which the interval lies. The dorsal branch thus supplies arteries to the sides of all the digits except to the lateral side of the lateral digit. This is supplied by A. suralis. The plantar branch (7) is larger than the dorsal. It passes distad on the medial surface of the flexor longus hallucis, accompanied by the tibial nerve, and across the space between the tendon of Achilles and the flexor. It gives superficial and deep branches to the structures about the ankle-joint, and sends inward a branch from the lateral side (Fig. 128, @) which joins the termination of A. tibialis anterior to form the plantar arch. It then passes distad along the plantar surface of the foot, nearer its medial border. Beneath the pad in the sole of the foot it divides into three branches which supply the interosseous spaces between the three digits. e. A. poplitea.x—The main trunk of the femoral. artery passes between the vastus medialis and the semimembranosus and then through the distal portion of the adductor femoris to reach the popliteal space. This is the space ventrad (or caudad) of the knee, between the biceps femoris on one side and the semimembranosus on the other. Here the artery receives the name A. poplitea, or popliteal artery. The pop- liteal artery gives off a number of large branches as it passes through the popliteal space, passes between the condyles of the femur and underneath the popliteal muscle, and finally turns dorsolaterad between the tibia and -fibula, just distad of the head of the fibula. It now receives the name A. tibialis THE ARTERIES. 313 anterior and passes distad along the dorsal (anterior) border of the fibula. Branches of the popliteal artery: 1. A. suralis.—This is a large branch which passes distad from the caudal side of the popliteal artery. It sends branches to the biceps and to the fat in the popliteal space, and passes onto the ventral border of the lateral head of the gastrocnemius. It sends branches to both heads of the gastrocnemius. and to the popliteus, passes distad onto the lateral surface of the ten- don of Achilles, and may be traced to the proximal portion of the dorsolateral side of the foot, where it sends many branches to the integument about the ankle-joint. It then passes along the lateral side of the foot and supplies the artery on the lateral side of the fifth digit. 2. Aa. genu posteriores.—Several small arteries which pass to the knee-joint. 3. Rami musculares.—Numerous small branches to the muscles about the popliteal space. 4. A. tibialis posterior.—This is the largest branch of the popliteal artery, which it leaves just before the latter passes beneath the popliteal muscle. The tibialis posterior passes at first mediad, then turns distad, passes across the popliteus muscle onto the surface of the flexor longus hallucis, and ramifies in the substance of this muscle and its tendon. It gives branches also to the gastrocnemius and soleus. (It does not pass into the foot as does the corresponding artery in man.) i 5. A. tibialis anterior.—The anterior tibial artery is the continuation of the popliteal after its passage through the inter- osseous membrane between tibia and fibula to the dorsal side of the lower leg. Here it passes distad, lying against the inter- _ osseous membrane, between the extensor longus digitorum and the tibialis anterior muscle, or partly imbedded in the substance of the latter. It passes, lying beneath the tendons of these muscles, through the transverse ligament proximad of the malleoli, thus reaching the dorsum of the foot. It extends dis- tad across the tarsus to the space between the second and third metatarsals, and through this space to the plantar side of the 314 foot (Fig. 128). THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. Here it receives one or two small branches (a and @) from the plantar branch of A. saphena (forming Fic. 128..DrEP ARTERIES ON THE PLANTAR SURFACE OF THE FOOT. a, medial twig from plantar branch of A. saphena; 4, A. tibialis anterior (or with them the plantar arch (c)), and passing distad and slightly laterad, divides into three main portions (¢). These (Aa. digitales plantares) pass to the three intervals between the digits. The medial one passes along the lateral side of the second digit; the next divides, sending a branch to the lateral side of the third digit and the medial side of the fourth; the lateral one passes along the medial border of the fifth digit. The Aa. digitales plantares send num- erous branches to the interos- seous muscles. Branches anterior: a. A. tibialis recurrens. —Immediately after passing through the interosseous mem- brane the anterior tibial sends a small artery proximad to the knee-joint. 6. Rami musculares. — Numerous’ short _ branches throughout the course of the artery, to the muscles about it. c. Ramus superficialis.— of the tibialis plantaris profunda); ¢, plantar arch; ¢d, A larger branch leaves the lateral twig from plantar branch of A. saphena; ¢, terminal branches from A. tibialis anterior. lateral surface of the artery about one-third the distance from the knee to the ankle and passes along with the super- ficial peroneal nerve, at first beneath M. peroneus longus, then THE VEINS. 315 superficially. It passes onto the dorsal surface of the foot and becomes connected with terminal branches of A. saphena. d. A. tarsea medialis.—This arises from the tibialis an- terior just distad of the transverse ligament through which it passes at the ankle, passes over the medial surface of the astragalus, and is distributed to the ligaments about the ankle-joint. It anastomoses with the plantar branch of A. saphena. ec. A. metatarsea.—The metatarsal artery passes laterad from the tibialis anterior at the distal boundary of the tarsus, on the dorsal surface of the foot. It sends branches distad in the intervals between the third and fourth and the fourth and fifth metatarsals. The distal branches (Fig. 128) of the tibialis anterior have been described in the general description of the artery. THE VEINS. VEN. Venez pulmonales. The Pulmonary Veins. The pulmonary veins follow in the lungs the course of the bronchi. They enter the left auricle in three groups (Fig. 116, page 276). The first of these (2) comes from the anterior and middle lobes of the right side, the second (%) from the corresponding lobes of the left side, and the third (g) from the terminal lobes of both sides. Each group is composed of two or three veins and opens into a sinus or extension of the auricle. The sinuses are from their position dextral (2), sinistral (/), and dorsal (g). The Veins of the Body. The veins of the body may be classified into three main groups: (1) the veins of the heart; (2) the superior vena cava and its branches; (3) the inferior vena cava and its branches. The portal system of veins will be considered with the inferior vena cava. 1. Veins of the Heart. The veins of the heart consist of one large vein, the vena cordis magna, and a number of small veins. 316 THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. Vena cordis magna (Fig. 118, 3).—This arises as a number of scattered branches on the surface of both ventricles. These unite to form two main trunks. One of these, on the ventral side of the heart, marks externally the septum between the two ventricles. It passes beneath the left auricular appendage, then turns to the left and passes along the sulcus coronarius to the dorsal side of the heart. Here it unites with the second main trunk which ramifies over the surface of the left ven- tricle. Arriving at the base of the right auricle it enters this by the coronary sinus, which lies just beneath the opening of the inferior vena cava. In addition to the vena cordis magna and its branches there are a number of small veins, especially in the wall of the right ventricle. These enter the right auricle by a number of small separate openings along the sulcus coronarius. 2. Vena cava superior (Fig. 129, 0). The superior vena cava is the great vein returning the blood from the head, fore-limb, and cranial part of the trunk. It extends from the level of the first rib on the right side of the . vertebral column to the right auricle. Its caudal end lies dorsad of the aortic arch. Opposite the right rib it is formed by the junction of the two innominate veins (#2). Branches of the superior vena cava: 1. V. azygos (d).—The first branch of the superior vena cava is the azygos vein, which enters the vena cava on the right side a centimeter or less craniad of the root of the right lung. It is formed in the abdominal cavity by the confluence of two or three small veins, which collect the blood from the muscles of the dorsal wall of the abdomen. The small median trunk thus formed enters the thoracic cavity between the crura of the diaphragm and lies on the ventral surface of the centra of the thoracic vertebre, slightly to the right of the middle line. The azygos receives the intercostal veins (z), which correspond to the intercostal arteries and have the same course and distribution. In the caudal part of the thoracic cavity the intercostals enter the azygos separately, but the intercostals of 317 VEINS. THE *SqIt U9AaIa JSIY 9Y) JO spua ynd ‘7-7 ‘snBeydosao ‘€ fvayown ‘z fyeoy ‘1 “stxe peotarao01ht} fo {sutaa pus SOMIB [BSOIOIUI ‘w ‘SUIDA 9JVUTWOUU! OM} OY} ‘@ SvUID}UI SUB[NSNl +A ‘7 !vusE}xo stepnsnl +A ‘y ‘stElIxe “A pue *y ‘/ ‘SUIDA [BOTAIIN0}sO09 puB [eIqa}IAA JO YUNA) pajytun ‘2 ‘stxv eotA1aI0}s00 ‘v ‘BUIOJUL BUvUIUIeU “A 6S SeUuIdJUI ‘ vuvuuem “y YY fejxep vlavpoqns *y ‘a !soshze -A {p ‘1olayul vavo vuaa ‘9 t1onodns vavo vura ‘yg !ejI08 ‘yp ‘AdIS LHOIY AHL WOUd ‘STASSHA-GOOTG SIOVYOH L—"6z1 “og 318 THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. the cranial intercostal spaces usually unite two or three together and enter the azygos by one or more common trunks. The azygos also receives bronchial and wsophageal veins, corresponding to the similarly named arteries. 2. V. mammaria interna (g).—The internal mammary veins follow the corresponding arteries. The two veins unite to form a common trunk which, after receiving a branch from the cranial part of the sternum, enters the vena cava opposite the third rib. 3. Vv. anonyme (Fig. 129, m; Fig. 115, p).—The in- nominate veins unite opposite the first intercostal space to form the vena cava superior. Each extends from the cranial end of the vena cava superior craniolaterad to a point a short distance craniad of the first rib and is there formed by the union of the external jugular (Fig. 129, £) and subclavian (7) veins. The innominate vein has the following branches: A and B. Vv. vertebralis and costocervicalis (¢).—The vertebral and costocervical veins unite to form a single trunk which enters the innominate about opposite the first rib. These two veins follow the corresponding arteries. (Some- times the vertebral and costocervical veins enter the innominate separately, and.in other cases one or more of the components of the costocervical veins (e.g., the transversa colli) may enter the axillary vein. In other cases the entire common trunk of the vertebralis and costocervicalis may enter the superior vena cava directly.) C. V. subclavia.—The subclavian vein enters the innom- inate at about the level of the first rib. Outside of the thorax it is called the axillary vein (7); this comes from the arm. Veins of the Arm.—The blood is returned from the arm by two systems of veins,—a deep and a superficial system. The deep system is composed of veins which correspond to the branches of the axillary artery, follow in general the same course, and receive the same names (Fig. 122). They unite to form the axillary vein. The brachial vein does not pass with the brachial artery through the supracondyloid foramen. The superficial system comprises the vena cephalica and its branches. THE VEINS. "319 V. cephalica (Fig. 130).—Several superficial branches lying in the palm of the hand unite to form a common trunk Fic. 130. SUPERFICIAL ARTERIES, VEINS, AND_ NERVES ON THE ExTENsor SIDE OF THE W ARM AND Dor- SUM OF THE HAND. a, V. cephalica; 6, V. mediana cu- biti; c, V. cepha- lica antibrachii: d, A. collateralis radi- alis superior; e, Aa. and Vv. digi- tales dorsales; f, A. radialis; g, su- © perficial radial nerve; 4, N. mus- culocutaneus; z, N. cutaneus medialis. which curves about the radial side of the wrist and here unites with a simi- larly formed trunk from the dorsum of the hand. The vein formed by this union, vena cephalica (antibrachii) (c), passes to the elbow accompanying the radial nerve (g) and the collateral radial artery (@), and lying on the extensor carpi radialis longus muscle just beneath the integument. It receives small lateral superficial branches. At the elbow it divides into two: these are the vena cephalica (humeri) (@) and the vena mediana cubiti (4). The latter passes beneath the pectoantibrachialis muscle, across the biceps, and unites with the brachial vein in the concavity of the elbow. The vena cephalica (humeri) passes at the elbow onto the upper arm, fol- lowing the lateral border of the clavobrachial muscle. It thus reaches the acromiodeltoid muscle, where it divides into two branches. One passes inward beneath the acromiodeltoid, and joins the vena circumflexa posterior (a branch of the axillary). The second continues over the outer surface of the shoulder, and finally joins the vena transversa scapula (a branch of the external jugular). D. V. jugularis externa (Fig. 131; Fig. 65, 5, page 109).—The external jugular 329 THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. vein comes from the head and face. It is formed by the junc- tion of the anterior (Fig. 131, c) and posterior (4) facial veins near the ventral border of the sternomastoid muscle. It passes thence obliquely across the sternomastoid to the triangular interval between it and the clavotrapezius. In the interval it receives a small branch which accompanies the branch of the transversa scapulz artery to the clavobrachialis muscle, receives next the common trunk of the vena cephalica and transversa scapule, and opposite the cranial end of the manubrium receives the internal jugular vein (Fig. 129, /). It then unites with the subclavian to form the innominate vein. Near the point where it receives the internal jugular the external jugular vein receives the thoracic duct (Fig. 118, 5). Branches of the external jugular: a. V. transversa scapule.—This follows the course of the artery of the same name. One of its branches receives one of the two terminal divisions of the vena cephalica (q. v.). In many cases veins which correspond to branches of the trans- versa scapule artery enter the external jugular separately (as shown in Fig. 118, x and y). 6. V. cervicalis ascendens.—A small branch which follows the corresponding branch of the thyrocervical axis. ¢. V. jugularis interna (Fig. 118, 2; Fig. 119, page 284). —The internal jugular vein varies much in size and in the place where it joins the external jugular. The point of junction is usually at about the level of the first rib, but may be much farther craniad. It arises on the ventral side of the:basal por- tion of the occipital by the junction of a number of veins which are described below. The internal jugular passes caudad in the neck region at the side of the trachea, in company with the common carotid artery and the vagus and sympathetic nerves. In this region it receives branches which accompany the branches of the common carotid artery. The veins which by their union form the internal jugular vein are the following: (1) One or two veins from the venous sinuses of the brain, leaving the cranial cavity by the jugular foramen. These are described in the account of the veins of the brain. THE VEINS. F 321 (2) A large communicating branch from the posterior facial. (3) The vena occipitalis, a large branch coming from the vertebral column (which it leaves by the atlantal foramen) and © from the back of the head. d. V. facialis anterior (Fig. 131, c).—The anterior facial vein’ collects the blood from the face, the tongue, and adjacent parts; it joins the posterior facial (4) caudad of the angle of the jaw to form the external jugular vein. The anterior facial begins over the frontal bone caudad of the orbit, where it is known as the frontal vein (c”’). This runs along the dorsal border of the orbit, into which it dips. It sends a communicating branch into the orbit, and receives small veins (Superior palpebral) from the upper eyelid. It then turns ventrad, passing along the cranial angle of the eye between the levator labii superioris proprius (5) and the orbicu- laris oculi (8) muscles, being called in this region the angular vein (c’). This receives branches (external nasal veins, #) from the side of the nose. The vein crosses the malar bone obliquely (now receiving the name anterior facial, c) and fol- lows the cranioventral border of the masseter muscle (9). As it passes the infraorbital foramen it receives through the foramen a small vein from within the orbit. _ It receives also the inferior palpebral (7) from the lower eyelid, and the superior labial vein (z) from the upper lip. Just caudad of the angle of the mouth it receives from beneath the cranioventral margin of the masseter the V. facialis profunda (/) described below. Still farther caudad it receives the inferior labial vein (g) from the lower lip, and a small branch from the masseter muscle. Caudad of the middle of the cranioventral border of the masseter it receives from beneath the lymphatic gland of this region the large submental vein (/). Next the anterior facial vein receives a large communicating branch (V. trans- versa, 2) which passes transversely across the ventral surface of the throat and connects the two anterior facial veins of the opposite sides. From the middle of this communicating branch an unpaired trunk passes caudad in the middle line and divides into the two laryngeal veins, which pass to the larynx; a small branch is continued from the unpaired trunk craniad into the 322 THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. tongue. The communicating branch receives also near its junction with the anterior facial a rather large superficial branch (e) which comes from the sides of the lower jaw and passes FIG. 131.—SUPERFICIAL VEINS AND ARTERIES OF THE FACE. a, external jugular vein; 4, posterior facial vein; ¢, anterior facial vein (c’, angular vein; ¢’, frontal vein); ¢, communicating branch with opposite anterior facial; e, superficial branch from lower jaw; /, submental vein; g, inferior labial vein; 4, deep facial vein; z, superior labial vein; 7, inferior palpebral vein; 2, external nasal veins; 4, posterior auricular vein; , superficial temporal vein; 7, anterior auricular vein; o, external maxillary artery; Z, inferior labial artery; g, superior labial artery; 7, infraorbital arteries; s, superficial temporal artery; #, anterior auricular branch of posterior auricular artery. 1, M. adductor auris superior; 2, M. corrugator super- cilii medialis; 3, M. corrugator supercilii lateralis; 4, M. levator labii superioris aleeque nasi; 5, M. levator labii superioris proprius; 6, M. myrtiformis; 7, M. orbicularis oris; 8, M. orbicularis oculi; 9, M. masseter; 10, parotid gland; 11, submaxillary gland; 12, lymphatic glands. across the lymphatic gland (42) to join the communicating branch. The following larger branches of the anterior facial are not described above: THE VEINS. 323 V. facialis profunda (Fig. 131, Z).—The deep facial vein enters the anterior facial from beneath the masseter, just caudad of the angle of the mouth. It collects branches from the soft and hard palates and the teeth, these branches passing along with the corresponding arteries for a distance, then uniting and passing ventrolaterad beneath the zygomatic arch to join the anterior facial. The deep facial vein also receives branches which come from the venous plexus that lies in the same region as the arterial carotid plexus. V. submentalis (Fig. 131, /#).—This enters the anterior facial vein at the ventral border of the masseter muscle and near the cranial end of the two superficial lymph-glands (12) in this region. The submental vein is formed at the dorsal border of the digastric muscle by two branches emerging from between the digastric and the mandible. The more cranial of these, V. lingualis, collects branches from the tongue, from its middle to the tip; it passes through the middle of the lateral border of the mylohyoid muscle to join the other branch. The second branch emerges from between the mandible and the pterygoid muscles. It comes from near the caudal end of the mandible, where it becomes continuous with a communi- cating branch from the posterior facial vein, and receives a branch which comes from the mandibular canal; also small branches from the adjacent parts. e. V. facialis posterior (Fig. 131, 4).—The posterior facial vein arises from the region of the internal maxillary artery, its terminal branches following the branches of the artery. It collects blood from the pterygoid, masseter (9), and temporal muscles, and forms a plexus which is interwoven with the carotid (arterial) plexus in the region of the orbital fissure. It is connected with the submental vein by a communicating branch. From the posterior facial a branch extends ventrad close against the outer surface of the tympanic bulla and then turns caudad, receives a branch from the pharynx, then con- tinues to join the internal jugular. The posterior facial itself passes laterad along the caudal border of the masseter (9) and the ventral border of the parotid gland (10), then becomes superficial and turns ventrad over the outer surface of the sub- 324 THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. maxillary gland (11) to join the anterior facial (c) caudad of the angle of the jaw. As it passes ventrad of the parotid gland (10), just before becoming superficial, the posterior facial receives the super- ficial temporal (7). This at first follows the superficial tem- poral artery (s), then enters the substance of the parotid gland, joining the posterior facial near the ventral border of the latter. The superficial temporal receives the anterior auricular (7), a large vein passing along the cranial border of the auricular opening and arising dorsad of the eye. The posterior facial receives also, at the point where it passes from beneath the parotid gland, the posterior auricular or great auricular vein (/). This collects blood from the back of the head and the external ear, its branches following those of the artery of the same name. It passes along the caudal border of the parotid gland to join the posterior facial. VEINS OF THE BRAIN AND SPINAL CORD,—The veins of the brain form a large number of small vessels which pour their blood into larger veins lying in folds of the dura mater; these are known as the venous sinuses of the dura mater. These sinuses communicate with the venous plexus about the orbital fissure, coming from the posterior facial vein; with the internal jugular through the jugular foramen, and with the vertebral veins, in the vertebral canal. The chief sinuses of the dura mater on the dorsal side of the brain are as follows: 1. Sinus sagittalis superior.—This lies in the dorsal part of the falx cerebri, between the two hemispheres of the cere- brum. It receives veins from the dorsal and middle parts of the cerebrum, and passes caudad to the tentorium. Here it enters the sinus transversus. It receives the vena cerebri magna, a large vein coming from the interior of the brain and passing directly dorsad at the caudal end of the corpus callosum to enter the sinus sagittalis. 2. Sinus transversus.—This lies in a canal in the dorsal border of the tentorium. It receives numerous small veins from the cerebellum, roof of the skull, etc. One or two centi- meters on each side of the middle line the sinus transversus passes out of the canal onto the caudal surface of the tentorium, THE VEINS. 325 thence proceeds caudoventrad obliquely over the surface of the cerebellum, unites with veins from the ventral side of the brain, leaves the skull by the jugular foramen, forming thus the inferior cerebral vein, and joins the internal jugular vein. On the ventral side of the brain are the following sinuses of the dura mater: 3. Sinus cavernosus.—A short broad venous sinus, one on each side of the hypophysis, on the body of the sphenoid. It receives veins from the side and ventral surface of the brain. The two sinuses are connected by communicating branches craniad and caudad of the hypophysis. From them branches pass out through the orbital fissure to join the plexus formed by the branches of the posterior facial vein. 4. Sinus petrosus inferior.—This arises from the sinus cavernosus and passes caudolaterad in the groove between the edge of the petrous bone and the basilar portion of the occipi- tal. Reaching the jugular foramen it divides; part joins the termination of the sinus transversus to form the inferior cere- bral vein, which passes through the jugular foramen to join the internal jugular vein. The other portion of the sinus petrosus inferior passes through the condyloid canal of the occipital bone, communicates by a strong transverse branch across the surface of the basioccipital with the vein of the opposite side, and enters the spinal canal through the foramen magnum. Here it joins the sinus of the vertebral column. 5. Sinus columne vertebralis.—On the ventral surface of the vertebral canal, beneath the periosteum, are two wide venous sinuses, one on each side of the middle line. These sinuses extend the entire length of the spinal cord. At the atlantal foramen each sends a strong branch to the internal jugular vein. Farther caudad they send branches to the verte- bral, intercostal, and lumbar veins, and communicate with each other by numerous transverse branches. They receive many small veins from the spinal cord. 3. Vena cava inferior (Fig. 129, c; Fig. 126, a). The inferior vena cava (Fig. 126, a) is formed at about the level of the last lumbar vertebra by the union of the two common 326 THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. iliac veins (Fig. 126, w). It passes craniad near the dorsal median line, lying at first dorsad of the aorta (4), then to the. right, then ventrad. It enters the substance of the liver in the dorsal part of the caudate lobe of the latter, passes through the liver, and then through the diaphragm near the ventrolateral edge of the central tendon. It passes then craniad in the thoracic cavity (Fig. 129, ¢) ventrad of the caudal lobe of the right lung, and enters the right auricle. It receives the following branches (Fig. 126): lumbar, ilio- lumbalis (v), spermatica interna (w), renal (7), adrenolum- balis (s), phrenic, and hepatic veins. All but the last two named accompany the arteries of the same name. V. phrenica.—The phrenic veins gather the blood from the diaphragm and empty into the vena cava as it penetrates the diaphragm. V. hepatica.—The hepatic veins vary in number. They gather the blood from the liver (sent in by the portal vein and hepatic arteries) and enter the vena cava just caudad of the diaphragm. VENA PORT#. THE PORTAL VEIN (Fig. 131).—The portal vein is the large vein carrying the blood from the abdominal viscera to the liver. Within the liver the portal vein breaks up into capillaries; these collect to form the hepatic veins, which enter the vena cava inferior. The portal vein (a) is formed near the pyloric end of the stomach (1) by the union of the superior mesenteric (4) and gastrosplenic (c) veins and passes thence along the ventral border of the fora- men epiploicum (foramen of Winslow) to the liver (2), where it divides, going to the lobes of the liver. On its way to the liver it may receive the pancreaticoduodenalis (7), gastroepi- ploica (c), and coronaria ventriculi (/). These may unite with the portal separately, or any two or all three may unite to form a single trunk before entering the portal vein. 1. V. coronaria ventriculi (/) gathers the blood from the lesser curvature of the stomach and anastomoses with the gastrosplenic veins. It usually empties into the portal vein near the pylorus. 2. V. pancreaticoduodenalis (@) receives the blood from THE VEINS. 327 the pancreas and first part of the duodenum, and empties into the vena porte near to or with the preceding. Fic. 132.—PORTAL VEIN. a, portal vein; 4, superior mesenteric; ¢, gastrosplenic; d, pancreaticoduodenalis; 2, gastroepiploica; 7, coronaria ventriculi; g, 4, z, branches of gastrosplenic; 7, in- ferior mesenteric. 1, stomach; 2, liver; 3, duodenum; 4, spleen. 3. V. gastroepiploica (¢) comes from the greater curvature of the stomach and ascending limb of the great omentum. It empties into the vena porte ventrodextrad of the opening of the coronaria ventriculi, or sometimes in common with it. 4. V. gastrolienalis (c).—The gastrosplenic is one of the veins which unite to make up the portal vein. It is formed by three branches: one (g) from the horizontal or gastric portion of the pancreas, one (/) from the stomach and gastric end of the spleen, the third and largest (2) from the caudal end of the spleen and descending limb of the great omentum. The three 328 THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. branches unite and the common trunk joins the superior mesen- teric vein (4) to form the portal vein as above described. 5. V. mesenterica superior (4).—The superior mesenteric vein receives the blood from the small and large intestines. It is formed by numerous branches which follow and have the same name as the corresponding arteries. It receives also the inferior mesenteric (7) from the large intestine. The numer- ous branches unite, and the main trunk thus formed joins the gastrosplenic (c), and the two united become the portal vein (a). VENA ILIACA COMMUNIS. COMMON ILIAC VEIN (Fig. 126, w; Fig. 127, page 310). The common iliac veins (Fig. 126, w) are the two large vessels which unite in the sacral region to form the inferior vena cava (a). Each is a large vessel, usually four or five centimeters in length, which is formed by the junction of the large external iliac vein with the smaller hypogastric vein (z). The left common iliac usually receives the V. sacralis media (0); other lateral branches are as a rule not received by the common iliac veins. There is much variation as to the formation of the common iliac veins and their union to form the vena cava. On this sub- ject the paper by McClure, in the American Naturalist, vol. XXXIV. pp. 135-198 (March, 1900), may be consulted with profit. The more typical variations may be classified as fol- lows: (1) The two common iliac veins may be longer than usual, so that the vena cava is formed farther craniad than usual. (2) There may be inthe abdominal region two sep- arate veins (vene cardinales) representing the inferior vena cava, these uniting in the region of the kidneys. (3) The vena sacralis media may enter into the left common iliac (the usual condition); or the right common iliac (as in Fig. 126); or it may fork, one branch passing to the left, the other to the right common iliac. Branches of the common iliac veins: 1. V. sacralis media (Fig. 126, 0).—This follows the course of the corresponding artery and usually enters the left common iliac. THE VEINS. 329 2. V. hypogastrica (or iliaca interna) (z).—The hypo- gastric or internal iliac vein joins the medial side of the external iliac to form the common iliac (w). Its branches follow the branches of the corresponding artery except that the vein from the bladder (umbilical vein) joins the V. hemor- rhoidalis media. Also the vena glutea inferior receives a large superficial communicating branch (Fig. 163, #) from the vena saphena parva. This branch leaves the saphena parva (Fig. 163, #) at the popliteal space, and passes over the lateral surface of the biceps muscle to its proximal end. Here it passes between the biceps and caudofemoralis to join the vena glutea inferior. 3. V. iliaca externa (Fig. 127, page 310).—This vein fol- lows the corresponding artery, collecting the blood from the posterior extremity. Its branches are the same and have in general the same distribution as those of the artery. The vein has, however, certain branches in addition to those of the artery, resulting in a somewhat different general arrangement of vessels; it will be necessary therefore to give an account of the system of veins from the foot and lower leg. The blood is collected from the foot into two sets of veins which may be distinguished as the deep and the superficial sets. The veins of the deep set are those which accompany the branches of the popliteal and anterior tibial arteries. Those of the superficial set are larger and carry most of the blood. On the dorsum of the foot blood is collected from the third, fourth, and fifth digits by two or three superficial metatarsal veins, which unite opposite the proximal end of the metatarsus into a single vein. This receives a similar branch coming from the dorsum of the second digit, and has numerous branches in the ankle region which form here a network, communicating with the vena saphena parva (Fig. 163, #), and with branches from the plantar side of the foot. From this network two or three main veins pass proximad on the medial side of the leg, along with the branches of the arteria saphena, and unite with a similar vein from the plantar side of the foot to form tle vena saphena magna (Fig. 127, £, page 310), which accompanies the arteria saphena to join the femoral vein (a). 330 THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. On the plantar side of the foot small veins pass from the digits to a superficial venous plantar arch, which lies just proximad of the fibrous pad on the sole of the foot. At its medial side this arch extends proximad and dorsad to join that branch of the vena saphena magna which comes from the dorsum of the second digit. On the lateral side it extends proximad along the lateral margin of the foot, sends a com- municating branch dorsad to the branches of the V. saphena magna, and continues along the lateral border of the foot to the ankle. It forms the beginning of the V. saphena parva (Fig. 163, k, page 401). This receives branches from the lateral surface of the ankle, which anastomose with those of the saphena magna. The saphena parva then passes proximad along the lateral surface of the leg, close to its ventral border, to the popliteal space. At the distal end of the popliteal space it divides into two branches. One passes inward through the fat of the popliteal space, receiving branches from the lymphatic gland situated here, and joins the popliteal vein, The other (£’) remains superficial and continues proximad over the lateral surface of the biceps to the proximal end of that muscle. Here it passes between the biceps and caudofemoralis to join the inferior gluteal vein. IV. THE LYMPHATIC SYSTEM. SYSTEMA LYMPHATICUM. The lymphatic system of the cat has not been worked out in detail, so that only the main features of the system are given in the following account. The lymphatic system consists of a number of vessels, the lymphatics, containing a colorless fluid called lymph, and of lymphatic glands, connected with the lymphatic vessels. The lymphatic vessels are found throughout the body as slender tubes, frequently united into networks, and containing many valves. They take origin from the spaces in the con- nective tissue, so that they are at first without definite walls. The fluid in the connective-tissue spaces gradually flows together into ‘tubes with definite walls, and these tubes, the lymphatic vessels, finally join the venous system. In their THE LYMPHATIC SYSTEM. 33! passage through the lymphatic glands the vessels break up into fine channels which again unite on leaving the gland. In the gland lymph-cells are added to the fluid, and probably other changes are produced. Most or all of the lymphatic vessels of the body finally unite into two trunks before entering the veins. The largest trunk is the thoracic duct (Fig. 118, 5, page 282), which collects the lymph from the entire caudal half of the body, and from the left forelimb and the left side of the thorax, head, and neck. It passes along the dorsosinistral side of the thoracic aorta, lying against its surface, and enters the left external jugular vein at its junction with the subclavian. The second main trunk is the right lymphatic duct; this collects the lymph from the right side of the thorax, the right forelimb, and the right side of the neck and head; it enters the right external jugular. 1. Lymphatics of the Head.—A number of lymphatic vessels arise on the sides of the face, especially in the upper and lower lips. They form a superficial network of vessels, lying over the ventral half of the masseter muscle and an area ventrad of it. These lymphatic vessels all enter two large lymphatic glands (Fig. 131, 12, page 322) lying at the ventro- caudal angle of the masseter muscle, covering the union of the anterior and posterior facial veins. Into these glands pass also a number of lymph vessels from the back of the head. From these two lymphatic glands two or three small lymphatic vessels pass caudad, lying on the surface of the external jugular vein. Near the point of the shoulder, some distance craniad of the junction of the external and internal jugular veins, these vessels enter another small lymphatic gland lying on the dorsal surface of the external jugular vein. Thence one or two vessels continue caudad, still on the surface of the external jugular, and finally unite with the deep lymphatics of the head and neck and those of the arm to enter the caudal end of the external jugular vein, usually (on the left side) after junction with the thoracic duct, from the thorax. . The deep lymphatics of the head come from the internal parts of the head, tongue, pharynx, etc., and enter a large lymphatic 332 THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. gland situated close to the caudoventral surface of the tympanic bulla, at the side of the pharynx. Thence a large lymphatic trunk passes caudad at the side of the trachea, along with the common carotid artery and internal jugular vein, unites with the superficial vessels from the head, above described, joins (on the left side) the thoracic duct, and enters the external jugular vein. 2. Lymphatics of the Neck.—Two or three lymph-glands are found in the fatty mass in the neck beneath the clavotrape- zius and levator scapule ventralis muscles. These receive lymphatics from the neck and side of the thorax. The vessels which arise from them join those from the head and arm to enter the external jugular vein. _ 3. Lymphatics of the Thoracic Limbs.—The lymphatics of the forelimbs begin as a number of vessels on the dorsum and palm of the hand. These all pass toward the radial side, and at about the base of the first metacarpal the vessels from both sides of the hand unite to form two or three main trunks. These pass towards the elbow, accompanying the vena cepha- lica (Fig. 130). There are usually two of these main trunks, one lying on each side of the vena cephalica) They accompany this vein over the shoulder, following that portion which finally joins the external jugular. In the hollow of the shoulder they enter the cervical lymph-glands, one or two lymph-glands imbedded in the fat lying beneath the clavotrapezius and levator scapule ventralis in this region. From the cervical lymph-glands a single trunk passes mediocaudad, unites with the lymphatics from the head, and usually (on the left side) with the cranial end of the thoracic duct,: and enters the external jugular vein at its junction with the subclavian. The common trunk from the head and arm may enter the jugular separately, but close to the termination of the thoracic duct. On the right side the common trunk is joined by one or more small vessels coming from the lymphatic glands of the thorax and forming the right lymphatic duct. There is said to be also a deep system of lymphatics in the arm, in addition to the superficial system above described; this is said to accompany the branches of the brachial vein. If this THE LYMPHATIC SYSTEM. 333 system is present in the cat, it is much less easily demonstrated than the superficial system. 4. Lymphatics of the Thorax and Abdomen.—In the thorax are a number of lymphatic glands which are apparently not constant in number and position. One is commonly found dorsad of the bifurcation of the superior vena cava, one ventrad of the mammary vein, several small ones about the bifurcation of the trachea, one or more in the region of the aortic arch, and a number of small ones scattered in the mediastinum. The vessels from these glands finally join either the right lym- phatic duct or the thoracic duct; the details have not been worked out and are probably variable. ; In the abdominal cavity a number of mesenteric glands, of considerable size, are found in the mesentery and in the meso- colon. In the mesocolon these are usually separate, forming a chain of glands following the colon about one and a half centimeters from it. In the mesentery the glands are mostly united into a very large one, formerly known as the pancreas aselli; this is the largest lymph-gland in the body. Itis a curved structure, four or five centimeters in length, lying in the central region of the mesentery. Into the mesenteric glands pass lymphatic vessels from the viscera of the abdomen. From the mesenteric glands one or two large lymphatic vessels pass craniodorsad, at first with the portal vein, then dorsad of it. This vessel reaches the dorsal side of the aorta near the cranial end of the kidney, where it enters a large fusiform vessel, the receptaculum chyli, which stretches from the cranial end of the kidney craniad between the crura of the diaphragm into the thorax. The receptaculum receives other lymphatics from the various organs of the abdominal cavity as well as vessels coming from the pelvic region, and from the iliac glands. These lie beside the iliac artery, receive lymphatics from the hind limbs, and send lym- phatics craniad to the receptaculum chyli. The latter forms the beginning of the thoracic duct. The thoracic duct (Fig. 118, 5, page 282) enters the thoracic cavity between the crura of the diaphragm as a con- tinuation of the receptaculum chyli. It lies on the dorsal side 334 THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. of the aorta (a), somewhat to the left. It passes along the aorta, gradually coming to lie more on its left side, and finally leaves that vessel near the aortic arch. The duct continues thence straight craniad along the left side of the cesophagus till it reaches the external jugular vein at its junction with the sub- clavian. In this region the thoracic duct usually unites with the lymphatics coming from the head and arm, then enters the external jugular vein, or the innominate at the point of union of external jugular and subclavian. In its passage through the thorax the duct frequently divides into two or three divisions which pass along parallel to each other for a distance, then reunite. Such division into two or three parts is especially frequent just before the union with the jugular vein. The numerous valves in the thoracic duct give it a beaded appearance. 5. Lymphatics of the Pelvic Limbs.—A number of lym- phatic vessels are formed on the dorsum and the sole of the foot. These pass to the lateral side, forming a network on the lateral and dorsal surface of the ankle-joint, and finally unite into two main trunks which accompany the vena saphena parva. In the popliteal space these enter the popliteal gland which lies imbedded in the fat of that region. From the popliteal gland one or two trunks accompany the superficial division of the vena saphena parva across the lateral surface of the biceps muscle, and finally thus reach the pelvic cavity. Here they join the lymphatics of the pelvic region, which all pour their lymph at last into the thoracic duct. Inguinal glands are either very small or not present in the cat. The pelvic limbs have perhaps a deep system of lymphatics, accompanying the deep veins; if so, they are not easily demonstrable. NERVOUS SYSTEM. I. THE CENTRAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 1. The Spinal Cord. Medulla spinalis (Figs. 133-136). —The spinal cord is that portion of the nervous system which occupies the vertebral canal; it is continuous craniad with the brain. It has the form of a somewhat flattened cylinder and extends from the foramen magnum into the caudal region. It diminishes in diameter after entering the sacral region. The cord has a cervical and a lumbar enlargement, the former (Fig. 133) marking the origin of the nerves which pass to the fore limb, and the latter (Fig. 136) the origin of those which pass to the hind limb. . The cervical enlargement (Fig. 133) lies in that part of the vertebral canal bounded by the fourth to seventh cervical and first thoracic vertebre. Caudad of the first thoracic vertebra the cord continues of nearly uniform diameter to the lumbar enlargement (Fig. 136) which stretches from the third to the seventh lumbar vertebre (inclusive). Caudad of the seventh lumbar vertebra it diminishes uniformly in diameter and ends in a slender cord, the filum terminale (Fig. 136, C), which may be traced into the caudal region. The surface of the cord is marked by a number of longi- tudinal grooves or sulci, and fissures. The most prominent of these is the anterior median fissure (Fig. 134, c), along the ventral median line; into this the pia mater dips. The posterior median sulcus (Fig. 133, ¢; Fig. 134, a) isa shallow furrow along the dorsal median line. The anterior fissure and the posterior sulcus thus divide the cord into lateral halves. 335 336 NERVOUS SYSTEM. Each half is subdivided by the anterior and posterior lateral NN iD SS ee io) ~ Q SES = ! @. or 6 , sulci. The posterior lateral sulcus (Fig. 133, f; Fig. 134, 4) lies at the side of the posterior median sulcus. It is broad and shallow and has the pos- terior roots of the spinal nerves emerg- ing from its bottom. The anterior lateral sulcus exists | only after the forcible pulling out of ll, the anterior (ventral) roots of the S. iy ‘1 “3 _— spinal nerves. It then marks the line i th along which they originate from the is ; cord. Th re 4 In cross-section (Fig. 134) the i) \, substance of the cord appears to the eae i 5 naked eye as composed of a darker i r\ nt central ‘*gray matter’’ (¢) and of an PAN Se outer ‘white matter’? (f). The \i9 f Sake gray matter has in section the form of 2) la the letter H. The cord is really Wihas « iN 7 tubular, having a central canal (/) AWS which appears in section in the middle TN) gy of the cross-bar of the H, while the ‘ \; two ends of each vertical bar extend An I toward the anterior and posterior lateral fissures. The white matter is divided into funiculi (or columns) by the fissures and sulci, so that there is in each half MENT. DorsAL VIEW. of the cord an anterior, a posterior, 1-8, the eight cervical and a lateral white funiculus. nerves. /—//, first two thoracic i i Y nerves. 4, dorsal roots (ventral In the cervical region (Fig. 134) roots not shown); 4, spinal there appears between the posterior ganglia; ¢, dorsal rami; d, ven- f ‘ . tral rami; ¢, posterior median lateral and posterior median sulci an sulcus; /; posterior lateral sulcus. intermediate sulcus which divides the posterior funiculus in this region into two. The median slenderer of these is the fasciculus gracilis (7) or column of FIG, 133.—CRANIAL PORTION OF THE SPINAL CORD, WITH THE CERVICAL ENLARGE ie eee ey el ‘denticulatum THE CENTRAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 337 Goll. The lateral and thicker is the fasciculus cuneatus (ec) or column of Burdach. The membranes of the spinal cord : The dura mater is a tough fibrous membrane directly con- tinuous with the dura mater of the brain. It differs from the dura mater of the brain in two particulars: I. At the foramen magnum it splits into two layers, one of which lines the bony vertebral canal and forms its periosteum, while the other covers the cord. Fics 956 Cates. 2. It is separated from the cord bya con-_ sEcrioN oF THE siderable space. The dura mater is contin- poe sp Pare Hig uous with the fibrous sheaths of the spinal cron. nerves at their points of exit. Along the sige siya upon ad sides of the cord it is connected to the pia lateral sulcus; ¢, an- mater by a delicate strand of connective tissue rece ty eanrrs. probably equivalent to the ‘‘ligamentum ¢ fasciculus cuneatus; f J, white matter; g, of man. gray matter; 4, cen- The arachnoid is a. delicate cellular mem- ‘tl canal. brane lying beneath the dura mater, between it and the pia mater. It forms a continuous investment for the cord, is not vascular, and is said not to dip into the fissures of the cord. The pia mater invests the cord closely and contains some blood-vessels. It is a delicate membrane which dips into the fissures and sulci of the cord and is con- nected to it by numerous strands of con- nective tissue that pass from it into the Fic. 135.—Srcrion or substance of the cord. The nerves pierce SPINAL CORD, SHOWING it THE ORIGIN OF A PAIR ~~ 2 : OF SPINAL NERVES. - Spinal Nerves.—From the spinal cord a, dorsal root; 4, spinal arise the spinal nerves. Of these there ganglion; c, dorsal ramus; sy . 3 - d, ventral ramus; ¢, ven. are about thirty-eight pairs in the cat. tral root. Eight are cervical, thirteen thoracic, seven lumbar, three sacral, and seven or eight caudal. Those leaving the cervical (Fig. 133, 5-8 and /) and lumbar (Fig. 136) enlargements are larger than the others. The first cervical nerve leaves the vertebral canal through the atlantal ” 338 NERVOUS SYSTEM. foramen, the second leaves between the arches of the atlas and axis, while all the others leave the vertebral canal by way of the intervertebral foramina. Each nerve arises from the cord by a dorsal and a ventral root. The dorsal root is chiefly sensory, the ventral motor in character. The dorsal root (radix posterior) (Figs. 133, 135, and 136, a) begins as a number (twelve or more) of separate nerve-bundles which emerge from the posterior lateral groove. These | roots lie nearly in a single plane and pass laterad, converging to penetrate a ganglion, the spinal ganglion (4) (or ganglion of the posterior root). All the spinal ganglia except the first and second are situated in the inter- vertebral foramina or within the verte- bral canal. The first and second are situated among the muscles surrounding the place of exit of the nerves. The ventral root (radix anterior) (Fig 135, ¢) arises as a larger number of small fibre-bundles which do not lie in a single plane, so that in a transverse section several rootlets may appear ina single section.. The rootlets converge to forma single mass which joins the dorsal root just as it emerges from the spinal ganglion.. The nerve formed by the junction of the ventral and dorsal Fic. 136.—Cavpa Portion F0ots is one of the spinal nerves. OF THE SPINAL Corb. The direction in which the nerves A, lumbar enlargement; 2, Jeave the cord varies. In the cervical cauda equina; C, filum termi- : 3 nale; 5-7, fifth to seventh lum- region (Fig. 133) and cranial part of cael gape hay hone the lumbar region it is nearly laterad; 6, spinal ganglia; <¢, dorsal at the cervical and lumbar enlargements rami; @, ventral rami. THE CENTRAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 339 it is laterocaudad. The nerves in the sacral and caudal regions pass almost directly caudad to reach the intervertebral foramina and form thus a brush which surrounds the filum terminale (Fig. 136, C) and is called the cauda equina (Fig. 136, 4). Each spinal nerve immediately after leaving the interverte- bral foramen divides into two branches, a dorsal or posterior branch or ramus (c), and a ventral or anterior ramus (7). The dorsal ramus is in each case small (except in the first and second cervical nerves), and is distributed to the longitudinal muscles and integument of the back. The ventral rami are larger and each is connected a short | distance beyond its origin with the sympathetic system by a short ramus communicans or communicating branch. Each is then distributed to the integument and muscles of the ventral part of the body, including the limbs. The ventral rami which pass to the limbs are much larger than the others. The ventral rami are further distinguished from the dorsal by the fact that they frequently unite with one another to form plexuses. The peripheral distribution of the spinal nerves is described later. 2. The Brain. Encephalon.—tThe brain is that portion of the central nervous system that is included within the cranial cavity. It is a direct continuation of the spinal cord, and presents many of the same essential characters as the latter, with great modifications in details. The structure of the brain can best be understood if it be considered as a modified continuation of the spinal cord, and the relation of the parts to the essential parts of the cord noted. The spinal cord is a nearly straight tube, with a central cavity and thick walls. The brain is likewise tubular, with the cavities enlarged or subdivided in places, with the walls greatly thickened, and with a number of bends and constrictions in the tube. The relation of the structure of the brain to that of the spinal cord is most easily perceived by an examination of the brain of some lower vertebrate, as the frog or shark, and such an examination should be made before proceeding to the study of the more complicated brain of the cat. 34° NERVOUS SYSTEM. In the following account of the brain of the cat all parts will be described as far as possible in relation with the tubular structure of the brain. The brain will be considered as a hollow structure, having central cavities, and the solid portions will be brought into relation as parts of the roof, sides, or floor of the cavities. The cavities of the brain, forming a direct continuation of the central canal of the spinal cord, are known as ventricles (ventriculi). In a general view of the cat’s brain from the dorsal side (Fig. 137) four subdivisions are discernible. At the caudal t Fic. 137.—DoORSAL SURFACE OF THE BRAIN. I, olfactory bulbs; Z/, cerebral hemispheres; ///, cerebellum; 7V, medulla. a, preesylvian sulcus; 4, cruciate sulcus; ¢c, sulcus ansatus; d, coronal sulcus; ¢, anterior sulcus; 7, posterior sulcus; g, suprasylvian sulcus; 4, separate parts of the lateral sulcus; z, end of splenial sulcus; 7, vermis of cerebellum; 4, hemispheres of cerebel- lum; 7, roof of fourth ventricle; 7, first cervical nerve. 1, orbital lobe (or gyrus); 2, sigmoid gyrus; 3, anterior sylvian gyrus; 4, ectosylvian gyrus; 5, suprasylvian gyrus; 6, posterior sylvian gyrus; 7, parts of marginal gyrus; 8, gyrus compositus posterior. ; end is a small stalk-like portion (JV) which is clearly a slightly modified continuation of the spinal cord; this is the myelen- cephalon or medulla oblongata. Just craniad of this, rising eT eee ee THE CENTRAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 341 high above it, is an irregularly lobulated rounded portion, the cerebellum (///). This is produced as a thickening of the wall of the original tube; it forms the dorsal part of the meten- cephalon. These two portions of the brain have a common cavity, lying within the medulla oblongata and ventrad of the cerebellum, and formed by a widening of the cavity of the spinal cord; it is known as the fourth ventricle. Craniad of the cerebellum, separated from it by a deep transverse fissure, ~ are two very large portions, the hemispheres of the cerebrum (7/7), separated from each other by a deep longitudinal fissure ; they constitute together the telencephalon. The hemispheres are produced by a sort of forking of the original central tube; —by outgrowths on the sides of the tube, the central cavity extending into the outgrowths. The two outgrowths extend dorsad, as well as craniad and caudad from the original place of origin, forming the larger part of the brain; the extensions of the central cavity which they contain are known as the lateral ventricles. Finally, in front of the two hemispheres are seen the two small olfactory bulbs (/) which are mere extensions of the two hemispheres and contains cavities which are extensions of the lateral ventricles. In a ventral view of the entire brain (Fig. 138) certain parts are visible which in the dorsal view are hidden by the large cerebral hemispheres. At the caudal end is seen, as before, the medulla oblongata, or myelencephalon, and craniad of this, on the ventral side of the cerebellum, a broad trans- verse tract, the pons (z); this, like the cerebellum, forms part of the metencephalon. All this part of the brain formed by the myelencephalon and metencephalon lies caudad of (behind) the rest of the brain and is marked off from it bya great fissure; it therefore receives as a whole the name hind- brain or rhombencephalon. Just craniad of the pons are seen two short diverging arm- like bands of fibres (g), enclosing a small triangular space between them. These two arms with the space between them are all that is visible of a division of the brain which in dorsal view is completely covered by the backward projection of the cerebral hemispheres. This is the midbrain or mesencephalon. 342 NERVOUS SYSTEM. In this portion of the brain the continuation of the central cavity is a narrow canal which receives the name cerebral aqueduct (aqueductus cerebri) or aqueduct of Sylvius. $F 7 rome ie Vl A De. a, ts oes : ae es i 6 = 4 Fic. 138.—VENTRAL SURFACE OF THE BRAIN. » J-XT7, the twelve cranial nerves in order; /, olfactory bulb; 7/, N. opticus; Z//, N. oculomotorius; /V, N. trochlearis; V, N. trigeminus (1, mandibular nerve; 2, maxillary nerve; 3, ophthalmic nerve; 4, sensory root); V7, N. abducens; V//, N. facialis; V77/, N. acusticus; ZX, N. glossopharyngeus; X, N. vagus; X7/, N. acces- sorius; X//, N. hypoglossus. a, tractus olfactorius; 4, substantia perforata anterior; £, optic chiasma; @, infundibulum; e, hypophysis; /, lobus pyriformis, or tractus postrhinalis; g, pedunculi cerebri; 2, substantia perforata posterior; ¢, pons; 7, sulcus basilaris of pons; 4, semilunar (or Gasserian) ganglion; /, trapezium; m2, area ovalis; m, area elliptica; 0, pyramidal tracts; f, anterior or ventral fissure; g, foramen cecum; 7”, anterior lateral sulcus; s, first cervical nerve. Just craniad of the midbrain is a small rather irregular area, bounded craniad by the band-like optic chiasma (c), from which arise the optic nerves (//), and showing caudad of this band a rounded irregular projection (¢). “This is a fourth divi- sion of the brain which is likewise covered dorsad by the | hemispheres; it is the ’tween-brain or diencephalon. Its cavity is known as the third ventricle. Just craniad of the ee Sed SR ee ee ee 1 a2 he lal eli THE CENTRAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 343 ‘tween-brain, in the median line, is a deep fissure, showing that here in reality is the termination of the original tube, the further extension craniad being due to the pushing forward of the lateral outgrowths, or cerebral hemispheres, which extend in ventral view a considerable distance further craniad. The hemispheres lie also caudad, laterad, and dorsad of the mid- brain and ’tween-brain, so that these parts are almost enveloped by the hemispheres. The hemispheres and ’tween-brain are sometimes taken together as forming a sage portion, the fore- brain or prosencephalon. There are thus altogether five principal subdivisions of the brain, each enclosing a portion of the central cavity. These are the myelencephalon, the metencephalon (these two enclos- ing the fourth ventricle), the mesencephalon (enclosing the cerebral aqueduct), the diencephalon (enclosing the third ventricle), and the two cerebral hemispheres, con- stituting together the telencephalon, and enclosing the two lateral ven- tricles. A plan of the brain, con- - sidered as a tube enclosing cavities, is given in Figs. 139 and 140. Fig. 139 shows the plan considered as Zz ist >> Fic. 139.—DIAGRAM OF BRAIN Fic. bo aa OF BRAIN FROM FROM ABOVE. THE SIDE. I, myelencephalon; 2, metencephalon; 3, mesencephalon; 4, diencephalon; 5, telencephalon. @, canal of the spinal cord; 4, fourth ventricle; ¢, cerebral aqueduct (aqueduct of Sylvius); d@, third ventricle; ¢, lateral ventricle; 7, interventricular fora- men (or foramen of Monroe); g, lamina terminalis; 4, olfactory bulb. viewed from the dorsal side, Fig. 140 in a lateral view. These figures are of course pure diagrams, showing only what may be called the f/an of structure, and omitting all details. In the actual conditions many important modifications even of the main features of the plan are met with. 344 NERVOUS SYSTEM. In the following description the parts of the brain will be taken up in this order: A. RHOMBENCEPHALON (primitive hindbrain). 1. Myelencephaton. 2. Metencephalon. B. MESENCEPHALON (primitive midbrain). 3. Mesencephalon. C. PROSENCEPHALON (primitive forebrain). 4. Diencephaton. 5. Lelencephalon. A. RHOMBENCEPHALON.—1. Myelencephalon.—The my- elencephalon or medulla oblongata is transitional between the spinal cord and the brain. It has in general the structural peculiarities ofthe cord, but these undergo in it a gradual trans- formation into the arrangements characteristic of the brain. It has the form of a flattened and truncated cone, which widens craniad and is limited at the cranial end by the pons (Fig. 138, 2) ventrally and laterally; by the cerebellum (Fig. 137, ///) dorsally. The cranial portion of its dorsal surface is overhung by the cerebellum. The points of origin of the roots of the first pair of cervical nerves (Fig. 138, s) may be taken as indicating the boundary between the spinal cord and the medulla oblongata; there is no other external marking to show the limits of the two. The central canal of that part of the medulla which is overhung by the cerebellum is greatly widened (Fig. 141, 4). The cavity: thus formed is flattened and triangular, with the apex of the triangle caudad, and is the caudal part of the fourth ventricle (Fig. 141, %). The roof is very thin (Fig. 143, 2) and is intimately connected with the pia mater, so that in removing the latter the thin roof of the fourth ventricle is removed with it and the cavity of the fourth ventricle is left exposed. The ‘thin roof of the fourth ventricle is known as the velum medullare posterius (Fig. 143, 7). The ventral (anterior) fissure (Fig. 138, f) of the cord passes onto the medulla oblongata and ends at the pons (2), its end being slightly deeper and forming what is known as the ie | tg Sah Ske PINE, Eee SEER eis SE Ss THE CENTRAL, NERVOUS SYSTEM. 345 foramen cecum (7). The dorsal (posterior) sulcus (Fig. 141, a) is well marked; it ends at the caudal boundary of the fourth ventricle (%). The anterior lateral sulcus (Fig. 138, 7) may be traced craniad from the origin of the ventral roots of the first cervical nerves (s), along the lateral border of the area elliptica (v), then curving mediad to the lateral border of the pyramis (0), and finally reaching the pons (7). Its position is marked by the origin of the roots of the hypoglossal nerve (X//). The posterior lateral sulcus (Fig. 141, 4), marked on the spinal cord by the origin of the dorsal nerve-roots, curves laterad at the sides of the fourth ventricle (Z) owing to the increasing width of the latter, and ends at an elevated area of oblique fibres, the area ovalis (/). The columns or funiculi bounded by the longitudinal fissures present the following peculiarities: The anterior white funiculus of the cord is replaced in the medulla by the pyramidal tracts (pyramides) (Fig. 138, 0). The pyramidal tracts are formed by fibres which emerge from beneath the pons and pass caudad to disappear just craniad of the level of the first cervical nerve (s). The pyramidal tracts are bounded medially by the anterior median fissure (/), but laterally each is separated from the anterior lateral sulcus (7) over its caudal part by an elongated area elliptica (x), the human homologue of which is uncertain. It perhaps represents the oliva. Laterad of the cranial portion of the pyramids is an irreg- ular area known as the trapezium (/) which abuts caudad on the area elliptica (7) and the area ovalis (7). The area ovalis (Fig. 138, m; Fig. 141, f) (or zonula Arnoldi) is a broad band of oblique fibres which passes from the lateral side of the area elliptica craniodorsad to disappear under the cerebellum. The posterior white funiculus was divided in the cervical region into two, the fasciculus gracilis (column of Goll) and the fasciculus cuneatus (column of Burdach). The fasciculus gracilis (Fig. 141, c) extends to the caudal end of the fourth ventricle (Z) and ends there in an expansion, the clava (@), which forms the posterior boundary of the fourth ventricle. 346 NERVOUS SYSTEM. The fasciculus cuneatus (e) passes laterad on account of the width of the fourth ventricle and appears to end at the area ovalis (/), but it may be seen passing beneath the area ovalis, emerging at its cranial border and turning dorsad to enter the cerebellum. It forms the side walls of a part of the shallow fourth ventricle. The lateral funiculi are divided by longitudinal furrows into three divisions. The dorsal one of these is the fasciculus cuneatus lateralis or column of Rolando (Fig. 141, g). It accompanies the fasciculus cuneatus into the cerebellum. The entire mass formed by the fasciculus gracilis, the fasciculus cuneatus medialis, and fasciculus cuneatus lateralis is known as the corpus restiforme, and since its fibres pass into the cerebellum it is sometimes known as the pedunculus cere- belli (or crus cerebelli ad medullam). The following cranial nerves arise from the medulla oblon- gata (Fig. 138). The twelfth nerve (X//) (N. hypoglossus) arises by ten or fifteen rootlets from the ventral surface of the medulla oblon- gata in the anterior lateral fissure (7) opposite the caudal por- tion of the area elliptica (7). The eleventh cranial nerve (X/) (N. accessorius) arises by numerous rootlets from the lateral surface of the medulla oblongata and of the spinal cord as far caudad as the sixth or seventh cervical nerve. These rootlets join to form a nerve which enters the cranium through the foramen magnum and is closely associated at its point of exit with the glossopharyngeal (7X) and vagus (X’) nerves. The line of origin on the medulla passes between the dorsal and ventral roots of the cervical nerves and is along the middle of the lateral white funiculi. The tenth cranial nerve (1) (N. vagus) arises by about eighteen very delicate rootlets from the surface of the area ovalis. The rootlets are divided into a dorsal and a ventral series. The dorsal series (about twelve) arise in the groove which separates the fasciculus cuneatus medialis from the fasciculus cuneatus lateralis. The ventral series arise somehat ventrad of this groove. These rootlets are to be distinguished from those of the ninth nerve by their smaller size. la THE CENTRAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 347 The ninth cranial nerve (/X) (N. glossopharyngeus) arises from the area ovalis from a line craniad of the dorsal line of origin of the vagus roots (1) and between these and those of the auditory (V///). It arises by a number of rootlets which are larger than those of the vagus (1), with which this nerve is closely associated. The eighth cranial nerve (V///) (N. acusticus) appears at the lateral end of the trapezium (/). It arises from an elevation (Fig. 141, 2) which is continued dorsomediad along the cranial border of the area ovalis. The seventh cranial nerve (VJZ/) (N. facialis) leaves the lateral border of the trapezium (/) near its cranial edge, between the fifth and eighth nerves. It is much smaller than the eighth nerve. The sixth cranial nerve (V/) (N. abducens) arises by about six bundles from the groove between the pyramids and the trapezii and passes craniad. 2. Metencephalon.—The metencephalon includes the pons and the cerebellum. The pons (Fig. 138, z) is a mass of transverse fibres which forms the ventral and cranial part of the primitive hindbrain. It is a modification of the latter brought about by the develop- ment of the cerebellum, and the degree of its development is in direct ratio to that of the cerebellar and cerebral hemispheres. The pons forms a projecting mass of fibres which is marked by a median longitudinal groove, the sulcus basilaris (7), which indicates the course of the basilar artery (Fig. 121, ¢). Laterad the fibres of the pons converge somewhat and turning dorsad disappear in the cerebellum, forming the brachia pontis (Fig. 141, Z). . The fifth cranial nerve (Fig. 138, ”) (N. trigeminus) arises by two roots from the caudal border of the pons, near the lateral end. The ventral root (4) is small; the dorsal one is much larger and soon forms the large semilunar ganglion (£) from which three branches (1,2, and 3) diverge. The ventral root (4) joins one of these branches (1). The cerebellum (Fig. 137, ///) is formed by an increase in size of the cranial portion of the primitive hindbrain. This 348 NERVOUS SYSTEM. increase has affected principally the surface of the roof, so that as the cerebellum has grown it has been thrown into many folds, the exact form of which varies in different specimens. The cerebellum has at the same time increased in size and has thus extended laterad as well as caudad and craniad. It thus touches the cerebrum in front (separated from it by the ten- torium) and aids it in concealing the midbrain and ’tween-brain in dorsal view, while caudad in the same view it conceals the greater part of the medulla. The connections of the cerebellum with adjacent parts of the brain are also overhung and con- cealed. The whole surface of the cerebellum is thrown up into numerous folds or gyri, separated from one another by deep fissures or Sulci, which appear at first to render the surface wholly irregular. The entire mass is, however, divisible into a central portion, which from its resemblance to a segmented worm is called the vermis (7) (its cranial part is the superior vermis, and its caudal part the inferior vermis), and into lateral portions, the hemispheres (4). The vermis (7) occupies a median longitudinal position, and its gyri and sulci are in the main transverse. It is not directly connected with adjacent parts, and its ventral] surface extends farther caudad and craniad than that of the hemispheres. The ventral part of the superior vermis is fitted against the posterior corpora quadrigemina. The hemispheres (4) may again be subdivided into groups of gyri which have received special names. One of these, the so-called appendicular lobe, fits into the appendicular fossa of the petrous bone. The cerebellum is connected to the adjacent parts by three tracts of fibres, sometimes known as crura cerebelli. The tract connecting it with the medulla oblongata is the corpus resti- forme; that connecting it with the pons is the brachium pontis (Fig. 141, 7); these have been described. A third tract passes craniad to the corpora quadrigemina (Fig. 141, p and g); this is the brachium conjunctivum (Fig. 141, £). The cerebellum is composed of white and gray matter, the latter on the surface (Fig. 143, ///). The folds of its surface present thus a contrivance for increasing the amount of gray THE CENTRAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 349 matter. The white matter forms a central mass from which tracts extend into the folds. The whole mass of white matter has thus in section (more particularly in a longitudinal section of the vermis) the appearance of a tree, whence the name_ arbor vite (Fig. 143). The fourth ventricle (Fig. 141, 2; Fig. 143, m) is the cavity of the original hindbrain. It begins caudad at the clava (Fig. 141, d@) as a widening and continuation of the central canal of the spinal cord and extends craniad, becoming wider and passing ventrad of the cerebellum. 1t becomes narrower craniad and ends at the posterior corpora quadrigemina (/), where it becomes continuous with the aqueductus cerebri (Fig. 141, 0; Fig. 143, 7). The cavity is shallow and is encroached upon dorsally by the vermis of the cerebellum (Fig. 143). The floor of the cavity is known as the fossa rhomboidea (Fig. 141, %). It is formed by the continuation of the gray matter which surrounds the central canal of the cord. It is marked by a median longitudinal groove. At its widest part are seen two considerable tracts of white fibres (striae medul- lares) which pass from near the median line laterad and extend into the auditory (eighth) nerves. The floor caudad and craniad of these strie is marked by a number of elevations and depressions. Similarly situated elevations in the human brain differ from one another slightly in color, are made up of gray matter, and are the centres of origin of most of the cranial nerves. Their homologues in the cat appear not to have been determined. The side walls of the fourth ventricle (Fig. 141) are formed by the following in order, beginning caudad: the clava (@), the ‘corpus restiforme, brachium pontis (/), brachium con- junctivum (#), and caudal corpora quadrigemina (/) (col- liculi inferiores). The roof (Fig. 143) is formed caudad by a thin layer of non-nervous matter which is closely associated with the pia mater. This thin layer is known as the velum medullare posterius (7). It connects the dorsal surface of the medulla with the caudal border of the cerebellum. The pia mater covering this portion of the roof is vascular and is folded in 350 NERVOUS SYSTEM. toward the floor of the ventricle, forming the choroid plexus of the fourth ventricle. In the middle the roof of the fourth ventricle is the cerebellum, while craniad the roof is the velum medullare anterius (Fig. 143, 7). This is a thin layer just craniad of the cerebellum, connecting it with the corpora quad- rigemina, and attached laterally to the brachia conjunctiva. Here the fourth ventricle narrows craniad and becomes con- tinuous with the slender aqueductus cerebri (Fig. 143, 7) (aqueduct of Sylvius). The narrowed portion of the brain is frequently known as the isthmus rhombencephali. Fic. 141.—DorsaL SuRFACE OF MYELENCEPHALON, MESENCEPHALON, AND DIENCEPHALON. The cerebellum and the greater part of the cerebral hemispheres have been re- moved. 4, posterior sulcus of cord; 4, posterior lateral sulcus; ¢, fasciculus gracilis; d, clava; e, fasciculus cuneatus; /, area ovalis; g. fasciculus cuneatus lateralis; 4, fossa rhomboidea or floor of fourth ventricle; 2, projection formed by origin of audi- tory nerve; 7, facial nerve; 4, cut end of brachium conjunctivum; 2, cut end of bra- chium pontis (7’, brachium pontis); 7, velum medullare anterius; 7, fourth nerve; 0, depression marking caudal end of aqueductus cerebri (aqueduct of Sylvius); A, caudal corpora quadrigemina (colliculi posteriores); g, cranial corpora quadrigemina (colliculi anteriores); 7, brachium quadrigeminum inferius; s, corpus geniculatum mediale; ¢, thalamus; z, striz medullares; v, third ventricle; w, pulvinar; x, corpus geniculatum laterale; y, corpus striatum; z, outlines of olfactory bulbs. 1, boundary between hemispheres and ’tween-brain; 2, pineal body. The fourth cranial nerve (Fig. 141, ~; Fig. 138, /V’) (N. trochlearis) arises from the brain at the craniolateral angle of the velum medullare anterius. THE CENTRAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 351 B. MESENCEPHALON.—3. Mesencephalon.—The mesen- cephalon or midbrain includes the corpora quadrigemina (Fig. 141) and the pedunculi cerebri (Fig. 142). In the primary midbrain there is a pronounced thickening of the walls accom- panied by a reduction of the central canal. The midbrain does not thus become very large and is concealed in the dorsal view by the cerebellum and cerebrum, though its floor appears in the ventral view just craniad of the pons (Fig. 138, g). Its narrow canal is the aqueductus cerebri (aqueduct of Sylvius) (Fig. 143, 7). Its roof forms the corpora quadrigemina, and its floor the pedunculi cerebri. In a dorsal view (Fig. 141) the roof is seen to be marked by two pairs of elevations, the corpora quadrigemina (7 and g). The cranial pair (7) (known as the colliculi superiores) are cir- cular in outline, surrounded on all sides except the cranial one by a deep groove. From the cranial side a tract of fibres (brachium quadrigeminum superius, or arm of the cranial cor- pus) extends craniad and disappears beneath the thalamus (¢). Between the anterior or cranial corpora quadrigemina lies the pineal body or epiphysis (corpus pineale) (Fig. 143, y; Fig. 141, 2), a portion of the roof of the ’tween-brain. The caudal corpora (Fig. 141, f) are larger than the cranial ones, and ovoid in shape with the long axis vertical. They are united in the median line, and the velum medullare anterius (wz) stretches between their caudal borders. The brachium of the caudal corpus quadrigeminum (brachium quadrigeminum in- ferius) (y) extends craniad and disappears beneath a consider- able elevation, the corpus geniculatum mediale (s). Crossing this brachium is seen a small tract of fibres which extends ventrad, crosses the pedunculus cerebri, and reaches the medial border of the latter. It is the tractus transversus peduncularis (Fig. 142, 4). Ventrad of the caudal corpus quadrigeminum is seen a triangular area of oblique fibres which corresponds in position to the human lemniscus. The pedunculi cerebri (peduncles of the cerebrum) form the ventral part of the midbrain. They appear in a ventral view of the entire brain (Fig. 138) as two broad tracts of fibres (g) emerging from beneath the pons and diverging from one 352 NERVOUS SYSTEM. another as they pass craniad, finally disappearing beneath the cerebral hemispheres. Each is made up of many fibre-bundles, which are apparent in surface view (Fig. 142). The peduncles are separated by a small triangular space, which is marked by a median longitudinal sulcus. In this space, just caudad of the mammillary bodies, is a small area through which a number of blood-vessels pass into the brain. This is known as the posterior perforated area (or substance) (Fig. 142,7). The cerebral peduncles (a) are Fic. 142.VenTRAL Sur- crossed by the tractus transversus pedun- etre eu cularis (0) (see above). WITH THE Pons. The third cranial nerve (Fig. 138, @, pedunculi cerebri; 4, 777) (N. oculomotorius) leaves the brain tractus transversus peduncu- 2 laris; ¢, corpus geniculatum at the medial border of the cerebral chu eae peduncle (g), just caudad of the tractus g, mammillary bodies; 4, transversus peduncularis. aber cinerum; /ousning ‘The aqueductus cerebri (Fig. 143, been removed); 7, posterior Fig. 153, @) (or aqueduct of Sylvius) is ian ee mira the continuation craniad of the fourth fifth, seventh, and eighth ventricle. It is a narrow passage, one cranial nerves. Lea 5 : ; or two millimeters in diameter, lying dorsad of the pedunculi cerebri and ventrad of the corpora quadrigemina. C. PROSENCEPHALON.—The prosencephalon or primitive forebrain includes the diencephalon or ’tween-brain and the telencephalon or cerebral hemispheres. 4. Diencephalon.—The diencephalon or ’tween-brain in- cludes the thalami and the other parts bounding the third ventricle. The diencephalon is seen in entire brains only in ventral view (Rig. 135, ¢, 0, & ete.) The diencephalon may be considered as forming almost or quite the most cranial portion of the median nervous tube,— the cranial wall of the third ventricle (the lamina terminalis) (Fig. 143, @), ending in the median line in the deep fissure between the hemispheres of the cerebrum. Parts of the brain THE CENTRAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 353 which extend farther craniad than this are lateral portions, due to the forward growth of the lateral hemispheres. The two hemispheres of the cerebrum may be considered as lateral out- growths of the central ’tween-brain; these outgrowths have extended dorsad, laterad, craniad, and caudad, so as to cover almost completely the ’tween-brain. In early stages the cerebral hemispheres are projections from the cranial end of the ’tween-brain, so that the plane of junc- tion was nearly transverse, the cranial end of the ’tween-brain joining the caudal end of the hemispheres. With the increas- ing size and backward growth of the latter, the attachment to the ’tween-brain has been shifted from a cranial to nearly a lateral position, and at the same time the originally lateral sur- face of the ’tween-brain has become nearly caudal. This is shown in Fig. 141, the deep fissure at I marking the line of ~ attachment between the ’tween-brain and the hemispheres. The dorsoventral plane of junction of ‘tween-brain and hemi- spheres is (as Fig. 141 shows) not wholly lateral, but oblique, passing from its cranial end near the middle line caudolaterad. A second peculiarity of the ’tween-brain lies in the thinness of its roof. The roof is exceedingly thin and is so intimately connected with the pia mater that they cannot be removed separately. The ventral thick floor of the ‘tween-brain is directly continuous with the similar floor of the cerebrum; but where the roof of the ’tween-brain joins the roof of the cerebrum along the oblique plane already indicated, the roof is very thin _and is intimately connected to the pia mater, and is at the same time folded into the lateral ventricles to form, together with the pia mater, the choroid plexuses of the lateral ventricles (Fig. 148, ¢). When the pia mater is removed the thin roof of the brain along the line of junction of the ’tween-brain and the cerebrum is brought away and there appears to be a direct communication between lateral ventricles and the exterior. We may now take up the parts of the diencephalon in detail. a. Thalamus (Fig. 141, ¢).—The two thalami are large oblique rounded ridges, forming the sides of the ’tween-brain. They lie just craniad of the cranial corpora quadrigemina (¢), but separated from them by a broad groove, and are completely 354 NERVOUS SYSTEM. covered by the caudally projecting part of the cerebral hemi- spheres. The medial larger end of each thalamus is near the middle line; thence the thalamus extends caudolaterad, and rises at its lateral extremity into a sharply rounded projection, the corpus geniculatum laterale (7). From this projection the thalamus is continued ventrad and then craniomediad as a large band of fibres, the optic tract (tractus opticus) (Fig. 142, ¢), which extends to the optic chiasma (e), where it passes into the optic nerves (f/f). On the caudal border of the thalamus, near the median line, is a very faint projection, the pulvinar (Fig. 141, w); this lies just craniad of the lateral border of the cranial corpus quadrigeminum (g). Just ventrad of the corpus genicu- latum laterale (x) is the prominent rounded corpus geniculatum mediale (s); this is connected by a prominent ridge, the brachium quadrigeminum inferius (7), with the caudal corpus quadrigeminum (f). In a similar manner the brachium quadrigeminum superius passes from the cranial corpus quad- rigeminum (g¢) into the thalamus itself. ' Between the two thalami there exists a groove, the sulcus hypothalamicus. Over this groove lies the roof of the third ventricle, forming the choroid plexus of the third ventricle (Fig. 143, w). The medial surface of the two thalami are flat and extend directly ventrad, forming part of the lateral boundary of the third ventricle (Fig. 143, %). The two medial surfaces meet over a considerable area across the narrow cavity of the third ventricle, and unite, forming the massa intermedia (Fig. 143, /) or intermediate mass of the thalamus (‘«middle commissure ’’). This connection of the thalami of the two sides is thus not a primitive one, forming no part of the roof or floor of the central cavity, but is a secondary con- nection due to a growing together of a part of the two sides of the ventricle across its cavity. Along the dorsal edge of the medial border of each thalamus passes a distinct white strand, the stria medullaris (Fig. 141, ~); the two striz meet in an arch caudad, lying beneath the pineal body (2). The thalamus is separated craniolaterad by a groove (1) from the corpus striatum’ (y), on the floor of the cerebral hemisphere. SS Te ey a Te ee Ne Pe aE Sr a ee ae a eae ee Page ae — TMP 7 " a ° Si ee 5 i a pet oe ee ee ee oe Te THE CENTRAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 355 6. The roof of the third ventricle is thin and united with the pia mater, as already stated. The pia mater bears many blood-vessels, and the two are folded into the groove between the optic thalami, forming the lamina chorioidea epithelialis, or choroid plexus of the third ventricle (Fig. 143, w). The roof is attached to the dorsomedial borders of the thalami and becomes continuous with the choroid plexus of the lateral ven- tricles (Fig. 148, ¢) at the craniolateral borders of the thalami. The pineal body (corpus pineale) or epiphysis (Fig. 141, 2; Fig. 143, y) is a small conical body which is formed as an outgrowth of the caudal part of the roof of the third ventricle. It lies on the roof of the brain between the two cranial corpora quadrigemina (Fig. 141, g). It is hollow, containing an exten- sion of the third ventricle. From its craniolateral angles two white strands, the habenule, extend into the striz medullares (Fig. 141, w) of the thalami. ‘Just ventrad of the pineal body is a transverse band of white fibres, lying in the caudal part of the roof of the third ventricle. This interconnects the two thalami, and forms the posterior commissure (Fig. 143, 2’) (commissura posterior). From this commissure a thin sheet of tissue extends to the pineal body. c. The floor of the third ventricle appears in a ventral view of the brain (Fig. 138, Fig. 142) as a somewhat diamond- shaped space craniad of the pedunculi cerebri (Fig. 142, a) and bounded along its cranial margin by the optic tracts (Fig. 142, d@). The optic tracts come from the thalami, as already described; they converge and unite to form the optic chiasma (Fig. 142, e), from which the optic nerves (/) diverge. Immediately caudad of the optic chiasma lies a considerable rounded gray elevation, the tuber cinereum (Fig. 142, 2%). - This bears on its ventral surface in the natural condition the infundibulum (Fig. 138, @) with the hypophysis (Fig. 138, ¢); in cases where the two latter structures have been removed (Fig. 142) the tuber cinereum (Z) bears a small longitudinal opening (2) for attachment of the infundibulum. The infundi- bulum (Fig. 138, @) is a hollow extension of the floor of the third ventricle, and is attached to the middle of the ventral 356 NERVOUS SYSTEM. surface of the tuber cinereum. It bears at its ventral end the hypophysis (pituitary body) (Fig. 138, ¢), a vascular non-ner- vous body of unknown function. The hypophysis is lodged in the sella turcica of the sphenoid bone. At its caudal border the tuber cinereum bears two white elevations, the mammillary bodies (corpora mammillaria) (Fig. 142, g). The third ventricle (Fig. 143, 2; Fig. 141, v) is a very narrow slit-like space, of considerable extent dorsoventrally, but less than a millimeter in width; it lies between the medial noe fy s ’ P.3 wu W 4 Fic. 143..-LONGITUDINAL MEDIAN SECTION OF BRAIN. Z, olfactory bulb; //, cerebrum; ///, section of cerebellum, showing ‘‘ arbor vite ’’; /V, medulla oblongata. a, tractus olfactorius; 4, substantia perforata an- terior; ¢, anterior commissure; @, lamina terminalis; ¢, optic chiasma; /, massa in- termedia of thalamus; g’, infundibulum; g, hypophysis; 4, third ventricle; z, mammil- lary body; 7, aqueductus cerebri (or aqueduct of Sylvius); 4, pons; 4, velum medul- lare anterius; #2, fourth ventricle; 7, velum medullare posterius; 0, continuation of canal of spinal cord; #, corpus callosum (body); g, genu of corpu callosum; 7, ros- trum; s, splenium; 7, septum pellucidum; zw, fornix; v, pillars of fornix; w, choroid plexus of third ventricle; x, stria medullaris; y, corpus pineale; z, cranial corpus quadrigeminum; 2’, posterior commissure. 1, sulcus falcialis; 2, sulcus cruciatus; 3, sulcus splenialis; 4, sulcus marginalis; 5, sulcus supracallosalis (or callosalis). ends of the thalami (Fig. 141), and extends ventrad into the tuber cinereum, and thence into the infundibulum (Fig. 143, g’). Dorsad it extends into the corpus pineale (Fig. 143, 7). The third ventricle communicates caudally near its dorsal border with the aqueductus cerebri (7); craniclaterally with the lateral ventricles, through the interventricular foramen 5 THE CENTRAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 357 (foramen of Monroe). Its cranial boundary forms in the middle line a thin plate, the lamina terminalis (d ), which is, morpho- logically, the cranial termination of the cerebrospinal axis; it lies at the bottom of the deep fissure between the cerebral hemispheres. At the dorsal border of the lamina terminalis is a strong transverse band of fibres connecting the two sides of the brain; this is the anterior commissure (c). The cavity of the third ventricle is much encroached upon by the meeting and secondary union of the two thalami across the middle line, forming the massa intermedia (/). The boundaries of the third ventricle, in order, are as fol- lows, beginning dorsocraniad of the communication with the aqueductus cerebri: the posterior commissure (Fig. 143, 2’), the pineal body (y), the choroid plexus of the third ventricle (w), the columns of the fornix (v), the anterior commissure (c), the lamina terminalis (d), the tuber cinereum with the infundibulum (g’), the substantia perforata posterior, and the midbrain. The lateral boundaries are formed by the thalami (Fig. 141, 2). 5. TLelencephalon.—The telencephalon includes the two cerebral hemispheres. The name cerebrum is also applied to this portion of the brain; frequently, however, the name cere- brum is used as signifying the entire mass of the brain craniad of the rhombencephalon,—therefore including mesencephalon, diencephalon, and telencephalon. The term will here be used as synonymous with telencephalon. The cerebral hemispheres arise as two lateral outgrowths from the cranial end of the primitive forebrain. They have undergone great increase in size in the course of evolution, so as to form the larger part of the brain; at the same time important modifications of structure have taken place. In the original condition the medial faces of the two hemispheres are not connected, the two being separate outgrowths of the *tween-brain, and connected only through the latter. But secondary connections have been formed across the fissure between the two hemispheres, resulting in the production of the corpus callosum (Fig. 143, £; Fig. 147; Figs. 149-152, a), a broad transverse band of white fibres connecting the two 358 NERVOUS SYSTEM. hemispheres dorsad of the ‘tween-brain. Ventrad of the corpus callosum another secondary union has resulted in the produc- tion of the fornix (Fig. 143, 2). Fic. 144.—LATERAL SURFACE OF THE BRAIN. a, olfactory bulb; 4, cerebral hemisphere; ¢, cerebellum; @, medulla oblongata; é, tractus olfactorius; 7, lobus pyriformis or tractus postrhinalis; g, pons; %, trape- zium; 2, pyramid; 7, area elliptica; %, area ovalis. //, N. opticus; V, N. trigemi- nus; V//, N. facialis; VZ//, N. acusticus; ZX, N. glossopharyngeus; X, N. vagus; X/, N. accessorius. I, sulcus preesylvius; 2, sulcus cruciatus; 3, sulcus ansatus; 4, sulcus lateralis; 5, sulcus suprasylvius; 6, sulcus anterior; 7, sulcus posterior; 8, sulcus rhinalis; 9, fissura Sylvii; 10, sulcus rhinalis posterior. External Features.—With increase in size the mass of the cerebrum shows externally a tendency to divide into three lobes, one craniad, the frontal (Fig. 145, 4); one caudoven- trad, the temporal (/); and one caudodorsad, the occipi- tal (C). The two latter are not distinctly marked off from one another. The limit between the temporal and frontal lobes is marked by a short deep fissure, the lateral fissure (fissura cerebri lateralis), or fissure of Sylvius (Fig. 144, 9; Fig. 145, @). Each lobe is thrown up into elevations or gyri, which are separated by grooves or Sulci; these are described below. The homology of the cerebral gyri and sulci of the cat with those of man is in most cases uncertain. The sulci and gyri of the cerebral hemispheres may be described briefly in their main features as follows: On the lateral surface of the hemisphere (Fig. 145) the lateral fissure (fissura cerebri lateralis), or fissure of Sylvius, separating temporal and frontal lobes, forms the most convenient point of departure for an understanding of the fissures. The fissure THE CENTRAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 359 of Sylvius is short but deep, and is formed eariy during development. In man it covers an area, the insula, at its bottom, which may be seen by separating the sides of the fissure. In the cat the insula is rudimentary and can be demonstrated only with difficulty. The lateral surface of the hemisphere is marked by fissures which form three concentric arches (d-c, d, and e), irregular and incomplete, about the fissure of Sylvius. These arches all open ventrad. The first arch (d—c) (that next to the fissure of Sylvius) lacks the central part, the keystone, so that a com- Fic. 145.—DIAGRAM OF THE SULCI AND GYRI ON THE LATERAL SURFACE OF THE HEMISPHERE. A, frontal lobe; 4, temporal lobe; C, occipital lobe. a, lateral fissure or fissure of Sylvius; 4, sulcus anterior; c, sulcus posterior (the broken line connecting the ends of @ and 4 serves to show how the first arch is completed to form the ectosylvian sulcus, as in the dog ; @, sulcus suprasylvius; ¢, sulcus lateralis; /, sulcus cruciatus; g, sulcus coronalis; 4, sulcus ansatus; 7, sulcus rhinalis; 7, sulcus preesylvius; 4, sulcus rhinalis posterior. I, anterior Sylvian gyrus; 2, posterior Sylvian gyrus; 3, gyrus ectosylvius; 4, gyrus suprasylvius; 5, gyrus marginalis; 6, gyrus compositus posterior; 7, sigmoid gyrus; 8, olfactory tract; 9, orbital gyrus; 10, lobus pyriformis; 11, olfactory bulb. plete arch is not formed, but only the two sides of the arch, as two separate sulci (6 and c). The one of these craniad of the fissure of Sylvius is the sulcus anterior (4); the other is the sulcus posterior (c). In the dog this arch is usually complete and the sulcus forming it is frequently known as the ectosylvian sulcus (sulcus ectosylvius). The gyri included between the fissure of Sylvius on the one hand and the anterior and posterior sulci on the other are known as the anterior (1) and posterior (2) Sylvian gyri. The second arch is formed by the suprasylvian sulcus (sulcus suprasylvius) (7). The gyrus between the anterior and posterior sulci ventrad and the suprasylvian sulcus dorsad 360 NERVOUS SYSTEM. is the ectosylvian gyrus (3) (because dorsad of the ectosylvian sulcus). The third arched sulcus, next to the medial margin of the hemisphere, is variable: it forms the lateral sulcus (¢). The gyrus lying between the suprasylvian and lateral sulci is the suprasylvian gyrus (4) (because dorsad of the suprasylvian sulcus). The lateral sulcus is sometimes broken into two (as in Fig. 137, 2), the two ends overlapping so as to leave a small gyrus between the two ends. The gyrus dorsomediad of the lateral sulcus, extending onto the medial surface of the hemisphere as far as the splenial sulcus, is the marginal gyrus (5). The four sets of gyri included between these three sets of arched sulci and the fissure of Sylvius unite caudad and craniad to form single gyri. The caudal one is the gyrus compositus posterior (6). The cranial one (less regular than the caudal one) is the sigmoid gyrus (7). The latter curves about the cruciate sulcus (/) (described below). In the cranial part of the lateral surface of the hemisphere are certain sulci and gyri which do not belong to the system above described. The cruciate sulcus (/) is a short transverse sulcus passing from the lateral surface of the hemisphere onto its medial surface, where it extends caudad about a centimeter. Curving around the lateral end of this, separated from it by part of the sigmoid gyrus, is the short coronal sulcus (,). Connected usually with the end of the lateral sulcus (e) and running nearly parallel with the cruciate sulcus is the short sulcus ansatus (/). At its ventral end the fissure of Sylvius (a) joins a longi- tudinal groove passing craniad and caudad from the point of junction. That part which passes craniad is the sulcus rhinalis (2); it forms the dorsolateral boundary of the olfactory tract (8). Passing dorsocraniad from the sulcus rhinalis is a sulcus which separates a very small cranial lobe from the rest of the hemisphere; this is the supraorbital or presylvian sulcus (7). The portion of the hemisphere craniad of this sulcus is the orbital gyrus (9). The sulcus rhinalis (Z) is continuous caudad with the THE CENTRAL NFRVOUS SYSTEM. 361 sulcus rhinalis posterior (or sulcus postrhinalis) (#). This extends caudad onto that portion of the hemisphere which faces the cerebeilum. It forms the lateral boundary of a large elon- gated oval lobe lying at the side of the ventral floor of the midbrain and ’tween-brain. This lobe has been called tractus postrhinalis or lobus pyriformis (Fig. 145, 10; Fig. 138, /). In addition to the sulci and gyri above mentioned, any given specimen will usually show a number. of small inconstant sulci and gyri in various regions; these inconstant structures will not be here described. On the medial surface of the hemisphere (Fig. 146), the following arrangement of sulci and gyri seems to be typical. Some distance from the dorsal margin a long sulcus runs parallel with the margin; this is the sulcus splenialis (ca). The marginal gyrus (1) is dorsad of the splenial sulcus, pass- ing onto the lateral surface of the hemisphere, where it is Fic. 146.—DIAGRAM OF THE SULCI AND GYRI ON THE MEDIAL SURFACE OF THE HEMISPHERE. a, sulcus splenialis; 4, sulcus marginalis; c, sulcus cruciatus; d@, sulcus falcialis; ¢, sulcus supracallosalis; f, sulcus rhinalis posterior; g, hippocampal sulcus; 4, corpus callosum. I, gyrus marginalis; 2, gyrus fornicatus; 3, gyrus compositus posterior. bounded by the lateral sulcus. The splenial sulcus extends onto the caudal surface of the hemisphere. A shallow sulcus marginalis (4) occurs frequently between the sulcus splenialis and the dorsal margin of the hemisphere. Cranioventrad ot the cranial end of the splenial sulcus is that portion of the sulcus cruciatus (c) that lies on the medial surface of the hemisphere. Ventrad of this is a short shallow furrow which has been called the sulcus falcialis (@). Immediately dorsad of the corpus callosum (/), separating its dorsal surface from a part of the hemisphere, is the 362 NERVOUS SYSTEM. supracallosal or callosal sulcus (e). Between the supracal- losal (¢) and splenial (a) sulci is the gyrus fornicatus (2). On the caudal surface of the hemisphere (that facing the cerebellum) appear the ends of the sulcus splenialis (a) and the sulcus rhinalis posterior (/). Hidden in the natural condition by the thalami and optic tract is the broad hippocampal sulcus (g), marking externally the course of the hippocampus. A further extension of the surface of the cerebrum has taken place in connection with the sense of smell. A mass of gray matter, the olfactory bulb (Fig. 144, a), reckoned as a part of the cerebrum, is separated from the latter and lies against the cribriform plate of the ethmoid bone. From it the olfactory fibres pass through the perforations of the plate to the olfactory mucous membrane. The olfactory bulb contains a cavity, a part of the lateral ventricle. The bulb lies against the ventral surface of the frontal lobe and projects craniad of it. It is connected to the cerebrum by a tract of fibres, the olfactory tract (Fig. 138, @), which is divisible into two roots, medial and lateral. The medial root comes from the medial surface of the frontal lobe, where it is continuous with a tract extending to the cranial end of the corpus callosum. The lateral root is traceable from an elevated gyrus-like portion of the cerebrum which lies at the side of the infundibulum and is known as the lobus pyriformis or tractus postrhinalis (Fig. 138, 7). The lateral root is divisible into a medial white strand and a lateral gray strand. That part of the brain comprising the olfactory bulb and the parts intimately related to it are frequently included under the term rhinencephalon. In the triangular area between the two olfactory tracts and craniad of the optic chiasma appears a mass of gray matter, subdivided by a longitudinal fissure. This possesses numerous openings through which blood-vessels pass to the brain sub- stance, and is thence known as the anterior perforated sub- stance (substantia perforata anterior) (Fig. 138, 0). Internal Structures of the Cerebrum.—tThe cavity of each of the cerebral hemispheres is known as a lateral ventricle. The two lateral ventricles constitute the first and second of the THE CENTRAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 363 ventricles of the brain, whence the application of the names third and fourth ventricles to the cavities of the ’tween-brain and hindbrain. ‘lhe lateral ventricles do not grow at the same rate as the walls of the hemispheres, so that they remain com- paratively small. The cavity of each ventricle is further reduced in size by the development on its floor of a large ridge-like thickening, the corpus striatum (Fig. 148, /). The dorsal wall or roof of the lateral ventricle joins the thin roof of the third ventricle on each side along an oblique curved line (Fig. 141, 1) which follows the cranial or lateral border of the thalamus (Fig. 141, #7). Along this line the thin roof of the brain is folded in together with the pia mater to form the choroid plexus of the lateral ventricles (lamina chorioidea epithelialis) (Fig. 148, ¢). When this is pulled out there is left a fissure, the ‘“great transverse fissure of the cerebrum ’’ (Fig. 141, 1). Just dorsad of the groove between the thalami there runs a tract of white fibres known as the fornix (Fig. 148, a). The two halves of the fornix separate at the cranial ends of the tha- lami and pass ventrad, forming thus the pillars of the fornix (Fig. 148, 4; Fig. 143, v). Dorsad of the cranial end of the fornix the corpus callosum (Fig. 143, /) passes from one hemisphere to the other. Caudad of the pillars of the fornix, the lateral ventricles communicate with the third ventricle by way of the interven- tricular foramen (foramen of Monroe). The parts of the cerebrum may now be taken up in detail. The corpus callosum (Fig. 147; Fig. 143, ~; Figs. 149-152, @) is a broad transverse band of fibres forming a secondary connection between the medial walls of the two hemispheres, dorsad of ventricle. Fic. 147. — THE Corpus CALLOSUM. The dorsal portion of the hemispheres has been dis- sected away, then sliced off, showing the plate of trans- verse fibres forming the corpus callosum. a, spleni- um; 4, genu; ¢, line marking the medial edge of the hemi- spheres; d, line marking the lateral boundary of the supra- callosal sulcus; laterad of this line the corpus callosum lies in the substance of the hemispheres, which have been dissected away; ¢, line marking medial limit of cut surface. the roof of the third Its outer surface (Fig. 147) is exposed at the bottom of the fissure which separates the hemispheres. On 364 NERVOUS SYSTEM. each side it passes laterad, forming the roof of the lateral ventricle. Its cranial part lies dorsad of the corpus striatum, and its caudal part dorsad of the thalamus. Laterally its fibres radiate into the substance of the hemispheres. At its cranial end the corpus callosum bends ventrad and then caudad (Fig. 143). The part which turns to pass ventrad is the genu (Fig. 143, 7) or knee, while the part which projects caudad is the rostrum (7). The caudal border of the corpus callosum is also thickened and turned ventrad and is called the splenium (Fig. 143, 5); it lies dorsad of the cranial corpora quadrigemina (z). Fic. 148.—ForN1Ix, HIPPOCAMPUS, AND Corpus STRIATUM. The dorsal portion of the hemispheres has been dissected away and the corpus callosum removed. a, fornix; 4, columns or pillars of the fornix; c, crura of the fornix; @, hippocampus; e, choroid plexus of the lateral ventricles overlying the fim- bria (the choroid plexus shows an artery), /, corpus striatum; g, corpora quadri- gemina; 4, position of the interventricular foramen (foramen of Monroe). The caudal half of the ventral surface of the corpus callosum is united with the fornix (Fig. 143, 2). The fornix (Fig. 148, a; Fig. 143, u, v; Figs. 150-152, 4) consists of an arched tract of longitudinal fibres near the medial border of each hemisphere, ventrad of the corpus callosum. Each tract begins in the mammillary bodies, and passes dorsad, the two converging until they run side by side, forming a cylindrical dorsoventral bundle known as the columns or pillars THE CENTRAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 365 of the fornix (Fig. 143, v; Fig. 150, ¢), which cross the anterior commissure, (Fig. 143, c; Fig. 150, /) caudad of the latter. Caudad of the pillars of the fornix, between these and the thalamus, lies on each side the interventricular foramen or foramen of Monroe, a small opening which connects the lateral ventricles with the third ventricle. Dorsad of the foramen the fornix turns caudad, the two fibre-tracts of each hemisphere lying side by side and closely connected (Fig. 148, a), forming thus another secondary union between the medial surfaces of the two hemispheres. This portion of the fornix is the corpus or body (Fig. 148, a); it lies dorsad of the roof of the third ventricle and passes to the splenium (Fig. 143, s) of the corpus callosum, and its dorsal surface unites with the ventral surface of the latter (Fig. 143). Caudad the two halves of the fornix diverge, forming the crura of the fornix (Fig. 148, c); these and the body are continuous laterally with the hippocampus (Fig. 148, @) and the fimbria (Fig. 148, beneath ¢). The anterior commissure (Fig. 143, c; Fig. 150, f) is a transverse band of white fibres which stretches from one hemi- sphere to the other about half way between the interventricular foramen or foramen of Monroe and the floor of the third ven- tricle, and just craniad of the pillars of the fornix. This tract of fibres is developed in the original wall of the third ventricle, so that it does not form a secondary connection between the halves of the cerebrum, as do the fornix and corpus callosum. It lies dorsad of the lamina terminalis (Fig. 143, @) and is continuous with it. The septum pellucidum (Fig. 143, 7) isa vertical partition which separates the lateral ventricles and fills the interval between the corpus callosum dorsad and the fornix ventrad. It is triangular and translucent. It is formed from the medial walls of the two hemispheres and therefore is made up of two laminze which embrace between them a space which originally was a part of the fissure separating the hemispheres. This space has been called the fifth ventricle. The hippocampus (Fig. 148, d; Fig. 152, @) is an elon- gated rounded elevation of the floor of the lateral ventricle. It is continuous mediad with the fornix (Fig. 148, @) and 366 NERVOUS SYSTEM. extends thence along the inferior horn of the lateral ventricle to its end in the temporal lobe. It is somewhat narrower at its lateral end. It is thus curved into a semicircle in conformity Fic. 149.—CAUDAL SURFACE OF Fic. 150.—CAUDAL SURFACE OF TRANSVERSE SECTION OF BRAIN TRANSVERSE SECTION OF BRAIN THROUGH THE GENU OF THE THROUGH THE OPTIC CHIASMA Corpus CALLOSUM. AND THE REGION OF THE INTER- VENTRICULAR FORAMEN (FoRA- MEN OF MONROE), Fig. 149.—Gray matter dotted; white matter with a few lines. 1, right hemi- sphere; 2, left hemisphere. @, corpus callosum, section through genu and rostrum; 6, cavity of lateral ventricles. . Fig. 150.—1, right hemisphere; 2, left hemisphere. @, corpus callosum; 4, for- nix (cut); ¢, cavity of lateral ventricles; @, fimbria (¢@’, cut surface; d, caudal uncut surface of the part that curves ventrad); ¢, pillars of fornix; 7, anterior commissure; g;, parts of thiid ventricle; 4, optic chiasma; ¢, parts of corpus striatum. Fic. 151.—CAUDAL SURFACE OF TRANSVERSE SECTION OF THE BRAIN THROUGH THE TUBER CINEREUM AND INFUNDIBULUM, CRANIAD OF THE HyPopHuysis. a, corpus callosum; 4, fornix (continuous at the sides with the hippocampus); ¢, cavity of lateral ventricles; ¢, hippocampus; ¢, choroid plexus of the third ventricle (roof of the diencephalon); /, dorsal part of cavity of the third ventricle; g, section of thalamus; #, massa intermedia of the thalami, dividing the third ventricle into a dorsal (7) and a ventral (2) portion; 7, ventral part of third ventricle; 7, part of optic tracts; 4, thin wall of infundibulum, with part of cavity of third ventricle; /, line separating roof of thalamus (diencephalon) from floor of hemispheres (telencephalon), with the inferior horn of the ventricle. Its dorsal surface is convex and looks into the lateral ventricle; its ventral surface is concave and rests upon the thalamus and the optic tract. THE CENTRAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 367 Along the craniolateral edge of the hippocampus is a broad, clearly marked fibre-tract, the fimbria; this runs parallel to the choroid plexus of the lateral ventricle and beneath it, and is continuous at its medial end with the fornix. The corpus striatum (Fig. 148, /; Fig. 141, vy; Fig. 150, 2) is a fusiform or ovoid elevation of the floor of the lateral ven- tricle. One of its narrow ends lies about opposite the middle Fic. 152. — CAUDAL SURFACE OF Fic. 153. — CAUDAL SURFACE OF TRANSVERSE SECTION OF THE TRANSVERSE SECTION OF THE BRAIN BRAIN THROUGH THE PINEAL THROUGH THE CRANIAL PAIR OF Bopy AND THALAMI. CORPORA QUADRIGEMINA. Fig, 152.—a, corpus callosum; 4, fornix; ¢, inferior horn of lateral ventricles; d, hippocampus; ¢, thalamus; /, third ventricle; g, pineal body; 4, space between the floor of the hemisphere (hippocampus) and roof of the ’tween-brain (thalamus). Fig. 153.—a, cranial corpora quadrigemina; 4, hippocampus; ¢, part of inferior horn of lateral ventricle; d, aqueductus’ cerebri (aqueduct of Sylvius); ¢, space between the outer surface of the midbrain and the lower surface of the hemisphere; J, cross-section of midbrain; g, pedunculi cerebri. of the thalamus (Fig. 141, ¢) and it extends thence obliquely mediad nearly parallel with the thalamus. In the groove between it and the thalamus is the choroid plexus of the lateral ventricles (Fig. 148, ¢). Internally the corpus striatum is made up of several layers of different texture (Fig. 150, z), whence its name. The choroid plexus of the lateral ventricles (lamina chorioidea epithelialis) (Fig. 148, ¢).—The line of junction of the roof of the third ventricle (i.e., the choroid plexus of the third ventricle) and the cerebral hemispheres is along the lateral (or cranial) border of the thalamus (Fig. 141, 2). Along this line (Fig. 141,1) the brain-wall remains very thin and becomes closely associated with the pia mater, so that on the removal of the pia there is left the ‘‘ transverse fissure ’’ which leads into the lateral ventricle. Inan early stage, before the cerebrum has grown far caudad, the fissure is exposed in 368 NERVOUS SYSTEM. dorsal view, but after the hemispheres have covered the thalami the fissure appears to be in the lower face of the hemi- sphere. Through this fissure the pia mater extends upward into the lateral ventricles as a fold separated from the ventricle by the thin brain-wall. This fold is vascular and is known as the choroid plexus of the lateral ventricle (Fig. 148, ¢). It is a fringe-like fold lying on the fimbria and extending from the foramen of Monroe (at #) nearly to the end of the inferior horn of the lateral ventricle. The lateral ventricles are the extensions into the hemi- spheres of the originally unpaired cavity of the forebrain. Each consists of a portion parallel to the basis cranii and lying at the side of the septum pellucidum between the corpus cal- losum dorsad and the corpus striatum, hippocampus, and fornix ventrad, and of two horns, an anterior and an inferior horn. The inferior horn (Fig. 152, c) is a narrow cleft, crescent- shaped in cross-section, which follows the dorsal surface of the hippocampus (Fig. 148, d; Fig. 152, d@) along the temporal lobe to its end almost against the tuber cinereum. It thus passes first caudad and then ventrad and finally mediad. The choroid plexus and hippocampus project into it from its floor. The anterior horn extends ventrad and then slightly caudad in the frontal lobe, following the corpus striatum (Fig. 148, /), on which it lies. The interventricular foramen (or foramen of Monroe).— If the choroid plexus of the lateral ventricle (Fig. 148, e) is followed to its medial end, it is found to pass through a foramen (at “) in which it becomes continuous with the opposite plexus or roof of the third ventricle. This foramen leads from one lateral ventricle to the other and is connected ventrally by a median opening with the third ventricle. It is thus Y-shaped or T-shaped and is the interventricular foramen (or foramen of Monroe). The foramen lies opposite the middle of the corpus striatum and caudad of the pillars of the fornix. Membranes of the Brain.—The membranes of the brain are the dura mater, the arachnoid, and the pia mater. The dura mater is a strong fibrous membrane lining the cranial cavity and covering the brain. It is strongly attached THE PERIPHERAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 369 to the projections of the base of the skull and to the tentorium. It dips between the cerebral hemispheres and olfactory bulbs, forming the falx cerebri. It likewise dips between the cere- brum and the cerebellum, covering both surfaces of the bony tentorium. The dura mater does not pass into the fissures or sulci of the surface of the brain. It becomes continuous with the sheath of the cranial nerves as they leave the skull. It is continuous with the dura mater of the spinal cord. The arachnoid and pia mater are essentially similar to the same structures on the spinal cord. The pia mater dips into the fissures and sulci of the brain. II. THE PERIPHERAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 1. Cranial Nerves. Nervi cerebrales.—I. N. OLFAC- TORIUS.—The fasciculi of the olfactory nerves arise from the olfactory bulb (Fig. 144, a) and pass through the foramina of the cribriform plate, upon which the bulb lies, to be distributed to the olfactory mucous membrane of the nose. II. N. opricus.—The second nerve or optic (Fig. 138, //) arises from the optic chiasma (Fig. 138, c), passes through the optic foramen, and extends in an S-shaped curve to the eyeball. Its course is craniodorsad. It pierces the sclerotic and choroid coats of the eye and spreads out into the retina. Ill. N. OcULOMOTORIUS.—The third or oculomotor nerve arises (Fig. 138, ///) from the pedunculus cerebri and passes into the orbit through the orbital fissure. It passes between the lateral and superior recti, sends a large branch to the superior rectus, supplies the medial rectus and the retractor oculi, passes laterad of the optic nerve and supplies the inferior rectus, and sends a long branch to the inferior oblique (Fig. 166, f). At the point where the branch is given off to the inferior oblique muscle is the triangular reddish ciliary (or ophthalmic) ganglion, about two milliméters in diameter. It is directly attached to the inferior oblique branch of the third nerve and receives a delicate sensory filament from the ophthalmic nerve. From the ciliary ganglion proceed two BD had NERVOUS SYSTEM. short ciliary nerves which pass along each side of the optic nerve to the eyeball. These nerves penetrate the sclerotic at the sides of the eyeball to be distributed to the ball. IV. N. TROCHLEARIS.—The fourth nerve, the trochlearis (or patheticus), arises from the lateral border of the velum medullare anterius, as already described (Fig. 141, ). It passes craniad, emerges through the orbital fissure in company with the oculomotor, abducens, and ophthalmic, passes dorsad of the superior rectus muscle, and reaches (Fig. 154, /) the caudal border of the belly of the superior oblique muscle near its middle. It supplies only the superior oblique. V. N. TRIGEMINUS.—The fifth nerve, the trigeminus (or trifacial) arises (Fig. 138, V) by two roots, a large sensory and a small motor root (4), as already described (p. 347). One of these, the motor (4), is smaller and more ventral; the other, the sensory root, is larger and dorsal. - The dorsal root soon enlarges to form a large ganglion, the semilunar (or Gasserian) ganglion (Fig. 138, £), from which three branches diverge. One branch is joined by the ventral root (4), which passes over the ventral surface of the semilunar ganglion; and the nerve thus formed is the mandibular division (1) of the fifth nerve. Of the other two branches from the ganglion, the middle and longest is the maxillary nerve (2), and the smallest is the ophthalmic (3). The mandibular nerve is thus mixed, motor and sensory, while the others are sensory. 1. N. ophthalmicus.—The ophthalmic or first division of the fifth nerve arises from the semilunar (or Gasserian) gan- glion. It passes out of the cranial cavity and into the orbit by way of the orbital fissure, in company with the third, fourth, and sixth nerves and with the extension of the carotid (arterial) plexus. It passes between the superior and medial recti along with the third nerve, crosses dorsad of the optic nerve,.and divides into infratrochlear and ethmoidal branches. In the orbital fissure it gives off the frontal nerve, and while crossing the optic it gives off the long ciliary nerve. a. N.-frontalis.—The frontal nerve passes along the lateral border of the superior oblique muscle and then laterad of the THE PERIPHERAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 37 pulley to near the middle of the supraorbital crest of the frontal bone. Here it passes out of the orbit and is distributed to the integument of the upper eyelid and the adjacent region at the side of the nose. 6. N. infratrochlearis.—The infratrochlear nerve passes between the superior rectus and the superior oblique in the first part of its course. It then passes ventrad of the superior oblique and ventrad of the pulley to be distributed to the in- tegument of the upper eyelid near the inner angle. c. N. ethmoidalis.—The ethmoidal nerve passes along with the ethmoidal artery through the ethmoidal foramen (or foramina) in the orbital plate of the frontal bone. It is finally distributed to the mucosa of the nose and to the cartilage and integument of the snout. d. N. ciliaris longus.—The long ciliary nerve arises from the ophthalmic and passes along the optic nerve to be dis- tributed to the eyeball. It divides into several branchés before penetrating the sclerotic. One or two small communicating branches to the ciliary ganglion are given off at about the same point as the long ciliary nerve. (For a description of this ganglion see the - account of the oculomotor nerve, page 369.) 2. N. maxillaris.—The maxillary nerve, the second divi- sion of N. trigeminus, rises from the semilunar (Gasserian) ganglion and leaves the skull by the foramen rotundum. It is the sensory nerve of the palate, upper teeth and upper lip, and of part of the forehead and cheek. On leaving the foramen the maxillary nerve divides into three branches, the two infraorbital nerves (Fig. 154, f) and the sphenopalatine (Fig. 154, g). Two smaller branches are _ likewise given off either within or just outside of the foramen, the lachrymal nerve (Fig. 154, 7) and the zygomatic (sub- cutaneus male) (Fig. 154, 2). a. N. lachrymalis (Fig. 154, 7; Fig. 155, ).—The lachrymal nerve passes along the periorbita to the lachrymal gland (Fig. 154, 11), to which it gives branches. It then con- tinues caudad of the zygomatic process of the temporal to the integument; here it turns caudad and is distributed to the integ- 372 NERVOUS SYSTEM. ument in the region between the eye and the external ear (Fig. 155, #). It anastomoses with the zygomatic branch of the seventh nerve (Fig. 155, 4%). b. N. zygomaticus (subcutaneus male) (Fig. 154, 2).— This arises with the preceding and follows it for some distance. It passes through a foramen in the frontal process of the malar bone and is distributed to the lower eyelid and adjacent integument. c. Nn. infraorbitales (Fig. 154, 7; Fig. 155, /).—The infraorbital nerves are two of nearly equal size. They pass through the orbit ventrad of the eyeball to the infraorbital canal. On their course each divides once or twice and each divides again in the infraorbital foramen, so that about eight branches emerge from the infraorbital foramen and diverge to the integument and whiskers of the upper lip and to the side and wing of the nose (Fig. 155, 7). In the infraorbital canal, and before reaching it, branches are given to the molar teeth, and a branch continues in the bone to the canine, incisor, and premolar teeth. d. N. sphenopalatinus (Fig. 154, ¢).—The sphenopala- tine nerve turns mediad from the infraorbitals, directing its course toward the sphenopalatine foramen. Before reaching this it gives off the greater palatine nerve (N. palatinus major), which enters the posterior palatine canal and passes to the hard palate. The sphenopalatine then usually divides into two branches which pass along side by side to enter the sphenopalatine ganglion. This is a large elongated triangular ganglion lying on the dorsal surface of the external pterygoid muscle, just laterad of the sphenopalatine foramen. The following nerves are connected with the sphenopala- tine ganglion: a. N. palatinus minor.—This leaves the craniolateral angle of the ganglion and passes to the soft palate. 6. N. nasalis posterior.—The posterior nasal nerve enters the nasal cavity by the sphenopalatine foramen and is dis- tributed to the mucosa of the ventral and middle parts of the nasal cavity. c. N. canalis pterygoidii (Vidian Nerve).—This is a large THE PERIPHERAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 373 nerve which leaves the caudal angle of the sphenopalatine ganglion and passes caudad. It enters the orbital fissure, lying in a groove on its ventral wall (the cranial end of this groove is sometimes converted into a canal). The groove ends caudally in a foramen which pierces the sphenoid bone between the wing and the body and lies just mediad of the foramen . rotundum. The groove and foramen constitute the pterygoid canal (from which the nerve is named). After emerging from the pterygoid canal onto the ventral surface of the basisphenoid the nerve enters the tympanic bulla along with the Eustachian tube, lying on the medial side of the latter. Just after enter- ing, on reaching the internal carotid artery, it divides into two. One of these, N. petrosus superficialis major (p. 375), passes into the hiatus facialis of the petrous bone and joins the facial nerve. The other, N. petrosus profundus, accompanies the internal carotid artery caudad, turning therefore out of the bulla and passing caudad along its medial side; it finally joins the superior cervical ganglion of the sympathetic system. 3. N. mandibularis.—The third division of the fifth, the mandibular nerve, takes origin by a strong root from the semilunar (or Gasserian) ganglion, and receives also after separating from the ganglion the smaller ventral root (portio minor) of the fifth nerve. The root from the ganglion is sen- sory; the smaller root is motor, so that the mandibular nerve is both sensory and motor. The nerve passes through the foramen ovale, and sends off at once the following branches: a. N. auriculotemporalis (Figs. 154 and 155, ).—This passes dorsad between the cartilaginous auditory meatus and the zygomatic process of the temporal bone (Fig. 154, 2), emerges at the caudal border of the masseter muscle (Fig. 155, 2), and divides into two chief branches. One, the auric- ular branch, passes along the cranial side of the external ear and is distributed to its integument. The other, the temporal branch, passes along the zygomatic arch, gives branches to the temporal muscle and to the skin, follows the zygomatic arch almost to the angle of the mouth, and anastomoses with the superior buccal branch of the facial (Fig. 155, 2). 374 NERVOUS SYSTEM. 6. N. temporalis profundus.—One or more large branches passing mediad of the zygomatic arch to the temporal muscle. c. N. massetericus.—The masseteric nerve passes dorso- craniad to the masseter muscle. d. N. pterygoideus.—One or more pterygoid branches pass to the pterygoid muscles. A small twig from the nerve to the internal pterygoid passes into the tympanic cavity and supplies the tensor tympani muscle. e. N. buccinatorius (Fig. 154, ¢).—This passes craniad along the dorsolateral surface of the pterygoid muscles (Fig. 154, 8) to the angle of the mouth. Here it divides into branches to the masseter muscle, the mucosa of the mouth, and to the lips. or Fic. 154.—DISSECTION SHOWING A NUMBER OF THE CRANIAL NERVES. The mandible and zygomatic arch have been cut and removed; the temporal and internal pterygoid muscles are also removed. a, N. hypoglossus; 4, N. lingualis; ¢, N. chorda tympani; d@, N, alveolaris inferior (cut); e, N. buccinatorius: 7, Nn. infraorbitales; g, N. sphenopalatinus; 4, branch of N. oculomotorius; z, N. zygo- maticus; 7, N. lachrymalis; £, N. abducens; ¢, N. trochlearis; , N. frontalis; 2, N. auriculotemporalis. 1, cut end of zygomatic process of temporal; 2, tympanic bulla; 3, M. digastricus; 4, M. constrictor pharyngis medius; 5, M. hyoglossus; 6, M. genioglossus; 7, M. geniohyoideus; 8, M. pterygoideus externus (cut); 9, cut cranial end of zygomatic arch; 10, mandible (cut); 11, lachrymal gland. After giving off the above branches the mandibular nerve passes three or four millimeters laterad along the root of the zygomatic process of the temporal bone, and divides into two large branches, the inferior alveolar (or dental) nerve (@) and the lingual nerve (4). THE PERIPHERAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 375 jf. N. alveolaris inferior (Fig. 154, @).— This passes toward the mandibular foramen, but before reaching it gives off a branch to the mylohyoid and digastric muscles. It then enters the foramen, passes through the mandibular canal, and gives numerous inferior dental branches to the teeth. At the mental foramen (or foramina) it passes out of the canal and divides into several mental nerves, to the chin, lower lip, and mucosa of the lower jaw. g. N. lingualis (Fig. 154, 4).—The lingual nerve passes between the internal and external pterygoid muscles, and two or three millimeters from its origin it receives the chorda tym- pani nerve (c), a communicating branch from the facial (see page 376). It passes onto the ventral surface of the external pterygoid, thence onto the side of the tongue, beneath the mylohyoid. On the side of the tongue it divides into branches which enter the tongue and are distributed to its mucous mem- brane. One branch passes to the mucosa of the pharynx. Just before entering the tongue a branch is given off to the sublingual and submaxillary glands. . VI. N. ABDUCENS.—The sixth nerve, the abducens, arises from the medulla, as already described (Fig. 138, V/, and page 347). It passes into the orbit through the orbital fissure, then extends obliquely cranioventrad along the medial surface of the lateral rectus muscle (Fig. 154, 4). At about the middle of the length of the muscle it divides into two or three branches which enter at once into the lateral rectus and supply it. VII. N. FACIALIS (Fig. 155).—The seventh or facial nerve arises from the trapezium at the caudal margin of the pons, craniad of the origin of the eighth nerve, as described in the account of the brain (Fig. 138, V//). It passes into the internal auditory meatus, traverses the facial canal through the petrous bone, and emerges at the stylomastoid foramen. Within the facial canal the nerve bears an enlargement, the ganglion geniculi. It gives off within the canal a branch to the stapedius muscle, and the superficial petrosal and chorda tympani nerves. The superficial petrosal (N. petrosus superficialis major) nerve passes into the hiatus facialis, through the canal which 376 NERVOUS SYSTEM. forms its continuation, and joins the sphenopalatine ganglion (p. 373). The chorda tympani is given off two or three millimeters before the emergence of the facial at the stylomastoid foramen. It passes into the tympanic cavity, extends across it between Fic. 155.—SUPERFICIAL NERVES OF THE FACE. a, N. facialis; 6, branch to digastric; c, N. auricularis posterior; d, branch to inside of ear; ¢, ventral ramus; /, dorsal ramus; g, temporal nerve; 4, zygomatic nerve; z, nerve to stylohyoid muscle; 7, inferior buccal nerve; 4, superior buccal nerve; /, infraorbital branches of fifth nerve; m, lachrymal branches of fifth nerve; m, auriculotemporal branches of fifth nerve. 1, M. digastricus; 2, M. stylohyoideus; 3, M. masseter. the malleus and incus, passing close against the tensor tympani muscle, and leaves it (by a small cleft, the canal of Huguier) between the bulla and the squamous portion of the temporal. It then passes craniad (Fig. 154, c), ventrad of the root of the THE PERIPHERAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 377° zygomatic process of the temporal, and joins the lingual nerve (Fig. 154, 4) (branch of the third division of the fifth nerve). On emerging from the stylomastoid foramen the facial nerve (Fig. 155, @) gives off at once a small branch (0) to the digastric muscle (1), and a larger branch, N. auricularis posterior (c), which passes dorsocaudad about the base of the ear, supplying some of its muscles. Another small branch (d@) pierces the cartilaginous external ear and is distributed to its inner surface. The facial nerve then curves craniad about the proximal part of the cartilaginous external ear, and divides five or six millimeters from its emergence into two main branches, which may be designated as the dorsal (/) and ventral (e) rami. A third small branch may also rise from the point of union of the two; it is usually, however, a’ twig from the dor- sal ramus, and passes to M. submentalis. The dorsal ramus (/) sends two or three small branches to the cheek (including the one just mentioned), and divides into the temporal (¢) and the zygomatic (Z) branches. The former (g) passes along the cranial margin of the external ear, supplying the superficial muscles, and extends into the tem- poral region, where it lies deeper than the terminal branches of the lachrymal nerve (m) (from the fifth cranial). The _ zygomatic branch (%) passes across the malar bone to the caudal angle of the eye, sends branches into both eyelids, anastomoses with twigs from the lachrymal branch (wv) of the fifth nerve, and passes along the medial side of the eye to the lateral surface of the nose, where it ramifies. The ventral ramus (¢) gives off a minute branch (z) to the stylohyoid muscle (2), then proceeds toward the angle of the mouth and divides into superior (4) and inferior (7) buccal branches, the former to the muscles of the upper lip and the contiguous regions, the latter to those of the lower lip and chin. The seventh nerve thus supplies most of the muscles of the head except those of mastication, and of these it supplies the digastric. : VIII. N. acusticus.—The eighth or auditory nerve takes origin (Fig. 138, VZ//) from the floor of the fourth ventricle, 378 NERVOUS SYSTEM. as before described (page 347). It passes into the internal auditory meatus and is distributed to the internal ear within the petrous bone. IX. N. GLOSSOPHARYNGEUS (Fig. 156, a).—The ninth or glossopharyngeal nerve takes origin (Fig. 138, 7X) from the side of the medulla, as described in the account of the brain. Close to its origin its trunk bears a small enlargement, the ganglion superius. It passes along with the tenth and eleventh nerves through the jugular foramen. At its exit it has a ganglionic enlargement, the ganglion petrosum; this is © connected by fine fibres with the ganglion nodosum (Fig. 156, ad) of the vagus. The glossopharyngeal (Fig. 156, @) then passes craniad over the surface of the tympanic bulla (15) and mediad of the digastric muscle. It continues mediad of the carotid artery, and as it approaches the cranial cornu of the. hyoid divides into two portions, one of which passes to the muscles and mucosa of the pharynx, and the other to the tongue, where it is the special nerve of taste. X. N. vAGUS.—The vagus nerve arises from the side of the medulla in the manner described under the Brain (page 346 and Fig. 138, X). It passes through the jugular foramen along with the glossopharyngeal and accessory nerves. Cervical Portion of the Vagus (Fig. 156, d, d’).—In the foramen, or just before entering it, it presents a ganglionic enlargement, the ganglion jugulare (or ‘‘ganglion of the root’’), and a short distance beyond the foramen it forms a second ganglion, the ganglion nodosum (7) (or ‘‘ ganglion of the trunk ’’), which lies dorsocaudad of the superior cervical sympathetic ganglion (¢). The ganglia of the vagus and sym- pathetic are closely bound together by connective tissue, and that portion of the vagus craniad of the ganglion nodosum is interconnected by a network of nervous fibres with the sym- pathetic (e), hypoglossal (6), and accessory (c) nerves. From the ganglion nodosum the vagus (@’) passes caudad, closely bound up with the sympathetic; the two lie at the side of the common carotid artery. Just before entering the thorax the two separate, the vagus being the larger and lying ventrad of re a Y os ld THE PERIPHERAL NERVOUS. SYSTEM. 379 the sympathetic. (In rare cases the two are distinctly sepa- rated ‘throughout their length.) Fic. 156. — GLOSSOPHARYNGEAL, HyYPOGLOSSAL, VAGUS, SYMPATHETIC, AND First CERVICAL NERVES IN THE NECK. a, N. glossopharyngeus; 4, N. hypoglossus; ¢, N. accessorius; @, ganglion nodo- sum of vagus nerve; @’, N. vagus; e, ganglion cervicale superius of sympathetic; f; ramus descendens of N. hypoglossus (united with first cervical); g, branch to M. thyrohyoid from ramus descendens of N. hypoglossus; 4, N. laryngeus superior of N. vagus; 2, united vagus and sympathetic nerves; 7, first cervical nerve; 4, second cervical nerve; 7, N. pharyngeus from vagus. 1, M. masseter; 2, outline of external ear; 3, M. splenius; 4, M. levator scapulze ventralis; 5, M. longus capitis; 6, trachea; 7, M. sternothyreoideus; 8, M. sternohyoideus; 9, M. thyreohyoideus; 10, M. con- strictor pharyngis inferior; 11, M. constrictor pharyngis medius; 12, cut end of M. stylohyoideus; 13, M. hyoglossus; 14, M. stylopharyngeus; 15, bulla tympani; 16, M. jugulohyoideus; 17, M. styloglossus; 18, M. mylohyoideus. Branches of the vagus in the cervical region (Fig. 156). a. N. auricularis.—This leaves the ganglion jugulare, passes into the petrous bone to the facial canal, leaves the skull with the facial nerve by the stylomastoid foramen, and is dis- tributed to the external ear. 6. N. pharyngeus (/).—This leaves the vagus craniad of the ganglion nodosum, passes ventrad, sends a small com- municating branch to N. laryngeus superior (%), and is dis- 380 NERVOUS SYSTEM. tributed to the pharyngeal muscles and cranial part of the cesophagus. c. N. laryngeus superior (%).—This arises from the gan- glion nodosum, passes ventrad, crossing the medial surface of the carotid artery, and reaches the larynx at about the level of the caudal end of M. thyreohyoideus. It passes into the larynx and supplies its mucosa. Thoracic Portion of the Vagus (Fig. 157).—As the vagus (4) and sympathetic (c) separate to enter the thorax, the vagus (4) lies more ventrad. The right vagus now lies along the lateral surface of the trachea, the left one (Fig. 157) along that of the cesophagus. At about the level of the first rib or further craniad there arise, apparently from the vagus (but really from the sympathetic), two slender nerves which pass caudad parallel and close to the vagus, lying slightly dorsad of it. These are the cardiac nerves (z); they arise from the sympathetic farther craniad in the neck region, accompany the vagus, and seem to branch from it. In cases where vagus and sympathetic are separate throughout their courses, these nerves arise clearly from the sympathetic. The cardiac nerves pass to the heart and aid in forming a network of nerves known as the cardiac plexus (). The vagus usually receives also, at about the level of the first rib, one or two communicating branches from the middle cervical ganglion (@) of the sympathetic. It then passes to the roots of the lungs, crossing the lateral surface of the aortic arch on the left side, and the medial surface of the azygos vein on the right side. As it crosses the aortic arch the left vagus gives off N. laryngeus inferior (7). This curves around the caudal side of the aortic arch to the lateral surface of the trachea (0), then extends on the lateral and ventral surface of the trachea craniad into the neck region. In the neck it passes to the dorsolateral side of the trachea and reaches the larynx. It passes into the larynx between the cricoid and thyroid carti- lages, and supplies the muscles of the larynx. It anastomoses with the superior laryngeal. The vzght inferior laryngeal nerve is given off from the right vagus much further craniad than the left; it curves around 381 THE PERIPHERAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. ‘Suny Jo oor ‘s Sqavay ‘« feyioe ‘4 isnBeydosa ‘¢ {vayovn ‘o foarou oruqouvsds woud ‘¢ ‘sndva yo youvsq [easvydosa yesiop ‘ww fapis aysoddo ay} wor yoursq rvyiuuts ‘7 {sn3va jo youvsq jeadeydoseo jeajuaa 7 ‘snxad ovipavo puv Arvuournd ‘y faasou jeasudsey zourazut ‘7! yrvay 0} sndvA YA Suoye oneypeduiss wos Surssed youvsq ovrpavo ‘2 Suorysuvs yworassd AOLIOZUL ay} Wo sayouvAG OvIpIvo ‘y fvI[suBS [woIAIId JOLayUL pus a]pprur ay) uaamyjaq ‘Araj1v UvIABpPqns ynoqe oNeyyeduuds jo dooy ‘F !aarou oruaryd {/tsaarou JwotArad YIYSIO puw “yUaAas ‘YIXIS 0} YOUBIG Sunevorunurmos ‘2 uolpsued peoiasso rowayut ‘a ‘onayyeduiks jo uorsuvs worasso oypprut ‘py fonoyyedurts “9 fsndva ‘g tonayyedurds pur sndva jo yuNy peutquios ‘y +(ynd) darouU IOBIOY) yay ‘,7 $(JNd) S9AJOU [woTAIND YDYSIO OF YY 94) ‘777-4 —74 (IND) sqlA UdaIayy oy) ‘EI-1 ‘XVUOH] GNV MOUN FHL NI SHAYAN OINAYHG ANV ‘sNOVA ‘OILAHLVAWAGS—'LSI1 ‘ol Se > ee = } JOS Ss tnpetrentttn i inl umn Kan Wy 382 NERVOUS SYSTEM. the right subclavian artery just caudad of the origin of the internal mammary artery, then passes to the trachea, and has a course and distribution like that of the left side. On reaching the root of the lungs the vagus divides into numerous branches which form the pulmonary plexus (£) over the roots of the lungs, and extends onto the basis of the heart as the cardiac plexus. From these plexuses numerous branches pass to the heart, lungs, pulmonary artery, pericar- dium, etc. The cardiac branches from the sympathetic, men- tioned above, are also connected with the cardiac plexus. Caudad of the pulmonary plexus the vagus is continued on each side as two trunks, a dorsal (wv) and a ventral (/) which pass along the cesophagus (f). The ventral branches of right and left vagi (and 7’) unite a short distance caudad of the root of the lung, and the single trunk extends into the abdominal cavity on the ventral surface of the cesophagus. The dorsal branches of right and left vagi unite farther back, near the diaphragm, and the single trunk thus formed (vz) enters the abdominal cavity on the dorsal surface of the cesophagus. Both divisions give fine nerves to the cesophagus. Abdominal Portion of the Vagus (Fig. 164, page 407).— After passing through the diaphragm the ventral division (Fig. 164, 7) reaches the lesser curvature of the stomach (1), over which it ramifies, some branches being traceable almost to the pylorus. The network of branches thus formed is the anterior gastric plexus. .Some twigs from the ventral division pass transversely across the cranial end of the stomach and join the plexus formed by the dorsal division. The dorsal division (7) of the vagus reaches the greater curvature of the stomach, where it ramifies, forming the pos- terior gastric plexus. Branches from this anastomose with the anterior gastric plexus and with the cceliac plexus of the sympathetic (¢). : XI. N. ACCESSORIUS.—The accessory (or spinal accessory) nerve arises (Fig. 138, X/) by numerous rootlets from the lateral surface of the medulla and of the spinal cord as far caudad as the fifth to seventh cervical nerve. These spinal rootlets join to form a nerve which enters the cranium through THE PERIPHERAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 383 the foramen magnum. After receiving the rootlets from the medulia, it leaves the cranial cavity along with the vagus and glossopharyngeal by the jugular foramen. Just outside the foramen (Fig. 156, c) it becomes involved in a plexus of fine branches which interconnect it with the vagus, sympathetic, and hypoglossal. It then turns laterad and caudad (Fig. 158, 1) and pierces the cleidomastoid muscle (@), to which it gives small branches. It then divides: one branch enters the sternomastoid muscle; the other passes caudad along the dorsal border of the levator scapulz ventralis, sends branches to the clavotrapezius, and may be traced to the acromiotrape- zius and spinotrapezius, which it supplies. XII. N. HypoGLOssus (Fig. 156, 6).—The twelfth or hypoglossal nerve arises from the ventral side of the medulla (Fig. 138, X//), as previously described. It emerges from the skull through the hypoglossal canal. At first it passes ventrad, then gradually turns craniad, following thus a curved - course and passing successively laterad of the vagus and sym- pathetic nerves (Fig. 156, d and e), the common carotid artery, and the cranial cornu of the hyoid bone. A short distance from its origin the nerve gives off a ramus descendens (Fig. 156, f), which receives a communicating branch from the first cervical nerve (7), and divides into two branches, one (g) to the thyrohyoid muscle (9), the other to the sternohyoid (8) and sternothyroid muscles (7). The main nerve passes beneath the mylohyoid muscle into the tongue, at first following the lingual artery, then laterad of it, then crossing it again. It sends branches to all the muscles of the tongue, and may be traced to its tip. _ The hypoglossal nerve is involved in the plexus just outside of the jugular foramen, with which the vagus, sympathetic, and accessory nerves are also connected. 2. Spinal Nerves.—The origin and general features of the spinal nerves have been described in connection with the account of the spinal cord (page 337). A description of their peripheral distribution will now be given. A. CERVICAL NERVES.—There are eight pairs of cervical nerves. The first leaves the vertebral canal through the 384 NERVOUS SYSTEM. atlantal foramen. The second passes out between the arches of the atlas and axis, not through a special intervertebral fora- men, so that its ganglion lies among the muscles .of the back of the neck. The others emerge through the intervertebral foramina, the eighth one from between the last cervical and first thoracic vertebre. Dorsal Rami (Rami posteriores).—The dorsal ramus of the first nerve (N. suboccipitalis) supplies the short dorsal muscles Uy WIZ Za ; Fic. 158.—SUPERFICIAL NERVES OF THE NECK. M. clavotrapezius has been partly removed. 1, N. accessorius; 2-4, ventral rami of second to fourth cervical nerves; 5, N. auricularis magnus; 6, N. cutaneus colli. a@, M. clavotrapezius (cut); 4, M. splenius; c, M. levator scapule ventralis; d, M. cleidomastoideus; e, M. sternomastoideus; /, parotid gland. which move the head and connect the atlas and skull. In the second nerve the dorsal ramus is much larger, forming N. occipitalis major. It sends small branches to the muscles about its origin, then turns craniad on the surface of the obliquus superior muscle, passes through the biventer cervicis and splenius, joins a small branch from the third nerve, and reaches the dorsal surface of the back of the head. It passes craniad,. lying beneath the levator auris longus, emerges from between THE PERIPHERAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 385 the two divisions of this muscle, and supplies the skin and cutaneous muscles between the two external ears. The dorsal rami of the other cervical nerves supply muscles and integu- ment on the back of the neck. Ventral Rami (rami anteriores).—These pass ventrad between the transverse processes of the vertebrz, except in the case of the first nerve (Fig. 156, 7). This passes ventrad from the atlantal foramen along the groove for the vertebral artery, through the notch in the wing of the atlas, and across the lateral surface of the longus capitis muscle (5). Here it sends a branch caudad to join the second cervical (£), then crosses the vagus (d’) and sympathetic and the carotid artery, giving off communicating branches to the vagus and sympathetic, and uniting with a branch of the descending ramus of the hypo- glossal (f/f). At the lateral surface of the larynx it turns caudad, following the lateral border of the sternothyroid muscle (7), and is distributed to the sternohyoid (8) and sterno- thyroid (7). The ventral ramus of the second nerve (Fig. 158, 2) receives a branch from that of the first nerve, passes laterad between the levator scapule ventralis (c) and the cleidomastoid (a), receives a communicating branch from the third cervical (3), sends a branch to N. accessorius (1) and numerous small nerves into the sternomastoid (e) and cleidomastoid (d@), then turns craniad and divides into N. auricularis magnus (5) and N. cutaneus colli (6). N. auricularis magnus (5), the great: auricular nerve, passes dorsocraniad across the lateral surface of the sternomas- toid (e) to the lateral and caudal surface of the external ear and parotid gland (/), where it ramifies. The cutaneus colli (6) is the smaller, ventral, division of the second nerve; it may receive also an accession from the third. It passes to the integument over the ventral part of M. masseter and ventrad of that muscle. The third nerve (Fig. 158, 3) communicates with the second and supplies the levator scapulz ventralis (c), cleidomastoid (2), sternomastoid (e), longus capitis, and other muscles of this region and aids in forming the cutaneus colli (6). The fourth 386 NERVOUS SYSTEM. (4) and fifth are distributed to the muscles and integument of the sides of the neck. A branch of the fourth supplies the in- tegument in the hollow of the shoulder, and one from the fifth follows the vena cephalica and supplies the integument over the shoulder. The fifth by sending a branch to aid in forming the phrenic nerve (Fig. 157, f) may be considered to enter partly into the brachial plexus. Owing to the intercommunicating branches between the ventral roots of the first five cervical nerves, these are some- times considered as forming a loose plexus which receives the name cervical plexus. The sixth, seventh, and eighth cervical nerves (with a part of the fifth) become interconnected with each other and with’ the first thoracic to form the brachial plexus. The Brachial Plexus (Fig. 159).—The brachial plexus is formed by the ventral rami of the fifth, sixth, seventh, and eighth cervical nerves and the first thoracic. Of the fifth cer- vical only a small part enters into the plexus, forming part of the phrenic nerve. The formation of the plexus is due to the union of. the different nerves by means of strong connecting branches or ans#. The plexus lies in the axilla, along with the axillary artery and vein; all its component nerves pass laterad in front of the first rib. Its branches supply the arm and shoulder. The precise arrangement of the different strands is. somewhat variable. The plexus is commonly made up in approximately the following manner (Fig. 159). From the fifth cervical nerve (V) a small branch joins a similar one from the sixth to form the phrenic nerve (a); the remainder of the fifth does not enter into the plexus. From the sixth cer- vical (V/) arise parts of the phrenic nerve (a), the suprascapular (4), the cranial one of the three subscapular nerves (c), the axillary (2), and the musculocutaneus (f/f). The sixth also gives off close to its origin a nerve (4’) which passes to the inner surface of the levator scapula and ramifies over the sur- face, supplying this muscle and extending to the rhomboideus, which it also innervates. The seventh cervical (V//) is the largest nerve entering into the plexus; it furnishes parts of one THE PERIPHERAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 387 or both of the anterior thoracic nerves (# and x), of the pos- terior thoracic (wz), the three subscapular nerves (c, e, and 2), the axillary (Z), musculocutaneus (/), radial (%), and median (g) nerves. The eighth cervical (V///) supplies parts of one Fic. 159.—DIAGRAM OF THE RIGHT BRACHIAL PLEXUS, V, Vl, VIl, VIZ, the fifth to eighth cervical nerves. 1, the first thoracic nerve. @, phrenic nerve; 4, suprascapular; 4’, nerve to serratus anterior and levator scapulze muscles; ¢, first or cranial subscapular nerve; d, axillary nerve; ¢, second subscapular; 7, musculocutaneous; g, median; 4, radial; z, third subscapular; 7, ulnar; Rk, second anterior thoracic; 7, medial cutaneous; , posterior thoracic; , first anterior thoracic. of the anterior thoracic nerves (#), the caudal one of the sub- scapular nerves (z), the radial (4), median (g), and ulnar (7) nerves. The first thoracic (1) curves craniad, so as to leave the thorax on the cranial side of the first rib; it supplies the median cutaneous nerve (/) and parts of the radial (4), ulnar (7), and median (g) nerves; sometimes also a part of one (4) of the anterior thoracic nerves. The following are the nerves which arise from the brachial plexus: A. Nerves of the Shoulder and Breast (Fig. 160). 1. Nn. thoracici anteriores.— There are two anterior thoracic nerves. One (Fig. 160, %, Fig. 159, ) arises from the seventh cervical and passes to the pectoral muscles (9) along with the anterior thoracic artery. The other (Fig. 159, £; Fig. 160, gand7) arises usually by two roots, one from the eighth cer- vical, one from the first thoracic; it passes along with the long thoracic artery to be distributed to the pectoralis muscles (Fig. 160, 8) and sometimes also to the latissimus dorsi (7). 388 NERVOUS SYSTEM. 2. N. thoracicus posterior.—The posterior thoracic (or long thoracic) nerve (external respiratory) (Fig. 159, #) arises from the seventh cervical nerve near its beginning. It passes within the scalenus muscle and extends caudad on the outer surface of the serratus anterior muscle, which it supplies. 3. N. suprascapularis (Figs. 159 and 160, 6).—The supra- scapular nerve arises from the sixth (and sometimes the seventh) cervical. It passes laterad and gives off a branch which passes over the shoulder-joint and penetrates the clavodeltoid muscle to be distributed to the integument on the ventral surface of the upper arm. It then follows the transversa scapule artery into the supraspinatus fossa and accompanies the artery to be distributed to the supraspinatus and infraspinatus muscles. 4. Nn. subscapulares.—The subscapular nerves are three. The cranial one (Figs. 159 and 160, c) arises from the sixth and seventh cervical and supplies the subscapular muscle. The middle one (Fig. 159, ¢) arises from the seventh; it supplies principally the teres major. The caudal one (Fig. 159, z) arises from the seventh and eighth cervical and supplies the latissi- mus dorsi. (The points of origin from the plexus vary.) 5. N. axillaris (or circumflexus) (Fig. 159, 2).—The axil- lary nerve arises from the sixth and seventh cervical nerves. It passes toward the shoulder-joint, then follows the posterior circumflex artery ventrad of the long head of the triceps to be distributed to the spinodeltoid and acromiodeltoid. A branch of it continues to the clavobrachial, which it supplies. B. The Phrenic Nerve (Fig. 157, 4, page 381). 6. N. phrenicus.—The phrenic nerve (internal respiratory) is formed by the junction of two slender branches, one from the fifth and one from the sixth cervical nerves (Fig. 159, a). (It is said to receive sometimes a branch from the fourth.) It passes caudad into the thorax on the ventral surface of the subclavian artery and then extends to the diaphragm lying at the side of the inferior and superior venze cave. It is the motor nerve of the diaphragm. C. Nerves of the Arm. 7. N. musculocutaneus (Fig. 160, @).—The musculo- cutaneous nerve or external cutaneous arises from the ventral THE PERIPHERAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 389 Fic. 160.—BLOoD-VESSELS AND THE MORE VENTRAL NERVES OF THE AXILLA, VENTRAL VIEW. The pectoral and clavobrachial muscles have been cut and laid aside, their ends being shown; only a part of the nerves are exhibited. 1, M. clavobrachialis; 2, cut end of M. pectoralis major; 3, cut end of M. pectoralis minor; 4, M. biceps; 5, M. teres major; 6, M. epitrochlearis, partly cut and turned back; 7, M. latissimus dorsi, partly cut; 8, M. pectoralis minor; 9, M. pectoralis major; 10, short portion of caput mediale of M. triceps brachii. @, branches of the thyrocervical axis to clavo- brachial and clavotrapezius muscles; 4, suprascapular nerve; ¢, first subscapular nerve; @, musculocutaneous nerve; ¢, median nerve; /, V. axillaris; g, A. axillaris; A, first anterior thoracic nerve, accompanied by the anterior thoracic artery and vein; z, V. subscapularis; 7, large muscular branch (to subscapular muscle) of the sub- scapular vein and brachial artery; 7, A. subscapularis; 2’, A. circumflexa humeri anterior; #2, radial nerve; 7, ulnar nerve; 0, medial cutaneous nerve; ~, A. tho- racica longa; g, 7, second anterior thoracic nerve; s, V. thoracica jonga; ¢, A. and V. thoracicodorsalis; w#, A. pofunda brachii; v, branch of brachial artery accom- panying medial cutaneous nerve; w, branch of A. collateralis radialis superior; x, A. collateralis radialis superior; y, V. mediana cubiti; 2, A. collateralis ulnaris. 390 NERVOUS SYSTEM. surface of the sixth and seventh nerves (Fig. 159, 7). It passes toward the shoulder-joint and supplies the biceps (Fig. 160, 4) and coracobrachialis muscles. It then passes distad, resting on the dorsal border of the biceps (4), and supplies the brachialis muscle. Thence it passes dorsad of the biceps to the lateral side, and reaches the integument by passing between the clavo- brachialis and pectoantibrachialis muscles near the elbow; it is then distributed to the skin on the radial side of the ventral sur- face of the forearm, as far as the wrist (Fig. 130, 4, page 319). 8. N. cutaneus medialis (Fig. 160, 0).—The medial (or internal) cutaneous nerve rises from the first thoracic. It passes distad along the medial side of the biceps, and at the junction of the second and third thirds of the upper arm reaches the integument by passing between the epitrochlearis and pectoantibrachialis muscles. It then curves spirally about the dorsal border of the forearm and is distributed to the integu- ment of the forearm on the ulnar side, extending nearly to the wrist. 9. N. medianus (Fig. 160, ¢).—The median nerve is formed by the junction of three branches, one each from the seventh and eighth cervical with the brachial artery (¢) passing between them, and one from the first thoracic nerve. It accompanies the brachial artery (g) lying on its medial side, and passes with it through the supracondyloid foramen; here it is connected by a branch to the musculocutaneous nerve. It passes into the forearm (Fig 161, 4), lying at first beneath the pronator teres (5). Here it gives branches to the pronator teres and flexor muscles (flexor carpi radialis, palmaris longus, five heads of the flexor profundus digitorum, but zo¢ to the flexor carpi ulnaris). Continuing along the forearm, lying on the flexor carpi radialis, it sends a posterior interosseous nerve to the pronator quadratus muscle and branches to the deep and superficial divisions of the flexor sublimis digitorum. It thus supplies the flexor and pronator muscles (except the flexor carpi ulnaris). It then passes into the palm beneath the trans- verse ligament and gives rise to three principal branches. The first of these supplies the integument of the thumb, sending a branch on either side of it; and onto the radial side of the THE PERIPHERAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 391 Fic, 161.—NERVES AND ARTERIES OF THE FOREARM, SEEN FROM THE FLEXOR SIDE. Mm. palmaris longus, flexor carpi radialis, flexor carpi ulnaris, and the third and fourth heads of M. flexor profundus digitorum have been removed; also part of: the pronator teres. 1, M. biceps; 2, conjoined tendon of M. brachialis and M. clavobrachialis; 3, short portion of caput mediale of M. triceps; 4, intermediate portion of caput mediale of M. triceps brachii; 5, cut ends of M. pronator teres; 6, M. brachioradialis; 7, M. extensor carpi radialis longus and brevis; 8, fifth head of M. flexor profundus digitorum; 9, second head of M. flexor profundus digitorum; 10, radial part of M. flexor sublimis digitorum; I1, common tendon of M. flexor profundus digitorum; 12, first head of M. flexor profundus digitorum; 13, cut origin of M. flexor carpi ulnaris, @, ulnar nerve: 4, median nerve; c, dorsal cutaneous branch of the ulnar nerve; d, palmar branch of ulnar nerve; ¢, deep palmar branch; /, superficial pa mar branch; g’, A. brachialis; g, A. radialis; 4, A. collate- ralis ulnaris superior; 7,'A. radialis recurrens; 7, A. ulnaris recurrens; 4, A. ulnaris; 2, A. interossea anteior; 2, large branch of A. radialis, joining A. ulnaris. 392 NERVOUS SYSTEM. second digit. The second passes along the contiguous sides of the second and third digits and supplies their integument. The third passes along the contiguous sides of the third and fourth digits to their integument. Each sends twigs into the trilobed pad in the palm, so that there are thus seven terminal branches in the palm. From these, branches (probably) pass to the three radial Mm. lumbricales. 10. N. radialis.—The radial (or musculospiral) nerve is formed by the junction of branches from the seventh and eighth cervical and first thoracic nerves. ‘It immediately sends branches to the epitrochlearis, long head of the triceps, and long and intermediate portions of the medial head of the triceps. It then passes between the long and intermediate portions of the medial head of the triceps, following the profunda brachii artery, and curves about the humerus to its cranial side. It supplies there the lateral head of the triceps and the anconeus, and, lying on the brachialis muscle, divides into a superficial and a deep branch. The superficial branch is the superficial radial nerve (Fig. 130, g); the deep one forms the dorsal (or pos- terior) interosseous nerve. The former is sensory and the latter motor. The superficial radial nerve (Fig. 130, g, page 319) becomes cutaneous at the junction of the second and third thirds of the upper arm, where it emerges from between the lateral head of the triceps and the brachialis muscle. It then follows the course of the vena cephalica (c) to the wrist and follows the dorsal tributary of the same vein onto the dorsum of the hand. It supplies the integument of the distal part of the ventral sur- face of the upper arm and that along the forearm. On the hand it is distributed to the dorsal surface in the same manner as the median nerve on the ventral surface, i.e. to the integu- ment of the thumb on both sides and to that of the medial side of the second digit; to that of the contiguous sides of the second and third digits and of the contiguous sides of the third and fourth digits. There are thus seven terminal branches, one for each of these regions. The dorsal interosseous nerve follows the brachialis muscle and passes onto the forearm between it and the extensor carpi THE PERIPHERAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 393 radialis longus. It supplies the supinator and extensor muscles of the forearm (brachioradialis, supinator, extensor carpi radialis longus, extensor carpi radialis brevis, extensor communis digitorum, extensor digitorum lateralis, extensor indicis, extensor brevis pollicis). The dorsal interosseous and radial nerves thus supply all the extensor muscles of the forearm and upper arm and the supinators (modified extensors). 11. N. ulnaris (Fig. 160, z).—The ulnar nerve arises from the eighth cervical and first thoracic and accompanies the brachial artery (g) and median nerve (¢) through the upper arm. It does not pass through the supracondyloid foramen, but curves over the dorsal end of the medial epicondyle of the humerus within the short division of the medial head of the triceps, and reaches the dorsal border of the forearm. In the forearm (Fig. 161, a) it lies beneath the flexor carpi ulnaris. It supplies muscular branches to the flexor carpi ulnaris and the first or ulnar head of the flexor profundus digitorum. Near the middle of the forearm it divides into two branches, dorsal cutaneous (c) and palmar (2). The dorsal cutaneous branch (c) curves about the ulnar side of the wrist to the dorsum of the hand and divides into twigs which supply the dorsal part of the ulnar side of the fifth digit and of the contiguous sides of the fourth and fifth. The palmar branch (d) sends a twig to the integument on the flexor surface of the arm near the wrist, and then divides into deep palmar (e¢) and superficial palmar (/) branches. The superficial palmar branch (/) passes into the palm and supplies the ventral portion of the integument on the ulnar side of the fifth digit, and on the contiguous sides of the fifth and fourth. The deep palmar branch (ce) passes into the palm, beneath the ligament of the pisiform bone. Just distad of the pisiform bone it curves toward the radial side and breaks up into a number of small branches which are distributed to the short ‘muscles in the palm. B. THORACIC NERVES. : Dorsal Rami.—The dorsal rami of the thoracic nerves are 394 NERVOUS SYSTEM. small and supply the muscles and integument of the back. Each gives off a branch directly dorsad to the spinal muscles, and a lateral branch which reaches the integument some dis- tance from the middle line. Ventral Rami.—The ventral ramus of the first thoracic nerve enters into the brachial plexus, as already described. The ventral rami of the other thoracic nerves form the inter- costal nerves. Each of these passes ventrolaterad, lying close to the caudal border of a rib, in company with the intercostal artery. Branches are given to the intercostal muscles, and at about the middle of the length of the rib a large lateral branch is given off, which passes to the more superficial muscles of the thoracic wall (serrati posteriores, obliquus externus, etc.), its main branches running dorsad and ventrad. The main inter- costal nerve extends ventrad to the transversus costarum and rectus abdominis, supplying these muscles. C. LUMBAR NERVES.—There are seven lumbar nerves, one passing from the vertebral canal caudad of each lumbar vertebra. Dorsal Rami.—The dorsal rami are similar to those of the thoracic region, sending one branch dorsad to the muscles of the vertebral column, another dorsolaterad to reach the integu- ment at about the lateral border of the longissimus dorsi. The dorsal rami are somewhat smaller caudad. Ventral Rami.—The last four lumbar nerves are intercon- nected to form the lumbar or lumbosacral plexus. The first three are distinct, and will therefore be described separately. The first three lumbar nerves are directed strongly caudad (as well as ventrad), so that on leaving the intervertebral fora- men they pass ventrad of the transverse process of the vertebra immediately succeeding. Each communicates with the sym- pathetic system and gives off near its origin branches to the muscles on the ventral side of the vertebre,—the first to the crus of the diaphragm, the second and third (Fig. 162, // and ITT) to the quadratus lumborum and psoas muscles. Each divides three to five centimeters from its origin into a lateral and a medial branch, the first having a more cranial, the latter a more caudal course. The first three nerves of the cat are nee ee THE PERIPHERAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 395 represented in man by the iliohypogastric and the ilioinguinal nerves. There seems no good ground for applying these names to two of the three in the cat, in preference to the third, so that we shall speak of these nerves in the cat as simply the first, second, and third lumbar nerves. 1. The first lumbar nerve arises from the intervertebral fora- men caudad of the first lumbar vertebra. Its lateral division passes between the transversus and obliquus internus muscles, then between the obliquus internus and externus. At about the middle of the abdomen it pierces the obliquus externus and is distributed to the integument of the middle of the ventral surface of the abdomen. The medial division passes between the obliquus internus and transversus, crosses the lateral divi- sion of the second (lying mediad of it), and extends to the rectus abdominis, which it supplies. 2. The second lumbar nerve (Fig. 162, @) divides, like the others, into two branches. The lateral branch pierces the muscles of the abdominal wall at the lateral border of the longissimus dorsi and passes, lying just beneath the integu- ment, ventrocaudad nearly to the pubis. It supplies the integument of the caudal half of the abdomen and of the fold between the thigh and abdomen. The medial branch passes at first almost directly caudad, lying on the medial surface of the transversus abdominis; it curves gradually ventrad, lying in the substance of the transversus, and reaches the rectus abdominis three or four centimeters craniad of the pubis. 3. The third lumbar nerve (4) is not united with the fourth, as in many animals, but remains distinct. It divides one or two centimeters from its origin. The lateral branch passes caudad to the outer surface of the abdominal muscles, and extends, lying just beneath the integument, to that portion of the abdominal wall which is partly covered by the thigh. The medial branch passes caudad on the lateral surface of the iliopsoas muscle, follows the iliolumbar artery for a short dis- tance, and gives branches to the caudal part of the transversus and rectus abdominis muscles. The Lumbar Plexus (Fig. 162).—The fourth, fifth, sixth, and seventh lumbar nerves are interconnected by short 396 NERVOUS SYSTEM. branches, forming thus the lumbar plexus. They are also connected with the sacral plexus, so that the two are often considered together as the lumbosacral plexus (Fig. 162). In some other animals the first three lumbar nerves form also a part of the plexus; but they are not connected with it in the cat. The fourth lumbar nerve forms the genitofemoral (c) and part of the lateral cutaneous (@) nerves, and is connected by a short strand with the fifth. The fifth aids in forming the lateral cutaneous (@) and femoral (/) nerves, and is connected by a short branch with the sixth. The sixth lumbar is large; it forms the major part of the femoral (/) and a large part of the obturator nerve (g), and sends a large connecting branch caudad to join the seventh and thus pass into the sacral plexus. The seventh passes caudad to join the sacral plexus and aid in forming the great sciatic nerve (Z); by its connection with the sixth it aids in forming also the obturator nerve (4). 4. N. genitofemoralis (or N. lumboinguinalis) (c, c’, c’”).— This is a direct continuation of the fourth lumbar nerve. Its medial branch (c’’) passes along the medial surface of the iliopsoas (8) and the psoas minor (9) to the external iliac artery, accompanies this, lying on the ventral surface, from its origin to the point where it gives off the profunda femoris, then accompanies the latter artery and passes onto that branch of it that spreads out under the integument of the ventral pelvic region. It crosses the spermatic cord and ramifies in the skin | of the proximal part of the medial side of the thigh. The lateral branch of the genitofemoralis (c’) pierces the psoas minor (9), appearing on its ventral surface opposite the fifth lumbar vertebra. It passes caudad on the ventral surface of this muscle, crosses the iliolumbar artery, then turns caudo- laterad, passes through the abdominal wall, and is distributed to the craniomedial surface of the thigh and to the adjacent abdominal wall. This nerve is variable in origin and in distribution. Its lateral branch is sometimes lacking. 5. N. cutaneus femoris lateralis (¢).—The lateral cuta- neous nerve arises from the connecting strand between the fourth THE PERIPHERAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 397 and fifth nerves, most of its fibres coming from the fifth. It passes caudoventrad between the iliopsoas and psoas minor and accompanies the iliolumbar. artery across the ventral surface of the iliopsoas. It pierces the abdominal wall in company with the artery and passes onto the cranial border of the thigh. Its terminal branches are distributed to the integument along with the branches of the iliolumbar artery,—supplying the lateral surface of the femur and extending as far as the knee. 6. N. femoralis (/).—The femoral is a large nerve which rises by strong roots from the fifth and sixth lumbar nerves. It gives branches to 'the iliopsoas (8) and passes through that muscle to its ventral surface. It-leaves the abdominal cavity lying on the ventral surface of the iliopsoas, and at the point where it pierces the abdominal wall it divides into three (or four) branches. One (or two) of these pass to the sartorius muscle. Another passes between the rectus femoris and vastus medialis muscles, and divides into numerous branches which supply these muscles and the vastus intermedius. The third branch of the femoral is N. saphenus or the long saphenous nerve (Fig. 127, g, page 310). This passes distad along with the femoral artery and vein, giving a few twigs to the integument. Where the long saphenous artery (/) sep- arates from the femoral artery the nerve follows the former and passes with it along the medial side of the lower leg. At the knee and in the lower leg it gives off a number of cutaneous branches, and finally divides just distad of the middle of the lower leg into two main branches. Both of these pass to the concavity of the ankle-joint and divide into fine branches, which form a sort of plexus on the ankle and dorsal surface of the foot; branches from this’can be traced almost to the toes. 7. N. obturatorius (Fig. 162, g).—The obturator nerve arises from the connecting band between the sixth and seventh nerves. It lies at first laterad, then dorsad, of the common iliac vein, and passes almost directly caudad to the cranial border of M. obturator internus (15). Here it turns sharply laterad about the pubis, and passes through the obturator foramen. It gives twigs to the obturator externus muscle, and nn == Fic. 162..THE LUMBAR AND SACRAL NERVES, AS SEEN IN A VIEW OF THE DorsAL WALL OF THE ABDOMINAL CAVITY, AFTER REMOVAL OF THE VISCERA, On the right side the iliopsoas, psoas minor, and quadratus lumborum have been removed. ‘The symphysis pubis has been split and the two parts divaricated, to show the pelvic cavity;.on the right side parts of the innominate bones and the levator ani and coccygeus muscles have been removed. //-V//, second to seventh lumbar nerves; 1-3, first to third sacral nerves. a@, second lumbar nerve; 4, lateral and medial branches of third lumbar nerve; ¢, N. genitofemoralis (c’, its lateral branch; ¢’, its medial branch); d@, N. cutaneus femoralis lateralis; ¢, muscular branch of N. femoralis; 7. N. femoralis; g, N. obturatorius; 4, N. ischiadicus or great sciatic nerve: z, N. gluteus superior; 7, N. gluteus inferior; 2, N. cutaneus femoris posterior; 7, N. pudendus; m, N. hemorrhoidalis inferior; #, part of the sympathetic (incompletely shown, merely to indicate connections with the spinal nerves); 4, M. transversus abdominis:; 5. 6, cut edges of M. obliquus internus and externus; 7, dorsal border of the diaphragm; 8, M. iliopsoas (mostly removed on the right side); 9, M. psoas minor; £0, M. pyriformis; 11, M. levator ani; 11’, M. ilio- caudalis; 12, M. flexor caudz longus; 13, M. flexor caudz brevis; 14, edge of pubic symphysis; 15, cut end of M. obturator internus; 16, cut ramus of ischium; 17, cut ramus of pubis. THE PERIPHERAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 399 divides into several branches, which innervate the adductor femoris, adductor longus, pectineus, and gracilis. D. SACRAL NERVES AND SACRAL PLEXUS (Fig. 162).— A large band passes caudad from the sixth and seventh lumbar ‘nerves to connect with the sacral nerves; this constitutes the so-called lumbosacral cord. The sacral nerves are three in number. Their dorsal rami pass dorsad out of the two pos- terior sacral foramina and the foramen caudad of the sacrum, to the muscles and skin dorsad of the sacrum. The ventral rami pass from the two anterior sacral foramina and from the fora- men between the last sacral and first caudal vertebra. The first is the largest; it joins the lumbosacral cord to form the great sciatic nerve (N. ischiadicus) (Z) and the superior (z) and inferior (7) gluteal, and sends a branch caudad to connect with the second sacral. The second and third sacral nerves are small; they unite with the connecting branch from the first to form a network from which arises the pudendus (/), cutaneus femoris posterior (#), hemorrhoidalis inferior (#), and a small branch to the great sciatic (4). The nerves arising from the sacral plexus are the following: 1. N. gluteus superior (Fig. 162, 7; Fig. 163, 7).-—The superior gluteal nerve arises from the lumbosacral cord and the first sacral nerve; it passes dorsad in the notch between sacrum and ilium, caudolaterad of the first anterior sacral foramen, curves over the dorsal border of the ilium between the gluteus medius and pyriformis muscles (Fig. 163, 7), passes between the gemellus superior (6) and gluteus minimus (5) and ventrad of the latter, and reaches the medial surface of the tensor fascize lates, which it innervates. In its course it sends branches to the gluteus medius, gluteus minimus (5), and gemellus superior. 2. N. gluteus inferior (Fig. 162, 7; Fig. 163, 7).—A small nerve from the lumbosacral cord and the first sacral nerve. It passes dorsocaudad, lying on the dorsal surface of the great sciatic nerve (Fig. 162, %). After leaving the pelvis by the great sciatic notch it divides beneath the pyriformis (Fig. 163, 7) into two branches; one goes to M. caudofemoralis (4), the other to M. gluteus maximus (3). 400 NERVOUS SYSTEM. 3. N. ischiadicus (Fig. 162, 2; Fig. 163, a).—The great sciatic nerve, the largest nerve in the body, arises from the lumbosacral cord (formed chiefly by the sixth and seventh lumbar nerves), the first sacral nerve and a small branch from the second sacral. It passes caudodorsad and leaves the pelvis by passing across the great sciatic notch, between M. pyri- formis and M. gemellus superior. It passes across the tendon of M. obturator internus (Fig. 163, 9) near the insertion, and here sends caudad a large muscular branch (4) beneath the biceps. This branch innervates the biceps, semitendinous (17) and semimembranosus (16). Other twigs in this region pass to the quadratus femoris (10) and tenuissimus. The great sciatic nerve (a) now passes across the quadratus femoris (10), adductor femoris (15), and semimembranosus (16), lying beneath the biceps femoris. It thus enters the popliteal space and ‘ap- proaches the popliteal artery and vein. Here it gives off one or two small muscular branches to -the distal part of the biceps, and sends a slender branch, N. suralis (c), along the medial surface of the biceps to the lateral surface of the lateral head of M. gastrocnemius (20). The sural nerve (c) becomes cutaneous at the distal (ventral) border of the biceps, and divides three or four centimeters proximad of the ankle into two branches. One passes over the tendon of Achilles (27) to the proximal end of the calcaneus and ramifies in this region. The other passes onto the lateral surface of the foot, and sup- plies the integument in this region over the tarsus and part of the metatarsus. The great sciatic nerve now divides in the popliteal space into the peroneus communis (7) and the tibialis (¢). a. N. peroneus communis (¢).—This is the more lateral of the two divisions of the great sciatic nerve. It passes along the medial surface of the biceps to the lateral surface of the lateral head of M. gastrocnemius (20), where it extends to a point just distad of the head of the fibula. Here it passes beneath that part of the gastrocnemius which has origin on the fascia of the shank, passes between the soleus and peroneus longus (21), then between the peroneus longus and peroneus tertius. It gives off a number of small muscular branches, THE PERIPHERAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 401 Fic. 163. — DIsSECTION OF Lec, LATERAL VIEW, TO SHOW DISTRIBUTION OF THE GREAT SCIATIC NERVE. The biceps, caudoiemoralis, gluteus maximus, gluteus me- dius, tensor vaginz femoris, and part of the peroneus longus have been re- moved. a, N. ischia- dicus or great sciatic nerve; 4, muscular branch; ¢, N. suralis; ad, N. peroneus com- munis; @, N. tibialis; J. N. peroneus pro- fundus; g, N. pe- roneus superficialis and its terminal branches; 4, branch- es of N. cutaneus femoris posterior; 2, N. gluteus inferior; 7, N. gluteus superior; 4, vena saphena parva; RY communicating branch to V. glutea in- ferior. 1, M. sartorius; 2, cut origin of M. gluteus me- dius; 3, cut origin of M. glu- teus maximus; 4, cut origin of M. caudofemoralis; 5, M. gluteus ‘ minimus; 6, M. gemellus superior; 7, M. pyriformis; 8, M. flexor caudze longus; 9, M. obturator internus; 10, M. quadratus femoris; I1, tuberosity of the ischium; 12, great trochanter of femur; 13, M. rectus femoris; 14, M. vastus lateralis; 15, M. adductor femoris; 16, M. semimem- branosus; 17, M. semitendinosus (the slender ribbon-like muscle crossing this is M. tenuissimus); 18, M. vastus intermedius; 19, M. plantaris; 20, M. gastrocnemius; 21, M. peroneus longus (cut); 22, M. tibialis an- terior; 23, M. extensor longus digitorum; 24, transverse ligament; 25. M. peroneus brevis; 26, M. soleus; 27, tendon of Achil- les; 28, M. extensor brevis digitorum; 29, ° tendon of M. peroneus tertius. 402 NERVOUS SYSTEM. then divides two or three centimeters distad of the head of the fibula into two main branches, N. peroneus superficialis () and N. peroneus profundus (/). (1) N. peroneus superficialis (¢).—The superficial peroneal nerve passes distad between the peroneus longus and peroneus tertius. Near the ankle it becomes superficial, passing along the concavity of the ankle across the transverse ligament which binds down the tendons of the extensor longus (23) and tibialis anterior (22), and thus reaches the dorsal side of the foot. Two or three minute twigs are given off to the ankle, then the nerve divides into four divisions. These pass distad to the toes, sub- dividing so as to send a nerve to each side of each toe. (2) N. peroneus profundus (/).—-The deep peroneal nerve passes between the tibialis anterior and extensor longus digi- torum muscles, gives branches to these muscles, and passes distad with the tibialis anterior artery, lying on the inner sur- face of the tibialis anterior muscle. It passes onto the dorsum of the foot, lying on the inner surface of the tendon of the muscle. On the tarsus it divides into two branches. The lateral branch passes into the extensor brevis digitorum, while the medial one extends in the dorsal groove between metatarsals four and five to the toes; here it divides into two nerves which supply the contiguous sides of digits four and five. b. N. tibialis (¢).—The tibial nerve passes distad parallel with the peroneal nerve, but mediad of it. It passes between the lateral and medial heads of the gastrocnemius, giving off muscular branches to these, and to the plantaris and soleus. It then passes between the plantaris and the medial head of the gastrocnemius, and reaches the space between the plantaris and flexor longus hallucis, where it passes distad. It gives off, inthe region just described, muscular branches to the flexor longus digitorum, flexor longus hallucis, and tibialis posterior. Below the middle of the lower leg the nerve becomes superficial (Fig. 127, z, page 310), lying on the ven- tral surface of the flexor longus hallucis. It passes in the depression between the heel and the medial malleolus onto the plantar surface of the tarsus, sends a small branch to the THE PERIPHERAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 403 plantar surface of the heel, and divides into two branches, the medial and the lateral plantar nerves. (1) N. plantaris medialis.— The medial plantar nerve passes along the medial border of the flexor brevis digitorum and divides into two branches. One passes to the medial (second) digit, supplying both sides; the other supplies the third digit in the same way. Both send branches to the fibrous pad on the sole of the foot. (2) N. plantaris lateralis.— The lateral plantar nerve passes laterad across the tendon of the flexor longus digitorum to its lateral edge. At about the proximal end of the metatarsi it divides into two branches. The lateral branch passes distad to the ventral surface of the fifth digit. The medial branch passes beneath the tendon of the.flexor longus digitorum and transversely across the interossei; it divides into numerous tendons which innervate the interossei and other short muscles of the sole of the foot. 4. N. pudendus (Fig. 162, 7; Fig. 112, 8, page 265).— This arises (Fig. 162, /) from the sacral plexus caudad of the great sciatic nerve. It has two roots, one from the second sacral, one from the third, and it may also receive a small accession from the great sciatic nerve (#) three or four centi- meters caudad of the origin of the latter. It passes at first dorsolaterad, laterad of the coccygeus muscle, then curves mediad toward the anus. It divides into two branches: one passes to the base of the penis, sends twigs into the compressor urethrz muscle, and passes onto the dorsal surface of the penis. This branch is N. dorsalis penis; it extends with the artery of the same name to the glans. The second branch of N. puden- dus (N. hemorrhoidalis medius) passes to the anus and inner- vates the muscles and other structures about the caudal end of the rectum. In the female, branches of N. pudendus supply the urogenital sinus and adjacent structures (Fig. 112, 8). 5. N. cutaneus femoris posterior (Fig. 162, &£; Fig. 163, #).—This arises from the sacral plexus, its roots coming chiefly from the second and third sacral nerves, and passes caudodorsad, at first in close connection with N. pudendus. It then accompanies the posterior gluteal artery and vein, sends 404 NERVOUS SYSTEM. branches (perineal nerves) into the fat at the sides of the anus, and branches onto the lateral surface of the biceps muscle. One of the latter follows the communicating vein (Fig. 163, %’) from V. saphena parva, and may be traced as far distad as the popliteal space. 6. N. hemorrhoidalis inferior (or posterior) (Fig. 162, 7). —This arises by two roots, from the second and third sacral | nerves, and passes with the inferior hemorrhoidal artery ventrad across the lateral surface of the rectum to the urethra. Here it divides into two parts: one passes craniad to the bladder, the other caudad onto the ventrolateral surface of the rectum. A small nerve passes from the sacral plexus, especially from the third sacral nerve, into M. levator ani (Fig. 162, 11). Another small nerve from the same region passes to M. coccy- geus, and a third to the proximal end of M. tenuissimus. __ E. NERVES OF THE TAIL. COCCYGEAL NERVES.—From the intervertebral foramina of the first seven or eight caudal vertebrz spinal nerves of the usual type are given off. The dorsal rami innervate the dorsal muscles of the tail. The ventral rami are interconnected with each other and with the last sacral nerve by a longitudinal cord; they innervate the muscles and integument of the ventral side of the tail. 3. The Sympathetic Nervous System. Systema nervo- rum sympathicum. The sympathetic system consists essentially of a chain of ganglia on each side of the ventral surface of the vertebral column, interconnected by longitudinal nerve-cords, and stretching from the base of the skull to the tail. The ganglia are connected to the spinal nerves by communicating branches, and numerous branches pass from them to the abdominal and thoracic viscera, and to the walls of the lymph- and _ blood- vessels, forming complicated plexuses. Cervical portion (Fig. 156, page 379).—The sympathetic system begins just caudad of the tympanic bulla as the superior cervical ganglion (G. cervicale superius) (Fig. 156, ¢). This is a large ganglion closely applied to the ganglion nodosum (@) of the vagus, and lying on its ventrocranial side. From THE PERIPHERAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 405 the superior cervical ganglion the sympathetic trunk passes caudad usually closely bound up with the vagus (d’), so that the two can scarcely be distinguished. They lie (2) at the side of the trachea (6), close against the lateral surface of the carotid artery. A few centimeters before reaching the first rib the two separate (Fig. 157, page 381); the sympathetic (c) is here the smaller and more dorsal of the two. Just craniad of the first rib the sympathetic usually forms a small swelling, the middle cervical ganglion (Fig. 157, @), beyond which it divides into two portions. The larger dorsal division passes dorsocaudad and joins a large ganglion, the inferior cervical (¢), which lies at the head of the first rib, on the lateral surface of the longus colli muscle. The ventral branch (g’) passes caudad, turns laterad about the medial and caudal surface of the subclavian artery, and likewise reaches the inferior cervical ganglion. In some cases the middle cervical ganglion (@) is lacking. Branches of the Sympathetic in the Cervical Region.— From the cranial end of the superior cervical ganglion several nerves pass craniad. Some of these become connected im- _mediately with the cranial nerves emerging from the jugular foramen, forming a plexus in this region. Others pass with the internal carotid artery craniad, forming a plexus about that artery; from the plexus twigs arise which pass to the fifth and sixth cranial nerves; doubtless also to the seventh and eighth. A specially large branch, the deep petrosal nerve (see page 373), passes from the superior cervical ganglion along with the internal carotid artery to the pterygoid canal, thence through this to the sphenopalatine ganglion. Before separating from the vagus the sympathetic gives off one or two cardiac nerves (Fig. 157, 2). These are closely bound up with the vagus (4), so that they appear usually to have origin from the vagus at about the level of the first rib. These pass with the vagus to the heart and take part in the formation of the cardiac plexus (4). At the middle cervical ganglion (@) usually a communicat- ing branch is given to the vagus. - The branches of the inferior cervical ganglion (¢) fall in the thoracic region, and are described in that connection. 406 NERVOUS SYSTEM. Thoracic Portion of the Sympathetic (Fig. 157, page 381). —The inferior cervical ganglion (e¢) lies entirely within the thoracic cavity. It has the following branches: 1. One or two small cardiac branches (%), which pass to the heart (r). 2. A large communicating branch (e’), which passes craniad from the cranial end of the ganglion (¢) along the lateral surface of the longus colli muscle, and gives communi- cating branches to the sixth, seventh, and eighth cervical nerves (VJ, V//, and VJ//). 3. One or two small communicating branches to the first thoracic nerve (/’). 4. A communicating branch to the second thoracic nerve. The arrangement of these communicating branches is somewhat variable; they may arise in various combinations, as at first united, or as more or less completely separated nerves. The sympathetic trunk (c) continues caudad from the caudal end of the inferior cervical ganglion, lying at first on the lateral surface of the longus colli, then on the lateral surface of the centra of the vertebra. For each vertebra there is a slight enlargement, forming one of the thoracic ganglia of the sym- pathetic, and from each ganglion one or two communicating branches are given off to the corresponding spinal nerve. Just caudad of the last rib (but while still in the thoracic cavity) the sympathetic gives off the large N. splanchnicus major or great splanchnic nerve (7), which passes ventrocaudad and pierces the diaphragm. The sympathetic itself then passes through the diaphragm laterad of the crus. Abdominal Portion of the Sympathetic (Fig. 164).—The great splanchnic nerve (4) passes through the diaphragm (2) laterad of the crus, extends two or three centimeters caudoven- trad, and joins a large ganglion lying just caudad of the cceliac artery (4), almost on the lateral surface of the superior mesen- teric (5). This is the coeliac (or semilunar) ganglion (d). From it nerves branch in all directions, forming the celiac plexus (¢), a part of the large solar plexus. Less than a centimeter ventrocaudad of the coeliac ganglion, on the caudal surface of the superior mesenteric artery (5), is the somewhat THE PERIPHERAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. 407 smaller superior mesenteric ganglion (/); the two are con- nected by two strong nerve-trunks. The cceliac ganglion (d) receives from the sympathetic (a), in addition to the great splanchnic nerve, two (or three) lesser Fic. 164,— SYMPATHETIC AND VAGUS IN THE ABDOMEN (SOMEWHAT SCHEMATIC). I, stomach; 2, crus and cut edge of diaphragm; 3, aorta; 4, coeliac artery; 5, superior mesenteric artery; 6, kidney, 7, inferior mesenteric artery; 8, large intes- tine. @, main trunk of sympathetic; 4, great splanchnic nerve; ¢, lesser splanchnic nerves; d@, cceliac (or semilunar) ganglion; ¢, cceliac plexus; 7, superior mesenteric ganglion; g, superior mesenteric plexus, following the artery; 4, aortic plexus; 2, inferior mesenteric ganglion and plexus; 7, suprarenal plexus on suprarenal body; 4, renal plexus following renal artery; 7, ventral cesophageal branch of vagus, forming anterior gastric plexus; #, dorsal cesophageal branch of vagus, forming posterior gastric plexus. splanchnic nerves (c), which arise from the main trunk of the sympathetic, the first just as it reaches the abdominal cavity, . the second one or two centimeters caudad of the diaphragm. From the cceliac and superior mesenteric ganglia a network of nerves passes in all directions to the abdominal viscera. 408 NERVOUS SYSTEM. These nerves follow especially the arteries, forming plexuses over their surfaces, and passing with them to the organs which they supply. The cceliac plexus anastomoses with the pos- terior gastric plexus of the vagus. Parts of the cceliac plexus following the branches of the coeliac artery may be distin- guished as hepatic plexus, splenic plexus, etc. A dense plexus is formed on the surface of the suprarenal body (supra- renal plexus, 7), anda renal plexus (4) follows the renal artery tothe kidneys (6). The superior mesenteric plexus (.¢) forms a dense network over the superior mesenteric artery (5) and follows it to the intestine. A plexus passes caudad on the aorta (aortic plexus, Z). This is a continuation of the cceliac and superior mesenteric plexuses; it receives a number of branches from the main sympathetic trunk, lying dorsad of the aorta. The aortic plexus contains a number of small ganglia. From the aortic plexus the smaller inferior mesenteric plexus (2) follows the inferior mesenteric artery (7) to the large intestine; in this lies a ganglion of considerable size, the inferior mesenteric ganglion. In the pelvic region small plexuses are formed in a similar manner, from branches given off by the main sympathetic trunk, together with branches from the plexuses of the abdominal cavity. These plexuses supply the various organs in the pelvis. The main sympathetic trunk (2) passes into the abdomen at the side of the crus of the diaphragm, lying dorsad of the great splanchnic nerve (4). In the abdomen it lies nearer the middle line than in the thorax, so that the two trunks of right and left side are separated by but a few millimeters as they lie on the ventral surface of the centra of the lumbar vertebrz. There is a ganglion for each vertebra (Fig. 162, 7), and from each ganglion are given off one or more communicating branches to the spinal nerves, and usually a branch which passes ventrad to join one of the plexuses among the viscera. The first three branches of this kind (Fig. 164, c) are larger and pass to the cceliac and superior mesenteric ganglia. The sympathetic may be traced into the pelvis, Where it becomes smaller, and is lost as the caudal region is reached. SENSE-ORGANS AND INTEGUMENT. I. THE ORGAN OF SIGHT. ORGANON VISUS. 1. The Orbit.—The bony framework of the orbital fossa, in which the organ of sight is situated, has already been described (page 53). The orbit is not protected by bone on all sides, being open caudad and ventrad, and partly laterad. The structures within the orbit are further protected and sepa- rated from other structures by a very thin, tough, transparent membranous sac, the periorbita, which surrounds them almost completely and nearly fills the orbit. The periorbita forms a conical sac with the apex of the cone directed caudoventrad and attached about the optic foramen and orbital fissure. The base of the cone is attached about the margin of the orbital fossa,—to the supraorbital margin of the frontal, to the maxillary and malar bones, and to the orbital ligament, con- necting the frontal process of the malar with the zygomatic process of the frontal. The periorbita is partly separated from the walls of the orbital fossa by masses of fat. It comes in contact, aside from the bones, with the temporal and pterygoid muscles, and with nerves and blood-vessels in the orbit. The sac thus formed encloses the eyeball with its muscles and glands (Fig. 166), as well as a mass of fat in which these are imbedded. The periorbita and its contents are freely movable with relation to surrounding structures. 2. The Eyelids. Palpebre.—The eyelids are two thin folds which protect the eye. Externally they are covered with hair; internally by the thin membranous conjunctiva. The eyelids contain the Meibomian or tarsal glands, arranged in short rows passing perpendicularly inward from the edge of the lids; these may sometimes be seen with the naked eye as 409 410 SENSE-ORGANS AND INTEGUMENT. broad yellowish lines. They secrete a substance which pre- vents the adhesion of the edges of the two lids. On the edge of each eyelid, three to four millimeters from the medial angle of the eye, is one of the openings of the lachrymal canals. At the medial angle of the eye is the large nictitating membrane (membrana nictitans), or ‘‘third eyelid,’’ corre- sponding to the plica semilunaris of man. In the cat this is large and may cover the whole surface of the eye. It is supported (Fig. 165) by a broad central strip of carti- Fis. 165. _ Iwvgp lage (2), passing from its edge to its inner SurFace or Mem- angle, and the inner end of this cartilage is BRANA NICMAS: surrounded, on the medial (concave) side of showing the support- ing cartilage and Har- the membrane, by the large lobulated Har- sorting” cartilage; s, derian glands (4). Harderian glands; ¢, The conjunctiva is the thin membrane ae covering the inner surface of the lids, the outer surface of the eyeball, and both surfaces of the nictitating membrane. The muscles of the eyelids are M. orbicularis oculi, already described (page 98), and M. levator palpebre superioris, described below. 3. Lachrymal Apparatus.—The lachrymal gland is a large reddish gland, not lobulated externally, which lies on the surface of the eyeball just beneath the lateral angle of the eye. The gland is situated immediately craniad of, and in contact with, the zygomatic process of the frontal bone (Fig. 154, 11, page 374). It is flat and about one centimeter in diameter. The ducts which pass from the gland to the eye are not visible to the naked eye. The fluid secreted by the gland collects at the medial angle of the eye and passes into the two openings of the lachrymal canals, one of which is found on the pigmented edge of each lid, three or four milli- meters from the medial angle of the eye. The canals pass- ing from these openings soon unite to form the nasolachrymal duct, which passes through the lachrymal bone, along the medial surface of the maxillary, to open into the nasal cavity ventrad of the ventral concha of the nose. THE ORGAN OF SIGHT. 41I 4. Muscles of the Orbit (Fig. 166).—Within the orbit are eleven muscles, ten connected with the eyeball, and one, M. levator palpebrz superioris, with the upper eyelid. Of the ten muscles of the eyeball, eight are straight muscles, passing from an origin about the inner end of the orbit directly distad; the other two have an oblique direction. Four of the straight muscles. are larger and are known as the Mm. recti (4, c, @); these are distinguished according to their position as lateral (c), medial, superior (¢@), and inferior (0). The four smaller straight muscles constitute together M. re- tractor oculi (¢). The two oblique muscles are known as Mm. obliqui and are distinguished according to their position as inferior (2) and superior. Fic, 166.—MUSCLES OF THE EYEBALL, LATERAL VIEW. a, M. obliquus inferior; 4, M. rectus inferior; c, M. rectus lateralis; ¢d, M. rectus superior; ¢, parts of M. retractor oculi; 4, the oculomotor nerve. Mm. recti (4, c, @).—The four recti muscles arise from the bone about the optic foramen and pass toward the eyeball. They are inserted by thin, flat tendons along a line which separates the darker caudal part of the sclerotic from the white zone of the sclerotic which borders the cornea,—the line of insertion of the four tendons forming thus a circle about the eyeball. The rectus superior (@) is partly covered by M. levator palpebrz superioris. The tendon of the rectus inferior (6) is crossed by M. obliquus inferior (a). The recti muscles are all innervated by the oculomotor (third) nerve (/), except the lateral (c), which is supplied by the abducens (sixth) nerve. M. retractor oculi (¢).—The retractor oculi arises about the optic foramen and divides into four. heads which lie nearer the 412 ’ SENSE-ORGANS AND INTEGUMENT. eyeball than the recti and are therefore partly covered by the latter. They alternate with the recti and are inserted into the eyeball at about its equator, except the inferior division, - which is inserted on a line with the recti. They are supplied by the oculomotor nerve. M. obliquus inferior (z).—The inferior oblique arises from the maxillary bone just laterad of the lachrymal bone and curves over the ventral side of the eyeball along the lines of | insertion of the recti (crossing the tendon of the rectus inferior, 6) to the ventral edge of the tendon of the lateral rectus (c), where it is inserted. It rotates the eyeball and is supplied by the third nerve (/). M. obliquus superior.—The superior oblique takes origin from the cranial border of the optic foramen, passes dorso- craniad, and ends in a small rounded tendon which passes through a fibrous pulley-ring. This ring is situated near the rim of the orbit, one or two centimeters craniad of the zygomatic process of the frontal bone, and is attached to the wall of the orbit by two fibrous bands. After passing through the pulley- ring the tendon turns and passes laterocaudad; it becomes much expanded, passes caudad of the superior rectus, and is inserted into the eyeball along the caudal margin of the inser- tion of the superior rectus tendon. The superior oblique is supplied by the trochlear (fourth) nerve. M. levator palpebre superioris..—This is a small thin muscle which takes origin on the wall of the optic foramen close to the rectus superior, passes over the outer surface of the rectus superior and beneath the lachrymal gland, and forms a thin tendon which is inserted into the margin of the upper eyelid. It is innervated by the oculomotor. 5. The Eyeball.—The eyeball is approximately spherical in form, but the cranial surface has a slightly, greater curvature than the caudal portion, so that the eye appears slightly pointed at the cranial (free) surface. The large cylindrical optic nerve (Fig. 167, a) enters the eyeball at nearly the centre of the caudal half of the eye. Onthe outer surface is seen the trans- parent cornea (c), covering the free surface of the eye, and the opaque sclerotic (4), covering the remainder of the ball. THE ORGAN OF SIGHT. 413 Through the cornea can be seen the yellow curtain-like iris, with an opening in its centre, the pupil. Coats of the Eye (Fig. 167).—The outer coat of the eye- ball is formed by the sclerotic (or sclera) (4) and the cornea (c). The sclerotic is the whitish opaque portion covering the caudal > three-fourths of the eye. It forms a tough sac serving as a protection for the structures within. The cornea (c) is the cir- cular transparent portion of the outer coat, covering the free surface of the eye; it is a direct continuation of the sclerotic. Just before passing into the cornea the sclerotic is much thick- ened, forming a broad white zone (4’) about the eyeball near its equator. To this zone, at its caudal margin, are attached the rectus muscles of the eyeball. The sclerotic has many pigment-cells on its inner surface, giving it a brownish appear- ance and forming the lamina fusca. The cornea (c) is transparent and more strongly curved than the sclerotic. It is thicker than most of the sclerotic coat, but not so thick as the white zone of the latter. Within the sclerotic is the second coat of the eye, formed by the choroid (d@) and the iris (e). The choroid (@) is a vascular layer, and contains much pigment, giving it a dark color. It lines the inner surface of the sclerotic, but does not cover the inner surface of the cornea. At the white zone of the heel tole ip akg Tag 7 sclerotic it is thrown into a large num- a, optic nerve: 4, sclerotic ber (about seventy) of meridional folds, (%: thickened “‘ white zone’’); 3 ee ERE i ¢, cornea; @, choroid; e, iris; the plice ciliares or ciliary folds, which ¥ ciliary body; g, retina; 4, together constitute the so-called ciliary oe ue beatae body (corpus ciliare) (7). This forms eye; 4, vitreous humor. a circular zone on the inner surface of the white zone of the sclerotic, and is continuous with the iris (¢). The choroid coat is furnished in certain parts of its area with a layer of cells containing crystals, which give it a brilliant color, forming the tapetum. The color of the tapetum is a metallic yellowish 414 SENSE-ORGANS AND INTEGUMENT. blue or green; it is this layer which causes the cat’s eye to ‘«shine ’’ in the dark. ; The iris (e) is a continuation of the choroid. It projects inward from the white zone of the sclerotic, forming a circular curtain lying some distance behind the cornea, and perforated by an opening, the pupil. The iris is usually yellow in color on its outer surface, darkly pigmented within. The pupil varies normally in size and form according to the amount of light to which the eye is subjected. In a cat killed with chloroform the pupil is very large and circular; in the living animal it is elliptical with the long axis dorsoventral, or when much contracted it is a mere dorsoventral slit. The inner coat of the eye is formed by the retina ( ¢°. This is the part of the eye which is sensitive to light; it is formed by an expansion of the optic nerve (a). In a preserved eye it is usually soft and opaque, and may be seen to line the caudal half of the inner surface, extending apparently to the ciliary body. Here it seems to end as a free margin, the ora serrata ; it really becomes thin and passes onto the surface of the ciliary body, forming the ciliary portion of the retina, and onto the inner surface of the iris, where it forms the uvea. Near the centre of the retina the entrance of the optic nerve is marked by a small round spot, the blind spot. The Crystalline Lens (/).—The lens is a biconvex trans- parent body situated within the eye a little in front of the ciliary body and just behind the iris. It is more strongly convex in front than behind. The lens is surrounded by a thin trans- parent sac, the capsule of the lens (capsula lentis). The capsule of the lens is attached all around the equator of the lens by fibrous bands to the ciliary body, this attachment forming the zonula ciliaris (or zonula Zinni) (¢), by which the lens is suspended. Chambers of the Eye.—The lens (4) and zonula ciliaris (2 } form a partition dividing the eye into two parts. The cavity in front of the lens contains a fluid, the aqueous humor. This cavity is partly subdivided by the iris into the anterior and posterior chambers of the eye. The part of the eye lying behind the lens is much larger THE EAR. 415 than the part in front of the lens. It is lined chiefly by the retina, its front boundary being the lens. It contains a jelly- like substance, the vitreous humor (or vitreous body, corpus vitreum). II. THE EAR. ORGANON AUDITUS. The ear of the cat, like that of man, is composed of three parts, the external, middle, and internal ear. The external ear is limited internally by the tympanic membrane. The middle ear extends from the tympanic membrane to the fenestra cochlez and fenestra vestibuli. It contains the bones of the ear, and is connected with the pharynx by the Eustachian tube. The internal ear is wholly contained within the petrous bone, and on the surface of the membrane lining its cavities are distributed the branches of the auditory (eighth) nerve. The External Ear. The external ear consists of an expanded portion, the auricle (auricula) or pinna, and of a canal leading from the auricle to the tympanic membrane, known as the external auditory meatus. The concave surface of the auricle is directed craniolaterad, and its edges form the dorsal and lateral boundaries of the auditory opening. From the bottom of the cavity which it partly encloses, the external auditory meatus passes medioventrad. The auricle (Fig. 168) is composed of a thin curved plate of cartilage (cartilago auricule), to which numerous muscles are attached and which is covered on both sides by integument intimately attached to the cartilage. Distad the edges of the cartilage form a free border (6); proximad the plate is rolled together in such a way that its edges (g and #) overlap on the craniomedial side, thus enclosing a tube or funnel (e) (concha) which forms the enlarged outer portion of the auditory passage. Within the cavity of the auricle, on its medial surface, somewhat below the level of the lowest portion of the margin of the auditory opening is seen a very prominent pedun- 416 SENSE-ORGANS. AND INTEGUMENT. culated process (d). This is really part of a transverse ridge, extending craniocaudad on the medial wall of the auricular cavity. This ridge is the antihelix (d); it divides the auricula into a distal and a proximal portion. The portion distad of the antihelix is the scapha (a); its surface is smooth except for two slight longitudinal ridges extending distad from near the two ends of the antihelix. That portion of the auricle that lies proximad of the antihelix forms a deep irregular cavity known as the concha (¢). A deep furrow, corresponding to the anti- helix, separates scapha from concha externally. The concha extends caudad as a deep, rounded pocket; externally this pocket forms a prominent convexity, the eminentia conche (7), on the caudal surface of the proximal portion of the external ear. Farther proximad the concha narrows like a funnel and becomes much compressed laterally, so that a sec- tion of its cavity forms a narrow craniocaudal slit. The inner surface of the concha is marked by a number of very prominent ridges and projections. These are usually due to folds in the cartilage, so that external furrows and depres- sions correspond to the internal projections. The edges of these depressions serve for attachment of muscles (Fig. 169), by con- traction of which the form of the concha is changed,—the folds of the cartilage thus serving as regions of greater flexibility. Two or three centimeters proximad of its external opening the cartilage of the concha ends in a free edge which receives within itself the distal end of the cartilaginous external auditory meatus (¢’). The two are united together by fibrous tissue. The cartilaginous auditory meatus (e’) extends as a nearly cylindrical tube mediad and slightly craniad to the tympanic membrane in the opening of the bulla tympani. This tube is lined with integument which continues over the tympanic membrane. The subcutaneous tissue of the tube contains the ceruminous glands, which secrete the ear-wax and open on the surface of the skin. To understand the relations of the muscles of the external ear it is necessary to consider a little more fully the structure of the auricular cartilage (Fig. 168), especially as compared with the human ear. The ear of the cat differs from the human THE EAR. 417 ear in the fact that the edges of the auricular cartilages are rolled together proximad so as to overlap. There is thus no gap between the tragus (g) and antitragus (#), as in man, but these two structures partly overlap. The free edge (4) of the auricular cartilage corresponds partly to the helix of man. At its mediocranial angle the proximal part of the auricle is composed of muscle and integument only, so that the cartilage when isolated presents here a deep notch distad of which is a prominent projecting angle, the spine (c) of the helix, which serves for attachment of the adductor auris superior muscle (Fig. 169, 1). Proxi- mad of the spine, separated from it by the deep notch, the cranial edge (g) of the auricular cartilage ap- proaches the caudal edge (A), finally overlapping it, so that the cavity of the auricle is now completely sur- rounded. This overlapping portion of the cartilage is on the medial side of the cavity, and in the natural state is covered by muscles and integu- re li hei Der hs BPDArERt Fic. 168.—CARTILAGE OF THE That portion of the cranial edge Exrernat Ear, CRANIOME- of the cartilage that overlaps the cau- PM! VIEW. 3 i a, scapha or pinna; 4, helix, dal edge forms a cartilaginous plate ¢, spine of the helix; d, antihelix; which projects proximad as a blunt ® concha; ¢’, cartilaginous audi- 5 j oe See tory meatus; /, crista helicis; g, point; this -plate is the tragus (g'). tragus; 4, antitragus; 2, processus Along the inner edge of the tragus is ""*™#t™S:/, «minentia conche. a ridge which forms a continuation of the helix; this is the crista helicis (f). The portion of the caudal edge of the car- tilage that is partly overlapped by the tragus is an irregular flat _ plate known as the antitragus (/). At its caudolateral margin the antitragus extends distad asa thin, pointed, cartilaginous spine, the processus uncinatus (7). This supports a sheet of 418 SENSE-ORGANS AND INTEGUMENT. integument which bears two longitudinal ridges projecting into the cavity of the ear, with a broad groove between them. The Scutiform Cartilage.—Closely connected with the external ear, but not forming a part of it, is the scutiform car- tilage. This lies in the temporal fossa, between the integu- ment and the temporal muscle, just behind the orbit and beneath the craniomedial portion of the auricle (Fig. 63, 1, page 97). It is a narrow cartilage about two centimeters long, with its long axis craniocaudal. For the greater part of its length it forms a slender rod, from which a thin cartilagi- nous sheet extends a short distance laterad; at its caudal end the rod forks, the two arms extending nearly at right angles to the main portion. The scutiform cartilage serves for the origin or insertion of a number of the muscles of the ear. Muscles of the External Ear (Fig. 169).—(a) The muscles connecting the cartilages of the external ear with other parts of the head have been described (page 96), excepting the tragicus lateralis (4). These muscles are the following: M. intermedius scutulorum (Fig. 63, a), M. frontoauricularis, M. levator auris longus (including the cervicoauricular) (Fig. 63, g, g’), M. auricularis superior (Fig. 63, &), M. abductor auris longus (Fig. 63, m), M. abductor auris brevis (Fig. 63, 7), M. zygo- maticus (Fig. 64, 7), M. submentalis (Fig. 64, c), M. depressor conche (Fig. 64, 4), M. frontoscutularis, M. adductor auris inferior (Fig. 63, 7), and M. tragicus lateralis (Fig. 169, 4). M. tragicus lateralis (Fig. 169, 4).—A band about seven millimeters wide, lying beneath the mass of fat about the ear and running ventrad lengthwise of the concha and close against it. Origin (Fig. 96, a, page 229) on the caudal end of the mandibula, in the cavity found between the condyloid process and the angular process. The muscle passes dorsad and is inserted (Fig. 169, 4) on the caudal margin of the tragus and in the depression on the concha just caudad of the tragus. Relations.—This muscle lies between the temporal muscle and the concha. Action.—Pulls the ear ventrad and probably rotates it outward. THE EAR. 419 (6) The following three muscles connect the scutiform cartilage with other parts of the external ear. M. rotator auris or scutuloauricularis inferior.—A flat craniocaudal band of fibres lying between the auricle and the temporal muscle. Origin on the scutiform cartilage, just caudad of the insertion of the frontoscutularis, of which this muscle seems to be a continuation. The muscle passes caudad as a band seven or eight millimeters wide, curving about the medial surface of the auri- cle, and is inserted on the caudo- medial surface of the eminentia conche. Relations.—Lateral surface with the auricular cartilage ; medial surface with the temporal muscle. Action.—Rotates the external ear mediad and caudad. M. adductor auris superior (Fig. 160,01; “Mis. 63; 7). (Patt of the auricularis anterior of man. ) Origin on the dorsal surface of the scutiform cartilage for its entire Y length. The fibres form a continua- Fic. 169.—CartTILaGE oF THE tion of those of the frontoscutularis ; prageass 4S, WITH OVE: they pass dorsocaudad and are zz- i, as in Fig, 168. 1, M. serted into the spina helicis or cranio- casas nee a medial margin of the auricular carti- 3, M. helicis; 4, M. tragicus later- lage. This muscle lies in the fold Since oe Chee a sgry ) of skin that connects the craniomedial adductor auris inferior (cut); 8, angle of the auricular cartilage with Biheller aaa? the head, so that it is covered on both M. auricularis externus; 11, M. é i abductor auris longus (cut). sides by integument. Action.—Draws the auricle craniad. M. adductor auris medius (Fig. 169, 2). (Part of the 420 SENSE-ORGANS AND INTEGUMENT. auricularis anterior of man.)—A very thin band of fibres eight to ten millimeters broad. Origin on the middle two-thirds of the caudoventral edge of the scutiform cartilage. The fibres pass nearly ventrad and are zuserted along the medial or caudal surface of the tragus. Relations. — Outer surface with the auricular cartilage. Inner surface with the temporal muscle or with the pad of fat separating this from the auricle. Action.—Pulls the concha dorsocraniad. (c) The remainder of the muscles of*the ear interconnect parts of the auricular cartilage. M. transversus auricule (Fig. 63, 7).—A band about six to eight millimeters wide, on the medial convex surface of the auricle, between the distal ends of M. levator auris longus ( g’) and M. auricularis superior (2). Origin on the medial surface of the concha, just proximad of the furrow which corresponds to the antihelix. The muscle bridges this furrow, passes distad about two centimeters, and is inserted on the auricular cartilage on a line which forms a caudal continuation of the line of insertion of the levator auris longus (g’). Relations.—Outer surface with the levator auris longus (g, g), the auricularis superior (£), and the integument; inner surface with the auricular cartilage. Action.—Flexes the scapha mediad on the concha, thus enlarging the external opening of the concha. M. auricularis externus (Fig. 169, 10; Fig. 64, ~).—This consists of small scattered bands of interrupted fibres on the convex surface of the auricle, caudad of the transversus auriculea. The largest of these bands runs parallel with the transversus auriculz about five or six millimeters caudad of the latter. It has origin on the eminentia conche distad of the insertion of the abductor auris longus. Thence the fibres run distad five or six millimeters and are interrupted by an attach- ment to the cartilage. Distad the fibres begin again, and the muscle runs thence distad for about one centimeter, the distal end being attached to the cartilage. THE EAR. 42i Caudad of this, especially of its proximal portion, are one or two small bands of fibres usually running parallel with it, but unconnected with it and with each other. The extent and distribution of these bands varies, and the direction of fibres is also variable. Relations.—Outer surface with the integument; inner sur- face with the auricular cartilage. Action.—F lexes the auricular cartilage. M. helicis (Fig. 169, 3; Fig. 64, m).—A muscle about two centimeters in length and five or six millimeters in width, on the inner surface of the ear, along its cranial margin. Origin on the medial surface of the concha, just caudad of ' the proximal end of the tragus. The fibres pass distad to be inserted on the auricular cartilage at the caudal angle of the notch which lies beneath the cranial edge of the auricle, along with the caudal fibres of the adductor auris superior (1). Relations.— Lateral surface with the integument; medial surface with the tragus. Action.— Draws proximad the cranial margin of the auricle. M. antitragicus (Fig. 169, 6; Fig. 64, z).—A small muscle about one centimeter in length and three millimeters in thick- ness, attached at one end to the caudal border of the anti- tragus. The fibres pass mediodistad and are inserted on the tragus, in common with the fibres of the tragicus medialis (Fig. 169, 5, 5’). Relations. —Outer surface with the adductor auris inferior and the integument; inner surface with the cartilage. Action.—Constricts the external auditory opening. M. tragicus medialis (Fig. 169, 5,5’).—A small, flat mus- cle, in two parts, on the medial surface of the concha. Origin on the ventral end of the tragus. The cranial fibres form a thick nearly cylindrical bundle which extends proximad about one centimeter, and is inserted on the cranial surface of the concha just proximad of a deep fold in the carti- lage. The caudal fibres form a thin sheet which spreads on the medial surface of the concha and is inserted on an obliquely proximodistal line on the medial surface of the concha, less than one centimeter from the free distal edge. 422 SENSE-ORGANS AND INTEGUMENT. These two bundles are distinct except at their origin, and are sometimes considered as separate muscles. Relations. —Outer surface with the tragicus lateralis (4) and the fat about the concha. Inner surface with the concha. Action.—Flexes the concha. Strauss-Durckheim describes under the name cornetocon- cheus a small muscle bridging the deep groove caused by the folding of the medial surface of the concha, its proximal end being close to the insertion of the abductor auris brevis (page 100). This muscle was absent in all of the cases examined for its presence. M. concheus externus (Fig. 169, 9).—A quadrilateral muscle on the lateral surface of the concha. The cranial end of this muscle is attached to the concha a short distance distad of the antitragus along a dorsoventral line six to eight milli- meters in length; the fibres pass thence caudodorsad a distance of about one centimeter, where they are again attached to the concha. The muscle thus bridges a shallow depression on the lateral surface of the concha. Action. — Constricts the concha. The Middle Ear. The middle ear is enclosed in a cavity within the tympanic bulla. Its outer boundary, as well as the inner boundary of the external ear, Fic. 170, TYMPANIC MEMBRANE, is formed by the tympanic mem- VIEWED FROM THE INNER SIDE. brane (Fig. 170, c.) This is a thin, The outer wall of the bulla has ‘ been removed, carrying with it the S¢mitransparent membrane attached tympanic membrane with the mal- to the bony ring (a) surrounding the leus and incus; these are now , : viewed from the side that was inner end of the external auditory turned toward the cavity. 4, bony meatus. It is oval in outline. Across ring forming inner end of external ; ee auditory meatus; 4, 4’, malleus; c, the dorsal third of its inner surface ene: Oude tm. runs the handle of the malleus (6), pani dee: g, cartilaginous ss to which the membrane is firmly pees fr opens ee ee attached and which by pulling on the membrane gives it the form of a cone instead of a flat sur- face. The apex of the cone is directed mediad. The middle ear, or cavum tympani, is an ellipsoidal cavity THE EAR. 423 situated in the tympanic bulla. On removing the medial wall of the bulla, a bony plate is seen separating its cavity into two chambers. This plate of bone extends in from the lateral wall of the bulla, forming a complete partition except at the dorso- caudal part, where a notch in the bone forms a free communi- cation. between the two chambers. The lateral chamber, or tympanum proper, contains the bones of the ear and is limited externally by the tympanic membrane. At its cranial end is seen the opening of the tuba auditiva, or Eustachian tube. The tuba auditiva, or Eustachian tube, is a cartilaginous tube about one and a half to two centimeters long, passing from the nasopharynx to the middle ear and placing these two cavities in communication. The pharyngeal opening is at about the middle of the length of the nasopharynx, near the dorsal border of the lateral wall; it is a narrow slit two or three millimeters long. Thence the tube passes caudolaterad on the ventral surface of the sphenoid bone, and enters the tympanic cavity through the opening just laterad of the styliform process of the tympanic bulla. The tube has a thick, cartilaginous medial wall, while the lateral wall is thin and formed of connective tissue. The lumen of the tube is a curved slit in cross-section. Bones of the Ear (ossicula auditus). —There are three small bones in the middle ear, the malleus (hammer) (Fig. 171, 1), incus (anvil) (Fig. 171, 2), and stapes (stirrup) (Fig. 172). The malleus (Fig. 171, 1) consists of a slender handle (a) with a small neck (0) at- tached at an angle to the caudal end of the handle. At the end of the neck is a rounded head (c) which articulates with the incus (2), and together with one part of the incus lies in a small fossa dorsad of the fenestra vestibuli. From the medial aspect of the neck extends a short process of bone (@) to which is attached the tendon of the tensor tympani muscle. One Fic. 171.—MALLE- US AND INCUS, UNITED IN THE NATURAL Posi- TION. I, malleus; 2, in- cus. @, handle of maileus; 4, neck; c, head; d, process for attachment of ten- don of M. tensor tympani; ¢, wing- like plate and pro- cess of neck; /, g, the two processes of the incus. side of the neck is produced into a thin wing-like plate, bear- ing on its edge a pointed process (e). 424 SENSE-ORGANS AND INTEGUMENT. The incus (Fig. 171, 2) bears much resemblance to a two- fanged molar tooth. It lies in the fossa with the head of the malleus. Its head or crown is directed craniad and has a concave surface which articulates with the head of the malleus. — One of the fangs (/) extends caudad in the fossa above men- tioned and is held in position by a ligament. The other fang (g) extends ventromediad and articulates with the head of the stapes. This fang terminates in a minute rounded tubercle known as the lenticular process; this in early stages of devel- opment is a separate bone, the os lenticulare. The stapes (Fig. 172) has the form of a stirrup, and is the last in the chain of bones. The small end is termed the head (a), and the broader part the base (0). The head of the stapes articulates with one of the processes of the incus. The base of the stapes fits into the > 6 fenestra vestibuli of the petrous bone and com- Fic. 172. pletely closes it. The stapes is held in position nga ’, by the stapedius muscle, which is attached to a base; ¢, process minute process (c) near the head. of er pets Thus the three bones of the midle ear form a muscle. chain which connects the medial surface of the tympanic membrane with the fenestra vestibuli. As the fenestra vestibuli forms a portion of the wall of the vestibule, the vibrations of the tympanic membrane are transmitted through the chain of bones to the fluid within the vestibule. Muscles of the Middle Ear. M. tensor tympani.—The tensor tympani muscle is a short conical muscle having origin in a small fossa (Fig. 25, d, p. 34) in the petrous bone dorsocraniad of the fenestra vestibuli. Its very short tendon passes laterad and is inserted into a pro- jection (Fig. 171, d@) on the neck of the malleus. M. stapedius.—The stapedius muscle is a short muscle taking origin from a fossa (Fig. 25, 7) in the lateral surface of the petrous bone caudad of that for the incus. It is inserted into the head of the stapes. The Internal Ear (Fig. 173). The internal ear or labyrinth is completely enclosed in the petrous bone. In the dry bone the internal ear communicates THE EAR. 425 with the middle ear by the fenestra cochlez and the fenestra vestibuli, which have been described in the account of the petrous bone (page 33). In the recent state the fenestra vestibuli is closed by the base of the stapes, while the fenestra cochlez is covered by a delicate membrane,—so that the in- ternal ear forms a closed cavity. It is possible to distinguish a bony labyrinth and a membranous labyrinth (Fig. 173), the former being the cavity in the petrous bone, while the latter is the real auditory organ, situated within the cavity. The mem- branous labyrinth repeats in general the form of the bony laby- rinth, so that it will not be necessary to distinguish the two in our account of the main features of the structure. The auditory nerve is distributed to the membranous labyrinth. For an account of the minute structure of this organ reference should be made to a text-book of general histology or physiology. The labyrinth (Fig. 173) consists of a cavity, the vesti- bule (a), and connected with this a coiled tube, the cochlea (4), and the three semi- circular canals (c, d, and e). The cochlea (4) is situated in the pro- montory,—the rounded elevation of the petrous bone extending craniad from the fenestra cochlee. It consists of a bony hah eee tube coiled spirally about a central column 4, vestibule; 4, cochlea; known as the modiolus. The coil has i a seam case nearly the form of a snail’s shell, and is circular canal; ¢, posterior g semicircular canal; /, scala somewhat more lengthened in the cat than tympani: g, scala vestibuli; in man. A plate of bone, the lamina % fenestra cochlex; , ei atnatr. Bo : fenestra vestibuli. spiralis, incompletely divides the cavity of the canal lengthwise into two parts, known as scale (fand g). One of these opens at the fenestra cochlez () into the tympanic cavity (or would so open but for the thin membrane covering the fenestra); this is known as the scala tympani (/). The other scala is connected with the vestibule (a) and is known as the scala vestibuli (). The vestibule (a) is a pyramidal cavity situated mediad of the caudal end of the cochlea. It is connected with the scala vestibuli of the cochlea, and with the three semicircular canals. 426 " SENSE-ORGANS AND INTEGUMENT. The fenestra vestibuli (7) is an opening in its bony wall, filled in the recent state by the stapes. On the medial surface of the vestibule are a number of minute orifices through which the auditory nerve enters. The semicircular canals (c, d, and ¢) are three curved tubes, each forming about two-thirds of a circle, and opening at both ends into the vestibule. They are imbedded in the petrous bone. The planes of the three tubes intersect nearly at right angles; from their position in man they have been named external (c), superior (@), and posterior (¢). The external one (c) is nearly horizontal in position, and surrounds the curved fossa (Fig. 25, 7) for the stapedius muscle, caudad of the fenestra vestibuli. The superior (Fig. 173, @) and pos- terior (¢) are in nearly dorsoventral planes, but at right angles to each other. The superior (@) lies in the ridge forming the caudal boundary of the appendicular fossa. The posterior (e) is situated in a continuation caudad of the ridge which forms the dorsal boundary of the internal auditory meatus. One end of each canal is slightly enlarged to form an ampulla. The superior (2) and posterior (¢) canals join at one end and enter the vestibule by a common opening. One end of the external canal (c) opens into the vestibule so close to one end of the posterior canal (e) that they appear to have a common opening, and this is commonly stated to be the case; according to Jayne, however, the openings are really separate. The two remaining ends (of the superior (@) and external (c) canals) also enter the vestibule separately, so that the three canals enter the vestibule by five openings. III. THE OLFACTORY ORGAN. ORGANON OLFACTUS. The olfactory organ consists of the olfactory mucous mem- brane, in the dorsocaudal part of the nasal cavity. The nasal cavity has been described in connection with the respiratory system. THE INTEGUMENT. 427 IV. THE ORGAN OF TASTE. ORGANON GUSTUS. The sense of taste is located in the mouth-cavity, especially in the mucosa of the tongue and the soft palate. The proper organs of taste are the so-called taste-buds, found on the papilla of the tongue, the soft palate, etc. Their exact distri- bution in the cat has apparently not been worked out. V. THE INTEGUMENT. INTEGUMENTUM COMMUNE. The skin of the cat consists of the usual two layers, the outer epidermis and the inner fibrous corium. The skin is particularly thick and tough about the sides of the neck and face. The skin is covered almost completely with fine soft hairs. Only the end of the nose, the pads on the soles of the feet, and the nipples are without hair. A number of long stiff sen- sory hairs (vibrisse) are found on the upper lip, the cheek, and above the upper eyelid. The pads on the soles of the feet are cushion-like projec- tions of skin, composed largely of connective and elastic tissue and fat. There is one large pad for each foot, and in addition a small pad for each digit. The fore limb has besides a small conical pad which is situated almost exactly over the pisiform bone. The nails are horny outgrowths of the epidermis, covering the distal phalanges. The muscles of the skin are the cutaneus maximus and platysma; these have been described (page 93). The super- ficial facial muscles are differentiations of the skin-muscles. APPENDIX. PRACTICAL DIRECTIONS. Tue following appendix on the dissection and study of the cat is not intended as a general treatise on methods of preservation and dissection, but attempts only to give the application of well-known methods to the dissection and study of the particular animal with which the book deals. General methods which are referred to bu not described must be looked up, if unfamiliar, in the manuals of general methods. Aids to Dissection and Study of the Cat.—A copy of Jayne’s ‘* Mammalian Anatomy ’’ should be in the laboratory for reference. Only the volume on the Bones of the Cat has been issued thus far. Wilder and Gage’s ‘* Anatomical Technology ’’ will be found very useful for methods of work. The plates of Strauss-Durckheim’s ‘*‘ Anatomie du Chat’’ are exceedingly valuable for the bones and muscles, and should be in _ the laboratory if possible. Outline reproductions of these plates have been published by H. S. Williams (G. P. Putnam’s Sons, New York, 1875). The use of both the original plates and the re- productions is made difficult by the antiquated nomenclature used for the structures figured. Method of Use of the Present Directions.—Except in the case of the Bones, the order of study of the structures is usually not the same as the order in which they are described. This is of course due to practical difficulties in dissection. The present directions give the order of study, or at least the order of dissection; of course after dissection the structures can be reviewed in the logical order given in the descriptions. But in the first study and dissection, the student is to use these directions for the order of work, while using the body of the book for the descriptions. It will be necessary therefore to keep the book opened in two places,—one in the appendix, for the directions; one in the body of the book, for descriptions. In studying the muscles, for example, the student will follow the order of dissection given in the appendix, but as every muscle is dissected he will find, confirm, and study the description of that muscle given in the body of the book. Other organs are studied in a similar manner. 429 430 ~- APPENDIX. Before commencing the study, read that portion of the preface which explains the use of /erms of direction (page VII). Note that the page on which any figure is found may be deter- mined by consulting the list of figures given in the Table of Contents. THE BONES. The bones will of course be studied from dried specimens. These may be prepared once for all and kept in the laboratory from year to year. A number of mounted skeletons of the cat should be at hand; these must be prepared by some one who has skill in such work. Preparation of Separate Bones.—For preparing the separate bones the liquid-soap process recommended by Wilder and Gage (‘‘ Ana- tomical Technology,’’ p. 107) will be found most convenient. This is as follows: The skin and soft parts are removed as far as possible without injury to the bones. Make the following ‘‘ liquid-soap ’’ mixture: OM WAM oa Go cA eae eS oe aie e's 2000 cc. SECIS AMIATIICIE Es Sh ea ie iid ss 150 cc. Nitrate of potash (saltpetre).......... 12 grams. vig EE ye Be 1s) SIRS slic epee ene Pn Ape Mg ea RI 75 grams. Heat these together till a homogeneous mixture is formed. Now immerse the bone or bones to be cleaned in a liquid composed of four parts water to one part of the above liquid-soap mixture. Boil forty minutes; pour off the liquid and renew it. Boil about half an hour longer; then remove soft parts with fingers, scalpel, and brush. The bones may be boiled as much longer in the mixture as is neces- sary to make the soft parts come away easily. If they are boiled too long, however, the epiphyses will separate from the bones. This is especially likely to occur in young skeletons, which must therefore not be boiled so long as the bones of an old cat. Skeletons prepared in the following rough way are useful for many purposes. The entire body of the cat, or a single limb, is placed in the liquid-soap mixture (after partial removal of soft parts), and boiled till the muscles may be removed, but the ligaments, holding the bones together, remain. Clean thoroughly without removing the ligaments, and allow to dry. The bones are thus held together in their natural positions. Skeletons so prepared are not elegant, but are frequently useful. Disarticulation of Skulls.—TYhe bones of the skull may be sepa- rated as follows: Clean the skull in the liquid-soap mixture, as above described. Then fill the cranial cavity with dry rice, beans, corn, or some other seeds that swell much on imbibition of water. Cork up the foramen magnum, and place the skull for twelve to twenty-four hours in water. The swelling of the grain will partially PRACTICAL DIRECTIONS. 431 separate the bones at the sutures. The bones may then usually be separated completely by hand. Entire skulls, and longitudinal sections, as represented in Fig. 43, p. 60, should be at hand. Study of the Bones.—The bones should be studied in the order in which they are described. No further special directions for their study are necessary. Study of Ligaments.—It will usually not be practicable for each student to make the dissections and preparations necessary for study- ing the ligaments. Rather should these be examined on demonstra- tion preparations preserved in the laboratory. Such preparations may most easily be made by using fresh material, and dissecting away muscles and other tissues, leaving only the ligaments connect- ing the bones. The preparations are then preserved in one or two per cent. formalin. It is difficult to prepare the ligaments satisfac- torily on preserved material, because they do not stand out clearly from other tissues in such material, so that they are not easily dis- tinguishable. MUSCLES. Preparation and Preservation of Material.—Formalin forms by far the most satisfactory preservative for anatomical material. It is much better in almost every respect than alcohol, and has the additional advantage of being much cheaper. After injecting with formalin, the cat may be preserved either immersed in a weaker solution of the same substance, or may be kept for a long time simply wrapped in a cloth dampened with formalin. The details of preparation differ according to which method is to be used. In either case, the cat should be killed with chloroform, by placing it in a tight jar or box with a cloth or bit of cotton saturated with chloroform. It is not necessary to bleed the specimen. When the cat is dead, remove it to a tray, place it on its back, and tie the limbs loosely so that they will remain outspread. i Expose the femoral artery in the thigh, as follows: Make a median longitudinal incision through the skin of the abdomen, from a point an inch or two caudad of the xiphoid process to the pubis. Make an incision passing from near the middle of this obliquely laterad onto the thigh, for about three inches. Reflect the two flaps in the angles between these cuts, then with forceps and tracer isolate the femoral artery just as it passes into the thigh (Fig. 127, a). Make with scissors an oblique incision in one side of the artery, one- half to one inch from the point where it leaves the abdominal cavity. Introduce a canula directed toward the body, and tie it in place, 1. If the cat is to be preserved immersed in a solution of formalin, it should now be injected with a five per cent. solution of commercial formalin in ordinary water (commercial formalin 5 parts; 432 APPENDIX. water 95 parts). Into an adult cat 300 to 400 cubic centimeters of the five per cent. formalin should be injected. The cat may now be preserved in a one per cent. solution of formalin. Before immersing it in the formalin it is well to remove the hair in some way, otherwise this will hold much water and be very inconvenient in dissection. ‘The neatest method is to cut off the hair with scissors; this takes some time, however. If the skin- muscles (p. 93) are not to be dissected, the skin may be removed. It is well in this case to leave the skin on the sides of the head and on the feet. It is not necessary to open the abdominal cavity, after injecting with the five per cent. formalin. If there is at any time reason to ‘suspect that the viscera are not keeping well, the abdominal and thoracic cavities should be filled with five per cent. formalin by making a small hole through the body wall into the cavity, introduc- ing a canula, and injecting till the cavity is full. The specimen should be kept in a jar or other vessel and should be completely immersed beneath the one per cent. formalin. Any parts projecting above the fluid may be attacked by mould. Ifa part is found to be moulded, it should be submerged, when the mould will be killed. The mould injures the specimen if allowed to grow for a long time, but if discovered soon, no very serious harm results, During dissection, exposed parts of the body should be kept from drying by covering with a damp cloth. Specimens preserved in formalin dry out much less quickly than those preserved in alcohol. 2. For some.purposes it is much more convenient to preserve the material without immersing it in a vessel of formalin. Specimens injected with five per cent. formalin, as above directed, would usually keep perfectly without further treatment, but for two difficulties: (1) the specimen may dry, (2) it may be attacked by mould. The drying may be prevented as follows: Use for injecting a mixture of the five per cent. formalin with one-sixth its volume of glycerine. This will dry only very slowly, and if pains are taken to keep exposed parts covered with cloths dampened with the mixture of formalin and glycerine, there will be no trouble from this source. The skin should not be removed from such specimens except as necessary in the course of dissection. The hair will give little trouble, because dry. The specimens should be kept in a tight box, that the fluid may not evaporate rapidly from the cioths used for wrapping, The attacks of the mould present a difficulty not so easily over- come. As long as the specimens are in daily use for dissection, and exposed parts kept covered with cloths saturated with the glycerine and formalin mixture, little or no trouble is to be anticipated. But if the specimens are left untouched for some days, and particularly if exposed surfaces are not kept covered in the manner above recom- PRACTICAL DIRECTIONS. 433 mended, mould is almost sure to attack them. Material neglected for a week may thus be ruined. If mould is found at any time to be attacking the material, the attacked part should be cleaned and well wrapped in cloths saturated in the formalin-glycerine mixture. If such means are unavailing, the specimen should be immersed in a vessel of one per cent. formalin and preserved for the future in this. Recourse should be had at once also to this method of preservation if the specimen shows signs of decomposition by having a strong odor. It seems probable that the attacks of the mould might be prevented by mixing some fungicide with the injecting fluid; experi- ments should be made in this direction. There are many advantages in preserving the material if possible without immersing it. All parts retain their color and _ pliability much more completely, so that the different structures are much more easily distinguishable. ‘The method above described, by the use of formalin and glycerine, is to be recommended when the material is to be worked on every day or so and is not to be kept longer than a few weeks. It is usually not very satisfactory in warm weather, however. If some method can be devised of entirely pre- venting the attacks of the mould, this will be an excellent method of preserving anatomical material. The same specimens used for the study of the muscles will serve also for the spinal cord and brain if prepared by one of the methods above described. (For the viscera, blood-vessels, and nerves, other specimens will have to be prepared; for these, directions are given later. “nacles to be Dissected.—I\t will probably usually be impossible in a given course of study to dissect all the muscles of the cat. The instructor will of course select such as seem most advisable to him. The following may perhaps be recommended as a good selection for a fairly extensive course: Muscles of the Fore Limbs (pp. 436—- 439); Muscles of the Neck and the Deep Muscles of the Head (pp. 439-441); Muscles of the Wall of the Thorax and of the Abdomen (pp. 441-442); Muscles on the Ventral Side of the Neck (p. 442). If the superficial facial muscles (excluding those of the ear) can be studied from a preparation, this willbe a valuable addition to a course (pp. 434-435). DISSECTION OF MUSCLES. General.—In dissecting muscles a prime requisite of successful dissection is to keep the muscles c/ean. Fat, connective tissue, etc., is to be carefully but thoroughly cleared away from the surface of muscles and from between them. Frequently when it seems impossi- ble to distinguish the structures described, all difficulty will vanish as soon as the dissection is thoroughly cleaned. 434 APPENDIX. In transecting a muscle, work under it completely from one edge to the other (except in case of very wide muscles), then introduce the scissors or scalpel, and cut it by a smooth clean cut. Always leave the entire origin with one-half of the muscle, the entire inser- tion with the other half. The student must be prepared to find in some cases considerable variations from the conditions described. The descriptions attempt to give an account of the wswa/ structures, but specimens showing no variations whatever are undoubtedly rare. DIRECTIONS FOR DISSECTING THE MUSCLES OF THE CAT. I. THE SKIN-MUSCLEs (pp. 93-96, and Fig. 62). These will perhaps not usually be dissected. If they are to be dissected, proceed as follows: Make a ventral median longitudinal incision of the skin from the cranial end of the manubrium to a point opposite the crest of the ilium. Connect the cranial end of this incision with the middle of the lambdoidal ridge by a similar incision through the skin. Make another incision from the manubrium to the spinous process of the thirteenth thoracic vertebra. Connect the caudal end of the first incision by an oblique cut with the root of the tail. Make another incision from the convexity of the knee- joint along the fold of skin which connects the hind limb and body, as far as the incision which leads to the root of the tail. Make an incision surrounding the base of the forelimb. Now reflect these flaps one at a time, working in general from the ventral side toward the dorsal middle line. Take great pains not to take up the thin skin-muscle with the skin. In this way all of one side of the body will be uncovered. The cutaneus maximus (Fig. 62, 4) and a part of the platysma (Fig. 62, a) will be thus exposed. Read and verify the descriptions of these muscles (pp. 93-96). The cranial portion of the platysma cannot be seen at this stage, but should be dissected in connection with the muscles of the face. II. SuperriciAL MuscLes oF THE Face AND HEap (pp. 96-107, and Figs. 63 and 64). These will perhaps not usually be dissected by the student. They should be studied on a well-dissected laboratory preparation, if possible. If they are to be dissected, this should be done if possible on a fresh specimen, as it is very difficult to dissect them on preserved material. Proceed as follows: The skin should be removed with care from the sides and top of the face and head, without injury to the external ear. 1. The platysma (p. 95, and Fig. 62, a). Determine its cranial attachments. 2. The intermedius scutulorum (p. 96, and Fig. 63, a). PRACTICAL DIRECTIONS. 435 3. The corrugator supercilii medialis (Fig. 63, 4). 4. The orbicularis oculi (Fig. 63, c; Fig. 64, s). 5. The corrugator supercilii lateralis (Fig. 64, &). 6. Notice the frontoauricularis if it exists. 7. The levator auris longus (Fig. 63, g, g’). Transect and 8. The auricularis superior (Fig. 63, 4). Transect. g. The abductor auris longus (Fig. 63, m). Transect. 10, The abductor auris brevis (Fig. 63, 7). Transect. ‘11. The epicranius (Fig. 63, 4,2’). In dissecting this muscle the intermedius scutulorum and corrugator supercilii medialis may be cut by an incision parallel to the middle line but a short distance to one side of it. 12. The zygomaticus (Fig. 64, 7). This and the two following muscles may usually be best seen running beneath the fibres of the platysma, without reflecting the latter. If necessary, however, the platysma may be transected and reflected, though this can be done only with great difficulty. 13. The submentalis (Fig. 64, c). 14. The depressor conche (Fig. 64, 4 The zygomaticus, submentalis, and depressor conche should now be transected one or two centimeters from the external ear. The corrugatores supercilii lateralis and medialis may be cut across between the eye and the ear, and reflected. There is thus exposed: 15. The frontoscutularis. Transect near the scutiform cartilage. 16. The adductor auris inferior (Fig. 64, 0). Transect near its insertion. The external ear is now attached to the head only by the external auditory meatus and the tragicus lateralis muscle. Read the descrip- tion of the latter (p. 418, and Fig. 67, @), find it beneath the fat which surrounds the proximal portion of the external ear, and cut it as far ventrad as possible. Now cut across the cartilaginous auditory meatus as near to the tympanic bone as possible, and remove the external ear, preserving it for future study. (The remainder of the muscles of the external ear may be studied in connection with the study of the auditory organ.) 17. The orbicularis oris (p. 105 and Fig. 64, z). 18. The zygomaticus minor, if it exists (p. 105, and Fig. 64, e). 19. The quadratus labii superioris (p. 105). a. The levator labii superioris proprius (Fig. 64, /). 6. The levator labii superioris aleque nasi (Fig. 64, g). 20. The caninus (p. 106, and Fig. 64, St’). 21. The buccinator (p. 106). 22. The myrtiformis (p. 106, and Fig. 64, 4). 23. The ‘‘ moustachier ”’ (p. 107). 24. The quadratus labii inferioris (p. 107). 436 _ APPENDIX. III. Muscies oF THE Fore Lime. A. Muscles connecting the Arm with the Body.—If{ the skin- muscles have been dissected, as above, cut the cutaneus maximus near its insertion, and reflect it toward the median dorsal line; in this way remove it completely. Remove the platysma in the same way. The first layer of body-muscles is thus exposed. If the skin-muscles are not to be dissected, these may be removed with the skin. If the skin has not yet been removed, proceed as follows: Beginning at the cranial end of the manubrium make two incisions in the skin, one passing to the lambdoidal ridge and the other to the spinous process of the thirteenth thoracic vertebra, Raise the triangular flap thus formed, taking up the skin-muscles with it. 1. The trapezius group of muscles (pp. 115-117, and Fig. 68, d, h, and) is now exposed and may be dissected. Begin with the spinotrapezius (Fig. 68, 7). Read the description of the muscle, then raise its caudal border and work under it until its cranial border is reached and the middle of its inner surface is free. Then transect it, and reflect the two halves of the muscle toward the origin and insertion, clearing the fat, etc., from the inner surface of the muscle and the parts covered by it. Determine origin and insertion. 2. The acromiotrapezius (Fig. 68, 4). Dissect in the same manner, being careful not to injure the broad thin tendon which connects the two muscles across the middle line. 3. The clavotrapezius (Fig. 68, 7). Separate it carefully, from the cleidomastoid (p. 120). Transect and reflect, as before. 4. The occipitoscapularis (Fig. 73, a, p. 149). Note the strong fascia which separates it from the deeper muscles of the neck. Be careful not to injure adjacent muscles in tracing this toward origin and insertion. Transect. 5. The rhomboideus. Transect. Recognize the levator scapule ventralis (Fig. 68, 7), the sterno- mastoid (Fig. 68, c; Fig. 65, g), and the cleidomastoid (Fig. 65, 4). Then dissect— 6. The levator scapulz ventralis (Fig. 68, 7). Its origin (Fig. 72, c, c’) cannot be seen at this stage and should be left until the cervical muscles are dissected. Be careful in transecting this muscle to separate it well from the cleidomastoid. Transect. 7. The cleidomastoid (Fig. 65, 4). Its origin cannot be fully seen at this stage. Transect. Make a midventral incision of the skin from the cranial end of the manubrium to a point opposite the crest of the ilium. From the caudal end of this incision make an incision to the root of the tail. From the cranial end of the incision in the ventral middle line make a cut around the base of the fore limb on its caudal side, thus con- ee 2 PRACTICAL DIRECTIONS. 437 necting the ventral incision with the incision which passes between the manubrium and the thirteenth thoracic vertebra, Make another incision from the convexity of the knee at the joint along the fold of the skin which connects the hind limb and body, to the incision which leads to the root of the tail. Reflect the flaps thus formed so as to expose the body and flank, removing the skin-muscle with the skin. 8. The latissimus dorsi (p. 121, and Fig. 68, m). Dissect it up and transect it. Work carefully toward its insertion and note the origin from its outer surface in the axilla of a part of the cutaneus maximus, and at about the same place of a thin muscle, the epitrochlearis (p. 164, and Fig. 65, 7), wz‘hout determining the inser- tion of the latissimus. g. Dissect the pectoralis group of muscles (Fig. 65, and p. 144), i.e., the pectoantibrachialis (Fig. 65, m), the pectoralis major (/), pectoralis minor (0), and xiphihumeralis (9). Determine the border of each muscle before lifting it, then work it up at its middle, transect it, and work toward its ends, determin- ing origin and insertion, Refer constantly to the skeleton. 10. Then recognize the teres major (p. 163, and Fig. 75, d; Fig. 77, c) and the common insertion of the teres major and latissimus (Fig. 79, @'); find the bicipital arch (Fig. 65, ¢’) and determine its composition (p. 166). 11 and 12. The serratus anterior and levator scapule (Fig. 73, A and z, and p. 122). In order to expose the origin of these muscles, the external oblique muscle (Fig. 68, #) must be recognized, and that part of it which has its origin from the fourth to the ninth rib should be transected about an inch and a half from its origin and reflected. The thoracic portion of the rectus abdominis (Fig. 73, 4) and of the scalenus (Fig. 73, 7/"") should also be recognized and then raised at their outer borders and displaced toward the median line. Vo part of any of these muscles should be removed or cut except as directed. The serratus anterior and levator scapulze should be transected and reflected to get at their origin and insertion. B. Muscles of the Arm (p. 156).—The arm is thus removed from the body and the dissection may be continued on the separated arm, 13. The clavobrachial (Fig. 65, 4, and p. 157). Its origin is best seen later. Dissect it up, but do not transect it. Search now with great care for the coracobrachialis. Consult the figures (Fig. 79, c) and descriptions (p. 164), and be especially care- ful not to injure the long head of the muscle and its tendon. 14. Dissect the coracobrachialis (Fig. 77, f). Cut and reflect it. 15. The subscapularis (Fig. 77, 2, and p. 161). Near its glenoid end, its glenoid and coracoid borders are separated by triangular intervals from the adjacent muscles. Transect the muscle by a line connecting the apices of these triangles. Carry an incision from the 438 APPENDIX. middle of this one to the middle of the vertebral border of the scapula, and reflect the muscle on both sides of this incision,—thus determining its area of origin. Reflect the humeral end without injuring the capsule of the joint. 16. Dissect the supraspinatus (Fig. 75, a, and p. 159). Cut the strong fascia free from the border of the scapula and its spine. Then transect the muscle and reflect it, being careful not to injure the capsule of the joint. 17. The spinodeltoideus (Fig. 75, e, and p. 156). Find its two borders, beginning with the caudal one. In freeing the very short cranial border do not injure the acromiodeltoideus (Fig. 75, /). Transect and reflect the spinodeltoid. 18. The acromiodeltoideus (p. 157, and Fig. 75, 7). Transect and reflect. 19. The infraspinatus (p. 160, and Fig. 75, ¢). Locate the borders in the region of the great scapular notch. It is difficult to separate the glenoid border from the adjacent teres minor (Fig. 80, c). The separation should be begun at the humerus. Transect the muscle at the great scapular notch and reflect. Be careful not to injure the teres minor (Fig. 80,-c). 20. The teres major (p. 163, and Fig, 75, d; Fig. 77, c) should be cut near its junction with the latissimus dorsi (Fig. 77, e). 21. The teres minor (Fig. 80, c, and p. 161) need not be cut. 22. The epitrochlearis (p. 164, and Fig. 65, 7). 2 3: The triceps (p. 166). (a) The long head of the triceps (Fig. 77, 1; Fig. 75, g). Find first its medial border and separate it from the medial head. Note the union of its lateral surface with the dor- sal border of the lateral head by strong fascia, and then cut the fascia. (4) The lateral head (Fig. 75, 4). (c) The medial head (Fig. 79, g, 2, and/). 24. The anconeus (p. 170, and Fig. 80, 7). 25. The brachioradialis (p. 173, and Fig. 75, &). Reflect it carefully to its origin and insertion. 26. The biceps (Fig. 77, g, and p. 165). The capsule of the shoulder-joint may be opened in order to expose its origin. Its insertion cannot be seen at this stage. 27. The brachialis (Figs. 75 and 79, z, and p. 166). Work under it near its union with the clavobrachial; cut it at that point and re- flect it. 28. Extensor carpi radialis longus (p. 173, and Fig. 75, 7). Note the oblique tendon on the radial side of the wrist near the insertion of the brachioradialis. A second tendon passes beneath its distal border. This tendon may be separated into a deep and superficial portion. The latter may be traced proximad to its muscle, the extensor carpi radialis longus. 29. Extensor carpi radialis brevis (p. 174). Its tendon is the deeper of the two tendons seen when isolating the tendon of the extensor longus. PRACTICAL DIRECTIONS. 439 30. Extensor communis digitorum (p. 174, and Fig. 75, m). 31. Extensor lateralis digitorum (p. 175, and Fig. 75, 7). 32. Extensor carpi ulnaris (p. 176, and Fig. 75, 0). 33. Extensor indicis (p. 176, and Fig. 85, c). 34. Pronator teres (p. 179, and Fig. 77, ¢). 35. Flexor carpi radialis (p. 179, and Fig. 77, 7). The tendon of the flexor carpi radialis should not be traced to its insertion until the deep muscles of the palm of the hand have been dissected. 36. Abductor brevis pollicis (p. 184, and Fig. 77, w). 37. Flexor carpi ulnaris (p. 180, and Fig. 77, 7). 38. Palmaris longus (p. 179. and Fig. 77, s). In dissecting this muscle be careful not to injure the part of the flexor sublimis (Fig. 77, x) that rises from its surface (see flexor sublimis, p. 181). Cut the palmaris proximad of the origin of the flexor sublimis and reflect it. 39. Flexor sublimis digitorum (p. 181 and Fig. 77, x). Trace one or two of the tendons through the sheaths on the ventral surfaces of the first phalanges. Cut and reflect the radial portion, 40. Flexor profundus digitorum (p. 181, and Fig. 77, uw). After recognizing the parts cut through the tendons of the first and fifth parts and reflect them to determine their origin. Then cut through the common tendon so as to reflect the other three parts together. Trace one or two of the tendons to the distal end of the digit. 41. The supinator (p. 177, and Fig. 85, 4). 42. The extensor brevis pollicis (p. 178, and Fig. 85, a). 43. Pronator quadratus (p. 183, and Fig. 87, a The insertion of the brachialis and clavobrachial (Fig. 87, c) and of the biceps (Fig. 87, 4) should now be examined. There remain to be dissected the small muscles of the palm of the hand. If these have been injured on the side dissected, the hand of the other side may be used. 44. The lumbricals (p. 184, and Fig. 88, /). 45. The flexor brevis pollicis (p. 184, and Fig. 89, a). 46. The adductor pollicis (p. 185, and Fig. 89, 4). 47. The abductor digiti quinti (p. 185, and Fig. 89, 2). 48. The flexor brevis digiti quinti (p. 186, and Fig. 89, 2). Cut and reflect it. 49. The opponens digiti quinti (p. 186, and Fig. 89, g). Cut and reflect it. 50. The interossei (p. 185, and Fig. 89). IV. MuscLes oF THE NECK AND THE DEEP MUSCLES OF THE HEAD. If the superficial muscles of the head have been dissected accord- ing to the directions above given (p. 434), the skin of the head and neck, and the external ear, will have been removed, and the speci- men is ready for further study. The parotid and submaxillary glands 440 APPENDIX. (Fig. 65, 1 and 2) should be removed if this has not been done; also the lymphatic glands (Fig. 65, 3). If the superficial muscles of the head have not been dissected and are not to be, remove the skin from the side of the neck, head, and face to the median dorsal line, removing the thin superficial muscles with the skin. Remove also the parotid, submaxillary, and lym- phatic glands (Fig. 65, 1,2, and 3), and cut through the ear-muscles and the cartilaginous auditory meatus (under direction) and remove the external ear. Clean fat, connective tissue, etc., from the surface of the muscles of the thorax, neck, and head; then dissect as follows: 1. The sternomastoid (p. 139, and Fig. 65, g). Transect and reflect it. z. The cleidomastoid (p. 120, and Fig. 65, 4). This has already been transected; examine now its origin. Remove the large lymphatic gland beneath the sternomastoid and close to the tympanic bulla, and clean the surface of the muscles in this region. 3. The levator scapulz ventralis (p. 120, and Fig. 72, ¢, c’, c’). This has already been cut; study now its origin. 4. The sternohyoid (p. 140, and Fig. 65, e). In raising it begin at the cranial end and take care not to injure the subjacent sterno- thyroid (Fig. 65, g’). Transect. 5. The sternothyroid (p. 141, and Fig. 65, g’). Transect. 6. The stylohyoid (p. 112, and Fig. 65, d). Transect. 7. The digastric (p. 107, and Fig, 65, 4). Transect, and reflect completely, to the origin and insertion. ; 8. The mylohyoid (p. 114, and Fig. 65, c). Transect and reflect. g. The geniohyoid (p. 113, and Fig. 67, g). 10. The jugulohyoid (p. 113, and Fig. 67, 4). (The extrinsic muscles of the tongue (p. 228, and Figs. 67 and 96) may be dissected at this point, if desired. (a) The styloglossus; (2) the genioglossus; (c) the hyoglossus. They need not be cut. ) _ 11. The masseter (p. 108, and Fig. 65, a). Cut the superficial and middle layers near their insertions by incisions parallel to the border of the jaw. Cut the deep layer near its origin. Look for the origin of fibres of the temporal muscle from the inner surface of the middle layer. 12. The temporal (p. 110, and Fig. 63, ~). Clear its outer sur- face completely. Cut the temporal fascia transversely and reflect it toward the insertion of the muscle, with the superficial portion of the muscle. Cut through the zygomatic arch at its two ends and remove it, dissecting the fibres of the temporal free from their origin on its inner surface. Then examine the insertion of the temporal. (The muscles of the pharynx (p. 232) may be dissected at this point; for directions, see page 451.) 13. The ceratohyoid (p. 115). To uncover this, the middle constrictor of the pharynx (Fig. 67, 7) must be cut and reflected. PRACTICAL DIRECTIONS. 441 Cut the mylohyoid, geniohyoid, genioglossus, and the mucosa of the floor of the mouth free from the mandible on both sides, so that the tongue and the floor of the mouth may be drawn ventrad and turned out of the way, exposing the roof of the mouth (as in Fig. 66, p. 112). Cut through one side of the pharynx near the ventral surface and turn the tongue toward the uncut side, The roof of the mouth is thus exposed. Dissect next— 14. The pterygoid muscles (Fig. 66). Remove the mucosa of the roof of the mouth, especially at the sides of the soft palate, and the two pterygoid muscles (p. 111) are exposed. The lower jaw ' may be removed on one side to get at their origin. (The muscles of the soft palate (p. 230, and Fig 66, d and e), and the superior constrictor of the pharynx (p. 233, and Fig. 66, /) may be observed at this point, if desired. ) V. MuscLes oF THE WALL OF THE THORAX AND OF THE ABDOMEN. 1. The scalenus (p. 141, and Fig. 73, 7/7"). To trace its cervical portion, cut the trachea and cesophagus just craniad of the first rib, cut the pharynx and hyoid free from the ventral side of the head and neck, and remove the pharynx, larynx, cesophagus, and trachea (these should be preserved for future study of the larynx). 2. The transversus costarum (p. 150, and Fig. 73, 7). 3. The serratus posterior superior (p. 148, and Fig. 73, 7). Transect this at about the middle of the muscle-bundles, and reflect it in both directions. 4. The serratus posterior inferior (p. 148, and Fig. 73, 2). Transect and reflect as in the last. 5. The external oblique (p. 153, and Fig. 68, f). Transect it by an incision parallel to its tendon of origin and about an inch from it, and reflect in both directions. 6. The internal oblique (p. 154, and Fig. 73, 0). Transect and reflect as above. 7. The transversus (p. 155, and Fig. 69, 7). Requires no further dissection. 8. The rectus abdominis (p. 155, and Fig. 73, &). Open its sheath by a longitudinal incision near the linea alba. g. The external intercostals (p. 150, and Fig. 73, m; Fig. 69, 7). To see these, remove the origins of the levator scapule and serratus anterior; also the serratus posterior superior. 10. The internal intercostals (p. 151, and Fig. 69, °%). To uncover these, remove the external intercostals from between two or three pairs of ribs. 11. The transversus thoracis (p. 151). To see this muscle, which lies on the inner surface of the thoracic wall, it is necessary to cut through the ribs on one side one or two inches from the sternum, and open the thorax. The muscle can then be observed directly. (The levatores costarum will be dissected later.) 442 APPENDIX VI. MuscLEs ON THE VENTRAL SIDE OF THE VERTEBRAL COLUMN IN THE Neck Recion (Fig. 72). Clean the surface of these muscles, removing pharynx, larynx, cesophagus, and trachea, if this has not been done. 1. Longus capitis (p. 142, and Fig. 72, a). 2. Longus colli (p. 144, and Fig. 72, g', g’). 3. Levator scapule ventralis (p. 120, and Fig. 72, c’, c’). Observe its origin. 4. Rectus capitis anterior minor (p. 143, and Fig. 72, 6). To see this, cut through on one side the longus capitis and one head of the levator scapulz ventralis, and remove the proximal portions, as in Fig. 72. 5. Obliquus capitis superior (p. 136, and Fig. 72, e). 6. Rectus capitis lateralis (p. 143, and Fig. 72, 2). VII. Muscies oF THE Back (p. 123). Remove what remains of the dorsal portion of the latissimus dorsi, serratus posterior superior, and serratus posterior inferior. See that the skin is removed completely to the dorsal middle line, or even for a little distance over onto the other side. There is thus exposed the lumbodorsal fascia (p. 126), covering the muscles of the back. Cut the superficial layer of the lumbodorsal fascia (that from which the latissimus dorsi and obliquus externus abdominis have origin) by an incision parallel to the dorsal median line, and remove it. The muscles of the back are thus exposed (Fig. 69). Observe in the lumbar region the longissimus dorsi (/, /’, 7"); in the thoracic region the longissimus dorsi, the spinalis dorsi (g), and the iliocostal (2); in the cervical region the splenius (Fig. 73, 4). 1. The longissimus dorsi (p. 126, and Fig. 69, 4, 7’, 7”). Notice in the lumbar region the strong deep layer of the lumbodorsal fascia, by which this muscle is covered, and from the under side of which many of the fibres of the muscle take origin. Cut this fascia by an incision parallel to the dorsal median line and about two centimeters from it, from the level of the crest of the ilium as far craniad as the fascia can be cut without cutting into the muscle-fibres (usually to about the level of the last rib). Reflect the medial division of the fascia to the middle line. Reflect the lateral division -of the fascia until it passes into the muscle and cannot be farther reflected. Observe then in the lumbar region the medial (Fig. 70, a) and lateral (Fig. 70, 4) divisions of the longissimus dorsi, and the portion (') of the lateral division taking origin from the lumbodorsal fascia (c). Dissect apart some of the muscle-fibres of the longissimus and observe their origin and insertion. Trace the longissimus dorsi into the thoracic and cervical regions PRACTICAL DIRECTIONS. 443 (Fig. 69, 7’, 7”), noting the separation off from it on the dorsal side of the spinalis dorsi (Fig. 69, g); on the ventral side of the iliocostal (Fig. 69, 4). 2. The extensor caudz lateralis (p. 137, and Fig. 70, /). Uncover this by cutting the lumbodorsal fascia over the sacral region. 3. The iliocostalis (p. 128, and Fig. 69, #). Uncover this completely; note its connection with the longissimus dorsi at the caudal end. Dissect apart some of its muscle-bundles, to see origin and insertion. 4. The splenius (p. 131, and Fig. 73, 6). Transect this by an incision beginning at its lateral border about four centimeters from the cranial end of the muscle and extending obliquely craniodorsad to the craniomedial angle of the muscle. Be careful not to injure the longissimus capitis (Fig. 73, g). 5. The longissimus capitis (p. 131, and Fig. 73, g). Transect. 6. The spinalis dorsi (p. 129, and Fig. 69, g). Separate some of its muscle-fibre bundles and trace to origin and insertion. 7. The biventer cervicis (p. 132, and Fig. 69, a). Raise its lateral border, turning it toward the middle line, and transect it near its caudal end. 8. The complexus (p. 133, and Fig. 69, 4). Raise its medial border, and transect it near its cranial end. g. The longus atlantis (p. 134, and Fig. 71, /). 10. The multifidus spine (p. 130, and Fig. 70, d). Remove a part of the longissimus dorsi in the lumbar region, and trace the course of the fibres of the multifidus spine. (If desired the entire longissimus may be removed and the multifidus spine completely uncovered. ) 11. The extensor caudz medialis (p. 136, and Fig. 70, e). 12, The semispinalis cervicis (p. 133, and Fig. 71, c). Dissect apart some of its fibre-bundles to see origin and insertion. 13. The interspinales and intertransversarii (p. 131) may be seen in the region from which the longissimus dorsi was removed, by removing the bundles of the multifidus spinz. 14. The rectus capitis posterior major (p. 134, and Fig. 71, a). Transect. 15. The obliquus superior (p. 136, and Fig. 71, e). 16. The obliquus capitis inferior (p. 136, and Fig. 71, 8). 17. The rectus capitis posterior medius (p. 135). Transect. 18. The rectus capitis posterior minor (p. 135). 19. The levatores costarum (p. 150). Remove ina part of the thoracic region a portion of the iliocostal and longissimus dorsi, so as to expose the dorsal ends of the ribs. The levatores costarum will be seen as but slightly separated bundles continuous with the external intercostals. 444 APPENDIX. VIII. Muscres or THE Hinp Limps (p. 186). Remove the skin and superficial fascia from the lateral surface of the thigh. Examine the /ascia /afa (p. 186, and Fig. 68, 2). Dissect : 1. The biceps femoris (p. 194, and Fig. 68, #). Work under its cranial and caudal borders. Find the tenuissimus (Fig. go, g) pass- ing obliquely beneath it and reaching its caudal border in its distal half. Transect the biceps without injuring the tenuissimus, and reflect its halves. 2. The tenuissimus (p. 195, and Fig. go, g). Transect. 3. The caudofemoralis (p. 195, and Fig. 68, s). Transect. 4. The gluteus maximus (p. 187). Transect. 5. The sartorius (p. 197, and Fig. 68, g; Fig. 91, a). Transect. 6. The tensor fasciz late (p. 187, and Fig. 68, 7). Cut the fascia lata along the distal end of the muscle-fibres and reflect the muscle. 7. The gluteus medius (p. 188, and Fig. go, 4). Work under it carefully, separating it from underlying muscles; cut it close to its tendon of insertion, and reflect it. 8. The pyriformis (p. 188, and Fig. 163, 7, p. 401). Cut and reflect it. g. The gemellus superior (p. 189, and Fig. 163, 6). This and the next muscle will sometimes be found to be completely united. Transect. 10. The gluteus minimus (p. 189, and Fig. 163, 5). Transect. 11. The obturator internus (p. 192, and Fig. go, e). Cut it at the dorsal border of the ischium in order to reflect it. The whole origin cannot be seen at this stage. 12. The gemellus inferior (p. 190). 13. The gracilis (p. 198, and Fig. g1, 4). Transect. 14. The semitendinosus (p. 196, and Figs. go and 91, 7; Fig. g2, 7). Transect. 15. The semimembranosus (p. 196, and Figs. go and 91, 2; Fig. 92, 4, h'). Transect. 16. The adductor femoris (p. 198, and Figs. go and g1, 4; Fig. 92, g). Transect. ' 17. The quadratus femoris (p. 191, and Fig. go, f). Transect. 18. The obturator externus (p. 191). 19. The adductor longus (p. 199, and Fig. 92, 7). This and the following will sometimes be found to be almost completely united. Transect. 20. The pectineus (p. 200, and Fig. 92, e). Transect. 21. The iliopsoas (p. 193, and Fig. g1, c; Fig. 92, d). Only its distal part, near the insertion, can be seen at present. 22. The capsularis (p. 190). Transect. 23. The quadriceps femoris (p. 201). Isolate the rectus femoris (Fig. 92, 4) as far as its junction with the vastus lateralis; cut it at PRACTICAL DIRECTIONS. 445 this point and reflect its proximal portion. Turn aside the distal end and find beneath it the transverse aponeurosis between the vastus medialis and the vastus lateralis, and covering the vastus intermedius. The vastus lateralis (Fig. 90, d@) may be cut near the middle and dissected up from its origin in both directions; the vastus intermedius is thus exposed. ‘The vastus medialis (Fig. 92, c) and the vastus intermedius need not be cut. 24. The gastrocnemius (p. 203, and Fig. go, m; Fig. g1, 4). It may be raised cautiously near its middle and divided. Care should be taken not to divide the underlying plantaris (Fig. go, 7). After noting the connection of the outer head with the plantaris, the latter may be divided and reflected, together with the outer head. 25. The plantaris (p. 205, and Figs. go and 91, 7). _ 26. The flexor brevis digitorum (p. 212). In tracing its tendon note the three branches of the common plantar ligament which emerges from between the second and third tendons. ‘The outer branch is inserted into the fascia covering the base of the fifth digit, while the other two spread out into the bilobed pad of the sole. 27, The soleus (p. 205, and Fig. go, 0). Cut and reflect. 28. The popliteus (p. 206, and Fig. g2, &). Cut very near the origin and reflect. The three following deep muscles on the ventral surface of the shank are covered by the deep crural fascia (p. 206) which separates them from the overlying muscles. It should be removed. 29. The flexor longus hallucis (p. 207, and Fig. g1, m). Divide the muscle at its junction with the tendon. Open the canals on the astragalus and calcaneus and reflect the tendon, cutting the tendon of the flexor longus digitorum near its insertion and dividing at the middle the quadratus plant (p. 213) which may be found inserted into its ventral surface. 30. Flexor longus digitorum (p. 208, and Fig. 91, ). This may be divided very near its origin. 31. Tibialis posterior (p. 208, and Fig. 91, 0). This may be divided near its tendon. 32. Peroneus longus (p. 209, and Fig. go, g). The overlying tendons may be cut in tracing its insertion. 33. Peroneus brevis (p. 210, and Fig. go, 5). 34. Peroneus tertius (p. 210, and Fig. go, 7). 35. Extensor longus digitorum (p. 210, and Fig. go, £). 36. Tibialis anterior (p. 211, and Fig. go, 7). 37. The extensor brevis digitorum (p. 212, and Fig. go, 2). 38. The quadratus plantz (p. 213). It was cut in dissecting the flexor longus hallucis. 39. The lumbricales (p. 213). 40. The interossei (with the muscles of the fifth digit) (p. 214). 41. The tarsal muscles (p. 215). The overlying ligaments must be removed in order to expose the scaphocuneiform. 446 APPENDIX. IX. Tue DIAPHRAGM AND THE MUSCLES ON THE VENTRAL SIDE OF THE VERTEBRAL COLUMN IN THE LUMBAR AND PELvic REGIONS. Remove the ventral and lateral walls of the thorax completely, as far back as the diaphragm,—leaving only a ring attached to the margin of the diaphragm. Remove the abdominal walls in the same way, as far back as the pubis, leaving the diaphragm in position. Remove the thoracic viscera (the heart and lungs may be preserved for future study). Remove also the abdominal viscera as far back as the beginning of the pelvis, cutting the large intestine where it passes into the pelvis. The dorsal wall of the abdominal cavity should be cleared of fat, blood-vessels, etc., without injury to the crura of the diaphragm. 1. The diaphragm (p. 151, and Fig. 74). Study by transmitted light, to see the tendons, etc. 2. The psoas minor (p. 139, and Fig. 162, 9, p. 398). Find its tendon and separate it from the iliopsoas (Fig. 162, 8) as far craniad as this can be done without tearing the fibres. 3. The iliopsoas (p. 193, and Fig. 162, 8). Find both portions; isolate them as far as it can be done. 4. The quadratus lumborum (p. 139). Free the lateral edge of the iliopsoas from the abdominal wall and turn the whole muscle mediad as far as possible. The bundles of the quadratus lumborum will be found beneath it, against the transverse processes of the lumbar vertebre. With a heavy cartilage-knife separate the two innominate bones along the pelvic symphysis. This is easily done if the knife is inserted exactly into the line of junction of the two bones. Divaricate the edges some distance, so as to make a ventral opening into the pelvic cavity. If necessary, part of the innominate bone of one side may be removed to make the opening larger. Find the thin sheet of fibres forming the levator ani muscle (Fig. 162, 11) at the side of the rectum, attached to the edge of the sym- physis. Carefully free the rectum and urogenital organs from this and remove them as far as the anus, leaving the levator ani intact. 5. The iliocaudalis (p. 137, and Fig. 162, 11’), 6. The levator ani (p. 269, and Fig. 162, 11). Remove with great care the levator ani and iliccaudalis of one side, by cutting first the attachment to the symphysis and the ilium, turning the muscle mediad, then cutting the attachment to the tail. There are thus exposed on the lateral wall of the thorax the medial surface of the obturator internus, craniad of it the pyriformis, caudad of it the quadratus femoris. Dorsad of these is the abductor caudz internus. 7. The abductor caudz internus (p. 137). On the ventral surface of the tail are exposed the oliowing: 8. The flexor caudz longus (p. 138, and Fig. 162, 12). g. The flexor caudz brevis (p. 138, and Fig. 162, 13). PRACTICAL DIRECTIONS. 447 X. Muscies or THE Tait (p. 136). By removing the skin of the tail, all the muscles of the tail are now easily seen. I, 2, 3, 4, 5—see 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, above (IX). 6. The abductor caudez externus (p. 137, and Fig. 113, 4; Fig. 70, &): 7. The extensor caudz lateralis (p. 137, and Fig. 70, /). 8. The extensor caudze medialis (p. 136, and Fig. 70, e). THE VISCERA. Kill the specimen with chloroform and inject with the five per cent. formalin, or the mixture of formalin and glycerine, as for the muscles. (It is an advantage if the preliminary examination of the viscera can be done in a perfectly fresh, uninjected specimen; such a specimen can be kept but a day or two, however. After one day’s examination the skin may be removed and the specimen placed in two per cent. formalin; it will usually be fairly well preserved by this, though the formalin is too strong to make the later dissection pleasant. The specimen cannot be preserved in this manner unless the skin is removed, and a sufficient quantity of formalin used. ) PRELIMINARY EXAMINATION OF THE VISCERA. (In this preliminary examination the descriptions in the text need not be read, except when this is specially directed.) Wet the hair along a line from the symphysis of the jaw to the pubis. Part it and make a longitudinal incision through the skin along the line. Make a transverse incision of the skin five centimeters caudad of the xiphoid process and reflect the flaps. Incise the body wall from the last rib to the pelvis along the same line as above and also transversely. Reflect the flaps without injuring the ligaments of the bladder. Make an incision through the pectoral muscles between the first rib and the ventral attachment of the diaphragm and about one centimeter from the median line. Make a second incision of the muscles from the cranial end of the first incision along the angles of the ribs to near the dorsolateral attachment of the diaphragm. Cut the ribs and thoracic wall along these incisions with strong scissors; connect the two incisions at their caudal ends, and remove the lateral thoracic wall thus circumscribed. Note the thoracic and abdominal cavities, separated by the diaphragm. Note the following viscera in their fresh condition: A. In the abdominal cavity (without injuring anything) 1. The liver, dark red and lobed, in the cranial part of the cavity, lying against the diaphragm. 2. The gall-bladder partly imbedded in the right median lobe. 3. Displacing the liver craniad, the stomach is seen dorsad of its left lobe. It may extend dorsad of the right lobe, its size depending on the degree of distension, > 448 APPENDIX. 4. The duodenum or first part of the small intestine leaves the stomach at its right side craniad and makes a U bend, the head of which is directed caudad; it then turns toward the middle line dorsad of the remaining part of the small intestine. 5. The great omentum isa thin fold of peritoneum with many bands of fat. It passes like a curtain from the great curvature of the stomach ventrad of the coils of the small intestine (ileum). It is tucked beneath the mass of coils at the sides and caudally, and folds of it extend between the individual coils. Turn it craniad and note— 6. The numerous coils of the third part of the small intestine or ileum. Turn these to one side and note— 7. The connection of the ileum with the duodenum across the middle line. An indefinite part of the intestine between the ileum and duodenum is called the jejunum, because in man it is found empty after death. 8. The passage of the ileum into the side of the large intestine which begins on the right side just caudad of the loops of the duodenum. The first part of the large intestine is the colon. It may be traced first toward the head (ascending colon), then sinistro- caudad (transverse colon) and then caudad (descending colon). The descending colon returns to the middle line and the large intestine then continues to the anus as the rectum. The blind pouch of the colon which lies caudad of the opening of the ileum is the czecum. g. Turn the duodenum toward the left and note the pancreas, a light red, elongated organ which stretches.along the greater curva- ture of the stomach and thence between the two lines of the duodenal U to its bottom. 10. The spleen, parallel to the gastric portion of the pancreas. It is deep red (darker than the pancreas and not so brown as the liver) and is held against the great curvature of the stomach by a part of the great omentum. 11. The kidneys, close against the dorsal body wall and in con- tact with the caudal part of the liver. 12. The bladder, in the median line at the caudal end of the cavity, held in place by the suspensory ligament, which passes to the midventral line, and by the lateral ligaments. 13. The mesenteric glands, large grayish-red glands one to four centimeters long, more numerous in the mesocolon. 14. In the female, lying against the ventral surface of the rectum, the uterus. It divides into two horns which diverge. Near the end of each horn the ovary. 15. The peritoneum. Study and understand the description of it (p. 218). Dissect some of it free from the body wall. (Trace the folds by aid of a diagram and model.) B. In the thoracic cavity: 1. The lungs. Each is divided into lobes, three on the left, four on the right. The caudal right lobe pushes the mediastium toward PRACTICAL DIRECTIONS. 449 the left and thus lies in a pocket dorsocaudad of the heart and dorsad of the vena cava inferior. 2. The pleura. Each pleura is a membrane like the peritoneum. It covers the diaphragm and the thoracic walls and is reflected onto the lungs. Hence it is divided into costal and pulmonary portions. Read the description (p. 217) and trace their connection. Each pleura forms a closed sac. 3. The mediastinal septum or median vertical portion formed by the apposition of the medial walls of the two pleural sacs. It divides the thorax into halves. 4. In the mediastinum or space between the halves of the mediastinal septum are seen— a. Ventrally (i.e., in the anterior mediastinum), blood-vessels and fat, and craniad the pink thymus gland. Read the description of the thymus (p. 254, and Fig. 107). 6. Dorsally (i.e., in the posterior mediastinum) the trachea (best seen craniad), the cesophagus (best seen caudad), qnd the aorta. c. In the middle (reckoning in a dorsoventral line) (i.e., in the middle mediastinum) the heart, with the inferior vena cava approaching it from the rear. Prick into the mediastinum and inflate it. Remove the thoracic wall opposite the one already removed, so as to stretch the mediastinum and show it more clearly. Expose the trachea beneath the caudal end of the sternomastoidei. Note the thyroid gland (Fig. 96, 6, p. 229). Insert a blowpipe without injury to the thyroid, and inflate the lungs. Cut the sternum at its caudal end and turn it craniad, cutting the mediastinal septum and noting its double character. Dissect the mediastinal septum from the thymus so as to expose this organ. d. The pericardium, a relatively thick-walled sac, within which the heart lies.. The pericardium is covered by the mediastinal septum on each side, but not dorsally and ventrally. Dissect the mediastinal septum from the pericardium. Prick and inflate the pericardium. Open it and expose the heart. @ DISSECTION OF THE ALIMENTARY CANAL. Study and verify the descriptions of the organs as they are dis- sected. I. Salivary glands (p. 223). 1. Keep the mouth open by a cork between the teeth. Find the papille upon which open the sublingual and submaxillary ducts (pp. 223 and 224); remove the mucosa and enlarge the opening and insert a black bristle into either duct. ‘I'race the duct by the bristle as far as possible on the floor of the mouth, 2. Find the white ridge formed on the cheek by the parotid duct (p. 223). It is opposite the molar tooth, and at its cranial end the 450 APPENDIX. opening of the duct is seen. Enlarge the opening and insert a black bristle as far as possible. 3. Remove the skin and the skin-muscles from the side of the face, beginning at the caudal end and working craniad. At the cranial border of the carotid on the ventral side look carefully for the parotid duct with the bristle in it. The duct is then easily traced by the removal of the skin and muscles. Study the parotid gland (Fig. 131, 10, p. 322). 2 4. Remove the facial vein (Fig. 131, 4 and c) and lymphatic gland (Fig. 131, 12) covering the submaxillary gland (Fig. 131, 11) anid clean its outer surface. Raise it and find the submaxillary duct leaving its inner surface. Reflect the digastric and mylohyoid muscles and trace the duct to the oral mucosa. The remainder of its course is shown by the bristle on the inside of the mouth. 5. The sublingual gland is uncovered in dissecting the submaxil- lary. Its duct is seen by the side of the submaxillary. It may be pricked near the gland and a bristle passed to its opening. 6. The infraorbital gland. Expose it by removal of the zygo- matic arch and masseter muscle. Find its duct by dissecting apart the lobules at its ventral end. Prick the duct and insert a bristle to find its inner opening. “. 7. The molar gland. Find it by raising the orbicularis oris of the lower lip. By raising its ventral border and dissecting between it and the mucosa the ducts may be found and perhaps pricked and bristles inserted. II]. The mouth-cavity. Study the general description (p. 221); the lips and the cheek. Then remove the masseter muscle and the caudal part of the zygoma. Cut through the mandible between the first premolar and the canine tooth. Then disarticulate the mandi- ble, cut the cheek and also the mylohyoid muscle and oral mucosa parallel to the medial border of the mandible, and remove-the mandi- ble with the parts thus left attached to it. The organs in the mouth-cavity are thus left exposed and should be studied. To demonstrate the incisive ducts (p. 222) pass a bristle into them. The teeth (p. 224). These should be studied on a skull in which the roots of the teeth have been laid bare by means of the bone-forceps, as in Figs. 93 and 94. The tongue (p. 226, and Fig. 95). Study its dorsal surface, the, papilla, etc. Then dissect its muscles (p. 228) from the ventral side. The stylohyoid, digastric, and mylohyoid muscles must be removed. Then dissect (2) the styloglossus (Fig. 96, e), (4) the genioglossus (Fig. 96, 7), (c) the hyoglossus (Fig. 96, 4). Make a transverse section of the tongue to see the intrinsic muscle-fibres. III. The thyroid gland (p. 254, and Fig. 96, 6). Clean the sternomastoid muscles. Cut their interdigitating portions along the median line and reflect them. Find the lateral lobe of the thyroid gland beneath the lateral borders of the sternohyoid muscles. Dissect it, being careful not to destroy the delicate isthmus. PRACTICAL DIRECTIONS. 451 IV. The pharynx (p. 231). Remove the large lymphatic gland between the atlantal transverse process and the larynx. Clean the outer surface of the pharynx. Dissect the muscles of the pharynx (p: 232) as follows: ' (a) The inferior constrictor (Fig. 96, &). (2) The middle constrictor (Fig. 96, /). (c) The glossopharyngeus (Fig. 96, 7). {d) The stylopharyngeus (Fig. 96, 7). The superior constrictor cannot well be seen at this point; it will be examined later. Disarticulate the cranial cornu of the hyoid from the bulla tympani and make an incision the length of the lateral wall of the pharynx so as to expose its cavity; study. Examine its opening into the mouth-cavity and study the general description (p. 231). Find and study the soft palate (p. 230). Dissect the tensor and levator palatini muscles (p. 230, and Fig. 66, d and e, p. 112), using, if necessary, the specimen on which the other muscles were dissected. Then slit the soft palate lengthwise at one side of the median line to expose the nasopharynx (p. 231). Bring the choanz into view by use of a bit of mirror-glass. Pass a bristle into the nares and out at the-choanz. Pass a bristle through the Eustachian tube into the middle ear. V. Csophagus (p. 234). After completing the study of the pharynx, leave the larynx and lungs in position and by displacing them toward the right follow the cesophagus to its termination. . Open it to see the folds of the mucosa. VI. Cut through the duodenum at its distal end and through the duodenal mesentery so as to separate the stormach and duodenum, with the liver, pancreas, and spleen, from the remainder of the alimentary canal. Float the parts in a dish of water. VII. Study the stomach (p. 234, and Fig. 97). Cut out the ventral wall of the stomach and wash it out, so as to study its cavity, and then continue the cut so as to expose the pyloric valve (p. 235). VIII. Study the duodenum (p. 236). Cut away the ventral walls of the duodenum far enough to expose the ampulla of Vater. IX. Study the liver (p, 239, and Figs. 100 and 101). Expose the hepatic duct of the left lateral lobe near its entrance into the lobe, and follow it so as to expose it fully. If necessary, prick it and inflate with blowpipe in order to follow it. Then expose the cystic duct and other hepatic ducts and follow them to or from the common bile-duct. Trace the latter to the duodenum. If the air does not enter any duct readily, it may be made to do so by manipulating the duct so as to break up the precipitated bile which obstructs it. X. Study the pancreas (p. 241, and Fig. 102). Expose the pancreatic duct near its entrance into the ampulla of Vater, by removing the peritoneum from the pancreas just caudad of the end of the common bile-duct, and by dissecting apart the pancreatic lobules until the duct appears. (If possible, expose also the acces- 452 APPENDIX. sory duct in the same way on the ventral side of the pancreas, two centimeters caudoventrad of the ampulla of Vater. Prick and inflate. Trace its connection with the main duct. ‘To demonstrate its open- ing pass a bristle through an opening in it into the duodenum.) (The pancreatic duct may be injected, if desired.) XI. The ventral wall of the duodenum should now be removed. Cut out a small piece, clean its mucosa with a fine brush and examine the villi with a lens. Demonstrate the coats of the duodenal wall by stripping them off with forceps. XII. The ampulla of Vater (p. 236). Pass bristles through openings in the common bile-duct and pancreatic duct into the duodenum through the ampulla. Slice away the duodenal wall parallel to the bristles until the bristles are exposed. XIII. The spleen (p. 242, and Fig. 102). XIV. Cut the mesentery from the small intestine and colon and slit them both lengthwise, but do not destroy the ileocolic valve. Wash and brush the mucous membrane clean and study the villi, solitary glands, and Peyer’s patches. Study the ileocolic valve (Fig. 99) and open it to study its inner surface. DISSECTION OF THE ORGANS OF RESPIRATION. I. The nasal cavity (p. 243). Review the description of the _ nasal cavity given under the Bones (p. 59). Study the cartilaginous framework that supports the external nose (p. 243); make a cross- section of the framework near the end of the nose and verify the description (p. 244, and Fig. 103). Without injuring the larynx or tongue saw through the head in a vertical plane and a little to one side of the median line. (If desired, the brain may first be removed from the specimen and preserved for future study. For directions, see page 462. The removal of the brain does not injure the head for the study of the nasal cavity; the skull may be sawn lengthwise in the same way as before.) Wash out the cut surfaces before examining. Find the ventral conch (p. 40), the labyrinths of the ethmoid (p. 43), the inferior meatus of the nose (p. 243), and by bristles the lachrymal duct or canal (p. 245). The lachrymal duct is conveniently found by passing bristles into the openings of the lachrymal canals. One of these is to be found on the border of each eyelid, two or three millimeters from the inner angle of the eye (see p. 410). Cut the cesophagus and trachea at the point where the blowpipe was inserted into the trachea. . Separate the tongue, hyoid, larynx, cesophagus, and first part of the trachea from the adjacent parts and remove them. II. The larynx (p. 246). (1) Read the description, studying the cartilages (p. 247) on a preparation (Fig. 104). Then very carefully remove the pharynx and its constrictor muscles, the sternothyroid and remains of sternohyoid muscles, and (2) dissect the muscles of PRACTICAL DIRECTIONS. 453 the larynx (p. 249, and Fig. 105), Dissect all those of one side first. The mucosa lining the vestibule and middle portions of the laryngeal cavity must be removed. After studying the muscles, remove the muscles and entire mucosa by scraping carefully with a dull but smooth scalpel, and study the cartilages (Fig. 104). III. The trachea and lungs (p. 251, and Fig. 106). The distal end of the trachea and lungs may now be removed with the heart from the body. ‘The lungs may be inflated with the bellows. The bronchi should then be exposed, cleaned, and followed as far as possible into the lungs. The heart should be preserved for future study. DISSECTION OF THE UROGENITAL ORGANS. - Excretory Organs. . Expose the kidney (p. 255, and Fig. 108) by removal of the Chih and the surrounding fat, taking care not to open the capsule of the kidney.- In removing the fat from the cranial end do not injure the suprarenal body (p. 257), which should be studied. 2. Open the capsule of the kidney and slice away its ventral wall to expose the sinus. After dissecting the contents of the sinus open the pelvis and study the papilla. Pass a bristle from the pelvis into the ureter. 3. Make a median section of the kidney parallel to its ventral surface and study structure (Fig. 109). 4. Trace the ureter to the bladder, being careful not to injure the vas deferens. Study the bladder and its ligaments, structure of its wall, etc. Pass a bristle through the ureter into it and then open it to see the openings of the ureter. Trace the neck of the bladder to the pubis. Male Genital Organs. . Study the external genital organs (p. 2 57). 2. Carefully remove the integument about the anus and expose the external sphincter ani muscle (p. 268, and Fig. 113, 7). Trace it to its origin. Remove the integument of the scrotum and dissect the intercolumnar fascia, the levator scroti muscle (p. 271, and Fig. 113, 7), the tunica vaginalis communis, and propria (p. 258). 3. The testis; the epididymis with great care, especially in uncovering the vasa efferentia; the vas deferens and spermatic cord (p. 259, and Figs. 110 and 111). 4. Follow the cord to the external inguinal ring (p. 259) and expose the ring. Dissect off in order from the inguinal canal: (a) The external oblique muscle; (4) the internal oblique muscle; (c) the transversus. In this way the cord is followed with its tunica communis and tunica propria to the internal inguinal ring. 5. Trace the vas deferens (p. 260, and Fig. 111) within the abdominal cavity as far as it can be seen dorsad of the neck of the bladder, 454 APPENDIX. 6. The penis (p. 262, and Figs, 111 and 113). Cut the skin along the dorsum of the penis and reflect. Dissect the ligamentum suspensorium penis. ‘Then introduce a bristle into the urethra and remove the integument from the whole penis and identify the corpora cavernosa and corpus spongiosum and the urethra. 7. Remove the fat at the side of the rectum and find the levator ani muscle (p. 269, and Fig. 162, 11). Transect and reflect it. The internal sphincter ani (p. 269, and Fig. 113, 4). Find the external opening of the anal gland (p. 239); slit and examine it. 8. Dissect the ischiocavernosus (p. 269) and bulbocavernosus (p- 271) muscles (Fig. 113), and find the bulbus of the corpus caver- nosum beneath the former. Cut it free from the ischial ramus. g. Clean the muscles from the pelvis on the side from which the crus penis is removed, and remove with bone forceps the body of the pubis and the ramus of the ischium. Then trace the neck of the bladder to its junction with the vasa deferentia, and the urethra from that point to the external opening (Fig. 111). Study the compressor urethre muscle (p. 271, and Fig. 113, ”). Find Cowper’s glands (p. 261) and the prostate gland (Fig. 113). Dissect the other muscles of the urogenital organs (pp. 268 to 273, and Fig. 113). 10. Slit the urethra on one side throughout its length and find the veru montanum (p. 261); the openings of the vasa deferentia (p. 261), by bristles passed into the urethra from them; the openings of the prostate gland and the openings of Cowper’s glands. 11. Study the structure of the penis (p. 262) by making a cross- section, and that of the glans by making a longitudinal section. Note, if possible, the os penis. C. Female Urogenital Organs (p. 263, and Fig. 112). The kidney and its ducts and the bladder are like those of the male (p. 255), except the neck of the bladder, which will be seen in dissecting the uterus and vagina. a. Without cutting anything examine— 1. The ovaries (p. 264); the ligaments of the ovary (p. 264, and Fig. 112). . The uterine tube. Its ostium (p. 264). The body of the uterus (p. 266) as far as exposed. The cornu of the uterus. The broad and round ligaments of the uterus (p. 266). Slit open one Fallopian tube, cornu, and body of the uterus as far as the junction of the divisions of the body of the uterus. é. Remove the ventral wall of the pelvis on one side only and find the vagina and urogenital sinus (p. 267). The levator ani muscle (p. 269, and Fig. 162, 11) must be cut and reflected. 1. Note the constrictor vestibuli, caudovaginalis, and urethralis muscles (p. 272, and Fig. 114). 2. Introduce a probe from the uterus into the vagina and feel with the finger for the hard cervix uteri (p. 266). Then open the vagina on the side, but do not cut the os uteri (p. 266). Nu Fwd IO NSS Na ON EE TE I Fe ee ee ee ee ee ee ee PRACTICAL DIRECTIONS. 455 3. Examine the cervix uteri and os uteri (p. 266). 4. Introduce a probe through the neck of the bladder and note its emergence into the urogenital sinus. 5. Find the end of the clitoris (p. 267), and its prepuce, and then dissect the integument carefully from about the external opening of the urogenital sinus and note an external sphincter of the sinus (M. levator vulvz) (p. 272, and Fig. 114), equivalent to the levator scroti in the male and continuous with the external sphincter ani. 6. Find (if possible) the corpora cavernosa of the clitoris (p. 267) and the ischiocavernosi muscles (p. 269). DISSECTION OF THE CIRCULATORY SYSTEM. I. THe Heart (p. 274, and Figs. 115 -117). Use the heart from the specimen dissected for the muscles, or from the specimen on which the viscera were studied.” 1. Study the outside (p. 275, and Figs. 115 and 116), and learn to recognize all parts. Find the pulmonary veins (p. 275, and Fig. 116, g, 4, 7) and cut them, thus separating the heart from the lungs. 2. The Pericardium (p. 279). Ina specimen the thoracic con- tents of which have not been injured, dissect the mediastinal septum from the pericardial sac and remove fat about the great blood-vessels so as to expose them all fully. Study their relations. Prick and inflate the pericardium. Slit it lengthwise over the ventricles and reflect it so as to expose its contents. Study the attachment of serous and fibrous layers to the heart and their relation to one another. 3. In dissecting the heart follow the course of the blood, study- ing each cavity with the aid of the descriptions (pp. 275-279) as you proceed. Dissect as follows: a. Remove the dorsal wall of the right auricle (p. 275) and of its appendage except that part of it to which the vene cave are attached. 6. Introduce the probe from the right auricle into the right ven- tricle, and feel with the probe the line along which the ventricular wall joins the septum. Cut along this line so as to turn back the ventricular wall as a flap, which remains attached at the base of the ventricle. c. Introduce a probe through the conus arteriosus into the pulmonary artery and cut along the probe. d. Remove the dorsal wall of the left auricle and its appendage, but do not remove that part to which the pulmonary veins are attached. e. Make a longitudinal incision beginning at the apex and divari- cate the lips of the cut as you pass toward the base, thus avoiding injury to the lateral flap of the bicuspid valve. Without injury to the flap or the columnz carnez, remove the heart-wall at the sides of this incision near the base of the ventricle, as much as necessary to expose the cavity. 456 APPENDIX. J. Pass a probe into the aorta. Introduce scissors behind the septal flap of the bicuspid valve and slit the aorta without injury to the bicuspid valve. II. Dissection oF THE BLOOD-VESSELS. Preparation and Injection. —A new specimen must be prepared for the dissection of the blood-vessels. The same specimen may be used, if necessary, for the dissection of the peripheral nervous system,—one side being used for the blood-vessels, the other for the nerves,—but it is much better to use separate specimens for the two systems. Inject the femoral artery of the specimen with either five per cent. formalin, or with the mixture of five per cent. formalin and glycerine, exactly as for the muscles. Then, without removing the canuld or waiting, inject the artery with red starch. This is prepared as follows: Mix together equal volumes of vermilion (or red lead), glycerine, and five per cent. formalin. Grind these together in a mortar, so as to destroy the lumps; strain the resulting mixture through fine muslin. This color mixture can be preserved in a closed bottle till it is to be used. Then mix together one volume of dry starch, one and one-fourth volumes of five per cent. formalin, and one-fourth volume of the color mixture, See that no lumps are present. ‘Inject the above red starch mass into the femoral artery. It will drive into the veins the formalin already injected, and the arteries will be filled with the red starch. The veins need not be injected, as they will be found to be filled with the formalin mixture, colored by the blood, so that they can be traced without great difficulty. Dissection of Blood-vessels.—In general the arteries and veins will be traced together. It is an excellent plan to make a sketch of each vessel as it is dissected, showing its origin, branches, and name. This will be a great aid to the memory and will be of much assist- ance in reviewing the vessels. The sketches can later be combined into a well-ordered drawing. The description of each vessel must of course be studied as the vessel is dissected. In tracing blood-vessels do no/ grasp them between the forceps- blades, but handle them by taking hold with the forceps of the con- nective-tissue coats of the vessels.- Do mot use the scalpel, but pul/ away the connective tissue and fat with fine forceps, using two pairs of forceps or one forceps and the tracer. Variations are especially common in the blood-vessels, and the student must not be surprised to find considerable deviations from the conditions described and figured in the text. These variations usually present nothing new in principle and are easily understood by comparing them with the structures described. Directions for Dissecting the Blood-vessels.—Make a median longi- eee ae en PRACTICAL DIRECTIONS. | 457 tudinal incision through the skin from the symphysis of the jaw to the caudal end of the xiphoid process. About three or four centi- meters caudad of the cranial end of the sternum make an incision at nearly right angles to this, passing from the first incision on the ventral side of the left arm about to the elbow. Reflect the flaps of skin, so as to uncover the left side of the thorax and the under sur- face of the arm, exposing the pectoral muscles, Isolate and transect the pectoral muscles one at a time, cutting each near its thoracic attachment. (The muscles (p. 145) should be reviewed at the same time.) In this way the nerves and blood-vessels of the axilla are exposed (Fig. 122, p. 295). Find the axillary artery and vein (Fig. 122, f and g) emerging from the thorax just craniad of the first rib, along with the nerves of the brachial plexus. Remove connective tissue, etc., so that the vessels and nerves are well isolated as they pass out of the thorax. Take great pains not to puncture the vessels, particularly the veins. Then remove the left side of the thorax by cutting through the first rib near its sternal end and then near its dorsal end, without injury to the vessels and nerves; cut the other ribs in the same way, and take out the thoracic wall. Now find with tracer and forceps the great blood-vessels leaving the cranial end of the heart (see Fig. 118). Take the greatest pains not to injure them. Find the aorta and aortic arch (p. 281); the left subclavian artery (p. 283) (continuous with the axillary); the innominate artery (p. 282), and the beginnings of its three branches (see Fig. 115). Find also the superior vena cava, the innominate veins, and the subclavian vein, continuous with the axillary vein. I. Study the smaller branches of the thoracic aorta (p. 283, and Fig. 118)—the intercostals, the bronchial and cesophageal arteries, and the first pair of lumbar arteries. (The coronary arteries will be examined later. ) : IJ. Dissect the subclavian and its branches (p. 290) as follows: 1. The internal mammary (p. 292). Follow it onto the ventral wall of the abdomen. Follow the vein at the same time (p. 318). 2. The vertebral artery (p. 291). Find its beginning, but do not trace it at present. 3. The costocervical axis (p. 292). Find its beginning, and trace the superior intercostal branch some distance. The other branches are not to be followed at present. 4. The thyrocervical axis (p. 293). Find its beginning, but do not trace it at present. 5. The axillary artery (continuation of the subclavian) (p. 294). Follow its branches, tracing at the same time the axillary vein (p. 318). (Consult Fig. 122.) In tracing the blood-vessels, separate the muscles, but do not cut them except where absolutely necessary. (The muscles should be reviewed as the vessels are traced. ) The following notes may be of assistance in following the different branches: 458 APPENDIX. (a) The anterior thoracic was probably cut in dissecting the pectoral muscles; it may be found, but its distal end is probably cut off. (4) The long thoracic is easily followed. (c) The subscapular. Follow the main artery before dissecting its branches. Where the subscapular disappears between the long head of the triceps, the latissimus dorsi, and the scapula, it may be traced and found again as follows: Remove the skin from the outer side of the shoulder, taking great pains to remove ody the skin and not to injure the vena cephalica (p. 319), a large vein that lies just beneath the skin on the lateral surface of the shoulder, coming from the elbow. The branches of the subscapular will be found appearing on the lateral surface of the arm in the angle between the spino- trapezius, the long head of the triceps, and the infraspinatus. The distal branches may then be followed. (¢) The posterior circumflex (p. 296) may be traced distad in a similar manner, by seeking it beneath the caudal border of the spinotrapezius. (Do not injure the vena cephalica.) (e) The other branches of the brachial artery and vein present no difficulty till we come to the collateralis radialis superior (Fig. 122, x). This must be traced with great care, along with the vena mediana cubiti (p. 319, and Fig. 122, y). Remove the skin from the extensor side of the forearm, taking great pains not to remove anything more than the skin. The artery and vein lie beneath the skin and should be traced to the hand (see Fig. 130). Along with the collateral radial artery trace the vena cephalica (p. 319, and Fig. 130, @ and c). Follow it across the shoulder, noting the branch to the posterior circumflex vein. The remainder of the blood-vessels of the arm present no special difficulty (see Figs. 123 and 124), Make a diagram of the subclavian artery, as far as dissected. III. Remove the skin from the sides of the neck, exposing the sternomastoid muscles and the external jugular veins crossing them (see Fig. 131). Clean the surface of the sternomastoid muscles, without injuring the vein; separate the two muscles caudad, and cut each close to the attachment to the sternum. Find the sternohyoid and sternothyroid muscles, and cut them close to their attachment to the first rib. Uncover the right side of the thorax in the same way as the left, cut the ribs without injury to the nerves and vessels of the right axilla, cut the internal mammary artery and vein (after tying the latter), and thus remove the sternum with nearly the entire thoracic wall. The blood-vessels of the thorax may now be more completely exposed. (If the nerves are to be dissected on the same specimen, find the phrenic, vagus, and sympathetic nerves (Fig. 157), and take the greatest pains not to injure them.) 1. The coronary arteries and the veins of the heart (pp. 281 and 316). PRACTICAL DIRECTIONS. 459 2. The superior vena cava (p. 316). Find its branches. Trace the azygos as far back as the diaphragm without dissecting it at all. Find the division of the innominate (p. 318) into subclavian and external jugular. Trace next— 3. The external jugular (p. 319). Remove the skin from the side of the face and trace its branches (Fig. 131). The internal jugular, vena facialis profunda, the submentalis, and the deep terminal branches of the posterior facial cannot be followed at this time; veins shown on Fig. 131 should all be found, however. 4. Trace the thyrocervical axis and its branches (p. 293). Add them to your diagram of the subclavian. 5. Follow the common carotid artery (p. 283) and internal jugular vein (p. 320). Find the division of the common carotid into its terminal branches and then dissect its lateral branches and those of the internal jugular (see Fig. 119). 6. The external carotid (p. 285, and Fig. 119). Follow its branches with the exception of the internal maxillary. 7. The internal maxillary (p. 287). Find its inferior alveolar branch first and follow it by cutting away with bone-forceps the ven- tral border of the lower jaw. To follow its other branches and those of the carotid plexus, remove the zygomatic arch, cut the temporal, masseter, and pterygoid muscles, and cut the mandible behind the incisor teeth and remove it. ‘The branches which pass into the skull are not to be followed at present. The posterior facial vein (p. 323), the vena facialis profunda (p. 323), and the submental vein (p. 323) may be followed at the same time. 8. The internal carotid (p. 285). Follow it to the point where it enters the cranium. g. Trace the other branches of the costocervical axis (p. 292). To do this, cut the arteries and nerves of the axilla on the side on which they have been dissected, allowing the arm to fall backward. Then trace the branches of the costocervical axis with tracer, scalpel, and bone-forceps, taking care not to injure the vertebral artery. Add these branches to your diagram of the subclavian. 10. The vertebral artery (p. 291). Trace it to the foramen transversarium of the sixth cervical vertebra. Then with bone-forceps follow it to the atlas and into the atlantal foramen. Add this to your diagram of the subclavian. 11. The basilar artery (p. 291) and the other arteries of the brain (p. 289) are best studied on a preparation, similar to that shown in Fig. 121. To obtain such a preparation it is only neces- _ sary to remove the brain (for directions, see p. 462) of a specimen in which the arteries have been injected. (12. Veins of the brain and dura mater (p. 324). These can be worked out only with much difficulty, except on specimens injected with gelatine. The skull must be chipped away and the veins followed without destroying them.) 460 APPENDIX. 13. Trace the pulmonary veins (p. 315) (filled with red injection) and the pulmonary artery (p. 280). IV. Vessels in the abdominal cavity. 1. Open the abdominal cavity; find the superior mesenteric vein (p. 326, and Fig. 132) in the duodenal mesentery near the border of the pancreas. Inject this in both directions with white starch and then dissect the portal vein and its tributaries without injuring any of the structures in the abdomen (p. 326, and Fig. 132). 2. Follow the inferior vena cava (p. 325) from the heart to the © diaphragm and then follow it to its tributaries in the abdominal cavity. be Dissect the branches of the abdominal aorta (p. 301) and of the inferior vena cava (Fig. 126). Make diagrams of the vessels dis- sected and review as far as necessary the viscera concerned. V. The external iliac and its branches (vessels of the hind limbs) (pp. 309 and 329, and Figs. 127, 128, and 163). Follow the branches of the external iliac arteries and the corre- sponding veins in the same manner as the vessels of the arm were traced, cutting the muscles only so far as absolutely necessary. Make diagrams of the vessels dissected. Make a diagram (a) of the arterial system as a whole; (8) of the venous system as a whole. THE LYMPHATIC SYSTEM (p. 330). It will hardly be found practicable to have each student make a dissection of the lymphatic system, and such parts of it as are to be studied may best be shown on a specimen prepared for demonstration purposes. The thoracic duct and the receptaculum chyli may be demon-+ strated by the following well-known method: A lean cat is fed with . milk about two hours before killing it. An egg may be beaten up with the milk to advantage. Kill the cat with chloroform, and inject the arteries with colored starch through the femoral, in the usual way. ‘The thoracic duct, the receptaculum chyli, and the lymphatics leading to the receptaculum chyli will be colored white by the milk, and can therefore be easily followed. For this purpose the abdomen should be opened, and the left side of the thorax removed, as in the dissection of the blood-vessels. The thoracic duct will be found at the left side of the aorta and may then be traced in both directions. For a more complete study of the lymphatics they should be injected. This is done as follows: Make a glass canula with a small point, and leave the point sharp. Connect this to the syringe by means of arubber tube. Use a saturated solution of soluble Prussian blue as injecting fluid. Employ a freshly killed animal. For injecting the lymphatics of the limbs, make with some pointed instrument, as the tracer, a small hole in one of the pads on the sole of the foot. Introduce the point of the canula into this opening and PRACTICAL DIRECTIONS. 461 inject the fluid. This will pass into the spaces in the connective tissue of the pad, which will swell up, and the colored fluid will pass from the connective-tissue spaces into the lymphatics. Pressure must be maintained with the syringe for a considerable time,—fifteen minutes to a half-hour for a good injection of the main trunks of the lymphatics of the limbs. The movement of the fluid should be facilitated by pressing and manipulating the limb at the same time with the hand,—in such a way as will tend to drive the fluid proximad, The lymphatics of the head may be injected in a similar manner, the canula being introduced into the upper and lower lip, or into the bare surface at the end of the nose. The internal lymphatic vessels may be injected by injecting the lymphatic glands with which they are connected. This may con- veniently be done as follows: Draw out to a fine point the tip of an ordinary pipette or medicine-dropper. The point should be fine, but should taper rapidly in a conical fashion, so that when the point is inserted the part of the glass tube behind it will close up the opening. Fill the pipette with soluble Prussian blue; insert the point into © the gland, and inject the fluid slowly. ‘The lymphatic vessels passing from the glands will be filled. By injecting thus the large lymphatic gland (‘‘ pancreas Aselli’’) in the mesentery, the abdominal lym- phatics, the receptaculum chyli, and the thoracic duct may be injected. By using thin gelatine colored with Prussian blue as an injecting fluid permanent preparations may be obtained; of course the process of injection is then less simple, and should be looked up in some manual of methods. : NERVOUS SYSTEM. I. THe Sprnar Corp (p. 335). Use the specimen on which the muscles were dissected. (Or if the peripheral nerves are not to be dissected on the specimen used for the blood-vessels, that may be employed. ) Make a longitudinal dorsal median incision of the skin, between the back of the head and root of the tail. Reflect the skin for one or two inches on each side of the incision and cut away the muscles covering the neural arches of the vertebrz from the third cervical to the seventh or eighth thoracic inclusive. Remove with bone-forceps the neural arch of one of the last cervical vertebrz and find the spinal nerve emerging from the inter- vertebral foramen. Isolate the nerve for a short distance, then proceed craniad, removing the neural arches on one side and isolat- ing the nerves until the third has been uncovered. The ganglion of the second nerve should be sought among the muscles on the dorsal surface between the atlas and axis, and after it has been isolated the 462 APPENDIX. arch of the axis may be removed. (The nerve may be found beneath the clavotrapezius and traced to the ganglion.) The ganglion of the second nerve should be isolated in or near the atlantal foramen, the muscles to which it passes turned aside, and the arch of the atlas removed. Having thus uncovered the first two or more spinal ganglia, proceed caudad, removing the vertebral arches, asi the whole cord and its nerves are exposed. Then— Study the cord, enlargements, filum terminale, etc. (p. 334, and ‘Figs 133 and 136). . Slit open and reflect the dura mater (p. 337) for an inch or two. . Demonstrate the arachnoid by pulling it off with forceps. . Reflect the pia mater in the same way as the dura mater. . Study the fissures and grooves of the cord. . Cut across the cord with fine scissors at the point where it is freed from its membranes and examine the section. Note the arrangement of gray and white matter and the fissures and grooves, particularly the anterior or ventral. Demonstrate the central canal with the blowpipe. 7. Study the origin of the spinal nerves (p. 337). Count them. Direction of exit? Carefully clean one in the thoracic region from dura mater and connective tissue, with fine scissors, and study dorsal and ventral roots and ganglion (see Fig. 135). Then follow it out and find its dorsal ramus and ventral ramus and the communicating branch of the latter with the sympathetic system. Do not trace the peripheral branches of the nerve at present. AnNFW hd II. Tue Brain (p. 339). The brain will usually be found to be in an entirely satisfactory condition for study in any specimen injected with five per cent. formalin or the glycerine and formalin mixture. The brain is a little swollen, but all parts are well preserved, and the white and gray matter are clearly marked off from each other. Either the specimen used for the muscles or that employed for the blood-vessels may therefore be used,—or if the brain was removed from the specimen employed for the viscera, that will be satisfactory. The following directions for removing the brain are designed for specimens preserved as above. For removing the /resh brain the process is essentially similar, but as the brain is then very soft, care should be taken not to tear it. The fresh brain should be preserved in the alcohol-formalin mixture given below, and should be allowed to rest only on some soft substance, as absorbent cotton. Remove the head from the body by cutting through the neck a little craniad of the first rib if this has not already been done. Remove all skin, muscles, and other soft parts from the head and cervical vertebra, as far as possible. Remove the structures in the orbit by cutting through the zygomatic arch at each end, and- removing it. The lower jaw should also be removed, if this has not ' — | PRACTICAL DIRECTIONS. 463 already been done. (Ifa fresh specimen is used, and the head is to be employed for other purposes, the brain can be removed without separating the head from the body, and without taking away the lower jaw and other structures on the ventral surface of the skull.) Have at hand dissecting-instruments and a dish containing alcohol and formalin in the following proportions (Parker and Floyd’s mixture) : EGE GO, BICONOL 5.5 Sic, ease sce te 6 parts 2 per cent, formalin... . 0b... se vet es 2 parts In the bottom of the dish should be placed a little absorbent cotton, to support the brain. In removing the brain have at hand entire and dissected skulls and note the rélations of parts on these as far as necessary before cutting the specimen. With bone-forceps make a small opening in the parietal bone so as to expose the dura mater, but do not cut through the dura mater. With some blunt instrument free the dura mater from the bone about the opening, and continue to cut away the bone until the dorsal and lateral faces of the cerebrum are fully exposed craniad of the tentorium. The olfactory bulbs (Fig. 137, 7) should be exposed carefully and as fully as possible. Cut away the dorsal arch of the atlas and carefully insert the forceps in the foramen magnum and, working as before, remove the squamous portion of the occipital and the parietal bones as far as the tentorium and as far ventrad as possible. Leave the dura mater intact if possible. Free the surface of the tentorium from the dura mater, carefully separate slightly the cerebellum and cerebrum; insert the bone-forceps (not too far) with the blades inclined from without ventromediad, and cut the tentorium on each side. Remove it slowly, cutting adhesions to the dura mater. ‘That part of the dura mater which dips between the cerebral hemispheres is the falx cerebri. Cut the dura mater along both sides of the falx cerebri and remove it by turning it down at the sides and cutting it at the level of the cut edge of the bone. Remove it also from the cerebellum and notice how it dips down on both sides of the tentorium and in close contact with it. Cut the falx at the cranial end between the olfactory bulbs and cut the tentorial dura (cut its adhesions, but do not remove with it the pineal body). The falx and tentorial dura may then be removed. Allow the head to hang sideways over the dish of alcohol-formalin in such a way that the brain will tend to fall out of the cranium. Free the olfactory bulbs from the bone. Then begin at the caudal end and tilt the brain out with the handle of a scalpel. In doing this note carefully and cut the cranial nerves. They should be left with central ends as long as possible, and those on the side which is uppermost should be cut first. In doing this refer to the foramina in the base of the skull and to Fig. 138. Take especial pains also not to break off the hypophysis, which is lodged in the sella turcica. 464 APPENDIX. The brain falls out and rests with its dorsal surface on the cotton. Now remove the remainder of the dura mater, carefully cutting all adhesions to nerves. Remove also the pia mater, as far as that can be done without pulling off at the same time parts of the brain-sub- stance. Preserve the brain in the alcohol-formalin mixture. Study of the Brain.—In the study of the brain demonstration specimens are to be used as much as or more than your own specimen. See everything on a demonstration preparation before attempting to expose it in your own specimen. I, Examine the brain of a shark or of a frog. Cranial nerves may be neglected, but the divisions of the brain should be recognized in dorsal and ventral views and in longitudinal sections, and sketched. II. Read the general description of the cat’s brain (pp. 339-343), using your own specimen and a longitudinal section. Cut nothing on your own specimen except when especially directed to do so. Study the cavities on a preparation. Compare the diagrams (Figs. 139 and 140) and the figures of the brain. III. Study the individual parts as follows. To avoid errors make constant reference to preparations and figures. ; 1. The medulla (p. 344 and Figs. 138 and 141). Use your own specimen and a preparation and dissect out carefully the cranial nerves on your own specimen. ‘The cerebellum (p. 347). Study it entire, then to expose the fourth ventricle (p.. 349) slice away with a very sharp scalpel one-half of the cerebellum by making a median longitudinal incision and then horizontal incisions. 3. The pons (p. 347). 4. The mesencephalon (p. 351, and Figs. 141 and 142). Study it first in a preparation. Then study the floor on your own speci- men; origin of third nerves. ’ 5. The diencephalon (Figs. 141 and 142). Study the roof and thalami and the pineal body on a preparation and on a longitudinal section; the floor on your specimen. 6. The telencephalon (p. 357). (Note that only ome side of this is to be dissected. ) a. Study it externally; sulci and gyri (Figs. 145 and 146). 6, Examine a preparation showing the corpus callosum (Fig. 147). Then slice away with a very sharp scalpel the top of one hemisphere nearly to the corpus callosum (see the preparation). Expose the corpus callosum on this side to its cranial and caudal borders, by fearing away the brain-substance at its side and above it. c. Raise the corpus callosum at the side and remove it, thus exposing the lateral ventricle in which note the septum pellucidum and fornix, the corpus striatum, and choroid plexus of the lateral ventricle (Fig. 148). (These are to be exposed on one side only, the other being left intact.) d, Expose the anterior and inferior horns of the ventricle and find the hippocampus, the fimbria, caudal part of the fornix, the PRACTICAL DIRECTIONS. 465 foramen of Monroe, the anterior commissure. See all these also on a preparation (Fig. 148). e. Remove the occipital and parietal portions of the cerebrum, on the side already dissected, so as to expose the roof of the third ventricle and the midbrain in your specimen, and note the pineal body, choroid plexus of third ventricle, and structures on the roof of the midbrain (Fig. 141). J. Remove the choroid plexus or roof of the third ventricle and study again the thalami (Fig. 141). g. Make a longitudinal section of the brain, in the following manner: Use a very sharp large scalpel, or a razor. Have this wet with the alcohol mixture at the time of using. Place the brain ventral surface down on a sheet of cork or a block of soft wood, the long axis of the brain coinciding with the direction of grain of the wood. Holding the brain firmly with one hand, place the wet knife beween the hemispheres with its edge resting on the corpus callosum. See that it is in the median plane and parallel with the long axis of the brain. See also that it is not inclined to one side or the other, so that it will make on cutting a median section throughout. The point of the knife should just reach the cork or wood between the olfactory bulbs. Now draw the knife caudad, keeping its point against the cork: the brain will thus be divided. If the section is not exactly median, observe the amount of divergence by placing the two halves together and finding the median ventral line. Then on the half that has /oo much slice away thin shavings until the cavities are exposed, showing the section to be median. Compare with a demonstration section or Fig. 143. Draw the section and compare with a section of shark’s brain (see Fig. 143). h, Study a series of transverse sections, identifying parts. Observe especially in these sections the fornix, corpus callosum, and ventricles, and the distribution of white and gray matter (see Figs. 149-153). III. PERIPHERAL NERVOUS SYSTEM. (There are some advantages in dissecting the eye with its muscles before dissecting the nerves, as a knowledge of the eye-muscles is presupposed for dissecting some of the cranial nerves. For directions on the eye, see p. 469.) A new specimen should be used, if possible, for the peripheral nervous system, though that used for the blood-vessels can be employed, at considerable disadvantage. Prepare as for the blood-vessels. The arteries should be injected with red starch, to aid in tracing the nerves. 1. THE CranraL NERVEs (p. 369) AND SYMPATHETIC SysTEM (p. 404). 1. Reflect the skin covering the sternomastoid muscle, and make a longitudinal incision of the muscle so as to expose the carotid artery. Lying along the artery find the combined trunk of the 466 APPENDIX. sympathetic and vagus nerves. Follow the vagus (p. 378) first craniad; transect the muscles as necessity arises, and find its ganglion nodosum and at the same time locate the superior cervical ganglion of the sympathetic nerve (p. 404, and Fig. 156). Then find the hypoglossal nerve (Fig. 156, 4), passing outside of the carotid artery to the tongue, and the accessory (Fig. 156, c), passing to the tra- pezius. Cut and reflect the digastric muscle and find the small glossopharyngeal nerve (Fig. 156, a), passing to the surface of the bulla and then beneath the carotid artery. 2. Follow the vagus (p. 378) caudad to its termination. To do this it is necessary to remove one side of the thorax, as in dissecting the blood-vessels. Do not injure the nerves of the axilla, nor the phrenic or sympathetic nerves. For the vagus in the thorax, com- pare Fig. 157. Find the branches of the nerve; in dissecting them, pull on them to make them tense. They are then more easily visible. To dissect the abdominal portion of the vagus, open the abdominal cavity, and compare Fig. 164 (p. 407). 3. Dissect the sympathetic (p. 404), following it and its branches to the pelvic region (Figs. 156, 157, and 164). 4. The hypoglossal (p. 383, and Fig. 156, 4). 5. The glossopharyngeal (p. 378, and Fig. 156, a). 6. The accessory nerve (p. 382, and Fig. 156, c; Fig. 158, 1). Cut away a portion of the tympanic bulla and the base of the skull, sufficient to follow these nerves in the jugular foramen, to the brain. 7. Locate the stylomastoid foramen and pick away overlying tissue until the facial nerve is found emerging and then follow its branches to their distribution (p. 375, and Fig. 155). 8. Expose the ventral surface of the pterygoid muscles just mediad of the angle of the jaw. Divide and reflect them, and the mandibular division of the fifth nerve (p. 373, and Fig. 154) will be found dorsad of them and of the internal maxillary artery. The chorda tympani (p. 375) passes ventrad of the artery to join the lingual. Follow out (1) the lingual branch (p. 375) (with the chorda tympani), and (2) the inferior alveolar (p. 375) by cutting away the ventral border of the mandible. Then cut the mandible near the canine tooth, and pull it to one side, and follow out the muscular branches of the mandibular nerve. g. Remove the mandible and find the maxillary nerve (p. 371) emerging from the foramen rotundum. Follow its branches and find the sphenopalatine ganglion (p. 372). 10, Remove the zygoma so as to expose the whole ventral aspect of the orbit. Carefully pick away the fat in the orbit without injuring any nerves, so as to expose the four recti muscles and the inferior oblique (see p. 411, and Fig. 166). Find the abducens nerve (p. 375, and Fig. 154), entering the dorsal edge of the lateral rectus, and follow it back. Look on the inner surface of the inferior rectus for the branch of the third nerve (p. 369) which supplies it. Find i itd ata DT eR PRACTICAL DIRECTIONS. 467 the branch of this nerve which runs to the inferior oblique muscle, and on it the ciliary ganglion; find the branches to the ciliary gan- glion frém the ophthalmic nerve and follow them (p. 371). Follow also the short ciliary nerves (p. 370) to the eyeball. 11. Trace the third nerve (p. 369) to its foramen of exit and find its branches, Where it passes between the superior and lateral recti, find the ophthalmic nerve (p. 370) by its side and trace its branches. 12. Find the fourth nerve (p. 370), passing outside of the lateral rectus at its origin and entering the superior oblique. 13. Follow the third, fourth, fifth, and sixth nerves into the skull by chipping away the bone and removing the dura. Note the semi- lunar or Gasserian ganglion (p. 370, and Fig. 138, &) and the origin of the fifth nerves from it, and the relation of the ventral root of the fifth nerve to the mandibular nerve, - 2. SprnaL NERVES. The spinal nerves may be dissected on the same side used for dissecting the cranial nerves. (If an undissected specimen is used, remove the skin from the side of the neck, and cut the sternomastoid, sternohyoid, and sternothyroid muscles, as directed for the vagus and sympathetic.) Cervical Nerves (p. 383).—The ventral rami of the cervical nerves are to be sought as they pass out between the bundles of the scalenus, or between the scalenus and longus capitis, in the neck. This region has already been uncovered in dissecting the vagus and sympathetic (Fig. 156). Dissect first the second cervical (p. 385). Find its ventral ramus as it emerges between the levator scapulze ventralis and cleidomastoid (Fig. 158, 2), and follow its branches, — the auricularis magnus (5) and cutaneus colli (6), Find its dorsal ramus, the great occipital nerve (p. 384), by reflecting the clavo- trapezius muscle; the nerve will be found emerging from the under- lying muscles close to the craniomedial angle of the clavotrapezius, near its origin. ‘Trace the nerve in both directions. The ventral ramus of the first cervical (p. 385) will be found emerging from beneath the wing of the atlas, a little distance craniad of the second (Fig. 156,7). Trace it. To find its short dorsal ramus, the suboccipital nerve (p. 384), it is necessary to dissect apart the muscles on the dorsal side of the atlas till the nerve is found passing from the atlantal foramen. Dissect the third, fourth, and fifth nerves (p. 385, and Fig. 158). Brachial Plexus (p. 386, and Figs. 159 and 160).—The brachial plexus has been partly uncovered in dissecting the vagus and sympa- thetic. (If a new specimen or the opposite side is used, reflect the skin from the ventral surface of the thorax and arm, and cut the pectoral muscles, thus uncovering the vessels and nerves of the axilla.) Reflect the skin from the ventral surface of the upper arm. (Do not use scalpel, but tear the skin from the muscles. In this 468 ; APPENDIX. way the nerves wil] be seen passing to the skin, while if the scalpel were used the nerves might be cut.) Tie the axillary vein or its two branches in two places, and cut the vein between the tied regions. Leave the arteries as guides for dissection, bnt remove the veins. Now clean thoroughly the nerves forming the brachial plexus as they pass from the thorax or neck.’ Be careful not to injure any of the fine nerves or the interconnections of the nerves in doing-this. Find and distinguish clearly the fifth, sixth, seventh, and eighth cervical nerves and the first thoracic, as they emerge from the neck or thorax. (Compare Fig. 159 and Fig. 157, V-V@/Zand I’'.) Follow out the branches of the plexus, noting the orgin and distribution of each branch, in order to determine its name. To follow the phrenic (p. 388, and Fig. 157, 7), removea portion of the thoracic wall. In following the other branches of the plexus, pull back the skin wherever an exposure is to be made, and separate the muscles. The epitrochlearis may be cut near the elbow, and the clavobrachial near the shoulder. In following the interosseous branches of the median nerve the fifth head of the flexor profundus, and the extensor brevis pollicis, may be cut. Asa rule it will not be necessary to cut other muscles. Thoracic and Luméar Nerves.—One or two of the thoracic nerves (p- 393) should be dissected from the outside by finding the inter- costal nerve along the caudal border of one of the ribs and tracing it in both directions. The nerve may be exposed by removing the external muscles covering the rib, and cutting the external intercostal muscles. ‘The dorsal ramus should be traced after the ventral ramus has been studied. The first lumbar nerve (p. 395) should be dissected in the same way. The other lumbar and sacral nerves (pp. 395-400) are best dis- sected from within. ‘lhe alimentary canal and its appendages should be removed from the abdomen, leaving only five or six centimeters of the caudal end of the rectum. The kidneys and urogenital organs may be left, to be removed during dissection. (Compare Fig. 162. Turn one of the kidneys to the other side, and find the second lumbar nerve (Fig. 162, 2) appearing at the lateral border of the iliopsoas muscle. ‘Trace it to its origin; trace it also distad, follow- ing both branches. It will be necessary to trace the nerves through the abdominal wall, then find them from the outside, and follow them to their distribution. The third nerve (Fig. 163, 4) may be found by dissecting apart the fibre-bundles of the iliopsoas and psoas minor, and following in the same way. The kidneys, ureters, vena cava, and aorta may be removed as occasion arises. The remainder of the lumbar nerves may be found in order, in a similar manner. Follow the saphenous nerve and its branches (p. ¥ a PRACTICAL DIRECTIONS. — . 469 397) by removing the integument from the medial side of the leg (see Fig. 127, p. 310). To dissect the sacral nerves (p. 399) separate the innominate bones at the pubic symphysis and divaricate them. Find the nerves arising from the sacral plexus, by cutting the levator ani muscle. After N. hemorrhoidalis inferior and N. pudendus have been traced, the rectum and urogenital organs may be removed, tak- ing great care not to remove more than is necessary. To dissect the great sciatic nerve (p. 400, and Fig. 163), separate the biceps and caudofemoralis near their proximal ends and find the large nerve- trunk (a). Then lift the biceps away from the nerve, cut that muscle near its middle, and reflect it. The nerve may now be followed to its terminal branches; during the process cut the muscles only when absolutely necessary. The inferior gluteal nerve (7) will be found on the dorsal surface of the great sciatic; by cutting the caudofemo- ralis and gluteus maximus muscles near their insertions and turning ~ them back the distribution of the nerve may be followed. The superior gluteal (7) will be found at the cranial margin of the pyri- formis by reflecting the gluteus medius in the same way; the tensor fasciz late may also be cut. SENSE-ORGANS, I. Tue Eye (p. 410). Use any specimen on which one side of the head has been left intact. Remove the head from the body by cutting through the neck a little craniad of the first rib. Study the eye externally. Observe the eyelids, the conjunc- tiva, nictitating membrane with its cartilage, and the Harderian gland (Fig. 165); the two openings of the lachrymal duct, the Meibomian glands if possible. Remove the zygomatic arch and expose the orbit and the struc- , tures which it contains. Study the periorbita (p. 409), and find the lachrymal gland (p. 410). Study the muscles of the eyeball (p. 411, and Fig. 166). The lateral rectus on the lateral surface will perhaps be first found, and its tendon traced beneath the inferior oblique. Use great care not to injure the levator palpebrz superioris. After studying the muscles, find the optic nerve. Cut it and the muscles, and remove the eyeball for farther study. The Eyeball (p. 412, and Fig. 167).—For an examination of the eye it is well to have a fresh specimen and one hardened in formalin or alcohol. The hardened specimen is more essential, however. An eye from one of the specimens used in dissection is usually satisfac- tory. All accessory portions should be trimmed from the eyeball, leaving only the spherical ball with a short stalk formed by the optic nerve. Observe such features of the eye as can be seen externally: the optic nerves, sclerotic, cornea, iris, and pupil. This should be done 470 APPENDIX. on a fresh specimen, if one is at hand. ‘The changes in size and form of the pupil can be observed in the living cat by changing it from a light to a dark place and wice versa. Dissection.—Examine the internal structures on a preparation. Then with fine scissors and forceps remove from the eye about one- fourth of the wall, in the form of a quadrant having one point at the optic nerve, the other at the centre of the cornea. The coats of the eye can then be studied on the piece removed, while the other struc- tures will be visible within the eyeball. No special directions are necessary for observation of the structures described, unless it be the capsule of the lens and the zonula ciliaris. The capsule of the lens may be demonstrated by tearing a bit of it off with fine forceps. The zonula ciliaris is easily seen by divaricating the edges of the cut made in removing the quadrant, so as to stretch the fine fibres of which the zonula is formed. II. Tue Ear (p. 415). (The muscles of the external ear are of little practical importance, and will doubtless usually be omitted.) (1) The External Ear. Read the description of the external ear (p- 415), verifying it by examination and comparison of an ear still covered with integument, in the natural condition, and of a prepara- tion of the isolated cartilages of the ear (Fig. 168). The latter may be obtained by dissecting the skin and muscles from a fresh ear. (2) The scutiform cartilage (p. 418) should be observed in the natural position, and as isolated. (3) The muscles of the external ear (p. 418, and Fig. eek Those connecting the external ear with other parts of the head have been studied in connection with the facial muscles. The remainder will be studied on an external ear removed according to the direc- tions given on page 435. Remove the integument from the convex surface of the auricle, sufficiently to expose the entire extent of the muscles. 1. The rotator auris. Transect. 2. The adductor auris superior (Fig. 169, 1). 3. The adductor auris medius (2). 4. The transversus auricule (Fig. 63, 7, p. 97). 5. The auricularis externus (Fig. 169, 10). The helicis (Fig. 169, 3). To expose this it will be necessary to remove the integument from along the cranial border of the inner surface of the auricle. 7. The antitragicus (Fig. 169, 6).. Remove the integument farther if necessary. 8. The tragicus medialis (Fig. 169, 5, 5’). g. The concheus externus (Fig. 169, 9). (4) Remove the tympanic bulla and petrous bone from the rest of the skull, by the use of bone-forceps and scalpel. Trim away all oy PRACTICAL DIRECTIONS. 471 soft tissue (including the cartilaginous auditory meatus), and all other bony parts from these, but leave them uninjured. (5) Find the Eustachian tube and study it (p. 423). (6) Study specimens of the bones of the middle ear (p. 423, and Figs. 171 and 172). (7) The middle ear should be studied on a demonstration prep- aration, then dissected as follows: Remove with bone-forceps the medial side of the tympanic bulla (the entotympanic). Note the two cavities within the bulla, with the shelf separating them. Observe the fenestra cochlee. Now remove with the forceps the shelf, first breaking through the middle part, then removing the rest with care. Remove part also of the membranous lining of the cavity, till the inner surface of the tym- panic membrane, with the malleus crossing it, is visible. Observe the tensor tympani muscle (p. 424) attached to the malleus by its small tendon. Next, with bone-forceps, fracture the thick, bony portion uniting the caudal end of the petrous with the caudal part of the ring of bone surrounding the external auditory meatus. These two parts may then be separated with the fingers, leaving the petrous bone on one side, the meatus, tympanum, and malleus on the other (Fig. 170). The head of the malleus may then be observed, with the incus attached to it. Note also the stapes, in the fenestra ves- tibuli, with the stapedius muscle (p. 424) attached to it. (8) The internal ear (p. 424). Note the fenestra vestibuli and fenestra cochlee and the promontory (p. 34). Study the cochlea and vestibule on a demonstration preparation and compare with Fig. 173. Then remove the wall of the promontory and find the cochlea. Open the vestibule and find as many of the openings of the semicir- cular canals as possible. Study the semicircular canals on demon- stration preparations, consulting Fig. 173. The semicircular canals may, if desired, be exposed on your own specimen, by cutting away the surface of the bone in places indicated in the description (p. 426), and inserting fine bristles (those from the sensory hairs on the face of the cat are excellent for this purpose). The membranous labyrinth (Fig. 173) may be isolated by decalci- fying the petrous bone with ten per cent. nitric acid, then dissecting out the labyrinth. This is an operation of considerable delicacy, but at least one or two specimens for demonstration should, if possible, be. prepared thus and kept in the laboratory. re Vinee iy Fiera INDEX. Abdominal aorta, 301 arteries, 301 . cavity, 217, 218 muscles, 153 dissection, 441 veins, 326 Abducens nerve, 347, 375 Abductor auris brevis, M., longus, M., 100, 435 brevis pollicis, M., 184, 439 caudz (coccygis) externus, M., 137, 447; internus, M., 137, 446 cruris, M., 195 digiti quinti, M., 185, 439; secundi, M., 185 medius digiti quinti, M., 215 Accelerator urinz, M., 271 Accessory nerve, 346, 382 process, 6, 8 Acetabular bone, 76, 78 notch, 79 Acetabulum, 76, 78, 87 Achilles, tendon of, 204, 206 Acromiodeltoid muscle, 157, 438 Acromion process, 62, 64 Acromiotrapezius, M., 116. 436 Adductor auris inferior, M., 104, 435; medius, M., 419, 470; superior, M., 419, 470 digiti secundi, M., 185 femoris, M., 198, 444 longus, M., 199, 444 medius digiti quinti, M., 215 pollicis, M., 185, 439 Aditus laryngis, 246 Adrenolumbar arteries, 304 veins, 326 Alz magne, 26, 27 parvee, 29 Albuginea, 260 Alcohol as preservative, 431 Alcohol-formalin for brains, 463 Alimentary canal, 221; dissection of, 100, 435; 449 Alisphenoids, 25, 27 Alveolar border, 39, 47 nerve, inferior, 374, 375 process, 39 Alveoli, 48 Ampulla (ear), 426 of Vater, 236 Anal glands or sacs, 239; constrictors of, 269 Anapophysis, 6 Anastomotica magna, A., 297 Anconeus, M., 170, 438 Anconeus internus, M., 170 lateralis, M., 167 longus, M., 168 posterior, M., 168 Angle of rib, 18 Angular process, 19, 48 vein, 321 Ankle, bones of, 82 ligaments of, 91 Annularis, 72 Annular ligaments, 75, 173, 213 Ansze, 386 Anterior cerebral artery, 289 circumflex artery, 296 commissure, 357, 365 facial vein, 321 fossa, 59 perforated substance, 362 spinal artery, 291 superior process, 78 Sylvian gyrus, 359 sulcus, 359 thoracic artery, 294; nerves, 387 tibial artery, 313 transverse processes, II Antibrachial fascia, 172 Antibrachium, muscles of, 172 Anticlinal vertebra, 6 Antihelix, 416 Antitragicus, M., 421, 470 Antitragus, 417 Anus, 239 muscles of, 268 Aorta, 275, 279, 281, 301 473 AT4 INDEX. Aorta abdominalis, 301 Aortic plexus, 408 semilunar valves, 279 sinus, 279 Apparatus digestorius, 221 respiratorius, 243 urogenitalis, 255 Appendicular fossa, 35, 58 lobe, 348 Appendix, 429 Aqueduct of Sylvius, 342, 343, 359, 351, 352 Aqueductus cerebri, 342, 343, 350; 351; 352; Fallopii, 35 Aqueous humor, 414 Arachnoid, 337, 369 Arbor vite, 349 Arch, bicipital, 166 supraorbital, 37, 51 zygomatic, 47, 49, 52 Area elliptica, 345 ovalis, 345 perforata posterior, 352 Arm, arteries of, 294 articulations of, 73 bones of, 64 muscles of, 156 dissection of, 436 nerves of, 388 veins of, 318 Arteria adrenolumbalis, 304 alveolaris inferior, 288 anastomotica magna, 297 anonyma, 282 articularis genu suprema, 311 pi Pp anterior, 287; posterior, 207 axillaris, 294 basilaris, 291, 292 brachialis, 296 bronchiales, 283 carotis communis, 282, 283; externa, 285; interna, 285 cerebelli anterior, 292; inferior poste- rior, 292 cerebri anterior, 289; media, 289; posterior, 292 cervicalis ascendens, 293; profunda, 293- circumflexa femoris lateralis, 311; hu- meri anterior, 296; humeri pos- terior, 296; scapulz, 294. ceeliaca, 301. colica dextra, 304; media, 303; sinis- tra, 306 collateralis radialis superior, 297; ul- naris, 297 coronariz, 275, 279, 281 digitales dorsales, 297; plantares, 314 dorsalis penis, 308 Arteria epigastrica inferior, 309 femoralis, 307, 310 gastrica sinistra, 303 gastroduodenalis, 302 gastroepiploica dextra, 303 genu posteriores, 313 glutea inferior, 308; superior, 308 hemorrhoidalis media, 308; superior, 306 hepatica, 302 hypogastrica, 307 ileocolica, 304 iliaca externa, 307, 309; interna, 307 iliolumbalis, 306 infraorbitalis, 290 intercostales, 283 intercostalis suprema, 293 interossez, 298, 300 lienalis, 303 lingualis, 285, 286 lumbales, 283, 306 lumboabdominalis, 304 mammaria interna, 292 maxillaris externa, 285, 286; interna, 287 mesenterica inferior, 306 ; superior, 393 . meningea media, 289 metatarsea, 315 occipitalis, 285 cesophager, 283 ophthalmica, 289 palatina descendens, 290; minor, 290 pancreaticoduodenalis inferior, 303; superior, 303 phrenica, 304 poplitea, 311, 312 princeps pollicis et indicis, 300 profunda brachii, 296; femoris, 309 pulmonalis, 275, 278, 280 pylorica, 302 radialis, 297; recurrens. 298 renalis, 304 sacralis lateralis, 309; media, 301, — 309 saphena, 311 spermatica externa, 309; interna, 304 sphenopalatina, 290 spinalis anterior, 291 subclavia, 282, 283, 290 subscapularis, 294 superior profunda, 296 suprascapularis, 293 suralis, 313 tarsea medialis, 315 temporalis superficialis, 287 thoracica anterior, 294; longa, 294 thoracicodorsalis, 296 thyreoidea ima, 283, 284; superior, 284 ee eee Arteria tibialis anterior, 313; posterior, 313; recurrens, 314 transversa colli, 293; scapulz, 293 ulnaris, 300; recurrens, 298 umbilicalis, 307 uterina, 308 ventriculi dorsalis, 303 vertebralis, 291 Arteries (see Arteria), 280 abdomen, 301 arm, 294 bladder, 307 brain, 289, 291 foot, 312, 314 hand, 300 » kidneys, 304 intestine, 304 limbs, 294, 309 liver, 302 stomach, 303 Artery (see Arteria) cystic, 302 labial, 286 mediastinal, 282 ovarian, 306 submental, 286 superior laryngeal, 285 Articular artery, superior, 311 circumference, 67 facet, 4 processes, 6, 8 Articulation, atlanto-occipital, 17 intervertebral, 16 Articulations of arm, 73 hind limb, 86 mandible, 61 Arytenoid cartilages, 248 Arytenoideus transversus, M., 250 Astragalus, $2 Atlantal foramen, 14 Atlanto-occipital articulation, 17 Atlas, 14 Atrium dextrum, 275 sinistrum, 279 Attollens auris. M., 100 Auditory bulla, 32 meatus, external, 32, 33, 52, 55, 415, 416; internal, 35, 5 nerve, 347, 377 organ, 415 Auricle (ear), 415 Auricles of heart, 274, 275, 279 Auricula, 415 Auricular appendage, 275, 279 arteries, 287 cartilage, 415, 416 facet, 10 impression, 77 Auricularis anterior, M., 104, 419 externus, M., 420, 470 INDEX. Auricularis posterior, M., 99 superior, M., 100, 435 Auricular nerve, 379; great, 385; terior, 377 475 pos- vein, anterior, 324; posterior, 324 Auriculotemporal nerve, 373 Auriculoventricular septum, 274 Axillary artery, 294 border, 63 nerve, 388 vein, 318 Axis, 15 Azygos vein, 316 Backbone, 1 Back, fascia of, 126 muscles of, I15, 123; dissection of, 442 Basilar artery, 291, 292 Basioccipital bone, 22 Basisphenoid bone, 25 Biceps brachii, M., 165, 438, 439 femoris, M., 194, 444 Bicipital arch, 166 groove, 66 tubercle, 64 tuberosity, 67 Bicuspid valve, 279 Bile duct, 241 Biventer cervicis, M., 132, 443 Bladder, 256 arteries of, 307 ligaments of, 219, 257 Blind spot, 414 Blood vessels, 280 dissection of, 456 injection of, 456 Body cavity, 217 Body muscles, 115 Bones, 1 ear, 423 head, 21 pelvic extremities, 76 preparation of, 430 sesamoid, 73, 80, 86 study of, 431 thoracic extremities, 62 Bony labyrinth, 425 Brachial artery, 296 Brachialis, M., 166, 438, 439 Brachial plexus, 386; dissection of, 467; vein, 318 Brachioradialis, M., 173, 438 Brachium conjuctivum, 348, 349 Brachium, muscles of, 164 pontis, 347, 348, 349 quadrigeminum inferius, 351, 354; superius, 351, 354 Brain, 339 arteries of, 289, 291 476 Brain, diagrams of, 343 dissection of, 464 preparation of, 462 preservation of, 462 removal of, 462 study of, 464 veins of, 324 Breast, muscles of, 144; dissection of, equina, 339 437; nerves of, 387 Broad ligament, 264, 266 Bronchi, 252 Bronchial arteries, 283 veins, 318 Buccee, 222 Buccal cavity, 221 nerves, 377 Buccinator, M., 106, 435 nerve, 374 Bulbocavernosus, M., 271, 454 Bulbourethral glands, 261 Bulbus olfactorius, 362 urethrz, 261 Bulla, auditory, 32, 55 tympanic, 32, 55 Burdach, column of, 337, 345 * Ceecum, 238 Calf of leg, muscles of, 203 Calcaneometatarsalis, M., 215, 445 Calcaneus, $2, 83 Callosal sulcus, 362 Canal, alimentary, 221 anterior palatine, 41 condyloid, 24, 58 facial, 35, 58 Hunter’s, 311 hypoglossal, 24, 58 Canalis adductorius, 311 facialis, 35, 58 Canal, lachrymal, 40, 54, 410 nasolachrymal, 40, 47, 54, 410 of Huguier, 376 posterior palatine, 45, 46, 54, 56 pterygoid, 27, 56, 59 sacral, 8 - Canals, semicircular, 425, 426 Canine teeth, 225 Caninus, M., 106, 435 Capitatum, os, 70 Capitulum, 18, 66 Capsula lentis, 414 Capsularis, M., 190, 444 Capsule of Glisson, 302 of lens 414 Caput epididymis, 260 Cardiac nerves, 380, 405, 406 plexus ,380, 382, 405 Cardinal veins, 328 INDEX. Carotid groove, 26 plexus, 287 Carpus, 69 Cartilage, costal, 18 Cartilages of larynx, 247 Cartilago auricule, 415, 416 Cauda epididymis, 260 Caudal muscles, 136; dissection of, 447 vertebree, I, II Caudoanalis, M., 270 Caudocavernosus, M., 271 Caudofemoralis, M.; 195, 444 Caudorectalis, M., 270 Caudovaginalis, M., 272 Cavernous sinus, 325 Cavities of the skull, 57 Cavity, abdominal, 217 body, 217 buccal, 221 - mediastinal, 218 nasal, 59, 243 pelvic, 218 thoracic, 217 Cavum nasi, 243 oris, 221 tympani, 422 Central nervous system, 335 Centrale, 69 q Centrum, 3 { Cephalica, V., 319 Cephalobrachial muscle, 118 Cephalohumeral muscle, 118 Ceratohyal, 49 q Ceratohyoid muscle, 115, 440 Cerebellar arteries, 292 fossa, 57, 58 gyri, 348 hemispheres, 348 Cerebellum, 341, 347 arteries of, 292 | Cerebral aqueduct, 342, 343. 350, 351, 352 | arteries, 289, 292 | fissures, 359 § fossa, 58 gyrl, 359 hemispheres, 341, 357 peduncles, 351 sulci, 359 vein, inferior, 325 Cerebri magna, V., 324 Cerebrum, 341, 357 arteries of, 289, 292 Ceruminous glands, 416 Cervical ganglia of sympathetic, 404, 405 lymphatic glands, 332 Carotid artery, common, 283; external, nerves, 383 . 285; internal, 285 plexus, 386 a ee eee INDEX. 477 Cervical vertebrze, I, 11, 15 Cervicalis ascendens, A., 293; V., 320 profunda, A., 293 Cervicofacial muscle, 95 - Cervix uteri, 266 Chambers of eye, 414 Cheek, muscles of, 105 Cheeks, 222 Chevron bones, II Chiasma, optic, 342, 354, 355, 369 Chiasmatic groove, 29, 59 Choanze, 60, 232, 244 Chorde tendinez, 278 Chorda tympani nerve, 375, 376 Choroid, 413 plexus of fourth ventricle. 350; of lateral ventricles, 353, 363, 367; of third ventricle, 354, 355 Ciliary body, 413 folds, 413 ganglion, 369, 371 nerve, long, 371; short, 370 Circle of Willis, 289, 292 Circulatory system, 274; dissection of, 455 Circulus arteriosus, 289, 292 Circumference, articular, 67 Circumflexa femoris lateralis, A., 311 humeri anterior, A., 296; posterior, A., 296 scapulee, A., 294 Circumflex nerve, 388 Circumvallate papillz, 227 Clava, 345, 349 Clavicle, 64 Clavicula, 64 Clavobrachial muscle, 157, 437, 439 Clavotrapezius muscle, 118, 436 Cleidomastoid muscle, 120, 436, 440 Clinoid processes, 26, 29 Clitoris, 264, 267 Coats of the eyeball, 413 of the testis, 258 Coccygeal nerves, 404 Coccygeus, M., 137 Cochlea, 425 Ceeliac artery, 301 ganglion, 406 plexus, 406 Ccelom, 217 Colica dextra, A., 304 media, A., 303 sinistra, A., 306 Collateral ligaments, 74, 88 radial artery, 297 ulnar artery, 297 Colliculi inferiores, 349, 351 superiores, 351 Collum of rib, 19 Colon, 237 Colon, ligaments of, 219 Columnz carnez, 278 Columns of spinal cord, 336 Commissura anterior, 357, 365 labiorum, 222 posterior, 355 Commissure, middle, 354 Common bile-duct, 241 carotid artery, 282, 283 iliac veins, 328 Communicating branches of sympa- thetic, 406 Complexus, M., 133, 443 Compound terms, viii Compressor urethree membranacez, M., 271, 454 Concha auris, 415, 416 nasalis superior, 42 ventral nasal, 40 Concheeus externus, M., 422, 470 Condyle, occipital, 23, 52, 55 Condyles of femur, tibia, 80 Condyloid canal, 24, 58 process, 48 Conjunctiva, 409, 410 Constrictor cunni, M., 272 pharyngis inferior, M., 232, 451; me- dius, M., 233,451; superior, M., 233 vestibuli, M., 272 Constrictors of anal glands, 269 Conus arteriosus, 277 Cor, 274 Coracobrachialis, M., 164 Coracoid border, 63, 64 process, 63, 64 Coracovertebral angle, 63 Cord, spinal, 335 Corium, 427 Cornea, 412, 413 Cornetoconchzeus, M., 422 Cornua of hyoid, 49 of uterus, 266 Coronal sulcus, 360 Coronaria ventriculi, V., 326 Coronary artery, 275; 279, 281 ligament of liver, 221 sinus, 277, 316 sulcus, 274 veins, 277, 315 Coronoid fossa, 48, 66 process, 48, 69 Corpora mammillaria, 356 quadrigemina, 351 Corpus callosum, 357, 363 cavernosum clitoridis, 267; penis, 263; urethree, 261, 263 ciliare, 413 geniculatum laterale. 354; mediale, 351, 354 478 INDEX. Corpus luteum, 264 of sternum, 20 of vertebrze, 3 pineale, 351, 355 restiforme, 346, 348, 349 spongiosum, 261 striatum, 363, 367 vitreum, 415 Corrugator supercilii lateralis, M., 98, 435; medialis, M., 97, 435 Cortical portion of kidney, 256 Coste, 18 spuriz, I9 vere, 19 Costal cartilage, 18 facet, 3, 5 Costocervical axis, 292 vein, 318 Cowper’s glands, 261 Cranial cavity, 57 nerves, 346, 369; dissection of, 465 portion of skull, 21 Cranium, 21 Cremaster muscle, 258 Cremasteric fascia, 258 Crest, external occipital, 24, 52 nasal, 40, 42 of ilium, 78 of tibia, 81 sagittal, 25, 50 Cribriform plate, 43 : Cricoarytenoideus lateralis, M., 251 posterior, 249 Cricoid cartilage, 248 Cricothyroid muscle, 249 Crista helicis, 417 Crucial ligaments, 88, 89 Cruciate sulcus, 360, 361 Crura cerebelli, 341, 348 of diaphragm, 152 of penis, 263 Crural arches, 154 fascia, deep, 206 muscle, 202 Crus cerebelli ad medullam, 346 Crus of diaphragm, 152 Crus, muscles of, 203 Crystalline lens, 414 Cuboid, 82, 84 Cuneatus, fasciculus, 337, 345, 346 Cuneiform bones, 70, 80, 84, 85 Cutaneous nerve, external, 388 Cutaneus colli, N., 385 femoralis lateralis, N., 396 femoris posterior, N., 403 maximus, M., 93, 434 medialis, N., 390 Cystic artery, 302 duct, 241 Deciduous teeth, 226 Deltoid muscle, 156 ridge, 66 Demifacets, costal, 3 Dens, 14, 15 Dental arteries, 288 nerves, inferior, 375 Dentes, 224 ' Depressor conche, M., 103, 435 Dermal muscles, 93 Diaphragm, 151; dissection of, 446 Diastema, 225 Diencephalon, 342, 343, 344, 352 Digastric muscle, 107, 440 Digestive apparatus, 221 Digital arteries, 297, 314 Digital fossa, 79 Digits, 72 Directions for dissection, 429 Disarticulation of skulls, 430 Dissection of alimentary canal, 449 blood-vessels, 456 brain, 464 circulatory system, 455 cranial nerves, 465 diaphragm, 446 ear, 470 eye, 469 ligaments, 431 lymphatics, 460 muscles, 433 nervous system, 461, 465 pelvic muscles, 446 respiratory organs, 452 sense organs, 469 spinal nerves, 467 sympathetic system, 465 urogenital organs, 453 viscera, 447 Dorsalis penis, A., 308; N., 403 Dorsum sellz, 26, 59 Drying of material, 432 Ductus Botalli, 280 communis choledochus, 241 Ducts of salivary glands, 222, 223 Duodenohepatic ligament, 220 Duodenorenal ligament, 219 Duodenum, 236; ligaments of, 219, 220 Dura mater, 337, 368 veins of, 324 venous sinuses of, 324 Ear, 415 Ear bones, 423 dissection of, 470 external, removal of, 435 muscles of, 96, 99, 103, 104, 418 Ectocuneiform, 84 Ectopectoralis, M., 145 INDEX. Ectosylvian gyrus, 360 sulcus. 359 Ectotympanic bone, 32 Eighth cranial nerve, 347, 377 Elbow-joint, 74 Eleventh cranial nerve, 346, 382 Eminence, iliopectineal, 78 Eminentia conche, 416 Encephalon, 339 Entocuneiform, 85 Entopectoralis, M., 146 Entotympanic bone, 32 Eparterial bronchus, 252 Epicondyles, 67, 80 Epicranius, M., 101, 435 Epidermis, 427 Epididymis, 260 Epigastric artery, inferior, 309 Epiglottic cartilage, 248 Epiglottis, 246 Epihyal, 49 Epimeralis, M., 190 Epiphysis, 351, 355 of bones, 3 Epistropheus, 15 Epitrochlea, 67 Epitrochlearis, M., 164, 438 Ethmoidal artery, 289 foramen, 38 nerve, 371 Ethmoid bone, 42 cells, 44 Ethmoturbinals, 42 Eustachian tube, 232, 423 Excretory organs, 255; dissection of, 453 Exoccipital bones, 22 Extensor antibrachii longus, M., 164 brevis digitorum, M., 212, 445; pol- licis, M., 178, 439 carpi radialis brevis, M., 174, 438; longus, M., 173, 438; ulnaris, M., 176, 439 caude lateralis, M., 137, 443, 447; medialis, M., 130, 136, 443, 447 communis digitorum, M., 174, 439 digitorum lateralis, M., 175, 439; longus, 210, 445 : dorsi communis, M., 124 indicis proprius, M., 176, 439 muscles of arm, 173 ossis metacarpi pollicis, M., 178 - External carotid artery, 285 ear, 415 iliac artery, 307, 309; vein, 328, 329 intercostal muscles, 150 jugular vein, 319 maxillary artery, 285, 286 oblique muscle, 153 _occipital crest, 24, 52; protuberance, 24 479 External pterygoid muscle, III sternocostal muscle, 150 Extremities, pelvic, bones of, 76 thoracic, bones of, 62 Eye, 409, 412 Eyeball, 412 Eyelids, 409; muscles of, 97, 410, 412 Eye, muscles of, 411 Face, muscles of, 96 veins of, 321 Facet, articular, 4 auricular, 10 costal, 3, 5 transverse costal, 4 tubercular, 4 Facial bones, 21 canal, 35, 58 muscles, 96; dissection of, 434 nerve, 347, 375 portion of skull, 21, 49 vein, anterior, 321 vein, deep, 323; posterior, 323 Fallopian tubes, 263, 264 False ribs, 19 vocal cords, 246 Fascia, antibrachial, 172 cremasteric, 258 deep crural, 206 endothoracica, 217 intercolumnar, 258 lata, 186 lumbodorsal, 126 of back, 126 of thigh, 186 propria, 258 Fasciculus cuneatus, 337, 345, 346 cuneatus lateralis, 346 gracilis, 336, 345 Fauces, pillars of, 230 Female genital organs, 263 Femoral artery, 307, 310 nerve, 397 Femur, 79 Fenestra cochlez, 34, 425 ovalis, 34 rotunda, 34 vestibuli, 34, 424, 425 Fibrocartilages, intervertebral, 16 Fibrocartilagines intervertebrales, 16 Fibula, 82 Fifth cranial nerve, 347, 379 Filiform papillz, 227 Filum terminale, 335 Fingers, arteries of, 297 bones of, 72 muscles of, 185 First cranial nerve, 369 Fissura cerebri lateralis, 358 Fissure of Sylvius, 358 480 INDEX. Fissure, orbital, 27, 54, 59 Formalin as preservative, 431 Fissures of cerebrum, 359 . Formalin-glycerine mixture for injec- medulla oblongata, 344, 345 tion, 432 spinal cord, 335 Formula for teeth, 224 Flexor brevis digiti quinti, M., 186, 439; | Fornicate gyrus, 362 digiti secundi, M., 185; digitorum, | Fornix, 358, 363, 364 M., 205, 212, 445; pollicis, M., | Fossa, anterior, 59 184, 439 appendicular, 35, 58 carpi radialis, M., 179, 439 cerebellar, 57, 58 carpi ulnaris, M., 180, 439 cerebral, 58 caudz brevis, M., 138, 446; longus, coronoid, 48, 66 M., 138, 446; longus digitorum, M., digital, 79 207, 208, 445; hallucis, M., 207, 445 external pterygoid, 30, 53 muscles of forearm, 179 glenoid, 63 perforans, M., 181 iliopectineal, 310 perforatus, M., 181 infraspinous, 63 profundus digitorum, M., 181, 439 intercondyloid, 80 sublimis digitorum, M., 181, 439 internal pterygoid, 28, 54 Floating ribs, 19 mandibular, 32, 52 Follicles, Graafian, 264 masseteric, 48 ; : solitary, 237 middle, 59 3 Foot, arteries of, 312, 314 olecranon, 66 a bones of, 82 olfactory, 59 joints and ligaments of, 91 orbital, 53 muscles of, 212; dissection of, 445 ovalis, 277 nerves of, 402 radial, 66 veins of, 329 rhomboidea, 349 Foramen, anterior palatine, 57 subscapular, 63 atlantal, 14 supraspinous, 63 : | cecum, 345 temporal, 51, 53 j epiploicum, 220 trochanteric, 79 | ethmoidal, 38 Fourth cranial nerve, 350, 370 hypoglossal, 24, 56, 58 ventricle, 341, 343, 344, 349 a incisivum, 41, 57 Frenulum glossoepiglottica, 227 infraorbital, 40, 54 linguze, 222, 227 5 interventricular, 356, 365, 368 of epiglottis, 246 intervertebral, 4 of lips, 221 é | jugular, 24, 33, 56, 58 penis, 257 lacerum, 26, 59; anterius, 54 Frontal bone, 37 magnum, 22, 52, 55, 58 lobe of brain, 358 mandibular, 48 muscle, IOI: mental, 47 nerve, 370 obturator, 76 plate, 37 of Monroe, 356, 365, 368 process, 39, 40, 47, 51 of Winslow, 220 sinuses, 38, 61 optic, 29 54, 59 spine, 37 ovale, 27. 54, 56, 59 ‘ vein, 321 ovale of heart, 277 Frontoauricular muscle, 99, 435 rotundum, 27, 54, 56, 59 Frontoscutularis, M., 104, 435 sacral, 9, IO Fundus of stomach, 234 sphenopalatine, 46, 54 'Fungiform papillz, 227 stylomastoid, 33, 34, 52, 55 Funiculi of spinal cord, 336 supracondyloid, 67 transversarium, 13 Galea aponeurotica, Lol vertebral, I Gall-bladder, 241 Forearm, muscles of, 172 Ganglia, sympathetic, 404, 405, 406, Fore limbs, bones of, 62 408 muscles of, 156; dissection, 436 thoracic, 406 Jymphatics of, 332 Ganglion cervicale inferius, 405 Formalin-alcohol mixture for brains, 463 cervicale mediale, 405; superius, 404 ee INDEX Ganglion, coeliac, 406 Gasserian, 347, 370 geniculi, 375 inferior mesenteric, 408 jugulare, 378 nodosum, 378 of the root, 378 of the trunk, 378 ophthalmic, 369 petrosum, 378 semilunar, 347, 370, 406 sphenopalatine, 372 superior mesenteric, 407 superius, 378 Gasserian ganglion, 347, 370 Gastrica sinistra, A., 303 Gastric plexuses, 382 Gastrocnemius, M., 203, 445 Gastroduodenal ligament, 235 artery, 302 Gastroepiploica dextra, A., 303; V., 327 Gastrohepatic ligament, 220, 245 Gastrolienal ligament, 235 omentum, 220 Gastrosplenic omentum, 220 vein, 327 Gemellus inferior, M., 190, 444 superior, M., 189, 444 Geniculate ganglion, 375 Genioglossus, M., 228, 440, 450 Geniohyoid muscle, 113, 440 Genital organs, 257; dissection of, 453, 454 Genitofemoral nerve, 396 Genu (brain), 364 Gland, bulbourethral, 261 , Cowper’s, 261 infraorbital, 224 lachrymal, 410 molar, 224 orbital, 224 parotid, 223 prostate, 261 sublingual, 224 submaxillary, 223 thymus, 254 thyroid, 254 Glands, Harderian, 410 inguinal 334 lymphatic, 330 Meibomian, 409 of mouth 223 of urethra, 261 tarsal, 409 Glandule oris, 223 suprarenales, 257 Glans penis, 257, 261 Glenoid angle, 62, 64 border, 63 fossa, 63 481 Glenovertebral angle, 63 Glisson, capsule of, 302 Glottis, 246 Glossoepiglotticus, M., 250 Glossopharyngeal nerve, 347, 378 Glossopharyngeus, M., 232, 451 Gluteal arteries, 308 nerve, inferior, 399; superior, 399 vein, inferior, 329 Gluteus maximus, M., 187, 444 medius, M., 188, 444 minimus, M., 189, 444 quartus, M., 190 Glycerine-formalin mixture for inject- ing, 432 Goll, column of, 337, 345 Graafian follicles, 264 Gracilis, fasciculus, 336, 345; M., 198, 444 Gray matter, 336 Great auricular vein, 324 Greater curvature of stomach, 234 Great omentum, 219, 235 scapular notch, 64 sciatic nerve, 400 sciatic notch, 77 sigmoid cavity, 69 transverse fissure, 363 trochanter, 79 tuberosity, 65 Gyri of cerebellum, 348 cerebrum, 359 Gyrus, anterior Sylvian, 359 compositus posterior, 360 ectosylvius, 360 fornicatus, 362 marginalis, 360, 361 orbitalis, 360 posterior Sylvian, 359 sigmoideus, 360 suprasylvius, 360 Habenule, 355 Hemal processes, II Hair, distribution of, 427 Hamatum, os, 70 : Hamular process, 28 Hamulus, 28, 54 Hand, arteries of, 300 bones of, 71 joints and ligaments of, 75 muscles of, 184; dissection of, 439 Harderian glands, 410 Head, bones of, 21 muscles of, 96; dissection, 434, 440 nerves of, 369 Heart, 274; dissection of, 455 veins of, 315 Heel, 83 Helicis, M., 421, 470 482 Helix, 417 Hemispheres of cerebellum, 348 cerebrum, 341, 357 Hemorrhoidal arteries, 306, 308 nerve, inferior, 404 nerve, middle, 403 veins, 329 Hepar, ‘239 Hepatic artery, 302 ducts, 241 plexus, 408 veins, 326 Hepatorenal ligament, 221 Hiatus facialis, 35 Hilus, 255 Hind brain, 344 Hind limb, bones of, 76 muscles of, 186; dissection, 444 Hip-joint, 87 Hip, muscles of, 186 Hippocampal sulcus, 362 Hippocampus, 365 Horns of uterus, 266 Huguier, canal of, 376 Humerus, 64 Humor, aqueous, 414 vitreous, 415 Hunter’s canal, 311 Hyoepiglotticus, M.. 250 Hyoglossus, M., 228, 440, 450 Hyoid bone, 49 muscles of, 112 Hyparterial bronchi, 252 lobes of lungs, 281 Hy pogastric arteries, 307 vein, 328, 329 Hypoglossal canal, 24, 58 foramen, 24, 56, 58 nerve, 346, 383 Hypophysis, 355, 356 Iliac arteries, 307, 309 glands, 333 veins, 328, 329 Tleocolic artery, 304 valve, 237 Tleum, 237 lliocaudalis, M., 137, 446 Tliocostalis, M., 124, 128, 443 Tliohy pogastric nerve, 395 Tlioinguinal nerve, 395 Tliolumbar arteries, 306 veins, 326 Tliopectineal eminence, 78 fossa, 310 line, 78 Tliopsoas, M., 138, 193, 444, 446 Tliosacral ligaments, 86, 87 Tlium, 76, 77 Incisive duct, 222 INDEX. Incisive foramen, 41, 57 Incisor teeth, 225 Incisura acetabuli, 79 scapule, 64 Incus, 424 Index, 72 Index, muscles of, 185 Inferior alveolar artery, 288 cerebral vein, 325 cervical ganglion, 405 dental artery, 288 epigastric artery, 309 gluteal arteries, 308 maxillary bone, 47 mesenteric artery, 306; vein, 328 thyroid artery, 283, 284 vena Cava, 325 vesical artery, 307 Infraorbital artery, 290 foramen, 40, 54 gland, 224 nerve, 372 Infraspinatus muscle, 160, 438 Infraspinous fossa, 63 Infratochlear nerve, 371 * Infundibulum, 355 Inguinal canal, 259 glands, 334 ligament, 153 rings, 259 Injection mass, 456 of blood-vessels, 456 of formalin, 431 of lymphatics, 460 Innominate arteries, 282 bone, 76 veins, 318 Insula, 359 Integument, 427 muscles, 93 Integumentum commune, 427 Intercarpal ligaments, 75 Intercolumnar fascia, 258 Intercondyloid fossa, 80 Intercostal arteries, 283 artery, superior, 293 Intercostales externi, M., 150, 441 interni, I51, 441 Intercostal veins. 316 Internal carotid artery, 285 ear, 424 iliac artery, 307; vein, 329 intercostals, 151 jugular vein, 320 mammary artery, 292; vein, 318 maxillary artery, 287 oblique muscle, 154 pterygoid muscle, 111 sternocostal muscle, 151 Intermediate cuneiform, 84 ey a ee INDEX. Intermedius scutulorum, M., 96, 443 Interossei, Mm., 185, 214, 439, 445 Interosseous arteries, 298, 300 ligaments, 75 membrane, 75, 90 nerve, dorsal, 392; posterior, 390 Interparietal bone, 25 Interspinalis, M., 124, 131, 136, 443 Intertransversarii, M., 124, 131, 136, 443 Intertrochanteric line, 79 Interventricular foramen, 356, 365, 368 Intervertebral fibrocartilages, 16 foramina, 4 Intestine, 236 arteries of, 303 Intestine, large,237 small, 236 Intestinum crassum, 237 tenue, 236 Intrinsic muscles of tongue, 229 Iris, 413, 414 Ischiadicus, N., 400 Ischiocavernosus, M., 269, 454, 455 Ischium, 76, 78 Isthmus faucium, 221, 230 rhombencephali, 350 Jacobson, organ of, 222, 244 Jaw, lower, bone of, 47 upper, bones of, 39, 41 Jejunum, 237 Joints of pelvic limbs, 86 of skull, 61 of thoracic limbs, 73 Jugal bone, 47 Jugular foramen, 24, 33, 56, 58 ganglion, 378 notch, 24 process, 24, 52, 55 vein, external, 319 ; internal, 320 Jugulohyoid muscle, 113, 440 Kidney, 255 Kidneys, arteries to, 304 Knee-joint, 87, 89 Knee, ligaments of, 87, 89 Labial arteries, 286 veins, 321 Labia oris, 221 Labrum glenoidale, 87 Labyrinth, 424, 425 Labyrinths of ethmoid, 42, 43 Lachrymal apparatus, 410 bone, 46 canal, 40, 54, 410 gland, 410 nerve, 371 Lambdoidal ridge, 24, 50, 52 483 Lamina, 4 : chorioidea epithelialis, 355, 363, 367 cribrosa, 43 fusca, 413 papyracea, 44 perpendicularis, 42, 43 spiralis, 425 terminalis, 352, 357 Large intestine, 237 Laryngeal arteries, 285 Laryngeal muscles, 249; dissection of, 452 nerve, inferior, 380; superior, 380 veins, 321 Larynx, 246 cartilages of, 247 muscles of, 249 Lateral angle (scapula), 63 cuneiform, $4 fissure of cerebrum, 358 ligaments of bladder, 257 mass of atlas, 14; of sacrum, Io sulcus, 360 ventricles, 341, 343, 362, 368 Latissimus dorsi, M., 121, 437 Leg, arteries of, 309 bones of, 79 ligaments of, 86 lower, muscles of, 203 muscles, 186; dissection, 444 veins of, 329 Lens, crystalline, 414 Lenticular bone, 424 process, 424 Lesser curvature of stomach, 234 omentum, 220 palatine artery, 290 sciatic notch, 78 trochanter, 79 tuberosity of humerus, 65 Levator anguli oris, M., 106 ani, M., 137, 269, 446, 454 auris longus, M., 99, 435 claviculz, M., 120 Levatores costarum, M., 150, 443 Levator labii superioris aleeque nasi, M., 105, 435 ; superioris proprius, M., 106, 435 palpebrze superioris, M., 412 scapule, M., 122, 123, 437 scapulee dorsalis, M., 118 scapule ventralis, M., 120, 436, 440, 443 scroti, M., 258, 271, 453 veli palatini, M., 230, 451 vulvze, M., 272, 455 Lien, 242 ‘ Ligament (see also Ligamentum) annular, 75, 173, 213 anterior longitudinal, 16 484 Ligament, broad, 264, 266 cervical supraspinous, 17 coronary, 221 duodenohepatic, 220 duodenorenal, 219 gastroduodenal, 235 gastrohepatic, 220, 235 gastrolienal, 235 hepatorenal, 221 inguinal, 153 lateral, of atlas, 17 orbital, 47 of peritoneum, 218 posterior longitudinal, 16 Poupart’s, 153 pulmonary, 253 round, 87, 220, 267 stylomandibular, 62, 228 supraspinous, 16 suspensory, 219, 220, 257 transverse, 18, 87, 91, 172 triangular, 221 Ligaments, collateral, 74, 88 crucial, 89 iliosacral, 86, 87 intercarpal, 75 interosseous, 75 of bladder, 219, 257 of hip-joint, 87 of liver, 220 of malleoli, 91 of menisci, 90 ofovary, 264 of pelvic limbs, 86 ofribs, I9 of skull, 61 of tarsus, 9I of thoracic limbs, 73 of uterus, 266 of vertebral column, 16 preparation of, 431 study of, 431. vaginal, 173 Ligamentum (a) alaria, 18 ; arteriosum, 280 Botalli, 280 collaterale, 74, 88 cruciata, 89 denticulatum, 337 dorsalia, 92 flava, 17 interossea, 92 interspinalia, 17 intertransversaria, 17 lateralia, 92 longitudinale anterius, 16; posterius, 16 nuchee, 17 ovarii, 264 INDEX. Ligamentum patelle, 81, 88 plantaria, 92 supraspinale, 16 suspensorium penis, 262 teres, 87, 220 transversum cruris, 91 Limbs, arteries of, 294, 309 bones of, 62, 76 lymphatics of, 332, 334 muscles of, 156, 186 veins of, 318, 328 Linea aspera, 80 Line, iliopectineal, 78 intertrochanteric, 79 spiral, 79 Lingua, 226 Lingual artery, 285, 286 nerve, 375 vein, 323 Lingula, 28 Lips, 221 muscles of, 105 Liquid soap, for bones, 430 Liver, 239 arteries of, 302 ligaments of, 220 veins of, 326 Lobes of cerebrum, 358 of liver, 239 Lobus pyriformis, 361, 362 Longissimus capitis, M., 128, 131, 443 cervicis, M., 128, 134 dorsi, M., 124, 126, 134, 442 Long saphenous nerve, 397 thoracic artery, 294 Longus atlantis, M., 134, 443 capitis, M., 142, 442 colli, M., 144, 442 Lumbar aponeurosis, 154 arteries, 283, 306 nerves, 394 plexus, 395 veins, 326 vertebree, 1, 7 Lumboabdominal arteries, 304 Lumbodorsal fascia, 126 Lumboinguinal nerve, 396 Lumbosacral cord, 399 plexus, 396 Lumbricales, Mm., 184, 213, 439, 445 Lunare, 69 Lungs, 252 Lymph, 330 Lymphatic duct, right, 331, 332 glands, 330 Lymphatics, 330 demonstration of, 460 injection of, 460 Magnum, os, 70 INDEX, Malar bone, 47 Male genital organs, 257 _ Malleoli, ligaments of, 91 Malleolus, lateral, 82 medial, 81 Malleus, 423 Mammary artery, internal, 292 glands, 268 Mammillary bodies, 356 process, 6, 8 Mandible, 47 articulations of, 61 Mandibular foramen, 48 fossa, 32, 52 nerve, 379, 373 Manubrium, 20 Manus, bones of, 71 Marginal gyrus, 360, 361 - sulcus, 361 Margin, supraorbital, 37 Massa intermedia, 354, 357 Masseter, M., 108, 440 Masseteric fossa, 48 nerve, 374. Mastication, muscles of, 107 Mastoid portion of temporal, 34, 35 process, 35, 55 Maxilla, 39 Maxillary arteries, 285, 286, 287 Maxillary bone, 39 inferior, 47 nerve, 370, 371 spine, 45 Maxilloturbinal, 40 Meati of nose, 44, 60, 243, 244, 245 Meatus auditorius externus, 32, 33, 52, 55, 415, 416 external auditory, 32, 33, 52, 55, 415, 416 inferior, 60 internal auditory, 35, 58 superior, 44 Medial cuneiform, 85 Mediana cubiti, V., 319 Median nerve, 390 Mediastinal artery, 282 cavity, 218 lobe of lung, 253 Mediastinum, 218 Medius, 72 Medulla oblongata, 340, 344 Medullary portion of kidney, 256 Medulla spinalis, 335 Meibomian glands, 409 Membrana nictitans, 410 tympani, 422 Membrane, anterior atlanto-occipital, 17 interosseous. 75, 90 mucous, 221 posterior atlanto-occipital, 17 485 Membranes of brain, 368 spinal cord, 337 Membranous labyrinth, 425; prepara- tion of, 471 Meningeal artery, middle, 289 Menisci, 87; ligaments of, 90 Mental foramen, 47 nerves, 375 Mesencephalon, 341, 343, 344, 351 Mesenteric arteries, 303, 3 Mesenteric ganglion, inferior, 408; su- perior, 407 glands, 333 plexus, inferior, 408; superior, 408 vein, inferior, 328; superior, 328 Mesentery, 218, 219, 236 Mesocolon, 219 Mesocuneiform, 84 Mesogastrium, 219 Mesorectum, 219 Metacarpals, 71 muscles of, 185 Metacarpus, 71 Metacromion, 64 Metapophysis, 6 Metatarsal artery, 315 Metatarsals, 85 Metatarsus, 85 Metencephalon, 341, 343, 344, 347 Midbrain, 341, 343, 344, 351 Middle cerebral artery, 289 cervical ganglion, 405 Middle ear, 422; muscles of, 424 commissure, 354 fossa, 59 meningeal artery, 289 sacral artery, 301, 309; vein, 328 Minimus, 72; muscles of, 185 Mitral valve, 279 Modiolus, 425 Molar gland, 224 teeth, 225 Monroe, foramen of, 356, 365, 368 Mould, attacks of, 432 Moustachier, M., 107, 435 Mouth, 221; glands of, 223 Mucosa, 221 Mucous membrane, 221 Multangulum majus, os, 71 minus, os, 71 Multifidus spine, 124, 130, 443 Muscle, see Musculus Muscles, 93; dissection of, 434 abdomen, 153; dissection, 441 antibrachium, 172 anus, 268 arm, 156; dissection of, 437 back, 115, 123; dissection, 442 body, 115 breast, 144; dissection, 437 486 Muscles of crus, 203 digits, 184, 213 ear, 96, 99, 103, 104, 418; dissection, 479, 471 external ear, 418 eye, 411; dissection of, 469 eyelid, 97, 410, 412 face, 96; dissection, 434 fingers, 185 foot, 212; dissection, 445 forearm, 172 fore limb, 156; dissection, 436 hand, 184; dissection, 439 head, 96; dissection, 434, 440 hind limbs; 186; dissection, 444 hip, 186 hyoid, 112 index finger, 185 larynx, 249; dissection of, 452 lips, 105 lower leg, 203 mastication, 107 middle ear, 424 minimus, 185 neck, 131, 139; dissection, 439, 442 orbit, 411 palate, 230; dissection, 451 pectoral, 144 pelvic limbs, 186 pelvis, dissection, 446 penis, 271 pharynx, 232; dissection, 451 preparation of, 431 shoulder, 115, 156 skin, 93, 427; dissection, 434 tail, 136; dissection, 447 tarsus, 215 thigh, 194 thoracic limbs, 156; dissection, 436 thoracic wall, 148 thorax, 144; dissection, 441 thumb, 184 toes, 214 tongue, 228; dissection, 450 urethra, 271 urogenital organs, 268; dissection, 454 vagina,’ 272 vertebral column, 123, 138; dissec- tion, 442, 446 Musculi pectinati, 276 Musculocutaneus nerve, 388 Musculospiral nerve, 392 Musculus (i) abductor auris brevis, 100, 435; lon- gus, 100, 435 brevis pollicis, 184, 439 caude (coccygis) externus, 447; internus, 137, 446 137; INDEX. Musculus abductor cruris, 195 digiti quinti, 185, 439; secundi, 185 medius digiti quinti, 215 accelerator urine, 271 acromiodeltoideus, 157, 438 acromiotrapezius, 116, 436 adductor auris inferior, 104, 435; me- dius, 419, 470; superior, 419, 470 femoris, 198, 444 digiti secundi, 185 longus, 199, 444 medius digiti quinti, 215 pollicis, 185, 439 anconeus, 170, 438; internus, 170; lateralis, 167; longus, 168; poste- rior, 168 antitragicus, 421, 470 arytenoideus transversus, 250 attollens auris, 100 auricularis anterior, 104, 419; exter- hus, 420, 470; posterior, 99; su- perior, 100, 435 biceps brachii, 165, 438,. 439; femo- ris, 194, 444 biventer cervicis, 132, 443 brachialis, 166, 438, 439 brachioradialis, 173, 438 buccinator, 106, 435 bulbocavernosus, 271, 454 calcaneometatarsalis, 215, 445 caninus, 106, 435 capsularis, 190, 444 caudoanalis, 270 caudocavernosus, 271 caudofemoralis, 195, 444 caudorectalis, 270 caudovaginalis, 272 ceratohyoideus, 115, 440 cervicofacialis, 95 clavobrachialis, 157, 437, 439 clavotrapezius, 118, 436 + cleidomastoideus, 120, 436, 440 coccygeus, 137 complexus, 133, 443 compressor urethree membranaceze. 271, 454 conchezeus externus, 422, 470 constrictor cunni, 272 pharyngis inferior, 232, 451; me- dius, 233, 451; superior, 233 vestibuli, 272 coracobrachialis, 164 cornetoconchezeus, 422 corrugator supercilii lateralis, 98, 435 corrugator supercilii medialis, 97, 435 cremaster, 258 cricoarytenoideus lateralis, 251; pos- ~ terior, 249 cricothyreoideus, 249 cruralis, 202 INDEX. Musculus cutaneus maximus, 93, 434 deltoideus, 156 depressor conchze, 103, 435 digastricus, 107, 440 ectopectoralis, 145 entopectoralis, 146 epicranius, IOI, 435 epimeralis, 190 epitrochlearis, 164, 438 extensor antibrachii longus, 164 brevis digitorum, 212, 445; pollicis, 178, 439 carpi radialis brevis, 174, 438; lon- gus, 173, 438 carpi ulnaris, 176, 439 caudz lateralis, 137, 443, 447; me- dialis, 130, 136, 443, 447 communis digitorum, 174, 439 digitorum lateralis, 175, 439; longus, 210, 445 dorsi communis, 124 indicis proprius, 176, 439 ossis metacarpi pollicis, 178 flexor brevis digiti quinti, 186, 439; secundi, 185 digitorum, 205, 212, 445 pollicis, 184, 439 [439 carpi radialis,179, 439; ulnaris, 180, caudz brevis, 138, 446; longus, 138, 4406 longus digitorum, 207, 208, 445; hallucis, 207, 445 perforans, 181 perforatus, 181 profundus digitorum, 181, 439 sublimis digitorum, 181, 439 frontalis, IOI frontoauricularis, 99, 435 frontoscutularis, 104, 435 gastrocnemius, 203, 445 gemellus inferior, 190, 444; superior, 189, 444 genioglossus, 228, 440, 450 geniohyoideus, 113, 440 glossoepiglotticus, 250 glossopharyngeus, 232, 451 gluteus maximus, 187, 444; medius, 188, 444; minimus, 189, 444; quar- tus, 190 gracilis, 198, 444 helicis, 421, 470 hyoepiglotticus, 250 hyoglossus, 228, 440, 450 iliocaudalis, 137, 446 iliocostalis, 124, 128, 443 iliopsoas, 138, 193, 444, 446 incisivi, 107 infraspinatus, 160, 438 intercostales externi, 150, 441; interni, 151, 441 487 Musculus intermedius scutulorum, 96, 434 interossei, 185, 214, 439, 445 interspinalis, 124, 131, 136, 443 intertransversarii, 124, 131, 139, 443 ischiocavernosus, 269, 454, 455 jugulohyoideus, 113, 440 latissimus dorsi, 121, 437 levator anguli oris, 106 ani, 137. 269, 446, 454 auris longus, 99, 435 clavicule, 120 levatores costarum, 150, 443 levator labii superioris alzeque nasi, 105, 435 labii superioris proprius, 106, 435 palbebrze superioris, 412 scapule, 122, 123, 437; dorsalis, 118; ventralis, 120, 436, 440, _ 443 scroti, 258, 271, 453 veli palatini, 230, 451 vulvze, 272, 455 longissimus capitis, 128, 131, 443; cervicis, 128, 134; dorsi, 124, 126, 134, 442 longus atlantis, 134, 443; capitis, 142, 442; colli, 144, 442 lumbricales, 184, 213, 439, 445 masseter, 108, 440 moustachier, 107, 435 multifidus spinze, 124, 130, 443 mylohyoideus, 114, 440 myrtiformis, 106, 435 nasalis, 106 obliqui, 411 obliquus abdominis externus, 153, 441; internus, 154, 441 capitis inferior 136; superior, 136, 442, 443 inferior, 412, 443 superior, 412 obturator externus, 191, 444; internus, 192, 444 occipitalis, LOI occipitofrontalis, IOI occipitoscapularis, 118, 436 opponens digiti quinti, 186, 215, 439 orbicularis oculi, 98, 435; oris, 105, 435 palmaris longus, 179, 439 parameralis, 195 pectineus, 200, 444 pectoantibrachialis, 145, 437 pectoralis major, 145, 437; minor, 146, 437 pedis perforatus, 205, 212 peroneus brevis, 210, 445; longus, 209, 445; tertius, 210, 445 plantaris, 205, 445 488 INDEX. Musculus platysma, 95, 434 Musculus styloglossus, 228, 440, 450 popliteus, 206, 445 stylohyoideus, 112, 440 pronator quadratus, 183, 439 stylopharyngeus, 233, 451 teres, 179, 439 submentalis, 103, 435 \ psoas minor, 139, 446 subscapularis, 161, 437 pterygoideus externus, III, 441; in- supercervicocutaneus, 95 ternus, III, 441 supinator, 177, 439; longus, 173 pterygopharyngeus, 233, supraspinatus, 159, 43 pubiocaudalis, 269 temporalis, I10, 440 pyriformis, 188, 444 tensor fascize late, 187, 444 quadratus femoris, I9l, 444 tympani, 424, 471 labii inferioris, 107, 435; supe- veli palatini, 230, 451 rioris, 105, 435 tenuissimus, 195, 444 lumborum, 139, 446 teres major, 163, 437, 438; minor, plantz, 213, 445 161, 438 quadriceps femoris, 201, 444 thyreoarytenoideus, 251 ~ recti, 411 thyreohyoideus, 249 rectocavernosus, 271 tibialis anterior, 211, 445; posterior, rectovaginalis, 272 208, 445 rectus abdominis, 155, 441 trachelomastoideus, 131 capitis anterior major, 142; minor, tragicus lateralis, 418, 435; medialis, 143, 442 421, 470 lateralis, 143, 442 transversus abdominis, 155, 441; posterior major, 134, 443; me- auriculze, 420, 470; costarum, 150, dius, 135, 443; minor, 135, 443 441; perinei, 269; thoracis, I51, femoris, 201, 444 441 inferior, 411; lateralis, 411, medi- trapezius, 115, 436 alis, 411; superior, 411 triangularis sterni, 151 retractor oculi, 411; penis, 271 triceps brachii, 166, 438 rhomboideus, 119, 436; capitis, 118 sure, 206 rotator auris, 419, 470 urethralis, 273 rotatores, 131 vastus intermedius, 203, 445; lateralis, sartorius, 197, 444 201, 445; medialis, 202, 445 scalenus, I4I, 441 xiphihumeralis, 147, 437 scalenus anterior, 141, 142 zygomaticus (major), IOI, 435; minor, medius, 141; posterior, 141 105, 435 scaphocuneiformis, 216, 445 Myelencephalon, 340, 343, 344 scutuloauricularis inferior, 419 Mylohyoid muscle, 114, 440 - semimembranosus, 196, 444 Myrtiformis, M., 106, 435 semispinalis capitis, 130, 132 cervicis, 130, 133, 443 Nails, 427 semitendinosus, 196, 444 Names of organs, v serratus anterior, 122, 437 Names of vertebral muscles, 124 posterior inferior, 148, 441; supe- | Nares, 51, 60, 244 rior, 148, 441 posterior, 60 soleus, 205, 445 Nasal bone, 42 sphincter ani externus, 268, 453; in- cavity, 59, 243 ternus, 269, 454 concha, superior, 42; ventral, 40 spinalis dorsi, 124, 128, 129, 133, crest, 40, 42 443 Nasalis, M., 106 spinodeltoideus, 156, 438 Nasal nerve, posterior, 372 spinotrapezius, 115, 436 process, 41 splenius, 131, 443 spine, 37; posterior, 45 stapedius, 424, 471 veins, external, 321 sternocleidomastoideus, 120, 139 Nasolachrymal canal, 49, 47, 54, 410 sternocostalis externus, 150; internus, duct, 40, 47, 410 151 Nasopharynx, 231 sternohyoideus, 140, 440 Nasoturbinal bone, 42 sternomastoideus, 139, 440 Navicular, 69, 82 sternothyreoideus, 141, 440 Naviculare pedis, os, 84 INDEX. 489 Neck, arteries of, 283, 293 muscles of, 131, 139 dissection, 439, 442 nerves of, 383 veins of, 320 Nerve, see Nervus. Nerves, cervical, 383 ‘coccygeal, 404 cranial, 369 lumbar, 394 of foot, 402 of head, 369 of neck, 383 of palm, 393 of shoulder, 387 of tail, 404 of taste, 378 sacral, 399 spinal, 337, 383 sympathetic, 404 thoracic, 393 Nervous system, 335; dissection, 461, 465; preparation, mee sympathet- ic, 404 Nervus abducens, 347, 375 accessorius, 346, 382 acusticus, 347, 377 alveolaris inferior, 374, 375 auricularis, 379 auricularis magnus, 385 ; posterior, 377 auriculotemporalis, 373 axillaris, 388 buccalis, 377 buccinatorius, 374 canalis pterygoidii, 372 cerebrales, 369 cardiacus, 380, 405, 406 chorda tympani, 375, 376 ciliaris brevis, 370 ciliaris longus, 371 circumflexus, 388 cutaneus colli, 385 femoris lateralis, 396; posterior, 403 medialis, 390 dorsalis penis, 403 ethmoidalis, 371 facialis, 347, 375 femoralis, 397 frontalis, 370 genitofemoralis, 396 Nervus ischiadicus, 400 _ lachrymalis, 371 laryngeus inferior, 380; superior, 380 lingualis, 375 lumboinguinalis, 396 mandibularis, 370, 373 massetericus, 374 maxillaris, 370, 371 medianus, 390 mentalis, 375 musculocutaneus, 388 nasalis posterior, 372 obturatorius, 397 occipitalis major, 384 oculomotorius, 352, 369 olfactorius, 369 ophthalmicus, 370 opticus, 342, 354, 355, 369, 412 palatinus major, 372; minor, 372 patheticus (trochlearis), 350, 370 peroneus communis, 400; profundus, 402; superficialis, 402 petrosus profundus, 373, 405; super- ficialis major, 373, 375 pharyngeus, 379 phrenicus, 388 plantaris lateralis, 403; medialis, 403 pterygoideus, 374 pudendus, 403 radialis, 392; superficialis, 392 saphenus, 397 sphenopalatinus, 372 splanchnicus major, 406; minor, 407 subcutaneus male, 372 suboccipitalis, 384 subscapulares, 388 suprascapularis, 388 suralis, 400 temporalis profundus, 374 thoracicus anterior, 387; posterior, 388 tibialis, 402 trifacialis, 370 trigeminus, 347, 370 trochlearis, 350, 370 ulnaris, 393 vagus, 346, 378 vidianus, 372 zygomaticus, 372, 377 glossopharyngeus, 347, 378 Neurapophysis, 4 gluteus inferior, 399; superior, 399 Nictitating membrane, 410 hemorrhoidalis inferior, 404; medius, | Ninth cranial nerve, 347, 378 403 | Nipples, 268 hypoglossus, 346, 383 Nomenclature, v iliohypogastricus, 395 Nose, 243 ilioinguinalis, 395 Notch, jugular, 24 infraorbitalis, 372 Number of bones, 1 infratrochlearis, 371 interosseus dorsalis, 392; posterior, 390 Oblique muscles of eye, 412 490 Obliquus abdominis externus, M., 153, 441; internus, M., 154, 441; ca- pitis inferior, M., 136, 443; supe- rior, M., 136, 442, 443 Obturator externus, M., IgI, 444 foramen, 76 internus, M., 192, 444 nerve, 397 Occipital artery, 285 bone, 22 condyle, 23, 52, 55 crest, external, 24, 52 lobe, 358 muscle, IOI nerve, great, 384 protuberance, 24 tubercle, external, 52 vein, 321 Occipitofrontal muscle, 101 Occipitoscapularis, M., 118, 436 Oculomotor nerve, 352, 369 Odontoid process, 14, 15 . (Esophageal arteries, 283 veins, 318 (Esophagus, 234 Olecranon, 69 fossa, 66 Olfactory bulb, 341, 362 fossa, 59 mucosa, 245 nerve, 369 organ, 245, 426 tract, 362 Oliva, 345 Omental sac, 219 Omentum, gastrolienal, 220 gastrosplenic, 220 great, 219, 235 lesser, 220 Ophthalmic artery, 289 ganglion, 369 nerve, 370 Opponens digiti quinti, M., 186, 215, 439 Optic chiasma, 342, 354, 355, 369 foramen, 29, 54, 59 nerves, 342, 354, 355, 369, 412 tract, 354, 355 Ora serrata, 414 Orbicularis oculi, M., 98, 435 oris, M., 105, 435 Orbit, 409 muscles of, 411 Orbital fissure, 27, 54, 59 fossa, 53 gland, 224 gyrus, 360 _ ligament, 47 plate, 37 process, 47 INDEX. Orbitosphenoid, 29 Organon auditus, 415 gustus, 427 olfactus, 426 visus, 409 Os calcis, 83 capitatum, 70 cox, 76 cuboideum, 82, 84 cuneiforme primum, 85; secundum, 84; tertium, 34 ethmoidale, 42 frontale, 37 hamatum, 70 hyoideum, 49 incisivum, 41 innominatum, 76 interparietale, 25 lachrymale, 46 lenticulare, 424 magnum, 70 multangulum majus, 71; minus, 71 nasale, 42 naviculare pedis, 34 occipitale, 22 palatinum, 45 parietale, 36 penis, 263 pisiforme, 70 presphenoidale, 29 sacrum, 8 scapholunaris, 70 sphenoidale, 25 temporale, 30 triquetrum, 70 uteri, 266 zygomaticum, 47 Ossa sesamoidea, 73, 80, 86 Ossicula auditus, 423 Ostium tubs abdominale, 264 Ovarian artery, 306 Ovary, 263, 264 Oviducts, 263, 264 Pads of feet, 427 Palate, hard, 56, 222 muscles, 230; dissection, 451 soft, 222, 229 Palatine arteries, 290 bones, 45 canal, anterior, 41; posterior, 45, 46, 54, 56 foramen, anterior, 57 grooves, 41, 56 nerve, greater, 372; lesser, 372 / process, 40 : Palatum durum, 56, 222 Palmar arch, 300 interossez, 300 Palmaris longus, M., 179, 439 INDEX. Palpebree, 409 Palpebral vein, inferior, 321; superior, 321 Pancreas, 241 Aselli, 333 . Pancreatic ducts, 242 Pancreaticoduodenalis inferior, A., 303; superior, A., 303; V., 326 Papillz of tongue, 227 Papilla of kidney, 256 Parameralis, M., 195 Parietal bone, 36 eminence, 36, 51 layer of peritoneum, 217, 218 tubercle, 36, 51 Parker and Floyd’s mixture, 463 Parotid duct, 222, 223 - gland, 223 Patella, 80 patellar ligament, 88 surface of femur, 80 Patheticus (trochlearis), N., 350, 370 . Pectineus, M., 200, 444 Pectoantibrachialis, M., 145, 437 Pectoralis major, M., 145, 437; minor, M., 146, 437 Pectoral muscles, 144, 437 ridge, 66 Pedicle, 4 Pedis perforatus, M., 205, 212 Peduncles of cerebrum, 351 Pedunculus cerebelli, 346 cerebri, 351 Pelvic arch, 76 cavity, 218 extremities, bones of, 76 girdle, 76 limbs, joints and ligaments of, 86 muscles, 186; dissection, 444 symphysis, 87 Pelvis, bones of, 76 of kidney, 256 ligaments of, 86 Penis, 257, 262 arteries of, 308 muscles of, 271 nerves of, 403 Pericardium, 279 Perineum, 268 Periorbita, 409 Peripheral nervous system, 369; dissec- tion, 465 Peritoneal cavity, 218; lesser, 219 Peritoneum, 218 Peroneal groove, 84 tubercle, 84 Peroneus brevis, M., 210, 445 communis, N., 400 longus, M., 209, 445 profundus, N., 402 491 Peroneus superficialis, N., 402 tertius, M., 210, 445 Pes, 85 Petrosal ganglion, 378 nerve, deep, 373, 405; great superfi- cial, 373, 375 sinus, inferior, 325 Petrous portion of temporal bone, 33 Peyer’s glands, 237, 238 patches, 237, 238 Phalanges, 72, 86; ligaments of, 76 Pharyngeal nerve, 379 Pharynx, 231 muscles, 232; dissection, 451 Phrenic artery, 304 nerve, 388 vein, 326 Pia mater, 337, 369 Pillars of fauces, 230 fornix, 363, 364 Pineal body, 351, 355 Pinna, 415. Pisiform bone, 70 Pituitary body, 356 Plantar arch, 314, 330 ligaments, 92 nerves, 403 Plantaris, M., 205, 445 Platysma, M., 95, 434 Pleura, 217 Plexus, anterior gastric, 382 aortic, 408 brachial, 386 cardiac, 380, 382, 405 carotid, 287 cervical, 386 coeliac, 406 hepatic, 408 inferior mesenteric, 408 lumbar, 395 lumbosacral, 396 posterior gastric, 382 pulmonary, 382 renal, 408 sacral, 399 solar, 406 splenic, 408 superior mesenteric, 408 suprarenal, 408 Plica aryepiglottica, 246 glossoepiglottica, 227, 246 sémilunaris, 410 Pollex, 72 Plicee ciliares, 413 Pons, 341, 347 Popliteal artery, 311, 312 bone, 206 gland, 334 notch, 81 vein, 330 492 Popliteus, M., 206, 445 Portal vein, 326 Portio minor (of fifth nerve), 373 Posterior auricular artery, 287 circumflex artery, 296 commissure, 355 facial vein, 323 inferior spine, 77 perforated area, 352 sulcus, 359 Sylvian gyrus, 359 thoracic nerve, 3 tibial artery, 313 Postglenoid process, 32 Postmandibular process, 32, 33 Postorbital process, 38 Postzygapophysis, 4 Poupart’s ligament, 153 ’ Practical directions, 429 Preesylvian sulcus, 360 Premaxilla, 41 Premaxillary bone, 41 Premolar teeth, 225 Preparation of bones, 430 ligaments, 431 of viscera, 447 Prepuce, 257, 262, 267 Preservation of material, 431 Preservatives for anatomical material, 431 Presphenoid bone, 25, 29 Prezygapophyses, 4 Princeps pollicis et indicis, A., 300 Profunda brachii, A., 296 femoris, A., 309 Process, accessory, 6, 8 acromion, 62, 64 alveolar, 39 angular, 19, 48 anterior clinoid, 29; superior, 78; transverse, II articular, 4, 6, 8 condyloid, 48 coracoid, 63, 64 coronoid, 48, 69 frontal, 39, 40, 47, 51 hzemal, I1 hamular, 28 jugular, 24, 52, 55 lenticular, 424 mammillary, 6, 8 mastoid, 35, 55 nasal, 41 odontoid, 14, 15 orbital, 47° palatine, 40 posterior clinoid, 26 postglenoid, 32 postmandibular, 32, 53 postorbital, 38 INDEX. Process, pseudotransverse, 8, 9 pterygoid, 26, 28 spinous, 3, 6, 8 styliform, 33, 56 transverse, 4, 6, 8, 12 xiphoid, 20 zygomatic, 31, 32, 38, 40, 47, 51 Processus costarius, 13 uncinatus, 417 Promontory, 34 Pronator muscles of forearm, 179 quadratus, M., 183, 439 teres, M.. 179, 439 Prosencephalon, 343, 344, 352 Prostate gland, 261 Protuberance, external occipital, 24 Pseudotransverse process, 8, 9 Psoas minor, M., 139, 446 Pterygoid bone, 25 canal, 27, 56, 59; nerve of, 372 Pterygoideus externus, M., III, 441; internus, M., III, 441 Pterygoid fossa, external, 30, 53; in- ternal, 28, 54 muscles, III nerves, 374 process, 26, 28 Pterygopharyngeus, M., 233 Pubic tubercle, 78 Pubiocaudalis, M., 269 Pubis, 76, 78 Pudendus, N., 403 Pulmonary artery, 275, 278, 280 ligament, 253 plexus, 382 sinuses, 278 veins, 275, 279, 315 Pulmones, 252 Pulvinar. 354 Pupil, 413, 414 Pyloric artery, 302 valve, 235 Pyramidal tracts, 345 Pyramides, 345 Pyriformis, M., 188, 444 Quadratus femoris. M., 191, 44 labii inferioris, M., 107, 435; supe- rioris, M., 105, 435 lumborum, M., 139, 446 plante, M., 213, 445 Quadriceps femoris, M., 201, 444 Radial artery, 297 fossa, 66 nerve, 392; superficial, 392 notch, 69 recurrent artery, 298 sesamoid, 73 Radio ulnar articulation, 75 INDEX. Radius, 67 Radix, 4; of lungs, 252 Rami of spinal nerves, 339 Ramus of ischium, 78 of mandible, 47, 48 of pubis, 78 Receptaculum chyli, 333; demonstration of, 460 Rectocavernosus, M., 271 Rectovaginalis, M., 272 Rectovesical pouch, 266 Rectum, 239; ligaments of, 219 Rectus abominis, M., 155, 441 capitis anterior major, M., minor, 143, 442 lateralis, M., 143, 442 posterior major, M., 134, 443; me- dius, M., 135, 443; minor, M., 135, 443 femoris, M., 201, 444 muscles of eye, 411 Reference works, 429 Removal of brain, 462 Ren, 255 Renal artery, 304 plexus, 408 veins, 326 Respiratory nerve, internal, 388 organs, 243; dissection, 452 Retina, 414 Retractor oculi, M., 411 penis, M., 271 Rhinencephalon, 362 Rhombencephalon, 341, 344 Rhomboideus, M., 119, 436 capitis, M., 118 Ribs, 18 false, I9 floating, 19 true, 19 Ridge deltoid, 66 lambdoidal, 24, 50, 52 pectoral, 66 supracondyloid, 67 Rolando, column of, 346 Roots of spinal nerves, 338 Rotator auris, M., 419, 470 Rotatores, Mm., 131 Round ligament of femur, 87, 220, 267 142; Sacral arteries, 301, 309 canal, 8 foramina, 9, 10 nerves, 399 plexus, 399 vein, middle, 328 vertebre, 1, 8 Sacrum, 1, 8 Sagittal crest, 25, 50 sinus, 30, 324 493 Salivary glands, 223 Santorini, duct of, 242 Saphenous artery, 311 nerve, 397 veins, 329, 330 Sartorius, M., 197, 444 Scalze, 425 Scala tympani, 425 vestibuli, 425 Scalenus, M., 141, 441 Scapha, 416 Scaphocuneiformis, M., 216, 445 Scapholunar bone, 70 Scaphoid bone, 69, 82, 84 Scapula, 62; muscles of, 160 Scarpa’s triangle, 310 Sciatic nerve, great, 400 notch, great, 77; lesser, 78 Sclera, 413 Sclerotic, 412, 413 Scrotum, 257, 258 Scutiform cartilage, 418 Scutuloauricularis inferior, M., 419 Second cranial nerve, 342, 354, 369, 412 Sella turcica, 26, 59 Semicircular canals, 425, 426; demon- stration, 471 Semilunar cartilages, 87 ganglion, 347, 370, 406 notch, tendon, 151 valve, 278, 279 Semimembranosus, M., 196, 444 Semispinalis (meaning), 124 capitis, M., 130, 132 cervicis, M., 130, 133, 443 Semitendinosus, M., 196, 444 Sense-organs, 409; dissection, 469 Serous covering, 219 Serratus anterior, M., 122, 437 Serratus posterior inferior, M., 148, 441; superior, M., 148, 441 Sesamoid bones, 73, 80, 86 Seventh cranial nerve, 347, 375 Shoulder-joint, 73 muscles of, 115, 156 nerves of, 387 Sight, organ of, 409 Sigmoid cavity, great, 69 gyrus, 360 Sinus cavernosus, 325 columnez vertebralis, 325 Sinuses, frontal, 38, 61 of dura mater, 324 sphenoidal, 29, 61 Sinus of kidney, 255 of vertebral column, 325 petrosus inferior, 325 sagittalis superior, 324 494 Sinus transversus, 324 Sixth cranial nerve, 347, 375 Skeleton, 1; preparation, 430 Skin, 427 muscles, 93, 427; dissection, 434 Skull, 21, 49 disarticulation of, 430 joints and ligaments of, 61 sutures of, 61 Small intestine, 236 Smell, organ of, 426 Soap-mixture for bones, 430 Soft palate, 229; muscles of, 230 Soleus, M., 205, 445 Sole of foot, muscles of, 212 Solar plexus, 406 Solitary glands, 237 Spermatic artery, external, 309; inter- nal, 304 cord, 258 vein, internal, 326 Sphenoid bone, 25 Sphenoidal sinus, 29, 61 Sphenopalatine artery, 290 foramen, 46, 54 ganglion, 372 nerve, 372 Sphincter ani externus, M., 268, 453; internus, M., 269, 454 Spigelian lobe of liver, 241 Spinal accessory nerve, 346, 382 artery, anterior, 291 column, I cord, 335; dissection, 461 Spinalis, 124 dorsi, M., 124, 128, 129, 133, 443 Spinal ganglia, 338 nerves, 337, 383; dissection of, 467 veins, 325. Spine, frontal, 37 maxillary, 45 nasal, 37 of helix, 417 ischium, 77, 78 scapula, 62, 63 tibia, 81 posterior inferior, 77 posterior nasal, 45 Spinodeltoid muscle, 156, 438 Spinotrapezius, M., 115, 436 Spinous processes, 3, 6, 8 Spiral line or ridge, 79 Splanchnic nerves, 406, 407 Spleen, 242 Splenial sulcus, 361, 362 Splenic artery, 303 plexus, ree Splenius, M., 131, 443 Squama occipitalis, 22 temporalis, 31 INDEX. Stapedius, M., 424, 471 Stapes, 424 Starch injection mass, 456 Stenon’s duct, 223 Steno’s duct, 222, 223 Stenson’s duct, 222 Sternocleidomastoid muscle, 120, 139 Sternocostalis externus, M., 150 internus, M., 151 Sternohyoid muscle, 140, 440 Sternomastoid muscle, 139, 440 Sternothyroid muscle, 141, 440 Sternum, 20 Stomach, 234, arteries of, 303 Striz medullares, 349, 354 Study, order of, 429 Styliform process, 33, 56 Styloglossus, M., 228, 440, 450 Stylohyal, 49 Stylohyoid muscle, 112, 440 Styloid process, 68, 69 Stylomandibular ligament, 62, 228 Stylomastoid foramen, 33, 34, 52, 55 Stylopharyngeus, M., 233, 451 Subclavian artery, 282, 283, 290 vein, 318 Subcutaneus male nerve, 372 Sublingual gland, 224 Submaxillary gland, 223 Submental artery, 286 Submentalis, M., 103, 435 Submental vein, 321, 323 Suboccipital nerve, 384 Subscapular artery, 294 fossa, 63 Subscapularis, M., 161, 437 Subscapular nerves, 388 Substantia perforata anterior, 362; pos- terior, 352 Sulci of cerebellum, 348 cerebrum, 359 medulla oblongata, 345 spinal cord, 335 Sulcus ansatus, 360 anterior, 359 basilaris, 347 callosalis, 362 coronalis, 360 coronarius, 274 cruciatus, 360, 361 ectosylvius, 359 falcialis, 361 hippocampal, 362 hypothalamicus, 354 intertubercularis, 66 lateralis, 360 ° marginalis, 361 palatinus, 41, 56 posterior, 359 postrhinalis, 361 INDEX. Sulcus preesylvius, 360 rhinalis, 360; posterior, 361, 362 splenialis, 361, 362 supracallosalis, 362 supraorbitalis, 360 suprasylvius, 359 Supercervicocutaneus, M., 95 Superficial temporal artery, 287 Superior cervical ganglion, 404 Supinator, M., 177, 439; longus, M.,173 Supracallosal sulcus, 362 Supracondyloid foramen, 67 ridge, 67 Supraglenoidal tubercle, 64 Supraoccipital bone, 22 Supraorbital arch, 37, 51 sulcus, 360 Suprarenal body, 257 plexus, 408 Suprascapular artery, 293 nerve, 388 notch, 64 Supraspinatus, M., 159, 438 Supraspinous fossa, 63 ligament, 16 Suprasylvian gyrus, 360 sulcus, 259 Sural artery, 313 nerve. 400 Suspensory ligament, 219, 220, 257 Sustentaculum tali, 84 Sutures of skull, 61 Sylvius, aqueduct of, 342, 343, 350, 351, 352 fissure of, 358 Sympathetic nervous system, 404; dis- section, 465 Symphysis of jaw, 47, 61 menti, 47, 61 pelvis, 76 pubis, 76, 78 Systema lymphaticum, 330 nervorum sympatheticum, 404 Tail, arteries of, 309 muscles of, 136 Tail muscles, dissection of, 447 Tail, nerves of, 404 veins of, 328 vertebrz of, II Talus, 82 Tapetum, 413 Tarsal glands, 409 Tarsea medialis, A., 315 Tarsus, 82 joints and ligaments of, 91 muscles of, 215 Taste-buds, 427 Taste, nerve of, 378 organs of, 427 495 Teeth, 224 deciduous, 226 Tegmen tympani, 35 Telencephalon, 341, 343, 344, 357 Temporal arteries, 287 Temporal bone, 30 Temporal fossa, 51, 53 Temporal lobe, 358 Temporal muscle, 110, 440 Temporal nerve, deep, 374 Temporal nerves, 373, 374, 377 Temporal vein, superficial, 324 Tendo calcaneus, 204, 206 Tendon of Achilles, 204, 206 Tensor fasciz latee M., 187, 444 tympani, M., 424, 471 veli palatini, M., 230, 451 Tenth cranial nerve, 346, 378 Tentorium, 36, 58 Tenuissimus, M, 195, 444 Teres major, M., 163, 437, 438 Teres minor, M., 161, 438 Terms of direction, vii Testes, 258, 259 Thalamus, 352, 353 Thebesius, valve of, 277 Thigh, bones of, 79 fascia of, 186 muscles of, 194 Third cranial nerves, 352, 369 ventricle, 342, 343, 356 Thoracic aorta, 281 cavity, 217 extremities, bones of, 62 duct, 320, 331, 333 460 ganglia, 406 limbs, muscles of, 156; joints and lig- aments, 73 nerves, 393 nerves, anterior, 387 nerve, posterior, 388 Thoracicodorsalis, A., 296 Thoracic vertebre, 1 wall, muscles of, 148 Thorax, bones of, 18 lymphatics of, 333 » muscles of, 144 Thumb, muscles of, 184 Thymus gland, 254 Thyroarytenoid muscle, 251 Thyrocervical axis, 293 Thyrohyal, 49 Thyrohyoid muscle, 249 Thyroid arteries, 284 Thyroid cartilage, 247 gland, 254 Tibia, 80 Tibial artery, anterior, 313 Tibialis.anterior, M., 211, 445; poster- ior, M., 208, 445 496 Tibial nerve, 402 recurrent artery, 314 Toes, bones of, 86 muscles of, 214 Tongue, 226 muscles of, 228; dissection, 450 Tonsils. 230 Tooth formula, 224 Topographical terms, vii Trabeculae, 277 carnez, 278 Trachea, 251 Trachelomastoid muscle, 131 Tracts, pyarmidal, 345 Tractus olfactorius, 362 opticus, 354, 355 postrhinalis, 361, 362 transversus peduncularis, 351, 352 Tragicus lateralis, M., 418, 435 medialis, M., 421, 470 Tragus, 417 Transversa, V., 321 colli, A., 293 scapulz, A., 293; V,, 320 Transverse costal facet, 4 Transverse ligament, 18, 87, 91, 172 process, 4, 6, 8, 12 sinus, 324 Transversospinalis, 124 Transversus abdominis, M., 155, 441 auriculz, M., 420, 470 costarum, M., 150, 441 perinei, M., 269 thoracis, M,, 151, 441 Trapezium, 71 (brain), 345 Trapezius, M., 115, 436 Trapezoid, 71 Triangle, Scarpa’s, 310 Triangularis sterni, M., 151 Triangular ligament, 221 Triceps brachii, M., 166, 438 sure, M., 206 Tricuspid valve, 277 Trifacial nerve, 370 Trigeminal nerve, 347, 370 Triquetrum, os, 70 Trochanter, great, 79 Trochanteric fossa, 79 Trochanter, lesser, 79 Trochlea (astragalus), 83 (humerus), 66 Trochlearis nerve, 350, 370 True ribs, 19 Truncus costocervicalis, 292 thyrocervicalis, 293 Tuba auditiva, 56, 423 Tuber cinereum, 355 Tubercle, external occipital, 52 peroneal, 84 INDEX. Tubercle, pubic, 78 of rib, 19 Tubercular facet, 4 Tuberculum anterius, 14 articulare, 32 sellee, 26 Tunica albuginea, 260 dartos, 258 fibrosa, 255 vaginalis communis, 258; propria, 258 ° Tuberosity, great, 65 lesser, 65 of ischium, 78 of scapula, 63 of tibia, 80 Turbinals, 40, 42 Twelfth cranial nerve, 346, 383 ? Tween. brain, 342, 352 Tympanic bone, 31, 32 bulla, 31, 32, 55, 422 cavity, 422 membrane, 422 Tympanohyal, 49 Ulna, 68 Ulnar artery, 300 nerve, 393 recurrent artery, 298 Umbilical artery, 307 vein, 329; foetal, 220 Unciform bone, 70 Ureter, 256 Urethra, 257, 261; muscles of, 271 Urethralis, M., 273 Urogenital organs, 255; dissection of, 453 ; muscles of, 268 sinus, 263, 267 system, 255 4 Uterine artery, 308 : tubes, 263, 264 a Uterus, 263, 266 4 Uvea, 414 Vagina, 263, 267 Vaginal ligaments, 173 Vagina, muscles of, 272 Vagus, N., 346, 378 Valsalva, sinuses of, 278, 279 Variations, 328, 434, 456 Vertebral muscles, 123, 138; dissec- tion, 442, 446 Vasa efferentia testis, 260 Vas deferens, 260 Vastus intermedius, M., 203, 445 lateralis, M., 201, 445 medialis, M., 202, 445 Vater, ampulla of, 236 Vein, see Vena Veins, 315 ———- - INDEX. Veins of abdomen, 326 arm, 318 brain, 324 face, 321 foot, 329 heart, 315 larynx, 321 leg, 329 lips, 321 liver, 326 spinal cord, 325 Velum medullare anterius, -posterius, 344, 349 palatinum, 222,229; muscles of, 230 Vene, 315 Vena a lrenolumbalis, 326 angularis, 321 anonyma, 318 auricularis anterior, 324; posterior, 324 axillaris, 318 azygos, 316 brachialis, 318 cardinales, 328 cava inferior, 274, 275, 325; supe- rior, 274, 275, 316 cephalica, 319 cerebri inferior, 325; magna, 324 cervicalis ascendens, 320 cordis magna, 316 coronaria ventriculi, 326 costocervicalis 318 facialis anterior, 321; profunda, 323 frontalis, 321 gastroepiploica, 327 gastrolienalis, 327 glutea inferior, 329 hemorrhoidalis media, 329 hepatica, 326 hypogastrica, 328, 329 ilia cacommunis, 328; externa, 328, 329; interna, 328, 329 iliolumbalis, 326 intercostales, 316 jugularis externa, 319; interna, 320 lingualis, 323 lumbalis, 326 mammaria interna, 318 mediana cubiti, 319 mesenterica inferior, 328; 328 nasalis externa, 321 occipitalis, 321 pancreaticoduodenalis, 326 phrenica, 326 poplitea, 330 porte, 326 pulmonales, 275, 279 315 renalis, 326 350, 351; 324; magna, posterior, 323; superior, 497 Vena sacralis media, 328 saphena magna, 329; 33° spermatica interna, 326 subclavia, 318 submentalis, 321, 323 temporalis superficialis, 324 transversa, 321 e transversa scapulz, 320 umbilicalis, 329 vertebralis, 318 Venous sinuses of dura mater, 324 Ventral arch (atlas), 14 Ventricles of brain, 340, 362 ; of heart, 274; 277 Ventriculi dorsalis, A., 303 Ventriculus, 234, 246 Vermis, 348 Vertebrae, I caudales, LI cervicales, II lumbales, 7 sacrales, 8 thoracales, I Vertebral arch, 3 artery, 291 column, 1; ligaments of, 16; mus- cles of, 123, 138 foramen, I vein, 318 Vertebrarterial canal, 291 Veru montanum, 261 Vesical arteries, 307 Vesica urinaria, 256 Vestibule (ear), 425 (larynx), 246 (mouth), 221 Vestibulum oris, 221 of uterine tube, 264 Vibrissee, 427 Vidian nerve, 372 Villi, 236, 237 Viscera, 217 Visceral skeleton, 21 Vitreous body, 415 humor, 415 Vocal cords, 246, 249 false, 246 Vomer, 44 Vomeronasal organ, 222, 244 Vulva, 267 parva, 329, Wharton’s duct, 223 White matter, 336 zone of eye, 413 Wilder and Gage’s soap mixture for bones, 430 Willis, circle of, 289, 292 Winslow, foramen of, 220 Wirsung, duct of, 242 --Xiphihumeralis, co aoopas » 147, 437 _ . Pt a as eS watt trad * Se SRP eat Wee ser y tae 4 wae A atte Ge fasta eye pa, eee stats thee ne Steir pee - - php ait ig tee ie ie Z : Tet Sos oe, Se bot) me 1 : ve 3M sa at a ut rite Be a =f Tegestaetaate Tiare oe yeh e rai Par ieear utes 36 3 #33 } i Cr mana 4 Ceeietah stele tet gases Bane he See i rere i é : ee aye eee ee ze ete rue Tetsu EReN nae rae Eee ae : ee Bry! ot i bs ae eS : Pt aad Ma ATpPel pray as sheneoe hearts J 4 ‘ rs oh ee te H ‘ ernie Ore “> fers ; ep ade Lp a eae or ae Pitaied st eaquiagte see Pott stotel tr Tah ie c ae 4 i lett) ene # hy ~